To our customers, Old Company Name in Catalogs and Other Documents On April 1st, 2010, NEC Electronics Corporation merged with Renesas Technology Corporation, and Renesas Electronics Corporation took over all the business of both companies. Therefore, although the old company name remains in this document, it is a valid Renesas Electronics document. We appreciate your understanding. Renesas Electronics website: http://www.renesas.com April 1st, 2010 Renesas Electronics Corporation Issued by: Renesas Electronics Corporation (http://www.renesas.com) Send any inquiries to http://www.renesas.com/inquiry. Notice 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. All information included in this document is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas Electronics products listed herein, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas Electronics sales office. Also, please pay regular and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas Electronics such as that disclosed through our website. Renesas Electronics does not assume any liability for infringement of patents, copyrights, or other intellectual property rights of third parties by or arising from the use of Renesas Electronics products or technical information described in this document. No license, express, implied or otherwise, is granted hereby under any patents, copyrights or other intellectual property rights of Renesas Electronics or others. You should not alter, modify, copy, or otherwise misappropriate any Renesas Electronics product, whether in whole or in part. Descriptions of circuits, software and other related information in this document are provided only to illustrate the operation of semiconductor products and application examples. You are fully responsible for the incorporation of these circuits, software, and information in the design of your equipment. Renesas Electronics assumes no responsibility for any losses incurred by you or third parties arising from the use of these circuits, software, or information. When exporting the products or technology described in this document, you should comply with the applicable export control laws and regulations and follow the procedures required by such laws and regulations. You should not use Renesas Electronics products or the technology described in this document for any purpose relating to military applications or use by the military, including but not limited to the development of weapons of mass destruction. Renesas Electronics products and technology may not be used for or incorporated into any products or systems whose manufacture, use, or sale is prohibited under any applicable domestic or foreign laws or regulations. Renesas Electronics has used reasonable care in preparing the information included in this document, but Renesas Electronics does not warrant that such information is error free. Renesas Electronics assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred by you resulting from errors in or omissions from the information included herein. Renesas Electronics products are classified according to the following three quality grades: "Standard", "High Quality", and "Specific". The recommended applications for each Renesas Electronics product depends on the product's quality grade, as indicated below. You must check the quality grade of each Renesas Electronics product before using it in a particular application. You may not use any Renesas Electronics product for any application categorized as "Specific" without the prior written consent of Renesas Electronics. Further, you may not use any Renesas Electronics product for any application for which it is not intended without the prior written consent of Renesas Electronics. Renesas Electronics shall not be in any way liable for any damages or losses incurred by you or third parties arising from the use of any Renesas Electronics product for an application categorized as "Specific" or for which the product is not intended where you have failed to obtain the prior written consent of Renesas Electronics. The quality grade of each Renesas Electronics product is "Standard" unless otherwise expressly specified in a Renesas Electronics data sheets or data books, etc. "Standard": 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. Computers; office equipment; communications equipment; test and measurement equipment; audio and visual equipment; home electronic appliances; machine tools; personal electronic equipment; and industrial robots. "High Quality": Transportation equipment (automobiles, trains, ships, etc.); traffic control systems; anti-disaster systems; anticrime systems; safety equipment; and medical equipment not specifically designed for life support. "Specific": Aircraft; aerospace equipment; submersible repeaters; nuclear reactor control systems; medical equipment or systems for life support (e.g. artificial life support devices or systems), surgical implantations, or healthcare intervention (e.g. excision, etc.), and any other applications or purposes that pose a direct threat to human life. You should use the Renesas Electronics products described in this document within the range specified by Renesas Electronics, especially with respect to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas Electronics shall have no liability for malfunctions or damages arising out of the use of Renesas Electronics products beyond such specified ranges. Although Renesas Electronics endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, semiconductor products have specific characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use conditions. Further, Renesas Electronics products are not subject to radiation resistance design. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard them against the possibility of physical injury, and injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas Electronics product, such as safety design for hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention, appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other appropriate measures. Because the evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or system manufactured by you. Please contact a Renesas Electronics sales office for details as to environmental matters such as the environmental compatibility of each Renesas Electronics product. Please use Renesas Electronics products in compliance with all applicable laws and regulations that regulate the inclusion or use of controlled substances, including without limitation, the EU RoHS Directive. Renesas Electronics assumes no liability for damages or losses occurring as a result of your noncompliance with applicable laws and regulations. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written consent of Renesas Electronics. Please contact a Renesas Electronics sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this document or Renesas Electronics products, or if you have any other inquiries. (Note 1) "Renesas Electronics" as used in this document means Renesas Electronics Corporation and also includes its majorityowned subsidiaries. (Note 2) "Renesas Electronics product(s)" means any product developed or manufactured by or for Renesas Electronics. User's Manual 78K0/FC2 8-Bit Single-Chip Microcontrollers PD78F0881(A) PD78F0882(A) PD78F0883(A) PD78F0884(A) PD78F0885(A) PD78F0886(A) PD78F0881(A2) PD78F0882(A2) PD78F0883(A2) PD78F0884(A2) PD78F0885(A2) PD78F0886(A2) The 78K0/FC2 has an on-chip debug function. Do not use this product for mass production after the on-chip debug function has been used because its reliability cannot be guaranteed, due to issues with respect to the number of times the flash memory can be rewritten. NEC Electronics does not accept complaints concerning when use this product for mass production after the on-chip debug function has been used. Document No. U17555EJ4V0UD00 (4th edition) Date Published March 2007 NS CP(K) 2005 Printed in Japan [MEMO] 2 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD NOTES FOR CMOS DEVICES 1 VOLTAGE APPLICATION WAVEFORM AT INPUT PIN Waveform distortion due to input noise or a reflected wave may cause malfunction. If the input of the CMOS device stays in the area between VIL (MAX) and VIH (MIN) due to noise, etc., the device may malfunction. Take care to prevent chattering noise from entering the device when the input level is fixed, and also in the transition period when the input level passes through the area between VIL (MAX) and VIH (MIN). 2 HANDLING OF UNUSED INPUT PINS Unconnected CMOS device inputs can be cause of malfunction. If an input pin is unconnected, it is possible that an internal input level may be generated due to noise, etc., causing malfunction. CMOS devices behave differently than Bipolar or NMOS devices. Input levels of CMOS devices must be fixed high or low by using pull-up or pull-down circuitry. Each unused pin should be connected to VDD or GND via a resistor if there is a possibility that it will be an output pin. All handling related to unused pins must be judged separately for each device and according to related specifications governing the device. 3 PRECAUTION AGAINST ESD A strong electric field, when exposed to a MOS device, can cause destruction of the gate oxide and ultimately degrade the device operation. Steps must be taken to stop generation of static electricity as much as possible, and quickly dissipate it when it has occurred. Environmental control must be adequate. When it is dry, a humidifier should be used. It is recommended to avoid using insulators that easily build up static electricity. Semiconductor devices must be stored and transported in an anti-static container, static shielding bag or conductive material. All test and measurement tools including work benches and floors should be grounded. The operator should be grounded using a wrist strap. Semiconductor devices must not be touched with bare hands. Similar precautions need to be taken for PW boards with mounted semiconductor devices. 4 STATUS BEFORE INITIALIZATION Power-on does not necessarily define the initial status of a MOS device. Immediately after the power source is turned ON, devices with reset functions have not yet been initialized. Hence, power-on does not guarantee output pin levels, I/O settings or contents of registers. A device is not initialized until the reset signal is received. A reset operation must be executed immediately after power-on for devices with reset functions. 5 POWER ON/OFF SEQUENCE In the case of a device that uses different power supplies for the internal operation and external interface, as a rule, switch on the external power supply after switching on the internal power supply. When switching the power supply off, as a rule, switch off the external power supply and then the internal power supply. Use of the reverse power on/off sequences may result in the application of an overvoltage to the internal elements of the device, causing malfunction and degradation of internal elements due to the passage of an abnormal current. The correct power on/off sequence must be judged separately for each device and according to related specifications governing the device. 6 INPUT OF SIGNAL DURING POWER OFF STATE Do not input signals or an I/O pull-up power supply while the device is not powered. The current injection that results from input of such a signal or I/O pull-up power supply may cause malfunction and the abnormal current that passes in the device at this time may cause degradation of internal elements. Input of signals during the power off state must be judged separately for each device and according to related specifications governing the device. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 3 EEPROM is trademark of NEC Electronics Corporation. Windows, Windows NT and Windows XP are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. PC/AT is a trademark of International Business Machines Corporation. HP9000 series 700 and HP-UX are trademarks of Hewlett-Packard Company. SPARCstation is a trademark of SPARC International, Inc. Solaris and SunOS are trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. SuperFlash is a registered trademark of Silicon Storage Technology, Inc. in several countries including the United States and Japan. Caution: This product uses SuperFlash(R) technology licensed from Silicon Storage Technology, inc. * The information in this document is current as of March, 2007. The information is subject to change without notice. For actual design-in, refer to the latest publications of NEC Electronics data sheets or data books, etc., for the most up-to-date specifications of NEC Electronics products. Not all products and/or types are available in every country. Please check with an NEC Electronics sales representative for availability and additional information. * No part of this document may be copied or reproduced in any form or by any means without the prior written consent of NEC Electronics. NEC Electronics assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear in this document. * NEC Electronics does not assume any liability for infringement of patents, copyrights or other intellectual property rights of third parties by or arising from the use of NEC Electronics products listed in this document or any other liability arising from the use of such products. No license, express, implied or otherwise, is granted under any patents, copyrights or other intellectual property rights of NEC Electronics or others. * Descriptions of circuits, software and other related information in this document are provided for illustrative purposes in semiconductor product operation and application examples. The incorporation of these circuits, software and information in the design of a customer's equipment shall be done under the full responsibility of the customer. NEC Electronics assumes no responsibility for any losses incurred by customers or third parties arising from the use of these circuits, software and information. * While NEC Electronics endeavors to enhance the quality, reliability and safety of NEC Electronics products, customers agree and acknowledge that the possibility of defects thereof cannot be eliminated entirely. To minimize risks of damage to property or injury (including death) to persons arising from defects in NEC Electronics products, customers must incorporate sufficient safety measures in their design, such as redundancy, fire-containment and anti-failure features. * NEC Electronics products are classified into the following three quality grades: "Standard", "Special" and "Specific". The "Specific" quality grade applies only to NEC Electronics products developed based on a customerdesignated "quality assurance program" for a specific application. The recommended applications of an NEC Electronics product depend on its quality grade, as indicated below. Customers must check the quality grade of each NEC Electronics product before using it in a particular application. "Standard": Computers, office equipment, communications equipment, test and measurement equipment, audio and visual equipment, home electronic appliances, machine tools, personal electronic equipment and industrial robots. "Special": Transportation equipment (automobiles, trains, ships, etc.), traffic control systems, anti-disaster systems, anti-crime systems, safety equipment and medical equipment (not specifically designed for life support). "Specific": Aircraft, aerospace equipment, submersible repeaters, nuclear reactor control systems, life support systems and medical equipment for life support, etc. The quality grade of NEC Electronics products is "Standard" unless otherwise expressly specified in NEC Electronics data sheets or data books, etc. If customers wish to use NEC Electronics products in applications not intended by NEC Electronics, they must contact an NEC Electronics sales representative in advance to determine NEC Electronics' willingness to support a given application. (Note) (1) "NEC Electronics" as used in this statement means NEC Electronics Corporation and also includes its majority-owned subsidiaries. (2) "NEC Electronics products" means any product developed or manufactured by or for NEC Electronics (as defined above). M8E 02. 11-1 4 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD [MEMO] User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 5 INTRODUCTION Readers This manual is intended for user engineers who wish to understand the functions of the 78K0/FC2 and design and develop application systems and programs for these devices. The target products are as follows. 78K0/FC2: PD78F0881 (A), 78F0882 (A), 78F0883 (A), 78F0884 (A), 78F0885 (A), 78F0886 (A), 78F0881 (A2), 78F0882 (A2), 78F0883 (A2), 78F0884 (A2), 78F0885 (A2), 78F0886 (A2) Purpose This manual is intended to give users an understanding of the functions described in the Organization below. Organization The 78K0/FC2 manual is separated into two parts: this manual and the instructions edition (common to the 78K/0 Series). 78K0/FC2 User's Manual (This Manual) * * * * * How to Read This Manual Pin functions Internal block functions Interrupts Other on-chip peripheral functions Electrical specifications 78K/0 Series User's Manual Instructions * CPU functions * Instruction set * Explanation of each instruction It is assumed that the readers of this manual have general knowledge of electrical engineering, logic circuits, and microcontrollers. * When using this manual as the manual for (A) and (A2) grade products: Only the quality grade differs between (A) grade products and (A2) grade products. Read the part number as follows. * PD78F0881 PD78F0881 (A), 78F0881 (A2) * PD78F0882 PD78F0882 (A), 78F0882 (A2) * PD78F0883 PD78F0883 (A), 78F0883 (A2) * PD78F0884 PD78F0894 (A), 78F0894 (A2) * PD78F0885 PD78F0885 (A), 78F0885 (A2) * PD78F0886 PD78F0886 (A), 78F0886 (A2) * To gain a general understanding of functions: Read this manual in the order of the CONTENTS. The mark shows major revised points. * How to interpret the register format: For a bit number enclosed in brackets, the bit name is defined as a reserved word in the assembler, and is already defined in the header file named sfrbit.h in the C compiler. * To check the details of a register when you know the register name: Refer to APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX. Conventions 6 Data significance: Active low representations: Note: Caution: Remark: Numerical representations: Higher digits on the left and lower digits on the right xxx (overscore over pin and signal name) Footnote for item marked with Note in the text. Information requiring particular attention Supplementary information ... xxxx or xxxxB Binary ... xxxx Decimal Hexadecimal ... xxxxH User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Related Documents The related documents indicated in this publication may include preliminary versions. However, preliminary versions are not marked as such. Documents Related to Devices Document Name Document No. 78K0/FC2 User's Manual This manual 78K/0 Series Instructions User's Manual U12326E Documents Related to Development Tools (Software) (User's Manuals) Document Name RA78K0 Ver.3.80 Assembler Package CC78K0 Ver.3.70 C Compiler ID78K0-QB Ver. 2.90 Integrated Debugger Document No. Operation U17199E Language U17198E Structured Assembly Language U17197E Operation U17201E Language U17200E Operation U17437E PM plus Ver. 5.20 U16934E Documents Related to Development Tools (Hardware) (User's Manuals) Document Name Document No. QB-78K0FX2 In-Circuit Emulator U17534E QB-78K0MINI ON-CHIP DEBUG Emulator U17029E QB-MINI2 On-Chip Debug Emulator with Programming Function U18371E Documents Related to Flash Memory Programming Document Name Document No. PG-FP4 Flash Memory Programmer User's Manual U15260E PG-FPL3 Flash Memory Programmer User's Manual U17454E Other Documents Document Name Document No. SEMICONDUCTOR SELECTION GUIDE - Products and Packages - X13769X Semiconductor Device Mount Manual Note Quality Grades on NEC Semiconductor Devices C11531E NEC Semiconductor Device Reliability/Quality Control System C10983E Guide to Prevent Damage for Semiconductor Devices by Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) C11892E Note See the "Semiconductor Device Mount Manual" website (http://www.necel.com/pkg/en/mount/index.html). Caution The related documents listed above are subject to change without notice. Be sure to use the latest version of each document when designing. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 7 CONTENTS CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE ............................................................................................................................ 17 1.1 Features......................................................................................................................................... 17 1.2 Applications .................................................................................................................................. 18 1.3 Ordering Information ................................................................................................................... 18 1.4 Pin Configuration (Top View) ...................................................................................................... 19 1.5 Fx2 Series Lineup......................................................................................................................... 22 1.5.1 78K0/Fx2 product lineup ................................................................................................................... 22 1.6 Block Diagram .............................................................................................................................. 24 1.7 Outline of Functions .................................................................................................................... 26 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS ............................................................................................................... 28 2.1 Pin Function List .......................................................................................................................... 28 2.2 Description of Pin Functions ...................................................................................................... 32 2.2.1 P00, P01, P06 (port 0)....................................................................................................................... 32 2.2.2 P10 to P17 (port 1) ............................................................................................................................ 33 2.2.3 P30 to P33 (port 3) ............................................................................................................................ 34 2.2.4 P40, P41 (port 4) ............................................................................................................................... 34 2.2.5 P60 to P63 (port 6) ............................................................................................................................ 34 2.2.6 P70 to P73 (port 7) ............................................................................................................................ 35 2.2.7 P80 to P87 (port 8) ............................................................................................................................ 35 2.2.8 P90 (port 9) ....................................................................................................................................... 36 2.2.9 P120 to P124 (port 12) ...................................................................................................................... 36 2.2.10 P130, P131 (port 13) ....................................................................................................................... 37 2.2.11 AVREF ............................................................................................................................................... 37 2.2.12 AVSS ................................................................................................................................................ 37 2.2.13 RESET ............................................................................................................................................ 37 2.2.14 REGC.............................................................................................................................................. 37 2.2.15 VDD and EVDD .................................................................................................................................. 37 2.2.16 VSS and EVSS ................................................................................................................................... 37 2.2.17 FLMD0 ............................................................................................................................................ 38 2.3 Pin I/O Circuits and Recommended Connection of Unused Pins ........................................... 39 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE ...................................................................................................... 43 3.1 Memory Space .............................................................................................................................. 43 3.1.1 Internal program memory space........................................................................................................ 48 3.1.2 Internal data memory space .............................................................................................................. 49 3.1.3 Special function register (SFR) area ................................................................................................. 49 3.1.4 Data memory addressing .................................................................................................................. 50 3.2 Processor Registers .................................................................................................................... 54 3.2.1 Control registers ................................................................................................................................ 54 3.2.2 General-purpose registers................................................................................................................. 58 3.2.3 Special Function Registers (SFRs) ................................................................................................... 59 3.3 Instruction Address Addressing................................................................................................. 65 3.3.1 Relative addressing........................................................................................................................... 65 3.3.2 Immediate addressing ....................................................................................................................... 66 8 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 3.3.3 Table indirect addressing ...................................................................................................................67 3.3.4 Register addressing ...........................................................................................................................67 3.4 Operand Address Addressing .................................................................................................... 68 3.4.1 Implied addressing .............................................................................................................................68 3.4.2 Register addressing ...........................................................................................................................69 3.4.3 Direct addressing ...............................................................................................................................70 3.4.4 Short direct addressing ......................................................................................................................71 3.4.5 Special function register (SFR) addressing........................................................................................72 3.4.6 Register indirect addressing...............................................................................................................73 3.4.7 Based addressing ..............................................................................................................................74 3.4.8 Based indexed addressing.................................................................................................................75 3.4.9 Stack addressing................................................................................................................................76 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS........................................................................................................... 77 4.1 Port Functions .............................................................................................................................. 77 4.2 Port Configuration ....................................................................................................................... 78 4.2.1 Port 0 .................................................................................................................................................79 4.2.2 Port 1 .................................................................................................................................................81 4.2.3 Port 3 .................................................................................................................................................84 4.2.4 Port 4 .................................................................................................................................................86 4.2.5 Port 6 .................................................................................................................................................87 4.2.6 Port 7 .................................................................................................................................................88 4.2.7 Port 8 .................................................................................................................................................91 4.2.8 Port 9 .................................................................................................................................................92 4.2.9 Port 12 ...............................................................................................................................................94 4.2.10 Port 13 .............................................................................................................................................97 4.3 Registers Controlling Port Function .......................................................................................... 99 4.4 Port Function Operations.......................................................................................................... 106 4.4.1 Writing to I/O port .............................................................................................................................106 4.4.2 Reading from I/O port.......................................................................................................................106 4.4.3 Operations on I/O port......................................................................................................................106 4.5 Cautions on 1-Bit Manipulation Instruction for Port Register n (Pn).................................... 107 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR .................................................................................................... 108 5.1 Functions of Clock Generator................................................................................................... 108 5.2 Configuration of Clock Generator ............................................................................................ 109 5.3 Registers Controlling Clock Generator ................................................................................... 111 5.4 System Clock Oscillator ............................................................................................................ 120 5.4.1 X1 oscillator .....................................................................................................................................120 5.4.2 XT1 oscillator ...................................................................................................................................120 5.4.3 When subsystem clock is not used ..................................................................................................123 5.4.4 Internal high-speed oscillator ...........................................................................................................123 5.4.5 Internal low-speed oscillator.............................................................................................................123 5.4.6 Prescaler..........................................................................................................................................123 5.5 Clock Generator Operation ....................................................................................................... 124 5.6 Controlling Clock ....................................................................................................................... 128 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock................................................................................................128 5.6.2 Example of controlling internal high-speed oscillation clock.............................................................131 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 9 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock...........................................................................................133 5.6.4 Controlling internal low-speed oscillation clock ................................................................................135 5.6.5 Clocks supplied to CPU and peripheral hardware ............................................................................135 5.6.6 CPU clock status transition diagram.................................................................................................136 5.6.7 Condition before changing CPU clock and processing after changing CPU clock ...........................141 5.6.8 Time required for switchover of CPU clock and main system clock .................................................142 5.6.9 Conditions before clock oscillation is stopped ..................................................................................143 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01......................................................... 144 6.1 Functions of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01............................................................. 145 6.2 Configuration of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 ...................................................... 146 6.3 Registers Controlling 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01.............................................. 154 6.4 Operation of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 ............................................................. 166 6.4.1 Interval timer operation.....................................................................................................................166 6.4.2 PPG output operations .....................................................................................................................169 6.4.3 Pulse width measurement operations ..............................................................................................172 6.4.4 External event counter operation......................................................................................................180 6.4.5 Square-wave output operation .........................................................................................................183 6.4.6 One-shot pulse output operation ......................................................................................................185 6.5 Special Use of TM0n .................................................................................................................. 190 6.5.1 Rewriting CR01n during TM0n operation .........................................................................................190 6.5.2 Setting LVS0n and LVR0n ...............................................................................................................190 6.6 Cautions for 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 ............................................................. 192 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51........................................................... 196 7.1 Functions of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51............................................................... 196 7.2 Configuration of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 ........................................................ 198 7.3 Registers Controlling 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51................................................ 200 7.4 Operations of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 ............................................................. 205 7.4.1 Operation as interval timer ...............................................................................................................205 7.4.2 Operation as external event counter ................................................................................................207 7.4.3 Square-wave output operation .........................................................................................................208 7.4.4 PWM output operation......................................................................................................................209 7.5 Cautions for 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 ............................................................... 213 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 .......................................................................................... 214 8.1 Functions of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 ....................................................................................... 214 8.2 Configuration of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1................................................................................. 214 8.3 Registers Controlling 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 ........................................................................ 218 8.4 Operation of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1........................................................................................ 223 8.4.1 Operation as interval timer/square-wave output ...............................................................................223 8.4.2 Operation as PWM output mode ......................................................................................................226 8.4.3 Carrier generator mode operation (8-bit timer H1 only)....................................................................232 CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER................................................................................................................ 239 9.1 Functions of Watch Timer ......................................................................................................... 239 9.2 Configuration of Watch Timer................................................................................................... 240 9.3 Register Controlling Watch Timer ............................................................................................ 241 10 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 9.4 Watch Timer Operations............................................................................................................ 243 9.4.1 Watch timer operation ......................................................................................................................243 9.4.2 Interval timer operation ....................................................................................................................244 9.5 Cautions for Watch Timer ......................................................................................................... 245 CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER ..................................................................................................... 246 10.1 Functions of Watchdog Timer ................................................................................................ 246 10.2 Configuration of Watchdog Timer.......................................................................................... 247 10.3 Register Controlling Watchdog Timer ................................................................................... 248 10.4 Operation of Watchdog Timer................................................................................................. 249 10.4.1 Controlling operation of watchdog timer.........................................................................................249 10.4.2 Setting overflow time of watchdog timer.........................................................................................251 10.4.3 Setting window open period of watchdog timer ..............................................................................252 CHAPTER 11 CLOCK OUTPUT/BUZZER OUTPUT CONTROLLER............................................... 254 11.1 Functions of Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller.......................................................... 254 11.2 Configuration of Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller ................................................... 255 11.3 Register Controlling Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller............................................. 255 11.4 Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller Operations............................................................. 258 11.4.1 Clock output operation ...................................................................................................................258 11.4.2 Operation as buzzer output ............................................................................................................258 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER ......................................................................................................... 259 12.1 Function of A/D Converter ...................................................................................................... 259 12.2 Configuration of A/D Converter .............................................................................................. 260 12.3 Registers Used in A/D Converter ........................................................................................... 262 12.4 A/D Converter Operations ....................................................................................................... 271 12.4.1 Basic operations of A/D converter..................................................................................................271 12.4.2 Input voltage and conversion results..............................................................................................273 12.4.3 A/D converter operation mode .......................................................................................................274 12.5 How to Read A/D Converter Characteristics Table .............................................................. 276 12.6 Cautions for A/D Converter..................................................................................................... 278 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61.......................................................... 282 13.1 Functions of Serial Interfaces UART60 and UART61 ........................................................... 282 13.2 Configurations of Serial Interface UART60 and UART61..................................................... 287 13.3 Registers Controlling Serial Interfaces UART60 and UART61 ............................................ 291 13.4 Operations of Serial Interface UART60 and UART61 ........................................................... 310 13.4.1 Operation stop mode......................................................................................................................310 13.4.2 Asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode .................................................................................311 13.4.3 Dedicated baud rate generator ......................................................................................................326 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 ........................................................................................ 332 14.1 Functions of Serial Interface CSI10........................................................................................ 332 14.2 Configuration of Serial Interface CSI10 ................................................................................. 333 14.3 Registers Controlling Serial Interface CSI10......................................................................... 335 14.4 Operation of Serial Interface CSI10........................................................................................ 338 14.4.1 Operation stop mode......................................................................................................................338 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 11 14.4.2 3-wire serial I/O mode ....................................................................................................................339 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER ..................................................................................................... 349 15.1 Outline Description .................................................................................................................. 349 15.1.1 Features .........................................................................................................................................349 15.1.2 Overview of functions .....................................................................................................................350 15.1.3 Configuration ..................................................................................................................................351 15.2 CAN Protocol ............................................................................................................................ 352 15.2.1 Frame format..................................................................................................................................352 15.2.2 Frame types ...................................................................................................................................353 15.2.3 Data frame and remote frame ........................................................................................................353 15.2.4 Error frame .....................................................................................................................................361 15.2.5 Overload frame...............................................................................................................................362 15.3 Functions .................................................................................................................................. 363 15.3.1 Determining bus priority .................................................................................................................363 15.3.2 Bit stuffing ......................................................................................................................................363 15.3.3 Multi masters ..................................................................................................................................363 15.3.4 Multi cast ........................................................................................................................................363 15.3.5 CAN sleep mode/CAN stop mode function ....................................................................................363 15.3.6 Error control function ......................................................................................................................364 15.3.7 Baud rate control function ..............................................................................................................370 15.4 Connection With Target System ............................................................................................. 374 15.5 Internal Registers of CAN Controller...................................................................................... 375 15.5.1 CAN controller configuration...........................................................................................................375 15.5.2 Register access type ......................................................................................................................376 15.5.3 Register bit configuration................................................................................................................385 15.6 Bit Set/Clear Function.............................................................................................................. 389 15.7 Control Registers ..................................................................................................................... 391 15.8 CAN Controller Initialization.................................................................................................... 426 15.8.1 Initialization of CAN module ...........................................................................................................426 15.8.2 Initialization of message buffer .......................................................................................................426 15.8.3 Redefinition of message buffer.......................................................................................................426 15.8.4 Transition from initialization mode to operation mode ....................................................................427 15.8.5 Resetting error counter C0ERC of CAN module ............................................................................428 15.9 Message Reception .................................................................................................................. 429 15.9.1 Message reception .........................................................................................................................429 15.9.2 Receive Data Read ........................................................................................................................430 15.9.3 Receive history list function ............................................................................................................431 15.9.4 Mask function .................................................................................................................................433 15.9.5 Multi buffer receive block function ..................................................................................................435 15.9.6 Remote frame reception .................................................................................................................436 15.10 Message Transmission.......................................................................................................... 437 15.10.1 Message transmission..................................................................................................................437 15.10.2 Transmit history list function .........................................................................................................439 15.10.3 Automatic block transmission (ABT).............................................................................................441 15.10.4 Transmission abort process .........................................................................................................442 15.10.5 Remote frame transmission..........................................................................................................443 15.11 Power Save Modes................................................................................................................. 444 12 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 15.11.1 CAN sleep mode ..........................................................................................................................444 15.11.2 CAN stop mode............................................................................................................................446 15.11.3 Example of using power saving modes........................................................................................447 15.12 Interrupt Function .................................................................................................................. 448 15.13 Diagnosis Functions and Special Operational Modes ....................................................... 449 15.13.1 Receive-only mode ......................................................................................................................449 15.13.2 Single-shot mode .........................................................................................................................450 15.13.3 Self-test mode ..............................................................................................................................451 15.13.4 Receive/Transmit Operation in Each Operation Mode .................................................................452 15.14 Time Stamp Function............................................................................................................. 453 15.14.1 Time stamp function.....................................................................................................................453 15.15 Baud Rate Settings ................................................................................................................ 455 15.15.1 Baud rate settings ........................................................................................................................455 15.15.2 Representative examples of baud rate settings ...........................................................................459 15.16 Operation of CAN Controller................................................................................................. 463 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS ............................................................................................ 489 16.1 Interrupt Function Types......................................................................................................... 489 16.2 Interrupt Sources and Configuration ..................................................................................... 489 16.3 Registers Controlling Interrupt Functions ............................................................................ 493 16.4 Interrupt Servicing Operations ............................................................................................... 501 16.4.1 Maskable interrupt acknowledgement............................................................................................501 16.4.2 Software interrupt request acknowledgement ................................................................................503 16.4.3 Multiple interrupt servicing .............................................................................................................504 16.4.4 Interrupt request hold .....................................................................................................................507 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION.................................................................................................. 508 17.1 Standby Function and Configuration..................................................................................... 508 17.1.1 Standby function ............................................................................................................................508 17.1.2 Registers controlling standby function............................................................................................508 17.2 Standby Function Operation................................................................................................... 511 17.2.1 HALT mode ....................................................................................................................................511 17.2.2 STOP mode ...................................................................................................................................516 CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION ....................................................................................................... 523 18.1 Register for Confirming Reset Source................................................................................... 531 CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER................................................................................................... 532 19.1 Functions of Multiplier/Divider ............................................................................................... 532 19.2 Configuration of Multiplier/Divider......................................................................................... 532 19.3 Register Controlling Multiplier/Divider .................................................................................. 536 19.4 Operations of Multiplier/Divider.............................................................................................. 537 19.4.1 Multiplication operation ..................................................................................................................537 19.4.2 Division operation...........................................................................................................................539 CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT ..................................................................................... 541 20.1 Functions of Power-on-Clear Circuit ..................................................................................... 541 20.2 Configuration of Power-on-Clear Circuit ............................................................................... 542 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 13 20.3 Operation of Power-on-Clear Circuit ...................................................................................... 542 20.4 Cautions for Power-on-Clear Circuit ...................................................................................... 545 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR ....................................................................................... 547 21.1 Functions of Low-Voltage Detector........................................................................................ 547 21.2 Configuration of Low-Voltage Detector ................................................................................. 548 21.3 Registers Controlling Low-Voltage Detector......................................................................... 548 21.4 Operation of Low-Voltage Detector ........................................................................................ 551 21.4.1 When used as reset .......................................................................................................................552 21.4.2 When used as interrupt ..................................................................................................................557 21.5 Cautions for Low-Voltage Detector ........................................................................................ 562 CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE............................................................................................................... 565 22.1 Functions of Option Bytes ...................................................................................................... 565 22.2 Format of Option Byte ............................................................................................................. 567 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY .......................................................................................................... 570 23.1 Internal Memory Size Switching Register.............................................................................. 570 23.2 Internal Expansion RAM Size Switching Register ................................................................ 571 23.3 Writing with Flash Memory Programmer ............................................................................... 572 23.4 Programming Environment ..................................................................................................... 578 23.5 Communication Mode.............................................................................................................. 578 23.6 Connection of Pins on Board.................................................................................................. 580 23.6.1 FLMD0 pin......................................................................................................................................580 23.6.2 Serial interface pins........................................................................................................................580 23.6.3 RESET pin......................................................................................................................................582 23.6.4 Port pins .........................................................................................................................................582 23.6.5 REGC pin .......................................................................................................................................582 23.6.6 Other signal pins ............................................................................................................................582 23.6.7 Power supply..................................................................................................................................583 23.7 Programming Method .............................................................................................................. 584 23.7.1 Controlling flash memory................................................................................................................584 23.7.2 Flash memory programming mode.................................................................................................584 23.7.3 Selecting communication mode......................................................................................................585 23.7.4 Communication commands ............................................................................................................586 23.8 Security Settings ...................................................................................................................... 587 23.9 Processing Time for Each Command When PG-FP4 Is Used (Reference)......................... 589 23.10 Flash Memory Programming by Self-Programming ........................................................... 590 23.10.1 Registers used for self-programming function ..............................................................................596 23.11 Boot Swap Function............................................................................................................... 600 CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION ..................................................................................... 602 24.1 Outline of Functions ................................................................................................................ 602 24.2 Connection with MINICUBE..................................................................................................... 603 24.3 Connection Circuit Examples ................................................................................................. 604 24.4 On-Chip Debug Security ID ..................................................................................................... 606 24.5 Restrictions and Cautions on On-Chip Debug Function ..................................................... 606 14 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET ...................................................................................................... 607 25.1 Conventions Used in Operation List...................................................................................... 607 25.1.1 Operand identifiers and specification methods ..............................................................................607 25.1.2 Description of operation column.....................................................................................................608 25.1.3 Description of flag operation column ..............................................................................................608 25.2 Operation List ........................................................................................................................... 609 25.3 Instructions Listed by Addressing Type ............................................................................... 617 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS).................................. 620 26.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings .................................................................................................... 620 26.2 Oscillator Characteristics........................................................................................................ 622 26.3 DC Characteristics ................................................................................................................... 624 27.4 AC Characteristics ................................................................................................................... 631 27.5 Data Retention Characteristics............................................................................................... 641 27.6 Flash EEPROM Programming Characteristics...................................................................... 642 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS)................................ 643 27.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings .................................................................................................... 643 27.2 Oscillator Characteristics........................................................................................................ 645 27.3 DC Characteristics ................................................................................................................... 647 27.4 AC Characteristics ................................................................................................................... 653 27.5 Data Retention Characteristics............................................................................................... 663 27.6 Flash EEPROM Programming Characteristics...................................................................... 664 CHAPTER 28 PACKAGE DRAWINGS................................................................................................ 665 CHAPTER 29 RECOMMENDED SOLDERING CONDITIONS........................................................... 667 CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT ................................................................................................ 668 30.1 Cautions for Wait ..................................................................................................................... 668 30.2 Peripheral Hardware That Generates Wait ............................................................................ 669 30.3 Example of Wait Occurrence .................................................................................................. 671 APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS .............................................................................................. 672 A.1 Software Package...................................................................................................................... 676 A.2 Language Processing Software............................................................................................... 676 A.3 Control Software........................................................................................................................ 677 A.4 Flash Memory Programming Tools ......................................................................................... 678 A.4.1 When using flash memory programmer FG-FP4, FL-PR4, PG-FPL3, and FP-LITE3......................678 A.4.2 When using on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 ...................................678 A.5 Debugging Tools (Hardware) ................................................................................................... 679 A.5.1 When using in-circuit emulator QB-78K0FX2 ..................................................................................679 A.5.2 When using on-chip debug emulator QB-78K0MINI ........................................................................679 A.5.3 When using on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 ...................................680 A.6 Debugging Tools (Software)..................................................................................................... 680 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 15 APPENDIX B NOTES ON TARGET SYSTEM DESIGN ................................................................... 681 APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX ......................................................................................................... 683 C.1 Register Index (In Alphabetical Order with Respect to Register Names) ............................ 683 C.2 Register Index (In Alphabetical Order with Respect to Register Symbol)........................... 688 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY ..................................................................................................... 692 D.1 Main Revisions in this Edition.................................................................................................. 692 D.2 Revision History of Preceding Editions .................................................................................. 693 16 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE 1.1 Features { Minimum instruction execution time can be changed from high speed (0.1 s: @ 20 MHz operation with highspeed system clock) to ultra low-speed (122 s: @ 32.768 kHz operation with subsystem clock) { General-purpose register: 8 bits x 32 registers (8 bits x 8 registers x 4 banks) { ROM, RAM capacities Item Program Memory (ROM) Part Number PD78F0881, 78F0884 Flash memory Note Data Memory Internal High-Speed RAM 32 KB PD78F0882, 78F0885 48 KB PD78F0883, 78F0886 60 KB Note 1024 bytes Internal Expansion RAM Note 1024 bytes 2048 bytes Note The internal flash memory, internal high-speed RAM capacities, and internal expansion RAM capacities can be changed using the internal memory size switching register (IMS) and the internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS). { On-chip single-power-supply flash memory { Self-programming (with boot swap function) { On-chip debug function { On-chip power-on-clear (POC) circuit and low-voltage detector (LVI) { Short startup is possible via the CPU default start using the on-chip internal high-speed oscillator { On-chip watchdog timer (operable with on-chip internal low-speed oscillator clock) { On-chip multiplier/divider { On-chip clock output/buzzer output controller { I/O ports: PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883: 37 (N-ch open drain: 3) PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886: 41 (N-ch open drain: 4) { Timer: 8 channels Note 1 { Serial interface: 3 channels (UART (LIN (Local Interconnect Network)-bus supported): 1 channel, CSI/UART Note 2: 1 channel, CAN: 1 channel) { 10-bit resolution A/D converter: PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883: 8 channels PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886: 9 channels { Supply voltage: VDD = 4.0 to 5.5 V when 20 MHz, VDD = 2.7 to 5.5 V when 10 MHz, VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V when 5 MHz (with internal high-speed oscillator clock or subsystem clock: VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V) { Operating ambient temperature: TA = -40 to +85C, -40 to +125C Notes 1. Since TM01 does not have the following terminal at 78K0/FC2, the function is restricted in part. PD78F0881, 78F0882, and 78F0883: TI001, TI011, TO01 PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886: TI001 2. Select either of the functions of these alternate-function pins. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 17 CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE 1.2 Applications { Automotive electrical appliances (Body control, Door control, Front light control) { Industrial equipment (Industrial robot, Building control) 1.3 Ordering Information * Flash memory version Part Number PD78F0881GB(A)-GAF-AX PD78F0881GB(A2)-GAF-AX PD78F0882GB(A)-GAF-AX PD78F0882GB(A2)-GAF-AX PD78F0883GB(A)-GAF-AX PD78F0883GB(A2)-GAF-AX PD78F0884GA(A)-GAM-AX PD78F0884GA(A2)-GAM-AX PD78F0885GA(A)-GAM-AX PD78F0885GA(A2)-GAM-AX PD78F0886GA(A)-GAM-AX PD78F0886GA(A2)-GAM-AX Package 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) Special 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) Special 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) Special 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) Special 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) Special 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) Special 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Special 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Special 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Special 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Special 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Special 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Special Remark All these products are lead free products. 18 Quality Grade User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE 1.4 Pin Configuration (Top View) P120/INTP0/EXLVI P00/TI000 P01/TI010/TO00 P80/ANI0 P81/ANI1 P82/ANI2 P83/ANI3 P84/ANI4 P85/ANI5 P86/ANI6 P87/ANI7 * 44-pin plastic LQFP (10x10) 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 1 33 2 32 3 31 4 30 5 29 6 28 7 27 8 26 9 25 10 24 11 23 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 AVSS AVREF P10/SCK10/TxD61 P11/SI10/RxD61 P12/SO10 P13/TxD60 P14/RxD60 P15/TOH0 P16/TOH1/INTP5 P17/TI50/TO50 P30/INTP1 P60 P61 P62 P33/TI51/TO51/INTP4 P130 P73/BUZ/INTP7 P72/PCL/INTP6 P71/CRxD P70/CTxD P32/INTP3 P31/INTP2 P41 P40 RESET P124/XT2/EXCLKS P123/XT1 FLMD0 P122/X2/EXCLK P121/X1 REGC VSS/EVSS VDD/EVDD Cautions 1. Make AVSS the same potential as VSS/EVSS. 2. Connect the REGC pin to VSS via a capacitor (0.47 to 1 F: recommended). 3. ANI0/P80 to ANI7/P87 are set in the analog input mode after release of reset. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 19 CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE P131 P00/TI000 P01/TI010/TO00 P80/ANI0 P81/ANI1 P82/ANI2 P83/ANI3 P84/ANI4 P85/ANI5 P86/ANI6 P87/ANI7 P90/ANI8 * 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) 1 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 2 3 35 4 34 33 5 32 6 7 8 31 30 9 10 11 28 27 26 29 12 25 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 AVSS AVREF P10/SCK10/TxD61 P11/SI10/RxD61 P12/SO10 P13/TxD60 P14/RxD60 P15/TOH0 P16/TOH1/INTP5 P17/TI50/TO50 P30/INTP1 P31/INTP2 P60 P61 P62 P63 P33/TI51/TO51/INTP4 P130 P73/BUZ/INTP7 P72/PCL/INTP6 P71/CRxD P70/CTxD P06/TI011/TO01 P32/INTP3 P120/INTP0/EXLVI P41 P40 RESET P124/XT2/EXCLKS P123/XT1 FLMD0 P122/X2/EXCLK P121/X1 REGC VSS/EVSS VDD/EVDD Cautions 1. Make AVSS the same potential as VSS/EVSS. 2. Connect the REGC pin to VSS via a capacitor (0.47 to 1 F: recommended). 3. ANI0/P80 to ANI7/P87 are set in the analog input mode after release of reset. 20 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE Pin Identification ANI0 to ANI8: Analog input P70 to P73: Port 7 AVREF: Analog reference voltage P80 to P87: Port 8 AVSS: Analog ground P90: Port 9 BUZ: Buzzer output P120 to P124: Port 12 CRxD: Receive data for CAN P130, P131: Port 13 CTxD: Transmit data for CAN PCL: Programmable clock output EVDD: Power supply for port REGC: Regulator Capacitance EVSS: Ground for port RESET: Reset EXCLK: External clock input RxD60, RxD61: Receive data SCK10: Serial clock input/output (Main system clock) EXCLKS: EXLVI: FLMD0: External clock input SI10: Serial data input (Subsystem clock) SO10: Serial data output External potential input TI000, TI010, for low-voltage detector TI011, TI50, TI51: Flash programming mode TO00, TO01, Timer input INTP0 to INTP7: External interrupt input TO50, TO51, P00, P01, TOH0, TOH1: Timer output TxD60, TxD61: Transmit data P06: Port 0 P10 to P17: Port 1 VDD: Power supply P30 to P33: Port 3 VSS: Ground P40, P41: Port 4 X1, X2: Crystal oscillator (high-speed system clock) P60 to P63: Port 6 XT1, XT2: Crystal oscillator (subsystem clock) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 21 CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE 1.5 Fx2 Series Lineup 1.5.1 78K0/Fx2 product lineup * 44-pin LQFP (10 x 10 mm 0.8 mm pitch) 78K0/FC2 PD78F0881 Single-power-supply flash memory: 32 KB, RAM: 2 KB PD78F0882 PD78F0883 Single-power-supply flash memory: 48 KB, RAM: 3 KB Single-power-supply flash memory: 60KB, RAM: 3 KB * 48-pin LQFP (7 x 7 mm 0.5 mm pitch) 78K0/FC2 PD78F0884 Single-power-supply flash memory: 32 KB, RAM: 2 KB PD78F0885 PD78F0886 Single-power-supply flash memory: 48 KB, RAM: 3 KB Single-power-supply flash memory: 60KB, RAM: 3 KB * 64-pin LQFP (10 x 10 mm 0.5 mm pitch, 12 x 12 mm 0.65 mm pitch) 78K0/FE2 PD78F0888 PD78F0887 Single-power-supply flash memory: 48 KB, RAM: 3 KB Single-power-supply flash memory: 60 KB, RAM: 3 KB PD78F0889 Single-power-supply flash memory: 96 KB, RAM: 5 KB PD78F0890 Single-power-supply flash memory: 128 KB, RAM: 7 KB * 80-pin LQFP (12 x 12 mm 0.5 mm pitch, 14 x 14 mm 0.65 mm pitch) 78K0/FF2 PD78F0891 Single-power-supply flash memory: 60 KB, RAM: 3 KB Remark 22 All product with on-chip debug function. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD PD78F0892 Single-power-supply flash memory: 96 KB, RAM: 5 KB PD78F0893 Single-power-supply flash memory: 128 KB, RAM: 7 KB CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE The list of functions in the 78K0/Fx2 is shown below. Part Number 78K0/FC2 78K0/FE2 78K0/FF2 Item Number of pins Internal memory (bytes) 44 pins Flash memory 64 pins 80 pins 32 K/48 K/60 K 48 K/60 K/96 K/128 K 60 K/96 K/128 K 2 K/3 K/3 K 3 K/3 K/5 K/7 K 3 K/5 K/7 K RAM Power supply voltage 48 pins VDD = 4.0 to 5.5 V when 20 MHz, VDD = 2.7 to 5.5 V when 10 MHz, VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V when 5 MHz 0.1 s (when 20 MHz, VDD = 4.0 to 5.5 V) Minimum instruction execution time Clock Crystal/ceramic 4 to 20 MHz Subclock Ports 32.768 kHz Internal low-speed oscillator 240 kHz (TYP.) Internal high-speed oscillator 8 MHz (TYP., VDD = 2.7 to 5.5 V) CMOS I/O 33 36 50 CMOS output N-ch open-drain I/O Timer 3 16 bits (TM0) 4 2 ch Note 4 ch 8 bits (TM5) 2 ch 8 bits (TMH) 2 ch For watch 1 ch WDT 1 ch Serial CAN interface 3-wire CSI 1 ch - 1 ch LIN-UART 1 ch LIN-UART/CSI 10-bit A/D converter 1 ch 8 ch 9 ch 12 ch Interrupts External Internal Reset LVI 16 ch 8 24 29 RESET pin POC 66 1 Provided 1.59 V 0.15 V (detection voltage is fixed) 4.24/4.09/3.93/3.78/3.62/3.47/3.32/3.16/3.01/2.85/2.70/2.55/2.39/2.24/2.08/1.93 V (selectable by software) WDT Provided Multiplier/divider Provided Clock output/buzzer output Provided Self-programming function Provided On-chip debug function Provided Standby function Operating ambient temperature HALT/STOP mode TA = -40 to +85C, -40 to +125C Note Since TM01 does not have the following terminal at 78K0/FC2, the function is restricted in part. PD78F0881, 78F0882, and 78F0883: TI001, TI011, TO01 PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886: TI001 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 23 CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE 1.6 Block Diagram * PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883 TO00/TI010/P01 TI000/P00 (LINSEL) 16-bit timer/ event counter 00 RxD60/P14 (LINSEL) Port 0 2 P00, P01 Port 1 8 P10-P17 Port 3 4 P30-P33 Port 4 2 P40, P41 Port 6 3 P60-P62 Port 7 4 P70-P73 Port 8 8 P80-P87 Port 12 5 P120-P124 16-bit timer/ event counter 01 TOH0/P15 8-bit timer H0 TOH1/P16 8-bit timer H1 8-bit timer/ event counter 50 TI50/TO50/P17 8-bit timer/ event counter 51 TI51/TO51/P33 78K/0 CPU core Flash memory Bank Low-speed internal oscillator Port 13 Watchdog timer Buzzer output BUZ/P73 Clock output control PCL/P72 Watch timer RxD60/P14 TxD60/P13 Serial interface UART60 LINSEL RxD61/P11 TxD61/P10 Serial interface UART61 Internal high-speed RAM Internal expansion RAM Multiplier/Divider Power on clear/ low voltage indicator Serial interface CSI10 SI10/P11 SO10/P12 System control 8 High-speed internal oscillator A/D converter AVREF AVSS VDD, VSS, FLMD0 EVDD EVSS INTP0/P120 (LINSEL) RxD60/P14 (LINSEL) INTP1/P30INTP4/P33 4 Interrupt control INTP5/P16 INTP6/P72 INTP7/P73 CRxD/P71 CTxD/P70 24 POC/LVI control Reset control SCK10/P10 ANI0/P80-ANI7/P87 P130 2 CAN User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD On-chip debugger RESET X1/P121 X2/EXCLK/P122 XT1/P123 XT2/EXCLKS/P124 EXLVI/P120 CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE * PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 TO00/TI010/P01 TI000/P00 (LINSEL) 16-bit timer/ event counter 00 RxD60/P14 (LINSEL) Port 0 3 P00, P01, P06 Port 1 8 P10-P17 Port 3 4 P30-P33 Port 4 2 P40, P41 Port 6 4 P60-P63 Port 7 4 P70-P73 Port 8 8 P80-P87 16-bit timer/ event counter 01 TO01/TI011/P06 TOH0/P15 8-bit timer H0 TOH1/P16 8-bit timer H1 8-bit timer/ event counter 50 TI50/TO50/P17 8-bit timer/ event counter 51 TI51/TO51/P33 78K/0 CPU core Flash memory Port 9 P90 Bank Low-speed internal oscillator Port 12 Watchdog timer Port 13 Watch timer RxD60/P14 TxD60/P13 Serial interface UART60 LINSEL RxD61/P11 TxD61/P10 Serial interface UART61 Internal high-speed RAM Internal expansion RAM 5 P120-P124 P130 P131 Buzzer output BUZ/P73 Clock output control PCL/P72 Multiplier/Divider SCK10/P10 Power on clear/ low voltage indicator Serial interface CSI10 SI10/P11 SO10/P12 POC/LVI control EXLVI/P120 Reset control ANI0/P80-ANI7/P87, ANI8/P90 AVREF AVSS 9 A/D converter System control VDD, VSS, FLMD0 EVDD EVSS INTP0/P120 (LINSEL) RxD60/P14 (LINSEL) INTP1/P30INTP4/P33 4 High-speed internal oscillator RESET X1/P121 X2/EXCLK/P122 XT1/P123 XT2/EXCLKS/P124 On-chip debugger Interrupt control INTP5/P16 INTP6/P72 INTP7/P73 CRxD/P71 CTxD/P70 2 CAN User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 25 CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE 1.7 Outline of Functions (1/2) Item Internal Flash memory memory (self-programming (bytes) supported) PD78F0881 PD78F0882 PD78F0883 PD78F0884 PD78F0885 PD78F0886 32 K 48 K 60 K 32 K 48 K 60 K 1K 2K 2K Note 1 - Bank High-speed RAM Expansion RAM Note 1 Note 1 1K 1K 2K 2K Memory space 64 KB High-speed system clock Crystal/ceramic oscillation (X1), external main system clock input (EXCLK) (oscillation frequency) 4 to 20 MHz: VDD = 4.0 to 5.5 V, 4 to 10 MHz: VDD = 2.7 to 5.5 V, 4 to 5 MHz: VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V Internal high-speed oscillation On-chip internal oscillation (8 MHz (TYP.): VDD = 2.7 to 5.5 V) clock (oscillation frequency) Internal low-speed oscillation On-chip internal oscillation (240 kHz (TYP.)) clock (oscillation frequency) Subsystem clock Crystal oscillation (XT1), external subsystem clock input (EXCLKS) (oscillation frequency) (32.768 kHz: VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V) General-purpose registers 8 bits x 32 registers (8 bits x 8 registers x 4 banks) Minimum instruction execution 0.1 s/0.2 s/0.4 s/0.8 s/1.6 s (high-speed system clock: @ fXP = 20 MHz operation) time 0.25 s/0.5 s/1.0 s/2.0 s/4.0 s (TYP.) (internal oscillator clock: @ fRH = 8 MHz (TYP.) operation) 122 s (subsystem clock: when operating at fXT = 32.768 kHz) Instruction set * 16-bit operation * Multiply/divide (8 bits x 8 bits, 16 bits / 8 bits) * Bit manipulate (set, reset, test, and Boolean operation) * BCD adjust, etc. I/O ports Total: 37 Total: 41 CMOS I/O 33 CMOS I/O 36 CMOS output 1 CMOS output 1 N-ch open-drain I/O 3 N-ch open-drain I/O 4 * 16-bit timer/event counter: 2 channels Timers Timer outputs Clock output * 8-bit timer/event counter: 2 channels * 8-bit timer: 2 channels * Watch timer 1 channel * Watchdog timer: 1 channel Note 2 8 (PWM output: 4) * 78.125 kHz, 156.25 kHz, 312.5 kHz, 625 kHz, 1.25 MHz, 2.5 MHz, 5 MHz, 10 MHz (high-speed system clock: 10 MHz) * 32.768 kHz (subsystem clock: 32.768 kHz) Notes 1. The internal flash memory capacity, internal high-speed RAM capacity, and internal expansion RAM capacity can be changed using the internal memory size switching register (IMS) and the internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS). 2. Since TM01 does not have the following terminal at 78K0/FC2, the function is restricted in part. PD78F0881, 78F0882, and 78F0883: TI001, TI011, TO01 PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886: TI001 26 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 1 OUTLINE (2/2) PD78F0881 Item PD78F0882 PD78F0883 PD78F0884 PD78F0885 Buzzer output 1.22 kHz, 2.44 kHz, 4.88 kHz, 9.77 kHz (high-speed system clock: 10 MHz) A/D converter 10-bit resolution x 8 channels Serial interface 10-bit resolution x 9 channels CAN 1 ch LIN-UART 1 ch LIN-UART/ 1 ch CSI PD78F0886 Note Multiplier/divider * 16 bit x 16 bit = 32 bit (Multiplication) * 32 bit / 32 bit = 32 bit remainder of 16 bits (Division) Vectored Internal 24 interrupt sources External 8 * Reset using RESET pin Reset * Internal reset by watchdog timer * Internal reset by power-on-clear * Internal reset by low-voltage detector On-chip debug function Provided Supply voltage VDD = 1.8 to 5.5 V Operating ambient temperature TA = -40 to +85C, -40 to +125C Package 44-pin plastic LQFP(10x10) Note 48-pin plastic LQFP (Fine pitch) (7x7) Select either of the functions of these alternate-function pins. An outline of the timer is shown below. 16-Bit Timer/ 8-Bit Timer/ Event Counters 00 to 03 Event Counters 8-Bit Timers H0 Watch Timer Watchdog Timer and H1 50 and 51 TM00 TM01 TM02 TM03 Operation mode Function Interval timer 1 ch External event counter 1 ch Timer output 1 PPG output 1 PWM output - Pulse width measurement 2 Square-wave output 1 Interrupt source 2 TM50 TM51 TMH0 TMH1 1 ch - - 1 ch 1 ch 1 ch 1 ch Note 1 1 channel 1 channel - - - 1 ch 1 ch - - - - 1 Note 2 - - 1 1 1 1 - - 1 Note 2 - - - - - - - - - - - 1 1 1 1 - - 1 - - - - - - - - - Note2 - - 1 1 1 1 - - 2 - - 1 1 1 1 1 - Notes 1. In the watch timer, the watch timer function and interval timer function can be used simultaneously. 2. PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Remark TM51 and TMH1 can be used in combination as a carrier generator mode. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 27 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.1 Pin Function List There are three types of pin I/O buffer power supplies: AVREF, EVDD/VDD. The relationship between these power supplies and the pins is shown below. Table 2-1. Pin I/O Buffer Power Supplies Power Supply Corresponding Pins Note AVREF P80 to P87, P90 EVDD/VDD * Port pins other than P80 to P87, P90 Note * Non-port pins Note P90 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. This section explains the names and functions of the pins of the 78K0/FC2. (1) Port pins Table 2-2. Port pins (1/2) Pin Name P00 I/O I/O Function Port 0. After Reset Input Alternate Function TI000 3-bit I/O port. P01 P06 TI010/TO00 Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by a Note P10 TI011/TO01 software setting. I/O Port 1. Input 8-bit I/O port. P11 SI10/RxD61 Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. P12 SO10 Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by a P13 SCK10/TxD61 TxD60 software setting. P14 RxD60 P15 TOH0 P16 TOH1/INTP5 P17 P30 TI50/TO50 I/O Port 3. Input 4-bit I/O port. P31 INTP1 INTP2 Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. P32 Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by a INTP3 P33 software setting. INTP4/TI51/TO51 P40, P41 I/O Port 4. Input 2-bit I/O port. Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by a software setting. Note P06 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 28 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD - CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS Table 2-2. Port pins (2/2) Pin Name P60 to P63 Note I/O I/O Function Port 6. N-ch open drain I/O port. After Reset Alternate Function - Input 4-bit I/O port Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. P70 I/O Port 7. Input 4-bit I/O port. P71 CRxD Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. P72 PCL/INTP6 Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by a P73 BUZ/INTP7 software setting. P80 to P87 I/O CTxD Port 8. Input ANI0 to ANI7 Input ANI8 Input INTP0/EXLVI 8-bit I/O port. Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. P90 Note I/O Port 9. 1-bit I/O port. Input/output can be specified in 1-bit units. I/O P120 Port 12. 5-bit I/O port. P121 X1 Only for P120, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be P122 X2/EXCLK specified by a software setting. P123 XT1 P124 XT2/EXCLKS P130 Output Port 13. Output - P130 is 1-bit output-only port. P131 Note P131 is 1-bit I/O port. I/O P131 use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by a Input software setting. Note P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 29 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS (2) Non-port pins Table 2-3. Non-port pins (1/2) Pin Name I/O Input INTP0 Function External interrupt request input for which the valid edge (rising After Reset Input edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges) can be INTP1 P120/EXLVI P30 specified INTP2 Alternate Function P31 INTP3 P32 INTP4 P33/TI51/TO51 INTP5 P16/TOH1 INTP6 P72/PCL INTP7 P73/BUZ SI10 Input Serial data input to serial interface Input P11/RxD61 SO10 Output Serial data output from serial interface Input P12 SCK10 I/O Clock input/output for serial interface Input P10/TxD61 RxD60 Input Serial data input to asynchronous serial interface Input P14 RxD61 P11/SI10 TxD60 Output Serial data output from asynchronous serial interface Input TxD61 P13 P10/SCK10 Input TI000 External count clock input to 16-bit timer/event counter 00 Input P00 Capture trigger input to capture registers (CR000, CR010) of 16-bit timer/event counter 00 Capture trigger input to capture register (CR000) of 16-bit TI010 P01/TO00 timer/event counter 00 Capture trigger input to capture register (CR001) of 16-bit TI011 P06/TO01 timer/event counter 01 Output TO00 TO01 16-bit timer/event counter 00 output Input P01/TI010 Input P17/TO50 16-bit timer/event counter 01 output Input TI50 TI51 External count clock input to 8-bit timer/event counter 50 P06/TI011 External count clock input to 8-bit timer/event counter 51 TO50 Output 8-bit timer/event counter 50 output P33/TO51/INTP4 Input P17/TI50 TO51 8-bit timer/event counter 51 output P33/TI51/INTP4 TOH0 8-bit timer H0 output P15 TOH1 8-bit timer H1 output P16/INTP5 PCL Output Clock output (for trimming of high-speed system clock, Input P72/INTP6 subsystem clock) BUZ ANI0 to ANI8 Note Output Buzzer output Input P73/INTP7 Input A/D converter analog input Input P80 to P87, P90 Note ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 30 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS Table 2-3. Non-port pins (2/2) Pin Name CTxD I/O Input Function After Reset Alternate Function CAN transmit data output Input P70 Input P71 CRxD Output CAN receive data input AVREF Input A/D converter reference voltage input and positive power - - - - - - supply for port 2 AVSS - A/D converter ground potential. Make the same potential as EVSS or VSS. RESET Input System reset input X1 Input Connecting resonator for high-speed system clock X2 - XT1 Input XT2 - Connecting resonator for subsystem clock Input P121 Input P122/EXCLK Input P123 Input P124/EXCLKS EXCLK Input External clock input for main system clock Input P122/X2 EXCLKS Input External clock input for subsystem clock Input P124/XT2 EXLVI Input Potential input for external low-voltage detection Input P120/INTP0 VDD - Positive power supply (except for ports) - - EVDD - Positive power supply for ports - - VSS - Ground potential (except for ports) - - EVSS - Ground potential for ports - - FLMD0 - Flash memory programming mode setting. - - REGC - This is the pin for connecting regulator output (2.5 V) - - stabilization capacitance for internal operation. Connect this pin to VSS via a capacitor (0.47 to 1 F: recommended). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 31 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.2 Description of Pin Functions 2.2.1 P00, P01, P06 (port 0) P00, P01 and P06 function as a 3-bit I/O port. These pins also function as timer I/O. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P00, P01 and P06 function as 3-bit I/O port. P00, P01 and P06 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 0 (PM0). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 0 (PU0). (2) Control mode P00, P01 and P06 function as timer I/O. (a) TI000 These is the pin for inputting an external count clock to 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and are also for inputting a capture trigger signal to the capture registers (CR000) of 16-bit timer/event counters 00. (b) TI010, TI011 These are the pin for inputting a capture trigger signal to the capture register (CR010, CR011) of 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01. (c) TO00, TO01 These are timer output pin. Caution P06 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 32 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.2.2 P10 to P17 (port 1) P10 to P17 function as an 8-bit I/O port. These pins also function as pins for external interrupt request input, serial interface data I/O, clock I/O, and timer I/O. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P10 to P17 function as an 8-bit I/O port. P10 to P17 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 1 (PM1). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 1 (PU1). (2) Control mode P10 to P17 function as external interrupt request input, serial interface data I/O, clock I/O, and timer I/O. (a) SI10 This is a serial interface serial data input pin. (b) SO10 This is a serial interface serial data output pin. (c) SCK10 This is a serial interface serial clock I/O pin. (d) RxD60, RxD61 These are the serial data input pins of the asynchronous serial interface. (e) TxD60, TxD61 These are the serial data output pins of the asynchronous serial interface. (f) TI50 This is the pin for inputting an external count clock to 8-bit timer/event counter 50. (g) TO50, TOH0, and TOH1 These are timer output pins. (h) INTP5 This is an external interrupt request input pin for which the valid edge (rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges) can be specified. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 33 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.2.3 P30 to P33 (port 3) P30 to P33 function as a 4-bit I/O port. These pins also function as pins for external interrupt request input and timer I/O. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P30 to P33 function as a 4-bit I/O port. P30 to P33 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 3 (PM3). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 3 (PU3). (2) Control mode P30 to P33 function as external interrupt request input pins and timer I/O pins. (a) INTP1 to INTP4 These are the external interrupt request input pins for which the valid edge (rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges) can be specified. (b) TI51 This is an external count clock input pin to 8-bit timer/event counter 51. (c) TO51 This is a timer output pin. Cautions 1. Be sure to pull the P31/INTP2 pin down before a reset release, to prevent malfunction. 2. Connect P31/INTP2 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash programmer. - P31/INTP2: Connect to EVSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. Remark P31/INTP2 and P32/INTP3 can be used as on-chip debug mode setting pins when the on-chip debug function is used. For details, refer to CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION. 2.2.4 P40, P41 (port 4) P40, P41 function as a 2-bit I/O port. P40, P41 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 4 (PM4). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 4 (PU4). 2.2.5 P60 to P63 (port 6) P60 to P63 function as a 4-bit I/O port. P60 to P63 can be set to input port or output port in 1-bit units using port mode register 6 (PM6) P60 to P63 are N-ch open-drain pins. Caution P63 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 34 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.2.6 P70 to P73 (port 7) P70 to P73 function as a 4-bit I/O port. These pins also function as external interrupt request input, clock output pins, buzzer output pins, CAN I/F I/O. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P70 to P73 function as a 4-bit I/O port. P70 to P73 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 7 (PM7). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 7 (PU7). (2) Control mode P70 to P73 function as external interrupt request input, output pins, buzzer output pins, CAN I/F I/O. (a) INTP6, INTP7 These are the external interrupt request input pins for which the valid edge (rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges) can be specified. (b) CRxD This is the CAN serial receive data input pin. (c) CTxD This is the CAN serial transmit data output pin. (d) PCL This is a clock output pin. (e) BUZ This is a buzzer output pin. 2.2.7 P80 to P87 (port 8) P80 to P87 function as an 8-bit I/O port. These pins also function as pins for A/D converter analog input. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P80 to P87 function as an 8-bit I/O port. P80 to P87 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 8 (PM8). (2) Control mode P80 to P87 function as A/D converter analog input pins (ANI0 to ANI7). When using these pins as analog input pins, see (5) P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 in 12.6 Cautions for A/D Converter. Caution P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 is set in the analog input mode after release of reset. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 35 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.2.8 P90 (port 9) P90 function as a 1-bit I/O port. These pins also function as pins for A/D converter analog input. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P90 function as a 1-bit I/O port. P90 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 9 (PM9). (2) Control mode P90 function as A/D converter analog input pins (ANI8). When using these pins as analog input pins, see (5) P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 in 12.6 Cautions for A/D Converter. Cautions 1. 2. P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 is set in the analog input mode after release of reset. P90 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 2.2.9 P120 to P124 (port 12) P120 to P124 function as a 5-bit I/O port. These pins also function as pins for external interrupt request input, external clock input for main system clock, external clock input for subsystem clock and potential input for external low-voltage detection. The following operation modes can be specified in 1-bit units. (1) Port mode P120 to P124 function as a 5-bit I/O port. P120 to P124 can be set to input or output using port mode register 12 (PM12). Only for P120, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 12 (PU12). (2) Control mode P120 to P124 function as pins for external interrupt request input, potential input for external low-voltage detection, resonator connection for main system clock, resonator connection for subsystem clock, external clock input for main system clock and external clock input for subsystem clock. (a) INTP0 This functions as an external interrupt request input for which the valid edge (rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges) can be specified. (b) EXLVI This is a potential input pin for external low-voltage detection. (c) X1, X2 These are the pins for connecting a resonator for high-speed system clock. When supplying an external clock, input a signal to the X1 pin and input the inverse signal to the X2 pin. Caution Connect P121/X1 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash programmer. - P121/X1: When using this pin as a port, connect it to VSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended) (in the input mode) or leave it open (in the output mode). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. Remark The X1 and X2 pins can be used as on-chip debug mode setting pins when the on-chip debug function is used. For details, refer to CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION. 36 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS (d) EXCLK This is an external clock input pin for main system clock. (e) XT1, XT2 These are the pins for connecting a resonator for subsystem clock. When supplying an external clock, input a signal to the XT1 pin and input the inverse signal to the XT2 pin. (f) EXCLKS This is an external clock input pin for subsystem clock. 2.2.10 P130, P131 (port 13) P130 functions as a 1-bit output-only port. P131 function as a 1-bit I/O port. P131 can be set to input or output in 1-bit units using port mode register 13 (PM13). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 13 (PU13). Caution P131 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 2.2.11 AVREF This is the A/D converter reference voltage input pin. Note When the A/D converter is not used, connect this pin directly to EVDD or VDD . Note Connect port 8 and port 9 directly to EVDD when it is used as a digital port. 2.2.12 AVSS This is the A/D converter ground potential pin. Even when the A/D converter is not used, always use this pin with the same potential as the EVSS pin or VSS pin. 2.2.13 RESET This is the active-low system reset input pin. 2.2.14 REGC This is the pin for connecting regulator output (2.5 V) stabilization capacitance for internal operation. Connect this pin to VSS via a capacitor (0.47 to 1 F: recommended). REGC VSS Caution Keep the wiring length as short as possible for the broken-line part in the above figure. 2.2.15 VDD and EVDD VDD is the positive power supply pin for other than ports. EVDD is the positive power supply pin for ports. 2.2.16 VSS and EVSS VSS is the ground potential pin for other than ports. EVSS is the ground potential pin for ports. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 37 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.2.17 FLMD0 This is a pin for setting flash memory programming mode. Connect to EVSS or VSS in the normal operation mode. In flash memory programming mode, be sure to connect this pin to the flash programmer. 38 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS 2.3 Pin I/O Circuits and Recommended Connection of Unused Pins Table 2-4 shows the types of pin I/O circuits and the recommended connections of unused pins. Refer to Figure 2-1 for the configuration of the I/O circuit of each type. Table 2-4. Pin I/O Circuit Types (1/2) Pin Name I/O Circuit Type P00/TI000 5-AH I/O I/O P01/TI010/TO00 P06/TI011/TO01 Note 1 Recommended Connection of Unused Pins Input: Independently connect to EVDD or EVSS via a resistor. Output: Leave open. P10/SCK10/TxD61 P11/SI10/RxD61 P12/SO10 5-H P13/TxD60 P14/RxD60 5-AH P15/TOH0 5-H P16/TOH1/INTP5 5-AH P17/TI50/TO50 P30/INTP1 P31/INTP2 Note 2 P32/INTP3 P33/TI51/TO51/INTP4 P40, P41 5-H P60 to P63 Note 1 13-P Input: Connect to EVSS. Output: Leave this pin open at low-level output after clearing the output latch of the port to 0. P70/CTxD 5-H P71/CRxD 5-AH Input: Independently connect to EVDD or EVSS via a resistor. Output: Leave open. P72/PCL/INTP6 P73/BUZ/INTP7 P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 Note 3 11-G I/O Connect to AVREF or AVSS. P90/ANI8 Note 1 Input: Independently connect to EVDD or EVSS via a resistor. Output: Leave open. Notes 1. 2. P06, P63 and P90 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Connect P31/INTP2 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash programmer. - P31/INTP2: Connect to EVSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. 3. P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 and P90/ANI8 is set in the analog input mode after release of reset. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 39 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS Table 2-4. Pin I/O Circuit Types (2/2) Pin Name P120/INTP0/EXLVI I/O Circuit Type 5-AH I/O I/O Recommended Connection of Unused Pins Input: Independently connect to EVDD or EVSS via a resistor. Output: Leave open. Note 1, 2 37 P121/X1 P122/X2/EXCLK P123/XT1 Input: Independently connect to EVDD or EVSS via a resistor. Output: Leave open. Note 1 P124/XT2/EXCLKS Note 1 P130 P131 I/O Note 1 Note 3 3-C Output 5-AH I/O Leave open. Input: Independently connect to EVDD or EVSS via a resistor. Output: Leave open. RESET 2 Input Connect to EVDD or VDD. AVREF - - Connect directly to EVDD or VDD Note 4 AVSS Connect directly to EVSS or VSS. FLMD0 Connect to EVSS or VSS. Notes 1. . Use the recommended connection above in I/O port mode (see Figure 5-6 Format of Clock Operation Mode Select Register (OSCCTL)) when these pins are not used. 2. Connect P121/X1 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash programmer. - P121/X1: When using this pin as a port, connect it to VSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended) (in the input mode) or leave it open (in the output mode). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. 40 3. P131 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 4. Connect port 8 directly to EVDD when it is used as a digital port. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS Figure 2-1. Pin I/O Circuit List (1/2) Type 5-H Type 2 EVDD Pullup enable P-ch IN EVDD Output data P-ch IN/OUT Schmitt-triggered input with hysteresis characteristics Output disable N-ch EVss Input enable Type 11-G Type 3-C AVREF Data EVDD P-ch IN/OUT P-ch Output disable Data OUT Comparator _+ N-ch N-ch P-ch AVSS N-ch AVREF (threshold voltage) AVSS Vss Input enable Type 5-AH Type 13-P EVDD Pull-up enable P-ch IN/OUT Data Output disable EVDD Data N-ch EVss P-ch IN/OUT Output disable N-ch input enable EVSS Input enable User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 41 CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS Figure 2-1. Pin I/O Circuit List (2/2) Type 37 Reset Data Output disable EVDD P-ch X2, XT2 N-ch EVSS P-ch N-ch P-ch Output disable EVDD N-ch Input enable Reset Data X1, XT1 EVSS Input enable 42 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.1 Memory Space Products in the 78K0/FC2 can each access a 64 KB memory space. Figures 3-1 to 3-3 show the memory map. Caution Regardless of the internal memory capacity, the initial values of the internal memory size switching register (IMS) and internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS) of the 78K0/FC2 is fixed (IMS = CFH, IXS = 0CH). Therefore, set the value corresponding to each product as indicated below. Table 3-1. Set Values of Internal Memory Size Switching Register (IMS) and Internal Expansion RAM Size Switching Register (IXS) Flash Memory Version IMS IXS PD78F0881, 78F0884 C8H 0AH PD78F0882, 78F0885 CCH 08H PD78F0883, 78F0886 CFH 08H User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 43 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-1. Memory Map (PD78F0881, 78F0884) FFFFH FF00H FEFFH FEE0H FEDFH Special function registers (SFR) 256 x 8 bits General-purpose registers 32 x 8 bits Short direct addressing Internal high-speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits Note 1 FB00H FAFFH 7FFFH FE20H FE1FH FE10H FE0FH AFCAN area (256 x 8 bits) FA00H F9FFH Data memory space FF20H FF1FH 1FFFH 1085H 1084H 1080H 107FH Option byte areaNote 3 5 x 8 bits Boot cluster 1 Program area Reserved 1000H 0FFFH F800H F7FFH RAM space in which instruction can be fetched F400H F3FFH Program area CALLF entry area 2048 x 8 bits Internal expansion RAM 1024 x 8 bits 0800H 07FFH Program area 1915 x 8 bits 0085H 0084H 0080H 007FH Reserved 8000H Program 7FFFH memory space 0190H 018FH 0083H 0082H Flash memory 32768 x 8 bits 0040H 003FH Note 2 Option byte areaNote 3 5 x 8 bits Boot cluster 0Note 4 CALLT table area 64 x 8 bits Vector table area 64 x 8 bits 0000H 0000H Notes 1. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the user data backup area for communication. 2. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the communication command area (269 bytes). 3. When boot swap is not used: Set the option bytes to 0080H to 0084H. When boot swap is used: Set the option bytes to 0080H to 0084H and 1080H to 1084H. 4. Writing boot cluster 0 can be prohibited depending on the setting of security (see 23.8 Security Setting). Remark The flash memory is divided into blocks (one block = 1 KB). For the address values and block numbers, see Table 3-2 Correspondence Between Address Values and Block Numbers in Flash Memory. 7FFFH EC00H EBFFH Block 1FH 07FFH 0400H 03FFH 0000H 44 Block 01H Block 00H 1 KB User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-2. Memory Map (PD78F0882, 78F0884) FFFFH FF00H FEFFH FEE0H FEDFH Special function registers (SFR) 256 x 8 bits General-purpose registers 32 x 8 bits Short direct addressing Internal high-speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits Note 1 FB00H FAFFH BFFFH FE20H FE1FH FE10H FE0FH AFCAN area (256 x 8 bits) FA00H F9FFH Data memory space FF20H FF1FH 1FFFH 1085H 1084H 1080H 107FH Option byte areaNote 3 5 x 8 bits Boot cluster 1 Program area Reserved 1000H 0FFFH F800H F7FFH RAM space in which instruction can be fetched Program area CALLF entry area 2048 x 8 bits Internal expansion RAM 2048 x 8 bits 0800H 07FFH Program area 1915 x 8 bits F000H EFFFH 0085H 0084H 0080H 007FH Reserved C000H BFFFH Program memory space 0190H 018FH 0083H 0082H Flash memory 49152 x 8 bits 0040H 003FH Note 2 Option byte areaNote 3 5 x 8 bits Boot cluster 0Note 4 CALLT table area 64 x 8 bits Vector table area 64 x 8 bits 0000H 0000H Notes 1. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the user data backup area for communication. 2. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the communication command area (269 byte). 3. When boot swap is not used: Set the option bytes to 0080H to 0084H. When boot swap is used: Set the option bytes to 0080H to 0084H and 1080H to 1084H. 4. Writing boot cluster 0 can be prohibited depending on the setting of security (see 23.8 Security Setting). Remark The flash memory is divided into blocks (one block = 1 KB). For the address values and block numbers, see Table 3-2 Correspondence Between Address Values and Block Numbers in Flash Memory. BFFFH EC00H EBFFH Block 2FH 07FFH 0400H 03FFH 0000H Block 01H Block 00H 1 KB User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 45 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-3. Memory Map (PD78F0883, 78F0886) FFFFH FF00H FEFFH FEE0H FEDFH Special function registers (SFR) 256 x 8 bits General-purpose registers 32 x 8 bits Short direct addressing Internal high-speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits Note 1 FB00H FAFFH EFFFH FE20H FE1FH FE10H FE0FH AFCAN area (256 x 8 bits) FA00H F9FFH Data memory space FF20H FF1FH 1FFFH 1085H 1084H 1080H 107FH Option byte areaNote 3 5 x 8 bits Boot cluster 1 Program area Reserved 1000H 0FFFH F800H F7FFH RAM space in which instruction can be fetched Program area CALLF entry area 2048 x 8 bits Internal expansion RAM 2048 x 8 bits 0800H 07FFH Program area 1915 x 8 bits F000H EFFFH Program memory space 0190H 018FH 0083H 0082H 0085H 0084H 0080H 007FH Flash memory 61440 x 8 bits 0040H 003FH Note 2 Option byte areaNote 3 5 x 8 bits Boot cluster 0Note 4 CALLT table area 64 x 8 bits Vector table area 64 x 8 bits 0000H 0000H Notes 1. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the user data backup area for communication. 2. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the communication command area (269 bytes). 3. When boot swap is not used: Set the option bytes to 0080H to 0084H. When boot swap is used: Set the option bytes to 0080H to 0084H and 1080H to 1084H. 4. Writing boot cluster 0 can be prohibited depending on the setting of security (see 23.8 Security Setting). Remark The flash memory is divided into blocks (one block = 1 KB). For the address values and block numbers, see Table 3-2 Correspondence Between Address Values and Block Numbers in Flash Memory. EFFFH EC00H EBFFH Block 3BH 07FFH 0400H 03FFH 0000H 46 Block 01H Block 00H 1 KB User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Correspondence between the address values and block numbers in the flash memory are shown below. Table 3-2. Correspondence Between Address Values and Block Numbers in Flash Memory (1) PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883, 78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 Address Value Block Address Value Number Block Address Value Number Block Address Value Number Block Number 0000H to 03FFH 00H 4000H to 43FFH 10H 8000H to 83FFH 20H C000H to C3FFH 30H 0400H to 07FFH 01H 4400H to 47FFH 11H 8400H to 87FFH 21H C400H to C7FFH 31H 0800H to 0BFFH 02H 4800H to 4BFFH 12H 8800H to 8BFFH 22H C800H to CBFFH 32H 0C00H to 0FFFH 03H 4C00H to 4FFFH 13H 8C00H to 8FFFH 23H CC00H to CFFFH 33H 1000H to 13FFH 04H 5000H to 53FFH 14H 9000H to 93FFH 24H D000H to D3FFH 34H 1400H to 17FFH 05H 5400H to 57FFH 15H 9400H to 97FFH 25H D400H to D7FFH 35H 1800H to 1BFFH 06H 5800H to 5BFFH 16H 9800H to 9BFFH 26H D800H to DBFFH 36H 1C00H to 1FFFH 07H 5C00H to 5FFFH 17H 9C00H to 9FFFH 27H DC00H to DFFFH 37H 2000H to 23FFH 08H 6000H to 63FFH 18H A000H to A3FFH 28H E000H to E3FFH 38H 2400H to 27FFH 09H 6400H to 67FFH 19H A400H to A7FFH 29H E400H to E7FFH 39H 2800H to 2BFFH 0AH 6800H to 6BFFH 1AH A800H to ABFFH 2AH E800H to EBFFH 3AH 2C00H to 2FFFH 0BH 6C00H to 6FFFH 1BH AC00H to AFFFH 2BH EC00H to EFFFH 3BH 3000H to 33FFH 0CH 7000H to 73FFH 1CH B000H to B3FFH 2CH 3400H to 37FFH 0DH 7400H to 77FFH 1DH B400H to B7FFH 2DH 3800H to 3BFFH 0EH 7800H to 7BFFH 1EH B800H to BBFFH 2EH 3C00H to 3FFFH 0FH 7C00H to 7FFFH 1FH BC00H to BFFFH 2FH Remark PD78F0881, 78F0884: Block numbers 00H to 1FH PD78F0882, 78F0885: Block numbers 00H to 2FH PD78F0883, 78F0886: Block numbers 00H to 3BH User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 47 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.1.1 Internal program memory space The internal program memory space stores the program and table data. Normally, it is addressed with the program counter (PC). 78K0/FC2 products incorporate internal ROM (flash memory), as shown below. Table 3-3. Internal ROM Capacity Part Number Internal ROM Structure PD78F0881, 78F0884 Capacity 32768 x 8 bits (0000H to 7FFFH) Flash memory PD78F0882, 78F0885 49152 x 8 bits (0000H to BFFFH) PD78F0893, 78F0886 61440 x 8 bits (0000H to EFFFH) The internal program memory space is divided into the following areas. (1) Vector code area The 64-byte area 0000H to 003FH is reserved as a Vector code area. The program start addresses for branch upon reset signal input or generation of each interrupt request are stored in the Vector code area. Of the 16-bit address, the lower 8 bits are stored at even addresses and the higher 8 bits are stored at odd addresses. Table 3-4. Vector Code Vector Code Address Interrupt Source Vector Code Address Interrupt Source RESET input, POC, LVI, 0020H INTCSI10/INTSRE61 WDT 0022H INTP6/INTSR61 0004H INTLVI 0024H INTP7/INTST61 0006H INTP0 0026H INTTMH1 0008H INTP1 0028H INTTMH0 000AH INTP2 002AH INTTM50 000CH INTP3 002CH INTTM000 000EH INTP4 002EH INTTM010 0010H INTP5 0030H INTAD 0012H INTC0ERR 0032H INTWTI/INTDMU 0014H INTC0WUP 0034H INTTM51 0016H INTC0REC 0036H INTWT 0018H INTC0TRX 003AH INTTM001 001AH INTSRE60 003CH INTTM011 001CH INTSR60 003EH BRK 001EH INTST60 0000H (2) CALLT instruction table area The 64-byte area 0040H to 007FH can store the subroutine entry address of a 1-byte call instruction (CALLT). (3) Option byte area The option byte area is assigned to the 1-byte area of 0080H. Refer to CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE for details. 48 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE (4) CALLF instruction entry area The area 0800H to 0FFFH can perform a direct subroutine call with a 2-byte call instruction (CALLF). (5) On-chip debug security ID setting area A 10-byte area of 0085H to 008EH and 1085H to 108EH can be used as an on-chip debug security ID setting area. Set the on-chip debug security ID of 10 bytes at 0085H to 008EH when the boot swap is not used and at 0085H to 008EH and 1085H to 108EH when the boot swap is used. For details, see CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION. 3.1.2 Internal data memory space 78K0/FC2 products incorporate the following RAM. (1) Internal high-speed RAM Table 3-5. Internal High-Speed RAM Capacity Part Number PD78F0881, 78F0884 Internal High-Speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits (FB00H to FEFFH) PD78F0882, 78F0885 PD78F0883, 78F0886 The 32-byte area FEE0H to FEFFH is assigned to four general-purpose register banks consisting of eight 8-bit registers per one bank. This area cannot be used as a program area in which instructions are written and executed. The internal high-speed RAM can also be used as a stack memory. (2) Internal expansion RAM Table 3-6. Internal Expansion RAM Capacity Part Number Internal Expansion RAM PD78F0881, 78F0884 1024 x 8 bits (F400H to F7FFH) PD78F0882, 78F0885 2048 x 8 bits (F000H to F7FFH) PD78F0883, 78F0886 The internal expansion RAM can also be used as a normal data area similar to the internal high-speed RAM, as well as a program area in which instructions can be written and executed. The internal expansion RAM cannot be used as a stack memory. 3.1.3 Special function register (SFR) area On-chip peripheral hardware special function registers (SFRs) are allocated in the area FF00H to FFFFH (refer to Table 3-7 Special Function Register List in 3.2.3 Special Function Registers (SFRs)). Caution Do not access addresses to which SFRs are not assigned. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 49 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.1.4 Data memory addressing Addressing refers to the method of specifying the address of the instruction to be executed next or the address of the register or memory relevant to the execution of instructions. Several addressing modes are provided for addressing the memory relevant to the execution of instructions for the 78K0/FC2, based on operability and other considerations. For areas containing data memory in particular, special addressing methods designed for the functions of special function registers (SFR) and general-purpose registers are available for use. Figure 3-4 to 3-6 show correspondence between data memory and addressing. For details of each addressing mode, refer to 3.4 Operand Address Addressing. 50 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-4. Correspondence Between Data Memory and Addressing (PD78F0881, PD78F0884) FFFFH Special function registers (SFR) 256 x 8 bits SFR addressing FF20H FF1FH FF00H FEFFH FEE0H FEDFH General-purpose registers 32 x 8 bits Internal high-speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits Note 1 FB00H FAFFH FA00H F9FFH Register addressing Short direct addressing FE20H FE1FH FE10H FE0FH AFCAN area (256 x 8 bits) Direct addressing Reserved F800H F7FFH Register indirect addressing Based addressing Based indexed addressing Internal expansion RAM 1024 x 8 bits F400H F3FFH Reserved 8000H 7FFFH 0190H 018FH 0083H 0082H Flash memory 32768 x 8 bits Note 2 0000H Notes 1. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the user data backup area for communication. 2. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the communication command area (269 bytes). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 51 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-5. Correspondence Between Data Memory and Addressing (PD78F0882, 78F0885) FFFFH Special function registers (SFR) 256 x 8 bits SFR addressing FF20H FF1FH FF00H FEFFH FEE0H FEDFH General-purpose registers 32 x 8 bits Register addressing Short direct addressing Internal high-speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits Note 1 FB00H FAFFH FA00H F9FFH FE20H FE1FH FE10H FE0FH AFCAN area (256 x 8 bits) Direct addressing Reserved Register indirect addressing F800H F7FFH Based addressing Based indexed addressing Internal expansion RAM 2048 x 8 bits F000H EFFFH Reserved C000H BFFFH Flash memory 49152 x 8 bits 0190H 018FH Note 2 0083H 0082H 0000H Notes 1. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the user data backup area for communication. 2. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the communication command area (269 bytes). 52 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-6. Correspondence Between Data Memory and Addressing (PD78F0883, 78F0886) FFFFH Special function registers (SFR) 256 x 8 bits SFR addressing FF20H FF1FH FF00H FEFFH FEE0H FEDFH General-purpose registers 32 x 8 bits Register addressing Short direct addressing Internal high-speed RAM 1024 x 8 bits Note 1 FB00H FAFFH FA00H F9FFH FE20H FE1FH FE10H FE0FH AFCAN area (256 x 8 bits) Direct addressing Reserved Register indirect addressing F800H F7FFH Based addressing Based indexed addressing Internal expansion RAM 2048 x 8 bits F000H EFFFH Flash memory 61440 x 8 bits 0190H 018FH Note 2 0083H 0082H 0000H Notes 1. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the user data backup area for communication. 2. During on-chip debugging, use of this area is disabled since it is used as the communication command area (269 bytes). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 53 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.2 Processor Registers 78K0/FC2 products incorporate the following processor registers. 3.2.1 Control registers The control registers control the program sequence, statuses and stack memory. The control registers consist of a program counter (PC), a program status word (PSW) and a stack pointer (SP). (1) Program counter (PC) The program counter is a 16-bit register that holds the address information of the next program to be executed. In normal operation, the PC is automatically incremented according to the number of bytes of the instruction to be fetched. When a branch instruction is executed, immediate data and register contents are set. Reset signal generation sets the reset Vector code values at addresses 0000H and 0001H to the program counter. Figure 3-7. Format of Program Counter 15 PC 0 PC15 PC14 PC13 PC12 PC11 PC10 PC9 PC8 PC7 PC6 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 (2) Program status word (PSW) The program status word is an 8-bit register consisting of various flags set/reset by instruction execution. Program status word contents are automatically stacked upon interrupt request generation or PUSH PSW instruction execution and are restored upon execution of the RETB, RETI and POP PSW instructions. Reset signal generation sets the PSW to 02H. Figure 3-8. Format of Program Status Word 7 PSW IE 0 Z RBS1 AC RBS0 0 ISP CY (a) Interrupt enable flag (IE) This flag controls the interrupt request acknowledge operations of the CPU. When 0, the IE flag is set to the interrupt disabled (DI) state, and all maskable interrupt requests are disabled. Other interrupt requests are all disabled. When 1, the IE flag is set to the interrupt enabled (EI) state and interrupt request acknowledgement is controlled with an in-service priority flag (ISP), an interrupt mask flag for various interrupt sources, and a priority specification flag. The IE flag is reset (0) upon DI instruction execution or interrupt acknowledgement and is set (1) upon EI instruction execution. (b) Zero flag (Z) When the operation result is zero, this flag is set (1). It is reset (0) in all other cases. (c) Register bank select flags (RBS0 and RBS1) These are 2-bit flags to select one of the four register banks. In these flags, the 2-bit information that indicates the register bank selected by SEL RBn instruction execution is stored. 54 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE (d) Auxiliary carry flag (AC) If the operation result has a carry from bit 3 or a borrow at bit 3, this flag is set (1). It is reset (0) in all other cases. (e) In-service priority flag (ISP) This flag manages the priority of acknowledgeable maskable vectored interrupts. When this flag is 0, lowlevel vectored interrupt requests specified by a priority specification flag register (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H) (refer to 16.3 (3) Priority specification flag registers (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H)) can not be acknowledged. Actual request acknowledgement is controlled by the interrupt enable flag (IE). (f) Carry flag (CY) This flag stores overflow and underflow upon add/subtract instruction execution. It stores the shift-out value upon rotate instruction execution and functions as a bit accumulator during bit operation instruction execution. (3) Stack pointer (SP) This is a 16-bit register to hold the start address of the memory stack area. Only the internal high-speed RAM area can be set as the stack area. Figure 3-9 Format of Stack Pointer 15 SP 0 SP15 SP14 SP13 SP12 SP11 SP10 SP9 SP8 SP7 SP6 SP5 SP4 SP3 SP2 SP1 SP0 The SP is decremented ahead of write (save) to the stack memory and is incremented after read (restored) from the stack memory. Each stack operation saves/restores data as shown in Figures 3-10 and 3-11. Caution Since reset signal generation makes the SP contents undefined, be sure to initialize the SP before using the stack. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 55 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-10. Data to Be Saved to Stack Memory (a) PUSH rp instruction (when SP = FEE0H) SP SP FEE0H FEDEH FEE0H FEDFH Register pair higher FEDEH Register pair lower (b) CALL, CALLF, CALLT instructions (when SP = FEE0H) SP SP FEE0H FEDEH FEE0H FEDFH PC15 to PC8 FEDEH PC7 to PC0 (c) Interrupt, BRK instructions (when SP = FEE0H) SP SP 56 FEE0H FEDDH FEE0H FEDFH PSW FEDEH PC15 to PC8 FEDDH PC7 to PC0 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Figure 3-11. Data to Be Restored from Stack Memory (a) POP rp instruction (when SP = FEDEH) SP SP FEE0H FEDEH FEE0H FEDFH Register pair higher FEDEH Register pair lower (b) RET instruction (when SP = FEDEH) SP SP FEE0H FEDEH FEE0H FEDFH PC15 to PC8 FEDEH PC7 to PC0 (c) RETI, RETB instructions (when SP = FEDDH) SP SP FEE0H FEDDH FEE0H FEDFH PSW FEDEH PC15 to PC8 FEDDH PC7 to PC0 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 57 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.2.2 General-purpose registers General-purpose registers are mapped at particular addresses (FEE0H to FEFFH) of the data memory. The general-purpose registers consists of 4 banks, each bank consisting of eight 8-bit registers (X, A, C, B, E, D, L, and H). Each register can be used as an 8-bit register, and two 8-bit registers can also be used in a pair as a 16-bit register (AX, BC, DE, and HL). These registers can be described in terms of function names (X, A, C, B, E, D, L, H, AX, BC, DE, and HL) and absolute names (R0 to R7 and RP0 to RP3). Register banks to be used for instruction execution are set by the CPU control instruction (SEL RBn). Because of the 4-register bank configuration, an efficient program can be created by switching between a register for normal processing and a register for interrupts for each bank. Figure 3-12. Configuration of General-Purpose Registers (a) Absolute name 16-bit processing 8-bit processing FEFFH R7 BANK0 RP3 R6 FEF8H R5 BANK1 RP2 R4 FEF0H R3 RP1 BANK2 R2 FEE8H R1 RP0 BANK3 R0 FEE0H 15 0 7 0 (b) Function name 16-bit processing 8-bit processing FEFFH H BANK0 HL L FEF8H D BANK1 DE E FEF0H B BC BANK2 C FEE8H A AX BANK3 X FEE0H 15 58 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 7 0 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.2.3 Special Function Registers (SFRs) Unlike a general-purpose register, each special function register has a special function. SFRs are allocated to the FF00H to FFFFH area. Special function registers can be manipulated like general-purpose registers, using operation, transfer and bit manipulation instructions. The manipulatable bit units, 1, 8, and 16, depend on the special function register type. Each manipulation bit unit can be specified as follows. * 1-bit manipulation Describe the symbol reserved by the assembler for the 1-bit manipulation instruction operand (sfr.bit). This manipulation can also be specified with an address. * 8-bit manipulation Describe the symbol reserved by the assembler for the 8-bit manipulation instruction operand (sfr). This manipulation can also be specified with an address. * 16-bit manipulation Describe the symbol reserved by the assembler for the 16-bit manipulation instruction operand (sfrp). When specifying an address, describe an even address. Table 3-7 gives a list of the special function registers. The meanings of items in the table are as follows. * Symbol Symbol indicating the address of a special function register. It is a reserved word in the RA78K0, and is defined by the header file "sfrbit.h" in the CC78K0. When using the RA78K0, ID78K0-NS, ID78K0, or SM78K0, symbols can be written as an instruction operand. * R/W Indicates whether the corresponding special function register can be read or written. R/W: Read/write enable R: Read only W: Write only * Manipulatable bit units Indicates the manipulatable bit unit (1, 8, or 16). "-" indicates a bit unit for which manipulation is not possible. * After reset Indicates each register status upon reset signal generation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 59 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Table 3-7. Special Function Register List (1/5) Address Special Function Register (SFR) Name Symbol R/W After Manipulatable Bit Unit 1 Bit 8 Bits 16 Bits Reset FF00H Port register 0 P0 R/W - 00H FF01H Port register 1 P1 R/W - 00H FF02H 8-bit timer H compare register 00 CMP00 R/W - - 00H FF03H Port register 3 P3 R/W - 00H FF04H Port register 4 P4 R/W - 00H FF06H Port register 6 P6 R/W - 00H FF07H Port register 7 P7 R/W - 00H FF08H Port register 8 P8 R/W - 00H FF09H Port register 9 P9 R/W - 00H FF0AH Receive buffer register 60 RXB60 R - - FFH FF0BH Transmit buffer register 60 TXB60 R/W - - FFH FF0CH Port register 12 P12 R/W - 00H FF0DH Port register 13 P13 R/W - 00H FF0EH 8-bit timer H compare register 10 CMP10 R/W - - 00H FF0FH Serial I/O shift register 10 SIO10 R - - 00H FF10H 16-bit timer counter 00 TM00 R - - 0000H 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 CR000 R/W - - 0000H 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 CR010 R/W - - 0000H FF16H 8-bit timer counter 50 TM50 R - - 00H FF17H 8-bit timer compare register 50 CR50 R/W - 00H FF18H 10- bit A/D conversion result register ADCR R - - 0000H FF11H FF12H FF13H FF14H FF15H ADCRH R - - 00H FF1AH 8-bit timer H compare register 01 CMP01 R/W - - 00H FF1BH 8-bit timer H compare register 11 CMP11 R/W - - 00H FF1FH 8-bit timer counter 51 TM51 R - - 00H FF20H Port mode register 0 PM0 R/W - FFH FF21H Port mode register 1 PM1 R/W - FFH FF22H A/D port configuration register ADPC R/W - 00H FF23H Port mode register 3 PM3 R/W - FFH FF24H Port mode register 4 PM4 R/W - FFH FF26H Port mode register 6 PM6 R/W - FFH FF27H Port mode register 7 PM7 R/W - FFH FF28H Port mode register 8 PM8 R/W - FFH PM9 R/W - FFH FF19H 8-bit A/D conversion result register Note FF29H Port mode register 9 FF2AH A/D converter mode register ADM R/W - 00H FF2BH Analog input channel specification register ADS R/W - 00H Note PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. 60 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Table 3-7. Special Function Register List (2/5) Address FF2CH Special Function Register (SFR) Name Symbol R/W After Manipulatable Bit Unit Reset 1 Bit 8 Bits 16 Bits - FFH Port mode register 12 PM12 R/W FF2DH Port mode register 13 PM13 R/W - FEH FF2EH Asynchronous serial interface selection register ASIM61 R/W - 01H ASIS61 R - - 00H 61 FF2FH Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 61 FF30H Pull-up resistor option register 0 PU0 R/W - 00H FF31H Pull-up resistor option register 1 PU1 R/W - 00H FF33H Pull-up resistor option register 3 PU3 R/W - 00H FF34H Pull-up resistor option register 4 PU4 R/W - 00H FF37H Pull-up resistor option register 7 PU7 R/W - 00H FF38H Asynchronous serial interface transmission ASIF61 R - - 00H status register 61 FF39H Clock selection register 61 CKSR61 R/W - - 00H FF3AH Asynchronous serial interface Receive buffer RXB61 R/W - - FFH TXB61 R/W - - FFH PU12 R/W - 00H PU13 R/W - 00H register 61 FF3BH Asynchronous serial interface Transmit buffer register 61 FF3CH Pull-up resistor option register 12 Note FF3DH Pull-up resistor option register 13 FF3EH Baud rate generator control register 61 BRGC61 R/W - - FFH FF3FH Asynchronous serial interface control register 61 ASICL61 R/W - 16H FF40H Clock output selection register CKS R/W - 00H FF41H 8-bit timer compare register 51 CR51 R/W - 00H FF42H Multiplier/divider control register 0 DMUC0 R/W - 00H FF43H 8-bit timer mode control register 51 TMC51 R/W - 00H FF44H Multiplier/divider data register 0 SDR0 SDR0L R/W - 0000H FF45H SDR0H FF48H External interrupt rising edge enable register EGP R/W - 00H FF49H External interrupt falling edge enable register EGN R/W - 00H FF4AH Multiplication/Division Data Register A0L MDA0L R/W - 0000H Multiplication/Division Data Register A0H MDA0H R/W - 0000H FF4FH Input switch control register ISC R/W - 00H FF50H Asynchronous serial interface operation mode ASIM60 R/W - 01H ASIS60 R - - 00H FF4BH FF4CH FF4DH register 60 FF53H Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60 Note PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 61 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Table 3-7. Special Function Register List (3/5) Address FF55H Special Function Register (SFR) Name Asynchronous serial interface transmission Symbol R/W After Manipulatable Bit Unit 1 Bit 8 Bits 16 Bits Reset ASIF60 R - - 00H status register 60 FF56H Clock selection register 60 CKSR60 R/W - - 00H FF57H Baud rate generator control register 60 BRGC60 R/W - - FFH FF58H Asynchronous serial interface control register 60 ASICL60 R/W - 16H FF60H Module Receive History List Get Pointer C0RGPT R/W - - xx02H FF61H Register C0TGPT R/W - - xx02H FF62H Module Transmission History List Get Pointer FF63H Register FF64H CAN Global Macro Clock Selection C0GMCTRL R/W - - 0000H FF66H CAN Global Macro Automatic Block C0GMABT R/W - - 0000H FF67H Transmission Delay Register FF68H Module Last Out Pointer Register C0LOPT R - - Undefined FF69H 8-bit timer H mode register 0 TMHMD0 R/W - 00H FF6AH Timer clock selection register 50 TCL50 R/W - 00H FF6BH 8-bit timer mode control register 50 TMC50 R/W - 00H FF6EH CAN Global Macro Clock Selection Register C0GMCS R/W - - 0FH FF6FH CAN Global Macro Automatic Block C0GMABTD R/W - - 00H CAN Module Mask 1 Register L C0MASK1L R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 1 Register H C0MASK1H R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 2 Register L C0MASK2L R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 2 Register H C0MASK2H R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 3 Register L C0MASK3L R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 3 Register H C0MASK3H R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 4 Register L C0MASK4L R/W - - Undefined CAN Module Mask 4 Register H C0MASK4H R/W - - Undefined FF80H Serial operation mode register 10 CSIM10 R/W - 00H FF81H Serial clock selection register 10 CSIC10 R/W - 00H FF84H Transmit buffer register 10 SOTB10 R/W - - 00H FF65H Transmission Register FF70H FF71H FF72H FF73H FF74H FF75H FF76H FF77H FF78H FF79H FF7AH FF7BH FF7CH FF7DH FF7EH FF7FH 62 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Table 3-7. Special Function Register List (4/5) Address Special Function Register (SFR) Name Symbol R/W Manipulatable Bit Unit 1 Bit 8 Bits 16 Bits After Reset CAN module time stamp register C0TS R/W - - 0000H FF8CH Timer clock selection register 51 TCL51 R/W - 00H FF8FH Watch timer operation mode register WTM R/W - 00H FF90H CAN Module Control Register C0CTRL R/W - - 0000H FF92H CAN Module Last Error Code Register C0LEC R/W - - 00H FF93H CAN Module Information Register C0INFO R - - 00H FF94H CAN Module Error Counters C0ERC R - - 0000H CAN Module Interrupt Enable Register C0IE R/W - - 0000H CAN Module Interrupt Pending Register C0INTS R/W - - 0000H FF9BH Watchdog timer enable register WDTE R/W - - 1AH/9AH FF9CH CAN Module Bit Rate Register C0BTR R/W - - 370FH FF9EH CAN Module bit rate Prescaler register C0BRP R/W - - FFH FF9FH CAN Module Last In Pointer Register C0LIPT R - - Undefined FFA0H Internal oscillator mode register RCM R/W - FFA1H Main clock mode register MCM R/W - 00H FFA2H Main OSC control register MOC R/W - 80H FFA3H Oscillation stabilization time counter status register OSTC R - 00H FFA4H Oscillation stabilization time select register OSTS R/W - 05H FFACH Reset control flag register RESF R - - 00H FFAEH Multiplier/divider data register B0 MDB0 MDB0L R/W - 0000H FF8AH FF8BH FF91H FF95H FF96H FF97H FF98H FF99H Note1 FF9DH FFAFH Note2 00H Note3 MDB0H 16-bit timer counter 01 TM01 R - - 0000H 16-bit timer capture/compare register 001 CR001 R/W - - 0000H 16-bit timer capture/compare register 011 CR011 R/W - - 0000H FFB6H 16-bit timer mode control register 01 TMC01 R/W - 00H FFB7H Prescaler mode register 01 PRM01 R/W - 00H FFB8H Capture/compare control register 01 CRC01 R/W - 00H FFB0H FFB1H FFB2H FFB3H FFB4H FFB5H Notes 1. 2. 3. The reset value of WDTE is determined by setting of option byte. The value of this register is 00H immediately after a reset release but automatically changes to 80H after internal high-speed oscillator oscillation has been stabilized. This value varies depending on the reset source. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 63 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE Tables 3-7. Special Function Register List (5/5) Address Special Function Register (SFR) Name Symbol R/W Manipulatable Bit Unit 1 Bit 8 Bits 16 Bits After Reset FFB9H 16-bit timer output control register 01 TOC01 R/W - 00H FFBAH 16-bit timer mode control register 00 TMC00 R/W - 00H FFBBH Prescaler mode register 00 PRM00 R/W - 00H FFBCH Capture/compare control register 00 CRC00 R/W - 00H FFBDH 16-bit timer output control register 00 TOC00 R/W - 00H FFBEH Low-voltage detection register LVIM R/W - 00H FFBFH Low-voltage detection level selection register LVIS R/W - 00H FFC2H Flash status register PFS R/W - 00H FFC4H Flash programming mode control register FLPMC R/W - FFE0H Interrupt request flag register 0L IF0 IF0L R/W FFE1H Interrupt request flag register 0H IF0H R/W FFE2H Interrupt request flag register 1L IF1L R/W FFE3H Interrupt request flag register 1H IF1H R/W FFE6H Interrupt mask flag register 1L MK1L R/W FFE7H Interrupt mask flag register 1H MK1H R/W FFE8H Priority specification flag register 0L PR0L R/W FFE9H Priority specification flag register 0H PR0H R/W FFEAH Priority specification flag register 1L PR1L R/W FFEBH Priority specification flag register 1H PR1H R/W FFEEH 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 TMCYC1 R/W - 00H FFEFH Clock operation mode select register OSCCTL R/W - 00H IMS R/W - - CFH IXS R/W - - 0CH FFF0H Internal memory size switching register FFF4H Internal expansion RAM size switching IF1 MK1 PR0 PR1 Note2 Note1 08H/0CH 00H 00H 00H 00H FFH DFH FFH FFH FFH FFH Note2 register FFFAH 8-bit timer H mode register 1 TMHMD1 R/W - 00H FFFBH Processor clock control register PCC R/W - 01H Notes 1. 2. Varies depending on the operation mode. * User mode: 08H * On-board mode: 0CH Regardless of the internal memory capacity, the initial values of the internal memory size switching register (IMS) and internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS) of the 78K0/FC2 is fixed (IMS = CFH, IXS = 0CH). Therefore, set the value corresponding to each as indicated below. Flash Memory Version 64 IMS IXS PD78F0881, 78F0884 C8H 0AH PD78F0882, 78F0885 CCH 08H PD78F0883, 78F0886 CFH 08H User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.3 Instruction Address Addressing An instruction address is determined by program counter (PC) contents and is normally incremented (+1 for each byte) automatically according to the number of bytes of an instruction to be fetched each time another instruction is executed. When a branch instruction is executed, the branch destination information is set to the PC and branched by the following addressing (for details of instructions, refer to 78K/0 Series Instructions User's Manual (U12326E). 3.3.1 Relative addressing [Function] The value obtained by adding 8-bit immediate data (displacement value: jdisp8) of an instruction code to the start address of the following instruction is transferred to the program counter (PC) and branched. The displacement value is treated as signed two's complement data (-128 to +127) and bit 7 becomes a sign bit. In other words, relative addressing consists of relative branching from the start address of the following instruction to the -128 to +127 range. This function is carried out when the BR $addr16 instruction or a conditional branch instruction is executed. [Illustration] 15 0 ... PC indicates the start address of the instruction after the BR instruction. PC + 15 8 7 0 6 S jdisp8 15 0 PC When S = 0, all bits of are 0. When S = 1, all bits of are 1. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 65 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.3.2 Immediate addressing [Function] Immediate data in the instruction word is transferred to the program counter (PC) and branched. This function is carried out when the CALL !addr16 or BR !addr16 or CALLF !addr11 instruction is executed. CALL !addr16 and BR !addr16 instructions can be branched to the entire memory space. The CALLF !addr11 instruction is branched to the 0800H to 0FFFH area. [Illustration] In the case of CALL !addr16 and BR !addr16 instructions 7 0 CALL or BR Low Addr. High Addr. 15 8 7 0 PC In the case of CALLF !addr11 instruction 7 6 4 3 0 CALLF fa10-8 fa7-0 15 PC 66 0 11 10 0 0 0 8 7 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.3.3 Table indirect addressing [Function] Table contents (branch destination address) of the particular location to be addressed by bits 1 to 5 of the immediate data of an operation code are transferred to the program counter (PC) and branched. This function is carried out when the CALLT [addr5] instruction is executed. This instruction references the address stored in the memory table from 40H to 7FH, and allows branching to the entire memory space. [Illustration] 7 Operation code 6 1 5 1 1 ta4-0 1 15 Effective address 0 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Memory (Table) 8 7 6 0 0 1 1 0 5 0 0 Low Addr. High Addr. Effective address+1 8 15 7 0 PC 3.3.4 Register addressing [Function] Register pair (AX) contents to be specified with an instruction word are transferred to the program counter (PC) and branched. This function is carried out when the BR AX instruction is executed. [Illustration] 7 rp 0 7 A 15 0 X 8 7 0 PC User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 67 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4 Operand Address Addressing The following methods are available to specify the register and memory (addressing) to undergo manipulation during instruction execution. 3.4.1 Implied addressing [Function] The register that functions as an accumulator (A and AX) among the general-purpose registers is automatically (implicitly) addressed. Of the 78K0/FC2 instruction words, the following instructions employ implied addressing. Instruction Register to Be Specified by Implied Addressing MULU A register for multiplicand and AX register for product storage DIVUW AX register for dividend and quotient storage ADJBA/ADJBS A register for storage of numeric values that become decimal correction targets ROR4/ROL4 A register for storage of digit data that undergoes digit rotation [Operand format] Because implied addressing can be automatically employed with an instruction, no particular operand format is necessary. [Description example] In the case of MULU X With an 8-bit x 8-bit multiply instruction, the product of A register and X register is stored in AX. In this example, the A and AX registers are specified by implied addressing. 68 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.2 Register addressing [Function] The general-purpose register to be specified is accessed as an operand with the register bank select flags (RBS0 to RBS1) and the register specify codes (Rn and RPn) of an operation code. Register addressing is carried out when an instruction with the following operand format is executed. When an 8-bit register is specified, one of the eight registers is specified with 3 bits in the operation code. [Operand format] Identifier Description r X, A, C, B, E, D, L, H rp AX, BC, DE, HL `r' and `rp' can be described by absolute names (R0 to R7 and RP0 to RP3) as well as function names (X, A, C, B, E, D, L, H, AX, BC, DE, and HL). [Description example] MOV A, C; when selecting C register as r Operation code 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 Register specify code INCW DE; when selecting DE register pair as rp Operation code 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 Register specify code User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 69 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.3 Direct addressing [Function] The memory to be manipulated is directly addressed with immediate data in an instruction word becoming an operand address. [Operand format] Identifier Description addr16 Label or 16-bit immediate data [Description example] MOV A, !0FE00H; when setting !addr16 to FE00H Operation code 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 OP code 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 00H 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 FEH [Illustration] 7 0 OP code addr16 (lower) addr16 (upper) Memory 70 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.4 Short direct addressing [Function] The memory to be manipulated in the fixed space is directly addressed with 8-bit data in an instruction word. This addressing is applied to the 256-byte space FE20H to FF1FH. Internal RAM and special function registers (SFRs) are mapped at FE20H to FEFFH and FF00H to FF1FH, respectively. The SFR area (FF00H to FF1FH) where short direct addressing is applied is a part of the overall SFR area. Ports that are frequently accessed in a program and compare and capture registers of the timer/event counter are mapped in this area, allowing SFRs to be manipulated with a small number of bytes and clocks. When 8-bit immediate data is at 20H to FFH, bit 8 of an effective address is set to 0. When it is at 00H to 1FH, bit 8 is set to 1. Refer to the [Illustration] shown below. [Operand format] Identifier Description saddr Immediate data that indicate label or FE20H to FF1FH saddrp Immediate data that indicate label or FE20H to FF1FH (even address only) [Description example] MOV 0FE30H, A; when transferring value of A register to saddr (FE30H) Operation code 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 0 OP code 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 30H (saddr-offset) [Illustration] 7 0 OP code saddr-offset Short direct memory 15 Effective address 1 8 7 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 When 8-bit immediate data is 20H to FFH, = 0 When 8-bit immediate data is 00H to 1FH, = 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 71 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.5 Special function register (SFR) addressing [Function] A memory-mapped special function register (SFR) is addressed with 8-bit immediate data in an instruction word. This addressing is applied to the 240-byte spaces FF00H to FFCFH and FFE0H to FFFFH. However, the SFRs mapped at FF00H to FF1FH can be accessed with short direct addressing. [Operand format] Identifier Description sfr Special function register name sfrp 16-bit manipulatable special function register name (even address only) [Description example] MOV PM0, A; when selecting PM0 (FF20H) as sfr Operation code 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 0 OP code 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 20H (sfr-offset) [Illustration] 7 0 OP code sfr-offset SFR 15 Effective address 72 1 8 7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.6 Register indirect addressing [Function] Register pair contents specified by a register pair specify code in an instruction word and by a register bank select flag (RBS0 and RBS1) serve as an operand address for addressing the memory. This addressing can be carried out for all the memory spaces. [Operand format] Identifier Description - [DE], [HL] [Description example] MOV A, [DE]; when selecting [DE] as register pair Operation code 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 [Illustration] 16 8 7 E D DE 0 7 Memory 0 The memory address specified with the register pair DE The contents of the memory addressed are transferred. 7 0 A User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 73 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.7 Based addressing [Function] 8-bit immediate data is added as offset data to the contents of the base register, that is, the HL register pair in the register bank specified by the register bank select flag (RBS0 and RBS1), and the sum is used to address the memory. Addition is performed by expanding the offset data as a positive number to 16 bits. A carry from the 16th bit is ignored. This addressing can be carried out for all the memory spaces. [Operand format] Identifier - Description [HL + byte] [Description example] MOV A, [HL + 10H]; when setting byte to 10H Operation code 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 [Illustration] 16 8 7 L H HL 0 7 Memory The contents of the memory addressed are transferred. 7 0 A 74 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 +10 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.8 Based indexed addressing [Function] The B or C register contents specified in an instruction word are added to the contents of the base register, that is, the HL register pair in the register bank specified by the register bank select flag (RBS0 and RBS1), and the sum is used to address the memory. Addition is performed by expanding the B or C register contents as a positive number to 16 bits. A carry from the 16th bit is ignored. This addressing can be carried out for all the memory spaces. [Operand format] Identifier - Description [HL + B], [HL + C] [Description example] In the case of MOV A, [HL + B]; (selecting B register) Operation code 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 [Illustration] 16 8 7 0 L H HL + 7 0 B 7 Memory 0 The contents of the memory addressed are transferred. 7 0 A User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 75 CHAPTER 3 CPU ARCHITECTURE 3.4.9 Stack addressing [Function] The stack area is indirectly addressed with the stack pointer (SP) contents. This addressing method is automatically employed when the PUSH, POP, subroutine call and return instructions are executed or the register is saved/reset upon generation of an interrupt request. With stack addressing, only the internal high-speed RAM area can be accessed. [Description example] In the case of PUSH DE; (saving DE register) Operation code 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 [Illustration] 7 SP SP 76 FEE0H FEDEH Memory FEE0H FEDFH D FEDEH E User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.1 Port Functions There are two types of pin I/O buffer power supplies: AVREF, EVDD/VDD. The relationship between these power supplies and the pins is shown below. Table 4-1. Pin I/O Buffer Power Supplies Power Supply Corresponding Pins Note AVREF P80 to P87, P90 EVDD/VDD * Port pins other than P80 to P87, P90 Note * Non-port pins Note P90 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. 78K0/FC2 products are provided with the ports shown in Figure 4-1 and 4-2, which enable variety of control operations. In addition to the function as digital I/O ports, these ports have several alternate functions. For details of the alternate functions, refer to CHAPTER 2 PIN FUNCTIONS. PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883 have a total of 37 I/O ports, ports 0, 1, 3, 4, 6 to 8, 12 and 13. The port configuration is shown below. Figure 4-1. Port Types (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) P00 P01 P70 Port 0 Port 7 P10 P73 P80 Port 1 Port 8 P17 P30 P87 Port 3 P33 P120 P40 P41 Port 12 P124 P60 P130 P62 Port 4 Port 6 Port 13 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 77 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 have a total of 41 I/O ports, ports 0, 1, 3, 4, 6 to 9, 12 and 13. The port configuration is shown below. Figure 4-2. Port Types (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) P00 P01 P06 P70 Port 7 P73 Port 0 P10 P80 Port 1 Port 8 P17 P87 Port 9 P30 P90 Port 3 P120 P33 P40 P41 Port 12 P124 P60 P130 P131 Port 13 Port 4 Port 6 P63 4.2 Port Configuration Ports include the following hardware. Table 4-2. Port Configuration (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) Item Control registers Configuration Port mode register (PM0, PM1, PM3, PM4, PM6 to PM8, PM12, PM13) Port register (P0, P1, P3, P4, P6 to P8, P12, P13) Pull-up resistor option register (PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4, PU7, PU12) Port Total: 37 (CMOS I/O: 33, CMOS output: 1, N-ch open drain I/O: 3) Pull-up resistor Total: 21 Table 4-3. Port Configuration (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) Item Control registers Configuration Port mode register (PM0, PM1, PM3, PM6 to PM9, PM12, PM13) Port register (P0, P1, P3, P4 to P9, P12, P13) Pull-up resistor option register (PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4, PU7, PU12, PU13) Port Total: 41 (CMOS I/O: 36, CMOS output: 1, N-ch open drain I/O: 4) Pull-up resistor Total: 23 78 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.1 Port 0 Port 0 is a 3-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 0 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 0 (PM0). When the P00, P01 and P06 pins are used as an input port, use of an on-chip pullup resistor can be specified in 1-bit units by pull-up resistor option register 0 (PU0). This port can also be used for timer I/O. Reset signal generation sets port 0 to input mode. Figures 4-3 and 4-4 show block diagrams of port 0. Caution P06 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Figure 4-3. Block Diagram of P00 EVDD WRPU PU0 PU00 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P0 Output latch (P00) P00/TI000 WRPM PM0 PM00 P0: Port register 0 PU0: Pull-up resistor option register 0 PM0: Port mode register 0 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 79 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-4. Block Diagram of P01 and P06 EVDD WRPU PU0 PU01, PU06 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P0 Output latch (P01, P06) P01/TI010/TO00, P06/TI011/TO01 WRPM PM0 PM01, PM06 Alternate function P0: Port register 0 PU0: Pull-up resistor option register 0 PM0: Port mode register 0 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal Caution P06 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. 80 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.2 Port 1 Port 1 is an 8-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 1 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 1 (PM1). When the P10 to P17 pins are used as an input port, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified in 1-bit units by pull-up resistor option register 1 (PU1). This port can also be used for external interrupt request input, serial interface data I/O, clock I/O, and timer I/O. Reset signal generation sets port 1 to input mode. Figures 4-5 to 4-7 show block diagrams of port 1. Caution To use P10/SCK10/TxD61, P11/SI10/RxD61 and P12/SO10 as general-purpose ports, set serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) and serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) to the default status (00H). Figure 4-5. Block Diagram of P10, P16 and P17 EVDD WRPU PU1 PU10, PU16 and PU17 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P1 Output latch (P10, P16, P17) P10/SCK10/TxD61, P16/TOH1/INTP5, P17/TI50/TO50 WRPM PM1 PM10, PM16 and PM17 Alternate function P1: Port register 1 PU1: Pull-up resistor option register 1 PM1: Port mode register 1 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 81 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-6. Block Diagram of P11 and P14 EVDD WRPU PU1 PU11, PU14 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P1 Output latch (P11, P14) P11/SI10/RxD61, P14/RxD60 WRPM PM1 PM11, PM14 P1: Port register 1 PU1: Pull-up resistor option register 1 PM1: Port mode register 1 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal 82 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-7. Block Diagram of P12, P13 and P15 EVDD WRPU PU1 PU12, ,PU13 and PU15 P-ch Internal bus Selector RD WRPORT P1 Output latch (P12, PU13, P15) P12/SO10, P13/TxD60, P15/TOH0 WRPM PM1 PM12, PM13 and PM15 Alternate function P1: Port register 1 PU1: Pull-up resistor option register 1 PM1: Port mode register 1 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 83 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.3 Port 3 Port 3 is a 4-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 3 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 3 (PM3). When used as an input port, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified in 1-bit units by pull-up resistor option register 3 (PU3). This port can also be used for external interrupt request input and timer I/O. Reset signal generation sets port 3 to input mode. Figures 4-8 and 4-9 show block diagrams of port 3. Cautions 1. Be sure to pull the P31 pin down before a reset release, to prevent malfunction. 2. Connect P31/INTP2 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash programmer. - P31/INTP2: Connect to EVSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. Remark P31/INTP2 and P32/INTP3 can be used for on-chip debug mode setting when the on-chip debug function is used. For details, refer to CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION. Figure 4-8. Block Diagram of P30 to P32 EVDD WRPU PU3 PU30 to PU32 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P3 Output latch (P30 to P32) P30/INTP1, P31/INTP2, P32/INTP3 WRPM PM3 PM30 to PM32 P3: Port register 3 PU3: Pull-up resistor option register 3 PM3: Port mode register 3 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal 84 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-9. Block Diagram of P33 EVDD WRPU PU3 PU33 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P3 Output latch (P33) P33/INTP4/TI51/TO51 WRPM PM3 PM33 Alternate function P3: Port register 3 PU3: Pull-up resistor option register 3 PM3: Port mode register 3 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 85 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.4 Port 4 Port 4 is a 2-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 4 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 4 (PM4). Use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified in 1-bit units with pull-up resistor option register 4 (PU4). Reset signal generation sets port 4 to input mode. Figure 4-10 shows a block diagram of port 4. Figure 4-10. Block Diagram of P40, P41 EVDD WRPU PU4 PU40, PU41 P-ch Internal bus RD Selector WRPORT P4 Output latch (P40, P41) WRPM P40, P41 PM4 PM40, PM41 P4: Port register 4 PU4: Pull-up resistor option register 4 PM4: Port mode register 4 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal 86 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.5 Port 6 Port 6 is a 4-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 6 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 6 (PM6). The P60 to P63 pins are N-ch open-drain pins (6 V tolerance). Reset signal generation sets port 6 to input mode. Figures 4-11 shows block diagrams of port 6. Caution P63 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Figure 4-11. Block Diagram of P60 to P63 RD Internal bus Selector WRPORT P6 Output latch (P60 to P63) WRPM P60 to P63 PM6 PM60 to PM63 P6: Port register 6 PM6: Port mode register 6 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 87 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.6 Port 7 Port 7 is a 4-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 7 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 7 (PM7). When the P70 to P73 pins are used as an input port, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified in 1-bit units by pull-up resistor option register 7 (PU7). This port can also be used for external interrupt request input, and clock output pins, buzzer output pins, CAN I/F I/O. Reset signal generation sets port 7 to input mode. Figures 4-12 and 4-13 show block diagrams of port 7. Figure 4-12. Block Diagram of P70 EVDD WRPU PU7 PU70 P-ch Internal bus Selector RD WRPORT P7 Output latch (P70) P70/CTxD WRPM PM7 PM70 Alternate function P7: Port register 7 PU7: Pull-up resistor option register 7 PM7: Port mode register 7 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal 88 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-13. Block Diagram of P71 EVDD WRPU PU7 PU71 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P7 Output latch (P71) P71/CRxD WRPM PM7 PM71 P7: Port register 7 PU7: Pull-up resistor option register 7 PM7: Port mode register 7 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 89 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-14. Block Diagram of P72 and P73 EVDD WRPU PU7 PU72 and PU73 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P7 Output latch (P72 and P73) P72/PCL/INTP6 P73/BUZ/INTP7 WRPM PM7 PM72 and PM73 Alternate function P7: Port register 7 PU7: Pull-up resistor option register 7 PM7: Port mode register 7 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal 90 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.7 Port 8 Port 8 is an 8-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 8 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 8 (PM8). This port can also be used for A/D converter analog input. To use P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 as digital input pins, set them in the digital I/O mode by using the A/D port configuration register (ADPC) and in the input mode by using PM8. Use these pins starting from the lower bit. To use P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 as digital output pins, set them in the digital I/O mode by using ADPC and in the output mode by using PM8 (for details, see 12.3 (5) A/D port configuration register (ADPC)). Table 4-4. Setting Functions of P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 Pins ADPC Digital I/O selection Analog input selection PM8 ADS P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 Pin Input mode - Digital input Output mode - Digital output Input mode Output mode Selects ANI. Analog input (to be converted) Does not select ANI. Analog input (not to be converted) Selects ANI. Setting prohibited Does not select ANI. All P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 are set in the analog input mode when the reset signal is generated. Figure 4-15 shows a block diagram of port 8. Caution Make the AVREF pin the same potential as the VDD pin when port 8 is used as a digital port. Figure 4-15. Block Diagram of P80 to P87 Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P8 Output latch (P80 to P87) P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 WRPM PM8 PM80 to PM87 A/D converter P8: Port register 8 PM8: Port mode register 8 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 91 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.8 Port 9 Port 9 is a 1-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 9 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 9 (PM9). This port can also be used for A/D converter analog input. To use P90/ANI8 as digital input pin, set them in the digital I/O mode by using the A/D port configuration register (ADPC) and in the input mode by using PM9. Use these pins starting from the lower bit. To use P90/ANI8 as digital output pin, set them in the digital I/O mode by using ADPC and in the output mode by using PM9 (for details, see 12.3 (5) A/D port configuration register (ADPC)). Table 4-5. Setting Function of P90/ANI8 Pin ADPC Digital I/O selection Analog input selection PM9 ADS P90/ANI8 Input mode - Digital input Output mode - Digital output Input mode Output mode Selects ANI. Analog input (to be converted) Does not select ANI. Analog input (not to be converted) Selects ANI. Setting prohibited Does not select ANI. All P90/ANI8 are set in the analog input mode when the reset signal is generated. Figure 4-16 shows a block diagram of port 9. Cautions 1. P90 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. 2. Make the AVREF pin the same potential as the VDD pin when port 9 is used as a digital port. 3. When using P90/ANI80 in the input mode, not only PM9 (input/output) but also the A/D port configuration register (ADPC) (analog input/digital input)must be set (for details, see 12.3 (5) A/D port configuration register (ADPC)). The reset value of ADPC is 00H (P90/ANI8 is analog input pin). 92 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-16. Block Diagram of P90 Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P9 Output latch (P90) P90/ANI8 WRPM PM9 PM90 A/D converter P9: Port register 9 PM9: Port mode register 9 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 93 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.9 Port 12 Port 12 is a 5-bit I/O port with an output latch. Port 12 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 12 (PM12). When used as an input port only for P120, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified by pull-up resistor option register 12 (PU12). This port can also be used for external interrupt input, potential input for external low-voltage detector, connecting resonator for main system clock, connecting resonator for subsystem clock, external clock input for main system clock, external clock input for subsystem clock. Reset signal generation sets port 12 to input mode. Figures 4-17 and 4-18 show block diagrams of port 12. Cautions 1. When using the P121 to P124 pins to connect a resonator for the main system clock (X1, X2) or subsystem clock (XT1, XT2), or to input an external clock for the main system clock (EXCLK) or subsystem clock (EXCLKS), the X1 oscillation mode, XT1 oscillation mode, or external clock input mode must be set by using the clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) (for detail, see 5.3 (5) Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL)). The reset value of OSCCTL is 00H (all of the P121 to P124 pins are I/O port pins). At this time, setting of the PM121 to PM124 and P121 to P124 pins is not necessary. 2. Connect P121/X1 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash programmer. - P121/X1: When using this pin as a port, connect it to VSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended) (in the input mode) or leave it open (in the output mode). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. 94 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-17. Block Diagram of P120 EVDD WRPU PU12 PU120 P-ch Alternate function Selector Internal bus RD WRPORT P12 Output latch (P120) P120/INTP0/EXLVI WRPM PM12 PM120 P12: Port register 12 PU12: Pull-up resistor option register 12 PM12: Port mode register 12 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 95 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-18. Block Diagram of P121 to P124 OSCCTL OSCSEL/ OSCSELS Selector RD WRPORT P12 Output latch (P122/P124) P122/X2/EXCLK, P124/XT2/EXCLKS WRPM PM12 PM122/PM124 OSCCTL OSCSEL/ OSCSELS Internal bus OSCCTL EXCLK, OSCSEL/ EXCLKS, OSCSELS Selector RD WRPORT P12 Output latch (P121/P123) P121/X1, P123/XT1 WRPM PM12 PM121/PM123 OSCCTL OSCSEL/OSCSELS OSCCTL EXCLK/EXCLKS P12: Port register 12 PU12: Pull-up resistor option register 12 PM12: Port mode register 12 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal 96 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.2.10 Port 13 Port 130 is a 1-bit output-only port. Port 131 is 1-bit I/O port. P131 can be set to the input mode or output mode in 1-bit units using port mode register 13 (PM13). When used as an input port, use of an on-chip pull-up resistor can be specified in 1-bit units by pull-up resistor option register 13 (PU13). Figures 4-19 and 4-20 show block diagrams of port 13. Caution P131 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Figure 4-19. Block Diagram of P130 Internal bus RD WRPORT P13 Output latch (P130) P13: Port register 13 RD: Read signal P130 WRxx: Write signal Remark When reset is effected, P130 outputs a low level. If P130 is set to output a high level before reset is effected, the output signal of P130 can be dummy-output as the CPU reset signal. Reset signal P130 Set by software User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 97 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-20. Block Diagram of P131 EVDD WRPU PU13 PU131 P-ch Internal bus RD Selector WRPORT P13 Output latch (P131) WRPM P131 PM13 PM131 P13: Port register 13 PU13: Pull-up resistor option register 13 PM13: Port mode register 13 RD: Read signal WRxx: Write signal Caution P131 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. 98 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.3 Registers Controlling Port Function Port functions are controlled by the following three types of registers. * Port mode registers (PM0, PM1, PM3, PM4, PM6 to PM9, PM12, PM13) * Port registers (P0, P1, P3, P4, P6 to P9, P12, P13) * Pull-up resistor option registers (PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4, PU7, PU12, PU13) * A/D port configuration register (ADPC) Caution P06, P63, P90, P131, PM06, PM63, PM90, PM131, PU06 and PU131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. (1) Port mode registers (PM0, PM1, PM3, PM4, PM6 to PM9, PM12, PM13) These registers specify input or output mode for the port in 1-bit units. These registers can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets these registers to FFH except for PM13. PM13 is set to FEH. When port pins are used as alternate-function pins, set the port mode register and output latch as shown in Table 4-6. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 99 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Figure 4-21. Format of Port Mode Register Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Address After reset R/W PM0 1 PM06 1 1 1 1 PM01 PM00 FF20H FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM17 PM16 PM15 PM14 PM13 PM12 PM11 PM10 FF21H FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 PM33 PM32 PM31 PM30 FF23H FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 PM41 PM40 FF24H FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FF26H FFH R/W FF27H FFH R/W FF28H FFH R/W FF29H FFH R/W FF2CH FFH R/W FF2DH FEH R/W PM1 PM3 PM4 PM6 Note 1 1 1 1 PM63 PM62 PM61 PM60 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 PM73 PM72 PM71 PM70 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM87 PM86 PM85 PM84 PM83 PM82 PM81 PM80 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PM90 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 PM124 PM123 PM122 PM121 PM120 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM7 PM8 Note PM9 PM12 PM13 1 1 1 1 1 1 Note Note PM131 0 Note Be sure to clear bit 6 of PM0, bit 3 of PM6, bit 0 of PM9 and bit 1 of PM13 to 1 at PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883. Pmn pin I/O mode selection PMmn (m = 0, 1, 3, 4, 6 to 9, 12, 13; n = 0 to 7) 100 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Table 4-6. Settings of Port Mode Register and Output Latch When Using Alternate Function (1/2) Alternate Function Pin Name Function Name PMxx Pxx I/O P00 TI000 Input 1 x P01 TI010 Input 1 x TO00 Output 0 0 P06 TI011 Input 1 x TO01 Output 0 0 SCK10 Input 1 x P10 Output 0 1 TxD61 Output 0 1 SI10 Input 1 x RxD61 Input 1 x P12 SO10 Output 0 0 P13 TxD60 Output 0 1 P14 RxD60 Input 1 x P15 TOH0 Output 0 0 P16 TOH1 Output 0 0 INTP5 Input 1 x TI50 Input 1 x TO50 Output 0 0 P30 INTP1 Input 1 x P31 INTP2 Input 1 x P32 INTP3 Input 1 x P33 INTP4 Input 1 x TI51 Input 1 x TO51 Output 0 0 P70 CTxD Output 0 1 P71 CRxD Input 1 x P72 PCL Output 0 0 INTP6 Input 1 x BUZ Output 0 0 INTP7 Input 1 x P80-P87 ANI0-ANI7 Input 1 x P90 ANI8 Input 1 x P11 P17 P73 Caution When using P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 in the input mode, not only PM8 and PM9 (input/output) but also the A/D port configuration register (ADPC) (analog input/digital input) must be set (for details, see 12.3 (4) Analog input channel specification register (ADS) to (7) Port mode register 9 (PM9)). The reset value of ADPC is 00H (P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 are all analog input pins). Remark x: Don't care PMxx: Port mode register Pxx: Port output latch User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 101 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS Table 4-6. Settings of Port Mode Register and Output Latch When Using Alternate Function (2/2) Alternate Function Pin Name Function Name PMxx Pxx I/O INTP0 Input 1 x EXLVI Input 1 x P121 X1 Input 1 x P122 X2 Input 1 x EXCLK Input 1 x P123 XT1 Input 1 x P124 XT2 Input 1 x EXCLKS Input 1 x P120 Remark x: Don't care PMxx: Port mode register Pxx: 102 Port output latch User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS (2) Port registers (P0, P1, P3, P4, P6 to P9, P12, P13) These registers write the data that is output from the chip when data is output from a port. If the data is read in the input mode, the pin level is read. If it is read in the output mode, the value of the output latch is read. These registers can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears these registers to 00H. Caution P9 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Figure 4-22. Format of Port Register Symbol P0 P1 P3 P4 P6 7 6 Note 5 4 3 2 1 0 Address After reset R/W FF00H 00H (output latch) R/W FF01H 00H (output latch) R/W FF03H 00H (output latch) R/W FF04H 00H (output latch) R/W FF06H 00H (output latch) R/W FF07H 00H (output latch) R/W FF08H 00H (output latch) R/W FF09H 00H (output latch) R/W FF0CH 00H (output latch) R/W FF0DH 00H (output latch) R/W 0 P06 0 0 0 0 P01 P00 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P17 P16 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 P33 P32 P31 P30 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 P41 P40 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Note 0 0 0 0 P63 P62 P61 P60 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P7 0 0 0 0 P73 P72 P71 P70 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P8 P87 P86 P85 P84 P83 P82 P81 P80 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 P90 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 P124 P123 P122 P121 P120 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P9 P12 P13 0 0 0 0 0 0 Note Note P131 P130 Note Be sure to clear bit 6 of P0, bit 3 of P6, bit 0 to P9 and bit 1 of P13 to 0 at PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883. Pmn m = 0, 1, 3, 4, 6 to 9, 12, 13; n = 0 to 7 Output data control (in output mode) Input data read (in input mode) 0 Output 0 Input low level 1 Output 1 Input high level User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 103 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS (3) Pull-up resistor option registers (PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4, PU7, PU12, PU13) These registers specify whether the on-chip pull-up resistors of P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P131 are to be used or not. On-chip pull-up resistors can be used in 1-bit units only for the bits set to input mode of the pins to which the use of an on-chip pull-up resistor has been specified in PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4, PU7, PU12, and PU13. On-chip pull-up resistors cannot be connected to bits set to output mode and bits used as alternate-function output pins, regardless of the settings of PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4 PU5, PU7, PU12, and PU13. These registers can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears these registers to 00H. Caution PU06 and PU131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Figure 4-23. Format of Pull-up Resistor Option Register Symbol 7 PU0 PU1 6 Note 5 4 3 2 1 0 Address After reset R/W FF30H 00H R/W FF31H 00H R/W FF33H 00H R/W FF34H 00H R/W FF37H 00H R/W FF3CH 00H R/W FF3DH 00H R/W 0 PU06 0 0 0 0 PU01 PU00 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PU17 PU16 PU15 PU14 PU13 PU12 PU11 PU10 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 PU33 PU32 PU31 PU30 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PU41 PU40 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 PU76 PU75 PU74 PU73 PU72 PU71 PU70 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PU120 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 PU3 PU4 PU7 PU12 PU13 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Note PU131 0 Note Be sure to clear bit 6 of PU0 and bit 1 of PU13 to 0 at PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883. PUmn PUmn pin on-chip pull-up resistor selection (m = 0, 1, 3, 4, 7, 12, 13, n = 0 to 7) 104 0 On-chip pull-up resistor not connected 1 On-chip pull-up resistor connected User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS (4) A/D port configuration register (ADPC) This register switches the P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 and P90/ANI8 pins to digital I/O of port or analog input of A/D converter. ADPC can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Table 4-7. Format of A/D Port Configuration Register (ADPC) Analog input (A)/ digital input (D) switching ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0 P90/ANI8 P87/ANI7 P86/ANI6 P85/ANI5 P84/ANI4 P83/ANI3 P82/ANI2 P81/ANI1 P80/ANI0 0 0 0 0 A A A A A A A A A 0 0 0 1 A A A A A A A A D 0 0 1 0 A A A A A A A D D 0 0 1 1 A A A A A A D D D 0 1 0 0 A A A A A D D D D 0 1 0 1 A A A A D D D D D 0 1 1 0 A A A D D D D D D 0 1 1 1 A A D D D D D D D 1 0 0 0 A D D D D D D D D 1 0 0 1 D D D D D D D D D Other than above Setting prohibited Cautions 1. Select the port from P80, in case P80/ANI0 to P80/ANI7, P90/ANI8 is used as digital port. 2. Set the channel used for A/D conversion to the input mode by using port mode register 8 (PM8) and port mode register 9 (PM9). 3. If data is written to ADPC, a wait cycle is generated. Do not write data to ADPC when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 105 CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.4 Port Function Operations Port operations differ depending on whether the input or output mode is set, as shown below. 4.4.1 Writing to I/O port (1) Output mode A value is written to the output latch by a transfer instruction, and the output latch contents are output from the pin. Once data is written to the output latch, it is retained until data is written to the output latch again. The data of the output latch is cleared by reset. (2) Input mode A value is written to the output latch by a transfer instruction, but since the output buffer is off, the pin status does not change. Once data is written to the output latch, it is retained until data is written to the output latch again. 4.4.2 Reading from I/O port (1) Output mode The output latch contents are read by a transfer instruction. The output latch contents do not change. (2) Input mode The pin status is read by a transfer instruction. The output latch contents do not change. 4.4.3 Operations on I/O port (1) Output mode An operation is performed on the output latch contents, and the result is written to the output latch. The output latch contents are output from the pins. Once data is written to the output latch, it is retained until data is written to the output latch again. The data of the output latch is cleared by reset. (2) Input mode The pin level is read and an operation is performed on its contents. The result of the operation is written to the output latch, but since the output buffer is off, the pin status does not change. 106 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS 4.5 Cautions on 1-Bit Manipulation Instruction for Port Register n (Pn) When a 1-bit manipulation instruction is executed on a port that provides both input and output functions, the output latch value of an input port that is not subject to manipulation may be written in addition to the targeted bit. Therefore, it is recommended to rewrite the output latch when switching a port from input mode to output mode. When P10 is an output port, P11 to P17 are input ports (all pin statuses are high level), and the port latch value of port 1 is 00H, if the output of output port P10 is changed from low level to high level via a 1-bit manipulation instruction, the output latch value of port 1 is FFH. Explanation: The targets of writing to and reading from the Pn register of a port whose PMnm bit is 1 are the output latch and pin status, respectively. A 1-bit manipulation instruction is executed in the following order in the 78K0/FC2. <1> The Pn register is read in 8-bit units. <2> The targeted one bit is manipulated. <3> The Pn register is written in 8-bit units. In step <1>, the output latch value (0) of P10, which is an output port, is read, while the pin statuses of P11 to P17, which are input ports, are read. If the pin statuses of P11 to P17 are high level at this time, the read value is FEH. The value is changed to FFH by the manipulation in <2>. FFH is written to the output latch by the manipulation in <3>. Figure 4-24. Bit Manipulation Instruction (P10) 1-bit manipulation instruction (set1 P1.0) is executed for P10 bit. P10 Low-level output P11 to P17 P10 High-level output P11 to P17 Pin status: High level Port 1 output latch 0 0 0 Pin status: High level Port 1 output latch 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1-bit manipulation instruction for P10 bit <1> Port register 1 (P1) is read in 8-bit units. * In the case of P10, an output port, the value of the port output latch (0) is read. * In the case of P11 to P17, input ports, the pin status (1) is read. <2> Set the P10 bit to 1. <3> Write the results of <2> to the output latch of port register 1 (P1) in 8-bit units. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 107 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.1 Functions of Clock Generator The clock generator generates the clock to be supplied to the CPU and peripheral hardware. The following system clocks and clock oscillators are selectable. (1) Main system clock <1> X1 oscillator This circuit oscillates a clock of fX = 4 to 20 MHz. Oscillation can be stopped by executing the STOP instruction or using the main OSC control register (MOC). <2> Internal high-speed oscillator This circuit oscillates a clock of fRH = 8 MHz (TYP.). After a RESET release, the CPU always starts operating with this internal high-speed oscillation clock. Oscillation can be stopped by executing the STOP instruction or using the internal oscillator mode register (RCM). An external main system clock (fEXCLK = 4 to 20 MHz) can also be supplied from the EXCLK pin. As the main system clock, a high-speed system clock (X1 clock or external main system clock) or internal high-speed oscillation clock can be selected by using the main clock mode register (MCM). (2) Subsystem clock * Subsystem clock oscillator This circuit oscillates at a frequency of fXT = 32.768 kHz. Oscillation can be stopped by using the processor clock control register (PCC) and clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL). An external subsystem clock (fEXCLKS = 32.768 kHz) can also be supplied from the EXCLKS pin. (3) Internal low-speed oscillation clock (clock for watchdog timer) * Internal low-speed oscillator This circuit oscillates a clock of fRL = 240 kHz (TYP.). After a RESET release, the internal low-speed oscillation clock always starts operating. Oscillation can be stopped by using the internal oscillator mode register (RCM). The internal low-speed oscillation clock cannot be used as the CPU clock. The following hardware operates with the internal low-speed oscillation clock. * Watchdog timer * TMH1 (fRL, fRL/27, fRL/29) Remarks 1. 108 fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency 2. fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock frequency 3. fEXCLK: External main system clock frequency 4. fXT: 5. fEXCLKS: External subsystem clock frequency 6. fRL: XT1 clock oscillation frequency Internal low-speed oscillation clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.2 Configuration of Clock Generator The clock generator includes the following hardware. Table 5-1. Configuration of Clock Generator Item Configuration Control registers Processor clock control register (PCC) Internal oscillator mode register (RCM) Main clock mode register (MCM) Main OSC control register (MOC) Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) Oscillators X1 oscillator XT1 oscillator Internal high-speed oscillator Internal low-speed oscillator User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 109 110 Figure 5-1. Block Diagram of Clock Generator Internal bus Main OSC control register (MOC) Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) AMPH EXCLK OSCSEL Main clock mode register (MCM) MCS MSTOP Main clock mode register (MCM) Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) OSTS2 OSTS1 OSTS0 Processor clock control register (PCC) CLS CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 XSEL MCM0 3 4 STOP X1 oscillation stabilization time counter Oscillation stabilization MOST MOST MOST MOST MOST time counter 11 13 14 15 16 status register (OSTC) fX External input clock fEXCLK Controller Main system fXP clock switch Internal high-speed fRH oscillator (8 MHz (TYP.)) Subsystem clock oscillator XT1/P123 XT2/EXCLKS/ P124 Crystal oscillation External input clock Prescaler fXP 2 1/2 fXT fSUB fXP 22 fSUB 2 fEXCLKS EXCLKS OSCSELS RSTS LSRSTOP RSTOP Internal oscillator mode register (RCM) Internal bus fXP 24 Internal low-speed fRL oscillator (240 kHz (TYP.)) Watch timer Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) fXP 23 Selector X2/EXCLK/ P122 fXH Crystal/ceramic oscillation Option byte 1: Cannot be stopped 0: Can be stopped CPU clock (fCPU) Watchdog timer, 8-bit timer H1 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD X1/P121 Peripheral hardware clock (fPRS) Peripheral hardware clock switch High-speed system clock oscillator CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Remarks 1. fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency 2. fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock frequency 3. fEXCLK: External main system clock frequency 4. fXH: 5. fXP: Main system clock oscillation frequency 6. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 7. fCPU: CPU clock oscillation frequency 8. fXT: XT1 clock oscillation frequency 9. fEXCLKS: External subsystem clock frequency High-speed system clock oscillation frequency 10. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency 11. fRL: Internal low-speed oscillation clock frequency 5.3 Registers Controlling Clock Generator The following seven registers are used to control the clock generator. * Processor clock control register (PCC) * Internal oscillator mode register (RCM) * Main clock mode register (MCM) * Main OSC control register (MOC) * Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) * Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) * Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) (1) Processor clock control register (PCC) This register is used to select the CPU clock and the division ratio. PCC is set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets PCC to 01H. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 111 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Figure 5-2. Format of Processor Clock Control Register (PCC) Address: FFFBH After reset: 01H R/W Note 1 Symbol 7 6 <5> <4> 3 2 1 0 PCC 0 0 CLS CSS 0 PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CLS CPU clock status 0 Main system clock 1 Subsystem clock CSS Note 2 PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 0 0 0 fXP 0 0 1 fXP/2 (default) 0 1 0 fXP/2 2 0 1 1 fXP/2 3 1 0 0 fXP/2 4 0 0 0 fSUB/2 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 0 0 Other than above CPU clock (fCPU) selection Setting prohibited Notes 1. Bit 5 is read-only. 2. Be sure to switch CSS from 1 to 0 when bits 1 (MCS) and 0 (MCM0) of the main clock mode register (MCM) are 1. Caution Be sure to clear bits 3 and 6 to 0. Remarks 1. fXP: Main system clock oscillation frequency 2. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency The fastest instruction can be executed in 2 clocks of the CPU clock in the 78K0/FC2. Therefore, the relationship between the CPU clock (fCPU) and the minimum instruction execution time is as shown in Table 5-2. Table 5-2. Relationship Between CPU Clock and Minimum Instruction Execution Time CPU Clock (fCPU) Minimum Instruction Execution Time: 2/fCPU High-Speed System Clock At 10 MHz Operation Note At 20 MHz Operation High-Speed Internal Note Oscillator Clock Subsystem Clock At 8 MHz (TYP.) Operation At 32.768 kHz Operation fXP 0.2 s 0.1 s 0.25 s (TYP.) - fXP/2 0.4 s 0.2 s 0.5 s (TYP.) - fXP/2 2 0.8 s 0.4 s 1.0 s (TYP.) - fXP/2 3 1.6 s 0.8 s 2.0 s (TYP.) - fXP/2 4 3.2 s 1.6 s 4.0 s (TYP.) - fSUB/2 - - 122.1 s Note The main clock mode register (MCM) is used to set the CPU clock (high-speed system clock/internal high-speed oscillation clock) (see Figure 5-4). 112 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (2) Internal oscillator mode register (RCM) This register sets the operation mode of internal oscillator. RCM can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 80HNote 1. Figure 5-3. Format of Internal Oscillator Mode Register (RCM) Address: FFA0H After reset: 80H Note 1 R/W Note 2 Symbol <7> 6 5 4 3 2 <1> <0> RCM RSTS 0 0 0 0 0 LSRSTOP RSTOP RSTS Status of internal high-speed oscillator oscillation Waiting for stabilization of internal high-speed oscillator oscillation in high-accuracy mode 0 (internal high-speed oscillator operation in low-accuracy mode) 1 Internal high-speed oscillator operation in high-accuracy mode LSRSTOP Internal low-speed oscillator oscillating/stopped 0 Internal low-speed oscillator oscillating 1 Internal low-speed oscillator stopped RSTOP Internal high-speed oscillator oscillating/stopped 0 Internal high-speed oscillator oscillating 1 Internal high-speed oscillator stopped Notes 1. The value of this register is 00H immediately after a reset release but automatically changes to 80H after internal high-speed oscillator oscillation has been stabilized. 2. Bit 7 is read-only. Caution When setting RSTOP to 1, be sure to confirm that the CPU operates with a clock other than the internal high-speed oscillation clock. Specifically, set RSTOP to 1 under either of the following conditions. * When MCS = 1 (when CPU operates with the high-speed system clock) * When CLS = 1 (when CPU operates with the subsystem clock) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 113 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (3) Main clock mode register (MCM) This register selects the main system clock supplied to CPU clock and clock supplied to peripheral hardware clock. MCM can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 5-4. Format of Main Clock Mode Register (MCM) Address: FFA1H After reset: 00H R/W Note Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 <2> <1> <0> MCM 0 0 0 0 0 XSEL MCS MCM0 XSEL MCM0 Selection of clock supplied to main system clock and peripheral hardware Main system clock (fXP) 0 0 Peripheral hardware clock (fPRS) 0 Internal high-speed oscillation clock Internal high-speed oscillation clock 1 (fRH) (fRH) 1 0 1 1 High-speed system clock (fXH) High-speed system clock (fXH) MCS Main system clock status 0 Operates with internal high-speed oscillation clock 1 Operates with high-speed system clock Note Bit 1 is read-only. Cautions 1. XSEL can be changed only once after a reset release. 2. The peripheral hardware cannot operate when the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. To resume the operation of the peripheral hardware after the peripheral hardware clock has been stopped, initialize the peripheral hardware. 3. A clock other than fPRS is supplied to the following peripheral functions regardless of the setting of XSEL and MCM0. * Watchdog timer * When "fRL/27" is selected as the count clock for 8-bit timer H1 * Peripheral hardware selects the external clock as the clock source (Except when the external count clock of TM0n (n = 0, 1) is selected (TI00n pin valid edge)) 4. It takes one clock to change the CPU clock. 114 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (4) Main OSC control register (MOC) This register selects the operation mode of the high-speed system clock. This register is used to stop the X1 oscillator or to disable an external clock input from the EXCLK pin when the CPU operates with a clock other than the high-speed system clock. MOC can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 80H. Figure 5-5. Format of Main OSC Control Register (MOC) Address: FFA2H After reset: 80H R/W Symbol <7> 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MOC MSTOP 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Control of high-speed system clock operation MSTOP X1 oscillation mode External clock input mode 0 X1 oscillator operating External clock from EXCLK pin is enabled 1 X1 oscillator stopped External clock from EXCLK pin is disabled Cautions 1. When setting MSTOP to 1, be sure to confirm that the CPU operates with a clock other than the high-speed system clock. Specifically, set MSTOP to 1 under either of the following conditions. * When MCS = 0 (when CPU operates with the internal high-speed oscillation clock) * When CLS = 1 (when CPU operates with the subsystem clock) In addition, stop peripheral hardware that is operating on the high-speed system clock before setting MSTOP to 1. 2. Do not clear MSTOP to 0 while bit 6 (OSCSEL) of the clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) is 0. 3. The peripheral hardware cannot operate when the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. To resume the operation of the peripheral hardware after the peripheral hardware clock has been stopped, initialize the peripheral hardware. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 115 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (5) Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) This register selects the operation modes of the high-speed system and subsystem clocks. OSCCTL can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 5-6. Format of Clock Operation Mode Select Register (OSCCTL) Address: FFEFH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol <7> <6> <5> <4> 3 2 1 <0> OSCCTL EXCLK OSCSEL EXCLKS OSCSELS 0 0 0 AMPH EXCLK OSCSEL High-speed system clock operation mode 0 0 P121/X1 pin I/O port mode I/O port P122/X2/EXCLK pin 0 1 X1 oscillation mode Crystal/ceramic resonator connection 1 0 I/O port mode I/O port 1 1 External clock input mode I/O port EXCLKS OSCSELS 0 0 Subsystem clock operation mode P123/XT1 pin I/O port mode I/O port External clock input P124/XT2/EXCLKS pin 0 1 XT1 oscillation mode Crystal resonator connection 1 0 I/O port mode I/O port 1 1 External clock input mode I/O port AMPH External clock input Operating frequency control 0 4 MHz fXH 10 MHz 1 10 MHz < fXH 20 MHz Cautions 1. Be sure to set AMPH to 1 if the high-speed system clock oscillation frequency exceeds 10 MHz. 2. Set AMPH before setting the peripheral functions after a reset release. The value of AMPH can be changed only once after a reset release. When the high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) is selected as the CPU clock, supply of the CPU clock is stopped for 4.06 to 16.12 s after AMPH is set to 1. When the highspeed system clock (external clock input) is selected as the CPU clock, supply of the CPU clock is stopped for the duration of 160 external clocks after AMPH is set to 1. 3. If the STOP instruction is executed when AMPH = 1, supply of the CPU clock is stopped for 4.06 to 16.12 s after the STOP mode is released when the internal high-speed oscillation clock is selected as the CPU clock, or for the duration of 160 external clocks when the high-speed system clock (external clock input) is selected as the CPU clock. When the high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) is selected as the CPU clock, the oscillation stabilization time is counted after the STOP mode is released. 4. AMPH can be changed only once after a reset release. 116 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Cautions 5. To change the value of EXCLK and OSCSEL, be sure to confirm that bit 7 (MSTOP) of the main OSC control register (MOC) is 1 (the X1 oscillator stops or the external clock from the EXCLK pin is disabled). 6. To change the value of EXCLKS and OSCSELS, confirm that bit 5 (CLS) of the processor clock control register (PCC) is 0 (the CPU is operating with the highspeed system clock). Remark fXH: High-speed system clock oscillation frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 117 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (6) Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) This is the status register of the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time counter. If the internal high-speed oscillation clock or subsystem clock is used as the CPU clock, the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time can be checked. OSTC can be read by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. When reset is released (reset by RESET input, POC, LVI, and WDT), the STOP instruction and MSTOP (bit 7 of MOC register) = 1 clear OSTC to 00H. Figure 5-7. Format of Oscillation Stabilization Time Counter Status Register (OSTC) Address: FFA3H After reset: 00H R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OSTC 0 0 0 MOST11 MOST13 MOST14 MOST15 MOST16 MOST11 MOST13 MOST14 MOST15 MOST16 Oscillation stabilization time status fX = 10 MHz 1 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 fX = 20 MHz 11 204.8 s min. 102.4 s min. 13 819.2 s min. 409.6 s min. 14 1.64 ms min. 819.2 s min. 15 3.27 ms min. 1.64 ms min. 16 6.55 ms min. 3.27 ms min. 2 /fX min. 2 /fX min. 2 /fX min. 1 1 1 1 0 2 /fX min. 1 1 1 1 1 2 /fX min. Cautions 1. After the above time has elapsed, the bits are set to 1 in order from MOST11 and remain 1. 2. If the STOP mode is entered and then released while the internal high-speed oscillation clock or subsystem clock is being used as the CPU clock, set the oscillation stabilization time as follows. * Desired OSTC oscillation stabilization time Oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS The oscillation stabilization time counter counts up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS. Note, therefore, that only the status up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS is set to OSTC after STOP mode is released. 3. The X1 clock oscillation stabilization wait time does not include the time until clock oscillation starts ("a" below). STOP mode release X1 pin voltage waveform a Remark 118 fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (7) Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) This register is used to select the X1 clock oscillation stabilization wait time when the STOP mode is released. The wait time set by OSTS is valid only after the STOP mode is released with the X1 clock selected as the CPU clock. After the STOP mode is released with the internal high-speed oscillation clock or subsystem clock selected as the CPU clock, the oscillation stabilization time must be confirmed by OSTC. OSTS can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets OSTS to 05H. Figure 5-8. Format of Oscillation Stabilization Time Select Register (OSTS) Address: FFA4H After reset: 05H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OSTS 0 0 0 0 0 OSTS2 OSTS1 OSTS0 OSTS2 OSTS1 OSTS0 Oscillation stabilization time selection fX = 10 MHz 0 0 0 1 1 204.8 s 102.4 s 13 819.2 s 409.6 s 2 /fX 0 2 /fX 14 1.64 ms 819.2 s 15 3.27 ms 1.64 ms 16 6.55 ms 3.27 ms 0 1 1 2 /fX 1 0 0 2 /fX 1 0 1 2 /fX Other than above fX = 20 MHz 11 Setting prohibited Cautions 1. To set the STOP mode when the X1 clock is used as the CPU clock, set OSTS before executing the STOP instruction. 2. Do not change the value of the OSTS register during the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time. 3. If the STOP mode is entered and then released while the internal high-speed oscillation clock or subsystem clock is being used as the CPU clock, set the oscillation stabilization time as follows. * Desired OSTC oscillation stabilization time Oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS The oscillation stabilization time counter counts up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS. Note, therefore, that only the status up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS is set to OSTC after STOP mode is released. 4. The X1 clock oscillation stabilization wait time does not include the time until clock oscillation starts ("a" below). STOP mode release X1 pin voltage waveform a Remark fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 119 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.4 System Clock Oscillator 5.4.1 X1 oscillator The X1 oscillator oscillates with a crystal resonator or ceramic resonator (4 to 20 MHz) connected to the X1 and X2 pins. An external clock can also be input. In this case, input the clock signal to the EXCLK pin. Figure 5-9 shows an example of the external circuit of the X1 oscillator. Figure 5-9. Example of External Circuit of X1 Oscillator (Crystal or Ceramic Oscillation) (a) Crystal or ceramic oscillation (b) External clock VSS X1 X2 External clock EXCLK Crystal resonator or ceramic resonator Cautions are listed on the next page. 5.4.2 XT1 oscillator The XT1 oscillator oscillates with a crystal resonator (standard: 32.768 kHz) connected to the XT1 and XT2 pins. An external clock can also be input. In this case, input the clock signal to the EXCLKS pin. Figure 5-10 shows an example of the external circuit of the XT1 oscillator. Figure 5-10. Example of External Circuit of XT1 Oscillator (Crystal Oscillation) (a) Crystal oscillation (b) External clock VSS XT1 32.768 kHz XT2 External clock Cautions are listed on the next page. 120 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD EXCLKS CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Caution When using the X1 oscillator and XT1 oscillator, wire as follows in the area enclosed by the broken lines in the Figures 5-9 and 5-10 to avoid an adverse effect from wiring capacitance. * Keep the wiring length as short as possible. * Do not cross the wiring with the other signal lines. Do not route the wiring near a signal line through which a high fluctuating current flows. * Always make the ground point of the oscillator capacitor the same potential as VSS. Do not ground the capacitor to a ground pattern through which a high current flows. * Do not fetch signals from the oscillator. Note that the XT1 oscillator is designed as a low-amplitude circuit for reducing power consumption. Figure 5-11 shows examples of incorrect resonator connection. Figure 5-11. Examples of Incorrect Resonator Connection (1/2) (a) Too long wiring (b) Crossed signal line PORT VSS Remark X1 X2 VSS X1 X2 When using the subsystem clock, replace X1 and X2 with XT1 and XT2, respectively. Also, insert resistors in series on the XT2 side. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 121 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Figure 5-11. Examples of Incorrect Resonator Connection (2/2) (c) Wiring near high alternating current (d) Current flowing through ground line of oscillator (potential at points A, B, and C fluctuates) VDD Pmn X1 X2 VSS High current VSS A X1 B X2 C High current (e) Signals are fetched VSS Remark X1 X2 When using the subsystem clock, replace X1 and X2 with XT1 and XT2, respectively. Also, insert resistors in series on the XT2 side. Caution When X2 and XT1 are wired in parallel, the crosstalk noise of X2 may increase with XT1, resulting in malfunctioning. 122 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.4.3 When subsystem clock is not used If it is not necessary to use the subsystem clock for low power consumption operations, or if not using the subsystem clock as an I/O port, set the XT1 and XT2 pins to I/O mode (OSCSELS = 0) and connect them as follows. Input (PM123/PM124 = 1): Independently connect to VDD or VSS via a resistor. Output (PM123/PM124 = 0): Leave open. Remark OSCSELS: Bit 4 of clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) PM123, PM124: Bits 3 and 4 of port mode register 12 (PM12) 5.4.4 Internal high-speed oscillator The internal high-speed oscillator is incorporated in the 78K0/FC2. Oscillation can be controlled by the internal oscillator mode register (RCM). After a RESET release, the internal high-speed oscillation clock starts oscillation (8 MHz (TYP.)). 5.4.5 Internal low-speed oscillator The internal low-speed oscillator is incorporated in the 78K0/FC2. The internal low-speed oscillator oscillation clock is only used as the watchdog timer and the clock of 8-bit timer H1. The internal low-speed oscillation clock cannot be used as the CPU clock. "Can be stopped by software" or "Cannot be stopped" can be selected by the option byte. When "Can be stopped by software" is set, oscillation can be controlled by the internal oscillator mode register (RCM). After a RESET release, the internal low-speed oscillation clock starts oscillation and the watchdog timer is operated (240 kHz (TYP.)). 5.4.6 Prescaler The prescaler generates various clocks by dividing the main system clock when the main system clock is selected as the clock to be supplied to the CPU. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 123 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.5 Clock Generator Operation The clock generator generates the following clocks and controls the operation modes of the CPU, such as standby mode. * Main system clock fXP * High-speed system clock fXH X1 clock fX External main system clock fEXCLK * Internal high-speed oscillation clock fRH * Subsystem clock fSUB * XT1 clock fXT * External subsystem clock fEXCLKS * Internal low-speed oscillation clock fRL * CPU clock fCPU * Peripheral hardware clock fPRS The CPU starts operation when the on-chip internal high-speed oscillator starts outputting after a reset release in the 78K0/FC2, thus enabling the following. (1) Enhancement of security function When the X1 clock is set as the CPU clock by the default setting, the device cannot operate if the X1 clock is damaged or badly connected and therefore does not operate after reset is released. However, the start clock of the CPU is the on-chip internal high-speed oscillation clock, so the device can be started by the internal highspeed oscillation clock after a reset release. Consequently, the system can be safely shut down by performing a minimum operation, such as acknowledging a reset source by software or performing safety processing when there is a malfunction. (2) Improvement of performance Because the CPU can be started without waiting for the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time, the total performance can be improved. A timing diagram of the CPU default start using the internal high-speed oscillation clock is shown in Figure 5-12 and 5-13. 124 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Figure 5-12 Operation of the clock generating circuit when power supply voltage injection (When 1.59 V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 0)) Power supply voltage (VDD) 1.8 V 1.59 V (TYP.) 0.5 V/ms (MIN.) 0V Internal reset signal <1> CPU clock <3> Waiting for voltage stabilization (1.93 to 5.39 ms) Reset processing (11 to 45 s) <5> Internal high-speed oscillation clock Switched by software High-speed system clock <5> Subsystem clock <2> Internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) High-speed system clock (fXH) (when X1 oscillation selected) Subsystem clock (fSUB) (when XT1 oscillation selected) Note 1 <4> X1 clock oscillation stabilization time: 211/fX to 216/fXNote 2 Starting X1 oscillation <4> is set by software. Starting XT1 oscillation is set by software. <1> The internal reset signal by the power-on clear (POC) circuit is generated after a power supply injection. <2> If power supply voltage exceeds 1.59 V (TYP.), reset will be released and the oscillation start of the highspeed oscillator will be carried out automatically. <3> If power supply voltage is rose by inclination of 0.5 V/ms (MAX.), after the voltage stable waiting time of a power supply/regulator passed after reset release and reset processing will be performed, CPU carries out a start of operation with high-speed oscillation clock . <4> One clock or XT1 clock should set up an oscillation start by software (see (1) in 5.6.1 Controlling highspeed system clock and (1) in 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock). <5> When you change CPU to X1 clock or XT1 clock, set up a change by software after the oscillation stability waiting of a clock (see (3) in 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock and (3) in 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock). Notes 1. The internal voltage stabilization time includes the oscillation accuracy stabilization time of the internal high-speed oscillation clock. 2. When releasing a reset (above figure) or releasing STOP mode while the CPU is operating on the internal high-speed oscillation clock, confirm the oscillation stabilization time for the X1 clock using the oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC). If the CPU operates on the high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation), set the oscillation stabilization time when releasing STOP mode using the oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 125 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Cautions 1. When the standup of voltage until it reaches 1.8 V from the time of a power supply injection is looser than 0.5 V/ms (MAX.), input a low level into RESET pin, or set up 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode (LVISTART = 1) from an option byte until it reaches 1.8 V from the time of a power supply injection (refer to Figure 5-13). When a low level is inputted into RESET pin until it reaches 1.8 V, after the reset release by RESET pin operates to the same timing as <2> of Figure 5-12 or subsequent ones. 2. When using the external clock input from EXCLK pin and EXCLKS pin, oscillation stable waiting time is unnecessary. Remark The clock which is not used as a CPU clock can be suspended by setup of software during microcomputer operation. Moreover, high-speed oscillation clock and a high-speed system clock can suspend a clock by execution of a STOP command (see (4) in 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock, (3) in 5.6.2 Example of controlling internal high-speed oscillation clock, and (4) in 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock). 126 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Figure 5-13 Operation of the clock generating circuit when power supply voltage injection (When 2.7 V/1.59V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 1)) 2.7 V (TYP.) Power supply voltage (VDD) 0V Internal reset signal <1> <3> Reset processing (11 to 45 s) <5> Internal high-speed oscillation clock CPU clock Switched by software High-speed system clock <5> Subsystem clock <2> Internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) High-speed system clock (fXH) (when X1 oscillation selected) Waiting for oscillation accuracy <4> stabilization (86 to 361 s) X1 clock oscillation stabilization time: 11 2 /fX to 216/fXNote Starting X1 oscillation <4> is set by software. Subsystem clock (fSUB) (when XT1 oscillation selected) Starting XT1 oscillation is set by software. <1> The internal reset signal by the power-on clear (POC) circuit is generated after a power supply injection. <2> If power supply voltage exceeds 1.59 V (TYP.), reset will be canceled and the oscillation start of the highspeed oscillator will be carried out automatically. <3> After reset release, after reset processing is performed, CPU carries out a start of operation with high-speed oscillation clock. <4> X1 clock or XT1 clock should set up an oscillation start by software (see (1) in 5.6.1 Controlling highspeed system clock and (1) in 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock). <5> When you change CPU to X1 clock or XT1 clock, set up a change by software after the oscillation stability waiting of a clock (see (3) in 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock and (3) in 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock). Note Check the oscillation stable time of X1 clock with an oscillation stable time counter status register (OSTC) when STOP mode release in case the time of reset release (figure 5-13) and a CPU clock are high-speed oscillation clocks . Moreover, when a CPU clock is a high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation), set up the oscillation stable time at the time of STOP mode release by the oscillation stable time selection register (OSTS). Cautions 1. A voltage oscillation stabilization time of 1.93 to 5.39 ms is required after the supply voltage reaches 1.59 V (TYP.). If the supply voltage rises from 1.59 V (TYP.) to 2.7 V (TYP.) within 1.93 ms, the power supply oscillation stabilization time of 0 to 5.39 ms is automatically generated before reset processing. 2. It is not necessary to wait for the oscillation stabilization time when an external clock input from the EXCLK and EXCLKS pins is used. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 127 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Remark The clock which is not used as a CPU clock can be suspended by setup of software during microcomputer operation. Moreover, high-speed oscillation clock and a high-speed system clock can suspend a clock by execution of a STOP command (see (4) in 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock, (3) in 5.6.2 Example of controlling internal high-speed oscillation clock, and (4) in 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock). 5.6 Controlling Clock 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock The following two types of high-speed system clocks are available. * X1 clock: Crystal/ceramic resonator is connected across the X1 and X2 pins. * External main system clock: External clock is input to the EXCLK pin. When the high-speed system clock is not used, the X1/P121 and X2/EXCLK/P122 pins can be used as I/O port pins. Caution The X1/P121 and X2/EXCLK/P122 pins are in the I/O port mode after a reset release. The following describes examples of setting procedures for the following cases. (1) When oscillating X1 clock (2) When using external main system clock (3) When using high-speed system clock as CPU clock and peripheral hardware clock (4) When stopping high-speed system clock (1) Example of setting procedure when oscillating the X1 clock <1> Setting frequency (OSCCTL register) Using AMPH, set the gain of the on-chip oscillator according to the frequency to be used. Note AMPH Operating Frequency Control 0 4 MHz f XH 10 MHz 1 10 MHz < f XH 20 MHz Note Set AMPH before setting the peripheral functions after a reset release. The value of AMPH can be changed only once after a reset release. When AMPH is set to 1, the clock supply to the CPU is stopped for 4.06 to 16.12 s. Remark fXH: High-speed system clock oscillation frequency <2> Setting P121/X1 and P122/X2/EXCLK pins and selecting X1 clock or external clock (OSCCTL register) When EXCLK is cleared to 0 and OSCSEL is set to 1, the mode is switched from port mode to X1 oscillation mode. EXCLK OSCSEL Operation Mode of High- P121/X1 Pin P122/X2/EXCLK Pin Speed System Clock Pin 0 1 X1 oscillation mode Crystal/ceramic resonator connection <3> Controlling oscillation of X1 clock (MOC register) If MSTOP is cleared to 0, the X1 oscillator starts oscillating. 128 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR <4> Waiting for the stabilization of the oscillation of X1 clock Check the OSTC register and wait for the necessary time. During the wait time, other software processing can be executed with the internal high-speed oscillation clock. Cautions 1. Do not change the value of EXCLK and OSCSEL while the X1 clock is operating. 2. Set the X1 clock after the supply voltage has reached the operable voltage of the clock to be used (see CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) or CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS)). (2) Example of setting procedure when using the external main system clock <1> Setting frequency (OSCCTL register) Using AMPH, set the frequency to be used. Note AMPH Operating Frequency Control 0 4 MHz f XH 10 MHz 1 10 MHz < f XH 20 MHz Note Set AMPH before setting the peripheral functions after a reset release. The value of AMPH can be changed only once after a reset release. The clock supply to the CPU is stopped for the duration of 160 external clocks after AMPH is set to 1. Remark fXH: High-speed system clock oscillation frequency <2> Setting P121/X1 and P122/X2/EXCLK pins and selecting operation mode (OSCCTL register) When EXCLK and OSCSEL are set to 1, the mode is switched from port mode to external clock input mode. EXCLK OSCSEL Operation Mode of High- P121/X1 Pin P122/X2/EXCLK Pin Speed System Clock Pin 1 1 External clock input mode I/O port External clock input <3> Controlling external main system clock input (MOC register) When MSTOP is cleared to 0, the input of the external main system clock is enabled. Cautions 1. Do not change the value of EXCLK and OSCSEL while the external main system clock is operating. 2. Set the external main system clock after the supply voltage has reached the operable voltage of the clock to be used (see CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) or CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS)). (3) Example of setting procedure when using high-speed system clock as CPU clock and peripheral hardware clock <1> Setting high-speed system clock oscillationNote (See 5.6.1 (1) Example of setting procedure when oscillating the X1 clock and (2) Example of setting procedure when using the external main system clock.) Note The setting of <1> is not necessary when high-speed system clock is already operating. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 129 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR <2> Setting the high-speed system clock as the main system clock (MCM register) When XSEL and MCM0 are set to 1, the high-speed system clock is supplied as the main system clock and peripheral hardware clock. XSEL MCM0 Selection of Main System Clock and Clock Supplied to Peripheral Hardware Main System Clock (f XP ) 1 1 Peripheral Hardware Clock (f PRS ) High-speed system clock (f XH ) High-speed system clock (f XH ) Caution If the high-speed system clock is selected as the main system clock, a clock other than the high-speed system clock cannot be set as the peripheral hardware clock. <3> Setting the main system clock as the CPU clock and selecting the division ratio (PCC register) When CSS is cleared to 0, the main system clock is supplied to the CPU. To select the CPU clock division ratio, use PCC0, PCC1, and PCC2. CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 0 0 0 0 fXP 0 0 1 fXP/2 (default) 0 1 0 fXP/2 2 0 1 1 fXP/2 3 1 0 0 fXP/2 4 Other than above CPU Clock (fCPU) Selection Setting prohibited (4) Example of setting procedure when stopping the high-speed system clock The high-speed system clock can be stopped in the following two ways. * Executing the STOP instruction and stopping the X1 oscillation (disabling clock input if the external clock is used) * Setting MSTOP to 1 and stopping the X1 oscillation (disabling clock input if the external clock is used) (a) To execute a STOP instruction <1> Setting to stop peripheral hardware Stop peripheral hardware that cannot be used in the STOP mode (for peripheral hardware that cannot be used in STOP mode, see CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION). <2> Setting the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time after standby release When the CPU is operating on the X1 clock, set the value of the OSTS register before the STOP instruction is executed. <3> Executing the STOP instruction When the STOP instruction is executed, the system is placed in the STOP mode and X1 oscillation is stopped (the input of the external clock is disabled). 130 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (b) To stop X1 oscillation (disabling external clock input) by setting MSTOP to 1 <1> Confirming the CPU clock status (PCC and MCM registers) Confirm with CLS and MCS that the CPU is operating on a clock other than the high-speed system clock. When CLS = 0 and MCS = 1, the high-speed system clock is supplied to the CPU, so change the CPU clock to the subsystem clock or internal high-speed oscillation clock. CLS MCS CPU Clock Status 0 0 Internal high-speed oscillation clock 0 1 High-speed system clock 1 x Subsystem clock <2> Stopping the high-speed system clock (MOC register) When MSTOP is set to 1, X1 oscillation is stopped (the input of the external clock is disabled). Caution Be sure to confirm that MCS = 0 or CLS = 1 when setting MSTOP to 1. In addition, stop peripheral hardware that is operating on the high-speed system clock. 5.6.2 Example of controlling internal high-speed oscillation clock The following describes examples of clock setting procedures for the following cases. (1) When restarting oscillation of the internal high-speed oscillation clock (2) When using internal high-speed oscillation clock as CPU clock, and internal high-speed oscillation clock or high-speed system clock as peripheral hardware clock (3) When stopping the internal high-speed oscillation clock (1) Example of setting procedure when restarting oscillation of the internal high-speed oscillation clockNote 1 <1> Setting restart of oscillation of the internal high-speed oscillation clock (RCM register) When RSTOP is cleared to 0, the internal high-speed oscillation clock starts operating. <2> Waiting for the oscillation accuracy stabilization time of internal high-speed oscillation clock (RCM register) Wait until RSTS is set to 1Note 2. Notes 1. After a reset release, the internal high-speed oscillator automatically starts oscillating and the internal high-speed oscillation clock is selected as the CPU clock. 2. This wait time is not necessary if high accuracy is not necessary for the CPU clock and peripheral hardware clock. (2) Example of setting procedure when using internal high-speed oscillation clock as CPU clock, and internal high-speed oscillation clock or high-speed system clock as peripheral hardware clock <1> * Restarting oscillation of the internal high-speed oscillation clockNote (See 5.6.2 (1) Example of setting procedure when restarting internal high-speed oscillation clock). * Oscillating the high-speed system clockNote (This setting is required when using the high-speed system clock as the peripheral hardware clock. See 5.6.1 (1) Example of setting procedure when oscillating the X1 clock and (2) Example of setting procedure when using the external main system clock.) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 131 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Note The setting of <1> is not necessary when the internal high-speed oscillation clock or highspeed system clock is already operating. <2> Selecting the clock supplied as the main system clock and peripheral hardware clock (MCM register) Set the main system clock and peripheral hardware clock using XSEL and MCM0. XSEL MCM0 Selection of Main System Clock and Clock Supplied to Peripheral Hardware Main System Clock (f XP ) 0 0 0 1 1 0 Peripheral Hardware Clock (f PRS ) Internal high-speed oscillation clock (f RH ) Internal high-speed oscillation clock (f RH ) High-speed system clock (f XH ) <3> Selecting the CPU clock division ratio (PCC register) When CSS is cleared to 0, the main system clock is supplied to the CPU. To select the CPU clock division ratio, use PCC0, PCC1, and PCC2. CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 0 0 0 0 fXP 0 0 1 fXP/2 (default) 0 1 0 fXP/2 2 0 1 1 fXP/2 3 1 0 0 fXP/2 4 Other than above CPU Clock (fCPU) Selection Setting prohibited (3) Example of setting procedure when stopping the internal high-speed oscillation clock The internal high-speed oscillation clock can be stopped in the following two ways. * Executing the STOP instruction to set the STOP mode * Setting RSTOP to 1 and stopping the internal high-speed oscillation clock (a) To execute a STOP instruction <1> Setting of peripheral hardware Stop peripheral hardware that cannot be used in the STOP mode (for peripheral hardware that cannot be used in STOP mode, see CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION). <2> Setting the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time after standby release When the CPU is operating on the X1 clock, set the value of the OSTS register before the STOP instruction is executed. <3> Executing the STOP instruction When the STOP instruction is executed, the system is placed in the STOP mode and internal highspeed oscillation clock is stopped. 132 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (b) To stop internal high-speed oscillation clock by setting RSTOP to 1 <1> Confirming the CPU clock status (PCC and MCM registers) Confirm with CLS and MCS that the CPU is operating on a clock other than the internal high-speed oscillation clock. When CLS = 0 and MCS = 0, the internal high-speed oscillation clock is supplied to the CPU, so change the CPU clock to the high-speed system clock or subsystem clock. CLS MCS CPU Clock Status 0 0 Internal high-speed oscillation clock 0 1 High-speed system clock 1 x Subsystem clock <2> Stopping the internal high-speed oscillation clock (RCM register) When RSTOP is set to 1, internal high-speed oscillation clock is stopped. Caution Be sure to confirm that MCS = 1 or CLS = 1 when setting RSTOP to 1. In addition, stop peripheral hardware that is operating on the internal high-speed oscillation clock. 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock The following two types of subsystem clocks are available. * XT1 clock: Crystal/ceramic resonator is connected across the XT1 and XT2 pins. * External subsystem clock: External clock is input to the EXCLKS pin. When the subsystem clock is not used, the XT1/P123 and XT2/EXCLKS/P124 pins can be used as I/O port pins. Caution The XT1/P123 and XT2/EXCLKS/P124 pins are in the I/O port mode after a reset release. The following describes examples of setting procedures for the following cases. (1) When oscillating XT1 clock (2) When using external subsystem clock (3) When using subsystem clock as CPU clock (4) When stopping subsystem clock (1) Example of setting procedure when oscillating the XT1 clock <1> Setting XT1 and XT2 pins and selecting operation mode (PCC and OSCCTL registers) When XTSTART, EXCLKS, and OSCSELS are set as any of the following, the mode is switched from port mode to XT1 oscillation mode. XTSTART EXCLKS OSCSELS Operation Mode of P123/XT1 Pin Subsystem Clock Pin 0 0 1 1 x x Remark XT1 oscillation mode P124/XT2/ EXCLKS Pin Crystal/ceramic resonator connection x: don't care <2> Waiting for the stabilization of the subsystem clock oscillation Wait for the oscillation stabilization time of the subsystem clock by software, using a timer function. Caution Do not change the value of XTSTART, EXCLKS, and OSCSELS while the subsystem clock is operating. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 133 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR (2) Example of setting procedure when using the external subsystem clock <1> Setting XT1 and XT2 pins, selecting XT1 clock/external clock and controlling oscillation (PCC and OSCCTL registers) When XTSTART is cleared to 0 and EXCLKS and OSCSELS are set to 1, the mode is switched from port mode to external clock input mode. In this case, input the external clock to the EXCLKS/XT2/P124 pins. XTSTART EXCLKS OSCSELS 0 1 1 Operation Mode of Subsystem Clock Pin External clock input mode P123/XT1 Pin I/O port P124/XT2/ EXCLKS Pin External clock input Caution Do not change the value of XTSTART, EXCLKS, and OSCSELS while the subsystem clock is operating. (3) Example of setting procedure when using the subsystem clock as the CPU clock <1> Setting subsystem clock oscillationNote (See 5.6.3 (1) Example of setting procedure when oscillating the XT1 clock and (2) Example of setting procedure when using the external subsystem clock.) Note The setting of <1> is not necessary when while the subsystem clock is operating. <2> Switching the CPU clock (PCC register) When CSS is set to 1, the subsystem clock is supplied to the CPU. CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 Other than above CPU Clock (fCPU) Selection fSUB/2 Setting prohibited (4) Example of setting procedure when stopping the subsystem clock <1> Confirming the CPU clock status (PCC and MCM registers) Confirm with CLS and MCS that the CPU is operating on a clock other than the subsystem clock. When CLS = 1, the subsystem clock is supplied to the CPU, so change the CPU clock to the internal high-speed oscillation clock or high-speed system clock. CLS MCS CPU Clock Status 0 0 Internal high-speed oscillation clock 0 1 High-speed system clock 1 x Subsystem clock <2> Stopping the subsystem clock (OSCCTL register) When OSCSELS is cleared to 0, XT1 oscillation is stopped (the input of the external clock is disabled). Caution1. Be sure to confirm that CLS = 0 when clearing OSCSELS to 0. In addition, stop the watch timer if it is operating on the subsystem clock. 2. 134 The subsystem clock oscillation cannot be stopped using the STOP instruction. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.6.4 Controlling internal low-speed oscillation clock The internal low-speed oscillation clock is a clock for the watchdog timer. It cannot be used as the CPU clock. With this clock, only the following peripheral hardware can operate. * Watchdog timer * 8-bit timer H1 (if fRL is selected as the count clock) In addition, the following operation modes can be selected by the option byte. * Internal low-speed oscillation clock oscillation cannot be stopped * Internal low-speed oscillation clock oscillation can be stopped by software After a reset release, the internal low-speed oscillation clock automatically oscillates. (1) To stop the internal low-speed oscillation clock (example of setting method) <1> Setting LSRSTOP to 1 (RCM register) If LSRSTOP is set to 1, the internal low-speed oscillator oscillation is stopped. (2) To oscillate the internal low-speed oscillation clock (example of setting method) <1> Clearing LSRSTOP to 0 (RCM register) If LSRSTOP is cleared to 0, the internal low-speed oscillation clock is oscillated. Caution If "internal low-speed oscillation clock oscillation cannot be stopped" is selected by the option byte, oscillation of the internal low-speed oscillation clock cannot be controlled. 5.6.5 Clocks supplied to CPU and peripheral hardware The following table shows the relation among the clocks supplied to the CPU and peripheral hardware, and setting of registers. Table 5-3. Clocks Supplied to CPU and Peripheral Hardware, and Register Setting XSEL CSS MCM0 EXCLK Supplied Clock Clock Supplied to Peripheral Clock Supplied to CPU Hardware 0 0 x x Internal high-speed oscillation clock 0 1 x x Subsystem clock Internal high-speed oscillation clock 1 0 0 0 Internal high-speed oscillation X1 clock External main system clock 1 0 0 1 clock 1 0 1 0 X1 clock 1 0 1 1 External main system clock 1 1 0 0 Subsystem clock 1 1 0 1 External main system clock 1 1 1 0 X1 clock 1 1 1 1 External main system clock Remarks 1. X1 clock XSEL: Bit 2 of the main clock mode register (MCM) 2. CSS: Bit 4 of the processor clock control register (PCC) 3. MCM0: Bit 0 of MCM 4. EXCLK: Bit 7 of the clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 135 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.6.6 CPU clock status transition diagram Figure 5-14 shows the CPU clock status transition diagram of this product. Figure 5-14. CPU Clock Status Transition Diagram Internal low-speed oscillation: Woken up Internal high-speed oscillation: Woken up X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Stops (I/O port mode) XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Stops (I/O port mode) Power ON VDD < 1.59 V (TYP.) (A) VDD 1.59 V (TYP.) Reset release Internal low-speed oscillation: Operating Internal high-speed oscillation: Operating X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Stops (I/O port mode) XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Stops (I/O port mode) Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Selectable by CPU X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Selectable by CPU XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Operating (D) Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Operating X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Selectable by CPU XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Selectable by CPU CPU: Operating with internal highspeed oscillation (H) CPU: Internal highspeed oscillation STOP CPU: Operating with XT1 oscillation or EXCLKS input (E) CPU: Internal highspeed oscillation HALT (C) (G) CPU: XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input HALT Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Operable X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Operable XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Operating VDD 1.8 V (MIN.) (B) CPU: Operating with X1 oscillation or EXCLK input Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Selectable by CPU X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Operating XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Selectable by CPU Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Operating X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Operable XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Operable (I) CPU: X1 oscillation/EXCLK input STOP (F) CPU: X1 oscillation/EXCLK input HALT Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Operable X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Operating XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Operable Remark Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Stops X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Stops XT1 oscillation/EXCLKS input: Operable Internal low-speed oscillation: Operable Internal high-speed oscillation: Stops X1 oscillation/EXCLK input: Stops XT1 oscillation: Operable In the 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 1), the CPU clock status changes to (A) in the above figure when the supply voltage exceeds 2.7 V (TYP.), and to (B) after reset processing (11 to 45 s). 136 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Table 5-4 shows transition of the CPU clock and examples of setting the SFR registers. Table 5-4. CPU Clock Transition and SFR Register Setting Examples (1/4) (1) CPU operating with high-speed system clock (C) after reset release (A) (The CPU operates with the internal high-speed oscillation clock immediately after a reset release (B).) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register AMPH EXCLK OSCSEL MSTOP OSTC XSEL MCM0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Register Status Transition (A) (B) (C) (X1 clock: less than 10 MHz) 0 0 1 0 Must be checked (A) (B) (C) (external main clock: less than 10 0 1 1 0 MHz) Must not be checked (A) (B) (C) (X1 clock: 10 MHz or more) 1 0 1 0 Must be checked (A) (B) (C) (external main clock: 10 MHz or 1 1 1 0 more) Must not be checked (2) CPU operating with internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) after reset release (A) Status Transition SFR Register Setting (A) (B) SFR registers do not have to be set (default status after reset release). (3) CPU operating with subsystem clock (D) after reset release (A) (The CPU operates with the internal high-speed oscillation clock immediately after a reset release (B).) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register EXCLKS OSCSELS Waiting for CSS Oscillation Status Transition Stabilization (A) (B) (D) (XT1 clock) 0 1 Necessary 1 (A) (B) (D) (external subsystem clock) 1 1 Unnecessary 1 Remarks 1. 2. (A) to (I) in Table 5-4 correspond to (A) to (I) in Figure 5-14. EXCLK, OSCSEL, EXCLKS, OSCSELS, AMPH: Bits 7 to 4 and 0 of the clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) MSTOP: Bit 7 of the main OSC control register (MOC) XSEL, MCM0: Bits 2 and 0 of the main clock mode register (MCM) CSS: Bit 4 of the processor clock control register (PCC) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 137 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Table 5-4. CPU Clock Transition and SFR Register Setting Examples (2/4) (4) CPU clock changing from internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) to high-speed system clock (C) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register AMPH EXCLK OSCSEL OSTC MSTOP XSEL MCM0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Register Status Transition (B) (C) (X1 clock: less than 10 MHz) 0 0 1 0 Must be checked (B) (C) (external main clock: less than 10 MHz) 0 1 1 0 Must not be checked (B) (C) (X1 clock: 10 MHz or more) 1 0 1 0 Must be checked (B) (C) (external main clock: 10 MHz or more) 1 1 1 0 Must not be checked Unnecessary if these registers Unnecessary if the Unnecessary if this are already set CPU is operating register is already with the high-speed set system clock (5) CPU clock changing from internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) to subsystem clock (D) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register EXCLKS OSCSELS Waiting for CSS Oscillation Status Transition Stabilization (B) (D) (XT1 clock) 0 1 Necessary 1 (B) (D) (external subsystem clock) 1 1 Unnecessary 1 Unnecessary if the CPU is operating with the subsystem clock Remarks 1. 2. (A) to (I) in Table 5-4 correspond to (A) to (I) in Figure 5-14. EXCLK, OSCSEL, EXCLKS, OSCSELS, AMPH: Bits 7 to 4 and 0 of the clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) MSTOP: Bit 7 of the main OSC control register (MOC) XSEL, MCM0: Bits 2 and 0 of the main clock mode register (MCM) CSS: 138 Bit 4 of the processor clock control register (PCC) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Table 5-4. CPU Clock Transition and SFR Register Setting Examples (3/4) (6) CPU clock changing from high-speed system clock (C) to internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register RSTOP RSTS MCM0 0 Confirm this flag is 1. 0 Status Transition (C) (B) Unnecessary if the CPU is operating with the internal high-speed oscillation clock (7) CPU clock changing from high-speed system clock (C) to subsystem clock (D) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register EXCLKS Waiting for OSCSELS CSS Oscillation Stabilization Status Transition (C) (D) (XT1 clock) 0 1 Necessary 1 (C) (D) (external subsystem clock) 1 1 Unnecessary 1 Unnecessary if the CPU is operating with the subsystem clock (8) CPU clock changing from subsystem clock (D) to high-speed system clock (C) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register AMPH EXCLK OSCSEL MSTOP OSTC XSEL MCM0 CSS 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 Register Status Transition (D) (C) (X1 clock: less than 10 MHz) 0 0 1 0 Must be checked (D) (C) (external main clock: less than 0 1 1 0 10 MHz) Must not be checked (D) (C) (X1 clock: 10 MHz or more) 1 0 1 0 Must be checked (D) (C) (external main clock: 10 MHz or 1 1 1 0 more) Must not be checked Unnecessary if these registers are already set Unnecessary if the Unnecessary if this register is CPU is operating already set with the high-speed system clock Remarks 1. 2. (A) to (I) in Table 5-4 correspond to (A) to (I) in Figure 5-14. EXCLK, OSCSEL, EXCLKS, OSCSELS, AMPH: Bits 7 to 4 and 0 of the clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) MSTOP: Bit 7 of the main OSC control register (MOC) XSEL, MCM0: Bits 2 and 0 of the main clock mode register (MCM) CSS: Bit 4 of the processor clock control register (PCC) RSTS, RSTOP: Bits 7 and 0 of the internal oscillator mode register (RCM) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 139 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Table 5-4. CPU Clock Transition and SFR Register Setting Examples (4/4) (9) CPU clock changing from subsystem clock (D) to internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) (Setting sequence of SFR registers) Setting Flag of SFR Register RSTOP RSTS MCM0 CSS 0 Confirm this flag 0 0 Status Transition (D) (B) is 1. Unnecessary if the CPU is operating Unnecessary if with the internal high-speed XSEL is 0 oscillation clock (10) * HALT mode (E) set while CPU is operating with internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) * HALT mode (F) set while CPU is operating with high-speed system clock (C) * HALT mode (G) set while CPU is operating with subsystem clock (D) Status Transition Setting (B) (E) Executing HALT instruction (C) (F) (D) (G) (11) * STOP mode (H) set while CPU is operating with internal high-speed oscillation clock (B) * STOP mode (I) set while CPU is operating with high-speed system clock (C) (Setting sequence) Status Transition Setting (B) (H) Stopping peripheral functions that (C) (I) cannot operate in STOP mode Remarks 1. 2. Executing STOP instruction (A) to (I) in Table 5-4 correspond to (A) to (I) in Figure 5-14. MCM0: Bit 0 of the main clock mode register (MCM) CSS: Bit 4 of the processor clock control register (PCC) RSTS, RSTOP: Bits 7 and 0 of the internal oscillator mode register (RCM) 140 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.6.7 Condition before changing CPU clock and processing after changing CPU clock Condition before changing the CPU clock and processing after changing the CPU clock are shown below. Table 5-5. Changing CPU Clock Condition Before Change CPU Clock Before Change Internal high- Processing After Change After Change X1 clock Stabilization of X1 oscillation speed oscillation * MSTOP = 0, OSCSEL = 1, EXCLK = 0 clock * After elapse of oscillation stabilization time * Internal high-speed oscillator can be stopped (RSTOP = 1). * Clock supply to CPU is stopped for 4.06 to 16.12 s after AMPH has been set to 1. External main Enabling input of external clock from EXCLK system clock pin * Internal high-speed oscillator can be stopped (RSTOP = 1). * MSTOP = 0, OSCSEL = 1, EXCLK = 1 * Clock supply to CPU is stopped for the duration of 160 external clocks from the EXCLK pin after AMPH has been set to 1. X1 clock Internal high- Oscillation of internal high-speed oscillator X1 oscillation can be stopped (MSTOP = 1). External main speed oscillation * RSTOP = 0 External main system clock input can be system clock clock Internal high- XT1 clock speed oscillation disabled (MSTOP = 1). Stabilization of XT1 oscillation Operating current can be reduced by * XTSTART = 0, EXCLKS = 0, stopping internal high-speed oscillator OSCSELS = 1, or XTSTART = 1 clock * After elapse of oscillation stabilization time X1 clock (RSTOP = 1). X1 oscillation can be stopped (MSTOP = 1). External main External main system clock input can be system clock disabled (MSTOP = 1). Internal high- External Enabling input of external clock from Operating current can be reduced by speed oscillation subsystem clock EXCLKS pin stopping internal high-speed oscillator * XTSTART = 0, EXCLKS = 1, (RSTOP = 1). clock OSCSELS = 1 X1 clock X1 oscillation can be stopped (MSTOP = 1). External main External main system clock input can be system clock disabled (MSTOP = 1). XT1 clock, Internal high- Oscillation of internal high-speed oscillator XT1 oscillation can be stopped or external external speed oscillation and selection of internal high-speed subsystem clock input can be disabled subsystem clock clock oscillation clock as main system clock (OSCSELS = 0). * RSTOP = 0, MCS = 0 X1 clock Stabilization of X1 oscillation and selection of high-speed system clock as main system clock * XT1 oscillation can be stopped or external subsystem clock input can be disabled (OSCSELS = 0). * MSTOP = 0, OSCSEL = 1, EXCLK = 0 * After elapse of oscillation stabilization time * Clock supply to CPU is stopped for 4.06 to 16.12 s after AMPH has been set to 1. * MCS = 1 External main Enabling input of external clock from EXCLK system clock pin and selection of high-speed system clock as main system clock * MSTOP = 0, OSCSEL = 1, EXCLK = 1 * MCS = 1 * XT1 oscillation can be stopped or external subsystem clock input can be disabled (OSCSELS = 0). * Clock supply to CPU is stopped for the duration of 160 external clocks from the EXCLK pin after AMPH has been set to 1. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 141 CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR 5.6.8 Time required for switchover of CPU clock and main system clock By setting bits 0 to 2 (PCC0 to PCC2) and bit 4 (CSS) of the processor clock control register (PCC), the CPU clock can be switched (between the main system clock and the subsystem clock) and the division ratio of the main system clock can be changed. The actual switchover operation is not performed immediately after rewriting to PCC; operation continues on the pre-switchover clock for several clocks (see Table 5-6). Whether the CPU is operating on the main system clock or the subsystem clock can be ascertained using bit 5 (CLS) of the PCC register. Table 5-6. Time Required for Switchover of CPU Clock and Main System Clock Cycle Division Factor Set Value Before Set Value After Switchover Switchover CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 CSS PCC2 PCC1 PCC0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 8 clocks 0 1 0 4 clocks 4 clocks 1 16 clocks 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 x x x 16 clocks 16 clocks 16 clocks 2fXP/fSUB clocks 8 clocks 8 clocks 8 clocks fXP/fSUB clocks 4 clocks 4 clocks fXP/2fSUB clocks 0 1 1 2 clocks 2 clocks 2 clocks 1 0 0 1 clock 1 clock 1 clock 1 clock 2 clocks x x x 2 clocks 2 clocks 2 clocks 2 clocks fXP/4fSUB clocks fXP/8fSUB clocks 2 clocks Caution Selection of the main system clock cycle division factor (PCC0 to PCC2) and switchover from the main system clock to the subsystem clock (changing CSS from 0 to 1) should not be set simultaneously. Simultaneous setting is possible, however, for selection of the main system clock cycle division factor (PCC0 to PCC2) and switchover from the subsystem clock to the main system clock (changing CSS from 1 to 0). Remarks 1. The number of clocks listed in Table 5-6 is the number of CPU clocks before switchover. 2. When switching the CPU clock from the main system clock to the subsystem clock, calculate the number of clocks by rounding up to the next clock and discarding the decimal portion, as shown below. Example When switching CPU clock from fXP/2 to fSUB/2 (@ oscillation with fXP = 10 MHz, fSUB = 32.768 kHz) fXP/fSUB = 10000/32.768 305.1 306 clocks By setting bit 0 (MCM0) of the main clock mode register (MCM), the main system clock can be switched (between the internal high-speed oscillation clock and the high-speed system clock). The actual switchover operation is not performed immediately after rewriting to MCM0; operation continues on the pre-switchover clock for several clocks (see Table 5-7). Whether the CPU is operating on the internal high-speed oscillation clock or the high-speed system clock can be ascertained using bit 1 (MCS) of MCM. 142 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR Table 5-7. Maximum Time Required for Main System Clock Switchover Set Value Before Switchover Set Value After Switchover MCM0 MCM0 0 0 1 1 + 2fRH/fXH clock 1 1 + 2fXH/fRH clock Caution When switching the internal high-speed oscillation clock to the high-speed system clock, bit 2 (XSEL) of MCM must be set to 1 in advance. The value of XSEL can be changed only once after a reset release. Remarks 1. The number of clocks listed in Table 5-7 is the number of main system clocks before switchover. 2. Calculate the number of clocks in Table 5-7 by removing the decimal portion. Example When switching the main system clock from the internal high-speed oscillation clock to the high-speed system clock (@ oscillation with fRH = 8 MHz, fXH = 10 MHz) 1 + 2fRH/fXH = 1 + 2 x 8/10 = 1 + 2 x 0.8 = 1 + 1.6 = 2.6 2 clocks 5.6.9 Conditions before clock oscillation is stopped The following lists the register flag settings for stopping the clock oscillation (disabling external clock input) and conditions before the clock oscillation is stopped. Table 5-8. Conditions Before the Clock Oscillation Is Stopped and Flag Settings Clock Conditions Before Clock Oscillation Is Stopped Flag Settings of SFR (External Clock Input Disabled) Register Internal high-speed MCS = 1 or CLS = 1 oscillation clock (The CPU is operating on a clock other than the internal high-speed RSTOP = 1 oscillation clock) X1 clock MCS = 0 or CLS = 1 External main system clock (The CPU is operating on a clock other than the high-speed system clock) XT1 clock CLS = 0 External subsystem clock (The CPU is operating on a clock other than the subsystem clock) MSTOP = 1 OSCSELS = 0 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 143 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 The 78K0/FC2 incorporates 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01. Since the composition of a timer I/O pin changes with products, the 16-bit timer/event counter 01 (TM01) has the difference of function in a 16-bir timer/event counter00 (TM00). The difference in the function by the product is shown below. PD78F0881, 78F0882 and PD78F0884, 78F0885 and 78F0883 78F0886 TI001 - - TI011 - Provided TO01 - Provided Product Pin Be careful to the following restrictions for function of TM01 for PD78F0881, 78F0882 and 78F0883. * Selecting TI001 and TI011 for count clock is prohibited. When Using TI001 for baud rate error calculation, it is not applicable. * Timer output is prohibited. Be careful to the following restrictions for function of TM01 for PD78F0884, 78F0885 and 78F0886. * Selecting TI001 for count clock is prohibited. When Using TI001 for baud rate error calculation, it is not applicable. 144 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.1 Functions of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 have the following functions. * Interval timer * PPG output * Pulse width measurement * External event counter * Square-wave output * One-shot pulse output (1) Interval timer 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 generate an interrupt request at the preset time interval. (2) PPG output 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 can output a rectangular wave whose frequency and output pulse width can be set freely. (3) Pulse width measurement 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 can measure the pulse width of an externally input signal. (4) External event counter 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 can measure the number of pulses of an externally input signal. (5) Square-wave output 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 can output a square wave with any selected frequency. (6) One-shot pulse output 16-bit timer event counters 00 and 01 can output a one-shot pulse whose output pulse width can be set freely. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 145 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.2 Configuration of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 16-bit timer/event counters 00 and 01 include the following hardware. Table 6-1. Configuration of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 Item Configuration Timer counter 16 bits (TM0n) Register 16-bit timer capture/compare register: 16 bits (CR00n, CR01n) Timer input TI000, TI01n Timer output TO0n, output controller Control registers 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) 16-bit timer capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) Port mode register 0 (PM0) Port register 0 (P0) Remarks 1. There are no TI001, TI011 and TO01 in PD78F0881, 78F0882 and 78F0883. 2. There is no TI001 in PD78F0884, 78F0885 and 78F0886. 3. n = 0, 1 Figures 6-1, 6-2 and 6-3 show the block diagrams. Figure 6-1. Block Diagram of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counter 00 Internal bus Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) TI010/TO00/P01 Selector Noise eliminator Selector CRC002CRC001 CRC000 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 (CR000) INTTM000 Match Noise eliminator 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) Output controller TO00/TI010/ P01 Match 2 Output latch (P01) Noise eliminator TI000/P00 Clear PM01 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010) Selector fPRS Selector fPRS fPRS/22 fPRS/28 INTTM010 CRC002 PRM001 PRM000 Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) 146 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 OSPT00 OSPE00 TOC004 LVS00 LVR00 TOC001 TOE00 16-bit timer output 16-bit timer mode control register 00 control register 00 (TOC00) (TMC00) Internal bus User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-2. Block Diagram of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counter 01 (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) Internal bus Capture/compare control register 01 (CRC01) Noise eliminator Selector Selector CRC012CRC011 CRC010 16-bit timer capture/compare register 001 (CR001) INTTM001 Match Selector fPRS fPRS/24 fPRS/26 Clear Output controller Match Noise eliminator fPRS 16-bit timer counter 01 (TM01) 2 Noise eliminator Selector 16-bit timer capture/compare register 011 (CR011) INTTM011 CRC012 TMC013 TMC012 TMC011 OVF01 OSPT01 OSPE01 TOC014 LVS01 LVR01 TOC011 TOE01 16-bit timer output 16-bit timer mode control register 01 control register 01 (TOC01) (TMC01) Internal bus PRM011 PRM010 Prescaler mode register 01 (PRM01) Figure 6-3. Block Diagram of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counter 01 (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) Internal bus Capture/compare control register 01 (CRC01) TI011/TO01/P06 Selector Noise eliminator Selector CRC012CRC011 CRC010 16-bit timer capture/compare register 001 (CR001) INTTM001 Match Noise eliminator 16-bit timer counter 01 (TM01) Clear Output controller TO01/TI011/ P06 Match 2 Output latch (P06) Noise eliminator PM06 16-bit timer capture/compare register 011 (CR011) Selector fPRS Selector fPRS fPRS/24 fPRS/26 INTTM011 CRC012 PRM011 PRM010 Prescaler mode register 01 (PRM01) TMC013 TMC012 TMC011 OVF01 OSPT01 OSPE01 TOC014 LVS01 LVR01 TOC011 TOE01 16-bit timer output 16-bit timer mode control register 01 control register 01 (TOC01) (TMC01) Internal bus User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 147 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (1) 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) TM0n is a 16-bit read-only register that counts count pulses. The counter is incremented in synchronization with the rising edge of the input clock. If the count value is read during operation, then input of the count clock is temporarily stopped, and the count value at that point is read. Figure 6-4. Format of 16-Bit Timer Counter 0n (TM0n) Address: FF10H, FF11H (TM00), FFB0H, FFB1H (TM01) Symbol After reset: 0000H FF11H (TM00) FFB1H (TM01) R FF10H (TM00) FFB0H (TM01) TM0n (n = 0, 1) The count value is reset to 0000H in the following cases. <1> At reset signal generation <2> If TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 are cleared <3> If the valid edge of the TI000 pin is input in the mode in which clear & start occurs when inputting the valid edge of the TI000 pin <4> If TM0n and CR00n match in the mode in which clear & start occurs on a match of TM0n and CR00n <5> OSPT00 is set to 1 in one-shot pulse output mode or the valid edge is input to the TI000 pin Caution Even if TM0n is read, the value is not captured by CR01n. 148 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (2) 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n) CR00n is a 16-bit register that has the functions of both a capture register and a compare register. Whether it is used as a capture register or as a compare register is set by bit 0 (CRC0n0) of capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n). CR00n can be set by a 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 0000H. Figure 6-5. Format of 16-Bit Timer Capture/Compare Register 00n (CR00n) Address: FF12H, FF13H (CR000), FFB2H, FFB3H (CR001) Symbol After reset: 0000H FF13H (CR000) FFB2H (CR001) R/W FF12H (CR000) FFB3H (CR001) CR00n (n = 0, 1) * When CR00n is used as a compare register The value set in CR00n is constantly compared with 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) count value, and an interrupt request (INTTM00n) is generated if they match. The set value is held until CR00n is rewritten. * When CR00n is used as a capture register It is possible to select the valid edge of the TI000 pin or the TI01n pin as the capture trigger. The TI000 or TI01n pin valid edge is set using prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) (see Table 6-2). Caution CR00n does not perform the capture operation when it is set in the comparison mode, even if a capture trigger is input to it. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 149 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Table 6-2. CR00n Capture Trigger and Valid Edges of TI000 and TI01n Pins (1) TI000 pin valid edge selected as capture trigger (CRC001 = 1, CRC000 = 1) CR000 Capture Trigger TI000 Pin Valid Edge ES001 ES000 Falling edge Rising edge 0 1 Rising edge Falling edge 0 0 No capture operation Both rising and falling edges 1 1 ES1n1 ES1n0 (2) TI01n pin valid edge selected as capture trigger (CRC0n1 = 0, CRC0n0 = 1) CR00n Capture Trigger TI01n Pin Valid Edge Falling edge Falling edge 0 0 Rising edge Rising edge 0 1 Both rising and falling edges Both rising and falling edges 1 1 Cautions 1. Set a value other than 0000H in CR00n in the mode in which clear & start occurs on a match of TM0n and CR00n. 2. If CR00n is cleared to 0000H in the free-running mode and an interrupt request (INTTM00n) is generated when the value of CR00n changes from 0000H to 0001H following TM0n overflow (FFFFH). In addition, INTTM00n is generated after a match between TM0n and CR00n, after detecting the valid edge of the TI01n pin, and the timer is cleared by a one-shot trigger. 3. When P01 or P06 is used as the valid edge input of the TI01n pin, it cannot be used as the timer output (TO0n). Moreover, when P01 or P06 is used as TO0n, it cannot be used as the valid edge input of the TI01n pin. 4. When CR00n is used as a capture register, read data is undefined if the register read time and capture trigger input conflict (the capture data itself is the correct value). If count stop input and capture trigger input conflict, the captured data is undefined. 5. Do not rewrite CR00n during TM0n operation. Remarks 1. Setting ES001, ES000 = 1, 0 and ES1n1, ES1n0 = 1, 0 is prohibited. 2. ES001, ES000: Bits 5 and 4 of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) ES1n1, ES1n0: Bits 7 and 6 of prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) CRC0n1, CRC0n0: Bits 1 and 0 of capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) 3. n = 0, 1 150 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (3) 16-bit timer capture/compare register 01n (CR01n) CR01n is a 16-bit register that has the functions of both a capture register and a compare register. Whether it is used as a capture register or a compare register is set by bit 2 (CRC002) of capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00). CR01n can be set by a 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 0000H. Figure 6-6. Format of 16-Bit Timer Capture/Compare Register 01n (CR01n) Address: FF14H, FF15H (CR010), FFB4H, FFB5H (CR011) Symbol After reset: 0000H FF15H (CR010) FFB5H (CR011) R/W FF14H (CR010) FFB4H (CR011) CR01n (n = 0, 1) * When CR01n is used as a compare register The value set in the CR01n is constantly compared with 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) count value, and an interrupt request (INTTM01n) is generated if they match. The set value is held until CR01n is rewritten. * When CR010 is used as a capture register It is possible to select the valid edge of the TI000 pin as the capture trigger. The TI000 pin valid edge is set by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) (see Table 6-3). Table 6-3. CR01n Capture Trigger and Valid Edge of TI000 Pin (CRC002 = 1) CR010 Capture Trigger TI000 Pin Valid Edge ES001 ES000 Falling edge Falling edge 0 0 Rising edge Rising edge 0 1 Both rising and falling edges Both rising and falling edges 1 1 Cautions 1. If the CR01n register is cleared to 0000H, an interrupt request (INTTM01n) is generated when the value of CR01n changes from 0000H to 0001H following TM0n overflow (FFFFH). In addition, INTTM01n is generated after a match between TM0n and CR01n, after detecting the valid edge of the TI000 pin, and the timer is cleared by a one-shot trigger. 2. When CR01n is used as a capture register, read data is undefined if the register read time and capture trigger input conflict (the capture data itself is the correct value). If count stop input and capture trigger input conflict, the captured data is undefined. 3. CR01n can be rewritten during TM0n operation. For details, see Caution 2 in Figure 6-22 PPG Output Operation Timing. Remarks 1. Setting ES001, ES000 = 1, 0 is prohibited. 2. ES001, ES000: Bits 5 and 4 of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) CRC002: Bit 2 of capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) 3. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 151 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (4) Setting range when CR00n or CR01n is used as a compare register When CR00n or CR01n is used as a compare register, set it as shown below. Operation CR00n Register Setting Range 0000H < N FFFFH Operation as interval timer CR01n Register Setting Range 0000H Note M FFFFH Normally, this setting is not used. Mask the Operation as square-wave output match interrupt signal (INTTM01n). Operation as external event counter Note Operation in the clear & start mode 0000H N FFFFH Note M FFFFH Note M TMC00 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 TMC003 TMC002 0 0 Operation enable of 16-bit timer/event counter 00 Disables 16-bit timer/event counter 00 operation. Stops supplying operating clock. Clears 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00). 0 1 Free-running timer mode 1 0 Clear & start mode entered by TI000 pin valid edge input 1 1 Clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM00 and CR000 TMC001 Note Condition to reverse timer output (TO00) 0 * Match between TM00 and CR000 or match between TM00 and CR010 1 * Match between TM00 and CR000 or match between TM00 and CR010 * Trigger input of TI000 pin valid edge OVF00 Clear (0) Set (1) TM00 overflow flag Clears OVF00 to 0 or TMC003 and TMC002 = 00 Overflow occurs. OVF00 is set to 1 when the value of TM00 changes from FFFFH to 0000H in all the operation modes (free-running timer mode, clear & start mode entered by TI000 pin valid edge input, and clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM00 and CR000). It can also be set to 1 by writing 1 to OVF00. Note The TI000 pin valid edge is set by bits 5 and 4 (ES001, ES000) of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00). Remark TO00: 16-bit timer/event counter 00 output pin TI000: 16-bit timer/event counter 00 input pin TM00: 16-bit timer counter 00 CR000: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 CR010: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 155 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-8. Format of 16-Bit Timer Mode Control Register 01 (TMC01) Address: FFB6H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 <0> TMC01 0 0 0 0 TMC013 TMC012 TMC011 OVF01 TMC013 TMC012 0 0 Operation enable of 16-bit timer/event counter 01 Disables 16-bit timer/event counter 01 operation. Stops supplying operating clock. Clears 16-bit timer counter 01 (TM01). 0 1 Free-running timer mode 1 0 Setting prohibited 1 1 Clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM01 and CR001 TMC011 Condition to reverse timer output (TO01) 0 * Match between TM01 and CR001 or match between TM01 and CR011 1 * Match between TM01 and CR001 or match between TM01 and CR011 OVF01 Clear (0) Set (1) TM01 overflow flag Clears OVF01 to 0 or TMC013 and TMC012 = 00 Overflow occurs. OVF01 is set to 1 when the value of TM01 changes from FFFFH to 0000H in all the operation modes (free-running timer mode and clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM01 and CR001). It can also be set to 1 by writing 1 to OVF01. Remark TO01: 16-bit timer/event counter 01 output pin TM01: 16-bit timer counter 01 CR001: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 001 CR011: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 011 156 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (2) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) CRC0n is the register that controls the operation of CR00n and CR01n. Changing the value of CRC0n is prohibited during operation (when TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 = other than 00). CRC0n can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears CRC0n to 00H. Remark n = 0, 1 Figure 6-9. Format of Capture/Compare Control Register 00 (CRC00) Address: FFBCH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CRC00 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 CRC002 CR010 operating mode selection 0 Operates as compare register 1 Operates as capture register CRC001 CR000 capture trigger selection 0 Captures on valid edge of TI010 pin 1 Captures on valid edge of TI000 pin by reverse phase Note The valid edge of the TI010 and TI000 pin is set by PRM00. If ES001 and ES000 are set to 11 (both edges) when CRC001 is 1, the valid edge of the TI000 pin cannot be detected. CRC000 CR000 operating mode selection 0 Operates as compare register 1 Operates as capture register If TMC003 and TMC002 are set to 11 (clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM00 and CR000), be sure to set CRC000 to 0. Note When the valid edge is detected from the TI010 pin, the capture operation is not performed but the INTTM000 signal is generated as an external interrupt signal. Caution To ensure that the capture operation is performed properly, the capture trigger requires a pulse two cycles longer than the count clock selected by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00). Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 157 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-10. Example of CR01n Capture Operation (When Rising Edge Is Specified) Valid edge Count clock TM00 N-3 N-2 N-1 N N+1 TI000 Rising edge detection CR010 N INTTM010 Figure 6-11. Format of Capture/Compare Control Register 01 (CRC01) Address: FFB8H Symbol CRC01 After reset: 00H 7 0 R/W 6 0 5 4 0 CRC012 0 3 0 2 1 Note 1 CRC012 0 Note 2 CRC011 Note 1 CRC010 CR011 operating mode selection 0 Operates as compare register 1 Operates as capture register CRC011 CR001 capture trigger selection 0 Captures on valid edge of TI011 pin 1 Setting prohibited The valid edge of the TI011 pin is set by PRM01. CRC010 CR001 operating mode selection 0 Operates as compare register 1 Operates as capture register If TMC013 and TMC012 are set to 11 (clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM01 and CR001), be sure to set CRC010 to 0. Notes 1. 2. Be sure to set to bit 2 and 0 of CRC01 to 0 in PD78F0881, 78F0882 and 78F0883. Be sure to set to bit 1 of CRC01 to 0. Caution To ensure that the capture operation is performed properly, the capture trigger requires a pulse two cycles longer than the count clock selected by prescaler mode register 01 (PRM01) (see Figure 6-10 Example of CR01n Capture Operation (When Rising Edge Is Specified)). 158 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (3) 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) TOC0n is an 8-bit register that controls the TO0n pin output. TOC0n can be rewritten while only OSPT0n is operating (when TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 = other than 00). Rewriting the other bits is prohibited during operation. However, TOC0n4 can be rewritten during timer operation as a means to rewrite CR01n (see 6.5.1 Rewriting CR01n during TM0n operation). TOC0n can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears TOC0n to 00H. Caution Be sure to set TOC0n using the following procedure. <1> Set TOC0n4 and TOC0n1 to 1. <2> Set only TOE0n to 1. <3> Set either of LVS0n or LVR0n to 1. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 159 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-12. Format of 16-Bit Timer Output Control Register 00 (TOC00) Address: FFBDH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 <6> <5> 4 <3> <2> 1 <0> TOC00 0 OSPT00 OSPE00 TOC004 LVS00 LVR00 TOC001 TOE00 OSPT00 One-shot pulse output trigger via software 0 - 1 One-shot pulse output The value of this bit is always "0" when it is read. Do not set this bit to 1 in a mode other than the oneshot pulse output mode. If it is set to 1, TM00 is cleared and started. OSPE00 One-shot pulse output operation control 0 Successive pulse output 1 One-shot pulse output One-shot pulse output operates correctly in the free-running timer mode or clear & start mode entered by TI000 pin valid edge input. The one-shot pulse cannot be output in the clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM00 and CR000. TOC004 TO00 pin output control on match between CR010 and TM00 0 Disables inversion operation 1 Enables inversion operation The interrupt signal (INTTM010) is generated even when TOC004 = 0. LVS00 LVR00 Setting of TO00 pin output status 0 0 No change 0 1 Initial value of TO00 pin output is low level (TO00 pin output is cleared to 0). 1 0 Initial value of TO00 pin output is high level (TO00 pin output is set to 1). 1 1 Setting prohibited * LVS00 and LVR00 can be used to set the initial value of the output level of the TO00 pin. If the initial value does not have to be set, leave LVS00 and LVR00 as 00. * Be sure to set LVS00 and LVR00 when TOE00 = 1. LVS00, LVR00, and TOE00 being simultaneously set to 1 is prohibited. * LVS00 and LVR00 are trigger bits. By setting these bits to 1, the initial value of the output level of the TO00 pin can be set. Even if these bits are cleared to 0, output of the TO00 pin is not affected. * The values of LVS00 and LVR00 are always 0 when they are read. * For how to set LVS00 and LVR00, see 6.5.2 Setting LVS0n and LVR0n. TOC001 TO00 pin output control on match between CR000 and TM00 0 Disables inversion operation 1 Enables inversion operation The interrupt signal (INTTM000) is generated even when TOC001 = 0. TOE00 160 TO00 pin output control 0 Disables output (TO00 pin output fixed to low level) 1 Enables output User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-13. Format of 16-Bit Timer Output Control Register 01 (TOC01) Address: FFB9H Symbol TOC01 After reset: 00H 7 0 R/W <6> <5> Note OSPT01 4 Note OSPE01 <3> Note TOC014 LVS01 <2> Note LVR01 1 Note OSPT01 One-shot pulse output trigger via software 0 - 1 <0> Note TOC011 TOE01 Note One-shot pulse output The value of this bit is always 0 when it is read. Do not set this bit to 1 in a mode other than the one-shot pulse output mode. If it is set to 1, TM01 is cleared and started. OSPE01 One-shot pulse output operation control 0 Successive pulse output 1 One-shot pulse output One-shot pulse output operates correctly in the free-running timer mode. The one-shot pulse cannot be output in the clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM01 and CR001. TOC014 TO01 pin output control on match between CR011 and TM01 0 Disables inversion operation 1 Enables inversion operation The interrupt signal (INTTM011) is generated even when TOC014 = 0. LVS01 LVR01 Setting of TO01 pin output status 0 0 No change 0 1 Initial value of TO01 pin output is low level (TO01 pin output is cleared to 0). 1 0 Initial value of TO01 pin output is high level (TO01 pin output is set to 1). 1 1 Setting prohibited * LVS01 and LVR01 can be used to set the initial value of the output level of the TO01 pin. If the initial value does not have to be set, leave LVS01 and LVR01 as 00. * Be sure to set LVS01 and LVR01 when TOE01 = 1. LVS01, LVR01, and TOE01 being simultaneously set to 1 is prohibited. * LVS01 and LVR01 are trigger bits. By setting these bits to 1, the initial value of the output level of the TO01 pin can be set. Even if these bits are cleared to 0, output of the TO01 pin is not affected. * The values of LVS01 and LVR01 are always 0 when they are read. * For how to set LVS01 and LVR01, see 6.5.2 Setting LVS0n and LVR0n. TOC011 TO01 pin output control on match between CR001 and TM01 0 Disables inversion operation 1 Enables inversion operation The interrupt signal (INTTM001) is generated even when TOC011 = 0. TOE01 TO01 pin output control 0 Disables output (TO01 pin output is fixed to low level) 1 Enables output Note Be sure to set to bit 6 to 0 of TOC01 to 0 in PD78F0881, 78F0882 and 78F0883. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 161 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (4) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) PRM0n is the register that sets the TM0n count clock and TI000 and TI01n pin input valid edges. Rewriting PRM0n is prohibited during operation (when TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 = other than 00). PRM0n can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears PRM0n to 00H. Cautions 1. Do not apply the following setting when setting the PRM0n1 and PRM0n0 bits to 11 (to specify the valid edge of the TI000 pin as a count clock). * Clear & start mode entered by the TI000 pin valid edge * Setting the TI000 pin as a capture trigger 2. If the operation of the 16-bit timer/event counter 0n is enabled when the TI000 or TI01n pin is at high level and when the valid edge of the TI000 or TI01n pin is specified to be the rising edge or both edges, the high level of the TI000 or TI01n pin is detected as a rising edge. Note this when the TI000 or TI01n pin is pulled up. However, the rising edge is not detected when the timer operation has been once stopped and then is enabled again. 3. The valid edge of TI010 and timer output (TO00) cannot be used for the P01 pin at the same time, and the valid edge of TI011 and timer output (TO01) cannot be used for the P06 pin at the same time. Select either of the functions. Remark 162 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-14. Format of Prescaler Mode Register 00 (PRM00) Address: FFBBH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PRM00 ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 ES101 ES100 0 0 Falling edge 0 1 Rising edge 1 0 Setting prohibited 1 1 Both falling and rising edges ES001 ES000 0 0 Falling edge 0 1 Rising edge TI010 pin valid edge selection TI000 pin valid edge selection 1 0 Setting prohibited 1 1 Both falling and rising edges PRM001 PRM000 Count clock selection fPRS = 4 MHz fPRS = 5 MHz fPRS = 10 MHz fPRS = 20 MHz 0 0 fPRS 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 0 1 fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz 1 0 fPRS/2 8 15.62 kHz 19.53 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.12 kHz 1 1 TI000 valid edge Note Note The external clock requires a pulse two cycles longer than internal clock (fPRS). Cautions 1. Always set data to PRM00 after stopping the timer operation. 2. If the valid edge of the TI000 pin is to be set for the count clock, do not set the clear & start mode using the valid edge of the TI000 pin and the capture trigger. 3. If the TI000 or TI010 pin is high level immediately after system reset, the rising edge is immediately detected after the rising edge or both the rising and falling edges are set as the valid edge(s) of the TI000 pin or TI010 pin to enable the operation of 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00). Care is therefore required when pulling up the TI000 or TI010 pin. However, when re-enabling operation for TI000 pin or TI010 pin are high level after the operation has been stopped, the rising edge is not detected. 4. When TI010 pin is used valid edge, it cannot be used as the timer output (TO00) to P01, and when TO00 is used, it cannot be used to the TI010 pin valid edge. Remark fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 163 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-15. Format of Prescaler Mode Register 01 (PRM01) Address: FFB7H Symbol PRM01 After reset: 00H 7 ES111 R/W 6 Note ES110 Note 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 PRM011 PRM010 ES111 ES110 TI011 pin valid edge selection 0 0 Falling edge 0 1 Rising edge 1 0 Setting prohibited 1 1 Both falling and rising edges PRM011 PRM010 Count clock selection fPRS = 4 MHz 0 0 0 1 fPRS fPRS = 5 MHz fPRS = 10 MHz fPRS = 20 MHz 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz fPRS/2 4 250 kHz 312.5 kHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz 6 62.5 kHz 78.125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 1 0 fPRS/2 1 1 Setting prohibited Note Be sure to set to bit 7 and 6 of PRM01 to 0 in PD78F0881, 78F0882 and 78F0883. Cautions 1. Always set data to PRM01 after stopping the timer operation. 2. If the TI011 pin is high level immediately after system reset, the rising edge is immediately detected after the rising edge or both the rising and falling edges are set as the valid edge(s) of the TI011 pin to enable the operation of 16-bit timer counter 01 (TM01). Care is therefore required when pulling up the TI011 pin. However, when re-enabling operation for TI011 pin are high level after the operation has been stopped, the rising edge is not detected. 3. When TI011 pin is used valid edge, it cannot be used as the timer output (TO01) to P06, and when TO01 is used, it cannot be used to the TI011 pin valid edge. Remark 164 fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (5) Port mode register 0 (PM0) This register sets port 0 input/output in 1-bit units. When using the P01/TO00/TI010 and P06/TO01/TI011 pin for timer output, set PM01, PM06, the output latch of P01 and P06 to 0. When using the P01/TO00/TI010 and P06/TO01/TI011 pin for timer input, set PM01 and PM06 to 1. At this time, the output latch of P01 and P06 may be 0 or 1. PM0 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets PM0 to FFH. Figure 6-16. Format of Port Mode Register 0 (PM0) Address: FF14H After reset: FFH Symbol 7 PM0 1 6 PM06 Note R/W 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 PM01 PM00 PM0n P0n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0, 1, 6) 0 Output mode (Output buffer on) 1 Input mode (Output buffer off) Note PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 165 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.4 Operation of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 6.4.1 Interval timer operation Setting 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) and capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) as shown in Figure 6-17 allows operation as an interval timer. Setting The basic operation setting procedure is as follows. <1> Set the CRC0n register (see Figure 6-17 for the set value). <2> Set any value to the CR00n register. <3> Set the count clock by using the PRM0n register. <4> Set the TMC0n register to start the operation (see Figure 6-17 for the set value). Caution CR00n cannot be rewritten during TM0n operation. Remark For how to enable the INTTM00n interrupt, see CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS. Interrupt requests are generated repeatedly using the count value preset in 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n) as the interval. When the count value of 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) matches the value set in CR00n, counting continues with the TM0n value cleared to 0 and the interrupt request signal (INTTM00n) is generated. The count clock of 16-bit timer/event counter 0n can be selected with bits 0 and 1 (PRM0n0, PRM0n1) of prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n). Remark 166 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-17. Control Register Settings for Interval Timer Operation (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) TMC0n 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC0n3 TMC0n2 TMC0n1 OVF0n 1 1 0/1 0 Clears and starts on match between TM0n and CR00n. (b) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) CRC0n 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC0n2 CRC0n1 CRC0n0 0/1 0/1 0 CR00n used as compare register (c) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) Note Note ES1n1 ES1n0 ES001 ES000 PRM0n 0/1 0/1 0/1 0/1 3 2 0 0 PRM0n1 PRM0n0 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Note PRM00 only. Be sure to set to 0 in PRM01 Remarks 1. 0/1: Setting 0 or 1 allows another function to be used simultaneously with the interval timer. See the description of the respective control registers for details. 2. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 167 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-18. Interval Timer Configuration Diagram 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n) INTTM00n Selector fPRS fPRS/22 fPRS/28 Note 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) OVF0n Noise eliminator TI000/P00 Clear circuit fPRS Note OVF0n is set to 1 only when 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n is set to FFFFH. Figure 6-19. Timing of Interval Timer Operation t Count clock TM0n count value 0000H 0001H Timer operation enabled CR00n N N 0000H 0001H Clear N N 0000H 0001H Clear N N INTTM00n Interrupt acknowledged Remark Interval time = (N + 1) x t N = 0001H to FFFFH n = 0, 1 168 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD N Interrupt acknowledged CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.4.2 PPG output operations Setting 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) and capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) as shown in Figure 6-20 allows operation as PPG (Programmable Pulse Generator) output. Setting The basic operation setting procedure is as follows. <1> Set the CRC0n register (see Figure 6-20 for the set value). <2> Set any value to the CR00n register as the cycle. <3> Set any value to the CR01n register as the duty factor. <4> Set the TOC0n register (see Figure 6-20 for the set value). <5> Set the count clock by using the PRM0n register. <6> Set the TMC0n register to start the operation (see Figure 6-20 for the set value). Caution To change the value of the duty factor (the value of the CR01n register) during operation, see Caution 2 in Figure 6-22 PPG Output Operation Timing. Remarks 1. For the setting of the TO0n pin, see 6.3 (5) Port mode register 0 (PM0). 2. For how to enable the INTTM00n interrupt, see CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS. In the PPG output operation, rectangular waves are output from the TO0n pin with the pulse width and the cycle that correspond to the count values preset in 16-bit timer capture/compare register 01n (CR01n) and in 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n), respectively. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 169 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-20. Control Register Settings for PPG Output Operation (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) TMC0n 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC0n3 TMC0n2 TMC0n1 OVF0n 1 1 0 0 Clears and starts on match between TM0n and CR00n. (b) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) CRC0n 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC0n2 CRC0n1 CRC0n0 0 x 0 CR00n used as compare register CR01n used as compare register (c) 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) 7 TOC0n 0 OSPT0n OSPE0n TOC0n4 LVS0n LVR0n TOC0n1 TOE0n 0 0 1 0/1 0/1 1 1 Enables TO0n output. Inverts output on match between TM0n and CR00n. Specifies initial value of TO0n output F/F (setting "11" is prohibited). Inverts output on match between TM0n and CR01n. Disables one-shot pulse output. (d) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) Note Note ES1n1 ES1n0 ES001 ES000 PRM0n 0/1 0/1 0/1 0/1 3 2 0 0 PRM0n1 PRM0n0 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Note PRM00 only. Be sure to set to 0 in PRM01 Cautions 1. Values in the following range should be set in CR00n and CR01n: 0000H CR01n < CR00n FFFFH 2. The cycle of the pulse generated through PPG output (CR00n setting value + 1) has a duty of (CR01n setting value + 1)/(CR00n setting value + 1). Remark x: Don't care n = 0, 1 170 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-21. Configuration Diagram of PPG Output 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n) Selector fPRS fPRS/22 fPRS/28 Noise eliminator Output controller TI000/P00 Clear circuit 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) fPRS TO00/TI010/P01 16-bit timer capture/compare register 01n (CR01n) Figure 6-22. PPG Output Operation Timing t Count clock TM0n count value N 0000H 0001H M-1 M Clear N-1 N 0000H 0001H Clear CR00n capture value N CR01n capture value M TO0n Pulse width: (M + 1) x t 1 cycle: (N + 1) x t Cautions 1. CR00n cannot be rewritten during TM0n operation. 2. In the PPG output operation, change the pulse width (rewrite CR01n) during TM0n operation using the following procedure. <1> Disable the timer output inversion operation by match of TM0n and CR01n (TOC0n4 = 0) <2> Disable the INTTM01n interrupt (TMMK01n = 1) <3> Rewrite CR01n <4> Wait for 1 cycle of the TM0n count clock <5> Enable the timer output inversion operation by match of TM0n and CR01n (TOC0n4 = 1) <6> Clear the interrupt request flag of INTTM01n (TMIF01n = 0) <7> Enable the INTTM01n interrupt (TMMK01n = 0) Remarks 1. 0000H M < N FFFFH 2. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 171 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.4.3 Pulse width measurement operations Pulse width measurement is using for16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) only. It is possible to measure the pulse width of the signals input to the TI000 pin using 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00). There are two measurement methods: measuring with TM00 used in free-running mode, and measuring by restarting the timer in synchronization with the edge of the signal input to the TI000 pin. When an interrupt occurs, read the valid value of the capture register, check the overflow flag, and then calculate the necessary pulse width. Clear the overflow flag after checking it. The capture operation is not performed until the signal pulse width is sampled in the count clock cycle selected by prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) and the valid level of the TI000 or TI010 pin is detected twice, thus eliminating noise with a short pulse width. Figure 6-23. CR010 Capture Operation with Rising Edge Specified Count clock TM00 N-3 N-2 N-1 N N+1 TI000 Rising edge detection N CR010 INTTM010 Setting The basic operation setting procedure is as follows. <1> Set the CRC00 register (see Figures 6-24, 6-27, 6-29, and 6-31 for the set value). <2> Set the count clock by using the PRM00 register. <3> Set the TMC00 register to start the operation (see Figures 6-24, 6-27, 6-29, and 6-31 for the set value). Caution To use two capture registers, set the TI000 and TI010 pins. Remarks 1. 2. For the setting of the TI000 (or TI010) pin, see 6.3 (5) Port mode register 0 (PM0). For how to enable the INTTM000 (or INTTM010) interrupt, see CHAPTER 16 FUNCTIONS. 172 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD INTERRUPT CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (1) Pulse width measurement with free-running counter and one capture register When 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) is operated in free-running mode, and the edge specified by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) is input to the TI000 pin, the value of TM00 is taken into 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010) and an external interrupt request signal (INTTM010) is set. Specify both the rising and falling edges of the TI000 pin by using bits 4 and 5 (ES000 and ES001) of PRM00. Sampling is performed using the count clock selected by PRM00, and a capture operation is only performed when a valid level of the TI000 pin is detected twice, thus eliminating noise with a short pulse width. Figure 6-24. Control Register Settings for Pulse Width Measurement with Free-Running Counter and One Capture Register (When TI000 and CR010 Are Used) (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) TMC00 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 0 1 0/1 0 Free-running mode (b) Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) CRC00 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 1 0/1 0 CR000 used as compare register CR010 used as capture register (c) Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 PRM00 0/1 0/1 1 1 3 2 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock (setting "11" is prohibited). Specifies both edges for pulse width detection. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Remark 0/1: Setting 0 or 1 allows another function to be used simultaneously with pulse width measurement. See the description of the respective control registers for details. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 173 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-25. Configuration Diagram for Pulse Width Measurement with Free-Running Counter Selector fPRS fPRS/22 fPRS/28 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM00) OVF00 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010) TI000 INTTM010 Internal bus Figure 6-26. Timing of Pulse Width Measurement Operation with Free-Running Counter and One Capture Register (with Both Edges Specified) t Count clock TM00 count value 0000H 0001H D0 D0 + 1 D1 D1 + 1 FFFFH 0000H D2 D3 TI000 pin input CR010 capture value D0 D1 D2 D3 INTTM010 Note OVF00 (D1 - D0) x t (10000H - D1 + D2) x t Note Clear OVF0n by software. 174 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD (D3 - D2) x t CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (2) Measurement of two pulse widths with free-running counter When 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) is operated in free-running mode, it is possible to simultaneously measure the pulse widths of the two signals input to the TI000 pin and the TI010 pin. When the edge specified by bits 4 and 5 (ES000 and ES001) of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) is input to the TI000 pin, the value of TM00 is taken into 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010) and an interrupt request signal (INTTM010) is set. Also, when the edge specified by bits 6 and 7 (ES100 and ES101) of PRM00 is input to the TI010 pin, the value of TM00 is taken into 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 (CR000) and an interrupt request signal (INTTM000) is set. Specify both the rising and falling edges as the edges of the TI000 and TI010 pins, by using bits 4 and 5 (ES000 and ES001) and bits 6 and 7 (ES100 and ES101) of PRM00. Sampling is performed using the count clock cycle selected by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00), and a capture operation is only performed when a valid level of the TI000 or TI010 pin is detected twice, thus eliminating noise with a short pulse width. Figure 6-27. Control Register Settings for Measurement of Two Pulse Widths with Free-Running Counter (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) TMC00 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 0 1 0/1 0 Free-running mode (b) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC00) CRC00 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 1 0 1 CR000 used as capture register Captures valid edge of TI010 pin to CR000. CR010 used as capture register (c) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM00) ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 PRM00 1 1 1 1 3 2 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock (setting "11" is prohibited). Specifies both edges for pulse width detection. Specifies both edges for pulse width detection. Remark 0/1: Setting 0 or 1 allows another function to be used simultaneously with pulse width measurement. See the description of the respective control registers for details. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 175 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-28. Timing of Pulse Width Measurement Operation with Free-Running Counter (with Both Edges Specified) t Count clock TM00 count value 0000H 0001H D0 D0 + 1 D1 D1 + 1 FFFFH 0000H D2 D2 + 1 D2 + 2 TI000 pin input CR010 capture value D0 D1 D2 INTTM010 TI010 pin input CR000 capture value D1 D2 + 1 INTTM000 Note OVF00 (D1 - D0) x t (10000H - D1 + D2) x t (10000H - D1 + (D2 + 1)) x t Note Clear OVF0n by software. 176 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD (D3 - D2) x t D3 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (3) Pulse width measurement with free-running counter and two capture registers When 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) is operated in free-running mode, it is possible to measure the pulse width of the signal input to the TI000 pin. When the rising or falling edge specified by bits 4 and 5 (ES000 and ES001) of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) is input to the TI000 pin, the value of TM00 is taken into 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010) and an interrupt request signal (INTTM010) is set. Also, when the inverse edge to that of the capture operation is input into CR010, the value of TM00 is taken into 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 (CR000). Sampling is performed using the count clock cycle selected by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00), and a capture operation is only performed when a valid level of the TI000 pin is detected twice, thus eliminating noise with a short pulse width. Figure 6-29. Control Register Settings for Pulse Width Measurement with Free-Running Counter and Two Capture Registers (with Rising Edge Specified) (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) TMC00 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 0 1 0/1 0 Free-running mode (b) Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) CRC00 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 1 1 1 CR000 used as capture register Captures to CR000 at inverse edge to valid edge of TI000. CR010 used as capture register (c) Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 PRM00 0/1 0/1 0 1 3 2 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock (setting "11" is prohibited). Specifies rising edge for pulse width detection. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Remark 0/1: Setting 0 or 1 allows another function to be used simultaneously with pulse width measurement. See the description of the respective control registers for details. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 177 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-30. Timing of Pulse Width Measurement Operation with Free-Running Counter and Two Capture Registers (with Rising Edge Specified) t Count clock TM00 count value 0000H 0001H D0 D0 + 1 D1 D1 + 1 FFFFH 0000H D2 D2 + 1 D3 TI000 pin input CR010 capture value D0 CR000 capture value D2 D1 D3 INTTM010 Note OVF00 (D1 - D0) x t (10000H - D1 + D2) x t (D3 - D2) x t Note Clear OVF00 by software. (4) Pulse width measurement by means of restart When input of a valid edge to the TI000 pin is detected, the count value of 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) is taken into 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010), and then the pulse width of the signal input to the TI000 pin is measured by clearing TM00 and restarting the count operation. Either of two edgesrising or fallingcan be selected using bits 4 and 5 (ES000 and ES001) of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00). Sampling is performed using the count clock cycle selected by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) and a capture operation is only performed when a valid level of the TI000 pin is detected twice, thus eliminating noise with a short pulse width. 178 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-31. Control Register Settings for Pulse Width Measurement by Means of Restart (with Rising Edge Specified) (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) TMC00 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 1 0 0/1 0 Clears and starts at valid edge of TI000 pin. (b) Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) CRC00 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 1 1 1 CR000 used as capture register Captures to CR000 at inverse edge to valid edge of TI000. CR010 used as capture register (c) Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 PRM00 0/1 0/1 0 1 3 2 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock (setting "11" is prohibited). Specifies rising edge for pulse width detection. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Figure 6-32. Timing of Pulse Width Measurement Operation by Means of Restart (with Rising Edge Specified) t Count clock TM00 count value 0000H 0001H D0 0000H 0001H D1 D2 0000H 0001H TI000 pin input CR010 capture value D0 D2 D1 CR000 capture value INTTM010 D1 x t D2 x t User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 179 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.4.4 External event counter operation This function is using for16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) only. Setting The basic operation setting procedure is as follows. <1> Set the CRC00 register (see Figure 6-33 for the set value). <2> Set the count clock by using the PRM00 register. <3> Set any value to the CR000 register (0000H cannot be set). <4> Set the TMC00 register to start the operation (see Figure 6-33 for the set value). Remarks 1. For the setting of the TI000 pin, see 6.3 (5) Port mode register 0 (PM0). 2. For how to enable the INTTM000 interrupt, see CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS. The external event counter counts the number of external clock pulses input to the TI000 pin using 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00). TM00 is incremented each time the valid edge specified by prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) is input. When the TM00 count value matches the 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 (CR000) value, TM00 is cleared to 0 and the interrupt request signal (INTTM000) is generated. Input a value other than 0000H to CR000 (a count operation with 1-bit pulse cannot be carried out). Any of three edgesrising, falling, or both edgescan be selected using bits 4 and 5 (ES000 and ES001) of prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00). Sampling is performed using the internal clock (fPRS) and an operation is only performed when a valid level of the TI000 pin is detected twice, thus eliminating noise with a short pulse width. 180 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-33. Control Register Settings in External Event Counter Mode (with Rising Edge Specified) (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) TMC00 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF000 1 1 0/1 Clears and starts on match between TM00 and CR000. (b) Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) CRC00 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 0/1 0/1 0 CR000 used as compare register (c) Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 PRM00 0/1 0/1 0 1 3 2 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 1 1 Selects external clock. Specifies rising edge for pulse width detection. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Remark 0/1: Setting 0 or 1 allows another function to be used simultaneously with the external event counter. See the description of the respective control registers for details. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 181 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-34. Configuration Diagram of External Event Counter Internal bus 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 (CR000) Match INTTM000 Clear Valid edge of TI000 pin Noise eliminator 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00) OVF00Note fPRS Note OVF00 is set to 1 only when CR000 is set to FFFFH. Figure 6-35. External Event Counter Operation Timing (with Rising Edge Specified) TI000 pin input TM00 count value CR000 0000H 0001H 0002H 0003H 0004H 0005H N-1 N 0000H 0001H 0002H 0003H N INTTM000 Caution When reading the external event counter count value, TM00 should be read. 182 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.4.5 Square-wave output operation Setting The basic operation setting procedure is as follows. <1> Set the count clock by using the PRM0n register. <2> Set the CRC0n register (see Figure 6-36 for the set value). <3> Set the TOC0n register (see Figure 6-36 for the set value). <4> Set any value to the CR00n register (0000H cannot be set). <5> Set the TMC0n register to start the operation (see Figure 6-36 for the set value). Caution CR00n cannot be rewritten during TM0n operation. Remarks 1. For the setting of the TO0n pin, see 6.3 (5) Port mode register 0 (PM0). 2. For how to enable the INTTM00n interrupt, see CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS. A square wave with any selected frequency can be output at intervals determined by the count value preset to 16bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n). The TO0n pin output status is reversed at intervals determined by the count value preset to CR00n + 1 by setting bit 0 (TOE0n) and bit 1 (TOC0n1) of 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) to 1. This enables a square wave with any selected frequency to be output. Figure 6-36. Control Register Settings in Square-Wave Output Mode (1/2) (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) TMC0n 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC0n3 TMC0n2 TMC0n1 OVF0n 1 1 0 0 Clears and starts on match between TM0n and CR00n. (b) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) CRC0n 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC0n2 CRC0n1 CRC0n0 0/1 0/1 0 CR00n used as compare register User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 183 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-36. Control Register Settings in Square-Wave Output Mode (2/2) (c) 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) 7 TOC0n OSPT0n OSPE0n TOC0n4 LVS0n LVR0n TOC0n1 TOE0n 0 0 0 0 0/1 0/1 1 1 Enables TO0n output. Inverts output on match between TM0n and CR00n. Specifies initial value of TO0n output F/F (setting "11" is prohibited). Does not invert output on match between TM0n and CR01n. Disables one-shot pulse output. (d) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) Note Note ES1n1 ES1n0 ES001 ES000 PRM0n 0/1 0/1 0/1 0/1 3 2 0 0 PRM0n1 PRM0n0 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Note PRM00 only. Be sure to set to 0 in PRM01 Remark 0/1: Setting 0 or 1 allows another function to be used simultaneously with square-wave output. See the description of the respective control registers for details. n = 0, 1 Figure 6-37. Square-Wave Output Operation Timing Count clock TM0n count value CR00n 0000H 0001H 0002H N-1 N 0000H 0001H 0002H N INTTM00n TO0n pin output Remark 184 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD N-1 N 0000H CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.4.6 One-shot pulse output operation 16-bit timer/event counter 0n can output a one-shot pulse in synchronization with a software trigger or an external trigger (TI000 pin input). Setting The basic operation setting procedure is as follows. <1> Set the count clock by using the PRM0n register. <2> Set the CRC0n register (see Figures 6-38 and 6-40 for the set value). <3> Set the TOC0n register (see Figures 6-38 and 6-40 for the set value). <4> Set any value to the CR00n and CR01n registers (0000H cannot be set). <5> Set the TMC0n register to start the operation (see Figures 6-38 and 6-40 for the set value). Remarks 1. For the setting of the TO0n pin, see 6.3 (5) Port mode register 0 (PM0) and (6) Port mode register 3 (PM3). 2. For how to enable the INTTM00n (if necessary, INTTM01n) interrupt, see CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS. (1) One-shot pulse output with software trigger A one-shot pulse can be output from the TO0n pin by setting 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n), capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n), and 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) as shown in Figure 6-38, and by setting bit 6 (OSPT0n) of the TOC0n register to 1 by software. By setting the OSPT0n bit to 1, 16-bit timer/event counter 0n is cleared and started, and its output becomes active at the count value (N) set in advance to 16-bit timer capture/compare register 01n (CR01n). After that, the output becomes inactive at the count value (M) set in advance to 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n)Note. Even after the one-shot pulse has been output, the TM0n register continues its operation. To stop the TM0n register, the TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 bits of the TMC0n register must be set to 00. Note The case where N < M is described here. When N > M, the output becomes active with the CR00n register and inactive with the CR01n register. Do not set N to M. Cautions 1. Do not set the OSPT0n bit while the one-shot pulse is being output. To output the oneshot pulse again, wait until the current one-shot pulse output is completed. 2. When using the one-shot pulse output of 16-bit timer/event counter 0n with a software trigger, do not change the level of the TI000 pin or its alternate-function port pin. Because the external trigger is valid even in this case, the timer is cleared and started even at the level of the TI000 pin or its alternate-function port pin, resulting in the output of a pulse at an undesired timing. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 185 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-38. Control Register Settings for One-Shot Pulse Output with Software Trigger (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) TMC0n 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC0n3 TMC0n2 TMC0n1 0 1 OVF0n 0 0 Free-running mode (b) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) CRC0n 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC0n2 CRC0n1 CRC0n0 0 0/1 0 CR00n as compare register CR01n as compare register (c) 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) 7 TOC0n OSPT0n OSPE0n TOC0n4 0 0 1 LVS0n LVR0n TOC0n1 TOE0n 0/1 0/1 1 1 1 Enables TO0n output. Inverts output upon match between TM0n and CR00n. Specifies initial value of TO0n output F/F (setting "11" is prohibited.) Inverts output upon match between TM0n and CR01n. Sets one-shot pulse output mode. Set to 1 for output. (d) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) PRM0n Note Note ES1n1 ES1n0 ES001 ES000 3 2 0/1 0/1 0/1 0/1 0 0 PRM0n1 PRM0n0 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Note PRM00 only. Be sure to set to 0 in PRM01 Caution Do not set 0000H to the CR00n and CR01n registers. Remark 186 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-39. Timing of One-Shot Pulse Output Operation with Software Trigger Set TMC0n to 04H (TM0n count starts) Count clock TM0n count 0000H 0001H N N+1 0000H N-1 N M-1 M M+1 M+2 CR01n set value N N N N CR00n set value M M M M OSPT0n INTTM01n INTTM00n TO0n pin output Caution 16-bit timer counter 0n starts operating as soon as a value other than 00 (operation stop mode) is set to the TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 bits. Remark N M, the output becomes active with the CR000 register and inactive with the CR010 register. Do not set N to M. Caution Even if the external trigger is generated again while the one-shot pulse is output, it is ignored. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 187 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-40. Control Register Settings for One-Shot Pulse Output with External Trigger (with Rising Edge Specified) (a) 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) TMC00 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 TMC003 TMC002 TMC001 OVF00 0 0 1 0 Clears and starts at valid edge of TI000 pin. (b) Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00) CRC00 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 CRC002 CRC001 CRC000 0 0/1 0 CR000 used as compare register CR010 used as compare register (c) 16-bit timer output control register 00 (TOC00) 7 TOC00 0 OSPT00 OSPE00 TOC004 0 1 1 LVS00 LVR00 TOC001 TOE00 0/1 0/1 1 1 Enables TO00 output. Inverts output upon match between TM00 and CR000. Specifies initial value of TO00 output F/F (setting "11" is prohibited.) Inverts output upon match between TM00 and CR010. Sets one-shot pulse output mode. (d) Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00) PRM00 ES101 ES100 ES001 ES000 3 2 0/1 0/1 0 1 0 0 PRM001 PRM000 0/1 0/1 Selects count clock (setting "11" is prohibited). Specifies the rising edge for pulse width detection. Setting invalid (setting "10" is prohibited.) Caution Do not set the CR000 and CR010 registers to 0000H. 188 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 Figure 6-41. Timing of One-Shot Pulse Output Operation with External Trigger (with Rising Edge Specified) When TMC00 is set to 08H (TM00 count starts) t Count clock TM00 count value 0000H 0001H 0000H N N+1 N+2 M-2 M-1 M M+1 M+2 CR010 set value N N N N CR000 set value M M M M TI000 pin input INTTM010 INTTM000 TO00 pin output Caution 16-bit timer counter 00 starts operating as soon as a value other than 00 (operation stop mode) is set to the TMC002 and TMC003 bits. Remark N Disable interrupt INTTM01n (TMMK01n = 1). <2> Disable reversal of the timer output when the value of TM0n matches that of CR01n (TOC0n4 = 0). <3> Change the value of CR01n. <4> Wait for one cycle of the count clock of TM0n. <5> Enable reversal of the timer output when the value of TM0n matches that of CR01n (TOC0n4 = 1). <6> Clear the interrupt flag of INTTM01n (TMIF01n = 0) to 0. <7> Enable interrupt INTTM01n (TMMK01n = 0). Remark For TMIF01n and TMMK01n, see CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS. 6.5.2 Setting LVS0n and LVR0n (1) Usage of LVS0n and LVR0n LVS0n and LVR0n are used to set the default value of the TO0n pin output and to invert the timer output without enabling the timer operation (TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 = 00). Clear LVS0n and LVR0n to 00 (default value: lowlevel output) when software control is unnecessary. Remark 190 LVS0n LVR0n Timer Output Status 0 0 Not changed (low-level output) 0 1 Cleared (low-level output) 1 0 Set (high-level output) 1 1 Setting prohibited n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (2) Setting LVS0n and LVR0n Set LVS0n and LVR0n using the following procedure. Figure 6-42. Example of Flow for Setting LVS0n and LVR0n Bits Setting TOC0n.OSPE0n, TOC0n4, TOC0n1 bits <1> Setting of timer output operation Setting TOC0n.TOE0n bit Setting TOC0n.LVS0n, LVR0n bits Setting TMC0n.TMC0n3, TMC0n2 bits <2> Setting of timer output F/F <3> Enabling timer operation Caution Be sure to set LVS0n and LVR0n following steps <1>, <2>, and <3> above. Step <2> can be performed after <1> and before <3>. Figure 6-43. Timing Example of LVR0n and LVS0n TOC0n.LVS0n bit TOC0n.LVR0n bit Operable bits (TMC0n3, TMC0n2) 00 01, 10, or 11 TO0n pin output INTTM00n signal <1> <2> <1> <3> <4> <4> <4> <1> The TO0n pin output goes high when LVS0n and LVR0n = 10. <2> The TO0n pin output goes low when LVS0n and LVR0n = 01 (the pin output remains unchanged from the high level even if LVS0n and LVR0n are cleared to 00). <3> The timer starts operating when TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 are set to 01, 10, or 11. Because LVS0n and LVR0n were set to 10 before the operation was started, the TO0n pin output starts from the high level. After the timer starts operating, setting LVS0n and LVR0n is prohibited until TMC0n3 and TMC0n2 = 00 (disabling the timer operation). <4> The output level of the TO0n pin is inverted each time an interrupt signal (INTTM00n) is generated. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 191 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 6.6 Cautions for 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 (1) Restrictions for each channel of 16-bit timer/event counter 0n Table 6-5 shows the restrictions for each channel. Table 6-5. Restrictions for Each Channel of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counter 0n Operation Restriction - As interval timer As square-wave output As external event counter As clear & start mode entered by Using timer output (TO00) is prohibited when detection of the valid edge of the TI010 pin is TI000 pin valid edge input used. (TOC00 = 00H) - As free-running timer As PPG output 0000H CP01n < CR00n FFFFH As one-shot pulse output Setting the same value to CR00n and CP01n is prohibited. As pulse width measurement Using timer output (TO0n) is prohibited (TOC0n = 00H) (2) Timer start errors An error of up to one clock may occur in the time required for a match signal to be generated after timer start. This is because counting TM0n is started asynchronously to the count pulse. Figure 6-44. Start Timing of TM0n Count Count pulse TM0n count value 0000H 0001H 0002H 0003H 0004H Timer start (3) Setting of CR00n and CR01n (clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM0n and CR00n) Set a value other than 0000H to CR00n and CR01n (TM0n cannot count one pulse when it is used as an external event counter). Remark 192 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (4) Timing of holding data by capture register (a) When the valid edge is input to the TI000/TI01n pin and the reverse phase of the TI000 pin is detected while CR000/CR01n is read, CR01n performs a capture operation but the read value of CR000/CR01n is not guaranteed. At this time, an interrupt signal (INTTM000/INTTM01n) is generated when the valid edge of the TI000/TI01n pin is detected (the interrupt signal is not generated when the reverse-phase edge of the TI000 pin is detected). When the count value is captured because the valid edge of the TI000/TI01n pin was detected, read the value of CR000/CR01n after INTTM000/INTTM01n is generated. Figure 6-45. Timing of Holding Data by Capture Register Count pulse TM0n count value N N+1 N+2 M M+1 M+2 Edge input INTTM01n Capture read signal Value captured to CR01n X N+1 Capture operation Capture operation is performed but read value is not guaranteed. (b) The values of CR00n and CR01n are not guaranteed after 16-bit timer/event counter 0n stops. (5) Setting valid edge Set the valid edge of the TI000 pin while the timer operation is stopped (TMC003 and TMC002 = 00). Set the valid edge by using ES000 and ES001. (6) Re-triggering one-shot pulse Make sure that the trigger is not generated while an active level is being output in the one-shot pulse output mode. Be sure to input the next trigger after the current active level is output. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 193 CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (7) Operation of OVF0n flag (a) Setting OVF0n flag (1) The OVF0n flag is set to 1 in the following case, as well as when TM0n overflows. Select the clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM0n and CR00n. Set CR00n to FFFFH. When TM0n matches CR00n and TM0n is cleared from FFFFH to 0000H Figure 6-46. Operation Timing of OVF0n Flag Count pulse CR00n FFFFH TM0n FFFEH FFFFH 0000H 0001H OVF0n INTTM00n (b) Clearing OVF0n flag Even if the OVF0n flag is cleared to 0 after TM0n overflows and before the next count clock is counted (before the value of TM0n becomes 0001H), it is set to 1 again and clearing is invalid. (8) One-shot pulse output One-shot pulse output operates correctly in the free-running timer mode or the clear & start mode entered by the TI000 pin valid edge. The one-shot pulse cannot be output in the clear & start mode entered upon a match between TM0n and CR00n. Remark 194 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 6 16-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 00 AND 01 (9) Capture operation (a) When valid edge of TI000 is specified as count clock When the valid edge of TI000 is specified as the count clock, the capture register for which TI000 is specified as a trigger does not operate correctly. (b) Pulse width to accurately capture value by signals input to TI01n and TI000 pins To accurately capture the count value, the pulse input to the TI000 and TI01n pins as a capture trigger must be wider than two count clocks selected by PRM0n (see Figure 6-10). (c) Generation of interrupt signal The capture operation is performed at the falling edge of the count clock but the interrupt signals (INTTM00n and INTTM01n) are generated at the rising edge of the next count clock (see Figure 6-10). (d) Note when CRC001 (bit 1 of capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00)) is set to 1 When the count value of the TM00 register is captured to the CR000 register in the phase reverse to the signal input to the TI000 pin, the interrupt signal (INTTM000) is not generated after the count value is captured. If the valid edge is detected on the TI010 pin during this operation, the capture operation is not performed but the INTTM000 signal is generated as an external interrupt signal. Mask the INTTM000 signal when the external interrupt is not used. (10) Edge detection (a) Specifying valid edge after reset If the operation of the 16-bit timer/event counter 0n is enabled after reset and while the TI000 or TI01n pin is at high level and when the rising edge or both the edges are specified as the valid edge of the TI000 or TI01n pin, then the high level of the TI000 or TI01n pin is detected as the rising edge. Note this when the TI000 or TI01n pin is pulled up. However, the rising edge is not detected when the operation is once stopped and then enabled again. (b) Sampling clock for eliminating noise The sampling clock for eliminating noise differs depending on whether the valid edge of TI000 is used as the count clock or capture trigger. In the former case, the sampling clock is fixed to fPRS. In the latter, the count clock selected by PRM00 is used for sampling. When the signal input to the TI000 pin is sampled and the valid level is detected two times in a row, the valid edge is detected. Therefore, noise having a short pulse width can be eliminated (see Figure 6-10). (11) Timer operation The signal input to the TI000/TI01n pin is not acknowledged while the timer is stopped, regardless of the operation mode of the CPU. Remarks 1. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 2. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 195 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.1 Functions of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 8-bit timer/event counters 50 and 51 have the following functions. * Interval timer * External event counter * Square-wave output * PWM output Figures 7-1 and 7-2 show the block diagrams of 8-bit timer/event counters 50 and 51. Figure 7-1. Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counter 50 Internal bus Selector Match Selector Note 1 S Q INV 8-bit timer OVF counter 50 (TM50) R Clear Selector TCL502 TCL501 TCL500 Timer clock selection register 50 (TCL50) Note 2 S 3 R Invert level TCE50 TMC506 LVS50 LVR50 TMC501 TOE50 8-bit timer mode control register 50 (TMC50) Internal bus Notes 1. Timer output F/F 2. PWM output F/F 196 INTTM50 Selector TI50/TO50/ P17 fPRS fPRS/2 fPRS/22 fPRS/26 fPRS/28 fPRS/213 Mask circuit 8-bit timer compare register 50 (CR50) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD To TMH0 To UART0 To UART6 TO50/TI50/ P17 Output latch (P17) PM17 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 Figure 7-2. Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counter 51 Internal bus Selector Note 1 S Q INV 8-bit timer OVF counter 51 (TM51) R Clear Selector TCL512 TCL511 TCL510 Timer clock selection register 51 (TCL51) Note 2 S 3 INTTM51 Selector Match Selector TI51/TO51/P33/INTP4 fPRS fPRS/2 fPRS/24 fPRS/26 fPRS/28 fPRS/212 Mask circuit 8-bit timer compare register 51 (CR51) R Invert level TO51/TI51/ P33/INTP4 Output latch (P33) PM33 TCE51 TMC516 LVS51 LVR51 TMC511 TOE51 8-bit timer mode control register 51 (TMC51) Internal bus Notes 1. Timer output F/F 2. PWM output F/F User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 197 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.2 Configuration of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 8-bit timer/event counters 50 and 51 include the following hardware. Table 7-1. Configuration of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 Item Configuration Timer register 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n) Register 8-bit timer compare register 5n (CR5n) Timer input TI5n Timer output TO5n Control registers Timer clock selection register 5n (TCL5n) 8-bit timer mode control register 5n (TMC5n) Port mode register 1 (PM1) or port mode register 3 (PM3) Port register 1 (P1) or port register 3 (P3) (1) 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n) TM5n is an 8-bit register that counts the count pulses and is read-only. The counter is incremented in synchronization with the rising edge of the count clock. Figure 7-3. Format of 8-Bit Timer Counter 5n (TM5n) Address: FF16H (TM50), FF1FH (TM51) After reset: 00H R Symbol TM5n (n = 0, 1) In the following situations, the count value is cleared to 00H. <1> Reset signal generation <2> When TCE5n is cleared <3> When TM5n and CR5n match in the mode in which clear & start occurs upon a match of the TM5n and CR5n. Remark 198 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 (2) 8-bit timer compare register 5n (CR5n) CR5n can be read and written by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Except in PWM mode, the value set in CR5n is constantly compared with the 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n) count value, and an interrupt request (INTTM5n) is generated if they match. In PWM mode, when the TO5n pin becomes active due to a TM5n overflow and the values of TM5n and CR5n match, the TO5n pin becomes inactive. The value of CR5n can be set within 00H to FFH. Reset signal generation clears CR5n to 00H. Figure 7-4. Format of 8-Bit Timer Compare Register 5n (CR5n) Address: FF17H (CR50), FF41H (CR51) After reset: 00H R/W Symbol CR5n (n = 0, 1) Cautions 1. In the mode in which clear & start occurs on a match of TM5n and CR5n (TMC5n6 = 0), do not write other values to CR5n during operation. 2. In PWM mode, make the CR5n rewrite period 3 count clocks of the count clock (clock selected by TCL5n) or more. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 199 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.3 Registers Controlling 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 The following four registers are used to control 8-bit timer/event counters 50 and 51. * Timer clock selection register 5n (TCL5n) * 8-bit timer mode control register 5n (TMC5n) * Port mode register 1 (PM1) or port mode register 3 (PM3) * Port register 1 (P1) or port register 3 (P3) (1) Timer clock selection register 5n (TCL5n) This register sets the count clock of 8-bit timer/event counter 5n and the valid edge of the TI5n pin input. TCL5n can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears TCL5n to 00H. Remark n = 0, 1 Figure 7-5. Format of Timer Clock Selection Register 50 (TCL50) Address: FF6AH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TCL50 0 0 0 0 0 TCL502 TCL501 TCL500 TCL502 TCL501 TCL500 Count clock selection fPRS = 4 fPRS = 8 fPRS = 10 fPRS = 20 MHz MHz MHz MHz 0 0 0 TI50 pin falling edge 0 0 1 TI50 pin rising edge 0 1 0 fPRS 0 1 1 fPRS/2 1 0 0 Note 1 Note 2 4 MHz 8 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 2 MHz 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 2 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz 1 0 1 fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 1 1 0 fPRS/2 8 15.62 kHz 31.25 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz fPRS/2 13 0.48 kHz 0.97 kHz 1.22 kHz 2.44 kHz 1 1 1 Notes 1. In the on-board mode, the FLMD0 pin falling edge is selected. 2. In the on-board mode, the FLMD0 pin rising edge is selected. Cautions 1. When rewriting TCL50 to other data, stop the timer operation beforehand. 2. Be sure to set bits 3 to 7 to 0. Remark 200 fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 Figure 7-6. Format of Timer Clock Selection Register 51 (TCL51) Address: FF8CH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TCL51 0 0 0 0 0 TCL512 TCL511 TCL510 TCL512 TCL511 TCL510 Count clock selection fPRS = 4 fPRS = 8 fPRS = 10 fPRS = 20 MHz MHz MHz MHz 0 0 0 TI51 pin falling edge 0 0 1 TI51 pin rising edge 0 1 0 fPRS 0 1 1 fPRS/2 1 0 0 fPRS/2 4 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 4 MHz 8 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 2 MHz 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 500 kHz 1 MHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz fPRS/2 8 15.62 kHz 31.25 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz fPRS/2 12 0.97 kHz 1.95 kHz 2.44 kHz 4.88 kHz Cautions 1. When rewriting TCL51 to other data, stop the timer operation beforehand. 2. Be sure to set bits 3 to 7 to 0. Remark fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 201 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 (2) 8-bit timer mode control register 5n (TMC5n) TMC5n is a register that performs the following five types of settings. <1> 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n) count operation control <2> 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n) operating mode selection <3> Timer output F/F (flip flop) status setting <4> Active level selection in timer F/F control or PWM (free-running) mode. <5> Timer output control TMC5n can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Remark n = 0, 1 Figure 7-7. Format of 8-Bit Timer Mode Control Register 50 (TMC50) Address: FF6BH After reset: 00H R/W Note Symbol <7> 6 5 4 <3> <2> 1 <0> TMC50 TCE50 TMC506 0 0 LVS50 LVR50 TMC501 TOE50 TCE50 TM50 count operation control 0 After clearing to 0, count operation disabled (counter stopped) 1 Count operation start TMC506 TM50 operating mode selection 0 Mode in which clear & start occurs on a match between TM50 and CR50 1 PWM (free-running) mode LVS50 LVR50 0 0 No change 0 1 Timer output F/F reset (0) 1 0 Timer output F/F set (1) 1 1 Setting prohibited TMC501 Timer output F/F status setting In other modes (TMC506 = 0) In PWM mode (TMC506 = 1) Timer F/F control Active level selection 0 Inversion operation disabled Active-high 1 Inversion operation enabled Active-low TOE50 Timer output control 0 Output disabled (TM50 output is low level) 1 Output enabled Note Bits 2 and 3 are write-only. (Refer to Cautions and Remarks on the next page.) 202 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 Figure 7-8. Format of 8-Bit Timer Mode Control Register 51 (TMC51) Address: FF43H After reset: 00H R/W Note Symbol <7> 6 5 4 <3> <2> 1 <0> TMC51 TCE51 TMC516 0 0 LVS51 LVR51 TMC511 TOE51 TCE51 TM51 count operation control 0 After clearing to 0, count operation disabled (counter stopped) 1 Count operation start TMC516 TM51 operating mode selection 0 Mode in which clear & start occurs on a match between TM51 and CR51 1 PWM (free-running) mode LVS51 LVR51 0 0 No change 0 1 Timer output F/F reset (0) 1 0 Timer output F/F set (1) 1 1 Setting prohibited TMC511 Timer output F/F status setting In other modes (TMC516 = 0) In PWM mode (TMC516 = 1) Timer F/F control Active level selection 0 Inversion operation disabled Active-high 1 Inversion operation enabled Active-low TOE51 Timer output control 0 Output disabled (TM51 output is low level) 1 Output enabled Note Bits 2 and 3 are write-only. Cautions 1. The settings of LVS5n and LVR5n are valid in other than PWM mode. 2. Perform <1> to <4> below in the following order, not at the same time. <1> Set TMC5n1, TMC5n6: Operation mode setting <2> Set TOE5n to enable output: Timer output enable <3> Set LVS5n, LVR5n (see Caution 1): Timer F/F setting <4> Set TCE5n 3. Stop operation before rewriting TMC5n6. Remarks 1. In PWM mode, PWM output is made inactive by clearing TCE5n to 0. 2. If LVS5n and LVR5n are read, the value is 0. 3. The values of the TMC5n6, LVS5n, LVR5n, TMC5n1, and TOE5n bits are reflected at the TO5n pin regardless of the value of TCE5n. 4. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 203 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 (3) Port mode registers 1 and 3 (PM1, PM3) These registers set port 1 and 3 input/output in 1-bit units. When using the P17/TO50/TI50 and P33/TO51/TI51/INTP4 pins for timer output, clear PM17 and PM33 and the output latches of P17 and P33 to 0. When using the P17/TO50/TI50 and P33/TO51/TI51/INTP4 pins for timer input, set PM17 and PM33 to 1. The output latches of P17 and P33 at this time may be 0 or 1. PM1 and PM3 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets these registers to FFH. Figure 7-9. Format of Port Mode Register 1 (PM1) Address: FF21H Symbol PM1 After reset: FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM17 PM16 PM15 PM14 PM13 PM12 PM11 PM10 PM1n P1n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 7) 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) Figure 7-10. Format of Port Mode Register 3 (PM3) Address: FF23H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM3 1 1 1 1 PM33 PM32 PM31 PM30 PM3n 204 After reset: FFH P3n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 3) 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.4 Operations of 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 7.4.1 Operation as interval timer 8-bit timer/event counter 5n operates as an interval timer that generates interrupt requests repeatedly at intervals of the count value preset to 8-bit timer compare register 5n (CR5n). When the count value of 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n) matches the value set to CR5n, counting continues with the TM5n value cleared to 0 and an interrupt request signal (INTTM5n) is generated. The count clock of TM5n can be selected with bits 0 to 2 (TCL5n0 to TCL5n2) of timer clock selection register 5n (TCL5n). Setting <1> Set the registers. * TCL5n: Select the count clock. * CR5n: Compare value * TMC5n: Stop the count operation, select the mode in which clear & start occurs on a match of TM5n and CR5n. (TMC5n = 0000xxx0B x = Don't care) <2> After TCE5n = 1 is set, the count operation starts. <3> If the values of TM5n and CR5n match, INTTM5n is generated (TM5n is cleared to 00H). <4> INTTM5n is generated repeatedly at the same interval. Set TCE5n to 0 to stop the count operation. Caution Do not write other values to CR5n during operation. Figure 7-11. Interval Timer Operation Timing (1/2) (a) Basic operation t Count clock TM5n count value 00H 01H Count start CR5n N N 00H 01H Clear N 00H 01H N Clear N N N TCE5n INTTM5n Interrupt acknowledged Interval time Remark Interrupt acknowledged Interval time Interval time = (N + 1) x t N = 00H to FFH n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 205 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 Figure 7-11. Interval Timer Operation Timing (2/2) (b) When CR5n = 00H t Count clock TM5n 00H 00H 00H CR5n 00H 00H TCE5n INTTM5n Interval time (c) When CR5n = FFH t Count clock TM5n CR5n 01 FF FE FF 00 FE FF FF 00 FF TCE5n INTTM5n Interrupt acknowledged Interval time Remark 206 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Interrupt acknowledged CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.4.2 Operation as external event counter The external event counter counts the number of external clock pulses to be input to the TI5n pin by 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n). TM5n is incremented each time the valid edge specified by timer clock selection register 5n (TCL5n) is input. Either the rising or falling edge can be selected. When the TM5n count value matches the value of 8-bit timer compare register 5n (CR5n), TM5n is cleared to 0 and an interrupt request signal (INTTM5n) is generated. Whenever the TM5n value matches the value of CR5n, INTTM5n is generated. Setting <1> Set each register. * Set the port mode register (PM17 or PM33)Note to 1. * TCL5n: Select TI5n pin input edge. TI5n pin falling edge TCL5n = 00H TI5n pin rising edge TCL5n = 01H * CR5n: Compare value * TMC5n: Stop the count operation, select the mode in which clear & start occurs on match of TM5n and CR5n, disable the timer F/F inversion operation, disable timer output. (TMC5n = 0000xx00B x = Don't care) <2> When TCE5n = 1 is set, the number of pulses input from the TI5n pin is counted. <3> When the values of TM5n and CR5n match, INTTM5n is generated (TM5n is cleared to 00H). <4> After these settings, INTTM5n is generated each time the values of TM5n and CR5n match. Note 8-bit timer/event counter 50: PM17 8-bit timer/event counter 51: PM33 Figure 7-12. External Event Counter Operation Timing (with Rising Edge Specified) TI5n Count start TM5n count value 00 01 02 03 04 05 CR5n N-1 N 00 01 02 03 N INTTM5n Remark N = 00H to FFH n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 207 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.4.3 Square-wave output operation A square wave with any selected frequency is output at intervals determined by the value preset to 8-bit timer compare register 5n (CR5n). The TO5n pin output status is inverted at intervals determined by the count value preset to CR5n by setting bit 0 (TOE5n) of 8-bit timer mode control register 5n (TMC5n) to 1. This enables a square wave with any selected frequency to be output (duty = 50%). Setting <1> Set each register. * Clear the port output latch (P17 or P33)Note and port mode register (PM17 or PM33)Note to 0. * TCL5n: Select the count clock. * CR5n: Compare value * TMC5n: Stop the count operation, select the mode in which clear & start occurs on a match of TM5n and CR5n. LVS5n LVR5n Timer Output F/F Status Setting 1 0 High-level output 0 1 Low-level output Timer output F/F inversion enabled Timer output enabled (TMC5n = 00001011B or 00000111B) <2> After TCE5n = 1 is set, the count operation starts. <3> The timer output F/F is inverted by a match of TM5n and CR5n. After INTTM5n is generated, TM5n is cleared to 00H. <4> After these settings, the timer output F/F is inverted at the same interval and a square wave is output from TO5n. The frequency is as follows. Frequency = 1/2t (N + 1) (N: 00H to FFH) Note 8-bit timer/event counter 50: P17, PM17 8-bit timer/event counter 51: P33, PM33 Caution Do not write other values to CR5n during operation. Remark n = 0, 1 208 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 Figure 7-13. Square-Wave Output Operation Timing t Count clock TM5n count value 00H 01H 02H N-1 N 00H 01H 02H N-1 N 00H Count start CR5n N TO5nNote Note The initial value of TO5n output can be set by bits 2 and 3 (LVR5n, LVS5n) of 8-bit timer mode control register 5n (TMC5n). 7.4.4 PWM output operation 8-bit timer/event counter 5n operates as a PWM output when bit 6 (TMC5n6) of 8-bit timer mode control register 5n (TMC5n) is set to 1. The duty pulse determined by the value set to 8-bit timer compare register 5n (CR5n) is output from TO5n. Set the active level width of the PWM pulse to CR5n; the active level can be selected with bit 1 (TMC5n1) of TMC5n. The count clock can be selected with bits 0 to 2 (TCL5n0 to TCL5n2) of timer clock selection register 5n (TCL5n). PWM output can be enabled/disabled with bit 0 (TOE5n) of TMC5n. Caution In PWM mode, make the CR5n rewrite period 3 count clocks of the count clock (clock selected by TCL5n) or more. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 209 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 (1) PWM output basic operation Setting <1> Set each register. * Clear the port output latch (P17 or P33)Note and port mode register (PM17 or PM33)Note to 0. * TCL5n: Select the count clock. * CR5n: Compare value * TMC5n: Stop the count operation, select PWM mode. The timer output F/F is not changed. TMC5n1 Active Level Selection 0 Active-high 1 Active-low Timer output enabled (TMC5n = 01000001B or 01000011B) <2> The count operation starts when TCE5n = 1. Clear TCE5n to 0 to stop the count operation. Note 8-bit timer/event counter 50: P17, PM17 8-bit timer/event counter 51: P33, PM33 PWM output operation <1> PWM output (output from TO5n) outputs an inactive level until an overflow occurs. <2> When an overflow occurs, the active level is output. The active level is output until CR5n matches the count value of 8-bit timer counter 5n (TM5n). <3> After the CR5n matches the count value, the inactive level is output until an overflow occurs again. <4> Operations <2> and <3> are repeated until the count operation stops. <5> When the count operation is stopped with TCE5n = 0, PWM output becomes inactive. For details of timing, see Figures 7-14 and 7-15. The cycle, active-level width, and duty are as follows. * Cycle = 28t * Active-level width = Nt * Duty = N/28 (N = 00H to FFH) Remark 210 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 Figure 7-14. PWM Output Operation Timing (a) Basic operation (active level = H) t Count clock TM5n 00H 01H CR5n N FFH 00H 01H 02H N N+1 FFH 00H 01H 02H M 00H TCE5n INTTM5n TO5n <1> <5> <2> Active level <3> Inactive level Active level (b) CR5n = 00H t Count clock TM5n 00H 01H CR5n 00H FFH 00H 01H 02H N N+1 N+2 FFH 00H 01H 02H M 00H TCE5n INTTM5n TO5n L Inactive level Inactive level (c) CR5n = FFH t TM5n 00H 01H CR5n FFH FFH 00H 01H 02H N N+1 N+2 FFH 00H 01H 02H M 00H TCE5n INTTM5n TO5n Inactive level Active level Active level Inactive level Inactive level Remarks 1. <1> to <3> and <5> in Figure 7-14 (a) correspond to <1> to <3> and <5> in PWM output operation in 7. 4. 4 (1) PWM output basic operation. 2. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 211 CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 (2) Operation with CR5n changed Figure 7-15. Timing of Operation with CR5n Changed (a) CR5n value is changed from N to M before clock rising edge of FFH Value is transferred to CR5n at overflow immediately after change. t Count clock TM5n N N+1 N+2 CR5n N TCE5n INTTM5n FFH 00H 01H 02H M M+1 M+2 FFH 00H 01H 02H M M+1 M+2 M H TO5n <2> <1> CR5n change (N M) (b) CR5n value is changed from N to M after clock rising edge of FFH Value is transferred to CR5n at second overflow. t Count clock TM5n N N+1 N+2 CR5n TCE5n INTTM5n N FFH 00H 01H 02H N N+1 N+2 FFH 00H 01H 02H N M M+1 M+2 M H TO5n <1> CR5n change (N M) <2> Caution When reading from CR5n between <1> and <2> in Figure 7-15, the value read differs from the actual value (read value: M, actual value of CR5n: N). 212 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 7 8-BIT TIMER/EVENT COUNTERS 50 AND 51 7.5 Cautions for 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51 (1) Timer start error An error of up to one clock may occur in the time required for a match signal to be generated after timer start. This is because 8-bit timer counters 50 and 51 (TM50, TM51) are started asynchronously to the count clock. Figure 7-16. 8-Bit Timer Counter 5n Start Timing Count clock TM5n count value 00H 01H 02H 03H 04H Timer start Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 213 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 8.1 Functions of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 8-bit timers H0 and H1 have the following functions. * Interval timer * PWM output mode * Square-wave output * Carrier generator mode (8-bit timer H1 only) 8.2 Configuration of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 8-bit timers H0 and H1 include the following hardware. Table 8-1. Configuration of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 Item Configuration Timer register 8-bit timer counter Hn Registers 8-bit timer H compare register 0n (CMP0n) Timer output TOHn Control registers 8-bit timer H mode register n (TMHMDn) 8-bit timer H compare register 1n (CMP1n) 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 (TMCYC1) Port mode register 1 (PM1) Port register 1 (P1) Note 8-bit timer H1 only Remark n = 0, 1 Figures 8-1 and 8-2 show the block diagrams. 214 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Note Figure 8-1. Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer H0 Internal bus 8-bit timer H mode register 0 (TMHMD0) TMHE0 CKS02 CKS01 CKS00 TMMD01 TMMD00 TOLEV0 TOEN0 3 8-bit timer H compare register 10 (CMP10) 8-bit timer H compare register 00 (CMP00) 2 Decoder TOH0/P15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD fPRS fPRS/2 fPRS/22 fPRS/26 fPRS/210 8-bit timer/ event counter 50 output Selector Match Interrupt generator F/F R Output controller Level inversion Output latch (P15) 8-bit timer counter H0 Clear PWM mode signal Timer H enable signal 1 0 INTTMH0 PM15 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Selector 215 216 Figure 8-2. Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer H1 Internal bus 8-bit timer H mode register 1 (TMHMD1) TMHE1 CKS12 CKS11 CKS10 TMMD11 TMMD10 TOLEV1 TOEN1 3 8-bit timer H compare register 0 1 (CMP01) 8-bit timer H compare register 1 1 (CMP11) 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 RMC1 NRZB1 NRZ1 (TMCYC1) INTTM51 Reload/ interrupt control 2 TOH1/ INTP5/ P16 Decoder fPRS fPRS/22 fPRS/24 fPRS/26 fPRS/212 fRL fRL/27 fRL/29 Selector User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Match Interrupt generator F/F R Output controller Level inversion Output latch (P16) 8-bit timer counter H1 Carrier generator mode signal Clear PWM mode signal Timer H enable signal 1 0 INTTMH1 PM16 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Selector CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 (1) 8-bit timer H compare register 0n (CMP0n) This register can be read or written by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. This register is used in all of the timer operation modes. This register constantly compares the value set to CMP0n with the count value of the 8-bit timer counter Hn and, when the two values match, generates an interrupt request signal (INTTMHn) and inverts the output level of TOHn. Rewrite the value of CMP0n while the timer is stopped (TMHEn = 0). A reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 8-3. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Compare Register 0n (CMP0n) Address: FF02H (CMP00), FF1AH (CMP01) Symbol CMP0n (n = 0, 1) 7 5 6 After reset: 00H 3 4 R/W 2 1 0 Caution CMP0n cannot be rewritten during timer count operation. CMP0n can be refreshed (the same value is written) during timer count operation. (2) 8-bit timer H compare register 1n (CMP1n) This register can be read or written by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. This register is used in the PWM output mode and carrier generator mode. In the PWM output mode, this register constantly compares the value set to CMP1n with the count value of the 8bit timer counter Hn and, when the two values match, inverts the output level of TOHn. No interrupt request signal is generated. In the carrier generator mode, the CMP1n register always compares the value set to CMP1n with the count value of the 8-bit timer counter Hn and, when the two values match, generates an interrupt request signal (INTTMHn). At the same time, the count value is cleared. CMP1n can be refreshed (the same value is written) and rewritten during timer count operation. If the value of CMP1n is rewritten while the timer is operating, the new value is latched and transferred to CMP1n when the count value of the timer matches the old value of CMP1n, and then the value of CMP1n is changed to the new value. If matching of the count value and the CMP1n value and writing a value to CMP1n conflict, the value of CMP1n is not changed. A reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 8-4. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Compare Register 1n (CMP1n) Address: FF0EH (CMP10), FF1BH (CMP11) Symbol CMP1n (n = 0, 1) 7 6 5 After reset: 00H 4 3 R/W 2 1 0 Caution In the PWM output mode and carrier generator mode, be sure to set CMP1n when starting the timer count operation (TMHEn = 1) after the timer count operation was stopped (TMHEn = 0) (be sure to set again even if setting the same value to CMP1n). Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 217 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 8.3 Registers Controlling 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 The following four registers are used to control 8-bit timers H0 and H1. * 8-bit timer H mode register n (TMHMDn) * 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 (TMCYC1)Note * Port mode register 1 (PM1) * Port register 1 (P1) Note 8-bit timer H1 only (1) 8-bit timer H mode register n (TMHMDn) This register controls the mode of timer H. This register can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Remark n = 0, 1 218 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-5. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Mode Register 0 (TMHMD0) Address: FF69H Symbol TMHMD0 After reset: 00H R/W <7> 6 5 4 3 2 <1> <0> TMHE0 CKS02 CKS01 CKS00 TMMD01 TMMD00 TOLEV0 TOEN0 TMHE0 Timer operation enable 0 Stops timer count operation (Counter is cleared to 0) 1 Enables timer count operation (Count operation started by inputting clock) CKS02 CKS01 CKS00 Count clock selection fPRS = 4 fPRS = 8 fPRS = 10 fPRS = 20 MHz MHz MHz MHz 0 0 0 fPRS 4 MHz 8 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 0 0 1 fPRS/2 2 MHz 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 2 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz fPRS/2 10 3.90 kHz 7.81 kHz 9.77 kHz 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 Other than above TM50 output Setting prohibited TMMD01 TMMD00 0 0 Interval timer mode 1 0 PWM output mode Other than above 19.54 kHz Note Timer operation mode Setting prohibited TOLEV0 Timer output level control (in default mode) 0 Low level 1 High level TOEN0 Timer output control 0 Disables output 1 Enables output Note When TM50 output as the count clock. * Set to PWM mode (TMC506 = 1) after the following order to bellow. <1>Set the count clock to make the duty = 50%. <2>Start the operation of 8-bit timer/event counter 50. * Set to Mode in which the count clock is cleared and started upon a match of TM50 and CR50 (TMC506 = 0) after the following order to bellow. <1>Enable the timer F/F inversion operation (TMC501 = 1). <2>Start the operation of 8-bit timer/event counter 50. It is not necessary to enable the TO50 pin as a timer output pin in any mode. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 219 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Cautions 1. When TMHE0 = 1, setting the other bits of TMHMD0 is prohibited. However, TMHMD0 can be refreshed (the same value is written). 2. In the PWM output mode, be sure to set 8-bit timer H compare register 10 (CMP10) when starting the timer count operation (TMHE0 = 1) after the timer count operation was stopped (TMHE0 = 0) (be sure to set again even if setting the same value to CMP10). Remarks 1. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 2. TMC506: Bit 6 of 8-bit timer mode control register 50 (TMC50) TMC501: Bit 1 of TMC50 Figure 8-6. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Mode Register 1 (TMHMD1) Address: FFFAH Symbol TMHMD1 After reset: 00H R/W <7> 6 5 4 3 2 <1> <0> TMHE1 CKS12 CKS11 CKS10 TMMD11 TMMD10 TOLEV1 TOEN1 TMHE1 Timer operation enable 0 Stops timer count operation (Counter is cleared to 0) 1 Enables timer count operation (Count operation started by inputting clock) CKS12 0 0 0 0 1 1 CKS11 CKS10 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 fPRS fPRS = 8 fPRS = 10 fPRS = 20 MHz MHz MHz MHz 4 MHz 8 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 2 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz fPRS/2 4 500 kHz 1 MHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz fPRS/2 12 0.97 kHz 1.95 kHz 2.44 kHz fRL/2 7 1.88 kHz (TYP.) 9 0.47 kHz (TYP.) 1 1 0 fRL/2 1 1 1 fRL TMMD11 TMMD10 0 0 Interval timer mode 0 1 Carrier generator mode 1 0 PWM output mode 1 1 Setting prohibited 240 kHz (TYP.) Timer operation mode TOLEV1 Timer output level control (in default mode) 0 Low level 1 High level TOEN1 220 Count clock selection fPRS = 4 Timer output control 0 Disables output 1 Enables output User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 4.88 kHz CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Cautions 1. When TMHE1 = 1, setting the other bits of TMHMD1 is prohibited. However, TMHMD1 can be refreshed (the same value is written). 2. In the PWM output mode and carrier generator mode, be sure to set 8-bit timer H compare register 11 (CMP11) when starting the timer count operation (TMHE1 = 1) after the timer count operation was stopped (TMHE1 = 0) (be sure to set again even if setting the same value to CMP11). 3. When the carrier generator mode is used, set so that the count clock frequency of TMH1 becomes more than 6 times the count clock frequency of TM51. Remarks 1. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 2. fRL: Internal low-speed oscillation clock frequency (2) 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 (TMCYC1) This register controls the remote control output and carrier pulse output status of 8-bit timer H1. This register can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 8-7. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Carrier Control Register 1 (TMCYC1) Address: FFEEH After reset: 00H R/WNote <0> TMCYC1 0 0 RMC1 NRZB1 0 0 Low-level output 0 1 High-level output at rising edge of INTTM51 signal input 1 0 Low-level output 1 1 Carrier pulse output at rising edge of INTTM51 signal input NRZ1 0 0 0 RMC1 NRZB1 NRZ1 Remote control output Carrier pulse output status flag 0 Carrier output disabled status (low-level status) 1 Carrier output enabled status (RMC1 = 1: Carrier pulse output, RMC1 = 0: High-level status) Note Bit 0 is read-only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 221 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 (3) Port mode register 1 (PM1) This register sets port 1 input/output in 1-bit units. When using the P15/TOH0 and P16/TOH1/INTP5 pins for timer output, clear PM15 and PM16 and the output latches of P15 and P16 to 0. PM1 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. Figure 8-8. Format of Port Mode Register 1 (PM1) Address: FF21H Symbol PM1 R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM17 PM16 PM15 PM14 PM13 PM12 PM11 PM10 PM1n 222 After reset: FFH P1n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 7) 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 8.4 Operation of 8-Bit Timers H0 and H1 8.4.1 Operation as interval timer/square-wave output When 8-bit timer counter Hn and compare register 0n (CMP0n) match, an interrupt request signal (INTTMHn) is generated and 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared to 00H. Compare register 1n (CMP1n) is not used in interval timer mode. Since a match of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP1n register is not detected even if the CMP1n register is set, timer output is not affected. By setting bit 0 (TOENn) of timer H mode register n (TMHMDn) to 1, a square wave of any frequency (duty = 50%) is output from TOHn. (1) Usage Generates the INTTMHn signal repeatedly at the same interval. <1> Set each register. Figure 8-9. Register Setting During Interval Timer/Square-Wave Output Operation (i) TMHMDn Setting timer H mode register n (TMHMDn) TMHEn CKSn2 CKSn1 CKSn0 0 0/1 0/1 0/1 TMMDn1 TMMDn0 TOLEVn 0 0 0/1 TOENn 0/1 Timer output setting Timer output level inversion setting Interval timer mode setting Count clock (fCNT) selection Count operation stopped (ii) CMP0n register setting * Compare value (N) <2> Count operation starts when TMHEn = 1. <3> When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP0n register match, the INTTMHn signal is generated and 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared to 00H. Interval time = (N +1)/fCNT <4> Subsequently, the INTTMHn signal is generated at the same interval. To stop the count operation, clear TMHEn to 0. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 223 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 (2) Timing chart The timing of the interval timer/square-wave output operation is shown below. Figure 8-10. Timing of Interval Timer/Square-Wave Output Operation (1/2) (a) Basic operation Count clock Count start 00H 8-bit timer counter Hn 01H N 00H 01H N Clear 00H 01H 00H Clear N CMP0n TMHEn INTTMHn Interval time TOHn <2> Level inversion, match interrupt occurrence, 8-bit timer counter Hn clear <1> <3> <2> Level inversion, match interrupt occurrence, 8-bit timer counter Hn clear <1> The count operation is enabled by setting the TMHEn bit to 1. The count clock starts counting no more than 1 clock after the operation is enabled. <2> When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP0n register match, the value of 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared, the TOHn output level is inverted, and the INTTMHn signal is output. <3> The INTTMHn signal and TOHn output become inactive by clearing the TMHEn bit to 0 during timer Hn operation. If these are inactive from the first, the level is retained. Remark n = 0, 1 N = 01H to FEH 224 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-10. Timing of Interval Timer/Square-Wave Output Operation (2/2) (b) Operation when CMP0n = FFH Count clock Count start 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H 01H FEH FFH 00H FEH Clear FFH 00H Clear FFH CMP0n TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn Interval time (c) Operation when CMP0n = 00H Count clock Count start 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H CMP0n 00H TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn Interval time Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 225 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 8.4.2 Operation as PWM output mode In PWM output mode, a pulse with an arbitrary duty and arbitrary cycle can be output. 8-bit timer compare register 0n (CMP0n) controls the cycle of timer output (TOHn). Rewriting the CMP0n register during timer operation is prohibited. 8-bit timer compare register 1n (CMP1n) controls the duty of timer output (TOHn). Rewriting the CMP1n register during timer operation is possible. The operation in PWM output mode is as follows. TOHn output becomes active and 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared to 0 when 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP0n register match after the timer count is started. TOHn output becomes inactive when 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP1n register match. (1) Usage In PWM output mode, a pulse for which an arbitrary duty and arbitrary cycle can be set is output. <1> Set each register. Figure 8-11. Register Setting in PWM Output Mode (i) TMHMDn Setting timer H mode register n (TMHMDn) TMHEn CKSn2 CKSn1 CKSn0 0 0/1 0/1 0/1 TMMDn1 TMMDn0 TOLEVn 1 0 0/1 TOENn 1 Timer output enabled Timer output level inversion setting PWM output mode selection Count clock (fCNT) selection Count operation stopped (ii) Setting CMP0n register * Compare value (N): Cycle setting (iii) Setting CMP1n register * Compare value (M): Duty setting Remarks 1. n = 0, 1 2. 00H CMP1n (M) < CMP0n (N) FFH 226 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 <2> The count operation starts when TMHEn = 1. <3> The CMP0n register is the compare register that is to be compared first after counter operation is enabled. When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP0n register match, 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared, an interrupt request signal (INTTMHn) is generated, and TOHn output becomes active. At the same time, the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter Hn is changed from the CMP0n register to the CMP1n register. <4> When 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP1n register match, TOHn output becomes inactive and the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter Hn is changed from the CMP1n register to the CMP0n register. At this time, 8-bit timer counter Hn is not cleared and the INTTMHn signal is not generated. <5> By performing procedures <3> and <4> repeatedly, a pulse with an arbitrary duty can be obtained. <6> To stop the count operation, set TMHEn = 0. If the setting value of the CMP0n register is N, the setting value of the CMP1n register is M, and the count clock frequency is fCNT, the PWM pulse output cycle and duty are as follows. PWM pulse output cycle = (N + 1)/fCNT Duty = Active width : Total width of PWM = (M + 1) : (N + 1) Cautions 1. In PWM output mode, three operation clocks (signal selected using the CKSn2 to CKSn0 bits of the TMHMDn register) are required to transfer the CMP1n register value after rewriting the register. 2. Be sure to set the CMP1n register when starting the timer count operation (TMHEn = 1) after the timer count operation was stopped (TMHEn = 0) (be sure to set again even if setting the same value to the CMP1n register). Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 227 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 (2) Timing chart The operation timing in PWM output mode is shown below. Caution Make sure that the CMP1n register setting value (M) and CMP0n register setting value (N) are within the following range. 00H CMP1n (M) < CMP0n (N) FFH Figure 8-12. Operation Timing in PWM Output Mode (1/4) (a) Basic operation Count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H 01H A5H 00H 01H 02H CMP0n A5H CMP1n 01H A5H 00H 01H 02H A5H 00H TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn (TOLEVn = 0) <1> <2> <3> <4> TOHn (TOLEVn = 1) <1> The count operation is enabled by setting the TMHEn bit to 1. Start 8-bit timer counter Hn by masking one count clock to count up. At this time, TOHn output remains inactive (when TOLEVn = 0). <2> When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP0n register match, the TOHn output level is inverted, the value of 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared, and the INTTMHn signal is output. <3> When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP1n register match, the level of the TOHn output is returned. At this time, the 8-bit timer counter value is not cleared and the INTTMHn signal is not output. <4> Clearing the TMHEn bit to 0 during timer Hn operation makes the INTTMHn signal and TOHn output inactive. Remark n = 0, 1 228 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-12. Operation Timing in PWM Output Mode (2/4) (b) Operation when CMP0n = FFH, CMP1n = 00H Count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H 01H FFH 00H 01H 02H FFH 00H 01H 02H CMP0n FFH CMP1n 00H FFH 00H TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn (TOLEVn = 0) (c) Operation when CMP0n = FFH, CMP1n = FEH Count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H 01H FEH FFH 00H 01H FEH FFH 00H 01H CMP0n FFH CMP1n FEH FEH FFH 00H TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn (TOLEVn = 0) Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 229 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-12. Operation Timing in PWM Output Mode (3/4) (d) Operation when CMP0n = 01H, CMP1n = 00H Count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H 01H 00H 01H 00H 00H 01H 00H 01H CMP0n 01H CMP1n 00H TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn (TOLEVn = 0) Remark 230 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-12. Operation Timing in PWM Output Mode (4/4) (e) Operation by changing CMP1n (CMP1n = 01H 03H, CMP0n = A5H) Count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn 00H 01H 02H A5H 00H 01H 02H 03H A5H 00H 01H 02H 03H A5H 00H A5H CMP0n 01H CMP1n 01H (03H) <2> 03H <2>' TMHEn INTTMHn TOHn (TOLEVn = 0) <1> <3> <4> <5> <6> <1> The count operation is enabled by setting TMHEn = 1. Start 8-bit timer counter Hn by masking one count clock to count up. At this time, the TOHn output remains inactive (when TOLEVn = 0). <2> The CMP1n register value can be changed during timer counter operation. This operation is asynchronous to the count clock. <3> When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP0n register match, the value of 8-bit timer counter Hn is cleared, the TOHn output becomes active, and the INTTMHn signal is output. <4> If the CMP1n register value is changed, the value is latched and not transferred to the register. When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP1n register before the change match, the value is transferred to the CMP1n register and the CMP1n register value is changed (<2>'). However, three count clocks or more are required from when the CMP1n register value is changed to when the value is transferred to the register. If a match signal is generated within three count clocks, the changed value cannot be transferred to the register. <5> When the values of 8-bit timer counter Hn and the CMP1n register after the change match, the TOHn output becomes inactive. 8-bit timer counter Hn is not cleared and the INTTMHn signal is not generated. <6> Clearing the TMHEn bit to 0 during timer Hn operation makes the INTTMHn signal and TOHn output inactive. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 231 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 8.4.3 Carrier generator mode operation (8-bit timer H1 only) The carrier clock generated by 8-bit timer H1 is output in the cycle set by 8-bit timer/event counter 51. In carrier generator mode, the output of the 8-bit timer H1 carrier pulse is controlled by 8-bit timer/event counter 51, and the carrier pulse is output from the TOH1 output. (1) Carrier generation In carrier generator mode, 8-bit timer H compare register 01 (CMP01) generates a low-level width carrier pulse waveform and 8-bit timer H compare register 11 (CMP11) generates a high-level width carrier pulse waveform. Rewriting the CMP11 register during 8-bit timer H1 operation is possible but rewriting the CMP01 register is prohibited. (2) Carrier output control Carrier output is controlled by the interrupt request signal (INTTM51) of 8-bit timer/event counter 51 and the NRZB1 and RMC1 bits of the 8-bit timer H carrier control register (TMCYC1). The relationship between the outputs is shown below. 232 RMC1 Bit NRZB1 Bit 0 0 Output Low-level output 0 1 High-level output 1 0 Low-level output 1 1 Carrier pulse output User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 To control the carrier pulse output during a count operation, the NRZ1 and NRZB1 bits of the TMCYC1 register have a master and slave bit configuration. The NRZ1 bit is read-only but the NRZB1 bit can be read and written. The INTTM51 signal is synchronized with the 8-bit timer H1 count clock and output as the INTTM5H1 signal. The INTTM5H1 signal becomes the data transfer signal of the NRZ1 bit, and the NRZB1 bit value is transferred to the NRZ1 bit. The timing for transfer from the NRZB1 bit to the NRZ1 bit is as shown below. Figure 8-13. Transfer Timing TMHE1 8-bit timer H1 count clock INTTM51 INTTM5H1 <1> NRZ1 0 1 0 <2> NRZB1 1 0 1 RMC1 <1> The INTTM51 signal is synchronized with the count clock of 8-bit timer H1 and is output as the INTTM5H1 signal. <2> The value of the NRZB1 bit is transferred to the NRZ1 bit at the second clock from the rising edge of the INTTM5H1 signal. Cautions 1. Do not rewrite the NRZB1 bit again until at least the second clock after it has been rewritten, or else the transfer from the NRZB1 bit to the NRZ1 bit is not guaranteed. 2. When 8-bit timer/event counter 51 is used in the carrier generator mode, an interrupt is generated at the timing of <1>. When 8-bit timer/event counter 51 is used in a mode other than the carrier generator mode, the timing of the interrupt generation differs. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 233 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 (3) Usage Outputs an arbitrary carrier clock from the TOH1 pin. <1> Set each register. Figure 8-14. Register Setting in Carrier Generator Mode (i) TMHMD1 Setting 8-bit timer H mode register 1 (TMHMD1) TMHE1 CKS12 CKS11 CKS10 0 0/1 0/1 0/1 TMMD11 TMMD10 TOLEV1 0 1 0/1 TOEN1 1 Timer output enabled Timer output level inversion setting Carrier generator mode selection Count clock (fCNT) selection Count operation stopped (ii) CMP01 register setting * Compare value (iii) CMP11 register setting * Compare value (iv) TMCYC1 register setting * RMC1 = 1 ... Remote control output enable bit * NRZB1 = 0/1 ... carrier output enable bit (v) TCL51 and TMC51 register setting * See 7.3 Registers Controlling 8-Bit Timer/Event Counters 50 and 51. <2> When TMHE1 = 1, 8-bit timer H1 starts counting. <3> When TCE51 of 8-bit timer mode control register 51 (TMC51) is set to 1, 8-bit timer/event counter 51 starts counting. <4> After the count operation is enabled, the first compare register to be compared is the CMP01 register. When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 and the CMP01 register value match, the INTTMH1 signal is generated, 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared, and at the same time, the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter H1 is switched from the CMP01 register to the CMP11 register. <5> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 and the CMP11 register value match, the INTTMH1 signal is generated, 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared, and at the same time, the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter H1 is switched from the CMP11 register to the CMP01 register. <6> By performing procedures <4> and <5> repeatedly, a carrier clock is generated. <7> The INTTM51 signal is synchronized with count clock of 8-bit timer H1 and output as the INTTM5H1 signal. The INTTM5H1 signal becomes the data transfer signal for the NRZB1 bit, and the NRZB1 bit value is transferred to the NRZ1 bit. <8> When the NRZ1 bit is high level, a carrier clock is output from the TOH1 pin. <9> By performing the procedures above, an arbitrary carrier clock is obtained. To stop the count operation, clear TMHE1 to 0. 234 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 If the setting value of the CMP01 register is N, the setting value of the CMP11 register is M, and the count clock frequency is fCNT, the carrier clock output cycle and duty are as follows. Carrier clock output cycle = (N + M + 2)/fCNT Duty = High-level width : Carrier clock output width = ( M + 1) : (N + M + 2) Cautions 1. Be sure to set the CMP11 register when starting the timer count operation (TMHE1 = 1) after the timer count operation was stopped (TMHE1 = 0) (be sure to set again even if setting the same value to the CMP11 register). 2. Set so that the count clock frequency of TMH1 becomes more than 6 times the count clock frequency of TM51. (4) Timing chart The carrier output control timing is shown below. Cautions 1. Set the values of the CMP01 and CMP11 registers in a range of 01H to FFH. 2. In the carrier generator mode, three operating clocks (signal selected by CKS12 to CKS10 bits of TMHMD1 register) or more are required from when the CMP11 register value is changed to when the value is transferred to the register. 3. Be sure to set the RMC1 bit before the count operation is started. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 235 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-15. Carrier Generator Mode Operation Timing (1/3) (a) Operation when CMP01 = N, CMP11 = N 8-bit timer Hn count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn count value 00H N 00H N 00H N 00H CMPn0 N CMPn1 N N 00H N 00H N TMHEn INTTMHn <3> <4> <1> <2> Carrier clock 8-bit timer 5n count clock TM5n count value 00H 01H L 00H 01H L 00H 01H L 00H 01H L 00H 01H L CR5n TCE5n <5> INTTM5n INTTM5Hn NRZBn 0 1 0 1 0 <6> NRZn 0 1 0 1 0 Carrier clock TOHn <7> <1> When TMHE1 = 0 and TCE51 = 0, 8-bit timer counter H1 operation is stopped. <2> When TMHE1 = 1 is set, 8-bit timer counter H1 starts a count operation. At that time, the carrier clock is held at the inactive level. <3> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 matches the CMP01 register value, the first INTTMH1 signal is generated, the carrier clock signal is inverted, and the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter H1 is switched from the CMP01 register to the CMP11 register. 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared to 00H. <4> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 matches the CMP11 register value, the INTTMH1 signal is generated, the carrier clock signal is inverted, and the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter H1 is switched from the CMP11 register to the CMP01 register. 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared to 00H. By performing procedures <3> and <4> repeatedly, a carrier clock with duty fixed to 50% is generated. <5> When the INTTM51 signal is generated, it is synchronized with 8-bit timer H1 count clock and output as the INTTM5H1 signal. <6> The INTTM5H1 signal becomes the data transfer signal for the NRZB1 bit, and the NRZB1 bit value is transferred to the NRZ1 bit. <7> When NRZ1 = 0 is set, the TOH1 output becomes low level. 236 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-15. Carrier Generator Mode Operation Timing (2/3) (b) Operation when CMP01 = N, CMP11 = M 8-bit timer Hn count clock 8-bit timer counter Hn count value 00H N 00H 01H M 00H N 00H 01H CMPn0 N CMPn1 M M 00H N 00H TMHEn INTTMHn <3> <4> <1> <2> Carrier clock 8-bit timer 5n count clock TM5n count value 00H 01H L 00H 01H L 00H 01H L 00H 01H L 00H 01H L CR5n TCE5n <5> INTTM5n INTTM5Hn NRZBn NRZn 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 Carrier clock <6> <7> TOHn <1> When TMHE1 = 0 and TCE51 = 0, 8-bit timer counter H1 operation is stopped. <2> When TMHE1 = 1 is set, 8-bit timer counter H1 starts a count operation. At that time, the carrier clock is held at the inactive level. <3> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 matches the CMP01 register value, the first INTTMH1 signal is generated, the carrier clock signal is inverted, and the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter H1 is switched from the CMP01 register to the CMP11 register. 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared to 00H. <4> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 matches the CMP11 register value, the INTTMH1 signal is generated, the carrier clock signal is inverted, and the compare register to be compared with 8-bit timer counter H1 is switched from the CMP11 register to the CMP01 register. 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared to 00H. By performing procedures <3> and <4> repeatedly, a carrier clock with duty fixed to other than 50% is generated. <5> When the INTTM51 signal is generated, it is synchronized with 8-bit timer H1 count clock and output as the INTTM5H1 signal. <6> A carrier signal is output at the first rising edge of the carrier clock if NRZ1 is set to 1. <7> When NRZ1 = 0, the TOH1 output is held at the high level and is not changed to low level while the carrier clock is high level (from <6> and <7>, the high-level width of the carrier clock waveform is guaranteed). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 237 CHAPTER 8 8-BIT TIMERS H0 AND H1 Figure 8-15. Carrier Generator Mode Operation Timing (3/3) (c) Operation when CMP11 is changed 8-bit timer H1 count clock 8-bit timer counter H1 count value 00H 01H N 00H 01H M 00H N 00H 01H L 00H N CMP01 <3> M CMP11 <3>' M (L) L TMHE1 INTTMH1 <2> Carrier clock <4> <5> <1> <1> When TMHE1 = 1 is set, 8-bit timer H1 starts a count operation. At that time, the carrier clock is held at the inactive level. <2> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 matches the CMP01 register value, 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared and the INTTMH1 signal is output. <3> The CMP11 register can be rewritten during 8-bit timer H1 operation, however, the changed value (L) is latched. The CMP11 register is changed when the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 and the CMP11 register value before the change (M) match (<3>'). <4> When the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 and the CMP11 register value before the change (M) match, the INTTMH1 signal is output, the carrier signal is inverted, and 8-bit timer counter H1 is cleared to 00H. <5> The timing at which the count value of 8-bit timer counter H1 and the CMP11 register value match again is indicated by the value after the change (L). 238 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER 9.1 Functions of Watch Timer The watch timer has the following functions. * Watch timer * Interval timer The watch timer and the interval timer can be used simultaneously. Figure 9-1 shows the watch timer block diagram. 7 fPRS/2 11-bit prescaler fW fWX fWX/24 5-bit counter fWX/25 INTWT Clear fW/24 fW/25 fW/26 fW/27 fW/28 fW/210 fW/211 fW/29 Selector fSUB Selector Clear Selector Selector Figure 9-1. Block Diagram of Watch Timer WTM7 WTM6 WTM5 INTWTI WTM4 WTM3 WTM2 WTM1 WTM0 Watch timer operation mode register (WTM) Internal bus Remark fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency fW: Watch timer clock frequency (fPRS/27 or fSUB) fWX: fW or fW/29 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 239 CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER (1) Watch timer When the high-speed system clock or subsystem clock is used, interrupt requests (INTWT) are generated at preset intervals. Table 9-1. Watch Timer Interrupt Time Interrupt Time When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at fSUB = 32.768 kHz fPRS = 4 MHz fPRS = 5 MHz fPRS = 10 MHz fPRS = 20 MHz 488 s 4 2 /fW 0.51 ms 410 s 205 s 102 s 5 977 s 1.03 ms 819 s 410 s 205 s 13 0.25 s 0.26 s 0.210 s 0.105 s 520 s 14 0.5 s 0.53 s 0.419 s 0.210 s 0.105 s 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW Remark fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency fW: Watch timer clock frequency (fPRS/27 or fSUB) (2) Interval timer Interrupt requests (INTWTI) are generated at preset time intervals. Table 9-2. Interval Timer Interval Time Interrupt Time When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at fSUB = 32.768 kHz fPRS = 4 MHz fPRS = 5 MHz fPRS = 10 MHz fPRS = 20 MHz 4 488 s 0.51 ms 410 s 205 s 102 s 5 977 s 1.03 ms 820 s 410 s 205 s 6 1.95 ms 2.05 ms 1.64 ms 820 s 410 s 7 3.91 ms 4.1 ms 3.28 ms 1.64 ms 820 s 8 7.81 ms 8.2 ms 6.55 ms 3.28 ms 1.64 ms 9 15.6 ms 16.4 ms 13.1 ms 6.55 ms 3.28 ms 10 31.3 ms 32.75 ms 26.2 ms 13.1 ms 6.55 ms 11 62.5 ms 65.55 ms 52.4 ms 26.2 ms 13.1 ms 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW Remark fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency fW: Watch timer clock frequency (fPRS/27 or fSUB) 9.2 Configuration of Watch Timer The watch timer includes the following hardware. Table 9-3. Watch Timer Configuration Item 240 Configuration Counter 5 bits x 1 Prescaler 11 bits x 1 Control register Watch timer operation mode register (WTM) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER 9.3 Register Controlling Watch Timer The watch timer is controlled by the watch timer operation mode register (WTM). * Watch timer operation mode register (WTM) This register sets the watch timer count clock, enables/disables operation, prescaler interval time, and 5-bit counter operation control. WTM is set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears WTM to 00H. Figure 9-2. Format of Watch Timer Operation Mode Register (WTM) Address: FF8FH Symbol WTM After reset: 00H R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 <1> <0> WTM7 WTM6 WTM5 WTM4 WTM3 WTM2 WTM1 WTM0 WTM7 Watch timer count clock selection (fW) fSUB = 32.768 kHz 0 fPRS/2 1 fSUB WTM6 - 7 fPRS = 4 MHz 31.25 kHz fPRS = 8 MHz 62.5 kHz fPRS = 20 MHz 78.125 kHz 156.25 kHz - 32.768 kHz WTM5 fPRS = 10 MHz WTM4 Prescaler interval time selection 4 0 0 0 2 /fW 0 0 1 2 /fW 0 1 0 2 /fW 0 1 1 2 /fW 1 0 0 2 /fW 1 0 1 2 /fW 1 1 0 2 /fW 1 1 1 2 /fW WTM3 WTM2 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Interrupt time selection 14 0 0 2 /fW 0 1 2 /fW 1 0 2 /fW 1 1 2 /fW 13 5 4 WTM1 5-bit counter operation control 0 Clear after operation stop 1 Start WTM0 Watch timer operation enable 0 Operation stop (clear both prescaler and 5-bit counter) 1 Operation enable User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 241 CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER Caution Do not change the count clock and interval time (by setting bits 4 to 7 (WTM4 to WTM7) of WTM) during watch timer operation. Remarks 1. fW: Watch timer clock frequency (fPRS/27 or fSUB) 2. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 3. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency 242 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER 9.4 Watch Timer Operations 9.4.1 Watch timer operation The watch timer generates an interrupt request signal (INTWT) at a specific time interval by using the peripheral hardware clock or subsystem clock. When bit 0 (WTM0) and bit 1 (WTM1) of the watch timer operation mode register (WTM) are set to 1, the count operation starts. When these bits are cleared to 0, the 5-bit counter is cleared and the count operation stops. When the interval timer is simultaneously operated, zero-second start can be achieved only for the watch timer by clearing WTM1 to 0. In this case, however, the 11-bit prescaler is not cleared. Therefore, an error up to 29 x 1/fW seconds occurs in the first overflow (INTWT) after zero-second start. The interrupt request is generated at the following time intervals. Table 9-4. Watch Timer Interrupt Time WTM3 WTM2 Interrupt Time When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at When Operated at Selection 0 0 14 2 /fW fPRS = 10 MHz fPRS = 20 MHz (WTM7 = 0) (WTM7 = 0) (WTM7 = 0) 0.53 s 0.419 s 0.210 s 0.105 s 0.25 s 0.26 s 0.210 s 0.105 s 52.5 ms 5 977 s 1.03 ms 819 s 410 s 205 s 4 488 s 0.51 ms 410 s 205 s 102 s 1 2 /fW 0 2 /fW Remarks 1. fW: fPRS = 5 MHz (WTM7 = 0) 0.5 s 1 1 fPRS = 4 MHz (WTM7 = 1) 13 0 1 fSUB = 32.768 kHz 2 /fW 7 Watch timer clock frequency (fPRS/2 or fSUB) 2. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 3. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 243 CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER 9.4.2 Interval timer operation The watch timer operates as interval timer which generates interrupt requests (INTWTI) repeatedly at an interval of the preset count value. The interval time can be selected with bits 4 to 6 (WTM4 to WTM6) of the watch timer operation mode register (WTM). When bit 0 (WTM0) of the WTM is set to 1, the count operation starts. When this bit is set to 0, the count operation stops. Table 9-5. Interval Timer Interval Time WTM6 WTM5 0 WTM4 0 0 2 /fW 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 Remarks 1. fW: 820 s 410 s 205 s 820 s 410 s 3.28 ms 1.64 ms 820 s 8.2 ms 6.55 ms 3.28 ms 1.64 ms 15.6 ms 16.4 ms 13.1 ms 6.55 ms 3.28 ms 31.3 ms 32.75 ms 26.2 ms 13.1 ms 6.55 ms 65.55 ms 52.4 ms 26.2 ms 13.1 ms 7 3.91 ms 4.1 ms 8 7.81 ms 9 10 11 62.5 ms 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW 2 /fW (WTM7 = 0) 1.64 ms 1.03 ms 2 /fW (WTM7 = 0) 102 s 2.05 ms 2 /fW (WTM7 = 0) 205 s 977 s 2 /fW 0 at fPRS = 5 MHz at fPRS = 10 MHz at fPRS = 20 MHz 410 s 0.51 ms 1.95 ms 1 1 1 (WTM7 = 0) 6 0 1 at fPRS = 4 MHz 5 0 1 at fSUB = 32.768 kHz (WTM7 = 1) 488 s 4 0 0 When Operated When Operated When Operated When Operated When Operated Interval Time 7 Watch timer clock frequency (fPRS/2 or fSUB) 2. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 3. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency Figure 9-3. Operation Timing of Watch Timer/Interval Timer 5-bit counter 0H Overflow Start Overflow Count clock Watch timer interrupt INTWT Interrupt time of watch timer (0.5 s) Interrupt time of watch timer (0.5 s) Interval timer interrupt INTWTI Interval time (T) Remark T fW: Watch timer clock frequency Figures in parentheses are for operation with fW = 32.768 kHz (WTM7 = 1, WTM3, WTM2 = 0, 0) 244 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 9 WATCH TIMER 9.5 Cautions for Watch Timer When operation of the watch timer and 5-bit counter is enabled by the watch timer mode control register (WTM) (by setting bits 0 (WTM0) and 1 (WTM1) of WTM to 1), the interval until the first interrupt request (INTWT) is generated after the register is set does not exactly match the specification made with bits 2 and 3 (WTM2, WTM3) of WTM. Subsequently, however, the INTWT signal is generated at the specified intervals. Figure 9-4. Example of Generation of Watch Timer Interrupt Request (INTWT) (When Interrupt Period = 0.5 s) It takes 0.515625 seconds for the first INTWT to be generated (29 x 1/32768 = 0.015625 s longer). INTWT is then generated every 0.5 seconds. WTM0, WTM1 0.515625 s 0.5 s 0.5 s INTWT User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 245 CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER 10.1 Functions of Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer operates on the low-speed internal oscillator clock. The watchdog timer is used to detect an inadvertent program loop. If a program loop is detected, an internal reset signal is generated. Program loop is detected in the following cases. * If the watchdog timer counter overflows * If a 1-bit manipulation instruction is executed on the watchdog timer enable register (WDTE) * If data other than "ACH" is written to WDTE * If data is written to WDTE during a window close period * If the instruction is fetched from an area not set by the IMS and IXS registers (detection of an invalid check while the CPU hangs up) * If the CPU accesses an area that is not set by the IMS and IXS registers (excluding FB00H to FFFFH) by executing a read/write instruction (detection of an abnormal access during a CPU program loop) When a reset occurs due to the watchdog timer, bit 4 (WDTRF) of the reset control flag register (RESF) is set to 1. For details of RESF, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. 246 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER 10.2 Configuration of Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer includes the following hardware. Table 10-1. Configuration of Watchdog Timer Item Configuration Control register Watchdog timer enable register (WDTE) How the counter operation is controlled, overflow time, and window open period are set by the option byte. Table 10-2. Setting of Option Bytes and Watchdog Timer Setting of Watchdog Timer Option Byte (0080H) Window open period Bits 6 and 5 (WINDOW1, WINDOW0) Controlling counter operation of watchdog timer Bit 4 (WDTON) Overflow time of watchdog timer Bits 3 to 1 (WDCS2 to WDCS0) Remark For the option byte, see CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE. Figure 10-1. Block Diagram of Watchdog Timer CPU access error detector CPU access signal WDCS2 to WDCS0 of option byte (0080H) fRL/2 Clock input controller 17-bit counter 210/fRL to 217/fRL Selector Count clear signal WINDOW1 and WINDOW0 of option byte (0080H) WDTON of option byte (0080H) Overflow signal Reset output controller Internal reset signal Window size determination signal Clear, reset control Watchdog timer enable register (WDTE) Internal bus User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 247 CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER 10.3 Register Controlling Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer is controlled by the watchdog timer enable register (WDTE). (1) Watchdog timer enable register (WDTE) Writing ACH to WDTE clears the watchdog timer counter and starts counting again. This register can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 9AH or 1AHNote. Figure 10-2. Format of Watchdog Timer Enable Register (WDTE) Address: FF9BH Symbol After reset: 9AH/1AHNote 7 6 R/W 5 4 3 2 1 0 WDTE Note The WDTE reset value differs depending on the WDTON setting value of the option byte (0080H). To operate watchdog timer, set WDTON to 1. WDTON Setting Value WDTE Reset Value 0 (watchdog timer count operation disabled) 1AH 1 (watchdog timer count operation enabled) 9AH Cautions 1. If a value other than ACH is written to WDTE, an internal reset signal is generated. If the source clock to the watchdog timer is stopped, however, an internal reset signal is generated when the source clock to the watchdog timer resumes operation. 2. If a 1-bit memory manipulation instruction is executed for WDTE, an internal reset signal is generated. If the source clock to the watchdog timer is stopped, however, an internal reset signal is generated when the source clock to the watchdog timer resumes operation. 3. The value read from WDTE is 9AH/1AH (this differs from the written value (ACH)). 248 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER 10.4 Operation of Watchdog Timer 10.4.1 Controlling operation of watchdog timer 1. When the watchdog timer is used, its operation is specified by the option byte (0080H). * Enable counting operation of the watchdog timer by setting bit 4 (WDTON) of the option byte (0080H) to 1 (the counter starts operating after a reset release) (for details, see CHAPTER 22). WDTON Operation Control of Watchdog Timer Counter/Illegal Access Detection 0 Counter operation disabled (counting stopped after reset), Illegal access detection operation disabled. 1 Counter operation enabled (counting started after reset), Illegal access detection operation enabled. * Set an overflow time by using bits 3 to 1 (WDCS2 to WDCS0) of the option byte (0080H) (for details, see 10.4.2 and CHAPTER 22). * Set a window open period by using bits 6 and 5 (WINDOW1 and WINDOW0) of the option byte (0080H) (for details, see 10.4.3 and CHAPTER 22). 2. After a reset release, the watchdog timer starts counting. 3. By writing "ACH" to WDTE after the watchdog timer starts counting and before the overflow time set by the option byte, the watchdog timer is cleared and starts counting again. 4. After that, write WDTE the second time or later after a reset release during the window open period. If WDTE is written during a period other than the window open period, an internal reset signal is generated. 5. If the overflow time expires without "ACH" written to WDTE, an internal reset signal is generated. An internal reset signal is generated in the following cases. * If a 1-bit manipulation instruction is executed on the watchdog timer enable register (WDTE) * If data other than "ACH" is written to WDTE * If the instruction is fetched from an area not set by the IMS and IXS registers (detection of an invalid check during a CPU program loop) * If the CPU accesses an area not set by the IMS and IXS registers (excluding FB00H to FFFFH) by executing a read/write instruction (detection of an abnormal access during a CPU program loop) Cautions 1. The first writing to WDTE after a reset release clears the watchdog timer, if it is made before the overflow time regardless of the timing of the writing, and the watchdog timer starts counting again. 2. If the watchdog timer is cleared by writing "ACH" to WDTE, the actual overflow time may be different from the overflow time set by the option byte by up to 2/fRL seconds. 3. The watchdog timer can be cleared immediately before the count value overflows (FFFFH). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 249 CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER Cautions 4. The operation of the watchdog timer in the HALT and STOP modes differs as follows depending on the set value of bit 0 (LSROSC) of the option byte. In HALT mode LSROSC = 0 (Internal Low-Speed LSROSC = 1 (Internal Low-Speed Oscillator Can Be Stopped by Software) Oscillator Cannot Be Stopped) Watchdog timer operation stops. Watchdog timer operation continues. In STOP mode If LSROSC = 0, the watchdog timer resumes counting after the HALT or STOP mode is released. At this time, the counter is not cleared to 0 but starts counting from the value at which it was stopped. If oscillation of the internal low-speed oscillator is stopped by setting LSRSTOP (bit 1 of the internal oscillation mode register (RCM) = 1) when LSROSC = 0, the watchdog timer stops operating. At this time, the counter is not cleared to 0. 5. The watchdog timer continues its operation during self-programming and EEPROMTM emulation of the flash memory. During processing, the interrupt acknowledge time is delayed. Set the overflow time and window size taking this delay into consideration. 250 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER 10.4.2 Setting overflow time of watchdog timer Set the overflow time of the watchdog timer by using bits 3 to 1 (WDCS2 to WDCS0) of the option byte. If an overflow occurs, an internal reset signal is generated. If "ACH" is written to WDTE during the window open period before the overflow time, the present count is cleared and the watchdog timer starts counting again. The following overflow time is set. Table 10-3. Setting of Overflow Time of Watchdog Timer WDCS2 WDCS1 WDCS0 Overflow Time of Watchdog Timer 10 0 0 0 2 /fRL (3.88 ms) 0 0 1 2 /fRL (7.76 ms) 0 1 0 2 /fRL (15.52 ms) 0 1 1 2 /fRL (31.03 ms) 1 0 0 2 /fRL (62.06 ms) 1 0 1 2 /fRL (124.12 ms) 1 1 0 2 /fRL (248.24 ms) 1 1 1 2 /fRL (496.48 ms) 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 Cautions 1. The combination of WDCS2 = WDCS1 = WDCS0 = 0 and WINDOW1 = WINDOW0 = 0 is prohibited. 2. The watchdog timer continues its operation during self-programming and EEPROM emulation of the flash memory. During processing, the interrupt acknowledge time is delayed. Set the overflow time and window size taking this delay into consideration. Remarks 1. fRL: Internal low-speed oscillation clock frequency 2. ( ): fRL = 264 kHz (MAX.) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 251 CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER 10.4.3 Setting window open period of watchdog timer Set the window open period of the watchdog timer by using bits 6 and 5 (WINDOW1, WINDOW0) of the option byte (0080H). The outline of the window is as follows. * If "ACH" is written to WDTE during the window open period, the watchdog timer is cleared and starts counting again. * Even if "ACH" is written to WDTE during the window close period, an abnormality is detected and an internal reset signal is generated. Example: If the window open period is 25% Counting starts Overflow time Window open period (25%) Window close period (75%) Internal reset signal is generated if ACH is written to WDTE. Counting starts again when ACH is written to WDTE. Caution The first writing to WDTE after a reset release clears the watchdog timer, if it is made before the overflow time regardless of the timing of the writing, and the watchdog timer starts counting again. The window open period to be set is as follows. Table 10-4. Setting Window Open Period of Watchdog Timer WINDOW1 WINDOW0 Window Open Period of Watchdog Timer 0 0 25% 0 1 50% 1 0 75% 1 1 100% Cautions 1. The combination of WDCS2 = WDCS1 = WDCS0 = 0 and WINDOW1 = WINDOW0 = 0 is prohibited. 2. The watchdog timer continues its operation during self-programming and EEPROM emulation of the flash memory. During processing, the interrupt acknowledge time is delayed. Set the overflow time and window size taking this delay into consideration. 252 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 10 WATCHDOG TIMER Remark If the overflow time is set to 210/fRL, the window close time and open time are as follows. Setting of Window Open Period 25% 50% 75% 100% Window close time 0 to 3.56 ms 0 to 2.37 ms 0 to 0.119 ms None Window open time 3.56 to 3.88 ms 2.37 to 3.88 ms 0.119 to 3.88 ms 0 to 3.88 ms * Overflow time: 210/fRL (MAX.) = 210/264 kHz (MAX.) = 3.88 ms * Window close time: 0 to 210/fRL (MIN.) x (1 - 0.25) = 0 to 210/216 kHz (MIN.) x 0.75 = 0 to 3.56 ms * Window open time: 210/fRL (MIN.) x (1 - 0.25) to 210/fRL (MAX.) = 210/216 kHz (MIN.) x 0.75 to 210/264 kHz (MAX.) = 3.56 to 3.88 ms User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 253 CHAPTER 11 CLOCK OUTPUT/BUZZER OUTPUT CONTROLLER 11.1 Functions of Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller The clock output controller is intended for carrier output during remote controlled transmission and clock output for supply to peripheral LSIs. The clock selected with the clock output selection register (CKS) is output. In addition, the buzzer output is intended for square-wave output of buzzer frequency selected with CKS. Figure 11-1 shows the block diagram of clock output/buzzer output controller. Figure 11-1. Block Diagram of Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller fPRS 8 fPRS/210 to fPRS/213 4 Selector Prescaler BUZ/INTP7/P73 Output latch (P73) BZOE BCS0, BCS1 Selector fPRS to fPRS/27 fSUB Clock controller CLOE BZOE BCS1 BCS0 CLOE CCS3 CCS2 CCS1 CCS0 Clock output selection register (CKS) Internal bus 254 PM73 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD PCL/INTP6/P72 Output latch (P72) PM72 CHAPTER 11 CLOCK OUTPUT/BUZZER OUTPUT CONTROLLER 11.2 Configuration of Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller The clock output/buzzer output controller includes the following hardware. Table 11-1. Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller Configuration Item Control registers Configuration Clock output selection register (CKS) Port mode register 7 (PM7) Port register 7 (P7) 11.3 Register Controlling Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller The following two registers are used to control the clock output/buzzer output controller. * Clock output selection register (CKS) * Port mode register 7 (PM7) (1) Clock output selection register (CKS) This register sets output enable/disable for clock output (PCL) and for the buzzer frequency output (BUZ), and sets the output clock. CKS is set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears CKS to 00H. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 255 CHAPTER 11 CLOCK OUTPUT/BUZZER OUTPUT CONTROLLER Figure 11-2. Format of Clock Output Selection Register (CKS) Address: FF40H Symbol CKS After reset: 00H R/W <7> 6 5 <4> 3 2 1 0 BZOE BCS1 BCS0 CLOE CCS3 CCS2 CCS1 CCS0 BZOE BUZ output enable/disable specification 0 Clock division circuit operation stopped. BUZ fixed to low level. 1 Clock division circuit operation enabled. BUZ output enabled. BCS1 BCS0 BUZ output clock selection fPRS = 10 MHz 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 fPRS/2 9.77 kHz 19.54 kHz fPRS/2 11 4.88 kHz 9.77 kHz fPRS/2 12 2.44 kHz 4.88 kHz fPRS/2 13 1.22 kHz 2.44 kHz CLOE PCL output enable/disable specification 0 Clock division circuit operation stopped. PCL fixed to low level. 1 Clock division circuit operation enabled. PCL output enabled. CCS3 0 fPRS = 20 MHz 10 CCS2 0 CCS1 0 Note CCS0 0 PCL output clock selection fSUB = fPRS = fPRS = 32.768 kHz 10 MHz 20 MHz - fPRS Setting 10 MHz Note prohibited 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 fPRS/2 5 MHz 10 MHz fPRS/2 2 2.5 MHz 5 MHz fPRS/2 3 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz fPRS/2 4 625 kHz 1.25 MHz fPRS/2 5 312.5 kHz 625 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 78.125 kHz 156.25 kHz 0 1 1 0 fPRS/2 6 0 1 1 1 fPRS/2 7 1 0 0 0 fSUB Other than above 32.768 kHz - Setting prohibited Notes 1. If the peripheral hardware clock operates on the internal high-speed oscillation clock when 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V, setting CCS3 = CCS2 = CCS1 = CCS0 = 0 (output clock of PCL: fPRS) is prohibited. 2. The PCL output clock prohibits settings if they exceed 10 MHz. Cautions 1. Set BCS1 and BCS0 when the buzzer output operation is stopped (BZOE = 0). 2. Set CCS3 to CCS0 while the clock output operation is stopped (CLOE = 0). Remarks 1. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 2. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency 256 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 11 CLOCK OUTPUT/BUZZER OUTPUT CONTROLLER (2) Port mode register 7 (PM7) This register sets port 7 input/output in 1-bit units. When using the P72/INTP6/PCL pin for clock output and the P73/INTP7/BUZ pin for buzzer output, set PM72, PM73 and the output latch of P72, P73 to 0. PM7 is set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets PM7 to FFH. Figure 11-3. Format of Port Mode Register 7 (PM7) Address: FF27H After reset: FFH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM7 1 PM76 PM75 PM74 PM73 PM72 PM71 PM70 PM7n P7n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 6) 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 257 CHAPTER 11 CLOCK OUTPUT/BUZZER OUTPUT CONTROLLER 11.4 Clock Output/Buzzer Output Controller Operations 11.4.1 Clock output operation The clock pulse is output as the following procedure. <1> Select the clock pulse output frequency with bits 0 to 3 (CCS0 to CCS3) of the clock output selection register (CKS) (clock pulse output in disabled status). <2> Set bit 4 (CLOE) of CKS to 1 to enable clock output. Remark The clock output controller is designed not to output pulses with a small width during output enable/disable switching of the clock output. As shown in Figure 11-4, be sure to start output from the low period of the clock (marked with * in the figure). When stopping output, do so after the high-level period of the clock. Figure 11-4. Remote Control Output Application Example CLOE * * Clock output 11.4.2 Operation as buzzer output The buzzer frequency is output as the following procedure. <1> Select the buzzer output frequency with bits 5 and 6 (BCS0, BCS1) of the clock output selection register (CKS) (buzzer output in disabled status). <2> Set bit 7 (BZOE) of CKS to 1 to enable buzzer output. 258 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.1 Function of A/D Converter The A/D converter converts an analog input signal into a digital value, and consists of up to eight channels (ANI0 to ANI8Note) with a resolution of 10 bits. The A/D converter has the following function. * 10-bit resolution A/D conversion 10-bit resolution A/D conversion is carried out repeatedly for one channel selected from analog inputs ANI0 to ANI8. Each time an A/D conversion operation ends, an interrupt request (INTAD) is generated. Figure 12-1. Block Diagram of A/D Converter AVREF ADCS bit P80/ANI0 P81/ANI1 P82/ANI2 P83/ANI3 P84/ANI4 P85/ANI5 P86/ANI6 P87/ANI7 P90/ANI8Note1 Voltage comparator AVSS Successive approximation register (SAR) Controller 4 AVSS INTAD A/D conversion result register (ADCR) 5 4 Tap selector Selector Sample & hold circuit Note2 ADS3 ADS2 ADS1 ADS0 ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0 Analog input channel specification register (ADS) ADCS FR2 FR1 FR0 A/D port configuration register (ADPC) LV1 LV0 ADCE A/D converter mode register (ADM) Internal bus Notes 1. P90/ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 2. ADS3 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 259 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.2 Configuration of A/D Converter The A/D converter includes the following hardware. (1) ANI0 to ANI8Note pins These are the analog input pins of the 8-channel A/D converter. They input analog signals to be converted into digital signals. Pins other than the one selected as the analog input pin can be used as I/O port pins. Note ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. (2) Sample & hold circuit The sample & hold circuit samples the input voltage of the analog input pin selected by the selector when A/D conversion is started, and holds the sampled voltage value during A/D conversion. (3) Series resistor string The series resistor string is connected between AVREF and AVSS, and generates a voltage to be compared with the sampled voltage value. Figure 12-2. Circuit Configuration of Series Resistor String AVREF P-ch ADCS Series resistor string AVSS (4) Voltage comparator The voltage comparator compares the sampled voltage value and the output voltage of the series resistor string. (5) Successive approximation register (SAR) This register converts the result of comparison by the voltage comparator, starting from the most significant bit (MSB). When the voltage value is converted into a digital value down to the least significant bit (LSB) (end of A/D conversion), the contents of the SAR register are transferred to the A/D conversion result register (ADCR). (6) 10-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCR) The A/D conversion result is loaded from the successive approximation register to this register each time A/D conversion is completed, and the ADCR register holds the A/D conversion result in its higher 10 bits (the lower 6 bits are fixed to 0). 260 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (7) 8-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCRH) The A/D conversion result is loaded from the successive approximation register to this register each time A/D conversion is completed, and the ADCRH register stores the higher 8 bits of the A/D conversion result. Caution When data is read from ADCR and ADCRH, a wait cycle is generated. Do not read data from ADCR and ADCRH when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. (8) Controller This circuit controls the conversion time of an input analog signal that is to be converted into a digital signal, as well as starting and stopping of the conversion operation. When A/D conversion has been completed, this controller generates INTAD. (9) AVREF pin This pin inputs an analog power/reference voltage to the A/D converter. Make this pin the same potential as the VDD pin when port 8 and port 9 are used as a digital port. The signal input to ANI0 to ANI8 is converted into a digital signal, based on the voltage applied across AVREF and AVSS. (10) AVSS pin This is the ground potential pin of the A/D converter. Always use this pin at the same potential as that of the VSS pin even when the A/D converter is not used. (11) A/D converter mode register (ADM) This register is used to set the conversion time of the analog input signal to be converted, and to start or stop the conversion operation. (12) A/D port configuration register (ADPC) This register switches the P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 and P90/ANI8 pins to analog input of A/D converter or digital I/O of port. (13) Analog input channel specification register (ADS) This register is used to specify the port that inputs the analog voltage to be converted into a digital signal. (14) Port mode register 8 (PM8) This register switches the P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 pins to input or output. (15) Port mode register 9 (PM9) This register switches the P90/ANI8 pin to input or output. Caution P90/ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 261 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.3 Registers Used in A/D Converter The A/D converter uses the following six registers. * A/D converter mode register (ADM) * A/D port configuration register (ADPC) * Analog input channel specification register (ADS) * Port mode register 8 (PM8) * Port mode register 9 (PM9)Note * 10-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCR) * 8-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCRH) Note PM9 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. (1) A/D converter mode register (ADM) This register sets the conversion time for analog input to be A/D converted, and starts/stops conversion. ADM can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 12-3. Format of A/D Converter Mode Register (ADM) Address: FF2AH Symbol ADM <7> ADCS ADCS After reset: 00H 6 0 R/W 5 FR2 Note 1 4 FR1 3 FR0 Note 1 2 LV1 Note 1 1 Note 1 LV0 <0> ADCE A/D conversion operation control 0 Stops conversion operation 1 Enables conversion operation Comparator operation controlNote 2 ADCE Notes 1. Note 1 0 Stops comparator operation 1 Enables comparator operation (comparator: 1/2AVREF operation) For details of FR2 to FR0, LV1, LV0, and A/D conversion, see Table 12-2 A/D Conversion Time Selection. 2. The operation of the comparator is controlled by ADCS and ADCE, and it takes 1 s from operation start to operation stabilization. Therefore, when ADCS is set to 1 after 1 s or more has elapsed from the time ADCE is set to 1, the conversion result at that time has priority over the first conversion result. Otherwise, ignore data of the first conversion. 262 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER Table 12-1. Settings of ADCS and ADCE ADCS ADCE 0 0 0 1 A/D Conversion Operation Stop status (DC power consumption path does not exist) Conversion waiting mode (comparator: 1/2AVREF operation, only comparator consumes power) Note 1 0 Conversion mode (comparator operation stopped 1 1 Conversion mode (comparator: 1/2AVREF operation) ) Note Ignore data of the first conversion because it is not guaranteed range. Figure 12-4. Timing Chart When Comparator Is Used Comparator: 1/2AVREF operation ADCE Comparator Conversion operation Conversion waiting Conversion operation Conversion stopped ADCS Note Note To stabilize the internal circuit, the time from the rising of the ADCE bit to the rising of the ADCS bit must be 1 s or longer. Cautions 1. A/D conversion must be stopped before rewriting bits FR0 to FR2, LV1, and LV0 to values other than the identical data. 2. If data is written to ADM, a wait cycle is generated. Do not write data to ADM when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 263 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER Table 12-2. A/D Conversion Time Selection (1) 2.7 V AVREF 5.5 V A/D Converter Mode Register (ADM) FR2 FR1 FR0 LV1 LV0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Conversion Time Selection fPRS = 4 MHz 264/fPRS Setting prohibited 176/fPRS fPRS = 20 MHz 26.4 s 13.2 s fPRS/12 17.6 s 8.8 s fPRS/8 Note 132/fPRS 33.0 s 13.2 s 6.6 s fPRS/6 88/fPRS 22.0 s 8.8 s Setting prohibited fPRS/4 6.6 s fPRS/3 Setting prohibited fPRS/2 1 0 0 0 0 66/fPRS 16.5 s 1 0 1 0 0 44/fPRS 11.0 s Other than above fPRS = 10 MHz Conversion Clock (fAD) Note Note Note Note Setting prohibited Note This can be set only when 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V. (2) 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V A/D Converter Mode Register (ADM) Conversion Time Selection FR2 FR1 FR0 LV1 LV0 fPRS = 2 MHz 0 0 0 0 1 480/fPRS 0 0 1 0 1 320/fPRS 0 1 0 0 1 240/fPRS 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 Other than above Cautions 1. Setting prohibited Conversion Clock (fAD) fPRS = 5 MHz Setting prohibited fPRS/12 64.0 s fPRS/8 60.0 s 48.0 s fPRS/6 160/fPRS 40.0 s 32.0 s fPRS/4 120/fPRS 30.0 s Setting prohibited fPRS/3 Setting prohibited Set the conversion times with the following conditions. * 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V: fAD = 0.6 to 3.6 MHz * 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V: fAD = 0.6 to 1.8 MHz * 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V: fAD = 0.6 to 1.48 MHz 2. When rewriting FR2 to FR0, LV1, and LV0 to other than the same data, stop A/D conversion once (ADCS = 0) beforehand. 3. Change LV1 and LV0 from the default value, when 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V. 4. The above conversion time does not include clock frequency errors. Select conversion time, taking clock frequency errors into consideration. Remark fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 264 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER Figure 12-5. A/D Converter Sampling and A/D Conversion Timing ADCS 1 or ADS rewrite ADCS Sampling timing INTAD Wait periodNote SAR clear Sampling time Successive conversion time Sampling time Transfer SAR to ADCR, clear INTAD generation Conversion time Conversion time Note For details of wait period, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. (2) 10-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCR) This register is a 16-bit register that stores the A/D conversion result. The lower 6 bits are fixed to 0. Each time A/D conversion ends, the conversion result is loaded from the successive approximation register, and is stored in ADCR in order starting from bit 7 of FF19H. FF19H indicates the higher 8 bits of the conversion result, and FF18H indicates the lower 2 bits of the conversion result. ADCR can be read by a 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 0000H. Figure 12-6. Format of 10-Bit A/D Conversion Result Register (ADCR) Address: FF18H, FF19H Symbol After reset: 0000H R FF19H FF18H ADCR 0 0 0 0 0 0 Cautions 1. When writing to the A/D converter mode register (ADM), analog input channel specification register (ADS), and A/D port configuration register (ADPC), the contents of ADCR may become undefined. Read the conversion result following conversion completion before writing to ADM, ADS, and ADPC. Using timing other than the above may cause an incorrect conversion result to be read. 2. If data is read from ADCR, a wait cycle is generated. Do not read data from ADCR when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 265 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (3) 8-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCRH) This register is an 8-bit register that stores the A/D conversion result. The higher 8 bits of 10-bit resolution are stored. ADCRH can be read by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 12-7. Format of 8-Bit A/D Conversion Result Register (ADCRH) Address: FF19H Symbol After reset: 00H 7 6 R 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADCRH Cautions 1. When writing to the A/D converter mode register (ADM), analog input channel specification register (ADS), and A/D port configuration register (ADPC), the contents of ADCRH may become undefined. Read the conversion result following conversion completion before writing to ADM, ADS, and ADPC. Using timing other than the above may cause an incorrect conversion result to be read. 2. If data is read from ADCRH, a wait cycle is generated. Do not read data from ADCRH when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. 266 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (4) Analog input channel specification register (ADS) This register specifies the input port of the analog voltage to be A/D converted. ADS can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 12-8. Format of Analog Input Channel Specification Register (ADS) Address: FF2BH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADS 0 0 0 0 ADS3 ADS2 ADS1 ADS0 ADS3 ADS2 ADS1 ADS0 0 0 0 0 ANI0 0 0 0 1 ANI1 0 0 1 0 ANI2 0 0 1 1 ANI3 0 1 0 0 ANI4 0 1 0 1 ANI5 0 1 1 0 ANI6 0 1 1 1 ANI7 1 0 0 0 ANI8 Analog input channel specification Note Note ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Cautions 1. Be sure to clear bits 4 to 7 to 0. Be sure to clear ADS3 to 0 (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883). 2 Because ADS and ADPC do not control input and output, set the channel used for A/D conversion in the input mode by using port mode register 8 (PM8) and port mode register 9 (PM9). If the channel is set in the output mode, selection of ADPC is disabled. 3. Do not set a pin to be used as a digital input pin with ADPC with ADS. 4. If data is written to ADS, a wait cycle is generated. Do not write data to ADS when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 267 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (5) A/D port configuration register (ADPC) This register switches the P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 pins to analog input of A/D converter or digital I/O of port. ADPC can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 12-9. Format of A/D Port Configuration Register (ADPC) Address: FF22H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADPC 0 0 0 0 ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0 Analog input (A)/ digital I/O (D) switching ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0 P90/ANI8 P87/ANI7 P86/ANI6 P85/ANI5 P84/ANI4 P83/ANI3 P82/ANI2 P81/ANI1 P80/ANI0 0 0 0 0 A A A A A A A A A 0 0 0 1 A A A A A A A A D 0 0 1 0 A A A A A A A D D 0 0 1 1 A A A A A A D D D 0 1 0 0 A A A A A D D D D 0 1 0 1 A A A A D D D D D 0 1 1 0 A A A D D D D D D 0 1 1 1 A A D D D D D D D 1 0 0 0 A D D D D D D D D 1 0 0 1 D D D D D D D D D Other than above Setting prohibited Cautions 1. Set the channel to be used for A/D conversion in the input mode by using port mode register 8, 9 (PM8, PM9). 2. If data is written to ADPC, a wait cycle is generated. Do not write data to ADPC when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. 3. P90/ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 268 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (6) Port mode register 8 (PM8) When using the P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 pins for analog input port, set PM80 to PM87 to 1. The output latches of P80 to P87 at this time may be 0 or 1. If PM80 to PM87 are set to 0, they cannot be used as analog input port pins. PM8 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. Figure 12-10. Format of Port Mode Register 8 (PM8) Address: FF28H Symbol PM8 After reset: FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM87 PM86 PM85 PM84 PM83 PM82 PM81 PM80 PM8n P8n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 7) 0 Output mode (Output buffer on) 1 Input mode (Output buffer off) (7) Port mode register 9 (PM9)Note When using the P90/ANI8 pin for analog input port, set PM90 to 1. The output latches of P90 at this time may be 0 or 1. If PM90 is set to 0, they cannot be used as analog input port pin. PM9 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. Figure 12-11. Format of Port Mode Register 9 (PM9) Address: FF29H After reset: FFH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM9 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PM90 PM90 P90 pin I/O mode selection 0 Output mode (Output buffer on) 1 Input mode (Output buffer off) Note PM9 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 269 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 pins are as shown below depending on the settings of ADPC, ADS, PM8 and PM9. Table 12-3. Setting Functions of P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 Pins ADPC PM8, PM9 ADS P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 Pins Analog input selection Input mode Output mode Selects ANI. Analog input (to be converted) Does not select ANI. Analog input (not to be converted) Selects ANI. Setting prohibited Does not select ANI. Digital I/O selection Input mode - Digital input Output mode - Digital output Caution P90/ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 270 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.4 A/D Converter Operations 12.4.1 Basic operations of A/D converter <1> Set bit 0 (ADCE) of the A/D converter mode register (ADM) to 1 to start the operation of the comparator. <2> Set channels for A/D conversion to analog input by using the A/D port configuration register (ADPC) and set to input mode by using port mode register 8, 9 (PM8, PM9). <3> Set A/D conversion time by using bits 5 to 1 (FR2 to FR0, LV1, and LV0) of ADM. <4> Select one channel for A/D conversion using the analog input channel specification register (ADS). <5> Start the conversion operation by setting bit 7 (ADCS) of ADM to 1. (<6> to <12> are operations performed by hardware.) <6> The voltage input to the selected analog input channel is sampled by the sample & hold circuit. <7> When sampling has been done for a certain time, the sample & hold circuit is placed in the hold state and the sampled voltage is held until the A/D conversion operation has ended. <8> Bit 9 of the successive approximation register (SAR) is set. The series resistor string voltage tap is set to (1/2) AVREF by the tap selector. <9> The voltage difference between the series resistor string voltage tap and sampled voltage is compared by the voltage comparator. If the analog input is greater than (1/2) AVREF, the MSB of SAR remains set to 1. If the analog input is smaller than (1/2) AVREF, the MSB is reset to 0. <10> Next, bit 8 of SAR is automatically set to 1, and the operation proceeds to the next comparison. The series resistor string voltage tap is selected according to the preset value of bit 9, as described below. * Bit 9 = 1: (3/4) AVREF * Bit 9 = 0: (1/4) AVREF The voltage tap and sampled voltage are compared and bit 8 of SAR is manipulated as follows. * Analog input voltage Voltage tap: Bit 8 = 1 * Analog input voltage < Voltage tap: Bit 8 = 0 <11> Comparison is continued in this way up to bit 0 of SAR. <12> Upon completion of the comparison of 10 bits, an effective digital result value remains in SAR, and the result value is transferred to the A/D conversion result register (ADCR, ADCRH) and then latched. At the same time, the A/D conversion end interrupt request (INTAD) can also be generated. <13> Repeat steps <6> to <12>, until ADCS is cleared to 0. To stop the A/D converter, clear ADCS to 0. To restart A/D conversion from the status of ADCE = 1, start from <5>. To start A/D conversion again when ADCE = 0, set ADCE to 1, wait for 1 s or longer, and start <5>. To change a channel of A/D conversion, start from <4>. Cautions 1. Make sure the period of <1> to <5> is 1 s or more. 2. PM9 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Remark Two types of A/D conversion result registers are available. * ADCR (16 bits): Store 10-bit A/D conversion value * ADCRH (8 bits): Store 8-bit A/D conversion value User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 271 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER Figure 12-12. Basic Operation of A/D Converter Conversion time Sampling time A/D converter operation Sampling A/D conversion Conversion result SAR Undefined Conversion result ADCR INTAD A/D conversion operations are performed continuously until bit 7 (ADCS) of the A/D converter mode register (ADM) is reset (0) by software. If a write operation is performed to the analog input channel specification register (ADS) during an A/D conversion operation, the conversion operation is initialized, and if the ADCS bit is set (1), conversion starts again from the beginning. Reset signal generation clears the A/D conversion result register (ADCR, ADCRH) to 0000H or 00H. 272 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.4.2 Input voltage and conversion results The relationship between the analog input voltage input to the analog input pins (ANI0 to ANI8Note) and the theoretical A/D conversion result (stored in the 10-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCR)) is shown by the following expression. SAR = INT ( VAIN AVREF x 1024 + 0.5) ADCR = SAR x 64 or (ADCR - 0.5) x where, INT( ): AVREF 1024 VAIN < (ADCR + 0.5) x AVREF 1024 Function which returns integer part of value in parentheses VAIN: Analog input voltage AVREF: AVREF pin voltage ADCR: A/D conversion result register (ADCR) value SAR: Successive approximation register Note P90/ ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Figure 12-13 shows the relationship between the analog input voltage and the A/D conversion result. Figure 12-13. Relationship Between Analog Input Voltage and A/D Conversion Result SAR ADCR 1023 FFC0H 1022 FF80H 1021 FF40H 3 00C0H 2 0080H 1 0040H A/D conversion result (ADCR) 0 0000H 1 1 3 2 5 3 2048 1024 2048 1024 2048 1024 2043 1022 2045 1023 2047 1 2048 1024 2048 1024 2048 Input voltage/AVREF User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 273 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.4.3 A/D converter operation mode The operation mode of the A/D converter is the select mode. One channel of analog input is selected from ANI0 to ANI8 by the analog input channel specification register (ADS) and A/D conversion is executed. (1) A/D conversion operation By setting bit 7 (ADCS) of the A/D converter mode register (ADM) to 1, the A/D conversion operation of the voltage, which is applied to the analog input pin specified by the analog input channel specification register (ADS), is started. When A/D conversion has been completed, the result of the A/D conversion is stored in the A/D conversion result register (ADCR), and an interrupt request signal (INTAD) is generated. When one A/D conversion has been completed, the next A/D conversion operation is immediately started. If ADS is rewritten during A/D conversion, the A/D conversion operation under execution is stopped and restarted from the beginning. If 0 is written to ADCS during A/D conversion, A/D conversion is immediately stopped. At this time, the conversion result immediately before is retained. Figure 12-14. A/D Conversion Operation Rewriting ADM ADCS = 1 A/D conversion ANIn Rewriting ADS ANIn ANIn ADCS = 0 ANIm ANIm Conversion is stopped Conversion result immediately before is retained ANIn ADCR, ADCRH ANIn INTAD Caution ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Remarks 1. n = 0 to 8 2. m = 0 to 8 274 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Stopped Conversion result immediately before is retained ANIm CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER The setting methods are described below. <1> Set bit 0 (ADCE) of the A/D converter mode register (ADM) to 1. <2> Set the channel to be used in the analog input mode by using bits 3 to 0 (ADPC3 to ADPC0) of the A/D port configuration register (ADPC) and bits 7 to 0 (PM87 to PM80) of port mode register 8 (PM8), bit 0 (PM90) of port mode register 9 (PM9)Note. <3> Select conversion time by using bits 5 to 1 (FR2 to FR0, LV1, and LV0) of ADM. <4> Select a channel to be used by using bits 3 to 0 (ADS3 to ADS0) of the analog input channel specification register (ADS). <5> Set bit 7 (ADCS) of ADM to 1 to start A/D conversion. <6> When one A/D conversion has been completed, an interrupt request signal (INTAD) is generated. <7> Transfer the A/D conversion data to the A/D conversion result register (ADCR, ADCRH). <8> Change the channel using bits 3 to 0 (ADS3 to ADS0) of ADS to start A/D conversion. <9> When one A/D conversion has been completed, an interrupt request signal (INTAD) is generated. <10> Transfer the A/D conversion data to the A/D conversion result register (ADCR, ADCRH). <11> Clear ADCS to 0. <12> Clear ADCE to 0. Note PM9 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Cautions 1. Make sure the period of <1> to <5> is 1 s or more. 2. <1> may be done between <2> and <4>. 3. <1> can be omitted. However, ignore data of the first conversion after <5> in this case. 4. The period from <6> to <9> differs from the conversion time set using bits 5 to 1 (FR2 to FR0, LV1, LV0) of ADM. The period from <8> to <9> is the conversion time set using FR2 to FR0, LV1, and LV0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 275 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.5 How to Read A/D Converter Characteristics Table Here, special terms unique to the A/D converter are explained. (1) Resolution This is the minimum analog input voltage that can be identified. That is, the percentage of the analog input voltage per bit of digital output is called 1LSB (Least Significant Bit). The percentage of 1LSB with respect to the full scale is expressed by %FSR (Full Scale Range). 1LSB is as follows when the resolution is 10 bits. 1LSB = 1/210 = 1/1024 = 0.098%FSR Accuracy has no relation to resolution, but is determined by overall error. (2) Overall error This shows the maximum error value between the actual measured value and the theoretical value. Zero-scale error, full-scale error, integral linearity error, and differential linearity errors that are combinations of these express the overall error. Note that the quantization error is not included in the overall error in the characteristics table. (3) Quantization error When analog values are converted to digital values, a 1/2LSB error naturally occurs. In an A/D converter, an analog input voltage in a range of 1/2LSB is converted to the same digital code, so a quantization error cannot be avoided. Note that the quantization error is not included in the overall error, zero-scale error, full-scale error, integral linearity error, and differential linearity error in the characteristics table. Figure 12-15. Overall Error Figure 12-16. Quantization Error 1......1 1......1 Overall error Digital output Digital output Ideal line 1/2LSB Quantization error 1/2LSB 0......0 AVREF 0 0......0 Analog input 0 Analog input AVREF (4) Zero-scale error This shows the difference between the actual measurement value of the analog input voltage and the theoretical value (1/2LSB) when the digital output changes from 0......000 to 0......001. If the actual measurement value is greater than the theoretical value, it shows the difference between the actual measurement value of the analog input voltage and the theoretical value (3/2LSB) when the digital output changes from 0......001 to 0......010. 276 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (5) Full-scale error This shows the difference between the actual measurement value of the analog input voltage and the theoretical value (Full-scale - 3/2LSB) when the digital output changes from 1......110 to 1......111. (6) Integral linearity error This shows the degree to which the conversion characteristics deviate from the ideal linear relationship. It expresses the maximum value of the difference between the actual measurement value and the ideal straight line when the zero-scale error and full-scale error are 0. (7) Differential linearity error While the ideal width of code output is 1LSB, this indicates the difference between the actual measurement value and the ideal value. Figure 12-17. Zero-Scale Error Figure 12-18. Full-Scale Error Full-scale error Digital output (Lower 3 bits) Digital output (Lower 3 bits) 111 Ideal line 011 010 001 Zero-scale error 000 111 110 101 Ideal line 000 0 1 2 3 AVREF AVREF-3 0 Analog input (LSB) AVREF-2 AVREF-1 AVREF Analog input (LSB) Figure 12-19. Integral Linearity Error Figure 12-20. Differential Linearity Error 1......1 1......1 Ideal 1LSB width Digital output Digital output Ideal line Differential linearity error Integral linearity error 0......0 0 Analog input 0......0 0 AVREF Analog input AVREF (8) Conversion time This expresses the time from the start of sampling to when the digital output is obtained. The sampling time is included in the conversion time in the characteristics table. (9) Sampling time This is the time the analog switch is turned on for the analog voltage to be sampled by the sample & hold circuit. Sampling time Conversion time User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 277 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER 12.6 Cautions for A/D Converter (1) Operating current in STOP mode The A/D converter stops operating in the STOP mode. At this time, the operating current can be reduced by clearing bit 7 (ADCS) and bit 0 (ADCE) of the A/D converter mode register (ADM) to 0. To restart from the standby status, clear bit 6 (ADIF) of interrupt request flag register 1L (IF1L) to 0 and start operation. (2) Input range of ANI0 to ANI8Note Observe the rated range of the ANI0 to ANI8 input voltage. If a voltage of AVREF or higher and AVSS or lower (even in the range of absolute maximum ratings) is input to an analog input channel, the converted value of that channel becomes undefined. In addition, the converted values of the other channels may also be affected. (3) Conflicting operations <1> Conflict between A/D conversion result register (ADCR, ADCRH) write and ADCR or ADCRH read by instruction upon the end of conversion ADCR or ADCRH read has priority. After the read operation, the new conversion result is written to ADCR or ADCRH. <2> Conflict between ADCR or ADCRH write and A/D converter mode register (ADM) write, analog input channel specification register (ADS), or A/D port configuration register (ADPC) write upon the end of conversion ADM, ADS, or ADPC write has priority. ADCR or ADCRH write is not performed, nor is the conversion end interrupt signal (INTAD) generated. (4) Noise countermeasures To maintain the 10-bit resolution, attention must be paid to noise input to the AVREF pin and pins ANI0 to ANI8. <1> Connect a capacitor with a low equivalent resistance and a good frequency response to the power supply. <2> The higher the output impedance of the analog input source, the greater the influence. To reduce the noise, connecting external C as shown in Figure 12-21 is recommended. <3> Do not switch these pins with other pins during conversion. <4> The accuracy is improved if the HALT mode is set immediately after the start of conversion. Note ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. 278 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER Figure 12-21. Analog Input Pin Connection If there is a possibility that noise equal to or higher than AVREF or equal to or lower than AVSS may enter, clamp with a diode with a small VF value (0.3 V or lower). Reference voltage input AVREF ANI0 to ANI8 Note C = 100 to 1,000 pF AVSS VSS Note ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. (5) P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 <1> The analog input pins (ANI0 to ANI8) are also used as I/O port pins (P80 to P87, P90). When A/D conversion is performed with any of ANI0 to ANI8 selected, do not access P80 to P87 and P90 while conversion is in progress; otherwise the conversion resolution may be degraded. It is recommended to select pins used as P80 to P87, P90 starting with the P80/ANI0 that is the furthest from AVREF. <2> If a digital pulse is applied to the pins adjacent to the pins currently used for A/D conversion, the expected value of the A/D conversion may not be obtained due to coupling noise. Therefore, do not apply a pulse to the pins adjacent to the pin undergoing A/D conversion. (6) Input impedance of ANI0 to ANI8 pins This A/D converter charges a sampling capacitor for sampling during sampling time. Therefore, only a leakage current flows when sampling is not in progress, and a current that charges the capacitor flows during sampling. Consequently, the input impedance fluctuates depending on whether sampling is in progress, and on the other states. To make sure that sampling is effective, however, it is recommended to keep the output impedance of the analog input source to within 10 k, and to connect a capacitor of about 100 pF to the ANI0 to ANI8 pins (see Figure 1221). (7) AVREF pin input impedance A series resistor string of several tens of k is connected between the AVREF and AVSS pins. Therefore, if the output impedance of the reference voltage source is high, this will result in a series connection to the series resistor string between the AVREF and AVSS pins, resulting in a large reference voltage error. Caution P90/ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 279 CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (8) Interrupt request flag (ADIF) The interrupt request flag (ADIF) is not cleared even if the analog input channel specification register (ADS) is changed. Therefore, if an analog input pin is changed during A/D conversion, the A/D conversion result and ADIF for the pre-change analog input may be set just before the ADS rewrite. Caution is therefore required since, at this time, when ADIF is read immediately after the ADS rewrite, ADIF is set despite the fact A/D conversion for the postchange analog input has not ended. When A/D conversion is stopped and then resumed, clear ADIF before the A/D conversion operation is resumed. Figure 12-22. Timing of A/D Conversion End Interrupt Request Generation ADS rewrite (start of ANIn conversion) A/D conversion ADCR ANIn ADS rewrite (start of ANIm conversion) ANIn ANIn ADIF is set but ANIm conversion has not ended. ANIm ANIn ANIm ANIm ANIm ADIF Remarks 1. n = 0 to 8 2. m = 0 to 8 (9) Conversion results just after A/D conversion start The first A/D conversion value immediately after A/D conversion starts may not fall within the rating range if the ADCS bit is set to 1 within 1 s after the ADCE bit was set to 1, or if the ADCS bit is set to 1 with the ADCE bit = 0. Take measures such as polling the A/D conversion end interrupt request (INTAD) and removing the first conversion result. (10) A/D conversion result register (ADCR, ADCRH) read operation When a write operation is performed to the A/D converter mode register (ADM), analog input channel specification register (ADS), and A/D port configuration register (ADPC), the contents of ADCR and ADCRH may become undefined. Read the conversion result following conversion completion before writing to ADM, ADS, and ADPC. Using a timing other than the above may cause an incorrect conversion result to be read. Caution ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. 280 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 12 A/D CONVERTER (11) Internal equivalent circuit The equivalent circuit of the analog input block is shown below. Figure 12-23. Internal Equivalent Circuit of ANIn Pin R1 ANIn C1 C2 Table 12-4. Resistance and Capacitance Values of Equivalent Circuit (Reference Values) AVREF R1 C1 C2 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 8.1 k 8 pF 5 pF 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 31 k 8 pF 5 pF 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 381 k 8 pF 5 pF Caution ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885, and 78F0886 only. Remarks 1. The resistance and capacitance values shown in Table 12-4 are not guaranteed values. 2. n = 0 to 8 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 281 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 The 78K0/FC2 incorporate serial interfaces UART60 and UART61. 13.1 Functions of Serial Interfaces UART60 and UART61 Serial interfaces UART60 and UART61 have the following two modes. (1) Operation stop mode This mode is used when serial communication is not executed and can enable a reduction in the power consumption. For details, see 13.4.1 Operation stop mode. (2) Asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode This mode supports the LIN (Local Interconnect Network)-bus. The functions of this mode are outlined below. For details, see 13.4.2 Asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode and 13.4.3 Dedicated baud rate generator. * Maximum transfer rate: 625 kbps * Two-pin configuration TxD6n: Transmit data output pin RXD6n: Receive data input pin * Data length of communication data can be selected from 7 or 8 bits. * Dedicated internal 8-bit baud rate generator allowing any baud rate to be set * Transmission and reception can be performed independently (full-duplex operation). * Twelve operating clock inputs selectable * MSB- or LSB-first communication selectable * Inverted transmission operation * Sync break field transmission from 13 to 20 bits * More than 11 bits can be identified for sync break field reception (SBF reception flag provided). Cautions 1. The TXD6n output inversion function inverts only the transmission side and not the reception side. To use this function, the reception side must be ready for reception of inverted data. 2. If clock supply to serial interfaces UART60 and UART61 are not stopped (e.g., in the HALT mode), normal operation continues. If clock supply to serial interfaces UART60 and UART61 are stopped (e.g., in the STOP mode), each register stops operating, and holds the value immediately before clock supply was stopped. The TXD6n pins also holds the value immediately before clock supply was stopped and outputs it. However, the operation is not guaranteed after clock supply is resumed. reset the circuit by setting POWER6n = 0, RXE6n = 0, and TXE6n = 0. 3. Set POWER6n = 1 and then set TXE6n = 1 (transmission) or RXE6n = 1 (reception) to start communication. 4. TXE6n and RXE6n are synchronized by the base clock (fXCLK6) set by CKSR6n. To enable transmission or reception again, set TXE6n or RXE6n to 1 at least two clocks of the base clock after TXE6n or RXEn6 has been cleared to 0. If TXE6n or RXE6n is set within two clocks of the base clock, the transmission circuit or reception circuit may not be initialized. 5. Set transmit data to TXB6n at least one base clock (fXCLK6) after setting TXE6n = 1. 282 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Cautions 6. If data is continuously transmitted, the communication timing from the stop bit to the next start bit is extended two operating clocks of the macro. However, this does not affect the result of communication because the reception side initializes the timing when it has detected a start bit. Do not use the continuous transmission function if the interface is used in LIN communication operation. Remarks 1. LIN stands for Local Interconnect Network and is a low-speed (1 to 20 kbps) serial communication protocol intended to aid the cost reduction of an automotive network. LIN communication is single-master communication, and up to 15 slaves can be connected to one master. The LIN slaves are used to control the switches, actuators, and sensors, and these are connected to the LIN master via the LIN network. Normally, the LIN master is connected to a network such as CAN (Controller Area Network). In addition, the LIN bus uses a single-wire method and is connected to the nodes via a transceiver that complies with ISO9141. n the LIN protocol, the master transmits a frame with baud rate information and the slave receives it and corrects the baud rate error. Therefore, communication is possible when the baud rate error in the slave is 15% or less. 2. n = 0, 1 Figures 13-1 and 13-2 outline the transmission and reception operations of LIN. Figure 13-1. LIN Transmission Operation Wakeup signal frame Sync break field Sync field Identifier field Data field Data field Checksum field LIN bus Note 1 8 bits 13-bitNote 2 SBF transmission 55H Data Data Data Data transmission transmission transmission transmission transmission TXD6n INTST6n Note 3 Notes 1. 2. The wakeup signal frame is substituted by 80H transmission in the 8-bit mode. The sync break field is output by hardware. The output width is the bit length set by bits 4 to 2 (SBL62n to SBL60n) of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n). If more precise output width adjustment is necessary, use baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) (see 13.4.2 (2) (h) SBF transmission). 3. Remark INTST6n is output on completion of each transmission. It is also output when SBF is transmitted. The interval between each field is controlled by software. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 283 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-2. LIN Reception Operation Wakeup signal frame Sync break field Sync field Identifer field Data field Data field Checksum field 13-bit SBF reception SF reception ID reception Data reception Data reception LIN bus <2> RXD6n Disable Data reception <5> Enable <3> Reception interrupt (INTSR6n) <1> Edge detection (INTPn) <4> Capture timer Disable Enable Reception processing is as follows. <1> The wakeup signal is detected at the edge of the pin, and enables UART6n and sets the SBF reception mode. <2> Reception continues until the STOP bit is detected. When an SBF with low-level data of 11 bits or more has been detected, it is assumed that SBF reception has been completed correctly, and an interrupt signal is output. If an SBF with low-level data of less than 11 bits has been detected, it is assumed that an SBF reception error has occurred. The interrupt signal is not output and the SBF reception mode is restored. <3> If SBF reception has been completed correctly, an interrupt signal is output. Start 16-bit timer/event counter 00 by the SBF reception end interrupt servicing and measure the bit interval (pulse width) of the sync field (see 6.4.3 Pulse width measurement operation). Detection of errors OVE6n, PE6n, and FE6n is suppressed, and error detection processing of UART communication and data transfer of the shift register and RXB6n is not performed. The shift register holds the reset value FFH. <4> Calculate the baud rate error from the bit length of the sync field, disable UART6n after SF reception, and then re-set baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n). <5> Distinguish the checksum field by software. Also perform processing by software to initialize UART6n after reception of the checksum field and to set the SBF reception mode again. Remark 284 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-3 and 13-4 show the port configuration for LIN reception operation. The wakeup signal transmitted from the LIN master is received by detecting the edge of the external interrupt (INTP0 and INTP1). The length of the sync field transmitted from the LIN master can be measured using the external event capture operation of 16-bit timer/event counter 00, and the baud rate error can be calculated. The input source of the reception port input (RxD60 and RxD61) can be input to the external interrupt (INTP0 and INTP1) and 16-bit timer/event counter 00 by port input switch control (ISC), without connecting RxD60, RxD61, INTP0, INTP1, TI010 externally. Figure 13-3. Port Configuration for LIN Reception Operation Selector P14/RxD60 RxD60 input Port mode (PM14) Output latch (P14) Selector Selector P01/TI010 TI010 input Port mode (PM01) Output latch (P01) Selector Port input switch control (ISC1) 0: Select TI010 (P01) 1: Select RxD60 (P14) Selector P120/INTP0 INTP0 input Port mode (PM120) Output latch (P120) Remark Port input switch control (ISC3) 0: Select INTP0 (P120) 1: Select RxD60 (P14) ISC1, ISC3: Bits 1 and 3 of the input switch control register (ISC) (see Figure 13-19) The peripheral functions used in the LIN communication operation are shown below. * External interrupt (INTP0); wakeup signal detection Use: Detects the wakeup signal edges and detects start of communication. * 16-bit timer/event counter 00 (TI010); baud rate error detection Use: Detects the baud rate error (measures the TI010 input edge interval in the capture mode) by detecting the sync field (SF) length and divides it by the number of bits. * Serial interface UART60. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 285 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-4. Port Configuration for LIN Reception Operation (UART61) Selector P11/RxD61 RxD61 input Port mode (PM11) Output latch (P11) Selector Selector P30/INTP1 INTP1 input Port mode (PM30) Output latch4 (P30) Port input switch control (ISC4) 0: Select INTP1 (P30) 1: Select RxD61 (P11) Remark ISC4: Bit 4 of the input switch control register (ISC) (see Figure 13-19) The peripheral functions used in the LIN communication operation are shown below. * External interrupt (INTP1); wakeup signal detection Use: Detects the wakeup signal edges and detects start of communication. * Serial interface UART61. 286 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 13.2 Configurations of Serial Interface UART60 and UART61 Serial interfaces UART60 and UART61 include the following hardware. Table 13-1. Configurations of Serial Interface UART60 and UART61 Item Configuration Receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n) Registers Receive shift register 6n (RXS6n) Transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n) Transmit shift register 6n (TXS6n) Control registers Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n) Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) Clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) Baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) Asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) Input switch control register (ISC) Port mode register 1 (PM1) Port register 1 (P1) Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 287 288 Figure 13-5. Block Diagram of Serial Interface UART60 TI010, INTP0 Filter INTSR60 Reception control INTSRE60 Selector Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 60 (ASIM60) Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60 (ASIS60) Baud rate generator Receive shift register 60 (RXS60) Asynchronous serial interface control register 60 (ASICL60) Receive buffer register 60 (RXB60) Asynchronous serial interface control register 60 (ASICL60) Transmit buffer register 60 (TXB60) Transmission control Transmit shift register 60 (TXS60) Reception unit Internal bus Baud rate generator control register 60 (BRGC60) 8 Asynchronous serial Clock selection interface transmission register 60 (CKSR60) status register 60 (ASIF60) Baud rate generator 8 INTST60 TXD60/P13 Registers Output latch P13 Transmission unit Note Selectable with input switch control register (ISC) PM13 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD fPRS fPRS/2 fPRS/22 fPRS/23 fPRS/24 fPRS/25 fPRS/26 fPRS/27 fPRS/28 fPRS/29 fPRS/210 8-bit timer/ event counter 50 output RXD60/P14 Figure 13-6. Block Diagram of Serial Interface UART61 Filter INTSR61 Reception control INTSRE61 Selector Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 61 (ASIM61) Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 61 (ASIS61) Baud rate generator Receive shift register 61 (RXS61) Asynchronous serial interface control register 61 (ASICL61) Receive buffer register 61 (RXB61) Asynchronous serial interface control register 61 (ASICL61) Transmit buffer register 61 (TXB61) Transmission control Transmit shift register 61 (TXS61) Reception unit Internal bus Baud rate generator control register 61 (BRGC61) 8 Asynchronous serial Clock selection interface transmission register 61 (CKSR61) status register 61 (ASIF61) Baud rate generator 8 INTST61 TXD61/P10/SCK10 Registers Output latch P10 Transmission unit PM10 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD fPRS fPRS/2 fPRS/22 fPRS/23 fPRS/24 fPRS/25 fPRS/26 fPRS/27 fPRS/28 fPRS/29 fPRS/210 8-bit timer/ event counter 50 output RXD61/P11/SI10 289 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (1) Receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n) This 8-bit register stores parallel data converted by receive shift register 6n (RXS6n). Each time 1 byte of data has been received, new receive data is transferred to this register from RXS6n. If the data length is set to 7 bits, data is transferred as follows. * In LSB-first reception, the receive data is transferred to bits 0 to 6 of RXB6n and the MSB of RXB6n is always 0. * In MSB-first reception, the receive data is transferred to bits 1 to 7 of RXB6n and the LSB of RXB6n is always 0. If an overrun error (OVE6n) occurs, the receive data is not transferred to RXB6n. RXB6n can be read by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. No data can be written to this register. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. (2) Receive shift register 6n (RXS6n) This register converts the serial data input to the RXD6n pins into parallel data. RXS6n cannot be directly manipulated by a program. (3) Transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n) This buffer register is used to set transmit data. Transmission is started when data is written to TXB6n. This register can be read or written by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. Cautions 1. Do not write data to TXB6n when bit 1 (TXBF6n) of asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) is 1. 2. Do not refresh (write the same value to) TXB6n by software during a communication operation (when bits 7 and 6 (POWER6n, TXE6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) are 1 or when bits 7 and 5 (POWER6n, RXE6n) of ASIM6n are 1). 3. Set transmit data to TXB6n at least one base clock (fXCLK6) after setting TXE6n = 1. (4) Transmit shift register 6n (TXS6n) This register transmits the data transferred from TXB6n from the TxD6n pins as serial data. Data is transferred from TXB6n immediately after TXB6n is written for the first transmission, or immediately before INTST6n occurs after one frame was transmitted for continuous transmission. Data is transferred from TXB6n and transmitted from the TXD6n pins at the falling edge of the base clock. TXS6n cannot be directly manipulated by a program. Remark 290 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 13.3 Registers Controlling Serial Interfaces UART60 and UART61 Serial interfaces UART60 and UART61 are controlled by the following nine registers. * Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) * Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n) * Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) * Clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) * Baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) * Asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) * Input switch control register (ISC) * Port mode register 1 (PM1) * Port register 1 (P1) (1) Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) This 8-bit register controls the serial communication operations of serial interface UART60 and UART61. This register can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 01H. Remarks 1. ASIM6n can be refreshed (the same value is written) by software during a communication operation (when bits 7 and 6 (POWER6n, TXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1 or bits 7 and 5 (POWER6n, RXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1). 2. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 291 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-7. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 60 (ASIM60) (1/2) Address: FF2EH After reset: 01H R/W Symbol <7> <6> <5> 4 3 2 1 0 ASIM60 POWER60 TXE60 RXE60 PS610 PS600 CL60 SL60 ISRM60 POWER60 0 Note 1 Enables/disables operation of internal operation clock Disables operation of the internal operation clock (fixes the clock to low level) and asynchronously resets the internal circuit 1 Note 2 Enables operation of the internal operation clock TXE60 Enables/disables transmission 0 Disables transmission (synchronously resets the transmission circuit). 1 Enables transmission RXE60 Notes 1. . Enables/disables reception 0 Disables reception (synchronously resets the reception circuit). 1 Enables reception The output of the TXD60 pins goes high level and the input from the RXD60 pins is fixed to the high level when POWER60 = 0 during transmission. 2. Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60 (ASIS60), asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 60 (ASIF60), bit 7 (SBRF60) and bit 6 (SBRT60) of asynchronous serial interface control register 60 (ASICL60), and receive buffer register 60 (RXB60) are reset. 292 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-7. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 60 (ASIM60) (2/2) PS610 PS600 Transmission operation 0 0 Does not output parity bit. Reception without parity 0 1 Outputs 0 parity. Reception as 0 parity 1 0 Outputs odd parity. Judges as odd parity. 1 1 Outputs even parity. Judges as even parity. CL60 Note Specifies character length of transmit/receive data 0 Character length of data = 7 bits 1 Character length of data = 8 bits SL60 Specifies number of stop bits of transmit data 0 Number of stop bits = 1 1 Number of stop bits = 2 ISRM60 Reception operation Enables/disables occurrence of reception completion interrupt in case of error 0 "INTSRE60" occurs in case of error (at this time, INTSR60 does not occur). 1 "INTSR60" occurs in case of error (at this time, INTSRE60 does not occur). Note If "reception as 0 parity" is selected, the parity is not judged. Therefore, bit 2 (PE60) of asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60 (ASIS60) is not set and the error interrupt does not occur. Cautions 1. To start the transmission, set POWER60 to 1 and then set TXE60 to 1. To stop the 2. To start the reception, set POWER60 to 1 and then set RXE60 to 1. To stop the reception, 3. Set POWER60 to 1 and then set RXE60 to 1 while a high level is input to the RxD60 pins. If 4. TXE60 and RXE60 are synchronized by the base clock (fXCLK6) set by CKSR60. To enable transmission, clear TXE60 to 0, and then clear POWER60 to 0. clear RXE60 to 0, and then clear POWER60 to 0. POWER60 is set to 1 and RXE60 is set to 1 while a low level is input, reception is started. transmission or reception again, set TXE60 or RXE60 to 1 at least two clocks of the base clock after TXE60 or RXE60 has been cleared to 0. If TXE60 or RXE60 is set within two clocks of the base clock, the transmission circuit or reception circuit may not be initialized. 5. Set transmit data to TXB60 at least one base clock (fXCLK6) after setting TXE60 = 1. 6. Clear the TXE60 and RXE60 bits to 0 before rewriting the PS610, PS600, and CL60 bits. 7. Fix the PS610 and PS600 bits to 0 when used in LIN communication operation. 8. Clear TXE60 to 0 before rewriting the SL60 bit. Reception is always performed with "the number of stop bits = 1", and therefore, is not affected by the set value of the SL60 bit. 9. Make sure that RXE60 = 0 when rewriting the ISRM60 bit. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 293 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-8. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 61 (ASIM61) (1/2) Address: FF2FH After reset: 01H R/W Symbol <7> <6> <5> 4 3 2 1 0 ASIM61 POWER61 TXE61 RXE61 PS611 PS601 CL61 SL61 ISRM61 POWER61 0 Note 1 Enables/disables operation of internal operation clock Disables operation of the internal operation clock (fixes the clock to low level) and asynchronously resets the internal circuit 1 . Enables operation of the internal operation clock TXE61 Enables/disables transmission 0 Disables transmission (synchronously resets the transmission circuit). 1 Enables transmission RXE61 Notes 1. Note 2 Enables/disables reception 0 Disables reception (synchronously resets the reception circuit). 1 Enables reception The output of the TXD61 pins goes high level and the input from the RXD61 pins is fixed to the high level when POWER61 = 0 during transmission. 2. Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 61 (ASIS61), asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 61 (ASIF61), bit 7 (SBRF61) and bit 6 (SBRT61) of asynchronous serial interface control register 61 (ASICL61), and receive buffer register 61 (RXB61) are reset. 294 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-8. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 61 (ASIM61) (2/2) PS611 PS601 Transmission operation 0 0 Does not output parity bit. Reception without parity 0 1 Outputs 0 parity. Reception as 0 parity 1 0 Outputs odd parity. Judges as odd parity. 1 1 Outputs even parity. Judges as even parity. CL61 Note Specifies character length of transmit/receive data 0 Character length of data = 7 bits 1 Character length of data = 8 bits SL61 Specifies number of stop bits of transmit data 0 Number of stop bits = 1 1 Number of stop bits = 2 ISRM61 Reception operation Enables/disables occurrence of reception completion interrupt in case of error 0 "INTSRE61" occurs in case of error (at this time, INTSR61 does not occur). 1 "INTSR61" occurs in case of error (at this time, INTSRE61 does not occur). Note If "reception as 0 parity" is selected, the parity is not judged. Therefore, bit 2 (PE61) of asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 61 (ASIS61) is not set and the error interrupt does not occur. Cautions 1. To start the transmission, set POWER61 to 1 and then set TXE61 to 1. To stop the 2. To start the reception, set POWER61 to 1 and then set RXE61 to 1. To stop the reception, 3. Set POWER61 to 1 and then set RXE61 to 1 while a high level is input to the RxD61 pins. If 4. TXE61 and RXE61 are synchronized by the base clock (fXCLK6) set by CKSR61. To enable transmission, clear TXE61 to 0, and then clear POWER61 to 0. clear RXE61 to 0, and then clear POWER61 to 0. POWER61 is set to 1 and RXE61 is set to 1 while a low level is input, reception is started. transmission or reception again, set TXE61 or RXE61 to 1 at least two clocks of the base clock after TXE61 or RXE61 has been cleared to 0. If TXE61 or RXE61 is set within two clocks of the base clock, the transmission circuit or reception circuit may not be initialized. 5. Set transmit data to TXB61 at least one base clock (fXCLK6) after setting TXE61 = 1. 6. Clear the TXE61 and RXE61 bits to 0 before rewriting the PS611, PS601, and CL61 bits. 7. Fix the PS611 and PS601 bits to 0 when used in LIN communication operation. 8. Clear TXE61 to 0 before rewriting the SL61 bit. Reception is always performed with "the number of stop bits = 1", and therefore, is not affected by the set value of the SL61 bit. 9. Make sure that RXE61 = 0 when rewriting the ISRM61 bit. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 295 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (2) Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n) This register indicates an error status on completion of reception by serial interfaces UART60 and UART61. It includes three error flag bits (PE6n, FE6n, OVE6n). This register is read-only by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation, or clearing bit 7 (POWER6n) or bit 5 (RXE6n) of ASIM6n to 0 clears this register to 00H. 00H is read when this register is read. If a reception error occurs, read ASIS6n and then read receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n) to clear the error flag. Figure 13-9. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Reception Error Status Register 60 (ASIS60) Address: FF53H After reset: 00H R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASIS60 0 0 0 0 0 PE60 FE60 OVE60 PE60 Status flag indicating parity error 0 If POWER60 = 0 and RXE60 = 0, or if ASIS60 register is read 1 If the parity of transmit data does not match the parity bit on completion of reception FE60 Status flag indicating framing error 0 If POWER60 = 0 and RXE60 = 0, or if ASIS60 register is read 1 If the stop bit is not detected on completion of reception OVE60 Status flag indicating overrun error 0 If POWER60 = 0 and RXE60 = 0, or if ASIS60 register is read 1 If receive data is set to the RXB60 register and the next reception operation is completed before the data is read. Cautions 1. The operation of the PE60 bit differs depending on the set values of the PS610 and PS600 bits of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 60 (ASIM60). 2. The first bit of the receive data is checked as the stop bit, regardless of the number of stop bits. 3. If an overrun error occurs, the next receive data is not written to receive buffer register 60 (RXB60) but discarded. 4. If data is read from ASIS60, a wait cycle is generated. Do not read data from ASIS60 when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the high-speed system clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. 296 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-10. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Reception Error Status Register 61 (ASIS61) Address: FF2FH After reset: 00H R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASIS61 0 0 0 0 0 PE61 FE61 OVE61 PE61 Status flag indicating parity error 0 If POWER61 = 0 and RXE61 = 0, or if ASIS61 register is read 1 If the parity of transmit data does not match the parity bit on completion of reception FE61 Status flag indicating framing error 0 If POWER61 = 0 and RXE61 = 0, or if ASIS61 register is read 1 If the stop bit is not detected on completion of reception OVE61 Status flag indicating overrun error 0 If POWER61 = 0 and RXE61 = 0, or if ASIS61 register is read 1 If receive data is set to the RXB61 register and the next reception operation is completed before the data is read. Cautions 1. The operation of the PE61 bit differs depending on the set values of the PS611 and PS601 bits of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 61 (ASIM61). 2. The first bit of the receive data is checked as the stop bit, regardless of the number of stop bits. 3. If an overrun error occurs, the next receive data is not written to receive buffer register 61 (RXB61) but discarded. 4. If data is read from ASIS61, a wait cycle is generated. Do not read data from ASIS6 when the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the high-speed system clock is stopped. For details, see CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 297 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (3) Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) This register indicates the status of transmission by serial interfaces UART60 and UART61. It includes two status flag bits (TXBF6n and TXSF6n). Transmission can be continued without disruption even during an interrupt period, by writing the next data to the TXB6n register after data has been transferred from the TXB6n register to the TXS6n register. This register is read-only by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation, or clearing bit 7 (POWER6n) or bit 6 (TXE6n) of ASIM6n to 0 clears this register to 00H. Figure 13-11. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Transmission Status Register 60 (ASIF60) Address: FF55H After reset: 00H R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASIF60 0 0 0 0 0 0 TXBF60 TXSF60 TXBF60 Transmit buffer data flag 0 If POWER60 = 0 or TXE60 = 0, or if data is transferred to transmit shift register 60 (TXS60) 1 If data is written to transmit buffer register 60 (TXB60) (if data exists in TXB60) TXSF60 0 Transmit shift register data flag If POWER60 = 0 or TXE60 = 0, or if the next data is not transferred from transmit buffer register 60 (TXB60) after completion of transfer 1 If data is transferred from transmit buffer register 60 (TXB60) (if data transmission is in progress) Cautions 1. To transmit data continuously, write the first transmit data (first byte) to the TXB60 register. Be sure to check that the TXBF60 flag is "0". If so, write the next transmit data (second byte) to the TXB60 register. If data is written to the TXB60 register while the TXBF60 flag is "1", the transmit data cannot be guaranteed. 2. To initialize the transmission unit upon completion of continuous transmission, be sure to check that the TXSF60 flag is "0" after generation of the transmission completion interrupt, and then execute initialization. If initialization is executed while the TXSF60 flag is "1", the transmit data cannot be guaranteed. 298 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-12. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Transmission Status Register 61 (ASIF61) Address: FF38H After reset: 00H R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASIF61 0 0 0 0 0 0 TXBF61 TXSF61 TXBF61 Transmit buffer data flag 0 If POWER61 = 0 or TXE61 = 0, or if data is transferred to transmit shift register 61 (TXS61) 1 If data is written to transmit buffer register 61 (TXB61) (if data exists in TXB61) TXSF61 Transmit shift register data flag 0 If POWER61 = 0 or TXE61 = 0, or if the next data is not transferred from transmit buffer register 61 (TXB61) after completion of transfer 1 If data is transferred from transmit buffer register 61 (TXB61) (if data transmission is in progress) Cautions 1. To transmit data continuously, write the first transmit data (first byte) to the TXB61 register. Be sure to check that the TXBF61 flag is "0". If so, write the next transmit data (second byte) to the TXB61 register. If data is written to the TXB61 register while the TXBF61 flag is "1", the transmit data cannot be guaranteed. 2. To initialize the transmission unit upon completion of continuous transmission, be sure to check that the TXSF61 flag is "0" after generation of the transmission completion interrupt, and then execute initialization. If initialization is executed while the TXSF61 flag is "1", the transmit data cannot be guaranteed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 299 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (4) Clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) This register selects the base clocks of serial interface UART60 and UART61. CKSR6n can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Remark CKSR6n can be refreshed (the same value is written) by software during a communication operation (when bits 7 and 6 (POWER6n, TXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1 or bits 7 and 5 (POWER6n, RXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1). Figure 13-13. Format of Clock Selection Register 60 (CKSR60) Address: FF56H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CKSR60 0 0 0 0 TPS630 TPS620 TPS610 TPS600 TPS630 TPS620 TPS610 TPS600 Base clock (fXCLK6) selection 0 0 0 0 fPRS 0 0 0 1 fPRS/2 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 fPRS = fPRS = fPRS = fPRS = 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 2 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz fPRS/2 3 500 kHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz fPRS/2 4 250 kHz 312.5 kHz 625 kHz fPRS/2 5 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz 0 1 1 0 fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 78.13 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 0 1 1 1 fPRS/2 7 31.25 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz 156.25 kHz 1 0 0 0 fPRS/2 8 15.625 kHz 19.53 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz fPRS/2 9 7.813 kHz 9.77 kHz 19.53 kHz 39.06 kHz fPRS/2 10 3.906 kHz 4.88 kHz 9.77 kHz 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 Other than above TM50 output 19.53 kHz Note Setting prohibited Note Note the following points when selecting the TM50 output as the base clock. * Mode in which the count clock is cleared and started upon a match of TM50 and CR50 (TMC506 = 0) Start the operation of 8-bit timer/event counter 50 first and then enable the timer F/F inversion operation (TMC501 = 1). * PWM mode (TMC506 = 1) Start the operation of 8-bit timer/event counter 50 first and then set the count clock to make the duty = 50%. It is not necessary to enable the TO50 pin as a timer output pin in any mode. Caution Make sure POWER60 = 0 when rewriting TPS630 to TPS600. Remarks 1. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 2. TMC506: Bit 6 of 8-bit timer mode control register 50 (TMC50) TMC501: Bit 1 of TMC50 300 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-14. Format of Clock Selection Register 61 (CKSR61) Address: FF39H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CKSR61 0 0 0 0 TPS631 TPS621 TPS611 TPS601 TPS631 TPS621 TPS611 TPS601 Base clock (fXCLK6) selection 0 0 0 0 fPRS 0 0 0 1 fPRS/2 fPRS = fPRS = fPRS = fPRS = 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 4 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 20 MHz 2 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz 0 0 1 0 fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz 0 0 1 1 fPRS/2 3 500 kHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz fPRS/2 4 250 kHz 312.5 kHz 625 kHz fPRS/2 5 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 625 kHz fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 78.13 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz fPRS/2 7 31.25 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz 156.25 kHz fPRS/2 8 15.625 kHz 19.53 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz fPRS/2 9 7.813 kHz 9.77 kHz 19.53 kHz 39.06 kHz 10 3.906 kHz 4.88 kHz 9.77 kHz 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 fPRS/2 1 0 1 1 TM50 output Other than above 1.25 MHz 19.53 kHz Note Setting prohibited Note Note the following points when selecting the TM50 output as the base clock. * Mode in which the count clock is cleared and started upon a match of TM50 and CR50 (TMC506 = 0) Start the operation of 8-bit timer/event counter 50 first and then enable the timer F/F inversion operation (TMC501 = 1). * PWM mode (TMC506 = 1) Start the operation of 8-bit timer/event counter 50 first and then set the count clock to make the duty = 50%. It is not necessary to enable the TO50 pin as a timer output pin in any mode. Caution Make sure POWER61 = 0 when rewriting TPS631 to TPS601. Remarks 1. fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency 2. TMC506: Bit 6 of 8-bit timer mode control register 50 (TMC50) TMC501: Bit 1 of TMC50 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 301 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (5) Baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) This register sets the division value of the 8-bit counters of serial interface UART60 and UART61. BRGC6n can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. Remark BRGC6n can be refreshed (the same value is written) by software during a communication operation (when bits 7 and 6 (POWER6n, TXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1 or bits 7 and 5 (POWER6n, RXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1). Figure 13-15. Format of Baud Rate Generator Control Register 60 (BRGC60) Address: FF57H After reset: FFH R/W Symbol BRGC60 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDL670 MDL660 MDL650 MDL640 MDL630 MDL620 MDL610 MDL600 MDL670 MDL660 MDL650 MDL640 MDL630 MDL620 MDL610 MDL600 k Output clock selection of 8-bit counter 0 0 0 0 0 0 x x x Setting prohibited 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 4 fXCLK6/4 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 5 fXCLK6/5 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 6 fXCLK6/6 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 252 fXCLK6/252 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 253 fXCLK6/253 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 254 fXCLK6/254 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 255 fXCLK6/255 Cautions 1. Make sure that bit 6 (TXE60) and bit 5 (RXE60) of the ASIM6n register = 0 when rewriting the MDL670 to MDL600 bits. 2. The baud rate is the output clock of the 8-bit counter divided by 2. Remarks 1. fXCLK6: Frequency of base clock selected by the TPS630 to TPS600 bits of CKSR60 register 2. k: Value set by MDL670 to MDL600 bits (k = 4, 5, 6, ..., 255) 3. x: Don't care 302 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-16. Format of Baud Rate Generator Control Register 61 (BRGC61) Address: FF3EH After reset: FFH R/W Symbol BRGC61 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDL671 MDL661 MDL651 MDL641 MDL631 MDL621 MDL611 MDL601 MDL671 MDL661 MDL651 MDL641 MDL631 MDL621 MDL611 MDL601 k Output clock selection of 8-bit counter 0 0 0 0 0 0 x x x Setting prohibited 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 4 fXCLK6/4 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 5 fXCLK6/5 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 6 fXCLK6/6 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 252 fXCLK6/252 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 253 fXCLK6/253 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 254 fXCLK6/254 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 255 fXCLK6/255 Cautions 1. Make sure that bit 6 (TXE61) and bit 5 (RXE61) of the ASIM61 register = 0 when rewriting the MDL671 to MDL601 bits. 2. The baud rate is the output clock of the 8-bit counter divided by 2. Remarks 1. fXCLK6: Frequency of base clock selected by the TPS631 to TPS601 bits of CKSR61 register 2. k: Value set by MDL671 to MDL601 bits (k = 4, 5, 6, ..., 255) 3. x: Don't care User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 303 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (6) Asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) This register controls the serial communication operations of serial interface UART60 and UART61. ASICL6n can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 16H. Caution ASICL6n can be refreshed (the same value is written) by software during a communication operation (when bits 7 and 6 (POWER6n, TXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1 or bits 7 and 5 (POWER6n, RXE6n) of ASIM6n = 1). However, do not set both SBRT6n and SBTT6n to 1 by a refresh operation during SBF reception (SBRT6n = 1) or SBF transmission (until INTST6n occurs since SBTT6n has been set (1)), because it may re-trigger SBF reception or SBF transmission. Figure 13-17. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Control Register 60 (ASICL60) (1/2) Address: FF58H After reset: 16H R/W Note Symbol <7> <6> 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASICL60 SBRF60 SBRT60 SBTT60 SBL620 SBL610 SBL600 DIR60 TXDLV60 SBRF60 SBF reception status flag 0 If POWER60 = 0 and RXE60 = 0 or if SBF reception has been completed correctly 1 SBF reception in progress SBRT60 SBF reception trigger - 0 1 SBF reception trigger SBTT60 SBF transmission trigger - 0 1 SBF transmission trigger Note Bit 7 is read-only. 304 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-17. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Control Register 60 (ASICL60) (2/2) SBL620 SBL610 SBL600 SBF transmission output width control 1 0 1 SBF is output with 13-bit length. 1 1 0 SBF is output with 14-bit length. 1 1 1 SBF is output with 15-bit length. 0 0 0 SBF is output with 16-bit length. 0 0 1 SBF is output with 17-bit length. 0 1 0 SBF is output with 18-bit length. 0 1 1 SBF is output with 19-bit length. 1 0 0 SBF is output with 20-bit length. DIR60 First-bit specification 0 MSB 1 LSB TXDLV60 Enables/disables inverting TXD6n output 0 Normal output of TXD60 1 Inverted output of TXD60 Cautions 1. In the case of an SBF reception error, the mode returns to the SBF reception mode. The status of the SBRF60 flag is held (1). 2. Before setting the SBRT60 bit, make sure that bit 7 (POWER60) and bit 5 (RXE60) of ASIM60 = 1. After setting the SBRT60 bit to 1, do not clear it to 0 before SBF reception is completed (before an interrupt request signal is generated). 3. The read value of the SBRT60 bit is always 0. SBRT60 is automatically cleared to 0 after SBF reception has been correctly completed. 4. Before setting the SBTT60 bit to 1, make sure that bit 7 (POWER60) and bit 6 (TXE60) of ASIM60 = 1. After setting the SBTT60 bit to 1, do not clear it to 0 before SBF transmission is completed (before an interrupt request signal is generated). 5. The read value of the SBTT60 bit is always 0. SBTT60 is automatically cleared to 0 at the end of SBF transmission. 6. Do not set the SBRT60 bit to 1 during reception, and do not set the SBTT60 bit to 1 during transmission. 7 Before rewriting the DIR60 and TXDLV60 bits, clear the TXE60 and RXE60 bits to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 305 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-18. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Control Register 61 (ASICL61) (1/2) Address: FF3FH After reset: 16H R/W Note Symbol <7> <6> 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASICL61 SBRF61 SBRT61 SBTT61 SBL621 SBL611 SBL601 DIR61 TXDLV61 SBRF61 SBF reception status flag 0 If POWER61 = 0 and RXE61 = 0 or if SBF reception has been completed correctly 1 SBF reception in progress SBRT61 SBF reception trigger 0 - 1 SBF reception trigger SBTT61 SBF transmission trigger 0 - 1 SBF transmission trigger Note Bit 7 is read-only. 306 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-18. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Control Register 61 (ASICL61) (2/2) SBL621 SBL611 SBL601 SBF transmission output width control 1 0 1 SBF is output with 13-bit length. 1 1 0 SBF is output with 14-bit length. 1 1 1 SBF is output with 15-bit length. 0 0 0 SBF is output with 16-bit length. 0 0 1 SBF is output with 17-bit length. 0 1 0 SBF is output with 18-bit length. 0 1 1 SBF is output with 19-bit length. 1 0 0 SBF is output with 20-bit length. DIR61 First-bit specification 0 MSB 1 LSB TXDLV61 Enables/disables inverting TXD6n output 0 Normal output of TXD6n 1 Inverted output of TXD6n Cautions 1. In the case of an SBF reception error, the mode returns to the SBF reception mode. The status of the SBRF61 flag is held (1). 2. Before setting the SBRT61 bit, make sure that bit 7 (POWER61) and bit 5 (RXE61) of ASIM61 = 1. After setting the SBRT61 bit to 1, do not clear it to 0 before SBF reception is completed (before an interrupt request signal is generated). 3. The read value of the SBRT61 bit is always 0. SBRT61 is automatically cleared to 0 after SBF reception has been correctly completed. 4. Before setting the SBTT61 bit to 1, make sure that bit 7 (POWER61) and bit 6 (TXE61) of ASIM61 = 1. After setting the SBTT61 bit to 1, do not clear it to 0 before SBF transmission is completed (before an interrupt request signal is generated). 5. The read value of the SBTT61 bit is always 0. SBTT61 is automatically cleared to 0 at the end of SBF transmission. 6. Do not set the SBRT61 bit to 1 during reception, and do not set the SBTT61 bit to 1 during transmission. 7. Before rewriting the DIR61 and TXDLV61 bits, clear the TXE61 and RXE61 bits to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 307 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (7) Input switch control register (ISC) The input switch control register (ISC) is used to receive a status signal transmitted from the master during LIN (Local Interconnect Network) reception. The input source is switched by setting ISC. This register can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 13-19. Format of Input Switch Control Register (ISC) Address: FF4FH Symbol ISC After reset: 00H 7 ISC7 R/W 6 0 ISC7 5 0 4 3 ISC4 ISC3 1 Note Interrupt source selection 0 INTWTI 1 INTDMU ISC4 INTP1 input source selection 0 INTP1 (P30) 1 RxD61(P11) ISC3 INTP0 input source selection 0 INTP0 (P120) 1 RxD60 (P14) ISC1 TI010 input source selection 0 TI010 (P01) 1 RxD60 (P14) ISC0 TI000 input source selection 0 TI000 (P00) 1 TSOUT Note Be sure to set bit 2 of ISC to 1. 308 2 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 1 0 ISC1 ISC0 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (8) Port mode register 1 (PM1) This register sets port 1 input/output in 1-bit units. When using the P13/TxD60 and P10/SCK10/TxD61 pins for serial interface data output, clear PM13 and PM10 to 0 and set the output latch of P13 and P10 to 1. When using the P14/RxD60 and P11/SI10/RxD61 in for serial interface data input, set PM14 and PM11 to 1. The output latch of P14 and P11 at this time may be 0 or 1. PM1 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to FFH. Figure 13-20. Format of Port Mode Register 1 (PM1) Address: FF21H Symbol PM1 After reset: FFH R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM17 PM16 PM15 PM14 PM13 PM12 PM11 PM10 PM1n P1n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 7) 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 309 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 13.4 Operations of Serial Interface UART60 and UART61 Serial interfaces UART60 and UART61 have the following two modes. * Operation stop mode * Asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode 13.4.1 Operation stop mode In this mode, serial communication cannot be executed; therefore, the power consumption can be reduced. In addition, the pins can be used as ordinary port pins in this mode. To set the operation stop mode, clear bits 7, 6, and 5 (POWER6n, TXE6n, and RXE6n) of ASIM6n to 0. (1) Register used The operation stop mode is set by asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n). ASIM6n can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 01H. Address: FF50H After reset: 01H R/W Symbol <7> <6> <5> 4 3 2 1 0 ASIM6n POWER6n TXE6n RXE6n PS61n PS60n CL6n SL6n ISRM6n POWER6n 0 Note 1 Enables/disables operation of internal operation clock Disables operation of the internal operation clock (fixes the clock to low level) and asynchronously resets the internal circuit TXE6n 0 Notes 1. . Enables/disables transmission Disables transmission operation (synchronously resets the transmission circuit). RXE6n 0 Note 2 Enables/disables reception Disables reception (synchronously resets the reception circuit). The output of the TXD6n pins goes high and the input from the RXD6n pins is fixed to high level when POWER6n = 0. 2. Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n), asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n), bit 7 (SBRF6n) and bit 6 (SBRT6n) of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n), and receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n) are reset. Caution Clear POWER6n to 0 after clearing TXE6n and RXE6n to 0 to stop the operation. To start the communication, set POWER6n to 1, and then set TXE6n and RXE6n to 1. Remarks 1. To use the RxD60/P14, RxD61/P11/SI10, TxD60/P13 and TxD61/P10/SCK10 pins as generalpurpose port pins, see CHAPTER 4 PORT FUNCTIONS. 2. 310 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 13.4.2 Asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode In this mode, data of 1 byte is transmitted/received following a start bit, and a full-duplex operation can be performed. A dedicated UART baud rate generator is incorporated, so that communication can be executed at a wide range of baud rates. (1) Registers used * Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) * Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n) * Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) * Clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) * Baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) * Asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) * Input switch control register (ISC) * Port mode register 1 (PM1) * Port register 1 (P1) The basic procedure of setting an operation in the UART mode is as follows. <1> Set the CKSR6n register (see Figure 13-13, 13-14). <2> Set the BRGC6n register (see Figure 13-15, 13-16). <3> Set bits 0 to 4 (ISRM6n, SL6n, CL6n, PS60n, PS61n) of the ASIM6n register (see Figure 13-7, 13-8). <4> Set bits 0 and 1 (TXDLV6n, DIR6n) of the ASICL6n register (see Figure 13-17, 13-18). <5> Set bit 7 (POWER6n) of the ASIM6n register to 1. <6> Set bit 6 (TXE6n) of the ASIM6n register to 1. Transmission is enabled. Set bit 5 (RXE6n) of the ASIM6n register to 1. Reception is enabled. <7> Write data to transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n). Data transmission is started. Caution Take relationship with the other party of communication when setting the port mode register and port register. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 311 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 The relationship between the register settings and pins is shown below. Table 13-2. Relationship Between Register Settings and Pins (a) UART60 POWER6n TXE6n RXE6n PM13 P13 PM14 P14 UART60 Operation 0 0 0 x Note x Note 1 0 1 x Note x Note 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 x Note x 1 x Note RxD60/P14 Stop P13 P14 P13 RxD60 Note Transmission TxD60 P14 x Transmission/ TxD60 RxD60 x 1 TxD60/P13 Reception x Note Pin Function reception (b) UART61 POWER6n TXE6n 0 0 1 0 RXE6n 0 1 PM10 x Note x Note P10 PM11 Pin Function TxD61/P10/SCK61 RxD61/P11/SI10 Stop P10 P11 RxD61 x x Note 1 x Reception P10 Note Note Transmission TxD61 P11 x Transmission/ TxD61 RxD61 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 x 1 x x Note UART61 Operation Note x Note P11 reception Note Can be set as port function. Remark x: don't care POWER6n: Bit 7 of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) TXE6n: Bit 6 of ASIM6n RXE6n: Bit 5 of ASIM6n PM1x: Port mode register P1x: Port output latch n = 0, 1 312 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (2) Communication operation (a) Format and waveform example of normal transmit/receive data Figures 13-21 and 13-22 show the format and waveform example of the normal transmit/receive data. Figure 13-21. Format of Normal UART Transmit/Receive Data 1. LSB-first transmission/reception 1 data frame Start bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity bit Stop bit D1 D0 Parity bit Stop bit Character bits 2. MSB-first transmission/reception 1 data frame Start bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 Character bits One data frame consists of the following bits. * Start bit ... 1 bit * Character bits ... 7 or 8 bits * Parity bit ... Even parity, odd parity, 0 parity, or no parity * Stop bit ... 1 or 2 bits The character bit length, parity, and stop bit length in one data frame are specified by asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n). Whether data is communicated with the LSB or MSB first is specified by bit 1 (DIR6) of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n). Whether the TXD6n pins outputs normal or inverted data is specified by bit 0 (TXDLV6) of ASICL6n. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 313 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-22. Example of Normal UART Transmit/Receive Data Waveform 1. Data length: 8 bits, LSB first, Parity: Even parity, Stop bit: 1 bit, Communication data: 55H 1 data frame Start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop 2. Data length: 8 bits, MSB first, Parity: Even parity, Stop bit: 1 bit, Communication data: 55H 1 data frame Start D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Parity Stop 3. Data length: 8 bits, MSB first, Parity: Even parity, Stop bit: 1 bit, Communication data: 55H, TXD6n pin inverted output 1 data frame Start D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Parity Stop 4. Data length: 7 bits, LSB first, Parity: Odd parity, Stop bit: 2 bits, Communication data: 36H 1 data frame Start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 Parity Stop 5. Data length: 8 bits, LSB first, Parity: None, Stop bit: 1 bit, Communication data: 87H 1 data frame Start Remark 314 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD D6 D7 Stop Stop CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (b) Parity types and operation The parity bit is used to detect a bit error in communication data. Usually, the same type of parity bit is used on both the transmission and reception sides. With even parity and odd parity, a 1-bit (odd number) error can be detected. With zero parity and no parity, an error cannot be detected. Caution Fix the PS61n and PS60n bits to 0 when the device is used in LIN communication operation. (i) Even parity * Transmission Transmit data, including the parity bit, is controlled so that the number of bits that are "1" is even. The value of the parity bit is as follows. If transmit data has an odd number of bits that are "1": 1 If transmit data has an even number of bits that are "1": 0 * Reception The number of bits that are "1" in the receive data, including the parity bit, is counted. If it is odd, a parity error occurs. (ii) Odd parity * Transmission Unlike even parity, transmit data, including the parity bit, is controlled so that the number of bits that are "1" is odd. If transmit data has an odd number of bits that are "1": 0 If transmit data has an even number of bits that are "1": 1 * Reception The number of bits that are "1" in the receive data, including the parity bit, is counted. If it is even, a parity error occurs. (iii) 0 parity The parity bit is cleared to 0 when data is transmitted, regardless of the transmit data. The parity bit is not detected when the data is received. Therefore, a parity error does not occur regardless of whether the parity bit is "0" or "1". (iv) No parity No parity bit is appended to the transmit data. Reception is performed assuming that there is no parity bit when data is received. Because there is no parity bit, a parity error does not occur. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 315 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (c) Normal transmission When bit 7 (POWER6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is set to 1 and bit 6 (TXE6n) of ASIM6n is then set to 1, transmission is enabled. Transmission can be started by writing transmit data to transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n). The start bit, parity bit, and stop bit are automatically appended to the data. When transmission is started, the data in TXB6n is transferred to transmit shift register 6n (TXS6n). After that, the data is sequentially output from TXS6n to the TXD6n pins. When transmission is completed, the parity and stop bits set by ASIM6n are appended and a transmission completion interrupt request (INTST6n) is generated. Transmission is stopped until the data to be transmitted next is written to TXB6n. Figure 13-23 shows the timing of the transmission completion interrupt request (INTST6n). This interrupt occurs as soon as the last stop bit has been output. Figure 13-23. Normal Transmission Completion Interrupt Request Timing 1. Stop bit length: 1 TXD6n (output) Start D0 D1 D2 D6 D7 Parity Start D0 D1 D2 D6 D7 Parity Stop INTST6n 2. Stop bit length: 2 TXD6n (output) INTST6n Remark 316 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Stop CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (d) Continuous transmission The next transmit data can be written to transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n) as soon as transmit shift register 6 (TXS6n) has started its shift operation. Consequently, even while the INTST6n interrupt is being serviced after transmission of one data frame, data can be continuously transmitted and an efficient communication rate can be realized. In addition, the TXB6n register can be efficiently written twice (2 bytes) without having to wait for the transmission time of one data frame, by reading bit 0 (TXSF6n) of asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) when the transmission completion interrupt has occurred. To transmit data continuously, be sure to reference the ASIF6n register to check the transmission status and whether the TXB6n register can be written, and then write the data. Cautions 1. The TXBF6n and TXSF6n flags of the ASIF6n register change from "10" to "11", and to "01" during continuous transmission. To check the status, therefore, do not use a combination of the TXBF6n and TXSF6n flags for judgment. Read only the TXBF6n flag when executing continuous transmission. 2. When the device is used in LIN communication operation, the continuous transmission function cannot be used. Make sure that asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) is 00H before writing transmit data to transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n). TXBF6n Writing to TXB6 Register 0 Writing enabled 1 Writing disabled Caution To transmit data continuously, write the first transmit data (first byte) to the TXB6n register. Be sure to check that the TXBF6n flag is "0". If so, write the next transmit data (second byte) to the TXB6n register. If data is written to the TXB6n register while the TXBF6n flag is "1", the transmit data cannot be guaranteed. The communication status can be checked using the TXSF6n flag. TXSF6n Transmission Status 0 Transmission is completed. 1 Transmission is in progress. Cautions 1. To initialize the transmission unit upon completion of continuous transmission, be sure to check that the TXSF6n flag is "0" after generation of the transmission completion interrupt, and then execute initialization. If initialization is executed while the TXSF6n flag is "1", the transmit data cannot be guaranteed. 2. During continuous transmission, an overrun error may occur, which means that the next transmission was completed before execution of TXSF6n interrupt servicing after transmission of one data frame. An overrun error can be detected by developing a program that can count the number of transmit data and by referencing the TXSF6n flag. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 317 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-24 shows an example of the continuous transmission processing flow. Figure 13-24. Example of Continuous Transmission Processing Flow Set registers. Write TXB6n. Transfer executed necessary number of times? Yes No Read ASIF6n TXBF6n = 0? No Yes Write TXB6n. Transmission completion interrupt occurs? No Yes Transfer executed necessary number of times? Yes No Read ASIF6n TXSF6n = 0? Yes Yes of Completion transmission processing Remark TXB6n: Transmit buffer register 6n ASIF6n: Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n TXBF6n: Bit 1 of ASIF6n (transmit buffer data flag) TXSF6n: Bit 0 of ASIF6n (transmit shift register data flag) n = 0, 1 318 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD No CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-25 shows the timing of starting continuous transmission, and Figure 13-25 shows the timing of ending continuous transmission. Figure 13-25. Timing of Starting Continuous Transmission Start TXD6n Data (1) Parity Stop Start Data (2) Parity Stop Start INTST6n TXB6n FF TXS6n FF Data (1) Data (2) Data (1) Data (3) Data (2) Data (3) TXBF6n Note TXSF6n Note When ASIF6n is read, there is a period in which TXBF6n and TXSF6n = 1, 1. Therefore, judge whether writing is enabled using only the TXBF6n bit. Remark TXD6n: TxD6n pins (output) INTST6n: Interrupt request signal TXB6n: Transmit buffer register 6n TXS6n: Transmit shift register 6n ASIF6n: Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n TXBF6n: Bit 1 of ASIF6n TXSF6n: Bit 0 of ASIF6n n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 319 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-26. Timing of Ending Continuous Transmission TXD6n Stop Data (n - 1) Start Parity Stop Start Data (n) Parity Stop INTST6n TXB6n Data (n - 1) Data (n) Data (n - 1) TXS6n Data (n) TXBF6n TXSF6n POWER6n or TXE6n Remark TXD6n: TXD6n pins (output) INTST6n: Interrupt request signal TXB6n: Transmit buffer register 6n TXS6n: Transmit shift register 6n ASIF6n: Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n TXBF6n: Bit 1 of ASIF6n TXSF6n: Bit 0 of ASIF6n POWER6n: Bit 7 of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register (ASIM6n) TXE6n: Bit 6 of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register (ASIM6n) n = 0, 1 320 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD FF CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (e) Normal reception Reception is enabled and the RXD6n pins input is sampled when bit 7 (POWER6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is set to 1 and then bit 5 (RXE6n) of ASIM6n is set to 1. The 8-bit counter of the baud rate generator starts counting when the falling edge of the RXD6n pins input is detected. When the set value of baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) has been counted, the RXD6n pins input is sampled again ( in Figure 13-27). If the RXD6n pins are low level at this time, it is recognized as a start bit. When the start bit is detected, reception is started, and serial data is sequentially stored in the receive shift register (RXS6n) at the set baud rate. When the stop bit has been received, the reception completion interrupt (INTSR6n) is generated and the data of RXS6n is written to receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n). If an overrun error (OVE6n) occurs, however, the receive data is not written to RXB6n. Even if a parity error (PE6n) occurs while reception is in progress, reception continues to the reception position of the stop bit, and an error interrupt (INTSR6n/INTSRE6n) is generated on completion of reception. Figure 13-27. Reception Completion Interrupt Request Timing RXD6n (input) Start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop INTSR6n RXB6n Cautions 1. If a reception error occurs, read ASIS6n and then RXB6n to clear the error flag. Otherwise, an overrun error will occur when the next data is received, and the reception error status will persist. 2. Reception is always performed with the "number of stop bits = 1". The second stop bit is ignored. 3. Be sure to read asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n) before reading RXB6n. Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 321 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (f) Reception error Three types of errors may occur during reception: a parity error, framing error, or overrun error. If the error flag of asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n) is set as a result of data reception, a reception error interrupt request (INTSR6n/INTSRE6n) is generated. Which error has occurred during reception can be identified by reading the contents of ASIS6n in the reception error interrupt servicing (INTSR6n/INTSRE6n) (see Figure 13-9, 13-10). The contents of ASIS6n are cleared to 0 when ASIS6n is read. Table 13-3. Cause of Reception Error Reception Error Cause Parity error The parity specified for transmission does not match the parity of the receive data. Framing error Stop bit is not detected. Overrun error Reception of the next data is completed before data is read from receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n). The error interrupt can be separated into reception completion interrupt (INTSR6n) and error interrupt (INTSRE6n) by clearing bit 0 (ISRM6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) to 0. Figure 13-28. Reception Error Interrupt 1. If ISRM6n is cleared to 0 (reception completion interrupt (INTSR6n) and error interrupt (INTSRE6n) are separated) (a) No error during reception (b) Error during reception INTSR6n INTSR6n INTSRE6n INTSRE6n 2. If ISRM6n is set to 1 (error interrupt is included in INTSR6n) (a) No error during reception INTSR6n INTSR6n INTSRE6n INTSRE6n Remark 322 (b) Error during reception n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (g) Noise filter of receive data The RXD6n signal's is sampled with the base clock output by the prescaler block. If two sampled values are the same, the output of the match detector changes, and the data is sampled as input data. Because the circuit is configured as shown in Figure 13-29, the internal processing of the reception operation is delayed by two clocks from the external signal status. Figure 13-29. Noise Filter Circuit Base clock RXD60/P14 RxD61/P11SI10 In Q Internal signal A Match detector User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD In Q Internal signal B LD_EN 323 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (h) SBF transmission When the device is used in LIN communication operation, the SBF (Synchronous Break Field) transmission control function is used for transmission. For the transmission operation of LIN, see Figure 13-1 LIN Transmission Operation. When bit 7 (POWER6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is set to 1 and bit 6 (TXE6n) of ASIM6n is then set to 1, transmission is enabled. SBF transmission can be started by setting bit 5 (SBTT6n) of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) to 1. Thereafter, a low level of bits 13 to 20 (set by bits 4 to 2 (SBL62n to SBL60n) of ASICL6n) is output. Following the end of SBF transmission, the transmission completion interrupt request (INTST6n) is generated and SBTT6n is automatically cleared. Thereafter, the normal transmission mode is restored. Transmission is suspended until the data to be transmitted next is written to transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n), or until SBTT6n is set to 1. Remark n = 0, 1 Figure 13-30. SBF Transmission TXD6n 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 INTST6n SBTT6n TXD6n pins (output) Remark TXD6n: INTST6n: Transmission completion interrupt request SBTT6n: Bit 5 of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) n = 0, 1 324 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Stop CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (i) SBF reception When the device is incorporated in LIN, the SBF (Synchronous Break Field) reception control function is used for reception. For the reception operation of LIN, see Figure 13-2 LIN Reception Operation. Reception is enabled when bit 7 (POWER6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is set to 1 and then bit 5 (RXE6n) of ASIM6n is set to 1. SBF reception is enabled when bit 6 (SBRT6n) of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) is set to 1. In the SBF reception enabled status, the RXD6n pins are sampled and the start bit is detected in the same manner as the normal reception enable status. When the start bit has been detected, reception is started, and serial data is sequentially stored in the receive shift register 6n (RXS6n) at the set baud rate. When the stop bit is received and if the width of SBF is 11 bits or more, a reception completion interrupt request (INTSR6n) is generated as normal processing. At this time, the SBRF6n and SBRT6n bits are automatically cleared, and SBF reception ends. Detection of errors, such as OVE6n, PE6n, and FE6n (bits 0 to 2 of asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 6n (ASIS6n)) is suppressed, and error detection processing of UART communication is not performed. In addition, data transfer between receive shift register 6n (RXS6n) and receive buffer register 6n (RXB6n) is not performed, and the reset value of FFH is retained. If the width of SBF is 10 bits or less, an interrupt does not occur as error processing after the stop bit has been received, and the SBF reception mode is restored. In this case, the SBRF6n and SBRT6n bits are not cleared. Figure 13-31. SBF Reception 1. Normal SBF reception (stop bit is detected with a width of more than 10.5 bits) 1 RXD6n 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 SBRT6n /SBRF6n INTSR6n 2. SBF reception error (stop bit is detected with a width of 10.5 bits or less) 1 RXD6n 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 SBRT6n /SBRF6n INTSR6n "0" Remark RXD6n: RXD6n pins (input) SBRT6n: Bit 6 of asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) SBRF6n: Bit 7 of ASICL6n INTSR6n: Reception completion interrupt request n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 325 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 13.4.3 Dedicated baud rate generator The dedicated baud rate generator consists of a source clock selector and an 8-bit programmable counter, and generates a serial clock for transmission/reception of UART60 and UART61. Separate 8-bit counters are provided for transmission and reception. (1) Configuration of baud rate generator * Base clock The clock selected by bits 3 to 0 (TPS63n to TPS60n) of clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) is supplied to each module when bit 7 (POWER6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is 1. This clock is called the base clock and its frequency is called fXCLK6. The base clock is fixed to low level when POWER6n = 0. * Transmission counter This counter stops operation, cleared to 0, when bit 7 (POWER6n) or bit 6 (TXE6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is 0. It starts counting when POWER6n = 1 and TXE6n = 1. The counter is cleared to 0 when the first data transmitted is written to transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n). If data are continuously transmitted, the counter is cleared to 0 again when one frame of data has been completely transmitted. If there is no data to be transmitted next, the counter is not cleared to 0 and continues counting until POWER6n or TXE6n is cleared to 0. * Reception counter This counter stops operation, cleared to 0, when bit 7 (POWER6n) or bit 5 (RXE6n) of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) is 0. It starts counting when the start bit has been detected. The counter stops operation after one frame has been received, until the next start bit is detected. Remark 326 n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Figure 13-32. Configuration of Baud Rate Generator POWER6n fPRS Baud rate generator fPRS/2 fPRS/22 POWER6n, TXE6n (or RXE6n) fPRS/23 fPRS/24 fPRS/25 Selector fPRS/26 8-bit counter fXCLK6 fPRS/27 fPRS/28 fPRS/29 fPRS/210 8-bit timer/ event counter 50 output Match detector CKSR6n: TPS63n to TPS60n Remark 1/2 Baud rate BRGC6n: MDL67n to MDL60n POWER6n: Bit 7 of asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 6n (ASIM6n) TXE6n: Bit 6 of ASIM6n RXE6n: Bit 5 of ASIM6n CKSR6n: Clock selection register 6n BRGC6n: Baud rate generator control register 6n n = 0, 1 (2) Generation of serial clock A serial clock can be generated by using clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) and baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n). Select the clock to be input to the 8-bit counter by using bits 3 to 0 (TPS63n to TPS60n) of CKSR6n. Bits 7 to 0 (MDL67n to MDL60n) of BRGC6n can be used to select the division value of the 8-bit counter. (a) Baud rate The baud rate can be calculated by the following expression. * Baud rate = fXCLK6 2xk [bps] fXCLK6: Frequency of base clock selected by TPS63n to TPS60n bits of CKSR6n register k: Value set by MDL67n to MDL60n bits of BRGC6n register (k = 4, 5, 6, ..., 255) (b) Error of baud rate The baud rate error can be calculated by the following expression. * Error (%) = Actual baud rate (baud rate with error) Desired baud rate (correct baud rate) - 1 x 100 [%] User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 327 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Cautions 1. Keep the baud rate error during transmission to within the permissible error range at the reception destination. 2. Make sure that the baud rate error during reception satisfies the range shown in (4) Permissible baud rate range during reception. Example: Frequency of base clock = 10 MHz = 10,000,000 Hz Set value of MDL67n to MDL60n bits of BRGC6 register = 00100001B (k = 33) Target baud rate = 153600 bps Baud rate = 10 M/(2 x 33) = 10000000/(2 x 33) = 151,515 [bps] Error = (151515/153600 - 1) x 100 = -1.357 [%] (3) Example of setting baud rate Table 13-4. Set Data of Baud Rate Generator Baud Rate [bps] fPRS = 5.0 MHz TPS63n, k TPS60n fPRS = 10.0 MHz Calculated ERR TPS63n, Value [%] TPS60n k fPRS = 20.0 MHz Calculated ERR TPS63n, Value [%] TPS60n k Calculated ERR Value [%] 300 7H 65 301 0.16 8H 65 301 0.16 9H 65 301 0.16 600 6H 65 601 0.16 7H 65 601 0.16 8H 65 601 0.16 1200 5H 65 1202 0.16 6H 65 1202 0.16 7H 65 1202 0.16 2400 4H 65 2404 0.16 5H 65 2404 0.16 6H 65 2404 0.16 4800 3H 65 4808 0.16 4H 65 4808 0.16 5H 65 4808 0.16 9600 2H 65 9615 0.16 3H 65 9615 0.16 4H 65 9615 0.16 19200 1H 65 19231 0.16 2H 65 19231 0.16 3H 65 19231 0.16 24000 3H 13 24038 0.16 4H 13 24038 0.16 5H 13 24038 0.16 31250 4H 5 31250 0 5H 5 31250 0 6H 5 31250 0 38400 0H 65 38462 0.16 1H 65 38462 0.16 2H 65 38462 0.16 48000 2H 13 48077 0.16 3H 13 48077 0.16 4H 13 48077 0.16 76800 0H 33 75758 -1.36 0H 65 76923 0.16 1H 65 76923 0.16 115200 1H 11 113636 -1.36 0H 43 116279 0.94 0H 87 114943 -0.22 153600 1H 8 156250 1.73 0H 33 151515 -1.36 1H 33 151515 -1.36 312500 0H 8 312500 0 1H 8 312500 0 2H 8 312500 0 625000 0H 4 625000 0 1H 4 625000 0 2H 4 625000 0 Remark TPS63n to TPS60n: Bits 3 to 0 of clock selection register 6n (CKSR6n) (setting of base clock (fXCLK6)) k Value set by MDL67n to MDL60n bits of baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) (k = 4, 5, 6, ..., 255) fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency ERR: Baud rate error n = 0, 1 328 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (4) Permissible baud rate range during reception The permissible error from the baud rate at the transmission destination during reception is shown below. Caution Make sure that the baud rate error during reception is within the permissible error range, by using the calculation expression shown below. Figure 13-33. Permissible Baud Rate Range During Reception Latch timing Data frame lengtz of UART60 and UART61 Start bit Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 7 Parity bit Stop bit FL 1 data frame (11 x FL) Minimum permissible data frame length Start bit Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 7 Parity bit Stop bit FLmin Maximum permissible data frame length Start bit Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 7 Parity bit Stop bit FLmax As shown in Figure 13-33, the latch timing of the receive data is determined by the counter set by baud rate generator control register 6n (BRGC6n) after the start bit has been detected. If the last data (stop bit) meets this latch timing, the data can be correctly received. Assuming that 11-bit data is received, the theoretical values can be calculated as follows. FL = (Brate)-1 Brate: Baud rate of UART60 and UART61 k: Set value of BRGC6n FL: 1-bit data length Margin of latch timing: 2 clocks Remark n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 329 CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 Minimum permissible data frame length: FLmin = 11 x FL - k-2 2k x FL = 21k + 2 2k FL Therefore, the maximum receivable baud rate at the transmission destination is as follows. 22k BRmax = (FLmin/11)-1 = Brate 21k + 2 Similarly, the maximum permissible data frame length can be calculated as follows. 10 x FLmax = 11 x FL - 11 FLmax = 21k - 2 20k k+2 2xk x FL = 21k - 2 2xk FL FL x 11 Therefore, the minimum receivable baud rate at the transmission destination is as follows. BRmin = (FLmax/11)-1 = 20k 21k - 2 Brate The permissible baud rate error between UART60 and UART61 and the transmission destination can be calculated from the above minimum and maximum baud rate expressions, as follows. Table 13-5. Maximum/Minimum Permissible Baud Rate Error Division Ratio (k) Maximum Permissible Baud Rate Error Minimum Permissible Baud Rate Error 4 +2.33% -2.44% 8 +3.53% -3.61% 20 +4.26% -4.31% 50 +4.56% -4.58% 100 +4.66% -4.67% 255 +4.72% -4.73% Remarks 1. The permissible error of reception depends on the number of bits in one frame, input clock frequency, and division ratio (k). The higher the input clock frequency and the higher the division ratio (k), the higher the permissible error. 330 2. k: Set value of BRGC6n 3. n = 0, 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 13 SERIAL INTERFACES UART60 AND UART61 (5) Data frame length during continuous transmission When data is continuously transmitted, the data frame length from a stop bit to the next start bit is extended by two clocks of base clock from the normal value. However, the result of communication is not affected because the timing is initialized on the reception side when the start bit is detected. Figure 13-34. Data Frame Length During Continuous Transmission Start bit of second byte 1 data frame Start bit FL Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 7 FL FL FL Parity bit FL Stop bit FLstp Start bit FL Bit 0 FL Where the 1-bit data length is FL, the stop bit length is FLstp, and base clock frequency is fXCLK6, the following expression is satisfied. FLstp = FL + 2/fXCLK6 Therefore, the data frame length during continuous transmission is: Data frame length = 11 x FL + 2/fXCLK6 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 331 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 The 78K0/FC2 incorporate serial interface CSI10. 14.1 Functions of Serial Interface CSI10 Serial interface CSI10 has the following two modes. * Operation stop mode * 3-wire serial I/O mode (1) Operation stop mode This mode is used when serial communication is not performed and can enable a reduction in the power consumption. For details, see 14.4.1 Operation stop mode. (2) 3-wire serial I/O mode (MSB/LSB-first selectable) This mode is used to communicate 8-bit data using three lines: a serial clock line (SCK10) and two serial data lines (SI10 and SO10). The processing time of data communication can be shortened in the 3-wire serial I/O mode because transmission and reception can be simultaneously executed. In addition, whether 8-bit data is communicated with the MSB or LSB first can be specified, so this interface can be connected to any device. The 3-wire serial I/O mode is used for connecting peripheral ICs and display controllers with a clocked serial interface. For details, see 14.4.2 3-wire serial I/O mode. 332 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 14.2 Configuration of Serial Interface CSI10 Serial interface CSI10 includes the following hardware. Table 14-1. Configuration of Serial Interface CSI10 Item Configuration Transmit controller Controller Clock start/stop controller & clock phase controller Transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10) Registers Serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10) Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) Control registers Serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) Port mode register 1 (PM1) Port register 1 (P1) Figure 14-1. Block Diagram of Serial Interface CSI10 Internal bus Serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10) SI10/P11/RXD61 (a) 8 8 Transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10) Output selector SO10/P12 Output latch (P12) Output latch Transmit data controller PM12 Selector Transmit controller fPRS/2 fPRS/22 fPRS/23 fPRS/24 fPRS/25 fPRS/26 fPRS/27 SCK10/P10/TxD61 Clock start/stop controller & clock phase controller INTCSI10 Baud rate generator PM10 Remark Output latch (P10) (a): SO10 output User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 333 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (1) Transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10) This register sets the transmit data. Transmission/reception is started by writing data to SOTB10 when bit 7 (CSIE10) and bit 6 (TRMD10) of serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) is 1. The data written to SOTB10 is converted from parallel data into serial data by serial I/O shift register 10, and output to the serial output pin (SO10). SOTB10 can be written or read by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Caution Do not access SOTB10 when CSOT10 = 1 (during serial communication). (2) Serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10) This is an 8-bit register that converts data from parallel data into serial data and vice versa. This register can be read by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reception is started by reading data from SIO10 if bit 6 (TRMD10) of serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) is 0. During reception, the data is read from the serial input pin (SI10) to SIO10. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Caution Do not access SIO10 when CSOT10 = 1 (during serial communication). 334 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 14.3 Registers Controlling Serial Interface CSI10 Serial interface CSI10 is controlled by the following four registers. * Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) * Serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) * Port mode register 1 (PM1) * Port register 1 (P1) (1) Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) CSIM10 is used to select the operation mode and enable or disable operation. CSIM10 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 14-2. Format of Serial Operation Mode Register 10 (CSIM10) Address: FF80H After reset: 00H R/W Note 1 Symbol <7> 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CSIM10 CSIE10 TRMD10 0 DIR10 0 0 0 CSOT10 CSIE10 Operation control in 3-wire serial I/O mode Note 2 0 Disables operation 1 Enables operation and asynchronously resets the internal circuit Note 4 TRMD10 0 Note 5 1 DIR10 2. . Transmit/receive mode control Receive mode (transmission disabled). Transmit/receive mode Note 6 First bit specification 0 MSB 1 LSB CSOT10 Notes 1. Note 3 Communication status flag 0 Communication is stopped. 1 Communication is in progress. Bit 0 is a read-only bit. To use P10/SCK10/TXD61 and P12/SO10 as general-purpose ports, set CSIM10 in the default status (00H). 3. Bit 0 (CSOT10) of CSIM10 and serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10) are reset. 4. Do not rewrite TRMD10 when CSOT10 = 1 (during serial communication). 5. The SO10 output (see (a) in Figure 14-1) is fixed to the low level when TRMD10 is 0. Reception is started when data is read from SIO10. 6. Do not rewrite DIR10 when CSOT10 = 1 (during serial communication). Caution Be sure to clear bit 5 to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 335 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (2) Serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) This register specifies the timing of the data transmission/reception and sets the serial clock. CSIC10 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 14-3. Format of Serial Clock Selection Register 10 (CSIC10) Address: FF81H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CSIC10 0 0 0 CKP10 DAP10 CKS102 CKS101 CKS100 CKP10 DAP10 0 0 Specification of data transmission/reception timing 1 SCK10 SO10 Type D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 SI10 input timing 0 1 2 SCK10 SO10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 SI10 input timing 1 0 3 SCK10 SO10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 SI10 input timing 1 1 4 SCK10 SO10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 SI10 input timing CKS102 CKS101 0 0 0 0 0 1 CKS100 0 1 0 CSI10 serial clock selection fPRS/2 Mode fPRS = 4 MHz fPRS = 5 MHz fPRS = 10 MHz fPRS = 20 MHz 2 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz 10 MHz fPRS/2 2 1 MHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz 5 MHz fPRS/2 3 500 kHz 625 kHz 1.25 MHz 2.5 MHz 625 kHz 0 1 1 fPRS/2 4 250 kHz 312.5 kHz 1 0 0 fPRS/2 5 125 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 1 0 1 fPRS/2 6 62.5 kHz 78.13 kHz 7 31.25 kHz 39.06 kHz 78.13 kHz 1 1 0 fPRS/2 1 1 1 External clock input to SCK10 Master mode 1.25 MHz 625 kHz 156.25 kHz 312.5 kHz 156.25 kHz Slave mode Cautions 1. Do not write to CSIC10 while CSIE10 = 1 (operation enabled). 2. To use P10/SCK10/TXD61 and P12/SO10 as general-purpose ports, set CSIC10 in the default status (00H). 3. The phase type of the data clock is type 1 after reset. Remark 336 fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (3) Port mode registers 1 (PM1) These registers set port 1 input/output in 1-bit units. When using P10/SCK10 as the clock output pins of the serial interface, clear PM10 to 0, and the output latches of P10 to 1. When using P12/SO10 as the data output pins of the serial interface, clear PM12, P12 to 0. When using P10/SCK10/TxD61 as the clock input pins of the serial interface, P11/SI10/RxD61 as the data input pins, set PM10 and M11 to 1. At this time, the output latches of P10 and P11 may be 0 or 1. PM1 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets these registers to FFH. Figure 14-4. Format of Port Mode Register 1 (PM1) Address: FF21H After reset: FFH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM1 PM17 PM16 PM15 PM14 PM13 PM12 PM11 PM10 PM10 P1n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 7) 0 Output mode (Output buffer on) 1 Input mode (Output buffer off) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 337 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 14.4 Operation of Serial Interface CSI10 Serial interface CSI10 can be used in the following two modes. * Operation stop mode * 3-wire serial I/O mode 14.4.1 Operation stop mode Serial communication is not executed in this mode. Therefore, the power consumption can be reduced. In addition, the P10/SCK10/TXD61, P11/SI10/RXD61 and P12/SO10 pins can be used as ordinary I/O port pins in this mode. (1) Register used The operation stop mode is set by serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10). To set the operation stop mode, clear bit 7 (CSIE10) of CSIM10 to 0. (a) Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) CSIM10 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears CSIM10 to 00H. * Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) Address: FF80H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol <7> 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CSIM10 CSIE10 TRMD10 0 DIR10 0 0 0 CSOT10 CSIE10 0 Notes 1. 2. 338 Operation control in 3-wire serial I/O mode Note 1 Disables operation and asynchronously resets the internal circuit Note 2 . To use P10/SCK10/TXD61 and P12/SO10 as general-purpose ports, set CSIM10 in the default status (00H). Bit 0 (CSOT10) of CSIM10 and serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10) are reset. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 14.4.2 3-wire serial I/O mode The 3-wire serial I/O mode is used for connecting peripheral ICs and display controllers with a clocked serial interface. In this mode, communication is executed by using three lines: the serial clock (SCK10), serial output (SO10), and serial input (SI10) lines. (1) Registers used * Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) * Serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) * Port mode register 1 (PM1) * Port register 1 (P1) The basic procedure of setting an operation in the 3-wire serial I/O mode is as follows. <1> Set the CSIC10 register (see Figures 14-3). <2> Set bits 0 and 4 to 6 (CSOT10, DIR10, and TRMD10) of the CSIM10 register (see Figures 14-2). <3> Set bit 7 (CSIE10) of the CSIM10 register to 1. Transmission/reception is enabled. <4> Write data to transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10). Data transmission/reception is started. Read data from serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10). Data reception is started. Caution Take relationship with the other party of communication when setting the port mode register and port register. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 339 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 The relationship between the register settings and pins is shown below. Table 14-2. Relationship Between Register Settings and Pins (a) Serial interface CSI10 CSIE10 TRMD10 PM11 P11 PM12 P12 PM10 CSI10 Pin Function Operation SI10/RxD61/ SO10/P12 SCK10/TxD61/ P10 P11 0 x x Note 1 x Note 1 x Note 1 x Note 1 x Note 1 x Note 1 Stop RxD61/ P10 P12 1 0 1 x x Note 1 x Note 1 1 Slave x reception 1 1 x Note 1 x Note 1 0 0 1 SI10 P12 Note 3 Slave x 1 1 1 x 0 0 1 SO10 reception 1 0 1 x x x Note 1 0 Note 3 P11 SI10 SO10 Note 3 SI10 P12 1 1 x Note 1 1 1 x Note 1 x 0 0 0 0 0 0 Master 1 RxD61/ transmission P11 Master SI10 1 transmission/ reception Notes 1. Can be set as port function. 2. To use P10/SCK10/TxD61 as port pins, clear CKP10 to 0. 3. To use the slave mode, set CKS102, CKS101, and CKS100 to 1, 1, 1. Remark x: don't care CSIE10: Bit 7 of serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) TRMD10: Bit 6 of CSIM10 CKP10: Bit 4 of serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) CKS102, CKS101, CKS100: Bits 2 to 0 of CSIC10 340 PM1x: Port mode register P1x: Port output latch User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD SCK10 (output) reception 1 SCK10 (input) Note 3 Master 1 SCK10 (input) transmission/ Note 1 SCK10 Note 3 RxD61/ Slave x Note 2 (input) Note 3 transmission TxD61/ P10 P11 SO10 SCK10 (output) SO10 SCK10 (output) CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (2) Communication operation In the 3-wire serial I/O mode, data is transmitted or received in 8-bit units. Each bit of the data is transmitted or received in synchronization with the serial clock. Data can be transmitted or received if bit 6 (TRMD10) of serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) is 1. Transmission/reception is started when a value is written to transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10). In addition, data can be received when bit 6 (TRMD10) of serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) is 0. Reception is started when data is read from serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10). After communication has been started, bit 0 (CSOT10) of CSIM10 is set to 1. When communication of 8-bit data has been completed, a communication completion interrupt request flag (CSIIF10) is set, and CSOT10 is cleared to 0. Then the next communication is enabled. Caution Do not access the control register and data register when CSOT10 = 1 (during serial communication). Figure 14-5. Timing in 3-Wire Serial I/O Mode (1/2) (1) Transmission/reception timing (Type 1; TRMD10 = 1, DIR10 = 0, CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 0) SCK10 Read/write trigger SOTB10 SIO10 55H (communication data) ABH 56H ADH 5AH B5H 6AH D5H AAH CSOT10 INTCSI10 CSIIF10 SI1n (receive AAH) SO10 55H is written to SOTB10 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 341 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 Figure 14-5. Timing in 3-Wire Serial I/O Mode (2/2) (2) Transmission/reception timing (Type 2; TRMD10 = 1, DIR10 = 0, CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 1) SCK10 Read/write trigger SOTB10 SIO10 55H (communication data) ABH 56H ADH 5AH CSOT10 INTCSI10 CSIIF10 SI10input AAH) SO10 55H is written to SOTB10. 342 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD B5H 6AH D5H AAH CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 Figure 14-6. Timing of Clock/Data Phase (a) Type 1; CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 0, DIR10 = 0 SCK10 SI10 capture SO10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 CSIIF10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 CSOT10 (b) Type 2; CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 1, DIR10 = 0 SCK10 SI10 capture SO10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 CSIIF10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 CSOT10 (c) Type 3; CKP10 = 1, DAP10 = 0, DIR10 = 0 SCK10 SI10 capture SO10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 CSIIF10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 CSOT10 (d) Type 4; CKP10 = 1, DAP10 = 1, DIR10 = 0 SCK10 SI10 capture SO10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 CSIIF10 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 CSOT10 Remark The above figure illustrates a communication operation where data is transmitted with the MSB first. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 343 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (3) Timing of output to SO10 pin (first bit) When communication is started, the value of transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10) is output from the SO10 pin. The output operation of the first bit at this time is described below. Figure 14-7. Output Operation of First Bit (1/2) (a) Type 1: CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 0 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch First bit SO10 2nd bit (b) Type 3: CKP10 = 1, DAP10 = 0 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch SO10 First bit 2nd bit The first bit is directly latched by the SOTB10 register to the output latch at the falling (or rising) edge of SCK10, and output from the SO10 pin via an output selector. Then, the value of the SOTB10 register is transferred to the SIO10 register at the next rising (or falling) edge of SCK10, and shifted one bit. At the same time, the first bit of the receive data is stored in the SIO10 register via the SI10 pin. The second and subsequent bits are latched by the SIO10 register to the output latch at the next falling (or rising) edge of SCK10, and the data is output from the SO10 pin. 344 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 Figure 14-7. Output Operation of First Bit (2/2) (c) Type 2: CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 1 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch SO10 First bit 2nd bit 3rd bit 2nd bit 3rd bit (d) Type 4: CKP10 = 1, DAP10 = 1 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch SO10 First bit The first bit is directly latched by the SOTB10 register at the falling edge of the write signal of the SOTB10 register or the read signal of the SIO10 register, and output from the SO10 pin via an output selector. Then, the value of the SOTB10 register is transferred to the SIO10 register at the next falling (or rising) edge of SCK10, and shifted one bit. At the same time, the first bit of the receive data is stored in the SIO10 register via the SI10 pin. The second and subsequent bits are latched by the SIO10 register to the output latch at the next rising (or falling) edge of SCK10, and the data is output from the SO10 pin. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 345 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (4) Output value of SO10 pin (last bit) After communication has been completed, the SO10 pin holds the output value of the last bit. Figure 14-8. Output Value of SO10 Pin (Last Bit) (1/2) (a) Type 1: CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 0 SCK10 ( Next request is issued.) Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch Last bit SO10 (b) Type 3: CKP10 = 1, DAP10 = 0 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 ( Next request is issued.) SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch SO10 346 Last bit User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 Figure 14-8. Output Value of SO10 Pin (Last Bit) (2/2) (c) Type 2: CKP10 = 0, DAP10 = 1 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 ( Next request is issued.) SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch SO10 Last bit (d) Type 4: CKP10 = 1, DAP10 = 1 SCK10 Writing to SOTB10 or reading from SIO10 ( Next request is issued.) SOTB10 SIO10 Output latch SO10 Last bit User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 347 CHAPTER 14 SERIAL INTERFACE CSI10 (5) SO10 output (see (a) in Figure 14-1) The status of the SO10 output is as follows if bit 7 (CSIE10) of serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) is cleared to 0. Table 14-3. SO10 Output Status TRMD10 TRMD10 = 0 DIR10 - - Outputs low level DAP10 = 0 - Value of SO10 latch Note TRMD10 = 1 Note 1 DAP10 SO10 Output Note 2 (low-level output) DAP10 = 1 Notes 1. DIR10 = 0 Value of bit 7 of SOTB10 DIR10 = 1 Value of bit 0 of SOTB10 The actual output of the SO10/P12 pin is determined according to PM12 and P12, as well as the SO10 output. 2. Status after reset Caution If a value is written to TRMD10, DAP10, and DIR10, the output value of SO10 changes. 348 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.1 Outline Description This product features an on-chip 1-channel CAN (Controller Area Network) controller that complies with CAN protocol as standardized in ISO 11898. 15.1.1 Features - Compliant with ISO 11898 and tested according to ISO/DIS 16845 (CAN conformance test) - Standard frame and extended frame transmission/reception enabled - Transfer rate: 1 Mbps max. (CAN clock input 8 MHz) - 16 message buffers/1 channel - Receive/transmit history list function - Automatic block transmission function - Multi-buffer receive block function - Mask setting of four patterns is possible for each channel User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 349 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.1.2 Overview of functions Table 15-1 presents an overview of the CAN controller functions. Table 15-1. Overview of Functions Function Details Protocol CAN protocol ISO 11898 (standard and extended frame transmission/reception) Baud rate Maximum 1 Mbps (CAN clock input 8 MHz) Data storage Storing messages in the CAN RAM Number of messages - 16 message buffers/1 channel - Each message buffer can be set to be either a transmit message buffer or a receive message buffer. Message reception - Unique ID can be set to each message buffer. - Mask setting of four patterns is possible for each channel. - A receive completion interrupt is generated each time a message is received and stored in a message buffer. - Two or more receive message buffers can be used as a FIFO receive buffer (multi-buffer receive block function). - Receive history list function Message transmission - Unique ID can be set to each message buffer. - Transmit completion interrupt for each message buffer - Message buffer number 0 to 7 specified as the transmit message buffer can be used for automatic block transfer. Message transmission interval is programmable (automatic block transmission function (hereafter referred to as "ABT")). - Transmission history list function Remote frame processing Remote frame processing by transmit message buffer Time stamp function - The time stamp function can be set for a message reception when a 16-bit timer is used in combination. Time stamp capture trigger can be selected (SOF or EOF in a CAN message frame can be detected.). Diagnostic function - Readable error counters - "Valid protocol operation flag" for verification of bus connections - Receive-only mode - Single-shot mode - CAN protocol error type decoding - Self-test mode Forced release from bus-off state - Forced release from bus-off (by ignoring timing constraint) possible by software. - No automatic release from bus-off (software must re-enable). Power save mode - CAN sleep mode (can be woken up by CAN bus) - CAN stop mode (cannot be woken up by CAN bus) 350 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.1.3 Configuration The CAN controller is composed of the following four blocks. (1) NPB interface This functional block provides an NPB (NEC peripheral I/O bus) interface and means of transmitting and receiving signals between the CAN module and the host CPU. (2) MCM (Message Control Module) This functional block controls access to the CAN protocol layer and to the CAN RAM within the CAN module. (3) CAN protocol layer This functional block is involved in the operation of the CAN protocol and its related settings. (4) CAN RAM This is the CAN memory functional block, which is used to store message IDs, message data, etc. Figure 15-1. Block Diagram of CAN Module CPU Interrupt request NPB (NEC Peripheral I/O Bus) INTTRX0 INTREC0 INTERR0 INTWUP0 CAN bus CAN module CAN Protocol Layer CTxD CRxD CAN transceiver CAN_H0 CAN_L0 CAN RAM Message buffer 0 Message buffer 1 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 3 C0MASK1 C0MASK2 C0MASK3 C0MASK4 ... NPB interface MCM (Message Control Module) Message buffer 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 351 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.2 CAN Protocol CAN (Controller Area Network) is a high-speed multiplex communication protocol for real-time communication in automotive applications (class C). CAN is prescribed by ISO 11898. For details, refer to the ISO 11898 specifications. The CAN specification is generally divided into two layers: a physical layer and a data link layer. In turn, the data link layer includes logical link and medium access control. The composition of these layers is illustrated below. Figure 15-2. Composition of Layers * Logical link control (LLC) Higher Data link layerNote Lower * Medium access control (MAC) * Acceptance filtering * Overload report * Recovery management * Data capsuled/not capsuled * Frame coding (stuffing/not stuffing) * Medium access management * Error detection * Error report * Acknowledgement * Seriated/not seriated Physical layer Prescription of signal level and bit description Note CAN controller specification 15.2.1 Frame format (1) Standard format frame - The standard format frame uses 11-bit identifiers, which means that it can handle up to 2048 messages. (2) Extended format frame - The extended format frame uses 29-bit (11 bits + 18 bits) identifiers which increase the number of messages that can be handled to 2048 x 218 messages. - Extended format frame is set when "recessive level" (CMOS level equals "1") is set for both the SRR and IDE bits in the arbitration field. 352 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.2.2 Frame types The following four types of frames are used in the CAN protocol. Table 15-2. Frame Types Frame Type Description Data frame Frame used to transmit data Remote frame Frame used to request a data frame Error frame Frame used to report error detection Overload frame Frame used to delay the next data frame or remote frame (1) Bus value The bus values are divided into dominant and recessive. - Dominant level is indicated by logical 0. - Recessive level is indicated by logical 1. - When a dominant level and a recessive level are transmitted simultaneously, the bus value becomes dominant level. 15.2.3 Data frame and remote frame (1) Data frame A data frame is composed of seven fields. Figure 15-3. Data Frame Data frame R D <1> <2> <3> <4> <5> <6> <7> <8> Interframe space End of frame (EOF) ACK field CRC field Data field Control field Arbitration field Start of frame (SOF) Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 353 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (2) Remote frame A remote frame is composed of six fields. Figure 15-4. Remote Frame Remote frame R D <1> <2> <3> <5> <6> <7> <8> Interframe space End of frame (EOF) ACK field CRC field Control field Arbitration field Start of frame (SOF) Remarks 1. The data field is not transferred even if the control field's data length code is not "0000B". 2. D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 (3) Description of fields <1> Start of frame (SOF) The start of frame field is located at the start of a data frame or remote frame. Figure 15-5. Start of Frame (SOF) (Interframe space or bus idle) Start of frame (Arbitration field) R D 1 bit Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 * If dominant level is detected in the bus idle state, a hard-synchronization is performed (the current TQ is assigned to be the SYNC segment). * If dominant level is sampled at the sample point following such a hard-synchronization, the bit is assigned to be a SOF. If recessive level is detected, the protocol layer returns to the bus idle state and regards the preceding dominant pulse as a disturbance only. No error frame is generated in such case. 354 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER <2> Arbitration field The arbitration field is used to set the priority, data frame/remote frame, and frame format. Figure 15-6. Arbitration Field (in Standard Format Mode) Arbitration field (Control field) R D Identifier RTR ID28 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * ID18 (11 bits) (1 bit) IDE (r1) r0 (1 bit) Cautions 1. ID28 to ID18 are identifiers. 2. An identifier is transmitted MSB first. Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 Figure 15-7. Arbitration Field (in Extended Format Mode) Arbitration field (Control field) R D Identifier SRR IDE Identifier RTR r1 r0 ID28 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * ID18 ID17 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * ID0 (11 bits) (1 bit) (1 bit) (18 bits) (1 bit) Cautions 1. ID28 to ID18 are identifiers. 2. An identifier is transmitted MSB first. Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 Table 15-3. RTR Frame Settings Frame Type RTR Bit Data frame 0 (D) Remote frame 1 (R) Table 15-4. Frame Format Setting (IDE Bit) and Number of Identifier (ID) Bits Frame Format SRR Bit IDE Bit Number. of Bits Standard format mode None 0 (D) 11 bits Extended format mode 1 (R) 1 (R) 29 bits User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 355 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER <3> Control field The control field sets "N" as the number of data bytes in the data field (N = 0 to 8). Figure 15-8. Control Field (Arbitration field) Control field (Data field) R D RTR Remark r1 (IDE) r0 DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0 D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 In a standard format frame, the control field's IDE bit is the same as the r1 bit. Table 15-5. Data Length Setting Data Byte Count Data Length Code DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0 0 0 0 0 0 bytes 0 0 0 1 1 byte 0 0 1 0 2 bytes 0 0 1 1 3 bytes 0 1 0 0 4 bytes 0 1 0 1 5 bytes 0 1 1 0 6 bytes 0 1 1 1 7 bytes 1 0 0 0 8 bytes Other than above 8 bytes regardless of the value of DLC3 to DLC0 Caution In the remote frame, there is no data field even if the data length code is not 0000B. 356 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER <4> Data field The data field contains the amount of data (byte units) set by the control field. Up to 8 units of data can be set. Figure 15-9. Data Field (Control field) Data field (CRC field) R D MSB Remark Data0 (8 bits) MSB LSB Data7 (8 bits) LSB D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 <5> CRC field The CRC field is a 16-bit field that is used to check for errors in transmit data. Figure 15-10. CRC Field (Data field or control field) CRC field (ACK field) R D CRC sequence (15 bits) Remark CRC delimiter (1 bit) D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 - The polynomial P(X) used to generate the 15-bit CRC sequence is expressed as follows. P(X) = X15 + X14 + X10 + X8 + X7 + X4 + X3 + 1 - Transmitting node: Transmits the CRC sequence calculated from the data (before bit stuffing) in the start of frame, arbitration field, control field, and data field. - Receiving node: Compares the CRC sequence calculated using data bits that exclude the stuffing bits in the receive data with the CRC sequence in the CRC field. If the two CRC sequences do not match, the node issues an error frame. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 357 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER <6> ACK field The ACK field is used to acknowledge normal reception. Figure 15-11. ACK Field (CRC field) ACK field (End of frame) R D ACK slot (1 bit) Remark ACK delimiter (1 bit) D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 - If no CRC error is detected, the receiving node sets the ACK slot to the dominant level. - The transmitting node outputs two recessive-level bits. <7> End of frame (EOF) The end of frame field indicates the end of data frame/remote frame. Figure 15-12. End of Frame (EOF) (ACK field) End of frame (Interframe space or overload frame) R D (7 bits) Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 358 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER <8> Interframe space The interframe space is inserted after a data frame, remote frame, error frame, or overload frame to separate one frame from the next. - The bus state differs depending on the error status. (a) Error active node The interframe space consists of a 3-bit intermission field and a bus idle field. Figure 15-13. Interframe Space (Error Active Node) (Frame) Interframe space (Frame) R D Intermission (3 bits) Bus idle (0 to bits) Remarks 1. Bus idle: State in which the bus is not used by any node. 2. D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 (b) Error passive node The interframe space consists of an intermission field, a suspend transmission field, and a bus idle field. Figure 15-14. Interframe Space (Error Passive Node) (Frame) R D (Frame) Interframe space Intermission (3 bits) Remarks 1. Bus idle: Suspend transmission (8 bits) Bus idle (0 to bits) State in which the bus is not used by any node. Suspend transmission: Sequence of 8 recessive-level bits transmitted from the node in the error passive status. 2. D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 Usually, the intermission field is 3 bits. If the transmitting node detects a dominant level at the third bit of the intermission field, however, it executes transmission. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 359 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER - Operation in error status Table 15-6. Operation in Error Status Error Status Operation Error active A node in this status can transmit immediately after a 3-bit intermission. Error passive A node in this status can transmit 8 bits after the intermission. 360 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.2.4 Error frame An error frame is output by a node that has detected an error. Figure 15-15. Error Frame Error frame R D <1> <2> <3> 6 bits 0 to 6 bits 8 bits (<4>) (<5>) Interframe space or overload frame Error delimiter Error flag2 Error flag1 Error bit Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 Table 15-7. Definition Error Frame Fields No. <1> Name Error flag1 Bit Count 6 Definition Error active node: Outputs 6 dominant-level bits consecutively. Error passive node: Outputs 6 recessive-level bits consecutively. If another node outputs a dominant level while one node is outputting a passive error flag, the passive error flag is not cleared until the same level is detected 6 bits in a row. <2> Error flag2 0 to 6 Nodes receiving error flag 1 detect bit stuff errors and issues this error flag. <3> Error delimiter 8 Outputs 8 recessive-level bits consecutively. If a dominant level is detected at the 8th bit, an overload frame is transmitted from the next bit. <4> Error bit - The bit at which the error was detected. The error flag is output from the bit next to the error bit. In the case of a CRC error, this bit is output following the ACK delimiter. <5> Interframe space/overload - An interframe space or overload frame starts from here.5 frame User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 361 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.2.5 Overload frame An overload frame is transmitted under the following conditions. - When the receiving node has not completed the reception operationNote - If a dominant level is detected at the first two bits during intermission - If a dominant level is detected at the last bit (7th bit) of the end of frame or at the last bit (8th bit) of the error delimiter/overload delimiter Note The CAN is internally fast enough to process all received frames not generating overload frames. Figure 15-16. Overload Frame Overload frame R D (<4>) <1> <2> <3> 6 bits 0 to 6 bits 8 bits (<5>) Interframe space or overload frame Overload delimiter Overload flag Overload flag Frame Remark D: Dominant = 0 R: Recessive = 1 Table 15-8. Definition of Overload Frame Fields No Name <1> Overload flag <2> Overload flag from other node Bit Count 6 0 to 6 Definition Outputs 6 dominant-level bits consecutively. The node that received an overload flag in the interframe space outputs an overload flag. <3> Overload delimiter 8 Outputs 8 recessive-level bits consecutively. If a dominant level is detected at the 8th bit, an overload frame is transmitted from the next bit. 362 <4> Frame - Output following an end of frame, error delimiter, or overload delimiter. <5> Interframe space/overload frame - An interframe space or overload frame starts from here. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.3 Functions 15.3.1 Determining bus priority (1) When a node starts transmission: - During bus idle, the node that output data first transmits the data. (2) When more than one node starts transmission: - The node that outputs the dominant level for the longest consecutively from the first bit of the arbitration field acquires the bus priority (if a dominant level and a recessive level are simultaneously transmitted, the dominant level is taken as the bus value). - The transmitting node compares its output arbitration field and the data level on the bus. Table 15-9. Determining Bus Priority Level match Continuous transmission Level mismatch Continuous transmission (3) Priority of data frame and remote frame - When a data frame and a remote frame are on the bus, the data frame has priority because its RTR bit, the last bit in the arbitration field, carries a dominant level. Remark If the extended-format data frame and the standard-format remote frame conflict on the bus (if ID28 to ID18 of both of them are the same), the standard-format remote frames takes priority. 15.3.2 Bit stuffing Bit stuffing is used to establish synchronization by appending 1-bit inverted data if the same level continues for 5 bits, in order to prevent a burst error. Table 15-10. Bit Stuffing Transmission During the transmission of a data frame or remote frame, when the same level continues for 5 bits in the data between the start of frame and the ACK field, 1 inverted-level bit of data is inserted before the following bit. Reception During the reception of a data frame or remote frame, when the same level continues for 5 bits in the data between the start of frame and the ACK field, reception is continued after deleting the next bit. 15.3.3 Multi masters As the bus priority (a node acquiring transmit functions) is determined by the identifier, any node can be the bus master. 15.3.4 Multi cast Although there is one transmitting node, two or more nodes can receive the same data at the same time because the same identifier can be set to two or more nodes. 15.3.5 CAN sleep mode/CAN stop mode function The CAN sleep mode/CAN stop mode function puts the CAN controller in waiting mode to achieve low power consumption. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 363 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER The controller is woken up from the CAN sleep mode by bus operation but it is not woken up from the CAN stop mode by bus operation (the CAN stop mode is controlled by CPU access). 15.3.6 Error control function (1) Error types Table 15-11. Error Types Type Description of Error Detection Method Bit error Comparison of output level and Detection State Detection Transmission/ Condition Reception Mismatch of levels level on the bus Field/Frame Transmitting/ Bit that outputting data on the receiving node bus at the start of frame to end of frame, error frame and overload frame. Stuff error CRC error Receiving node Start of frame to CRC sequence Mismatch of CRC Receiving node CRC field Field/frame check of the fixed Detection of fixed Receiving node format format violation Check the receive data at the 6 consecutive bits stuff bit of the same output level Comparison of the CRC sequence generated from the receive data and the received CRC sequence Form error CRC delimiter ACK field End of frame Error frame Overload frame ACK error Check of the ACK slot by the Detection of transmitting node recessive level in ACK slot Transmitting node ACK slot (2) Output timing of error frame Table 15-12. Output Timing of Error Frame Type Output Timing Bit error, stuff error, form error, ACK error Error frame output is started at the timing of the bit following the detected error. CRC error Error frame output is started at the timing of the bit following the ACK delimiter. (3) Processing in case of error The transmission node re-transmits the data frame or remote frame after the error frame (However, it does not re-transmit the frame in the single-shot mode.). 364 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (4) Error state (a) Types of error states The following three types of error states are defined by the CAN specification. - Error active - Error passive - Bus-off These types of error states are classified by the values of the TEC7 to TEC0 bits (transmission error counter bits) and the REC6 to REC0 bits (reception error counter bits) of the CAN error counter register (C0ERC) as shown in Table 15-13. The present error state is indicated by the CAN module information register (C0INFO). When each error counter value becomes equal to or greater than the error warning level (96), the TECS0 or RECS0 bit of the C0INFO register is set to 1. In this case, the bus state must be tested because it is considered that the bus has a serious fault. An error counter value of 128 or more indicates an error passive state and the TECS1 or RECS1 bit of the C0INFO register is set to 1. - If the value of the transmission error counter is greater than or equal to 256 (actually, the transmission error counter does not indicate a value greater than or equal to 256), the bus-off state is reached and the BOFF bit of the C0INFO register is set to 1. - If only one node is active on the bus at startup (i.e., a particular case such as when the bus is connected only to the local station), ACK is not returned even if data is transmitted. Consequently, retransmission of the error frame and data is repeated. In the error passive state, however, the transmission error counter is not incremented and the bus-off state is not reached. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 365 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-13. Types of Error States Type Error active Error passive Operation Value of Error Indication of Counter C0INFO Register Transmission 0-95 TECS1, TECS0 = 00 Reception 0-95 RECS1, RECS0 = 00 Transmission 96-127 TECS1, TECS0 = 01 Reception 96-127 RECS1, RECS0 = 01 Transmission 128-255 TECS1, TECS0 = 11 Reception 128 or more RECS1, RECS0 = 11 Operation specific to Given Error State - Outputs an active error flag (6 consecutive dominant-level bits) on detection of the error. - Outputs a passive error flag (6 consecutive recessive-level bits) on detection of the error. - Transmits 8 recessive-level bits, in between transmissions, following an intermission (suspend transmission). Bus-off Transmission 256 or more (not Note indicated) BOFF = 1, - Communication is not possible. TECS1, TECS0 = 11 Messages are not stored when receiving frames, however, the following operations of <1>, <2>, and <3> are done. <1> TSOUT toggles. <2> REC is incremented/decremented. <3> VALID bit is set. - If the CAN module is entered to the initialization mode and then transition request to any operation mode is made, and when 11 consecutive recessive-level bits are detected 128 times, the error counter is reset to 0 and the error active state can be restored. Note The value of the transmission error counter (TEC) is invalid when the BOFF bit is set to 1. If an error that increments the value of the transmission error counter by +8 while the counter value is in a range of 248 to 255, the counter is not incremented and the bus-off state is assumed. 366 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (b) Error counter The error counter counts up when an error has occurred, and counts down upon successful transmission and reception. The error counter is updated immediately after error detection. Table 15-14. Error Counter State Transmission Error Counter (TEC7 to TEC0) Receiving node detects an error (except bit error in the active error flag Reception Error Counter (REC6 to REC0) No change +1 (when REPS bit = 0) No change +8 (when REPS bit = 0) +8 No change +8 No change No change +8 (when REPS bit = 0) +8 (during transmission) +8 (during reception, or overload flag). Receiving node detects dominant level following error flag of error frame. Transmitting node transmits an error flag. [As exceptions, the error counter does not change in the following cases.] <1> ACK error is detected in error passive state and dominant level is not detected while the passive error flag is being output. <2> A stuff error is detected in an arbitration field that transmitted a recessive level as a stuff bit, but a dominant level is detected. Bit error detection while active error flag or overload flag is being output (error-active transmitting node) Bit error detection while active error flag or overload flag is being output (error-active receiving node) When the node detects 14 consecutive dominant-level bits from the when REPS bit = 0) beginning of the active error flag or overload flag, and then subsequently detects 8 consecutive dominant-level bits. When the node detects 8 consecutive dominant levels after a passive error flag When the transmitting node has completed transmission without error -1 No change No change - -1 (1 REC6 to REC0 (0 if error counter = 0) When the receiving node has completed reception without error 127, when REPS bit = 0) - 0 (REC6 to REC0 = 0, when REPS bit = 0) - Value of 119 to 255 is set (when REPS bit = 1) (c) Occurrence of bit error in intermission An overload frame is generated. Caution If an error occurs, the error flag output (active or passive) is controlled according to the contents of the transmission error counter and reception error counter before the error occurred. The value of the error counter is incremented after the error flag has been output. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 367 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (5) Recovery from bus-off state When the CAN module is in the bus-off state, the CAN module permanently sets its output signals (CTxD) to recessive level. The CAN module recovers from the bus-off state in the following bus-off recovery sequence. <1> A request to enter the CAN initialization mode <2> A request to enter a CAN operation mode (a) Recovery operation through normal recovery sequence (b) Forced recovery operation that skips recovery sequence (a) Recovery operation from bus-off state through normal recovery sequence The CAN module first issues a request to enter the initialization mode (refer to timing <1> in Figure 1517). This request will be immediately acknowledged, and the OPMODE bits of the C0CTRL register are cleared to 000B. Processing such as analyzing the fault that has caused the bus-off state, re-defining the CAN module and message buffer using application software, or stopping the operation of the CAN module can be performed by clearing the GOM bit to 0. Next, the user requests to change the mode from the initialization mode to an operation mode (refer to timing <2> in Figure 15-17). This starts an operation to recover the CAN module from the bus-off state. The conditions under which the module can recover from the bus-off state are defined by the CAN protocol ISO 11898, and it is necessary to detect 11 consecutive recessive-level bits 128 times. At this time, the request to change the mode to an operation mode is held pending until the recovery conditions are satisfied. When the recovery conditions are satisfied (refer to timing <3> in Figure 15-17), the CAN module can enter the operation mode it has requested. Until the CAN module enters this operation mode, it stays in the initialization mode. Completion to be requested operation mode can be confirmed by reading the OPMODE bits of the C0CTRL register. During the bus-off period and bus-off recovery sequence, the BOFF bit of the C0INFO register stays set (to 1). In the bus-off recovery sequence, the reception error counter (REC[6:0]) counts the number of times 11 consecutive recessive-level bits have been detected on the bus. Therefore, the recovery state can be checked by reading REC[6:0]. Cautions 1. When the transmission from the initialization mode to any operation modes is requested to execute bus-off recovery sequence again in the bus-off recovery sequence, reception error counter is cleared. Therefore it is necessary to detect 11 consecutive recessive-level bits 128 times on the bus again. 2. In the bus-off recovery sequence, REC[6:0] counts up (+1) each time 11 consecutive recessive-level bits have been detected. Even during the bus-off period, the CAN module can enter the CAN sleep mode or CAN stop mode. To start the bus-off recovery sequence, it is necessary to transit to the initialization mode once. However, when the CAN module is in either CAN sleep mode or CAN stop mode, transition request to the initialization mode is not accepted, thus you have to release the CAN sleep mode first. In this case, as soon as the CAN sleep mode is released, the bus-off recovery sequence starts and no transition to initialization mode is necessary. If the can module detects a dominant edge on the CAN bus while in sleep mode even during bus-off, the sleep mode will be left and the bus-off recovery sequence will start. 368 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-17. Recovery Operation from Bus-off State through Normal Recovery Sequence TEC > FFH bus-off error-passive bus-off-recovery-sequence error-active BOFF bit in C0INFO register <1> OPMODE[2:0] in C0CTRL register (user writings) 00H <2> 00H 00H <3> OPMODE[2:0] in C0CTRL register (user readings) 00H TEC[7:0] in C0ERC 80H TEC[7:0] FFH register REPS, REC[6:0] in C0ERC register 00H 00H FFH < TEC [7:0] 80H REPS, REC[6:0] FFH 00H TEC[7:0] < 80H 00H 00H REPS, REC[6:0] < 80H Undefined (b) Forced recovery operation that skips bus-off recovery sequence The CAN module can be forcibly released from the bus-off state, regardless of the bus state, by skipping the bus-off recovery sequence. Here is the procedure. First, the CAN module requests to enter the initialization mode. For the operation and points to be noted at this time, refer to (a) Recovery operation from bus-off state through normal recovery sequence. Next, the module requests to enter an operation mode. At the same time, the CCERC bit of the C0CTRL register must be set to 1. As a result, the bus-off recovery sequence defined by the CAN protocol ISO 11898 is skipped, and the module immediately enters the operation mode. In this case, the module is connected to the CAN bus after it has monitored 11 consecutive recessive-level bits. For details, refer to the processing in Figure 15-56. Caution This function is not defined by the CAN protocol ISO 11898. When using this function, thoroughly evaluate its effect on the network system. (6) Initializing CAN module error counter register (C0ERC) in initialization mode If it is necessary to initialize the CAN module error counter register (C0ERC) and CAN module information register (C0INFO) for debugging or evaluating a program, they can be initialized to the default value by setting the CCERC bit of the C0CTRL register in the initialization mode. When initialization has been completed, the CCERC bit is automatically cleared to 0. Cautions 1. This function is enabled only in the initialization mode. Even if the CCERC bit is set to 1 in a CAN operation mode, the C0ERC and C0INFO registers are not initialized. 2. The CCERC bit can be set at the same time as the request to enter a CAN operation mode. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 369 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.3.7 Baud rate control function (1) Prescaler The CAN controller has a prescaler that divides the clock (fCAN) supplied to CAN. This prescaler generates a CAN protocol layer basic clock (fTQ) derived from the CAN module system clock (fCANMOD), and divided by 1 to 256 (refer to 15.6 (12) CAN Bit Rate Prescaler Register (C0BRP)). (2) Data bit time (8-25 time quanta) One data bit time is defined as shown in Figure 15-18. The CAN controller sets time segment 1, time segment 2, and reSynchronization Jump Width (SJW) as the parameter of data bit time, as shown in Figure 15-18. Time segment 1 is equivalent to the total of the propagation (prop) segment and phase segment 1 that are defined by the CAN protocol specification. Time segment 2 is equivalent to phase segment 2. Figure 15-18. Segment Setting Data bit time(DBT) Sync segment Prop segment Phase segment 1 Time segment 1(TSEG1) Phase segment 2 Time segment 2 (TSEG2) Sample point (SPT) Segment Name Settable Range Notes on Setting to Confirm to CAN Specification Time Segment 1 (TSEG1) 2TQ-16TQ -- Time Segment 2 (TSEG2) 1TQ-8TQ IPT of the CAN controller is 0TQ. To conform to the CAN protocol specification, therefore, a length equal to phase segment 1 must be set here. This means that the length of time segment 1 minus 1TQ is the settable upper limit of time segment 2. Resynchronization jump 1TQ-4TQ The length of time segment 1 minus 1TQ or 4 TQ, width(SJW) whichever is smaller. Remark IPT : Information Processing Time TQ : Time Quanta 370 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Reference: The CAN standard ISO 11898 specification defines the segments constituting the data bit time as shown in Figure 15-19. Figure 15-19. Reference: Configuration of Data Bit Time Defined by CAN Specification Data bit time(DBT) Sync segment Prop segment Phase segment 1 Phase segment 2 SJW Sample point (SPT) Segment Name Sync Segment Segment Length 1 This segment starts at the edge where the level changes from recessive to dominant when hard-synchronization is established. (Synchronization Segment) Prop Segment Description Programmable to 1 to 8 This segment absorbs the delay of the output buffer, CAN or more bus, and input buffer. The length of this segment is set so that ACK is returned before the start of phase segment 1. Time of prop segment (Delay of output buffer) + 2 x (Delay of CAN bus) + (Delay of input buffer) Phase Segment 1 Programmable to 1 to 8 This segment compensates for an error of data bit time. Phase Segment 2 Phase Segment 1 or The longer this segment, the wider the permissible range but the slower the communication speed. IPT, whichever greater SJW Programmable from This width sets the upper limit of expansion or contraction 1TQ to length of of the phase segment during resynchronization. segment 1 or 4TQ, whichever is smaller Remark IPT : Information Processing Time TQ : Time Quanta User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 371 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (3) Synchronizing data bit - The receiving node establishes synchronization by a level change on the bus because it does not have a sync signal. - The transmitting node transmits data in synchronization with the bit timing of the transmitting node. (a) Hard-synchronization This synchronization is established when the receiving node detects the start of frame in the interframe space. - When a falling edge is detected on the bus, that TQ means the sync segment and the next segment is the prop segment. In this case, synchronization is established regardless of SJW. Figure 15-20. Hard-synchronization at Recognition of Dominant Level during Bus Idle Interframe space Start of frame CANbus Bit timing 372 Sync segment Prop segment Phase segment 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Phase segment 2 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (b) Resynchronization Synchronization is established again if a level change is detected on the bus during reception (only if a recessive level was sampled previously). - The phase error of the edge is given by the relative position of the detected edge and sync segment. 0: If the edge is within the sync segment Positive: If the edge is before the sample point (phase error) Negative: If the edge is after the sample point (phase error) If phase error is positive: Phase segment 1 is longer by specified SJW. If phase error is negative: Phase segment 2 is shorter by specified SJW. - The sample point of the data of the receiving node moves relatively due to the "discrepancy" in baud rate between the transmitting node and receiving node. Figure 15-21. Resynchronization If phase error is positve CAN bus Bit timing Sync segment Prop segment Phase segment 2 Phase segment 1 Sample point If phase error is negative CAN bus Bit timing Sync segment Prop segment Phase segment 1 Phase segment 2 Sample point Data bit time(DBT) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 373 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.4 Connection with Target System The microcontroller incorporated a CAN has to be connected to the CAN bus using an external transceiver. Figure 15-22. Connection to CAN Bus Microcontroller incorporated a CAN 374 CTxD CRxD CANL Transceiver User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CANH CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.5 Internal Registers of CAN Controller 15.5.1 CAN controller configuration Table 15-15. List of CAN Controller Registers Item CAN global registers Register Name CAN global control register (C0GMCTRL) CAN global clock selection register (C0GMCS) CAN global automatic block transmission control register (C0GMABT) CAN global automatic block transmission delay register (C0GMABTD) CAN module registers CAN module mask 1 register (C0MASK1L, C0MASK1H) CAN module mask 2 register (C0MASK2L, C0MASK2H) CAN module mask3 register (C0MASK3L, C0MASK3H) CAN module mask 4 registers (C0MASK4L, C0MASK4H) CAN module control register (C0CTRL) CAN module last error code register (C0LEC) CAN module information register (C0INFO) CAN module error counter register (C0ERC) CAN module interrupt enable register (C0IE) CAN module interrupt status register (C0INTS) CAN module bit rate prescaler register (C0BRP) CAN module bit rate register (C0BTR) CAN module last in-pointer register (C0LIPT) CAN module receive history list register (C0RGPT) CAN module last out-pointer register (C0LOPT) CAN module transmit history list register (C0TGPT) CAN module time stamp register (C0TS) Message buffer registers CAN message data byte 01 register m (C0MDATA01m) CAN message data byte 0 register m (C0MDATA0m) CAN message data byte 1 register m (C0MDATA1m) CAN message data byte 23 register m (C0MDATA23m) CAN message data byte 2 register m (C0MDATA2m) CAN message data byte 3 Register m (C0MDATA3m) CAN message data byte 45 Register m (C0MDATA45m) CAN message data byte 4 Register m (C0MDATA4m) CAN message data byte 5 Register m (C0MDATA5m) CAN message data byte 67 Register m (C0MDATA67m) CAN message data byte 6 register m (C0MDATA6m) CAN message data byte 7 register m (C0MDATA7m) CAN message data length register m (C0MDLCm) CAN message configuration register m (C0MCONFm) CAN message ID register m (C0MIDLm, C0MIDHm) CAN message control register m (C0MCTRLm) Remark m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 375 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.5.2 Register access type Table 15-16. Register Access Types (1/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FA00H FA00H FA01H 8 R/W CAN0 message data byte 01 register 00 C0MDATA0100 CAN0 message data byte 0 register 00 C0MDATA000 Default Value 16 Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 1 register 00 C0MDATA100 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 00 C0MDATA2300 FA02H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 00 C0MDATA200 Undefined FA03H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 00 C0MDATA300 Undefined FA02H FA04H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 00 C0MDATA4500 FA04H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 00 C0MDATA400 Undefined FA05H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 00 C0MDATA500 Undefined FA06H Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 00 C0MDATA6700 FA06H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 00 C0MDATA600 Undefined FA07H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 00 C0MDATA700 Undefined FA08H CAN0 message data length code register 00 C0MDLC00 0000xxxxB FA09H CAN0 message configuration register 00 C0MCONF00 Undefined FA0AH CAN0 message ID register 00 C0MIDL00 C0MIDH00 Undefined FA0EH CAN0 message control register 00 C0MCTRL00 00x00000 000xx000B FA10H CAN0 message data byte 01 register 01 C0MDATA0101 Undefined FA0CH Undefined Undefined FA10H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 01 C0MDATA001 Undefined FA11H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 01 C0MDATA101 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 01 C0MDATA2301 FA12H Undefined FA12H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 01 C0MDATA201 Undefined FA13H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 01 C0MDATA301 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 01 C0MDATA4501 FA14H Undefined FA14H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 01 C0MDATA401 Undefined FA15H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 01 C0MDATA501 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 01 C0MDATA6701 FA16H Undefined FA16H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 01 C0MDATA601 Undefined FA17H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 01 C0MDATA701 Undefined FA18H CAN0 message data length code register 01 C0MDLC01 0000xxxxB FA19H CAN0 message configuration register 01 C0MCONF01 FA1AH CAN0 message ID register 01 C0MIDL01 Undefined C0MIDH01 Undefined C0MCTRL01 00x00000 000xx000B FA1CH FA1EH 376 CAN0 message control register 01 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (2/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FA20H FA20H FA21H FA22H FA22H FA23H 8 R/W CAN0 message data byte 01 register 02 C0MDATA0102 CAN0 message data byte 0 register 02 C0MDATA002 CAN0 message data byte 1 register 02 C0MDATA102 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 02 C0MDATA2302 CAN0 message data byte 2 register 02 C0MDATA202 Default Value 16 Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 3 register 02 C0MDATA302 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 02 C0MDATA4502 FA24H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 02 C0MDATA402 Undefined FA25H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 02 C0MDATA502 Undefined FA24H FA26H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 02 C0MDATA6702 FA26H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 02 C0MDATA602 Undefined FA27H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 02 C0MDATA702 Undefined FA28H CAN0 message data length code register 02 C0MDLC02 0000xxxxB FA29H CAN0 message configuration register 02 C0MCONF02 Undefined FA2AH CAN0 message ID register 02 C0MIDL02 C0MIDH02 Undefined FA2EH CAN0 message control register 02 C0MCTRL02 00x00000 000xx000B FA30H Undefined FA2CH Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 03 C0MDATA0103 FA30H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 03 C0MDATA003 Undefined FA31H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 03 C0MDATA103 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 03 C0MDATA2303 FA32H Undefined FA32H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 03 C0MDATA203 Undefined FA33H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 03 C0MDATA303 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 03 C0MDATA4503 FA34H Undefined FA34H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 03 C0MDATA403 Undefined FA35H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 03 C0MDATA503 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 03 C0MDATA6703 FA36H Undefined FA36H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 03 C0MDATA603 Undefined FA37H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 03 C0MDATA703 Undefined CAN0 message data length code register 03 C0MDLC03 0000xxxxB FA38H FA39H CAN0 message configuration register 03 C0MCONF03 FA3AH CAN0 message ID register 03 C0MIDL03 Undefined C0MIDH03 Undefined C0MCTRL03 00x00000 000xx000B FA3CH FA3EH CAN0 message control register 03 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined 377 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (3/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FA40H FA40H FA41H FA42H FA42H FA43H 8 R/W CAN0 message data byte 01 register 04 C0MDATA0104 CAN0 message data byte 0 register 04 C0MDATA004 CAN0 message data byte 1 register 04 C0MDATA104 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 04 C0MDATA2304 CAN0 message data byte 2 register 04 C0MDATA204 Default Value 16 Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 3 register 04 C0MDATA304 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 04 C0MDATA4504 FA44H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 04 C0MDATA404 Undefined FA45H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 04 C0MDATA504 Undefined FA44H FA46H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 04 C0MDATA6704 FA46H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 04 C0MDATA604 Undefined FA47H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 04 C0MDATA704 Undefined FA48H CAN0 message data length code register 04 C0MDLC04 0000xxxxB FA49H CAN0 message configuration register 04 C0MCONF04 Undefined FA4AH CAN0 message ID register 04 C0MIDL04 C0MIDH04 Undefined FA4EH CAN0 message control register 04 C0MCTRL04 00x00000 000xx000B FA50H FA4CH Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 05 C0MDATA0105 FA50H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 05 C0MDATA005 Undefined FA51H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 05 C0MDATA105 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 05 C0MDATA2305 FA52H Undefined Undefined FA52H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 05 C0MDATA205 Undefined FA53H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 05 C0MDATA305 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 05 C0MDATA4505 FA54H Undefined FA54H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 05 C0MDATA405 Undefined FA55H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 05 C0MDATA505 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 05 C0MDATA6705 FA56H Undefined FA56H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 05 C0MDATA605 Undefined FA57H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 05 C0MDATA705 Undefined FA58H CAN0 message data length code register 05 C0MDLC05 0000xxxxB FA59H CAN0 message configuration register 05 C0MCONF05 FA5AH CAN0 message ID register 05 C0MIDL05 Undefined C0MIDH05 Undefined C0MCTRL05 00x00000 000xx000B FA5CH FA5EH 378 CAN0 message configuration register 05 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (4/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FA60H FA60H FA61H FA62H FA62H FA63H 8 R/W CAN0 message data byte 01 register 06 C0MDATA0106 CAN0 message data byte 0 register 06 C0MDATA006 CAN0 message data byte 1 register 06 C0MDATA106 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 06 C0MDATA2306 CAN0 message data byte 2 register 06 C0MDATA206 Default Value 16 Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 3 register 06 C0MDATA306 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 06 C0MDATA4506 FA64H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 06 C0MDATA406 Undefined FA65H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 06 C0MDATA506 Undefined FA64H FA66H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 06 C0MDATA6706 FA66H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 06 C0MDATA606 Undefined FA67H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 06 C0MDATA706 Undefined FA68H CAN0 message data length code register 06 C0MDLC06 0000xxxxB FA69H CAN0 message configuration register 06 C0MCONF06 Undefined FA6AH CAN0 message ID register 06 C0MIDL06 C0MIDH06 Undefined FA6EH CAN0 message control register 06 C0MCTRL06 00x00000 000xx000B FA70H Undefined FA6CH Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 07 C0MDATA0107 FA70H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 07 C0MDATA007 Undefined FA71H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 07 C0MDATA107 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 07 C0MDATA2307 FA72H Undefined FA72H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 07 C0MDATA207 Undefined FA73H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 07 C0MDATA307 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 07 C0MDATA4507 FA74H Undefined FA74H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 07 C0MDATA407 Undefined FA75H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 07 C0MDATA507 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 07 C0MDATA6707 FA76H Undefined FA76H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 07 C0MDATA607 Undefined FA77H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 07 C0MDATA707 Undefined CAN0 message data length code register 07 C0MDLC07 0000xxxxB FA78H FA79H CAN0 message configuration register 07 C0MCONF07 FA7AH CAN0 message ID register 07 C0MIDL07 Undefined C0MIDH07 Undefined C0MCTRL07 00x00000 000xx000B FA7CH FA7EH CAN0 message control register 07 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined 379 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (5/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FA80H FA80H FA81H FA82H FA82H FA83H 8 R/W CAN0 message data byte 01 register 08 C0MDATA0108 CAN0 message data byte 0 register 08 C0MDATA008 CAN0 message data byte 1 register 08 C0MDATA108 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 08 C0MDATA2308 CAN0 message data byte 2 register 08 C0MDATA208 Default Value 16 Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 3 register 08 C0MDATA308 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 08 C0MDATA4508 FA84H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 08 C0MDATA408 Undefined FA85H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 08 C0MDATA508 Undefined FA84H FA86H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 08 C0MDATA6708 FA86H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 08 C0MDATA608 Undefined FA87H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 08 C0MDATA708 Undefined FA88H CAN0 message data length code register 08 C0MDLC08 0000xxxxB FA89H CAN0 message configuration register 08 C0MCONF08 Undefined FA8AH CAN0 message ID register 08 C0MIDL08 C0MIDH08 Undefined FA8EH CAN0 message control register 08 C0MCTRL08 00x00000 000xx000B FA90H FA8CH Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 09 C0MDATA0109 FA90H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 09 C0MDATA009 Undefined FA91H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 09 C0MDATA109 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 09 C0MDATA2309 FA92H Undefined Undefined FA92H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 09 C0MDATA209 Undefined FA93H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 09 C0MDATA309 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 09 C0MDATA4509 FA94H Undefined FA94H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 09 C0MDATA409 Undefined FA95H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 09 C0MDATA509 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 09 C0MDATA6709 FA96H Undefined FA96H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 09 C0MDATA609 Undefined FA97H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 09 C0MDATA709 Undefined FA98H CAN0 message data length code register 09 C0MDLC09 0000xxxxB FA99H CAN0 message configuration register 09 C0MCONF09 FA9AH CAN0 message ID register 09 C0MIDL09 Undefined C0MIDH09 Undefined C0MCTRL09 00x00000 000xx000B FA9CH FA9EH 380 CAN0 message control register 09 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (6/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FAA0H 8 R/W Default Value 16 CAN0 message data byte 01 register 10 C0MDATA0110 FAA0H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 10 C0MDATA010 FAA1H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 10 C0MDATA110 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 10 C0MDATA2310 FAA2H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 10 C0MDATA210 FAA3H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 10 C0MDATA310 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 10 C0MDATA4510 FAA4H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 10 C0MDATA410 Undefined FAA5H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 10 C0MDATA510 Undefined FAA2H FAA4H FAA6H Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 10 C0MDATA6710 FAA6H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 10 C0MDATA610 Undefined FAA7H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 10 C0MDATA710 Undefined FAA8H CAN0 message data length code register 10 C0MDLC10 0000xxxxB FAA9H CAN0 message configuration register 10 C0MCONF10 Undefined FAAAH CAN0 message ID register 10 C0MIDL10 C0MIDH10 Undefined CAN0 message control register 10 C0MCTRL10 00x00000 000xx000B Undefined FAACH FAAEH FAB0H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 11 C0MDATA0111 FAB0H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 11 C0MDATA011 Undefined FAB1H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 11 C0MDATA111 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 11 C0MDATA2311 FAB2H Undefined FAB2H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 11 C0MDATA211 Undefined FAB3H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 11 C0MDATA311 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 11 C0MDATA4511 FAB4H Undefined FAB4H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 11 C0MDATA411 Undefined FAB5H CAN0 message data byte 51 register 11 C0MDATA511 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 11 C0MDATA6711 FAB6H Undefined FAB6H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 11 C0MDATA611 Undefined FAB7H CAN0 message data byte 71 register 11 C0MDATA711 Undefined FAB8H CAN0 message data length code register 11 C0MDLC11 0000xxxxB FAB9H CAN0 message configuration register 11 C0MCONF11 FABAH CAN0 message ID register 11 C0MIDL11 Undefined C0MIDH11 Undefined C0MCTRL11 00x00000 000xx000B FABCH FABEH CAN0 message control register 11 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined 381 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (7/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FAC0H 8 R/W Default Value 16 CAN0 message data byte 01 register 12 C0MDATA0112 FAC0H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 12 C0MDATA012 FAC1H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 12 C0MDATA112 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 12 C0MDATA2312 FAC2H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 12 C0MDATA212 FAC3H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 12 C0MDATA312 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 12 C0MDATA4512 FAC4H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 12 C0MDATA412 Undefined FAC5H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 12 C0MDATA512 Undefined FAC2H FAC4H FAC6H Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 12 C0MDATA6712 FAC6H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 12 C0MDATA612 Undefined FAC7H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 12 C0MDATA712 Undefined FAC8H CAN0 message data length code register 12 C0MDLC12 0000xxxxB FAC9H CAN0 message configuration register 12 C0MCONF12 Undefined FACAH CAN0 message ID register 12 C0MIDL12 C0MIDH12 Undefined CAN0 message control register 12 C0MCTRL12 00x00000 000xx000B FACCH FACEH FAD0H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 13 C0MDATA0113 FAD0H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 13 C0MDATA013 Undefined FAD1H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 13 C0MDATA113 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 13 C0MDATA2313 FAD2H Undefined Undefined FAD2H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 13 C0MDATA213 Undefined FAD3H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 13 C0MDATA313 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 13 C0MDATA4513 FAD4H Undefined FAD4H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 13 C0MDATA413 Undefined FAD5H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 13 C0MDATA513 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 13 C0MDATA6713 FAD6H Undefined FAD6H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 13 C0MDATA613 Undefined FAD7H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 13 C0MDATA713 Undefined CAN0 message data length code register 13 C0MDLC13 0000xxxxB FAD8H FAD9H CAN0 message configuration register 13 C0MCONF13 FADAH CAN0 message ID register 13 C0MIDL13 Undefined C0MIDH13 Undefined C0MCTRL13 00x00000 000xx000B FADCH FADEH 382 CAN0 message control register 13 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (8/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 FAE0H 8 R/W Default Value 16 CAN0 message data byte 01 register 14 C0MDATA0114 FAE0H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 14 C0MDATA014 FAE1H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 14 C0MDATA114 CAN0 message data byte 23 register 14 C0MDATA2314 FAE2H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 14 C0MDATA214 FAE3H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 14 C0MDATA314 CAN0 message data byte 45 register 14 C0MDATA4514 FAE4H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 14 C0MDATA414 Undefined FAE5H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 14 C0MDATA514 Undefined FAE2H FAE4H FAE6H Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 14 C0MDATA6714 FAE6H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 14 C0MDATA614 Undefined FAE7H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 14 C0MDATA714 Undefined FAE8H CAN0 message data length code register 14 C0MDLC14 0000xxxxB FAE9H CAN0 message configuration register 14 C0MCONF14 Undefined FAEAH CAN0 message ID register 14 C0MIDL14 C0MIDH14 Undefined CAN0 message control register 14 C0MCTRL14 00x00000 000xx000B Undefined FAECH FAEEH FAF0H Undefined Undefined CAN0 message data byte 01 register 15 C0MDATA0115 FAF0H CAN0 message data byte 0 register 15 C0MDATA015 Undefined FAF1H CAN0 message data byte 1 register 15 C0MDATA115 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 23 register 15 C0MDATA2315 FAF2H Undefined FAF2H CAN0 message data byte 2 register 15 C0MDATA215 Undefined FAF3H CAN0 message data byte 3 register 15 C0MDATA315 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 45 register 15 C0MDATA4515 FAF4H Undefined FAF4H CAN0 message data byte 4 register 15 C0MDATA415 Undefined FAF5H CAN0 message data byte 5 register 15 C0MDATA515 Undefined CAN0 message data byte 67 register 15 C0MDATA6715 FAF6H Undefined FAF6H CAN0 message data byte 6 register 15 C0MDATA615 Undefined FAF7H CAN0 message data byte 7 register 15 C0MDATA715 Undefined CAN0 message data length code register 15 C0MDLC15 0000xxxx FAF8H FAF9H CAN0 message configuration register 15 C0MCONF15 FAFAH CAN0 message ID register 15 C0MIDL15 Undefined C0MIDH15 Undefined C0MCTRL15 00x00000 000xx000B FAFCH FAFEH CAN0 message control register 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Undefined 383 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-16. Register Access Types (9/9) Address Register Name Symbol R/W Bit Manipulation Units 1 8 16 Default Value FF60H CAN0 module receive history list register C0RGPT R/W - - xx02H FF62H CAN0 module transmit history list register C0TGPT R/W - - xx02H FF64H CAN0 global control register C0GMCTRL R/W - - 0000H FF66H CAN0 global automatic block transmission control register C0GMABT R/W - - 0000H FF68H CAN0 module last out-pointer register C0LOPT R - - Undefined FF6EH CAN0 global clock select register C0GMCS R/W - - 0FH FF6FH CAN0 global automatic block transmission delay setting register C0GMABTD R/W - - 00H FF70H CAN0 module mask 1 register C0MASK1L R/W - - Undefined R/W - - Undefined R/W - - Undefined R/W - - Undefined FF72H FF74H C0MASK1H CAN0 module mask 2 register C0MASK2L FF76H FF78H C0MASK2H C0MASK3L CAN0 module mask 3 register FF7AH FF7CH C0MASK3H CAN0 module mask 4 register C0MASK4L FF7EH C0MASK4H FF8AH CAN0 module time stamp register C0TS R/W - - 0000H FF90H CAN0 module control register C0CTRL R/W - - 0000H FF92H CAN0 module last error information register C0LEC R/W - - 00H FF93H CAN0 module information register C0INFO R - - 00H FF94H CAN0 module error counter register C0ERC R - - 0000H FF96H CAN0 module interrupt enable register C0IE R/W - - 0000H FF98H CAN0 module interrupt status register C0INTS R/W - - 0000H FF9CH CAN0 module bit rate register C0BTR R/W - - 370FH FF9EH CAN0 module bit rate prescaler register C0BRP R/W - - FFH FF9FH CAN0 module last in-pointer register C0LIPT R - - Undefined 384 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.5.3 Register bit configuration Table 15-17. Bit Configuration of CAN Global Registers Address FF64H Symbol Bit 7/15 Bit 6/14 Bit 5/13 Bit 4/12 Bit 3/11 Bit 2/10 Bit 1/9 Bit 0/8 C0GMCTRL(W) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear GOM 0 0 0 0 0 0 Set EFSD Set GOM FF65H FF64H C0GMCTRL(R) FF65H FF66H C0GMABT(W) FF67H FF66H C0GMABT(R) FF67H 0 0 0 0 0 0 EFSD GOM MBON 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear ABTTRG 0 0 0 0 0 0 Set ABTCLR Set ABTTRG 0 0 0 0 0 0 ABTCLR ABTTRG 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 FF6EH C0GMCS 0 0 0 0 CCP3 CCP2 CCP1 CCP0 FF6FH C0GMABTD 0 0 0 0 ABTD3 ABTD2 ABTD1 ABTD0 Caution The actual register address is calculated as follows: Register Address = Global Register Area Offset (CH dependent) + Offset Address as listed in table above Remark (R) When read (W) When write User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 385 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-18. Bit Configuration of CAN Module Registers (1/2) Address FF60H Symbol C0RGPT(W) FF61H FF60H C0RGPT(R) Bit 7/15 Bit 6/14 Bit 5/13 Bit 4/12 Bit 3/11 Bit 2/10 Bit 1/9 Bit 0/8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear ROVF 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RHPM ROVF FF61H RGPT[7:0] FF62H C0LOPT FF64H C0TGPT(W) FF65H FF64H C0TGPT(R) LOPT[7:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear TOVF 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 THPM TOVF FF65H FF70H TGPT[7:0] C0MASK1L CM1ID [7:0] FF71H FF72H CM1ID [15:8] C0MASK1H FF73H FF74H CM1ID [23:16] 0 0 0 C0MASK2L CM2ID [7:0] C0MASK2H CM2ID [23:16] FF75H FF76H CM2ID [15:8] FF77H FF78H 0 0 0 C0MASK3L CM3ID [15:8] C0MASK3H FF7BH FF7CH CM3ID [23:16] 0 0 0 C0MASK4L CM4ID [15:8] C0MASK4H FF7FH FF8AH C0TS(W) FF8BH FF8AH CM3ID [28:24] CM4ID [7:0] FF7DH FF7EH CM2ID [28:24] CM3ID [7:0] FF79H FF7AH CM1ID [28:24] C0TS(R) FF8BH CM4ID [23:16] 0 0 0 CM4ID [28:24] 0 0 0 0 0 Clear TSLOCK Clear TSSEL Clear TSEN 0 0 0 0 0 Set TSLOCK Set TSSEL Set TSEN 0 0 0 0 0 TSLOCK TSSEL TSEN 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Caution The actual register address is calculated as follows: Register Address = Global Register Area Offset (CH dependent) + Offset Address as listed in table above Remark (R) When read (W) When write 386 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-18. Bit Configuration of CAN Module Registers (2/2) Address FF90H Symbol Bit 7/15 Bit 6/14 Bit 5/13 C0CTRL(W) Clear CCERC Clear AL Clear VALID Clear Clear Clear Clear Clear PSMODE PSMODE OPMODE OPMODE OPMODE 1 0 2 1 0 Set CCERC Set AL 0 Set Set Set Set Set PSMODE PSMODE OPMODE OPMODE OPMODE 1 0 2 1 0 CCERC AL VALID PS MODE1 PS MODE0 OP MODE2 OP MODE1 OP MODE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RSTAT TSTAT 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 FF91H FF90H C0CTRL(R) FF91H FF92H C0LEC(W) Bit 4/12 Bit 3/11 Bit 2/10 Bit 1/9 Bit 0/8 FF92H C0LEC(R) 0 0 0 0 0 LEC2 LEC1 LEC0 FF93H C0INFO 0 0 0 BOFF TECS1 TECS0 RECS1 RECS0 FF94H C0ERC TEC[7:0] FF95H FF96H REC[7:0] C0IE(W) FF97H FF96H C0IE(R) FF97H FF98H C0INTS(W) FF99H FF98H C0INTS(R) FF99H FF9CH C0BTR FF9DH 0 0 Clear CIE5 Clear CIE4 Clear CIE3 Clear CIE2 Clear CIE1 Clear CIE0 0 0 Set CIE5 Set CIE4 Set CIE3 Set CIE2 Set CIE1 Set CIE0 0 0 CIE5 CIE4 CIE3 CIE2 CIE1 CIE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear CINTS5 Clear CINTS4 Clear CINTS3 Clear CINTS2 Clear CINTS1 Clear CINTS0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CINTS5 CINTS4 CINTS3 CINTS2 CINTS1 CINTS0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TSEG1[3:0] SJW[1:0] 0 FF9EH C0BRP TQPRS[7:0] FF9FH C0LIPT LIPT[7:0] TSEG2[2:0] Caution The actual register address is calculated as follows: Register Address = Global Register Area Offset (CH dependent) + Offset Address as listed in table above Remark (R) When read (W) When write User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 387 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-19. Bit Configuration of Message Buffer Registers Address FAx0H Symbol C0MDATA01m FAx1H Bit 7/15 Bit 6/14 C0MDATA0m FAx1H C0MDATA1m Message data (byte 1) FAx2H C0MDATA23m Message data (byte 2) FAx3H Bit 2/10 Bit 1/9 Bit 0/8 Message data (byte 3) C0MDATA2m Message data (byte 2) FAx3H C0MDATA3m Message data (byte 3) FAx4H C0MDATA45m Message data (byte 4) FAx4H C0MDATA4m Message data (byte 4) FAx5H C0MDATA5m Message data (byte 5) FAx6H C0MDATA67m Message data (byte 6) FAx5H Message data (byte 5) FAx7H Message data (byte 7) FAx6H C0MDATA6m Message data (byte 6) FAx7H C0MDATA7m Message data (byte 7) FAx8H C0MDLCm FAx9H C0MCONFm FAxAH C0MIDLm FAxBH C0MIDHm FAxDH C0MCTRLm (W) FAxFH FAxEH Bit 3/11 Message data (byte 0) FAx2H FAxEH Bit 4/12 Message data (byte 1) FAx0H FAxCH Bit 5/13 Message data (byte 0) C0MCTRLm (R) FAxFH 0 0 0 0 MDLC3 MDLC2 MDLC1 MDLC0 OWS RTR MT2 MT1 MT0 0 0 MA0 ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 ID15 ID14 ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID23 ID22 ID21 ID20 ID19 ID18 ID17 ID16 IDE 0 0 ID28 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear MOW Clear IE 0 Set IE Clear DN Clear TRQ Clear RDY 0 Set TRQ Set RDY 0 0 0 MOW IE DN TRQ RDY 0 0 MUC 0 0 0 0 0 Caution The actual register address is calculated as follows: Register Address = Global Register Area Offset (CH dependent) + Offset Address as listed in table above Remarks 1. (R) When read (W) When write 2. m = 0 to 15 388 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.6 Bit Set/Clear Function The CAN control registers include registers whose bits can be set or cleared via the CPU and via the CAN interface. An operation error occurs if the following registers are written directly. Do not write any values directly via bit manipulation, read/modify/write, or direct writing of target values. * CAN global control register (C0GMCTRL) * CAN global automatic block transmission control register (C0GMABT) * CAN module control register (C0CTRL) * CAN module interrupt enable register (C0IE) * CAN module interrupt status register (C0INTS) * CAN module receive history list register (C0RGPT) * CAN module transmit history list register (C0TGPT) * CAN module time stamp register (C0TS) * CAN message control register (C0MCTRLm) Remark m = 0 to 15 All the 16 bits in the above registers can be read via the usual method. Use the procedure described in figure 1523 below to set or clear the lower 8 bits in these registers. Setting or clearing of lower 8 bits in the above registers is performed in combination with the higher 8 bits (refer to the 16-bit data after a write operation in Figure 15-24). Figure 15-23 shows how the values of set bits or clear bits relate to set/clear/no change operations in the corresponding register. Figure 15-23. Example of Bit Setting/Clearing Operations Register's current values 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 1 Write values 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 set 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 clear 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 Set Set 0 No change 0 No change 0 Clear 0 No change 0 Clear 0 Clear 0 Bit status Register's value after write operations 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 389 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-24. 16-Bit Data during Write Operation 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 set 7 set 6 set 5 set 4 set 3 set 2 set 1 7 6 4 3 2 1 0 set 0 clear 7 clear 6 clear 5 clear 4 clear 3 clear 2 clear 1 clear 0 set n clear n Status of bit n after bit set/clear operation 0 0 No change 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 No change Remark n = 0 to 7 390 5 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.7 Control Registers Remark m = 0 to 15 (1) CAN global control register (C0GMCTRL) The C0GMCTRL register is used to control the operation of the CAN module. After reset: 0000H R/W Address: FF64H, FF65H (a) Read C0GMCTRL 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 MBON 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 EFSD GOM 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 (b) Write C0GMCTRL Set Set EFSD GOM 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Clear GOM (a) Read MBON Bit Enabling Access to Message Buffer Register, Transmit/Receive History List Registers 0 Write access and read access to the message buffer register and the transmit/receive history list registers is disabled. 1 Write access and read access to the message buffer register and the transmit/receive history list registers is enabled. Cautions 1. While the MBON bit is cleared (to 0), software access to the message buffers (C0MDATA0m, C0MDATA1m, C0MDATA01m, C0MDATA2m, C0MDATA3m, C0MDATA23m, C0MDATA4m, C0MDATA5m, C0MDATA45m, C0MDATA6m, C0MDATA7m, C0MDATA67m, C0MDLCm, C0MCONFm, C0MIDLm, C0MIDHm, and C0MCTRLm), or registers related to transmit history or receive history (C0LOPT, C0TGPT, C0LIPT, and C0RGPT) is disabled. 2. This bit is read-only. Even if 1 is written to MBON while it is 0, the value of MBON does not change, and access to the message buffer registers, or registers related to transmit history or receive history remains disabled. Remark MBON bit is cleared (to 0) when the CAN module enters CAN sleep mode/CAN stop mode or GOM bit is cleared (to 0). MBON bit is set (to 1) when the CAN sleep mode/the CAN stop mode is released or GOM bit is set (to 1). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 391 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER EFSD Bit Enabling Forced Shut Down 0 Forced shut down by GOM = 0 disabled. 1 Forced shut down by GOM = 0 enabled. Caution To request forced shutdown, the GOM bit must be cleared to 0 in a subsequent, immediately following write access after the EFSD bit has been set to 1. If access to another register (including reading the C0GMCTRL register) is executed without clearing the GOM bit immediately after the EFSD bit has been set to 1, the EFSD bit is forcibly cleared to 0, and the forced shutdown request is invalid. GOM Global Operation Mode Bit 0 CAN module is disabled from operating. 1 CAN module is enabled to operate. Caution The GOM bit can be cleared only in the initialization mode or immediately after EFSD bit is set (to 1). (b) Write Set EFSD EFSD Bit Setting 0 No change in ESFD bit . 1 EFSD bit set to 1. Set GOM Clear GOM 0 1 GOM bit cleared to 0. 1 0 GOM bit set to 1. Other than above GOM Bit Setting No change in GOM bit. Caution Set GOM bit and ESFD bit always separately. 392 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (2) CAN global clock selection register (C0GMCS) The C0GMCS register is used to select the CAN module system clock. After reset: 0FH C0GMCS R/W Address: FF6EH 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 CCP3 CCP2 CCP1 CCP0 CCP3 CCP2 CCP1 CCP1 CAN Module System Clock (fCANMOD) 0 0 0 0 fCAN/1 0 0 0 1 fCAN/2 0 0 1 0 fCAN/3 0 0 1 1 fCAN/4 0 1 0 0 fCAN/5 0 1 0 1 fCAN/6 0 1 1 0 fCAN/7 0 1 1 1 fCAN/8 1 0 0 0 fCAN/9 1 0 0 1 fCAN/10 1 0 1 0 fCAN/11 1 0 1 1 fCAN/12 1 1 0 0 fCAN/13 1 1 0 1 fCAN/14 1 1 1 0 fCAN/15 1 1 1 1 fCAN/16 (Default value) Remark fCAN = Clock supplied to CAN User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 393 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (3) CAN global automatic block transmission control register (C0GMABT) The C0GMABT register is used to control the automatic block transmission (ABT) operation. After reset: 0000H R/W Address: FF66H, FF67H (a) Read C0GMABT 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ABTCLR ABTTRG (b) Write C0GMABT 9 8 Set Set ABTCLR ABTTRG 0 Clear ABTTRG Caution Before changing the normal operation mode with ABT to the initialization mode, be sure to set the C0GMABT register to the default value (0000H). (a) Read ABTCLR Automatic Block Transmission Engine Clear Status Bit 0 Clearing the automatic transmission engine is completed. 1 The automatic transmission engine is being cleared. Remarks 1. Set the ABTCLR bit to 1 while the ABTTRG bit is cleared (0). The operation is not guaranteed if the ABTCLR bit is set to 1 while the ABTTRG bit is set to 1. 2. When the automatic block transmission engine is cleared by setting the ABTCLR bit to 1, the ABTCLR bit is automatically cleared to 0 as soon as the requested clearing processing is complete. ABTTRG Automatic Block Transmission Status Bit 0 Automatic block transmission is stopped. 1 Automatic block transmission is under execution. Caution Do not set the ABTTRG bit (ABTTRG = 1) in the initialization mode. If the ABTTRG bit is set in the initialization mode, the operation is not guaranteed after the CAN module has entered the normal operation mode with ABT. 394 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (b) Write Set ABTCLR Automatic Block Transmission Engine Clear Request Bit 0 The automatic block transmission engine is in idle state or under operation. 1 Request to clear the automatic block transmission engine. After the automatic block transmission engine has been cleared, automatic block transmission is started from message buffer 0 by setting the ABTTRG bit to 1. Set ABTTRG Clear Automatic Block Transmission Start Bit ABTTRG 0 1 Request to stop automatic block transmission. 1 0 Request to start automatic block transmission. Other than above No change in ABTTRG bit. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 395 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (4) CAN global automatic block transmission delay setting register (C0GMABTD) The C0GMABTD register is used to set the interval at which the data of the message buffer assigned to ABT is to be transmitted in the normal operation mode with ABT. After reset: 00H R/W C0GMABTD Address: FF6FH 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 ABTD3 ABTD2 ABTD1 ABTD0 ABTD3 ABTD2 ABTD1 ABTD0 Data frame interval during automatic block transmission (unit: Data bit time (DBT)) 0 0 0 0 0 DBT (default value) 0 0 0 1 2 DBT 0 0 1 0 2 DBT 0 0 1 1 2 DBT 0 1 0 0 2 DBT 0 1 0 1 2 DBT 0 1 1 0 2 DBT 0 1 1 1 2 DBT 1 0 0 0 2 DBT 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 Other than above Setting prohibited Cautions 1. Do not change the contents of the C0GMABTD register while the ABTTRG bit is set to 1. 2. The timing at which the ABT message is actually transmitted onto the CAN bus differs depending on the status of transmission from the other station or how a request to transmit a message other than an ABT message (message buffers 8 to 15) is made. 396 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (5) CAN module mask control register (C0MASKaL, C0MASKaH) (a = 1, 2, 3, or 4) The C0MASKaL and C0MASKaH registers are used to extend the number of receivable messages into the same message buffer by masking part of the ID comparison of a message and invalidating the ID of the masked part. - CAN Module Mask 1 Register (C0MASK1L, C0MASK1H) After reset: Undefined R/W Address: C0MASK1L FF70H, FF71H C0MASK1H FF72H, FF73H 15 C0MASK1L C0MASK1H 14 13 12 11 10 CMID15 CMID14 CMID13 CMID12 CMID11 CMID10 9 8 CMID9 CMID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMID7 CMID6 CMID5 CMID4 CMID3 CMID2 CMID1 CMID0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 7 6 5 CMID28 CMID27 CMID26 CMID25 CMID24 4 3 2 1 0 CMID23 CMID22 CMID21 CMID20 CMID19 CMID18 CMID17 CMID16 - CAN Module Mask 2 Register (C0MASK2L, C0MASK2H) After reset: Undefined R/W Address: C0MASK2L FF74H, FF75H C0MASK2H FF76H, FF77H 15 C0MASK2L C0MASK2H 14 13 12 11 10 CMID15 CMID14 CMID13 CMID12 CMID11 CMID10 9 8 CMID9 CMID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMID7 CMID6 CMID5 CMID4 CMID3 CMID2 CMID1 CMID0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 7 6 5 CMID28 CMID27 CMID26 CMID25 CMID24 4 3 2 1 0 CMID23 CMID22 CMID21 CMID20 CMID19 CMID18 CMID17 CMID16 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 397 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER - CAN Module Mask 3 Register (C0MASK3L, C0MASK3H) After reset: Undefined 15 C0MASK3L R/W 14 Address: 13 C0MASK3L FF78H, FF79H C0MASK3H FF7AH, FF7BH 12 11 10 CMID15 CMID14 CMID13 CMID12 CMID11 CMID10 C0MASK3H 9 8 CMID9 CMID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMID7 CMID6 CMID5 CMID4 CMID3 CMID2 CMID1 CMID0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 7 6 5 CMID28 CMID27 CMID26 CMID25 CMID24 4 3 2 1 0 CMID23 CMID22 CMID21 CMID20 CMID19 CMID18 CMID17 CMID16 - CAN Module Mask 4 Register (C0MASK4L, C0MASK4H) After reset: Undefined R/W Address: C0MASK4L FF7CH, FF7DH C0MASK4H FF7EH, FF7FH 15 C0MASK4L 14 13 12 11 10 CMID15 CMID14 CMID13 CMID12 CMID11 CMID10 C0MASK4H 9 8 CMID9 CMID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMID7 CMID6 CMID5 CMID4 CMID3 CMID2 CMID1 CMID0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 7 6 5 CMID28 CMID27 CMID26 CMID25 CMID24 4 3 2 1 0 CMID23 CMID22 CMID21 CMID20 CMID19 CMID18 CMID17 CMID16 CMID28-CMID0 Sets Mask Pattern of ID Bit. 0 The ID bits of the message buffer set by the CMID28 to CMID0 bits are compared with the ID bits of the received message frame. 1 The ID bits of the message buffer set by the CMID28 to CMID0 bits are not compared with the ID bits of the received message frame (they are masked). Remark Masking is always defined by an ID length of 29 bits. If a mask is assigned to a message with a standard ID, CMID17 to CMID0 are ignored. Therefore, only CMID28 to CMID18 of the received ID are masked. The same mask can be used for both the standard and extended IDs. 398 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (6) CAN module control register (C0CTRL) The C0CTRL register is used to control the operation mode of the CAN module. After reset: 0000H R/W Address: FF90H, FF91H (a) Read C0CTRL 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 RSTAT TSTAT 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CCERC AL VALID 15 14 13 Set CCERC Set AL 0 7 6 5 Clear Clear Clear CCERC AL VALID PSMODE1 PSMODE0 OPMODE2 OPMODE1 OPMODE0 (b) Write C0CTRL 12 11 10 9 8 Set Set Set Set Set PSMODE1 PSMODE0 OPMODE2 OPMODE1 OPMODE0 4 3 2 1 0 Clear Clear Clear Clear Clear PSMODE1 PSMODE0 OPMODE2 OPMODE1 OPMODE0 (a) Read RSTAT Reception Status Bit 0 Reception is stopped. 1 Reception is in progress. Remark - The RSTAT bit is set to 1 under the following conditions (timing). - The SOF bit of a receive frame is detected - On occurrence of arbitration loss during a transmit frame - The RSTAT bit is cleared to 0 under the following conditions (timing) - When a recessive level is detected at the second bit of the interframe space - On transition to the initialization mode at the first bit of the interframe space User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 399 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER TSTAT Transmission Status Bit 0 Transmission is stopped. 1 Transmission is in progress. Remark - The TSTAT bit is set to 1 under the following conditions (timing). - The SOF bit of a transmit frame is detected - The first bit of an error flag is detected during a transmit frame - The TSTAT bit is cleared to 0 under the following conditions (timing). - During transition to bus-off state - On occurrence of arbitration loss in transmit frame - On detection of recessive level at the second bit of the interframe space - On transition to the initialization mode at the first bit of the interframe space CCERC Error Counter Clear Bit 0 The C0ERC and C0INFO registers are not cleared in the initialization mode. 1 The C0ERC and C0INFO registers are cleared in the initialization mode. Remarks 1. The CCERC bit is used to clear the C0ERC and C0INFO registers for re-initialization or forced recovery from the bus-off state. This bit can be set to 1 only in the initialization mode. 2. When the C0ERC and C0INFO registers have been cleared, the CCERC bit is also cleared to 0 automatically. 3. The CCERC bit can be set to 1 at the same time as a request to change the initialization mode to an operation mode is made.4. The CCERC bit is read-only in the CAN sleep mode or CAN stop mode. 4. The receive data may be corrupted in case of setting the CCERC bit to (1) immediately after entering the INIT mode from self-test mode. AL Bit to Set Operation in Case of Arbitration Loss 0 Re-transmission is not executed in case of an arbitration loss in the single-shot mode. 1 Re-transmission is executed in case of an arbitration loss in the single-shot mode. Remark The AL bit is valid only in the single-shot mode. VALID Valid Receive Message Frame Detection Bit 0 A valid message frame has not been received since the VALID bit was last cleared to 0. 1 A valid message frame has been received since the VALID bit was last cleared to 0. Remarks 1. Detection of a valid receive message frame is not dependent upon storage in the receive message buffer (data frame) or transmit message buffer (remote frame). 400 2. Clear the VALID bit (0) before changing the initialization mode to an operation mode. 3. If only two CAN nodes are connected to the CAN bus with one transmitting a message frame in the normal operation mode and the other in the receive-only mode, the VALID bit is not set to 1 before the transmitting node enters the error passive state, because in receive-only mode no acknowledge is generated. 4. In order to clear the VALID bit, set the Clear VALID bit to 1 first and confirm that the VALID bit is cleared. If it is not cleared, perform clearing processing again. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER PSMODE1 PSMODE0 Power Save Mode 0 0 No power save mode is selected. 0 1 CAN sleep mode 1 0 Setting prohibited 1 1 CAN stop mode Cautions 1. Transition to and from the CAN stop mode must be made via CAN sleep mode. A request for direct transition to and from the CAN stop mode is ignored. 2. The MBON flag of C0GMCTRL must be checked after releasing a power save mode, prior to access the message buffers again. 3. CAN Sleep mode requests are kept pending, until cancelled by software or entered on appropriate bus condition (bus idle). Software can check the actual status by reading PSMODE. OPMODE2 OPMODE1 OPMODE0 Operation Mode 0 0 0 No operation mode is selected (CAN module is in the initialization mode). 0 0 1 Normal operation mode 0 1 0 Normal operation mode with automatic block transmission function (normal operation mode with ABT) 0 1 1 Receive-only mode 1 0 0 Single-shot mode 1 0 1 Self-test mode Other than above Setting prohibited Caution Transit to initialization mode or power saving modes may take some time. Be sure to verify the success of mode change by reading the values, before proceeding. Remark The OPMODE[2:0] bits are read-only in the CAN sleep mode or CAN stop mode. (b)Write Set CCERC Clear CCERC Setting of CCERC Bit 1 1 CCERC bit is set to 1. Other than 0 CCERC bit is not changed. above Set AL Clear AL 0 1 AL bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 AL bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of AL Bit AL bit is not changed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 401 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Clear VALID Setting of VALID Bit 0 VALID bit is not changed. 1 VALID bit is cleared to 0. Set Clear PSMODE0 PSMODE0 0 1 PSMODE0 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 PSMODE bit is set to 1. Other than above PSMODE0 bit is not changed. Set Clear PSMODE1 PSMODE1 0 1 PSMODE1 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 PSMODE1 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of PSMODE1 Bit PSMODE1 bit is not changed. Set OPMODE0 Clear OPMODE0 0 1 OPMODE0 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 OPMODE0 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of OPMODE0 Bit OPMODE0 bit is not changed. Set OPMODE1 Clear OPMODE1 0 1 OPMODE1 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 OPMODE1 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of OPMODE1 Bit OPMODE1 bit is not changed. Set OPMODE2 Clear OPMODE2 0 1 OPMODE2 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 OPMODE2 bit is set to 1. Other than above 402 Setting of PSMODE0 Bit Setting of OPMODE2 Bit OPMODE2 bit is not changed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (7) CAN module last error code register (C0LEC) The C0LEC register provides the error information of the CAN protocol. After reset: 00H C0LEC R/W Address: FF92H 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 LEC2 LEC1 LEC0 Remarks 1. The contents of the C0LEC register are not cleared when the CAN module changes from an operation mode to the initialization mode. 2. If an attempt is made to write a value other than 00H to the C0LEC register by software, the access is ignored. LEC2 LEC1 LEC0 Last CAN Protocol Error Information 0 0 0 No error 0 0 1 Stuff error 0 1 0 Form error 0 1 1 ACK error 1 0 0 1 0 1 of a transmit message, ACK bit, error frame, or overload frame, but the value on the CAN bus is a recessive-level bit.) 1 1 0 CRC error 1 1 1 Undefined Bit error (The CAN module tried to transmit a recessive-level bit as part of a transmit message (except the arbitration field), but the value on the CAN bus is a dominant-level bit.) Bit error (The CAN module tried to transmit a dominant-level bit as part User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 403 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (8) CAN module information register (C0INFO) The C0INFO register indicates the status of the CAN module. After reset: 00H C0INFO R Address: 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 BOFF TECS1 TECS0 RECS1 RECS0 BOFF 0 1 404 FF93H Bus-off State Bit Not bus-off state (transmit error counter 255) (The value of the transmit counter is less than 256.) Bus-off state (transmit error counter > 255) (The value of the transmit counter is 256 or more.) TECS1 TECS0 Transmission Error Counter Status Bit 0 0 The value of the transmission error counter is less than that of the warning level (<96). 0 1 The value of the transmission error counter is in the range of the warning level (96 to 127). 1 0 Undefined 1 1 The value of the transmission error counter is in the range of the error passive or busoff state ( 128). RECS1 RECS0 Reception Error Counter Status Bit 0 0 The value of the reception error counter is less than that of the warning level (<96). 0 1 The value of the reception error counter is in the range of the warning level (96 to 127). 1 0 Undefined 1 1 The value of the reception error counter is in the error passive range ( 128). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (9) CAN module error counter register (C0ERC) The C0ERC register indicates the count value of the transmission/reception error counter. After reset: 0000H C0ERC REPS R Address: FF94H, FF95H 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 REPS REC6 REC5 REC4 REC3 REC2 REC1 REC0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TEC7 TEC6 TEC5 TEC4 TEC3 TEC2 TEC1 TEC0 Reception error passive status bit 0 Reception error counter is not error passive (<128) 1 Reception error counter is error passive range (128) REC6-REC0 0-127 Reception Error Counter Bit Number of reception errors. These bits reflect the status of the reception error counter. The number of errors is defined by the CAN protocol. Remark REC6 to REC0 of the reception error counter are invalid in the reception error passive state (RECS [1:0] = 11B). TEC7-TEC0 0-255 Transmission Error Counter Bit Number of transmission errors. These bits reflect the status of the transmission error counter. The number of errors is defined by the CAN protocol. Remark TEC7 to TEC0 of the transmission error counter are invalid in the bus-off state (BOFF = 1). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 405 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (10) CAN module interrupt enable register (C0IE) The C0IE register is used to enable or disable the interrupts of the CAN module. After reset: 0000H R/W Address: FF96H, FF97H (a) Read C0IE 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 CIE5 CIE4 CIE3 CIE2 CIE1 CIE0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 Set CIE5 Set CIE4 Set CIE3 Set CIE2 Set CIE1 Set CIE0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 Clear Clear Clear Clear Clear Clear CIE5 CIE4 CIE3 CIE2 CIE1 CIE0 (b) Write C0IE (a) Read CIE5-CIE0 CAN Module Interrupt Enable Bit 0 Output of the interrupt corresponding to interrupt status register CINTSx bit is disabled. 1 Output of the interrupt corresponding to interrupt status register CINTSx bit is enabled. (b) Write Set CIE5 Clear CIE5 0 1 CIE5 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 CIE5 bit is set to 1. Other than above CIE5 bit is not changed. Set CIE4 Clear CIE4 0 1 CIE4 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 CIE4 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of CIE4 Bit CIE4 bit is not changed. Set CIE3 Clear CIE3 0 1 CIE3 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 CIE3 bit is set to 1. Other than above 406 Setting of CIE5 Bit Setting of CIE Bit CIE3 bit is not changed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Set CIE2 Clear CIE2 0 1 CIE2 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 CIE2 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of CIE2 Bit CIE2 bit is not changed. Set CIE1 Clear CIE1 0 1 CIE1 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 CIE1 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of CIE1 Bit CIE1 bit is not changed. Set CIE0 Clear CIE0 0 1 CIE0 bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 CIE0 bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of CIE0 Bit CIE0 bit is not changed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 407 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (11) CAN module interrupt status register (C0INTS) The C0INTS register indicates the interrupt status of the CAN module. After reset: 0000H R/W Address: FF98H, FF99H (a) Read C0INTS 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 CINTS5 CINTS4 CINTS3 CINTS2 CINTS1 CINTS0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 Clear CINTS5 Clear CINTS4 Clear CINTS3 Clear CINTS2 Clear CINTS1 Clear CINTS0 (b) Write C0INTS (a) Read CINTS5-CINTS0 CAN Interrupt Status Bit 0 No related interrupt source event is pending. 1 A related interrupt source event is pending. Interrupt Status Bit Related Interrupt Source Event Note CINTS5 Wakeup interrupt from CAN sleep mode CINTS4 Arbitration loss interrupt CINTS3 CAN protocol error interrupt CINTS2 CAN error status interrupt CINTS1 Interrupt on completion of reception of valid message frame to message buffer m CINTS0 Interrupt on normal completion of transmission of message frame from message buffer m Note The CINTS5 bit is set only when the CAN module is woken up from the CAN sleep mode by a CAN bus operation. The CINTS5 bit is not set when the CAN sleep mode has been released by software. (b) Write Clear Setting of CINTS5 to CINTS0 Bits CINTS5-CINTS0 0 CINTS5 to CINTS0 bits are not changed. 1 CINTS5 to CINTS0 bits are cleared to 0. Caution Please clear the status bit of this register with software when the confirmation of each status is necessary in the interrupt processing, because these bits are not cleared automatically. 408 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (12) CAN module bit rate prescaler register (C0BRP) The C0BRP register is used to select the CAN protocol layer basic clock (fTQ). The communication baud rate is set to the C0BTR register. After reset: FFH R/W 7 C0BRP Address: 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TQPRS7 TQPRS6 TQPRS5 TQPRS4 TQPRS3 TQPRS2 TQPRS1 TQPRS0 TQPRS7-TQPRS0 CAN Protocol Layer Basic System Clock (fTQ) 0 fCANMOD/1 1 fCANMOD/2 : : n fCANMOD/(n+1) : : 255 FF9EH fCANMOD/256 (default value) Figure 15-25. CAN Module Clock CAN module clock selection register (C0GMCS) 0 fCAN 0 0 0 CCP3 CCP2 CCP1 CCP0 fCANMOD Prescaler Baud rate generator fTQ CAN bit-rate register (C0BTR) TQPRS7 TQPRS6 TQPRS5 TQPRS4 TQPRS3 TQPRS2 TQPRS1 TQPRS0 CAN module bit-rate prescaler register (C0BRP) Caution The C0BRP register can be write-accessed only in the initialization mode. Remark fCAN: Clock supplied to CAN (fPRS) fCANMOD: CAN module system clock fTQ: CAN protocol layer basic system clock User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 409 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (13) CAN module bit rate register (C0BTR) The C0BTR register is used to control the data bit time of the communication baud rate. After reset: 370FH C0BTR R/W Address: FF9CH, FF9DH 15 14 13 12 11 0 0 SJW1 SJW0 0 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 10 9 8 TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 2 1 0 TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10 Figure 15-26. Data Bit Time Data bit time (DBT) Sync segment Prop segment Phase segment 1 Time segmet 1(TSEG1) Phase segment 2 Time segmet 2(TSEG2) Sample point(SPT) 410 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER SJW1 SJW0 Length of Synchronization jump width 0 0 1TQ 0 1 2TQ 1 0 3TQ 1 1 4TQ (default value) TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 Length of time segment 2 0 0 0 1TQ 0 0 1 2TQ 0 1 0 3TQ 0 1 1 4TQ 1 0 0 5TQ 1 0 1 6TQ 1 1 0 7TQ 1 1 1 8TQ (default value) TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10 Length of time segment 1 0 0 0 0 Setting prohibited 0 0 0 1 2TQ 0 0 1 0 3TQ 0 0 1 1 4TQ 0 1 0 0 5TQ 0 1 0 1 6TQ 0 1 1 0 7TQ 0 1 1 1 8TQ 1 0 0 0 9TQ 1 0 0 1 10TQ 1 0 1 0 11TQ 1 0 1 1 12TQ 1 1 0 0 13TQ 1 1 0 1 14TQ 1 1 1 0 15TQ 1 1 1 1 16TQ (default value) Note Note Note This setting must not be made when the C0BRP register = 00H. Remark TQ = 1/fTQ (fTQ: CAN protocol layer basic system clock) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 411 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (14) CAN module last in-pointer register (C0LIPT) The C0LIPT register indicates the number of the message buffer in which a data frame or a remote frame was last stored. After reset: Undefined C0LIPT LIPT7-LIPT0 0 to 15 R Address: FF9FH 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LIPT7 LIPT6 LIPT5 LIPT4 LIPT3 LIPT2 LIPT1 LIPT0 Last In-Pointer Register (C0LIPT) When the C0LIPT register is read, the contents of the element indexed by the last inpointer (LIPT) of the receive history list are read. These contents indicate the number of the message buffer in which a data frame or a remote frame was last stored. Remark The read value of the C0LIPT register is undefined if a data frame or a remote frame has never been stored in the message buffer. If the RHPM bit of the C0RGPT register is set to 1 after the CAN module has changed from the initialization mode to an operation mode, therefore, the read value of the C0LIPT register is undefined. 412 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (15) CAN module receive history list register (C0RGPT) The C0RGPT register is used to read the receive history list. After reset: xx02H R/W Address: FF60H, FF61H (a) Read C0RGPT 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RGPT7 RGPT6 RGPT5 RGPT4 RGPT3 RGPT2 RGPT1 RGPT0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RHPM ROVF 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 (b) Write C0RGPT Clear ROVF (a) Read RGPT7-RGPT0 0 to 15 Receive History List Get Pointer When the C0RGPT register is read, the contents of the element indexed by the receive history list get pointer (RGPT) of the receive history list are read. These contents indicate the number of the message buffer in which a data frame or a remote frame has been stored. RHPM Receive History List Pointer Match Note 0 The receive history list has at least one message buffer number that has not been read. 1 The receive history list has no message buffer numbers that has not been read. Note The read value of RGPT0 to RGPT7 is invalid when RHPM = 1. ROVF 0 Receive History List Overflow Bit All the message buffer numbers that have not been read are preserved. All the numbers of the message buffer in which a new data frame or remote frame has been received and stored are recorded to the receive history list (the receive history list has a vacant element). 1 All the message buffer numbers that are recorded are preserved except the message buffer number recorded last Note . The RHL is fully loaded with the unread message buffer number and all RHL elements beside the last one are preserved. Message buffer number of subsequent data frame storage or remote frame assignment is always logged in the RHL element LIPT pointer -1 is pointing to. Note that the RHL will be updated, but the LIPT pointer will not be incremented. Always the position the LIPT pointer -1 is pointing to is overwritten (the receive history list does not have a vacant element). Note If ROVF is set, RHPM is no longer cleared on message storage, but RHPM is still set, if all entries of C0RGPT are read by software. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 413 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (b) Write Clear ROVF Setting of ROVF Bit 0 ROVF bit is not changed. 1 ROVF bit is cleared to 0. (16) CAN module last out-pointer register (C0LOPT) The C0LOPT register indicates the number of the message buffer to which a data frame or a remote frame was transmitted last. After reset: Undefined C0LOPT LOPT7-LOPT0 0 to 15 R Address: FF68H 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LOPT7 LOPT6 LOPT5 LOPT4 LOPT3 LOPT2 LOPT1 LOPT0 Last Out-Pointer of Transmit History List (LOPT) When the C0LOPT register is read, the contents of the element indexed by the last outpointer (LOPT) of the receive history list are read. These contents indicate the number of the message buffer to which a data frame or a remote frame was transmitted last. Remark The value read from the C0LOPT register is undefined if a data frame or remote frame has never been transmitted from a message buffer. If the THPM bit is set to 1 after the CAN module has changed from the initialization mode to an operation mode, therefore, the read value of the C0LOPT register is undefined. 414 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (17) CAN module transmit history list register (C0TGPT) The C0TGPT register is used to read the transmit history list. After reset: xx02H R/W Address: FF62H, FF63H (a) Read C0TGPT 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 TGPT7 TGPT6 TGPT5 TGPT4 TGPT3 TGPT2 TGPT1 TGPT0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 THPM TOVF 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 (b) Write C0TGPT Clear TOVF (a) Read TGPT7-TGPT0 0 to 15 Transmit History List Read Pointer When the C0TGPT register is read, the contents of the element indexed by the read pointer (TGPT) of the transmit history list are read. These contents indicate the number of the message buffer to which a data frame or a remote frame was transmitted last. THPM Note Transmit History Pointer Match 0 The transmit history list has at least one message buffer number that has not been read. 1 The transmit history list has no message buffer number that has not been read. Note The read value of TGPT0 to TGPT7 is invalid when THPM = 1. TOVF Transmit History List Overflow Bit 0 All the message buffer numbers that have not been read are preserved. All the numbers of the message buffers to which a new data frame or remote frame has been transmitted are recorded to the transmit history list (the transmit history list has a vacant element). 1 At least 7 entries have been stored since the host processor has serviced the THL last time (i.e. read CnTGPT). The first 6 entries are sequentially stored while the last entry can have been overwritten whenever a message is newly transmitted because all buffer numbers are stored at position LOPT-1 when TOVF bit is set. Thus the sequence of transmissions can not be recovered completely now. Note If TOVF is set, THPM is no longer cleared on message transmission, but THPM is still set, if all entries of C0TGPT are read by software. Remark Transmission from message buffer 0 to 7 is not recorded to the transmit history list in the normal operation mode with ABT. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 415 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (b) Write Clear TOVF Setting of TOVF Bit 0 TOVF bit is not changed. 1 TOVF bit is cleared to 0. (18) CAN module time stamp register (C0TS) The C0TS register is used to control the time stamp function. After reset: 0000H R/W Address: FF8AH, FF8BH (a) Read C0TS 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 TSLOCK TSSEL TSEN 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 0 (b) Write C0TS 7 6 5 4 3 0 0 0 0 0 Set Set Set TSLOCK TSSEL TSEN 2 1 0 Clear Clear Clear TSLOCK TSSEL TSEN Remark The lock function of the time stamp function must not be used when the CAN module is in the normal operation mode with ABT. (a) Read TSLOCK 0 Time Stamp Lock Function Enable Bit Time stamp lock function stopped. The TSOUT signal is toggled each time the selected time stamp capture event occurs. 1 Time stamp lock function enabled. The TSOUT signal is toggled each time the selected time stamp capture event occurs. However, the TSOUT output signal is locked when a data frame has been correctly received to message buffer 0 Note . Note The TSEN bit is automatically cleared to 0. TSSEL 416 Time Stamp Capture Event Selection Bit 0 The time stamp capture event is SOF. 1 The time stamp capture event is the last bit of EOF. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER TSEN TSOUT Signal Operation Setting Bit 0 Disable TSOUT signal toggle operation. 1 Enable TSOUT signal toggle operation. Remark The signal TSOUT is output from the CAN macro to a timer resource, depending on implementation. Refer to documentation of device implementation for details. (b) Write Set TSLOCK Clear Setting of TSLOCK Bit TSLOCK 0 1 TSLOCK bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 TSLOCK bit is set to 1. Other than above TSLOCK bit is not changed. Set TSSEL Clear TSSEL 0 1 TSSEL bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 TSSEL bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of TSSEL Bit TSSEL bit is not changed. Set TSEN Clear TSEN 0 1 TSEN bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 TSEN bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of TSEN Bit TSEN bit is not changed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 417 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (19) CAN message data byte register (C0MDATAxm)(x = 0 to 7), (C0MDATAzm) (z = 01, 23, 45, 67) The C0MDATAxm, C0MDATAzm registers are used to store the data of a transmit/receive message. The C0MDATAzm registers can access the C0MDATAxm registers in 16-bit units. After reset: Undefined R/W Address: See Table 15-16 - C0MDATAxm Register 7 C0MDATA0m 418 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDATA67 MDATA66 MDATA65 MDATA64 MDATA63 MDATA62 MDATA61 MDATA60 7 C0MDATA7m 0 MDATA57 MDATA56 MDATA55 MDATA54 MDATA53 MDATA52 MDATA51 MDATA50 7 C0MDATA6m 1 MDATA47 MDATA46 MDATA45 MDATA44 MDATA43 MDATA42 MDATA41 MDATA40 7 C0MDATA5m 2 MDATA37 MDATA36 MDATA35 MDATA34 MDATA33 MDATA32 MDATA31 MDATA30 7 C0MDATA4m 3 MDATA27 MDATA26 MDATA25 MDATA24 MDATA23 MDATA22 MDATA21 MDATA20 7 C0MDATA3m 4 MDATA17 MDATA16 MDATA15 MDATA14 MDATA13 MDATA12 MDATA11 MDATA10 7 C0MDATA2m 5 MDATA07 MDATA06 MDATA05 MDATA04 MDATA03 MDATA02 MDATA01 MDATA00 7 C0MDATA1m 6 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDATA77 MDATA76 MDATA75 MDATA74 MDATA73 MDATA72 MDATA71 MDATA70 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER - C0MDATAzm Register 15 C0MDATA01m 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 MDATA011 MDATA011 MDATA011 MDATA011 MDATA011 MDATA011 MDATA019 MDATA018 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDATA017 MDATA016 MDATA015 MDATA014 MDATA013 MDATA012 MDATA011 MDATA010 15 C0MDATA23m 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 MDATA231 MDATA231 MDATA231 MDATA231 MDATA231 MDATA231 MDATA239 MDATA238 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDATA237 MDATA236 MDATA235 MDATA234 MDATA233 MDATA232 MDATA231 MDATA230 15 C0MDATA45m 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 MDATA451 MDATA451 MDATA451 MDATA451 MDATA451 MDATA451 MDATA459 MDATA458 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDATA457 MDATA456 MDATA455 MDATA454 MDATA453 MDATA452 MDATA451 MDATA450 15 C0MDATA67m 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 MDATA671 MDATA671 MDATA671 MDATA671 MDATA671 MDATA671 MDATA679 MDATA678 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MDATA677 MDATA676 MDATA675 MDATA674 MDATA673 MDATA672 MDATA671 MDATA670 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 419 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (20) CAN message data length register m (C0MDLCm) The C0MDLCm register is used to set the number of bytes of the data field of a message buffer. After reset: 0000xxxxB R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 MDLC3 MDLC2 MDLC1 MDLC0 C0MDLCm Address: See Table 15-16 MDLC3 MDLC2 MDLC1 MDLC0 Data Length Of Transmit/Receive Message 0 0 0 0 0 bytes 0 0 0 1 1 byte 0 0 1 0 2 bytes 0 0 1 1 3 bytes 0 1 0 0 4 bytes 0 1 0 1 5 bytes 0 1 1 0 6 bytes 0 1 1 1 7 bytes 1 0 0 0 8 bytes 1 0 0 1 Setting prohibited 1 0 1 0 (If these bits are set during transmission, 8-byte data is transmitted 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 regardless of the set DLC value when a data frame is transmitted. However, the DLC actually transmitted to the CAN bus is the DLC Note value set to this register.) Note The data and DLC value actually transmitted to CAN bus are as follows. Type of Transmit Frame Data frame Length of Transmit Data Number of bytes specified by DLC DLC Transmitted MDLC[3:0] (However, 8 bytes if DLC 8) Remote frame 0 bytes Cautions 1. Be sure to set bits 7 to 4 0000B. 2. Receive data is stored in as many C0MDATAx as the number of bytes (however, the upper limit is 8) corresponding to DLC of the received frame. C0MDATAx in which no data is stored is undefined. 420 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (21) CAN message configuration register (C0MCONFm) The C0MCONFm register is used to specify the type of the message buffer and to set a mask. After reset: Undefined R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OWS RTR MT2 MT1 MT0 0 0 MA0 C0MCONFm Address: OWS 0 See Table 15-16 Overwrite Control Bit The message buffer that has already received a data frame Note is not overwritten by a newly received data frame. The newly received data frame is discarded. 1 The message buffer that has already received a data frame data frame. Note is overwritten by a newly received Note The "message buffer that has already received a data frame" is a receive message buffer whose DN bit has been set to 1. Remark A remote frame is received and stored, regardless of the setting of OWS bit and DN bit. A remote frame that satisfies the other conditions (ID matches, RTR = 0, TRQ = 0) is always received and stored in the corresponding message buffer (interrupt generated, DN flag set, MDLC[3:0] bits updated, and recorded to the receive history list). RTR Remote Frame Request Bit 0 Transmit a data frame. 1 Transmit a remote frame. Note Note The RTR bit specifies the type of message frame that is transmitted from a message buffer defined as a transmit message buffer.Even if a valid remote frame has been received, RTR of the transmit message buffer that has received the frame remains cleared to 0.Even if a remote frame whose ID matches has been received from the CAN bus with the RTR bit of the transmit message buffer set to 1 to transmit a remote frame, that remote frame is not received or stored (interrupt generated, DN flag set, MDLC[3:0] bits updated, and recorded to the receive history list). MT2 MT1 MT0 0 0 0 Transmit message buffer 0 0 1 Receive message buffer (no mask setting) 0 1 0 Receive message buffer (mask 1 set) 0 1 1 Receive message buffer (mask 2 set) 1 0 0 Receive message buffer (mask 3 set) 1 0 1 Receive message buffer (mask 4 set) Other than above Message Buffer Type Setting Bit Setting prohibited User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 421 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER MA0 Message Buffer Assignment Bit 0 Message buffer not used. 1 Message buffer used. Caution Be sure to write 0 to bits 2 and 1. (22) CAN message id register m (C0MIDLm, C0MIDHm) The C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers are used to set an identifier (ID). After reset: Undefined C0MIDLm R/W Address: See Table 15-16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ID15 ID14 ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 IDE 0 0 ID28 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ID23 ID22 ID21 ID20 ID19 ID18 ID17 ID16 C0MIDHm IDE Format Mode Specification Bit 0 Standard format mode (ID28 to ID18: 11 bits) 1 Extended format mode (ID28 to ID0: 29 bits) Note Note The ID17 to ID0 bits are not used. ID28 to ID0 ID28 to ID18 Standard ID value of 11 bits (when IDE = 0) ID28 to ID0 Extended ID value of 29 bits (when IDE = 1) Cautions 1. 2. 422 Message ID Be sure to write 0 to bits 14 and 13 of the C0MIDHm register. Be sure to align the ID value according to the given bit positions into this registers. Note that for standard ID, the ID value must be shifted to fit into ID28 to ID11 bit positions. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (23) CAN message control register m (C0MCTRLm) The C0MCTRLm register is used to control the operation of the message buffer. After reset: 00x000000 R/W Address: See Table 15-16. 00000000B (a) Read C0MCTRLm 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 MUC 0 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 MOW IE DN TRQ RDY 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 0 0 0 0 Set IE 0 Set TRQ Set RDY 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 Clear Clear Clear Clear Clear MOW IE DN TRQ RDY (b) Write C0MCTRLm (a) Read Note MUC Message Buffer Data Updating Bit 0 The CAN module is not updating the message buffer (reception and storage). 1 The CAN module is updating the message buffer (reception and storage). Note The MUC bit is undefined until the first reception and storage is performed. MOW Message Buffer Overwrite Status Bit 0 The message buffer is not overwritten by a newly received data frame. 1 The message buffer is overwritten by a newly received data frame. Remark MOW bit is not set to 1 even if a remote frame is received and stored in the transmit message buffer with DN = 1. IE 0 Message Buffer Interrupt Request Enable Bit Receive message buffer: Valid message reception completion interrupt disabled. Transmit message buffer: Normal message transmission completion interrupt disabled. 1 Receive message buffer: Valid message reception completion interrupt enabled. Transmit message buffer: Normal message transmission completion interrupt enabled. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 423 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER DN Message Buffer Data Updating Bit 0 A data frame or remote frame is not stored in the message buffer. 1 A data frame or remote frame is stored in the message buffer. TRQ Message Buffer Transmission Request Bit 0 No message frame transmitting request that is pending or being transmitted is in the message buffer. 1 The message buffer is holding transmission of a message frame pending or is transmitting a message frame. Caution Do not set the TRQ bit and the RDY bit (1) at the same time. Set the RDY bit (1) before setting the TRQ bit. RDY Message Buffer Ready Bit 0 The message buffer can be written by software. The CAN module cannot write to the message buffer. 1 Writing the message buffer by software is ignored (except a write access to the RDY, TRQ, DN, and MOW bits). The CAN module can write to the message buffer. Cautions 1. Do not clear the RDY bit (0) during message transmission. Follow the transmission abort process about clearing the RDY bit (0) for redefinition of the message buffer. 2. Clear again when RDY bit is not cleared even if this bit is cleared. 3. Be sure that RDY is cleared before writing to the other message buffer registers, by checking the status of the RDY bit. (b) Write Clear MOW Setting of MOW Bit 0 MOW bit is not changed. 1 MOW bit is cleared to 0. Set IE Clear IE 0 1 IE bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 IE bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of IE Bit IE bit is not changed. Caution Set IE bit and RDY bit always separately. Clear DN Setting of DN Bit 0 DN bit is not changed. 1 DN bit is cleared to 0. Caution Do not set the DN bit to 1 by software. Be sure to write 0 to bit 10. 424 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Set TRQ Clear TRQ 0 1 TRQ bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 TRQ bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of TRQ Bit TRQ bit is not changed. Set RDY Clear RDY 0 1 RDY bit is cleared to 0. 1 0 RDY bit is set to 1. Other than above Setting of RDY Bit RDY bit is not changed. Caution Set IE bit and RDY bit always separately. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 425 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.8 CAN Controller Initialization 15.8.1 Initialization of CAN module Before the CAN module operation is enabled, the CAN module system clock needs to be determined by setting the CCP[3:0] bits of the C0GMCS register by software. Do not change the setting of the CAN module system clock after CAN module operation is enabled. The CAN module is enabled by setting the GOM bit of the C0GMCTRL register. For the procedure of initializing the CAN module, refer to 15.16 Operation Of CAN Controller. 15.8.2 Initialization of message buffer After the CAN module is enabled, the message buffers contain undefined values. A minimum initialization for all the message buffers, even for those not used in the application, is necessary before switching the CAN module from the initialization mode to one of the operation modes. - Clear the RDY, TRQ, and DN bits of the C0MCTRLm register to 0. - Clear the MA0 bit of the C0MCONFm register to 0. Remark m = 0 to 15 15.8.3 Redefinition of message buffer Redefining a message buffer means changing the ID and control information of the message buffer while a message is being received or transmitted, without affecting other transmission/reception operations. (1) To redefine message buffer in initialization mode Place the CAN module in the initialization mode once and then change the ID and control information of the message buffer in the initialization mode. After changing the ID and control information, set the CAN module in an operation mode. (2) To redefine message buffer during reception Perform redefinition as shown in Figure 15-40. (3) To redefine message buffer during transmission To rewrite the contents of a transmit message buffer to which a transmission request has been set, perform transmission abort processing (refer to 15.10.4 (1) Transmission abort process except for in normal operation mode with automatic block transmission (ABT) and 15.10.4 (2) Transmission abort process except for ABT transmission in normal operation mode with automatic block transmission (ABT). Confirm that transmission has been aborted or completed, and then redefine the message buffer. After redefining the transmit message buffer, set a transmission request using the procedure described below. When setting a transmission request to a message buffer that has been redefined without aborting the transmission in progress, however, the 1-bit wait time is not necessary. 426 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-27. Setting Transmission Request (TRQ) to Transmit Message Buffer After Redefining Redefinition completed No Execute transmission? Yes Wait for 1 bit of CAN data. Set TRQ bit Set TRQ = 1 Clear TRQ = 0 End Cautions 1. When a message is received, reception filtering is performed in accordance with the ID and mask set to each receive message buffer. If the procedure in Figure 15-40 is not observed, the contents of the message buffer after it has been redefined may contradict the result of reception (result of reception filtering). If this happens, check that the ID and IDE received first and stored in the message buffer following redefinition are those stored after the message buffer has been redefined. If no ID and IDE are stored after redefinition, redefine the message buffer again. 2. When a message is transmitted, the transmission priority is checked in accordance with the ID, IDE, and RTR bits set to each transmit message buffer to which a transmission request was set. The transmit message buffer having the highest priority is selected for transmission. If the procedure in Figure 15-41 is not observed, a message with an ID not having the highest priority may be transmitted after redefinition. 15.8.4 Transition from initialization mode to operation mode The CAN module can be switched to the following operation modes. - Normal operation mode - Normal operation mode with ABT - Receive-only mode - Single-shot mode - Self-test mode User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 427 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-28. Transition to Operation Modes OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and CAN bus is busy. [Receive-only mode] OPMODE[2:0]=03H OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and CAN bus is busy. OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and CAN bus is busy. [Normal operation mode with ABT] OPMODE[2:0]=02H OPMODE[2:0] = 03H OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and interframe space OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and interframe space OPMODE[2:0] = 04H OPMODE[2:0] = 02H OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and CAN bus is busy. [Normal operation mode] OPMODE[2:0]=01H OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and interframe space OPMODE[2:0] = 01H [Single-shot mode] OPMODE[2:0]=04H OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and interframe space INIT mode OPMODE[2:0] = 00H OPMODE[2:0] = 05H OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and interframe space OPMODE[2:0] = 00H and CAN bus is busy. [Self-test mode] OPMODE[2:0]=05H GOM = 1 All CAN modules are in INIT mode and GOM = 0 EFSD = 1 and GOM = 0 CAN module channel invalid RESET released RESET The transition from the initialization mode to an operation mode is controlled by the bit string OPMODE[2:0] in the C0CTRL register. Changing from one operation mode into another requires shifting to the initialization mode in between. Do not change one operation mode to another directly; otherwise the operation will not be guaranteed. Requests for transition from the operation mode to the initialization mode are held pending when the CAN bus is not in the interframe space (i.e., frame reception or transmission is in progress), and the CAN module enters the initialization mode at the first bit in the interframe space (the value of OPMODE[2:0] are changed to 00H). After issuing a request to change the mode to the initialization mode, read the OPMODE[2:0] bits until their value becomes 000B to confirm that the module has entered the initialization mode (refer to Figure 15-37). 15.8.5 Resetting error counter C0ERC of CAN module If it is necessary to reset the CAN module error counter C0ERC and the CAN module information register C0INFO when re-initialization or forced recovery from the bus-off state is made, set the CCERC bit of the C0CTRL register to 1 in the initialization mode. When this bit is set to 1, the CAN module error counter C0ERC and the CAN module information register C0INFO are cleared to their default values. 428 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.9 Message Reception 15.9.1 Message reception In all the operation modes, the complete message buffer area is analyzed to find a suitable buffer to store a newly received message. All message buffers satisfying the following conditions are included in that evaluation (RX-search process). - Used as a message buffer (MA0 bit of C0MCONFm register set to 1B.) - Set as a receive message buffer (MT[2:0] bits of C0MCONFm register set to 001B, 010B, 011B, 100B, or 101B.) - Ready for reception (RDY bit of C0MCTRLm register set to 1.) When two or more message buffers of the CAN module receive a message, the message is stored according to the priority explained below. The message is always stored in the message buffer with the highest priority, not in a message buffer with a low priority. For example, when an unmasked receive message buffer and a receive message buffer linked to mask 1 have the same ID, the received message is not stored in the message buffer linked to mask 1, even if that message buffer has not received a message and a message has already been received in the unmasked receive message buffer. In other words, when a condition has been set to store a message in two or more message buffers with different priorities, the message buffer with the highest priority always stores the message; the message is not stored in message buffers with a lower priority. This also applies when the message buffer with the highest priority is unable to receive and store a message (i.e., when DN = 1 indicating that a message has already been received, but rewriting is disabled because OWS = 0). In this case, the message is not actually received and stored in the candidate message buffer with the highest priority, but neither is it stored in a message buffer with a lower priority. Priority 1 (high) Storing Condition If Same ID is Set Unmasked message buffer DN = 0 DN = 1 and OWS = 1 2 Message buffer linked to mask 1 DN = 0 DN = 1 and OWS = 1 3 Message buffer linked to mask 2 DN = 0 DN = 1 and OWS = 1 4 Message buffer linked to mask 3 DN = 0 DN = 1 and OWS = 1 5(low) Message buffer linked to mask 4 DN = 0 DN = 1 and OWS = 1 Remark m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 429 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.9.2 Receive Data Read To keep data consistency when reading CAN message buffers, perform the data reading according to Figure 15-51 to 15-53. During message reception, the CAN module sets DN of the C0MCTRLm register two times: at the beginning of the storage process of data to the message buffer, and again at the end of this storage process. During this storage process, the MUC bit of the C0MCTRLm register of the message buffer is set. (Refer to Figure 15-29.) The receive history list is also updated just before the storage process. In addition, during storage process (MUC = 1), the RDY bit of the C0MCTRL register of the message buffer is locked to avoid the coincidental data WR by CPU. Note the storage process may be disturbed (delayed) when the CPU accesses the message buffer. Figure 15-29. DN and MUC Bit Setting Period (for Standard ID Format) (11) R0 (1) IDE ID RTR SOF CAN std ID format (1) (1) (1) Recessive DLC DATA0-DATA7 CRC (4) (0-64) (16) ACK EOF (2) IFS Dominant (7) Message Store MDATA,MDLC.MIDx- > MBUF DN MUC CINTS1 INTREC1 Set DN & MUC at the same time Operation of the CAN contoroller Remark m = 0 to 15 430 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Set DN & clear MUC at the same timing CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.9.3 Receive history list function The receive history list (RHL) function records in the receive history list the number of the receive message buffer in which each data frame or remote frame was received and stored. The RHL consists of storage elements equivalent to up to 23 messages, the last in-message pointer (LIPT) with the corresponding C0LIPT register and the receive history list get pointer (RGPT) with the corresponding C0RGPT register. The RHL is undefined immediately after the transition of the CAN module from the initialization mode to one of the operation modes. The C0LIPT register holds the contents of the RHL element indicated by the value of the LIPT pointer minus 1. By reading the C0LIPT register, therefore, the number of the message buffer that received and stored a data frame or remote frame first can be checked. The LIPT pointer is utilized as a write pointer that indicates to what part of the RHL a message buffer number is recorded. Any time a data frame or remote frame is received and stored, the corresponding message buffer number is recorded to the RHL element indicated by the LIPT pointer. Each time recording to the RHL has been completed, the LIPT pointer is automatically incremented. In this way, the number of the message buffer that has received and stored a frame will be recorded chronologically. The RGPT pointer is utilized as a read pointer that reads a recorded message buffer number from the RHL. This pointer indicates the first RHL element that the CPU has not read yet. By reading the C0RGPT register by software, the number of a message buffer that has received and stored a data frame or remote frame can be read. Each time a message buffer number is read from the C0RGPT register, the RGPT pointer is automatically incremented. If the value of the RGPT pointer matches the value of the LIPT pointer, the RHPM bit (receive history list pointer match) of the C0RGPT register is set to 1. This indicates that no message buffer number that has not been read remains in the RHL. If a new message buffer number is recorded, the LIPT pointer is incremented and because its value no longer matches the value of the RGPT pointer, the RHPM bit is cleared. In other words, the numbers of the unread message buffers exist in the RHL. If the LIPT pointer is incremented and matches the value of the RGPT pointer minus 1, the ROVF bit (receive history list overflow) of the C0RGPT register is set to 1. This indicates that the RHL is full of numbers of message buffers that have not been read. When further message reception and storing occur, the last recorded message buffer number is overwritten by the number of the message buffer that received and stored the new message. In this case, after the ROVF bit has been set (1), the recorded message buffer numbers in the RHL do not completely reflect the chronological order. However messages itself are not lost and can be located by CPU search in message buffer memory with the help of the DN-bit. Caution If the history list is in the overflow condition (ROVF is set), reading the history list contents is still possible, until the history list is empty (indicated by RHPM flag set). Nevertheless, the history list remains in the overflow condition, until ROVF is cleared by software. If ROVF is not cleared, the RHPM flag will also not be updated (cleared) upon a message storage of newly received frame. This may lead to the situation, that RHPM indicates an empty history list, although a reception has taken place, while the history list is in the overflow state (ROVF and RHPM are set). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 431 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER As long as the RHL contains 23 or less entries the sequence of occurrence is maintained. If more receptions occur without reading the RHL by the host processor, complete sequence of receptions can not be recovered. Figure 15-30. Receive History List Receive history list(RHL) Receive history list (RHL) When message buffer 6 is read 23 22 : : : Last in-message pointer(LIPT) 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 : : : If message is stored in message buffers 3, 4, and 8 7 Last in-message pointer(LIPT) 23 22 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 9 Message buffer 6 Receive history list get pointer (RGPT) 7 Message buffer 8 6 5 4 Message buffer 4 Message buffer 3 3 2 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 1 Message buffer 9 0 Receive history list get pointer (RGPT) When RHL is full Receive history list (RHL) Receive history list(RHL) 23 22 Message buffer 1 Message buffer 9 : : : Last in-message pointer(LIPT) 7 Message buffer 5 6 5 4 3 Message buffer 8 Message buffer 4 Message buffer 3 2 1 0 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 9 ROVF is set. When ROVF = 1, message 23 22 buffer number is stored (overwritten) to element indicated by LIPT-1. When message buffer 3 receives and stores more messages 6 5 4 3 2 Receive history list get pointer (RGPT) Last in-message pointer(LIPT) LIPT is locked. 432 7 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 1 0 Message buffer 3 Message buffer 9 Message buffer 5 Message buffer 8 Message buffer 4 Message buffer 3 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 9 Receive history list get pointer (RGPT) CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.9.4 Mask function For any message buffer, which is used for reception, the assignment to one of four global reception masks (or no mask) can be selected. By using the mask function, the message ID comparison can be reduced by masked bits, herewith allowing the reception of several different IDs into one buffer. While the mask function is in effect, an identifier bit that is defined to be "1" by a mask in the received message is not compared with the corresponding identifier bit in the message buffer. However, this comparison is performed for any bit whose value is defined as "0" by the mask. For example, let us assume that all messages that have a standard-format ID, in which bits ID27 to ID25 are "0" and bits ID24 and ID22 are "1", are to be stored in message buffer 14. The procedure for this example is shown below. <1> Identifier to be stored in message buffer ID28 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21 ID20 ID19 ID18 x 0 0 0 1 x 1 x x x x x = don't care <2> Identifier to be configured in message buffer 14 (example) (using CANn message ID registers L14 and H14 (C0MIDL14 and C0MIDH14)) ID28 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21 ID20 ID19 ID18 x 0 0 0 1 x 1 x x x x ID17 ID16 ID15 ID14 ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7 x x x x x x x x x x x ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 x x x x x x x ID with ID27 to ID25 cleared to "0" and ID24 and ID22 set to "1" is registered (initialized) to message buffer 14. Remark Message buffer 14 is set as a standard format identifier that is linked to mask 1 (MT[2:0] of C0MCONF14 register are set to 010B). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 433 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER <3> Mask setting for CAN module 1 (mask 1) (Example) (Using CAN1 address mask 1 registers L and H (C1MASKL1 and C1MASKH1)) CMID28 CMID27 CMID26 CMID25 CMID24 CMID23 CMID22 CMID21 CMID20 CMID19 CMID18 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 CMID17 CMID16 CMID15 CMID14 CMID13 CMID12 CMID11 CMID10 CMID9 CMID8 CMID7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CMID6 CMID5 CMID4 CMID3 CMID2 CMID1 CMID0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Not compared (masked) 0: Compared The CMID27 to CMID24 and CMID22 bits are cleared to "0", and CMID28, CMID23, and CMID21 to CMID0 bits are set to "1". 434 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.9.5 Multi buffer receive block function The multi buffer receive block (MBRB) function is used to store a block of data in two or more message buffers sequentially with no CPU interaction, by setting the same ID to two or more message buffers with the same message buffer type. Suppose, for example, the same message buffer type is set to 5 message buffers, message buffers 10 to 14, and the same ID is set to each message buffer. If the first message whose ID matches the ID of the message buffers is received, it is stored in message buffer 10. At this point, the DN bit of message buffer 10 is set, prohibiting overwriting the message buffer when subsequent messages are received. If the next message with a matching ID is received, it is received and stored in message buffer 11. Each time a message with a matching ID is received, it is sequentially (in the ascending order) stored in message buffers 12, 13, and 14. Even when a data block consisting of multiple messages is received, the messages can be stored and received without overwriting the previously received matching-ID data. Whether a data block has been received and stored can be checked by setting the IE bit of the C0MCTRLm register of each message buffer. For example, if a data block consists of k messages, k message buffers are initialized for reception of the data block. The IE bit in message buffers 0 to (k-2) is cleared to 0 (interrupts disabled), and the IE bit in message buffer k-1 is set to 1 (interrupts enabled). In this case, a reception completion interrupt occurs when a message has been received and stored in message buffer k-1, indicating that MBRB has become full. Alternatively, by clearing the IE bit of message buffers 0 to (k-3) and setting the IE bit of message buffer k-2, a warning that MBRB is about to overflow can be issued. The basic conditions of storing receive data in each message buffer for the MBRB are the same as the conditions of storing data in a single message buffer. Cautions 1. MBRB can be configured for each of the same message buffer types. Therefore, even if a message buffer of another MBRB whose ID matches but whose message buffer type is different has a vacancy, the received message is not stored in that message buffer, but instead discarded. 2. MBRB does not have a ring buffer structure. Therefore, after a message is stored in the message buffer having the highest number in the MBRB configuration, a newly received message will not be stored in the message buffer having the lowest message buffer number. 3. MBRB operates based on the reception and storage conditions; there are no settings dedicated to MBRB, such as function enable bits. By setting the same message buffer type and ID to two or more message buffers, MBRB is automatically configured. 4. With MBRB, "matching ID" means "matching ID after mask". Even if the ID set to each message buffer is not the same, if the ID that is masked by the mask register matches, it is considered a matching ID and the buffer that has this ID is treated as the storage destination of a message. 5. The priority between MBRBs is mentioned in 15.9.1 Message Reception. Remark m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 435 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.9.6 Remote frame reception In all the operation modes, when a remote frame is received, the message buffer that is to store the remote frame is searched from all the message buffers satisfying the following conditions. - Used as a message buffer (MA0 bit of C0MCONFm register set to 1B.) - Set as a transmit message buffer (MT[2:0] bits in C0MCONFm register set to 000B) - Ready for reception (RDY bit of C0MCTRLm register set to 1.) - Set to transmit message (RTR bit of C0MCONFm register is cleared to 0.) - Transmission request is not set. (TRQ bit of C0MCTRLm register is cleared to 1.) Upon acceptance of a remote frame, the following actions are executed if the ID of the received remote frame matches the ID of a message buffer that satisfies the above conditions. - The MDLC[3:0] bit string in the C0MDLCm register stores the received DLC value. - C0MDATA0m to C0MDATA7m in the data area are not updated (data before reception is saved). - The DN bit of the C0MCTRLm register is set to 1. - The CINTS1 bit of the C0INTS register is set to 1 (if the IE bit in the C0MCTRLm register of the message buffer that receives and stores the frame is set to 1). - The reception completion interrupt (INTC0REC) is output (if the IE bit in the C0MCTRLm register of the message buffer that receives and stores the frame is set to 1 and if the CIE1 bit of the C0IE register is set to 1). - The message buffer number is recorded to the receive history list. Caution When a message buffer is searched for receiving and storing a remote frame, overwrite control by the OWS bit of the C0MCONFm register of the message buffer and the DN bit of the C0MCTRLm register are not affected. The setting of OWS is ignored, and DN is set in any case. If more than one transmit message buffer has the same ID and the ID of the received remote frame matches that ID, the remote frame is stored in the transmit message buffer with the lowest message buffer number. Remark 436 m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.10 Message Transmission 15.10.1 Message transmission In all the operation modes, if the TRQ bit is set to 1 in a message buffer that satisfies the following conditions, the message buffer that is to transmit a message is searched. - Used as a message buffer (MA0 bit of C0MCONFm register set to 1B.) - Set as a transmit message buffer (MT[2:0] bits of C0MCONFm register set to 000B.) - Ready for transmission (RDY bit of C0MCTRLm register set to 1.) The CAN system is a multi-master communication system. In a system like this, the priority of message transmission is determined based on message identifiers (IDs). To facilitate transmission processing by software when there are several messages awaiting transmission, the CAN module uses hardware to check the ID of the message with the highest priority and automatically identifies that message. This eliminates the need for softwarebased priority control. Transmission priority is controlled by the identifier (ID). Figure 15-31. Message Processing Example Message No. Message waiting to be transmitted 0 1 ID = 120H 2 ID = 229H 3 4 5 ID = 223H 6 ID = 023H The CAN module transmits messages in the following sequence. 1. Message 6 2. Message 1 3. Message 8 4. Message 5 5. Message 2 7 8 ID = 123H 9 After the transmit message search, the transmit message with the highest priority of the transmit message buffers that have a pending transmission request (message buffers with the TRQ bit set to 1 in advance) is transmitted. If a new transmission request is set, the transmit message buffer with the new transmission request is compared with the transmit message buffer with a pending transmission request. If the new transmission request has a higher priority, it is transmitted, unless transmission of a message with a low priority has already started. If transmission of a message with a low priority has already started, however, the new transmission request is transmitted later. To solve this priority inversion effect, the software can perform a transmission abort request for the lower priority message. The highest priority is determined according to the following rules. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 437 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Priority 1(high) Conditions Description Value of first 11 bits of ID The message frame with the lowest value represented by the first [ID28 to ID18]: 11 bits of the ID is transmitted first. If the value of an 11-bit standard ID is equal to or smaller than the first 11 bits of a 29-bit extended ID, the 11-bit standard ID has a higher priority than message frame with the 29-bit extended ID. 2 Frame type A data frame with an 11-bit standard ID (RTR bit is cleared to 0) has a higher priority than a remote frame with a standard ID and a message frame with an extended ID. 3 ID type A message frame with a standard ID (IDE bit is cleared to 0) has a higher priority than a message frame with an extended ID. 4 Value of lower 18 bits of ID If more than one transmission-pending extended ID message frame [ID17 to ID0]: have equal values in the first 11 bits of the ID and the same frame type (equal RTR bit values), the message frame with the lowest value in the lower 18 bits of its extended ID is transmitted first. 5(low) Message buffer number If two or more message buffers request transmission of message frames with the same ID, the message from the message buffer with the lowest message buffer number is transmitted first. Remarks 1. If automatic block transmission request bit ABTTRG is set to 1 in the normal operation mode with ABT, the TRQ bit is set to 1 only for one message buffer in the ABT message buffer group. If the ABT mode was triggered by ABTTRG bit, one TRQ bit is set to 1 in the ABT area (buffer 0 through 7). Beyond this TRQ bit, the application can request transmissions (set TRQ to 1) for other TX-message buffers that do not belong to the ABT area. In that case an interval arbitration process (TX-search) evaluates all TX-message buffers with TRQ bit set to 1 and chooses the message buffer that contains the highest prioritized identifier for the next transmission. If there are 2 or more identifiers that have the highest priority (i.e. identical identifiers), the message located at the lowest message buffer number is transmitted at first. Upon successful transmission of a message frame, the following operations are performed. - The TRQ flag of the corresponding transmit message buffer is automatically cleared to 0. - The transmission completion status bit CINTS0 of the C0INTS register is set to 1 (if the interrupt enable bit (IE) of the corresponding transmit message buffer is set to 1). - An interrupt request signal INTC0TRX output (if the CIE0 bit of the C0IE register is set to 1 and if the interrupt enable bit (IE) of the corresponding transmit message buffer is set to 1). 2. When changing the contents of a transmit buffer, the RDY flag of this buffer must be cleared before updating the buffer contents. As during internal transfer actions, the RDY flag may be locked temporarily, the status of RDY must be checked by software, after changing it. 3. m = 0 to 15 438 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.10.2 Transmit history list function The transmit history list (THL) function records in the transmit history list the number of the transmit message buffer from which data or remote frames have been were sent. The THL consists of storage elements equivalent to up to seven messages, the last out-message pointer (LOPT) with the corresponding C0LOPT register, and the transmit history list get pointer (TGPT) with the corresponding C0TGPT register. The THL is undefined immediately after the transition of the CAN module from the initialization mode to one of the operation modes. The C0LOPT register holds the contents of the THL element indicated by the value of the LOPT pointer minus 1. By reading the C0LOPT register, therefore, the number of the message buffer that transmitted a data frame or remote frame first can be checked. The LOPT pointer is utilized as a write pointer that indicates to what part of the THL a message buffer number is recorded. Any time a data frame or remote frame is transmitted, the corresponding message buffer number is recorded to the THL element indicated by the LOPT pointer. Each time recording to the THL has been completed, the LOPT pointer is automatically incremented. In this way, the number of the message buffer that has received and stored a frame will be recorded chronologically. The TGPT pointer is utilized as a read pointer that reads a recorded message buffer number from the THL. This pointer indicates the first THL element that the CPU has not yet read. By reading the C0TGPT register by software, the number of a message buffer that has completed transmission can be read. Each time a message buffer number is read from the C0TGPT register, the TGPT pointer is automatically incremented. If the value of the TGPT pointer matches the value of the LOPT pointer, the THPM bit (transmit history list pointer match) of the C0TGPT register is set to 1. This indicates that no message buffer numbers that have not been read remain in the THL. If a new message buffer number is recorded, the LOPT pointer is incremented and because its value no longer matches the value of the TGPT pointer, the THPM bit is cleared. In other words, the numbers of the unread message buffers exist in the THL. If the LOPT pointer is incremented and matches the value of the TGPT pointer minus 1, the TOVF bit (transmit history list overflow) of the C0TGPT register is set to 1. This indicates that the THL is full of message buffer numbers that have not been read. If a new message is received and stored, the message buffer number recorded last is overwritten by the number of the message buffer that transmitted its message afterwards. After the TOVF bit has been set (1), therefore, the recorded message buffer numbers in the THL do not completely reflect the chronological order. However the other transmitted messages can be found by a CPU search applied to all transmit message buffers unless the CPU has not overwritten a transmit object in one of these buffers beforehand. In total up to six transmission completions can occur without overflowing the THL. Caution If the history list is in the overflow condition (TOVF is set), reading the history list contents is still possible, until the history list is empty (indicated by THPM flag set). Nevertheless, the history list remains in the overflow condition, until TOVF is cleared by software. If TOVF is not cleared, the THPM flag will also not be updated (cleared) upon successful transmission of a new message. This may lead to the situation, that THPM indicates an empty history list, although a successful transmission has taken place, while the history list is in the overflow state (TOVF and THPM are set). Remark m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 439 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-32. Transmit History List Transmit history list(THL) When message buffer 6 is read 7 Last out-message pointer(LOPT) 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 If transmission from message buffers 3 and 4 is completed Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 9 Message buffer 6 Last out-message pointer(LOPT) Transmit history list get pointer(TGPT) Transmit history list(THL) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Message buffer 4 Message buffer 3 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 9 Transmit history list get pointer(TGPT) When THL is full Transmit history list(THL) Last out-message pointer(LOPT) 7 6 5 Message buffer 5 4 3 2 1 0 Message buffer 3 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 8 Message buffer 4 Message buffer 9 TOVF is set. Transmit history list(THL) When TOVF = 1, message buffer Message buffer 3 number is stored (overwritten) to7 element indicated by LOPT-1. 6 Message buffer 8 Message buffer 4 5 When transmission from message buffer 3 is completed. Transmit history list get pointer(TGPT) Last out-message pointer(LOPT) LOPT is locked. 440 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 4 3 2 1 0 Message buffer 3 Message buffer 7 Message buffer 2 Message buffer 9 Transmit history list get pointer (TGPT) CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.10.3 Automatic block transmission (ABT) The automatic block transmission (ABT) function is used to transmit two or more data frames successively with no CPU interaction. The maximum number of transmit message buffers assigned to the ABT function is eight (message buffer numbers 0 to 7). By setting OPMODE [2:0] bits of the CnCTRL register to 010B, "normal operation mode with automatic block transmission function" (hereafter referred to as ABT mode) can be selected. To issue an ABT transmission request, define the message buffers by software first. Set the MA0 bit (1) in all the message buffers used for ABT, and define all the buffers as transmit message buffers by setting MT [2:0] bits to 000B. Be sure to set the ID for each message buffer for ABT even when the same ID is being used for all the message buffers. To use two or more IDs, set the ID of each message buffer by using the CnMIDLm and CnMIDHm registers. Set the CnMDLCm and CnMDATA0m to CnMDATA7m registers before issuing a transmission request for the ABT function. After initialization of message buffers for ABT is finished, the RDY bit needs to be set (1). In the ABT mode, the TRQ bit does not have to be manipulated by software. After the data for the ABT message buffers has been prepared, set the ABTTRG bit to 1. Automatic block transmission is then started. When ABT is started, the TRQ bit in the first message buffer (message buffer 0) is automatically set to 1. After transmission of the data of message buffer 0 has finished, TRQ bit of the next message buffer, message buffer 1, is set automatically. In this way, transmission is executed successively. A delay time can be inserted by program in the interval in which the transmission request (TRQ) is automatically set while successive transmission is being executed. The delay time to be inserted is defined by the CnGMABTD register. The unit of the delay time is DBT (data bit time). DBT depends on the setting of the CnBRP and CnBTR registers. Among transmit objects within the ABT-area, the priority of the transmission ID is not evaluated. The data of message buffers 0 to 7 are sequentially transmitted. When transmission of the data frame from message buffer 7 has been completed, the ABTTRG bit is automatically cleared to 0 and the ABT operation is finished. If the RDY bit of an ABT message buffer is cleared during ABT, no data frame is transmitted from that buffer, ABT is stopped, and the ABTTRG bit is cleared. After that, transmission can be resumed from the message buffer where ABT stopped, by setting the RDY and ABTTRG bits to 1 by software. To not resume transmission from the message buffer where ABT stopped, the internal ABT engine can be reset by setting the ABTCLR bit to 1 while ABT mode is stopped and ABTTRG bit is cleared to 0. In this case, transmission is started from message buffer 0 if the ABTCLR bit is cleared to 0 and then the ABTTRG bit is set to 1. An interrupt can be used to check if data frames have been transmitted from all the message buffers for ABT. To do so, the IE bit of the CnMCTRLm register of each message buffer except the last message buffer needs to be cleared (0). If a transmit message buffer other than those used by the ABT function (message buffer 8 to 15) is assigned to a transmit message buffer, the message to be transmitted next is determined by the priority of the transmission ID of the ABT message buffer whose transmission is currently held pending and the transmission ID of the message buffers other than those used by the ABT function. Transmission of a data frame from an ABT message buffer is not recorded in the transmit history list (THL). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 441 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Cautions 1. Set the ABTCLR bit to 1 while the ABTTRG bit is cleared to 0 in order to resume ABT operation at buffer No.0. If the ABTCLR bit is set to 1 while the ABTTRG bit is set to 1, the subsequent operation is not guaranteed. 2. If the automatic block transmission engine is cleared by setting the ABTCLR bit to 1, the ABTCLR bit is automatically cleared immediately after the processing of the clearing request is completed. 3. Do not set the ABTTRG bit in the initialization mode. If the ABTTRG bit is set in the initialization mode, the proper operation is not guaranteed after the mode is changed from the initialization mode to the ABT mode. 4. Do not set TRQ bit of the ABT message buffers to 1 by software in the normal operation mode with ABT. Otherwise, the operation is not guaranteed. 5. The C0GMABTD register is used to set the delay time that is inserted in the period from completion of the preceding ABT message to setting of the TRQ bit for the next ABT message when the transmission requests are set in the order of message numbers for each message for ABT that is successively transmitted in the ABT mode. The timing at which the messages are actually transmitted onto the CAN bus varies depending on the status of transmission from other stations and the status of the setting of the transmission request for messages other than the ABT messages (message buffer 8 to 15). 6. If a transmission request is made for a message other than an ABT message and if no delay time is inserted in the interval in which transmission requests for ABT are automatically set (C0GMABTD = 00H), messages other than ABT messages may be transmitted not depending on the priority of the ABT message. 7. Do not clear the RDY bit to 0 when ABTTRG = 1. 8. If a message is received from another node while normal operation mode with ABT is active, the TX-message from the ABT-area may be transmitted with delay of one frame although CnGMABTD register was set up with 00H. Remark m = 0 to 15 15.10.4 Transmission abort process (1) Transmission abort process except for in normal operation mode with automatic block transmission (ABT) The user can clear the TRQ bit of the C0MCTRLm register to 0 to abort a transmission request. The TRQ bit will be cleared immediately if the abort was successful. Whether the transmission was successfully aborted or not can be checked using the TSTAT bit of the C0CTRL register and the C0TGPT register, which indicate the transmission status on the CAN bus (for details, refer to the processing in Figure 15-47). (2) Transmission abort process except for ABT transmission in normal operation mode with automatic block transmission (ABT) The user can clear the ABTTRG bit of the C0GMABT register to 0 to abort a transmission request. After checking the ABTTRG bit of the C0GMABT register = 0, clear the TRQ bit of the C0MCTRLm register to 0. The TRQ bit will be cleared immediately if the abort was successful. Whether the transmission was successfully aborted or not can be checked using the TSTAT bit of the C0CTRL register and the C0TGPT register, which indicate the transmission status on the CAN bus (for details, refer to the processing in Figure 15-48). 442 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER (3) Transmission abort process for ABT transmission in normal operation mode with automatic block transmission (ABT) To abort ABT that is already started, clear the ABTTRG bit of the C0GMABT register to 0. In this case, the ABTTRG bit remains 1 if an ABT message is currently being transmitted and until the transmission is completed (successfully or not), and is cleared to 0 as soon as transmission is finished. This aborts ABT. If the last transmission (before ABT) was successful, the normal operation mode with ABT is left with the internal ABT pointer pointing to the next message buffer to be transmitted. In the case of an erroneous transmission, the position of the internal ABT pointer depends on the status of the TRQ bit in the last transmitted message buffer. If the TRQ bit is set to 1 when clearing the ABTTRG bit is requested, the internal ABT pointer points to the last transmitted message buffer (for details, refer to the process in Figure 15-49). If the TRQ bit is cleared to 0 when clearing the ABTTRG bit is requested, the internal ABT pointer is incremented (+1) and points to the next message buffer in the ABT area (for details, refer to the process in Figure 15-50). Caution Be sure to abort ABT by clearing ABTTRG to 0. The operation is not guaranteed if aborting transmission is requested by clearing RDY bit. When the normal operation mode with ABT is resumed after ABT has been aborted and ABTTRG bit is set to 1, the next ABT message buffer to be transmitted can be determined from the following table. Status of TRQ of Abort After Successful Transmission Abort after erroneous transmission ABT Message Buffer Set (1) Next message buffer in the ABT Same message buffer in the ABT area Note area Cleared (0) Next message buffer in the ABT Note Next message buffer in the ABT area Note area Note The above resumption operation can be performed only if a message buffer ready for ABT exists in the ABT area. For example, an abort request that is issued while ABT of message buffer 7 is in progress is regarded as completion of ABT, rather than abort, if transmission of message buffer 7 has been successfully completed, even if ABTTRG is cleared to 0. If the RDY bit in the next message buffer in the ABT area is cleared to 0, the internal ABT pointer is retained, but the resumption operation is not performed even if ABTTRG is set to 1, and ABT ends immediately. Remark m = 0 to 15 15.10.5 Remote frame transmission Remote frames can be transmitted only from transmit message buffers. Set whether a data frame or remote frame is transmitted via the RTR bit of the C0MCONFm register. Setting (1) the RTR bit sets remote frame transmission. Remark m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 443 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.11 Power Save Modes 15.11.1 CAN sleep mode The CAN sleep mode can be used to set the CAN controller to standby mode in order to reduce power consumption. The CAN module can enter the CAN sleep mode from all operation modes. Release of the CAN sleep mode returns the CAN module to exactly the same operation mode from which the CAN sleep mode was entered. In the CAN sleep mode, the CAN module does not transmit messages, even when transmission requests are issued or pending. (1) Entering CAN sleep mode The CPU issues a CAN sleep mode transition request by writing 01B to the PSMODE[1:0] bits of the C0CTRL register. This transition request is only acknowledged only under the following conditions. - The CAN module is already in one of the following operation modes - Normal operation mode - Normal operation mode with ABT - Receive-only mode - Single-shot mode - Self-test mode - CAN stop mode in all the above operation modes - The CAN bus state is bus idle (the 4th bit in the interframe space is recessive)Note - No transmission request is pending Note If the CAN bus is fixed to dominant, the request for transition to the CAN sleep mode is held pending. Also the transition from CAN stop mode to CAN sleep mode is independent of the CAN bus state. Remark If a sleep mode request is pending, and at the same time a message is received in a message box, the sleep mode request is not cancelled, but is executed right after message storage has been finished. This may result in AFCAN being in sleep mode, while the CPU would execute the RX interrupt routine. Therefore, the interrupt routine must check the access to the message buffers as well as reception history list registers by using the MBON flag, if sleep mode is used. If any one of the conditions mentioned above is not met, the CAN module will operate as follows. - If the CAN sleep mode is requested from the initialization mode, the CAN sleep mode transition request is ignored and the CAN module remains in the initialization mode. - If the CAN bus state is not bus idle (i.e., the CAN bus state is either transmitting or receiving) when the CAN sleep mode is requested in one of the operation modes, immediate transition to the CAN sleep mode is not possible. In this case, the CAN sleep mode transition request is held pending until the CAN bus state becomes bus idle (the 4th bit in the interframe space is recessive). In the time from the CAN sleep mode request to successful transition, the PSMODE [1:0] bits remain 00B. When the module has entered the CAN sleep mode, PSMODE [1:0] bits are set to 01B. - If a request for transition to the initialization mode and a request for transition to the CAN sleep are made at the same time while the CAN module is in one of the operation modes, the request for the initialization mode is enabled. The CAN module enters the initialization mode at a predetermined timing. At this time, the CAN sleep mode request is not held pending and is ignored. 444 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER - Even when initialization mode and sleep mode are not requested simultaneously (i.e the first request has not been granted while the second request is made), the request for initialization has priority over the sleep mode request. The sleep mode request is cancelled when the initialization mode is requested. When a pending request for initialization mode is present, a subsequent request for Sleep mode request is cancelled right at the point in time where it was submitted. (2) Status in CAN sleep mode The CAN module is in one of the following states after it enters the CAN sleep mode. - The internal operating clock is stopped and the power consumption is minimized. - The function to detect the falling edge of the CAN reception pin (CRxD) remains in effect to wake up the CAN module from the CAN bus. - To wake up the CAN module from the CPU, data can be written to PSMODE [1:0] of the CAN module control register (C0CTRL), but nothing can be written to other CAN module registers or bits. - The CAN module registers can be read, except for C0LIPT, C0RGPT, C0LOPT, and C0TGPT. - The CAN message buffer registers cannot be written or read. - MBON bit of the CAN Global Control register (C0GMCTRL) is cleared. - A request for transition to the initialization mode is not acknowledged and is ignored. (3) Releasing CAN sleep mode The CAN sleep mode is released by the following events. - When the CPU writes 00B to the PSMODE [1:0] bits of the C0CTRL register - A falling edge at the CAN reception pin (CRxD) (i.e. the CAN bus level shifts from recessive to dominant) Caution Even if the falling edge belongs to the SOF of a receive message, this message will not be received and stored. If the CPU has turned off the clock to the CAN while the CAN was in sleep mode, even subsequently the CAN sleep mode will not be released and PSMODE [1:0] will continue to be 01B unless the clock to the CAN is supplied again. In addition to this, the receive message will not be received after that. After releasing the sleep mode, the CAN module returns to the operation mode from which the CAN sleep mode was requested and the PSMODE [1:0] bits of the C0CTRL register are reset to 00B. If the CAN sleep mode is released by a change in the CAN bus state, the CINTS5 bit of the C0INTS register is set to 1, regardless of the CIE bit of the C0IE register. After the CAN module is released from the CAN sleep mode, it participates in the CAN bus again by automatically detecting 11 consecutive recessive-level bits on the CAN bus. The user application has to wait until MBON = 1, before accessing message buffers again. When a request for transition to the initialization mode is made while the CAN module is in the CAN sleep mode, that request is ignored; the CPU has to be released from sleep mode by software first before entering the initialization mode. Caution Be aware that the release of CAN sleep mode by CAN bus event, and thus the wake up interrupt may happen at any time, even right after requesting sleep mode, if a CAN bus event occurs. Remark m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 445 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.11.2 CAN stop mode The CAN stop mode can be used to set the CAN controller to standby mode to reduce power consumption. The CAN module can enter the CAN stop mode only from the CAN sleep mode. Release of the CAN stop mode puts the CAN module in the CAN sleep mode. The CAN stop mode can only be released (entering CAN sleep mode) by writing 01B to the PSMODE [1:0] bits of the C0CTRL register and not by a change in the CAN bus state. No message is transmitted even when transmission requests are issued or pending. (1) Entering CAN stop mode A CAN stop mode transition request is issued by writing 11B to the PSMODE [1:0] bits of the C0CTRL register. A CAN stop mode request is only acknowledged when the CAN module is in the CAN sleep mode. In all other modes, the request is ignored. Caution To set the CAN module to the CAN stop mode, the module must be in the CAN sleep mode. To confirm that the module is in the sleep mode, check that PSMODE [1:0] = 01B, and then request the CAN stop mode. If a bus change occurs at the CAN reception pin (CRxD) while this process is being performed, the CAN sleep mode is automatically released. In this case, the CAN stop mode transition request cannot be acknowledged. (2) Status in CAN stop mode The CAN module is in one of the following states after it enters the CAN stop mode. - The internal operating clock is stopped and the power consumption is minimized. - To wake up the CAN module from the CPU, data can be written to PSMODE [1:0] of the CAN module control register (C0CTRL), but nothing can be written to other CAN module registers or bits. - The CAN module registers can be read, except for C0LIPT, C0RGPT, C0LOPT, and C0TGPT. - The CAN message buffer registers cannot be written or read. - MBON bit of the CAN Global Control register (C0GMCTRL) is cleared. - An initialization mode transition request is not acknowledged and is ignored. (3) Releasing CAN stop mode The CAN stop mode can only be released by writing 01B to the PSMODE [1:0] bits of the C0CTRL register. After releasing the CAN stop mode, the CAN module enters the CAN sleep mode. When the initialization mode is requested while the CAN module is in the CAN stop mode, that request is ignored; the CPU has to release the stop mode and subsequently CAN sleep mode before entering the initialization mode. It is impossible to enter the other operation mode directly from the CAN stop mode not entering the CAN sleep mode, that request is ignored. Remark 446 m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.11.3 Example of using power saving modes In some application systems, it may be necessary to place the CPU in a power saving mode to reduce the power consumption. By using the power saving mode specific to the CAN module and the power saving mode specific to the CPU in combination, the CPU can be woken up from the power saving status by the CAN bus. Here is an example of using the power saving modes. First, put the CAN module in the CAN sleep mode (PSMODE = 01B). Next, put the CPU in the power saving mode. If an edge transition from recessive to dominant is detected at the CAN reception pin (CRxD) in this status, the CINTS5 bit in the CAN module is set to 1. If the CIE5 bit of the C0CTRL register is set to 1, a wakeup interrupt (INTC0WUP) is generated. The CAN module is automatically released from the CAN sleep mode (PSMODE = 00B) and returns to the normal operation mode. The CPU, in response to INTC0WUP, can release its own power saving mode and return to the normal operation mode. To further reduce the power consumption of the CPU, the internal clocks, including that of the CAN module, may be stopped. In this case, the operating clock supplied to the CAN module is stopped after the CAN module is put in the CAN sleep mode. Then the CPU enters a power saving mode in which the clock supplied to the CPU is stopped. If an edge transition from recessive to dominant is detected at the CAN reception pin (CRxD) in this status, the CAN module can set the CINTS5 bit to 1 and generate the wakeup interrupt (INTC0WUP) even if it is not supplied with the clock. The other functions, however, do not operate because clock supply to the CAN module is stopped, and the module remains in the CAN sleep mode. The CPU, in response to INTC0WUP, releases its power saving mode, resumes supply of the internal clocks, including the clock to the CAN module, after the oscillation stabilization time has elapsed, and starts instruction execution. The CAN module is immediately released from the CAN sleep mode when clock supply is resumed, and returns to the normal operation mode (PSMODE = 00B). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 447 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.12 Interrupt Function The CAN module provides 6 different interrupt sources. The occurrence of these interrupt sources is stored in interrupt status registers. Four separate interrupt request signals are generated from the six interrupt sources. When an interrupt request signal that corresponds to two or more interrupt sources is generated, the interrupt sources can be identified by using an interrupt status register. After an interrupt source has occurred, the corresponding interrupt status bit must be cleared to 0 by software. Table 15-20. List of CAN Module Interrupt Sources No. Interrupt Status Bit Name 1 Note CINTS0 Register C0INTS Interrupt Enable Bit Name Note CIE0 Register C0IE Interrupt Interrupt Source Description Request Signal INTC0TRX Message frame successfully transmitted from message buffer m Note Note 2 CINTS1 C0INTS CIE1 C0IE INTC0REC Valid message frame reception in message buffer m 3 CINTS2 C0INTS CIE2 C0IE INTC0ERR CAN module error state interrupt (Supplement 1) 4 CINTS3 C0INTS CIE3 C0IE CAN module protocol error interrupt (Supplement 2) 5 CINTS4 C0INTS CIE4 C0IE CAN module arbitration loss interrupt 6 CINTS5 C0INTS CIE5 C0IE INTC0WUP CAN module wakeup interrupt from CAN sleep mode (Supplement 3) Note The IE bit (message buffer interrupt enable bit) in the C0MCTRL register of the corresponding message buffer has to be set to 1 for that message buffer to participate in the interrupt generation process. Supplements 1. This interrupt is generated when the transmission/reception error counter is at the warning level, or in the error passive or bus-off state. 2. This interrupt is generated when a stuff error, form error, ACK error, bit error, or CRC error occurs. 3. This interrupt is generated when the CAN module is woken up from the CAN sleep mode because a falling edge is detected at the CAN reception pin (CAN bus transition from recessive to dominant). Remark 448 m = 0 to 15 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.13 Diagnosis Functions and Special Operational Modes The CAN module provides a receive-only mode, single-shot mode, and self-test mode to support CAN bus diagnosis functions or the operation of specific CAN communication methods. 15.13.1 Receive-only mode The receive-only mode is used to monitor receive messages without causing any interference on the CAN bus and can be used for CAN bus analysis nodes. For example, this mode can be used for automatic baud-rate detection. The baud rate in the CAN module is changed until "valid reception" is detected, so that the baud rates in the module match ("valid reception" means a message frame has been received in the CAN protocol layer without occurrence of an error and with an appropriate ACK between nodes connected to the CAN bus). A valid reception does not require message frames to be stored in a receive message buffer (data frames) or transmit message buffer (remote frames). The event of valid reception is indicated by setting the VALID bit of the C0CTRL register (1). Figure 15-33. CAN Module Terminal Connection in Receive-Only Mode CAN macro Tx Rx Fixed to the recessive level CTxD CRxD In the receive-only mode, no message frames can be transmitted from the CAN module to the CAN bus. Transmit requests issued for message buffers defined as transmit message buffers are held pending. In the receive-only mode, the CAN transmission pin (CTxD) in the CAN module is fixed to the recessive level. Therefore, no active error flag can be transmitted from the CAN module to the CAN bus even when a CAN bus error is detected while receiving a message frame. Since no transmission can be issued from the CAN module, the transmission error counter TEC is never updated. Therefore, a CAN module in the receive-only mode does not enter the bus-off state. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 449 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Furthermore, ACK is not returned to the CAN bus in this mode upon the valid reception of a message frame. Internally, the local node recognizes that it has transmitted ACK. An overload frame cannot be transmitted to the CAN bus. Caution If only two CAN nodes are connected to the CAN bus and one of them is operating in the receive-only mode, there is no ACK on the CAN bus. Due to the missing ACK, the transmitting node will transmit an active error flag, and repeat transmitting a message frame. The transmitting node becomes error passive after transmitting the message frame 16 times (assuming that the error counter was 0 in the beginning and no other errors have occurred). After the message frame for the 17th time is transmitted, the transmitting node generates a passive error flag. The receiving node in the receive-only mode detects the first valid message frame at this point, and the VALID bit is set to 1 for the first time. 15.13.2 Single-shot mode In the single-shot mode, automatic re-transmission as defined in the CAN protocol is switched off (According to the CAN protocol, a message frame transmission that has been aborted by either arbitration loss or error occurrence has to be repeated without control by software.). All other behavior of single shot mode is identical to normal operation mode. Features of single shot mode can not be used in combination with normal mode with ABT. The single-shot mode disables the re-transmission of an aborted message frame transmission according to the setting of the AL bit of the C0CTRL register. When the AL bit is cleared to 0, re-transmission upon arbitration loss and upon error occurrence is disabled. If the AL bit is set to 1, re-transmission upon error occurrence is disabled, but retransmission upon arbitration loss is enabled. As a consequence, the TRQ bit in a message buffer defined as a transmit message buffer is cleared to 0 by the following events. - Successful transmission of the message frame - Arbitration loss while sending the message frame - Error occurrence while sending the message frame The events arbitration loss and error occurrence can be distinguished by checking the CINTS4 and CINTS3 bits of the C0INTS register respectively, and the type of the error can be identified by reading the LEC[2:0] bits of the C0LEC register. Upon successful transmission of the message frame, the transmit completion interrupt bit CINTS0 of the C0INTS register is set to 1. If the CIE0 bit of the C0IE register is set to 1 at this time, an interrupt request signal is output. The single-shot mode can be used when emulating time-triggered communication methods (e.g. TTCAN level 1). Caution The AL bit is only valid in Single-shot mode. It does not influence the operation of retransmission upon arbitration loss in the other operation modes. 450 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.13.3 Self-test mode In the self-test mode, message frame transmission and message frame reception can be tested without connecting the CAN node to the CAN bus or without affecting the CAN bus. In the self-test mode, the CAN module is completely disconnected from the CAN bus, but transmission and reception are internally looped back. The CAN transmission pin (CTxD) is fixed to the recessive level. If the falling edge on the CAN reception pin (CRxD) is detected after the CAN module has entered the CAN sleep mode from the self-test mode, however, the module is released from the CAN sleep mode in the same manner as the other operation modes. To keep the module in the CAN sleep mode, use the CAN reception pin (CRxD) as a port pin. Figure 15-34. CAN Module Terminal Connection in Self-test Mode CAN macro Tx Rx Fixed to the recessive level CTxD CRxD User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 451 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.13.4 Receive/Transmit Operation in Each Operation Mode Table 15-21 shows outline of the receive/transmit operation in each operation mode. Table 15-21. Outline of the Receive/Transmit in Each Operation Mode Operation Transmission Transmission Transmission Transmission Automatic Set of Store Data Mode of data/ remote frame of ACK of error/ overload frame retry Block VALID bit to message buffer No No No No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Receiveonly mode No No No No No Yes Yes Single-shot Mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Initialization Transmission (ABT) Mode Normal Operation Mode Normal Operation Mode with ABT Self-test Mode Notes 1. 2. 452 Yes Note 2 Yes Note 2 Yes Note 2 No Note 1 Yes Note 2 No Yes Note 2 Yes When the arbitration lost occurs, control of re-transmission is possible by the AL bit of C0CTRL register. Each signals are not generated to outside, but generated into the CAN module. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Note 2 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.14 Time Stamp Function CAN is an asynchronous, serial protocol. All nodes connected to the CAN bus have a local, autonomous clock. As a consequence, the clocks of the nodes have no relation (i.e., the clocks are asynchronous and may have different frequencies). In some applications, however, a common time base over the network (= global time base) is needed. In order to build up a global time base, a time stamp function is used. The essential mechanism of a time stamp function is the capture of timer values triggered by signals on the CAN bus. 15.14.1 Time stamp function The CAN controller supports the capturing of timer values triggered by a specific frame. An on-chip 16-bit capture timer unit in a microcontroller system is used in addition to the CAN controller. The 16-bit capture timer unit captures the timer value according to a trigger signal (TSOUT) for capturing that is output when a data frame is received from the CAN controller. The CPU can retrieve the time of occurrence of the capture event, i.e., the time stamp of the message received from the CAN bus, by reading the captured value. TSOUT signal can be selected from the following two event sources and is specified by the TSSEL bit of the C0TS register. - SOF event (start of frame) (TSSEL = 0) - EOF event (last bit of end of frame) (TSSEL = 1) The TSOUT signal is enabled by setting the TSEN bit of the C0TS register to 1. Figure 15-35. Timing Diagram of Capture Signal TSOUT SOF SOF SOF SOF TSOUT t TSOUT signal toggles its level upon occurrence of the selected event during data frame reception (in the above timing diagram, the SOF is used as the trigger event source). To capture a timer value by using TSOUT signal, the capture timer unit must detect the capture signal at both the rising edge and falling edge. This time stamp function is controlled by the TSLOCK bit of the C0TS register. When TSLOCK is cleared to 0, TSOUT bit toggles upon occurrence of the selected event. If TSLOCK bit is set to 1, TSOUT toggles upon occurrence of the selected event, but the toggle is stopped as the TSEN bit is automatically cleared to 0 as soon as the message storing to the message buffer 0 starts. This suppresses the subsequent toggle occurrence by TSOUT, so that the time stamp value toggled last (= captured last) can be saved as the time stamp value of the time at which the data frame was received in message buffer 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 453 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Caution The time stamp function using TSLOCK bit is to stop toggle of TSOUT bit by receiving a data frame in message buffer 0. Therefore, message buffer 0 must be set as a receive message buffer. Since a receive message buffer cannot receive a remote frame, toggle of TSOUT bit cannot be stopped by reception of a remote frame. Toggle of TSOUT bit does not stop when a data frame is received in a message buffer other than message buffer 0. For these reasons, a data frame cannot be received in message buffer 0 when the CAN module is in the normal operation mode with ABT, because message buffer 0 must be set as a transmit message buffer. In this operation mode, therefore, the function to stop toggle of TSOUT bit by TSLOCK bit cannot be used. The input source of the timer value according to a trigger signal (TSOUT) can be input to the 16-bit timer/event counter 00 by port input switch control (ISC0), without connectingTI000, externally. Figure 15-36. Port Input Switch Control CAN controller Selector Selector P00/TI000 TI000 input Port mode (PM00) Output latch (P00) Remark 454 Port input switch control (ISC0) 0: Select TI000 (P00) 1: Select TSOUT ISC0: Bit 0 of the input switch control register (ISC) (see Figure 13-19) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.15 Baud Rate Settings 15.15.1 Baud rate settings Make sure that the settings are within the range of limit values for ensuring correct operation of the CAN controller, as follows. (a) 5TQ SPT (sampling point) 17 TQ SPT = TSEG1 + 1 (b) 8 TQ DBT (data bit time) 25 TQ DBT = TSEG1 + TSEG2 + 1TQ = TSEG2 + SPT (c) 1 TQ SJW (synchronization jump width) 4TQ SJW DBT - SPT (d) 4 TSEG1 16 [3 (Setting value of TSEG1 [3:0] 15] (e) 1 TSEG2 8 [0 (Setting value of TSEG2 [2:0] 7] Remark TQ = 1/fTQ (fTQ: CAN protocol layer basic system clock) TSEG1 [3:0]: Bits 3 to 0 of CAN0 bit rate register (C0BTR) TSEG2 [2:0]: Bits 10 to 8 of CAN0 bit rate register (C0BTR) Table 15-22 shows the combinations of bit rates that satisfy the above conditions. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 455 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-22. Settable Bit Rate Combinations (1/3) Valid Bit Rate Setting C0BTR Register Setting Value Sampling Point (Unit %) DBT Length SYNC SEGMENT PROP SEGMENT PHASE SEGMENT1 PHASE SEGMENT2 TSEG1[3:0] TSEG2[2:0] 25 1 8 8 8 1111 111 68.0 24 1 7 8 8 1110 111 66.7 24 1 9 7 7 1111 110 70.8 23 1 6 8 8 1101 111 65.2 23 1 8 7 7 1110 110 69.6 23 1 10 6 6 1111 101 73.9 22 1 5 8 8 1100 111 63.6 22 1 7 7 7 1101 110 68.2 22 1 9 6 6 1110 101 72.7 22 1 11 5 5 1111 100 77.3 21 1 4 8 8 1011 111 61.9 21 1 6 7 7 1100 110 66.7 21 1 8 6 6 1101 101 71.4 21 1 10 5 5 1110 100 76.2 21 1 12 4 4 1111 011 81.0 20 1 3 8 8 1010 111 60.0 20 1 5 7 7 1011 110 65.0 20 1 7 6 6 1100 101 70.0 20 1 9 5 5 1101 100 75.0 20 1 11 4 4 1110 011 80.0 20 1 13 3 3 1111 010 85.0 19 1 2 8 8 1001 111 57.9 19 1 4 7 7 1010 110 63.2 19 1 6 6 6 1011 101 68.4 19 1 8 5 5 1100 100 73.7 19 1 10 4 4 1101 011 78.9 19 1 12 3 3 1110 010 84.2 19 1 14 2 2 1111 001 89.5 18 1 1 8 8 1000 111 55.6 18 1 3 7 7 1001 110 61.1 18 1 5 6 6 1010 101 66.7 18 1 7 5 5 1011 100 72.2 18 1 9 4 4 1100 011 77.8 18 1 11 3 3 1101 010 83.3 18 1 13 2 2 1110 001 88.9 18 1 15 1 1 1111 000 94.4 456 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-22. Settable Bit Rate Combinations (2/3) Valid Bit Rate Setting C0BTR Register Setting Value Sampling Point (Unit %) DBT Length SYNC SEGMENT PROP SEGMENT PHASE SEGMENT1 PHASE SEGMENT2 TSEG1[3:0] TSEG2[2:0] 17 1 2 7 7 1000 110 58.8 17 1 4 6 6 1001 101 64.7 17 1 6 5 5 1010 100 70.6 17 1 8 4 4 1011 011 76.5 17 1 10 3 3 1100 010 82.4 17 1 12 2 2 1101 001 88.2 17 1 14 1 1 1110 000 94.1 16 1 1 7 7 0111 110 56.3 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 16 1 13 1 1 1101 000 93.8 15 1 2 6 6 0111 101 60.0 15 1 4 5 5 1000 100 66.7 15 1 6 4 4 1001 011 73.3 15 1 8 3 3 1010 010 80.0 15 1 10 2 2 1011 001 86.7 15 1 12 1 1 1100 000 93.3 14 1 1 6 6 0110 101 57.1 14 1 3 5 5 0111 100 64.3 14 1 5 4 4 1000 011 71.4 14 1 7 3 3 1001 010 78.6 14 1 9 2 2 1010 001 85.7 14 1 11 1 1 1011 000 92.9 13 1 2 5 5 0110 100 61.5 13 1 4 4 4 0111 011 69.2 13 1 6 3 3 1000 010 76.9 13 1 8 2 2 1001 001 84.6 13 1 10 1 1 1010 000 92.3 12 1 1 5 5 0101 100 58.3 12 1 3 4 4 0110 011 66.7 12 1 5 3 3 0111 010 75.0 12 1 7 2 2 1000 001 83.3 12 1 9 1 1 1001 000 91.7 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 457 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-22. Settable Bit Rate Combinations (3/3) Valid Bit Rate Setting C0BTR Register Setting Value Sampling Point (Unit %) DBT Length SYNC SEGMENT PROP SEGMENT PHASE SEGMENT1 PHASE SEGMENT2 TSEG1[3:0] TSEG2[2:0] 11 1 2 4 4 0101 011 63.6 11 1 4 3 3 0110 010 72.7 11 1 6 2 2 0111 001 81.8 11 1 8 1 1 1000 000 90.9 10 1 1 4 4 0100 011 60.0 10 1 3 3 3 0101 010 70.0 10 1 5 2 2 0110 001 80.0 10 1 7 1 1 0111 000 90.0 9 1 2 3 3 0100 010 66.7 9 1 4 2 2 0101 001 77.8 9 1 6 1 1 0110 000 88.9 8 1 1 3 3 0011 010 62.5 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 7 Note 1 2 2 2 0011 001 71.4 7 Note 1 4 1 1 0100 000 85.7 6 Note 1 1 2 2 0010 001 66.7 6 Note 1 3 1 1 0011 000 83.3 5 Note 1 2 1 1 0010 000 80.0 4 Note 1 1 1 1 0001 000 75.0 Note Setting with a DBT value of 7 or less is valid only when the value of the C0BRP register is other than 00H. Caution The values in Table 15-22 do not guarantee the operation of the network system. Thoroughly check the effect on the network system, taking into consideration oscillation errors and delays of the CAN bus and CAN transceiver. 458 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.15.2 Representative examples of baud rate settings Tables 15-23 and 15-24 show representative examples of baud rate setting. Table 15-23. Representative Examples of Baud Rate Settings (fCANMOD = 8 MHz) (1/2) Set Baud Rate Value (Unit: kbps) Division Ratio of C0BRP C0BRP Register Set Value Valid Bit Rate Setting (Unit: kbps) C0BTR Register Setting Value Length of DBT SYNC SEGME NT PROP SEGME NT PHASE SEGME NT1 PHASE SEGME NT2 TSEG1 TSEG2 [3:0] [2:0] Samplin g point (Unit: %) 1000 1 00000000 8 1 1 3 3 0011 010 62.5 1000 1 00000000 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 1000 1 00000000 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 500 1 00000000 16 1 1 7 7 0111 110 56.3 500 1 00000000 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 500 1 00000000 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 500 1 00000000 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 500 1 00000000 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 500 1 00000000 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 500 1 00000000 16 1 13 1 1 1101 000 93.8 500 2 00000001 8 1 1 3 3 0011 010 62.5 500 2 00000001 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 500 2 00000001 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 250 2 00000001 16 1 1 7 7 0111 110 56.3 250 2 00000001 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 250 2 00000001 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 250 2 00000001 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 250 2 00000001 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 250 2 00000001 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 250 2 00000001 16 1 13 1 1 1101 000 93.8 250 4 00000011 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 250 4 00000011 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 125 4 00000011 16 1 1 7 7 0111 110 56.3 125 4 00000011 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 125 4 00000011 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 125 4 00000011 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 125 4 00000011 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 125 4 00000011 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 125 4 00000011 16 1 13 1 1 1101 000 93.8 125 8 00000111 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 125 8 00000111 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 Caution The values in Table 15-23 do not guarantee the operation of the network system. Thoroughly check the effect on the network system, taking into consideration oscillation errors and delays of the CAN bus and CAN transceiver. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 459 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-23. Representative Examples of Baud Rate Settings (fCANMOD = 8 MHz) (2/2) Set Baud Rate Value (Unit: kbps) Division Ratio of C0BRP C0BRP Register Set Value Valid Bit Rate Setting (Unit: kbps) C0BTR Register Setting Value Length of DBT SYNC SEGME NT PROP SEGME NT PHASE SEGME NT1 PHASE SEGME NT2 TSEG1 TSEG2 [3:0] [2:0] Samplin g point (Unit: %) 100 4 00000011 20 1 7 6 6 1100 101 70.0 100 4 00000011 20 1 9 5 5 1101 100 75.0 100 5 00000100 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 100 5 00000100 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 100 8 00000111 10 1 3 3 3 0101 010 70.0 100 8 00000111 10 1 5 2 2 0110 001 80.0 100 10 00001001 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 100 10 00001001 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 83.3 4 00000011 24 1 7 8 8 1110 111 66.7 83.3 4 00000011 24 1 9 7 7 1111 110 70.8 83.3 6 00000101 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 83.3 6 00000101 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 83.3 6 00000101 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 83.3 6 00000101 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 83.3 8 00000111 12 1 5 3 3 0111 010 75.0 83.3 8 00000111 12 1 7 2 2 1000 001 83.3 83.3 12 00001011 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 83.3 12 00001011 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 33.3 10 00001001 24 1 7 8 8 1110 111 66.7 33.3 10 00001001 24 1 9 7 7 1111 110 70.8 33.3 12 00001011 20 1 7 6 6 1100 101 70.0 33.3 12 00001011 20 1 9 5 5 1101 100 75.0 33.3 15 00001110 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 33.3 15 00001110 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 33.3 16 00001111 15 1 6 4 4 1001 011 73.3 33.3 16 00001111 15 1 8 3 3 1010 010 80.0 33.3 20 00010011 12 1 5 3 3 0111 010 75.0 33.3 20 00010011 12 1 7 2 2 1000 001 83.3 33.3 24 00010111 10 1 3 3 3 0101 010 70.0 33.3 24 00010111 10 1 5 2 2 0110 001 80.0 33.3 30 00011101 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 33.3 30 00011101 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 Caution The values in Table 15-23 do not guarantee the operation of the network system. Thoroughly check the effect on the network system, taking into consideration oscillation errors and delays of the CAN bus and CAN transceiver. 460 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-24. Representative Examples of Baud Rate Settings (fCANMOD = 16 MHz) (1/2) Set Baud Rate Value (Unit: kbps) Division Ratio of C0BRP C0BRP Register Set Value Valid Bit Rate Setting (Unit: kbps) C0BTR Register Setting Value Length of DBT SYNC SEGME NT PROP SEGME NT PHASE SEGME NT1 PHASE SEGME NT2 TSEG1 TSEG2 [3:0] [2:0] Samplin g point (Unit: %) 1000 1 00000000 16 1 1 7 7 0111 110 56.3 1000 1 00000000 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 1000 1 00000000 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 1000 1 00000000 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 1000 1 00000000 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 1000 1 00000000 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 1000 1 00000000 16 1 13 1 1 1101 000 93.8 1000 2 00000001 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 1000 2 00000001 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 500 2 00000001 16 1 1 7 7 0111 110 56.3 500 2 00000001 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 500 2 00000001 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 500 2 00000001 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 500 2 00000001 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 500 2 00000001 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 500 2 00000001 16 1 13 1 1 1101 000 93.8 500 4 00000011 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 500 4 00000011 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 250 4 00000011 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 250 4 00000011 16 1 5 5 5 1001 100 68.8 250 4 00000011 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 250 4 00000011 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 250 4 00000011 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 250 8 00000111 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 250 8 00000111 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 125 8 00000111 16 1 3 6 6 1000 101 62.5 125 8 00000111 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 125 8 00000111 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 125 8 00000111 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 125 16 00001111 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 125 16 00001111 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 Caution The values in Table 15-24 do not guarantee the operation of the network system. Thoroughly check the effect on the network system, taking into consideration oscillation errors and delays of the CAN bus and CAN transceiver. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 461 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Table 15-24. Representative Examples of Baud Rate Settings (fCANMOD = 16 MHz) (2/2) Set Baud Rate Value (Unit: kbps) Division Ratio of C0BRP C0BRP Register Set Value Valid Bit Rate Setting (Unit: kbps) C0BTR Register Setting Value Length of DBT SYNC SEGME NT PROP SEGME NT PHASE SEGME NT1 PHASE SEGME NT2 TSEG1 TSEG2 [3:0] [2:0] Samplin g point (Unit: %) 100 8 00000111 20 1 9 5 5 1101 100 75.0 100 8 00000111 20 1 11 4 4 1110 011 80.0 100 10 00001001 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 100 10 00001001 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 100 16 00001111 10 1 3 3 3 0101 010 70.0 100 16 00001111 10 1 5 2 2 0110 001 80.0 100 20 00010011 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 83.3 8 00000111 24 1 7 8 8 1110 111 66.7 83.3 8 00000111 24 1 9 7 7 1111 110 70.8 83.3 12 00001011 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 83.3 12 00001011 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 83.3 12 00001011 16 1 11 2 2 1100 001 87.5 83.3 16 00001111 12 1 5 3 3 0111 010 75.0 83.3 16 00001111 12 1 7 2 2 1000 001 83.3 83.3 24 00010111 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 83.3 24 00010111 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 33.3 30 00011101 24 1 7 8 8 1110 111 66.7 33.3 30 00011101 24 1 9 7 7 1111 110 70.8 33.3 24 00010111 20 1 9 5 5 1101 100 75.0 33.3 24 00010111 20 1 11 4 4 1110 011 80.0 33.3 30 00011101 16 1 7 4 4 1010 011 75.0 33.3 30 00011101 16 1 9 3 3 1011 010 81.3 33.3 32 00011111 15 1 8 3 3 1010 010 80.0 33.3 32 00011111 15 1 10 2 2 1011 001 86.7 33.3 37 00100100 13 1 6 3 3 1000 010 76.9 33.3 37 00100100 13 1 8 2 2 1001 001 84.6 33.3 40 00100111 12 1 5 3 3 0111 010 75.0 33.3 40 00100111 12 1 7 2 2 1000 001 83.3 33.3 48 00101111 10 1 3 3 3 0101 010 70.0 33.3 48 00101111 10 1 5 2 2 0110 001 80.0 33.3 60 00111011 8 1 3 2 2 0100 001 75.0 33.3 60 00111011 8 1 5 1 1 0101 000 87.5 Caution The values in Table 15-24 do not guarantee the operation of the network system. Thoroughly check the effect on the network system, taking into consideration oscillation errors and delays of the CAN bus and CAN transceiver. 462 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER 15.16 Operation of CAN Controller Remark m = 0 to 15 Figure 15-37. Initialization START Set CnGMCS register Set CnGMCTRL register (Set GOM = 1) Set CnBRP register, CnBTR register Set CnIE register Set CnMASK register Initialize message buffers Set CnCTRL register (set OPMODE) END Remark OPMODE: Normal operation mode, normal operation mode with ABT, receive-only mode, singleshot mode, self-test mode User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 463 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-38. Re-initialization START Clear OPMODE No INIT mode? Yes Set C0BRP register, C0BTR register Set C0IE register Set C0MASK register Initialize message buffers C0ERC and C0INFO register clear? No Yes Set CCERC bit Set C0CTRL register (Set OPMODE) END Caution After setting the CAN module to the initialization mode, avoid setting the module to another operation mode immediately after. If it is necessary to immediately set the module to another operation mode, be sure to access registers other than the C0CTRL and C0GMCTRL registers (e.g. set a message buffer). Remark OPMODE: Normal operation mode, normal operation mode with ABT, receive-only mode, singleshot mode, self-test mode 464 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-39. Message Buffer Initialization START No RDY = 1? Yes Clear RDY bit No RDY = 0? Yes Set C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDHm register, C0MIDLm register No Transmit message buffer? Yes Set C0MDLCm register Clear C0MDATAm register Set C0MCTRLm register Set RDY bit END Cautions 1. Before a message buffer is initialized, the RDY bit must be cleared. 2. Make the following settings for message buffers not used by the application. - Clear the RDY, TRQ, and DN bits of the C0MCTRLm register to 0. - Clear the MA0 bit of the C0MCONFm register to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 465 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-40 shows the processing for a receive message buffer (MT [2:0] bits of C0MCONFm register = 001B to 101B). Figure 15-40. Message Buffer Redefinition START Clear VALID bit No RDY = 1? Yes Clear RDY bit No RDY = 0? Yes No RSTAT = 0 or Note1 VALID = 1? Yes Note 2 Wait for 4 CAN data bits Set message buffers Set RDY bit END Notes 1. Confirm that a message is being received because RDY bit must be set after a message is completely received. 2. Avoid message buffer redefinition during store operation of message reception by waiting additional 4 CAN data bits. 466 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-41 shows the processing for a transmit message buffer during transmission (MT [2:0] bits of C0MCONFm register = 000B). Figure 15-41. Message Buffer Redefinition during Transmission START Transmit abort process Clear RDY bit RDY = 0? No Yes Data frame Data frame or remote frame? Set C0MDATAxm register Set C0MDLCm register Clear RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Remote frame Set C0MDLCm register Set RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set RDY bit No Transmit? Yes Wait for 1CAN data bits Set TRQ bit END User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 467 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-42 shows the processing for a transmit message buffer (MT [2:0] bits of C0MCONFm register = 000B). Figure 15-42. Message Transmit Processing START TRQ = 0? No Yes Clear RDY bit RDY = 0? No Yes Data frame Data frame or remote frame? Set C0MDATAxm register Set C0MDLCm register Clear RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Remote frame Set C0MDLCm register Set RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set RDY bit Set TRQ bit END Cautions 1. The TRQ bit should be set after the RDY bit is set. 2. The RDY bit and TRQ bit should not be set at the same time. 468 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-43 shows the processing for a transmit message buffer (MT [2:0] bits of C0MCONFm register = 000B). Figure 15-43. ABT Message Transmit Processing START ABTTRG = 0? No Yes Clear RDY bit RDY = 0? No Yes Set C0MDATAxm register Set C0MDLCm register Clear RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set RDY bit Set all ABT transmit messages? No Yes TSTAT = 0? No Yes Set ABTTRG bit END Caution The ABTTRG bit should be set to 1 after the TSTAT bit is cleared to 0. Checking the TSTAT bit and setting the ABTTRG bit to 1 must be processed continuously. Remark This processing (normal operation mode with ABS) can only be applied to message buffers 0 to 7. For message buffers other than the ABT message buffers, refer to Figure 15-42. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 469 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-44. Transmission via Interrupt (Using C0LOPT register) START Transmit completion interrupt processing Read C0LOPT register Clear RDY bit RDY = 0? No Yes Data frame Data frame or remote frame? Set C0MDATAxm register Set C0MDLCm register, Clear RTR bit of C0MCONFm register. Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Remote frame Set C0MDLCm register Set RTR bit of C0MCONFm register. Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set RDY bit Set TRQ bit END Cautions 1. The TRQ bit should be set after the RDY bit is set. 2. The RDY bit and TRQ bit should not be set at the same time. Remark Also check the MBON flag at the beginning and at the end of the interrupt routine, in order to check the access to the message buffers as well as TX history list registers, in case a pending sleep mode had been executed. If MBON is detected to be cleared at any check, the actions and results of the processing have to be discarded and processed again, after MBON is set again. It is recommended to cancel any sleep mode requests, before processing TX interrupts. 470 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-45. Transmit via Interrupt (Using C0TGPT register) START Transmit completion interrupt processing Read C0TGPT register TOVF = 1? No Yes Clear TOVF bit Clear RDY bit No RDY = 0? Yes Data frame Remote frame Data frame or remote frame? Set C0MDATAxm register Set C0MDLCm register Clear RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set C0MDLCm register Set RTR bit of C0MCONFm register Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set RDY bit Set TRQ bit THPM = 1? No Yes END Cautions 1. The TRQ bit should be set after the RDY bit is set. 2. The RDY bit and TRQ bit should not be set at the same time. Remark Also check the MBON flag at the beginning and at the end of the interrupt routine, in order to check the access to the message buffers as well as TX history list registers, in case a pending sleep mode had been executed. If MBON is detected to be cleared at any check, the actions and results of the processing have to be discarded and processed again, after MBON is set again. It is recommended to cancel any sleep mode requests, before processing TX interrupts. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 471 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-46. Transmission via Software Polling START No CINTS0 = 1? Yes Clear CINTS0 bit Read C0TGPT register No TOVF = 1? Yes Clear TOVF bit Clear RDY bit RDY = 0? No Yes Data frame Data frame or remote frame? Set C0MDATAxm register Set C0MDLCm register Clear RTR bit of C0MCONFm register. Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Remote frame Set C0MDLCm register Set RTR bit of C0MCONFm Set C0MIDLm and C0MIDHm registers Set RDY bit Set TRQ bit THPM = 1? No Yes END Cautions 1. The TRQ bit should be set after the RDY bit is set. 2. The RDY bit and TRQ bit should not be set at the same time. Remark Also check the MBON flag at the beginning and at the end of the polling routine, in order to check the access to the message buffers as well as TX history list registers, in case a pending sleep mode had been executed. If MBON is detected to be cleared at any check, the actions and results of the processing have to be discarded and processed again, after MBON is set again. 472 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-47. Transmission Abort Processing (Except Normal Operation Mode with ABT) START Clear TRQ bit Note Wait for 11 CAN data bits TSTAT = 0? No Yes Read C0LOPT register Message buffer to be aborted matches C0LOPT register? No Yes Transmission successful Transmit abort request was successful END Note There is a possibility of starting the transmission without being aborted even if TRQ bit is cleared, because the transmission request to protocol layer might already been accepted between 11 bits, total of interframe space (3 bits) and suspend transmission (8 bits). Cautions 1. Execute transmission request abort processing by clearing the TRQ bit, not the RDY bit. 2. Before making a sleep mode transition request, confirm that there is no transmission request left using this processing. 3. The TSTAT bit can be periodically checked by a user application or can be checked after the transmit completion interrupt. 4. Do not execute the new transmission request including in the other message buffers while transmission abort processing is in progress. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 473 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-48. Transmission Abort Processing Except for ABT Transmission (Normal Operation Mode with ABT) START Clear ABTTRG bit No ABTTRG = 0? Yes Clear TRQ bit Wait for 11 CAN data bits Note TSTAT = 0? No Yes Read C0LOPT register Message buffer to be aborted matches C0LOPT register? No Yes Transmission successful Transmit abort request was successful END Note There is a possibility of starting the transmission without being aborted even if TRQ bit is cleared, because the transmission request to protocol layer might already been accepted between 11 bits, total of interframe space (3 bits) and suspend transmission (8 bits). Cautions 1. Execute transmission request abort processing by clearing the TRQ bit, not the RDY bit. 2. Before making a sleep mode transition request, confirm that there is no transmission request left using this processing. 3. The TSTAT bit can be periodically checked by a user application or can be checked after the transmit completion interrupt. 4. Do not execute the new transmission request including in the other message buffers while transmission abort processing is in progress. 474 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-49 shows the processing not to skip resumption of transmitting a message that was stopped when transmission of an ABT message buffer was aborted. Figure 15-49. ABT Transmission Abort Processing (Normal Operation Mode with ABT) START TSTAT = 0? No Yes Clear ABTTRG bit ABTTRG = 0? No Yes Clear TRQ bit of message buffer whose transmission was aborted Transmit abort Transmission start No Yes Set ABTCLR bit END Cautions 1. Do not set any transmission requests while ABT transmission abort processing is in progress. 2. Make a CAN sleep mode/CAN stop mode transition request after ABTTRG bit is cleared (after ABT mode is aborted) following the procedure shown in Figure 15-49 or 15-50. When clearing a transmission request in an area other than the ABT area, follow the procedure shown in Figure 15-47. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 475 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-50 shows the processing to skip resumption of transmitting a message that was stopped when transmission of an ABT message buffer was aborted. Figure 15-50. ABT Transmission Request Abort Processing (Normal Operation Mode with ABT) START Clear TRQ bit of message buffer undergoing transmission Clear ABTTRG bit ABTTRG = 0? No Yes Transmit abort Transmission start pointer clear? No Yes Set ABTCLR bit END Cautions 1. Do not set any transmission requests while ABT transmission abort processing is in progress. 2. Make a CAN sleep mode/CAN stop mode request after ABTTRG is cleared (after ABT mode is stopped) following the procedure shown in Figure 15-49 or 15-50. When clearing a transmission request in an area other than the ABT area, follow the procedure shown in Figure 15-47. 476 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-51. Reception via Interrupt (Using C0LIPT Register) START Generation of receive completion interrupt Read C0LIPT register Clear DN bit Read C0MDATAxm , C0MDLCm,, C0MIDLm, and C0MIDHm registers DN = 0 AND MUC = 0Note No Yes END Note Check the MUC and DN bits using one read access. Remark Also check the MBON flag at the beginning and at the end of the interrupt routine, in order to check the access to the message buffers as well as reception history list registers, in case a pending sleep mode had been executed. If MBON is detected to be cleared at any check, the actions and results of the processing have to be discarded and processed again, after MBON is set again. It is recommended to cancel any sleep mode requests, before processing RX interrupts. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 477 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-52. Reception via Interrupt (Using C0RGPT Register) START Generation of receive completion interrupt Read C0RGPT register ROVF = 1? No Yes Clear ROVF bit Yes RHPM = 1? No Clear DN bit Read C0MDATAxm , C0MDLCm,, C0MIDLm,, C0MIDHm registers DN = 0 AND Note MUC = 0 No Yes Correct data is read Illegal data is read END Note Check the MUC and DN bits using one read access. Remark Also check the MBON flag at the beginning and at the end of the interrupt routine, in order to check the access to the message buffers as well as reception history list registers, in case a pending sleep mode had been executed. If MBON is detected to be cleared at any check, the actions and results of the processing have to be discarded and processed again, after MBON is set again. It is recommended to cancel any sleep mode requests, before processing RX interrupts. 478 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-53. Reception via Software Polling START No CINTS1 = 1? Yes Clear CINTS1 bit Read C0RGPT register No ROVF = 1? Yes Clear ROVF bit Yes RHPM = 1? No Clear DN bit Read C0MDATAxm , C0MDLCm,, C0MIDLm,, C0MIDHm registers DN = 0 AND Note MUC = 0 No Yes Correct data is read Illegal data is read END Note Check the MUC and DN bits using one read access. Remark Also check the MBON flag at the beginning and at the end of the polling routine, in order to check the access to the message buffers as well as reception history list registers, in case a pending sleep mode had been executed. If MBON is detected to be cleared at any check, the actions and results of the processing have to be discarded and processed again, after MBON is set again. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 479 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-54. Setting CAN Sleep Mode/Stop Mode START (when PSMODE[1:0] = 00B) Set PSMODE0 bit PSMODE0 = 1? No Yes CAN sleep mode Set PSMODE1 bit No PSMODE1 = 1? Yes Request CAN sleep mode again? Yes CAN stop mode No Clear OPMODE END No INIT mode? Yes Access to registers other than the C0CTRL and C0GMCTRL registers Set C0CTRL register (Set OPMODE) Clear CINTS5 bit Caution 480 To abort transmission before making a request for the CAN sleep mode, perform processing according to Figures 15-47 and 15-48. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-55. Clear CAN Sleep/Stop Mode START CAN stop mode Clear PSMODE1 bit CAN sleep mode Released by USER Released by CRxD at CPU NOT standby state (VPCLK is still supplied) Released by CRxD at CPU standby state (VPCLK is stopped) Clear PSMODE0 After CRxD is dominant level, PSMODE0 = 0, CINTS5 = 1 After CRxD is dominant level, CINTS5 = 1 Clear CINTS5 bit Clear PSMODE0 Clear CINTS5 bit END User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 481 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-56. Bus-Off Recovery (Expect Normal Operation Mode with ABT) START No BOFF = 1? Yes Note Clear all TRQ bits Set C0CTRL register (Clear OPMODE) Access to registers other than C0CTRL and C0GMCTRL registers Forced recovery from bus off? No Yes Set CCERC bit Set C0CTRL register (Set OPMODE) Set C0CTRL register (Set OPMODE) Wait for recovery from bus off END Note Clear all TRQ bits when re-initialization of message buffer is executed by clearing RDY bit before bus-off recovery sequence is started. Caution When the transmission from the initialization mode to any operation modes is requested to execute bus-off recovery sequence again in the bus-off recovery sequence, reception error counter is cleared. Therefore it is necessary to detect 11 consecutive recessive-level bits 128 times on the bus again. Remark OPMODE: Normal operation mode, normal operation mode with ABT, receive-only mode, single-shot mode, self-test mode 482 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-57. Bus-Off Recovery (Normal Operation Mode with ABT) START No BOFF = 1? Yes Clear ABTTRG bit Note Clear all TRQ bits Set C0CTRL register (Clear OPMODE) Access to registers other than C0CTRL and C0GMCTRL registers Forced recovery from bus off? No Yes Set CCERC bit Set C0CTRL register (Set OPMODE) Set C0CTRL register (Set OPMODE) Wait for recovery from bus off END Note Clear all TRQ bits when re-initialization of message buffer is executed by clearing RDY bit before bus-off recovery sequence is started. Caution When the transmission from the initialization mode to any operation modes is requested to execute bus-off recovery sequence again in the bus-off recovery sequence, reception error counter is cleared. Therefore it is necessary to detect 11 consecutive recessive-level bits 128 times on the bus again. Remark OPMODE: Normal operation mode, normal operation mode with ABT, receive-only mode, single-shot mode, self-test mode User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 483 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-58. Normal Shutdown Process START INIT mode Clear GOM bit GOM = 0? Yes Shutdown successful GOM = 0, EFSD = 0 END 484 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD No CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-59. Forced Shutdown Process START Set EFSD bit Must be a subseguent write Clear GOM bit No GOM = 0? Yes Shutdown successful GOM = 0, EFSD = 0 END Caution Do not read- or write-access any registers by software between setting the EFSD bit and clearing the GOM bit. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 485 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-60. Error Handling START Error interrupt CINTS2 = 1? No Yes Check CAN module state (read C0INFO register) Clear CINTS2 bit No CINTS3 = 1? Yes Check CAN protocol error state (read C0LEC register) Clear CINTS3 bit CINTS4 = 1? Yes Clear CINTS4 bit END 486 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD No CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-61. Setting CPU Standby (from CAN Sleep Mode) START Set PSMODE0 bit PSMODE0 = 1? No Yes CAN sleep mode Set CPU standby mode END Caution Before the CPU is set in the CPU standby mode, please check the CAN sleep mode or not. However, after check of the CAN sleep mode, until the CPU is set in the CPU standby mode, the CAN sleep mode may be cancelled by wakeup from CAN bus. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 487 CHAPTER 15 CAN CONTROLLER Figure 15-62. Setting CPU Standby (from CAN Stop Mode) START Set PSMODE0 bit PSMODE0 = 1? No Note Clear CINTS5 bit Yes CAN sleep mode Set PSMODE1 bit No PSMODE1 = 1? Yes CAN stop mode Set CPU standby mode END Note During wakeup interrupts Caution The CAN stop mode can only be released by writing 01B to the PSMODE[1:0] bit of the C0CTRL register and not by a change in the CAN bus state. 488 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS 16.1 Interrupt Function Types The following two types of interrupt functions are used. (1) Maskable interrupts These interrupts undergo mask control. Maskable interrupts can be divided into a high interrupt priority group and a low interrupt priority group by setting the priority specification flag registers (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H). Multiple interrupt servicing can be applied to low-priority interrupts when high-priority interrupts are generated. If two or more interrupt requests, each having the same priority, are simultaneously generated, then they are processed according to the priority of vectored interrupt servicing. For the priority order, see Table 16-1. A standby release signal is generated and STOP and HALT modes are released. 8 external interrupt requests and 24 internal interrupt requests are provided as maskable interrupts. (2) Software interrupt This is a vectored interrupt generated by executing the BRK instruction. It is acknowledged even when interrupts are disabled. The software interrupt does not undergo interrupt priority control. 16.2 Interrupt Sources and Configuration A total of 33 interrupt sources exist for maskable and software interrupts. In addition, they also have up to four reset source (see Table 16-1). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 489 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Table 16-1. Interrupt Source List (1/2) Interrupt Type Default Interrupt Source Note 1 Priority Name Trigger Internal/ Vector Basic External Table Configuration Address Maskable Note 3 Type Note 2 0 INTLVI Low-voltage detection Internal 0004H (A) 1 INTP0 Pin input edge detection External 0006H (B) 2 INTP1 Pin input edge detection 0008H 3 INTP2 Pin input edge detection 000AH 4 INTP3 Pin input edge detection 000CH 5 INTP4 Pin input edge detection 000EH 6 INTP5 Pin input edge detection 0010H 7 INTC0ERR AFCAN0 error occurrence 8 INTC0WUP AFCAN0 wakeup 0014H Internal 0012H 9 INTC0REC AFCAN0 reception completion 0016H 10 INTC0TRX AFCAN0 transmission completion 0018H 11 INTSRE60 UART60 reception error generation 001AH 12 INTSR60 End of UART60 reception 001CH 13 INTST60 End of UART60 transmission 001EH 14 INTCSI10 End of CSI10 transmission 0020H INTSRE61 UART61 reception error generation 15 INTP6 Pin input edge detection INTSR61 End of UART61 reception Internal 16 INTP7 Pin input edge detection External INTST61 End of UART61 transmission Internal INTTMH1 Match between TMH1 and CMP01 17 External (A) 0022H (B) 0024H (B) (A) (A) 0026H (when compare register is specified) 18 INTTMH0 Match between TMH0 and CMP00 0028H (when compare register is specified) 19 INTTM50 Match between TM50 and CR50 002AH (when compare register is specified) 20 INTTM000 Match between TM00 and CR000 002CH (when compare register is specified), TI010 pin valid edge detection (when capture register is specified) 21 INTTM010 Match between TM00 and CR010 002EH (when compare register is specified), TI000 pin valid edge detection (when capture register is specified) 22 Notes 1. INTAD End of A/D conversion The default priority is the priority applicable when two or more maskable interrupt are generated simultaneously. 0 is the highest priority, and 27 is the lowest. 490 0030H 2. Basic configuration types (A) to (C) correspond to (A) to (C) in Figure 16-1. 3. When bit 1 (LVIMD) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM) is set to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Table 16-1. Interrupt Source List (2/2) Interrupt Type Default Interrupt Source Note 1 Priority Name Trigger Internal/ Vector Basic External Table Configuration Address Maskable 23 INTWTI 24 INTTM51 Watch timer reference time interval signal INTDMU Internal 0032H Type Note 2 (A) DMU operation end Note 3 Match between TM51 and CR51 0034H (when compare register is specified) 25 INTWT Watch timer overflow 0036H 26 INTTM001 Match between TM01 and CR001 003AH (when compare register is specified), TI011 pin valid edge detection (when capture register is specified) 27 INTTM011 Match between TM01 and CR011 003CH (when compare register is specified) Software - BRK BRK instruction execution - 003EH (C) Reset - RESET Reset input - 0000H - POC Power-on clear LVI Low-voltage detection WDT WDT overflow Notes 1. Note 4 The default priority is the priority applicable when two or more maskable interrupt are generated simultaneously. 0 is the highest priority, and 27 is the lowest. 2. Basic configuration types (A) to (C) correspond to (A) to (C) in Figure 16-1. 3. When the 8-bit timer/event counter 51 is used in the carrier generator mode, the interrupt source is INTTM5H1 (see Figure 8-13 Transfer Timing). 4. When bit 1 (LVIMD) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM) is set to 1. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 491 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Figure 16-1. Basic Configuration of Interrupt Function (A) Internal maskable interrupt Internal bus MK Interrupt request IE PR ISP Priority controller IF Vector table address generator Standby release signal (B) External maskable interrupt (INTP0 to INTP7) Internal bus External interrupt edge enable register (EGP, EGN) Interrupt request Edge detector MK IF IE PR ISP Vector table address generator Priority controller Standby release signal (C) Software interrupt Internal bus Interrupt request IF: 492 Priority controller Interrupt request flag IE: Interrupt enable flag ISP: In-service priority flag MK: Interrupt mask flag PR: Priority specification flag User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Vector table address generator CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS 16.3 Registers Controlling Interrupt Functions The following 6 types of registers are used to control the interrupt functions. * Interrupt request flag register (IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, IF1H) * Interrupt mask flag register (MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, MK1H) * Priority specification flag register (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H) * External interrupt rising edge enable register (EGP) * External interrupt falling edge enable register (EGN) * Program status word (PSW) Table 16-2 shows a list of interrupt request flags, interrupt mask flags, and priority specification flags corresponding to interrupt request sources. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 493 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Table 16-2. Flags Corresponding to Interrupt Request Sources Interrupt Interrupt Request Flag Request Interrupt Mask Flag Register IF0L Priority Specification Flag Register INTLVI LVIIF INTP0 PIF0 PMK0 PPR0 INTP1 PIF1 PMK1 PPR1 INTP2 PIF2 PMK2 PPR2 INTP3 PIF3 PMK3 PPR3 INTP4 PIF4 PMK4 PPR4 INTP5 PIF5 PMK5 PPR5 INTC0ERR C0ERRIF C0ERRMK C0ERRPR INTC0WUP C0WUPIF INTC0REC C0RECIF C0RECMK C0RECPR INTC0TRX C0TRXIF C0TRXMK C0TRXPR INTSRE60 SREIF60 SREMK60 SREPR60 INTSR60 SRIF60 SRMK60 SRPR60 INTST60 STIF60 STMK60 STPR60 INTCSI10 CSIIF10 IF0H DUALIF0 LVIMK C0WUPMK CSIMK10 Note 1 INTSRE61 MK0L Register MK0H DUALMK0 LVIPR C0WUPPR CSIPR10 Note 2 SREIF61 PR0L PR0H DUALPR0 Note 2 SREMK61 SREPR61 INTP6 PIF6 DUALIF1 PMK6 DUALMK1 PPR6 DUALPR1 INTSR61 SRIF61 Note 1 SRMK61 Note 2 SRPR61 Note 2 INTP7 PIF7 DUALIF2 PMK7 DUALMK2 INTST61 STIF61 Note 1 STMK61 Note 2 INTTMH1 TMIFH1 TMMKH1 TMPRH1 INTTMH0 TMIFH0 TMMKH0 TMPRH0 INTTM50 TMIF50 TMMK50 TMPR50 INTTM000 TMIF000 TMMK000 TMPR000 IF1L MK1L PPR7 DUALPR2 STPR61 Note 2 INTTM010 TMIF010 TMMK010 TMPR010 INTAD ADIF ADMK ADPR INTWTI WTIIF DUALIF7 WTIMK Note 1 INTDMU INTTM51 DMUIF Note 3 TMIF51 DUALMK7 WTIPR Note 2 TMMK51 DMUPR MK1H TMPR51 INTWT WTIF WTMK WTPR INTTM001 TMIF001 TMMK001 TMPR001 INTTM011 TMIF011 TMMK011 TMPR011 Notes 1. 2. 3. PR1H If either of the two types of interrupt sources is generated, these flags are set (1). Both types of interrupt sources are supported. When the 8-bit timer/event counter 51 is used in the carrier generator mode, the interrupt source is INTTM5H1 (see Figure 8-13 Transfer Timing). 494 DUALPR7 Note 2 DMUMK IF1H PR1L User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS (1) Interrupt request flag registers (IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, IF1H) The interrupt request flags are set to 1 when the corresponding interrupt request is generated or an instruction is executed. They are cleared to 0 when an instruction is executed upon acknowledgment of an interrupt request or upon reset signal generation. When an interrupt is acknowledged, the interrupt request flag is automatically cleared and then the interrupt routine is entered. IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, and IF1H are set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. When IF0L and IF0H, and IF1L and IF1H are combined to form 16-bit registers IF0 and IF1, they are read with a 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears these registers to 00H. Figure 16-2. Format of Interrupt Request Flag Registers (IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, IF1H) Address: FFE0H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol IF0L <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> C0ERRIF PIF5 PIF4 PIF3 PIF2 PIF1 PIF0 LVIIF Address: FFE1H Symbol IF0H R/W <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> DUALIF1 DURLIF0 STIF60 SRIF60 SREIF60 C0TRXIF C0RECIF C0WUPIF PIF6 CSIIF10 SRIF61 SREIF61 Address: FFE2H Symbol IF1L After reset: 00H After reset: 00H R/W <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> DUALIF7 ADIF TMIF010 TMIF000 TMIF50 TMIFH0 TMIFH1 DUALIF2 WTIIF PIF7 DMUIF STIF61 Address: FFE3H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 <4> <3> 2 <1> <0> IF1H 0 0 0 TMIF011 TMIF001 0 WTIF TMIF51 XXIFX Interrupt request flag 0 No interrupt request signal is generated 1 Interrupt request is generated, interrupt request status Cautions 1. Be sure to set bits 2, 5 to 7 of IF1H to 0. 2. When operating a timer, serial interface, or A/D converter after standby release, operate it once after clearing the interrupt request flag. An interrupt request flag may be set by noise. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 495 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Cautions 3. When manipulating a flag of the interrupt request flag register, use a 1-bit memory manipulation instruction (CLR1). When describing in C language, use a bit manipulation instruction such as "IF0L.0 = 0;" or "_asm("clr1 IF0L, 0");" because the compiled assembler must be a 1-bit memory manipulation instruction (CLR1). If a program is described in C language using an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction such as "IF0L &= 0xfe;" and compiled, it becomes the assembler of three instructions. mov a, IF0L and a, #0FEH mov IF0L, a In this case, even if the request flag of another bit of the same interrupt request flag register (IF0L) is set to 1 at the timing between "mov a, IF0L" and "mov IF0L, a", the flag is cleared to 0 at "mov IF0L, a". Therefore, care must be exercised when using an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction in C language. 496 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS (2) Interrupt mask flag registers (MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, MK1H) The interrupt mask flags are used to enable/disable the corresponding maskable interrupt servicing. MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, and MK1H are set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. When MK0L and MK0H, and MK1L and MK1H are combined to form 16-bit registers MK0 and MK1, they are set with a 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets these registers sets to FFH. Figure 16-3. Format of Interrupt Mask Flag Registers (MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, MK1H) Address: FFE4H Symbol MK0L After reset: FFH R/W <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> C0ERRMK PMK5 PMK4 PMK3 PMK2 PMK1 PMK0 LVIMK <1> <0> Address: FFE5H After reset: FFH R/W Symbol <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> MK0H DUALMK1 DURLMK0 STMK60 SRMK60 SREMK60 C0TRXMK PMK6 CSIMK10 SRMK61 SREMK61 Address: FFE6H Symbol MK1L After reset: FFH C0RECMK C0WUPMK R/W <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> DUALMK7 ADMK TMMK010 TMMK000 TMMK50 TMMKH0 TMMKH1 DUALMK2 WTIMK PMK7 DMUMK STMK61 Address: FFE7H After reset: FFH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 <4> <3> 2 <1> <0> MK1H 1 1 1 TMMK011 TMMK001 1 WTMK TMMK51 XXMKX Caution Interrupt servicing control 0 Interrupt servicing enabled 1 Interrupt servicing disabled Be sure to set bits 2, 5 to 7 of MK1H to 1. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 497 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS (3) Priority specification flag registers (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H) The priority specification flag registers are used to set the corresponding maskable interrupt priority order. PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, and PR1H are set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. If PR0L and PR0H, and PR1L and PR1H are combined to form 16-bit registers PR0 and PR1, they are set with a 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets these registers to FFH. Figure 16-4. Format of Priority Specification Flag Registers (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H) Address: FFE8H After reset: FFH Symbol PR0L <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> C0ERRPR PPR5 PPR4 PPR3 PPR2 PPR1 PPR0 LVIPR Address: FFE9H After reset: FFH Symbol PR0H R/W <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> DUALPR1 DURLPR0 STPR60 SRPR60 SREPR60 C0TRXPR C0RECPR C0WUPPR PPR6 CSIPR10 SRPR61 SREPR61 Address: FFEAH Symbol PR1L R/W After reset: FFH R/W <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> <2> <1> <0> DUALPR7 ADPR TMPR010 TMPR000 TMPR50 TMPRH0 TMPRH1 DUALPR2 WTIPR PPR7 DMUPR STPR61 Address: FFEBH After reset: FFH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 <4> <3> 2 <1> <0> PR1H 1 1 1 TMPR011 TMPR001 1 WTPR TMPR51 XXPRX Priority level selection 0 High priority level 1 Low priority level Caution Be sure to set bit 2, 5 to 7 of PR1H to 1. 498 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS (4) External interrupt rising edge enable register (EGP), external interrupt falling edge enable register (EGN) These registers specify the valid edge for INTP0 to INTP7. EGP and EGN are set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears these registers to 00H. Figure 16-5. Format of External Interrupt Rising Edge Enable Register (EGP) and External Interrupt Falling Edge Enable Register (EGN) Address: FF48H After reset: 00H Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EGP7 EPG6 EGP5 EGP4 EGP3 EGP2 EGP1 EGP0 EGP R/W Address: FF49H After reset: 00H Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EGN7 EGN6 EGN5 EGN4 EGN3 EGN2 EGN1 EGN0 EGPn EGNn 0 0 Edge detection disabled 0 1 Falling edge 1 0 Rising edge 1 1 Both rising and falling edges EGN R/W INTPn pin valid edge selection (n = 0 to 7) Table 16-3 shows the ports corresponding to EGPn and EGNn. Table 16-3. Ports Corresponding to EGPn and EGNn Detection Enable Register Edge Detection Port External Request Signal EGP0 EGN0 P120 INTP0 EGP1 EGN1 P30 INTP1 EGP2 EGN2 P31 INTP2 EGP3 EGN3 P32 INTP3 EGP4 EGN4 P33 INTP4 EGP5 EGN5 P16 INTP5 EGP6 EGN6 P72 INTP6 EGP7 EGN7 P73 INTP7 Caution Select the port mode by clearing EGPn and EGNn to 0 because an edge may be detected when the external interrupt function is switched to the port function. Remark n = 0 to 7 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 499 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS (5) Program status word (PSW) The program status word is a register used to hold the instruction execution result and the current status for an interrupt request. The IE flag that sets maskable interrupt enable/disable and the ISP flag that controls multiple interrupt servicing are mapped to the PSW. Besides 8-bit read/write, this register can carry out operations using bit manipulation instructions and dedicated instructions (EI and DI). When a vectored interrupt request is acknowledged, if the BRK instruction is executed, the contents of the PSW are automatically saved into a stack and the IE flag is reset to 0. If a maskable interrupt request is acknowledged, the contents of the priority specification flag of the acknowledged interrupt are transferred to the ISP flag. The PSW contents are also saved into the stack with the PUSH PSW instruction. They are restored from the stack with the RETI, RETB, and POP PSW instructions. Reset signal generation sets PSW to 02H. Figure 16-6. Format of Program Status Word PSW <7> <6> <5> <4> <3> 2 <1> 0 After reset IE Z RBS1 AC RBS0 0 ISP CY 02H Used when normal instruction is executed ISP 500 Priority of interrupt currently being serviced 0 High-priority interrupt servicing (low-priority interrupt disabled) 1 Interrupt request not acknowledged, or lowpriority interrupt servicing (all maskable interrupts enabled) IE Interrupt request acknowledgment enable/disable 0 Disabled 1 Enabled User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS 16.4 Interrupt Servicing Operations 16.4.1 Maskable interrupt acknowledgement A maskable interrupt becomes acknowledgeable when the interrupt request flag is set to 1 and the mask (MK) flag corresponding to that interrupt request is cleared to 0. A vectored interrupt request is acknowledged if interrupts are in the interrupt enabled state (when the IE flag is set to 1). However, a low-priority interrupt request is not acknowledged during servicing of a higher priority interrupt request (when the ISP flag is reset to 0). The times from generation of a maskable interrupt request until interrupt servicing is performed are listed in Table 16-4 below. For the interrupt request acknowledgement timing, see Figures 16-8 and 16-9. Table 16-4. Time from Generation of Maskable Interrupt Until Servicing Note Minimum Time Maximum Time When xxPR = 0 7 clocks 32 clocks When xxPR = 1 8 clocks 33 clocks Note If an interrupt request is generated just before a divide instruction, the wait time becomes longer. Remark 1 clock: 1/fCPU (fCPU: CPU clock) If two or more maskable interrupt requests are generated simultaneously, the request with a higher priority level specified in the priority specification flag is acknowledged first. If two or more interrupts requests have the same priority level, the request with the highest default priority is acknowledged first. An interrupt request that is held pending is acknowledged when it becomes acknowledgeable. Figure 16-7 shows the interrupt request acknowledgement algorithm. If a maskable interrupt request is acknowledged, the contents are saved into the stacks in the order of PSW, then PC, the IE flag is reset (0), and the contents of the priority specification flag corresponding to the acknowledged interrupt are transferred to the ISP flag. The vector table data determined for each interrupt request is the loaded into the PC and branched. Restoring from an interrupt is possible by using the RETI instruction. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 501 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Figure 16-7. Interrupt Request Acknowledgement Processing Algorithm Start No xxIF = 1? Yes (interrupt request generation) No xxMK = 0? Yes Interrupt request held pending Yes (High priority) xxPR = 0? No (Low priority) Yes Any high-priority interrupt request among those simultaneously generated with xxPR = 0? Interrupt request held pending Any high-priority interrupt request among those simultaneously generated with xxPR = 0? No No No IE = 1? Yes Interrupt request held pending Interrupt request held pending Any high-priority interrupt request among those simultaneously generated? No IE = 1? Vectored interrupt servicing Yes ISP = 1? Yes Yes Yes Interrupt request held pending No Interrupt request held pending No Interrupt request held pending Vectored interrupt servicing xxIF: Interrupt request flag xxMK: Interrupt mask flag xxPR: Priority specification flag IE: Flag that controls acknowledgement of maskable interrupt request (1 = Enable, 0 = Disable) ISP: Flag that indicates the priority level of the interrupt currently being serviced (0 = high-priority interrupt servicing, 1 = No interrupt request acknowledged, or low-priority interrupt servicing) 502 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Figure 16-8. Interrupt Request Acknowledgement Timing (Minimum Time) 6 clocks CPU processing Instruction PSW and PC saved, jump to interrupt servicing Instruction Interrupt servicing program xxIF (xxPR = 1) 8 clocks xxIF (xxPR = 0) 7 clocks Remark 1 clock: 1/fCPU (fCPU: CPU clock) Figure 16-9. Interrupt Request Acknowledgement Timing (Maximum Time) CPU processing Instruction 25 clocks 6 clocks Divide instruction PSW and PC saved, jump to interrupt servicing Interrupt servicing program xxIF (xxPR = 1) 33 clocks xxIF (xxPR = 0) 32 clocks Remark 1 clock: 1/fCPU (fCPU: CPU clock) 16.4.2 Software interrupt request acknowledgement A software interrupt acknowledge is acknowledged by BRK instruction execution. Software interrupts cannot be disabled. If a software interrupt request is acknowledged, the contents are saved into the stacks in the order of the program status word (PSW), then program counter (PC), the IE flag is reset (0), and the contents of the vector table (003EH, 003FH) are loaded into the PC and branched. Restoring from a software interrupt is possible by using the RETB instruction. Caution Do not use the RETI instruction for restoring from the software interrupt. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 503 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS 16.4.3 Multiple interrupt servicing Multiple interrupt servicing occurs when another interrupt request is acknowledged during execution of an interrupt. Multiple interrupt servicing does not occur unless the interrupt request acknowledgement enabled state is selected (IE = 1). When an interrupt request is acknowledged, interrupt request acknowledgement becomes disabled (IE = 0). Therefore, to enable multiple interrupt servicing, it is necessary to set (1) the IE flag with the EI instruction during interrupt servicing to enable interrupt acknowledgement. Moreover, even if interrupts are enabled, multiple interrupt servicing may not be enabled, this being subject to interrupt priority control. Two types of priority control are available: default priority control and programmable priority control. Programmable priority control is used for multiple interrupt servicing. In the interrupt enabled state, if an interrupt request with a priority equal to or higher than that of the interrupt currently being serviced is generated, it is acknowledged for multiple interrupt servicing. If an interrupt with a priority lower than that of the interrupt currently being serviced is generated during interrupt servicing, it is not acknowledged for multiple interrupt servicing. Interrupt requests that are not enabled because interrupts are in the interrupt disabled state or because they have a lower priority are held pending. When servicing of the current interrupt ends, the pending interrupt request is acknowledged following execution of at least one main processing instruction execution. Table 16-5 shows relationship between interrupt requests enabled for multiple interrupt servicing and Figure 16-10 shows multiple interrupt servicing examples. Table 16-5. Relationship Between Interrupt Requests Enabled for Multiple Interrupt Servicing During Interrupt Servicing Multiple Interrupt Request PR = 0 Software interrupt Remarks 1. Interrupt PR = 1 Request Interrupt Being Serviced Maskable interrupt Software Maskable Interrupt Request IE = 1 IE = 0 IE = 1 IE = 0 ISP = 0 { x x x { ISP = 1 { x { x { { x { x { : Multiple interrupt servicing enabled 2. x: Multiple interrupt servicing disabled 3. ISP and IE are flags contained in the PSW. ISP = 0: An interrupt with higher priority is being serviced. ISP = 1: No interrupt request has been acknowledged, or an interrupt with a lower priority is being serviced. 4. IE = 0: Interrupt request acknowledgement is disabled. IE = 1: Interrupt request acknowledgement is enabled. PR is a flag contained in PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, and PR1H. PR = 0: Higher priority level PR = 1: Lower priority level 504 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Figure 16-10. Examples of Multiple Interrupt Servicing (1/2) Example 1. Multiple interrupt servicing occurs twice Main processing INTxx servicing INTyy servicing IE = 0 EI IE = 0 IE = 0 EI INTxx (PR = 1) INTzz servicing EI INTyy (PR = 0) INTzz (PR = 0) RETI IE = 1 RETI IE = 1 RETI IE = 1 During servicing of interrupt INTxx, two interrupt requests, INTyy and INTzz, are acknowledged, and multiple interrupt servicing takes place. Before each interrupt request is acknowledged, the EI instruction must always be issued to enable interrupt request acknowledgment. Example 2. Multiple interrupt servicing does not occur due to priority control Main processing INTxx servicing INTyy servicing IE = 0 EI EI INTxx (PR = 0) INTyy (PR = 1) RETI IE = 1 1 instruction execution IE = 0 RETI IE = 1 Interrupt request INTyy issued during servicing of interrupt INTxx is not acknowledged because its priority is lower than that of INTxx, and multiple interrupt servicing does not take place. The INTyy interrupt request is held pending, and is acknowledged following execution of one main processing instruction. PR = 0: Higher priority level PR = 1: Lower priority level IE = 0: Interrupt request acknowledgment disabled User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 505 CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS Figure 16-10. Examples of Multiple Interrupt Servicing (2/2) Example 3. Multiple interrupt servicing does not occur because interrupts are not enabled Main processing INTxx servicing INTyy servicing IE = 0 EI INTyy (PR = 0) INTxx (PR = 0) RETI IE = 1 1 instruction execution IE = 0 RETI IE = 1 Interrupts are not enabled during servicing of interrupt INTxx (EI instruction is not issued), therefore, interrupt request INTyy is not acknowledged and multiple interrupt servicing does not take place. The INTyy interrupt request is held pending, and is acknowledged following execution of one main processing instruction. PR = 0: Higher priority level IE = 0: 506 Interrupt request acknowledgement disabled User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 16 INTERRUPT FUNCTIONS 16.4.4 Interrupt request hold There are instructions where, even if an interrupt request is issued for them while another instruction is being executed, request acknowledgement is held pending until the end of execution of the next instruction. These instructions (interrupt request hold instructions) are listed below. * MOV PSW, #byte * MOV A, PSW * MOV PSW, A * MOV1 PSW. bit, CY * MOV1 CY, PSW. bit * AND1 CY, PSW. bit * OR1 CY, PSW. bit * XOR1 CY, PSW. bit * SET1 PSW. bit * CLR1 PSW. bit * RETB * RETI * PUSH PSW * POP PSW * BT PSW. bit, $addr16 * BF PSW. bit, $addr16 * BTCLR PSW. bit, $addr16 * EI * DI * Manipulation instructions for the IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, IF1H, MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, MK1H, PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, and PR1H registers. Caution The BRK instruction is not one of the above-listed interrupt request hold instructions. However, the software interrupt activated by executing the BRK instruction causes the IE flag to be cleared. Therefore, even if a maskable interrupt request is generated during execution of the BRK instruction, the interrupt request is not acknowledged. Figure 16-11 shows the timing at which interrupt requests are held pending. Figure 16-11. Interrupt Request Hold CPU processing Instruction N Instruction M PSW and PC saved, jump to interrupt servicing Interrupt servicing program xxIF Remarks 1. Instruction N: Interrupt request hold instruction 2. Instruction M: Instruction other than interrupt request hold instruction 3. The xxPR (priority level) values do not affect the operation of xxIF (instruction request). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 507 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION 17.1 Standby Function and Configuration 17.1.1 Standby function The standby function is designed to reduce the operating current of the system. The following two modes are available. (1) HALT mode HALT instruction execution sets the HALT mode. In the HALT mode, the CPU operation clock is stopped. If the high-speed system clock oscillator, internal high-speed oscillator, internal low-speed oscillator, or subsystem clock oscillator is operating before the HALT mode is set, oscillation of each clock continues. In this mode, the operating current is not decreased as much as in the STOP mode, but the HALT mode is effective for restarting operation immediately upon interrupt request generation and carrying out intermittent operations. (2) STOP mode STOP instruction execution sets the STOP mode. In the STOP mode, the high-speed system clock oscillator and internal high-speed oscillator stop, stopping the whole system, thereby considerably reducing the CPU operating current. Because this mode can be cleared by an interrupt request, it enables intermittent operations to be carried out. However, because a wait time is required to secure the oscillation stabilization time after the STOP mode is released, select the HALT mode if it is necessary to start processing immediately upon interrupt request generation. In either of these two modes, all the contents of registers, flags and data memory just before the standby mode is set are held. The I/O port output latches and output buffer statuses are also held. Cautions 1. The STOP mode can be used only when the CPU is operating on the main system clock. The subsystem clock oscillation cannot be stopped. The HALT mode can be used when the CPU is operating on either the main system clock or the subsystem clock. 2. When shifting to the STOP mode, be sure to stop the peripheral hardware operation operating with main system clock before executing STOP instruction. 3. The following sequence is recommended for operating current reduction of the A/D converter when the standby function is used: First clear bit 7 (ADCS) and bit 0 (ADCE) of the A/D converter mode register (ADM) to 0 to stop the A/D conversion operation, and then execute the STOP instruction. 17.1.2 Registers controlling standby function The standby function is controlled by the following two registers. * Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) * Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) Remark 508 For the registers that start, stop, or select the clock, see CHAPTER 5 CLOCK GENERATOR. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (1) Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) This is the register that indicates the count status of the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time counter. When X1 clock oscillation starts with the internal high-speed oscillation clock or subsystem clock used as the CPU clock, the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time can be checked. OSTC can be read by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. When reset is released (reset by RESET input, POC, LVI and WDT), the STOP instruction and MSTOP (bit 7 of MOC register) = 1 clear OSTC to 00H. Figure 17-1. Format of Oscillation Stabilization Time Counter Status Register (OSTC) Address: FFA3H After reset: 00H R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OSTC 0 0 0 MOST11 MOST13 MOST14 MOST15 MOST16 MOST MOST MOST MOST MOST 11 1 1 1 13 14 0 1 1 0 0 1 15 0 0 0 Oscillation stabilization time status 16 0 0 0 fX = 4 MHz fX = 5 MHz fX = 10 MHz fX = 20 MHz 11 512 s min. 409.6 s min. 204.8 s min. 102.4 s min. 13 2.05 ms min. 1.64 ms min. 819.2 s min. 409.6 s min. 14 4.10 ms min. 3.27 ms min. 1.64 ms min. 819.2 s min. 15 8.19 ms min. 6.55 ms min. 3.27 ms min. 1.64 ms min. 16 16.38 ms min. 13.11 ms min. 6.55 ms min. 3.27 ms min. 2 /fX min. 2 /fX min. 2 /fX min. 1 1 1 1 0 2 /fX min. 1 1 1 1 1 2 /fX min. Cautions 1. After the above time has elapsed, the bits are set to 1 in order from MOST11 and remain 1. 2. The oscillation stabilization time counter counts up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS. If the STOP mode is entered and then released while the internal highspeed oscillation clock is being used as the CPU clock, set the oscillation stabilization time as follows. * Desired OSTC oscillation stabilization time Oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS Note, therefore, that only the status up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS is set to OSTC after STOP mode is released. 3. The X1 clock oscillation stabilization time does not include the time until clock oscillation starts ("a" below). STOP mode release X1 pin voltage waveform a Remark fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 509 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (2) Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) This register is used to select the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time when the STOP mode is released. When the X1 clock is selected as the CPU clock, the operation waits for the time set using OSTS after the STOP mode is released. When the internal high-speed oscillation clock is selected as the CPU clock, confirm with OSTC that the desired oscillation stabilization time has elapsed after the STOP mode is released. The oscillation stabilization time can be checked up to the time set using OSTC. OSTS can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets OSTS to 05H. Figure 17-2. Format of Oscillation Stabilization Time Select Register (OSTS) Address: FFA4H After reset: 05H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OSTS 0 0 0 0 0 OSTS2 OSTS1 OSTS0 OSTS2 OSTS1 OSTS0 Oscillation stabilization time selection fX = 4 MHz 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 Other than above fX = 5 MHz fX = 10 MHz fX = 20 MHz 11 512 s 409.6 s 204.8 s 102.4 s 13 2.05 ms 1.64 ms 819.2 s 409.6 s 14 4.10 ms 3.27 ms 1.64 ms 819.2 s 15 8.19 ms 6.55 ms 3.27 ms 1.64 ms 16 16.38 ms 13.11 ms 6.55 ms 3.27 ms 2 /fX 2 /fX 2 /fX 2 /fX 2 /fX Setting prohibited Cautions 1. To set the STOP mode when the X1 clock is used as the CPU clock, set OSTS before executing the STOP instruction. 2. Do not change the value of the OSTS register during the X1 clock oscillation stabilization time. 3. The oscillation stabilization time counter counts up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS. If the STOP mode is entered and then released while the internal highspeed oscillation clock is being used as the CPU clock, set the oscillation stabilization time as follows. * Desired OSTC oscillation stabilization time Oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS Note, therefore, that only the status up to the oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS is set to OSTC after STOP mode is released. 4. The X1 clock oscillation stabilization time does not include the time until clock oscillation starts ("a" below). STOP mode release X1 pin voltage waveform a Remark 510 fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION 17.2 Standby Function Operation 17.2.1 HALT mode (1) HALT mode The HALT mode is set by executing the HALT instruction. HALT mode can be set regardless of whether the CPU clock before the setting was the high-speed system clock, internal high-speed oscillation clock, or subsystem clock. The operating statuses in the HALT mode are shown below. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 511 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION Table 17-1. Operating Statuses in HALT Mode (1/2) HALT Mode Setting Item When HALT Instruction Is Executed While CPU Is Operating on Main System Clock When CPU Is Operating on When CPU Is Operating on When CPU Is Operating on Internal High-Speed X1 Clock (fX) External Main System Clock Oscillation Clock (fRH) System clock (fEXCLK) Clock supply to the CPU is stopped Main system clock fRH Operation continues (cannot Status before HALT mode was set is retained be stopped) fX fEXCLK Status before HALT mode Operation continues (cannot Status before HALT mode was set is retained be stopped) was set is retained Operates or stops by external clock input Operation continues (cannot be stopped) Subsystem clock fXT fEXCLKS fRL Status before HALT mode was set is retained Operates or stops by external clock input Status before HALT mode was set is retained CPU Operation stopped Flash memory Operation stopped RAM Status before HALT mode was set is retained Port (latch) Status before HALT mode was set is retained 16-bit timer/event 00 counter 01 8-bit timer/event 50 counter 51 8-bit timer H0 Operable H1 Watch timer Watchdog timer Operable. Clock supply to watchdog timer stops when "internal low-speed oscillator can be stopped by software" is set by option byte. Clock output Operable Buzzer output A/D converter Serial interface UART60 UART61 CSI10 CAN controller Multiplier/divider Power-on-clear function Low-voltage detection function External interrupt Remark fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock fX: X1 clock fEXCLK: External main system clock fXT: XT1 clock fEXCLKS: External subsystem clock fRL: 512 Internal low-speed oscillation clock User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION Table 17-1. Operating Statuses in HALT Mode (2/2) HALT Mode Setting When HALT Instruction Is Executed While CPU Is Operating on Subsystem Clock When CPU Is Operating on XT1 Clock (fXT) When CPU Is Operating on External Subsystem Clock (fEXCLKS) Item System clock Clock supply to the CPU is stopped Main system clock Status before HALT mode was set is retained fRH fX Subsystem clock fEXCLK Operates or stops by external clock input fXT Operation continues (cannot be stopped) Status before HALT mode was set is retained Operates or stops by external clock input Operation continues (cannot be stopped) fEXCLKS fRL Status before HALT mode was set is retained CPU Operation stopped Flash memory Operation stopped RAM Status before HALT mode was set is retained Port (latch) Status before HALT mode was set is retained 00 Note counter 01 Note 8-bit timer/event 50 Note counter 51 Note 8-bit timer H0 16-bit timer/event Operable H1 Watch timer Operable. Clock supply to watchdog timer stops when "internal low-speed oscillator can be Watchdog timer stopped by software" is set by option byte. Clock output Operable Buzzer output Operable. However, operation disabled when peripheral hardware clock (fPRS) is stopped. A/D converter Serial interface UART60 Operable UART61 CSI10 Note CAN controller Multiplier/divider Power-on-clear function Low-voltage detection function External interrupt Note When the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the internal high-speed oscillation clock has been stopped, do not start operation of these functions on the external clock input from peripheral hardware pins. Remark fRH: fX: fEXCLK: fXT: fEXCLKS: fRL: Internal high-speed oscillation clock X1 clock External main system clock XT1 clock External subsystem clock Internal low-speed oscillation clock User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 513 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (2) HALT mode release The HALT mode can be released by the following two sources. (a) Release by unmasked interrupt request When an unmasked interrupt request is generated, the HALT mode is released. If interrupt acknowledgement is enabled, vectored interrupt servicing is carried out. If interrupt acknowledgement is disabled, the next address instruction is executed. Figure 17-3. HALT Mode Release by Interrupt Request Generation HALT instruction Interrupt request Standby release signal Status of CPU Operating mode HALT mode Wait Note Operating mode Oscillation High-speed system clock, internal high-speed oscillation clock, or subsystem clock Note The wait time is as follows: * When vectored interrupt servicing is carried out: 8 or 9 clocks * When vectored interrupt servicing is not carried out: 2 or 3 clocks Remark The broken lines indicate the case when the interrupt request which has released the standby mode is acknowledged. 514 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (b) Release by reset signal generation When the reset signal is generated, HALT mode is released, and then, as in the case with a normal reset operation, the program is executed after branching to the reset vector address. Figure 17-4. HALT Mode Release by Reset (1) When high-speed system clock is used as CPU clock HALT instruction Reset signal Status of CPU High-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) Normal operation (high-speed system clock) HALT mode Reset Reset processing period (11 to 45 s) Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Oscillation Oscillation stopped stopped Oscillates Oscillates Oscillation stabilization time (211/fX to 216/fX) Starting X1 oscillation is specified by software. (2) When internal high-speed oscillation clock is used as CPU clock HALT instruction Reset signal Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Status of CPU Internal high-speed oscillation clock HALT mode Oscillates Reset Reset processing period (11 to 45 s) Oscillation stopped Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Oscillates Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) (3) When subsystem clock is used as CPU clock HALT instruction Reset signal Status of CPU Subsystem clock (XT1 oscillation) Normal operation (subsystem clock) HALT mode Oscillates Reset period Reset Normal operation mode processing (internal high-speed (11 to 45 s) oscillation clock) Oscillation Oscillation stopped stopped Oscillates Starting XT1 oscillation is specified by software. Remark fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 515 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION Table 17-2. Operation in Response to Interrupt Request in HALT Mode Release Source Maskable interrupt MKxx PRxx IE ISP 0 0 0 x request Operation Next address instruction execution 0 0 1 x 0 1 0 1 Next address 0 1 x 0 instruction execution 0 1 1 1 Interrupt servicing Interrupt servicing execution execution Reset signal input 1 x x x HALT mode held - - x x Reset processing x: don't care 17.2.2 STOP mode (1) STOP mode setting and operating statuses The STOP mode is set by executing the STOP instruction, and it can be set only when the CPU clock before the setting was the main system clock. Caution Because the interrupt request signal is used to clear the standby mode, if there is an interrupt source with the interrupt request flag set and the interrupt mask flag reset, the standby mode is immediately cleared if set. Thus, the STOP mode is reset to the HALT mode immediately after execution of the STOP instruction and the system returns to the operating mode as soon as the wait time set using the oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) has elapsed. The operating statuses in the STOP mode are shown below. 516 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION Table 17-3. Operating Statuses in STOP Mode STOP Mode Setting Item When STOP Instruction Is Executed While CPU Is Operating on Main System Clock When CPU Is Operating on When CPU Is Operating on When CPU Is Operating on Internal High-Speed X1 Clock (fX) External Main System Clock Oscillation Clock (fRH) System clock (fEXCLK) Clock supply to the CPU is stopped Main system clock fRH Stopped fX fEXCLK Subsystem clock Input invalid fXT Status before STOP mode was set is retained fEXCLKS Operates or stops by external clock input fRL Status before STOP mode was set is retained CPU Operation stopped Flash memory Operation stopped RAM Status before STOP mode was set is retained Port (latch) Status before STOP mode was set is retained 16-bit timer/event 00 counter 01 8-bit timer/event 50 Note Operation stopped Note Note Note counter 51 8-bit timer H0 Operable only when TI50 is selected as the count clock Operable only when TI51 is selected as the count clock Operable only when TM50 output is selected as the count clock during 8-bit timer/event counter 50 operation H1 Watch timer 7 9 Operable only when fRL, fRL/2 , fRL/2 is selected as the count clock Operable only when subsystem clock is selected as the count clock Watchdog timer Operable. Clock supply to watchdog timer stops when "internal low-speed oscillator can be stopped by software" is set by option byte. Clock output Operable only when subsystem clock is selected as the count clock Buzzer output Operation stopped A/D converter Serial interface UART60 Operable only when TM50 output is selected as the serial clock during 8-bit timer/event counter UART61 50 operation Note CSI10 Operable only when external clock is selected as the serial clock CAN controller Operable. Can be woken up from sleep mode. Multiplier/divider Operation stopped Power-on-clear function Operable Low-voltage detection function External interrupt Note Do not start operation of these functions on the external clock input from peripheral hardware pins in the stop mode. (Remark and Cautions are listed on the next page.) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 517 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION Remark fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock fX: X1 clock fEXCLK: External main system clock fXT: XT1 clock fEXCLKS: External subsystem clock fRL: Internal low-speed oscillation clock Cautions 1. To use the peripheral hardware that stops operation in the STOP mode, and the peripheral hardware for which the clock that stops oscillating in the STOP mode after the STOP mode is released, restart the peripheral hardware. 2. Even if "internal low-speed oscillator can be stopped by software" is selected by the option byte, the internal low-speed oscillator continues in the STOP mode in the status before the STOP mode is set. To stop the internal low-speed oscillator in the STOP mode, stop it by software and then execute the STOP instruction. 3. To shorten oscillation stabilization time after the STOP mode is released when the CPU operates with the high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation), temporarily switch the CPU clock to the internal high-speed oscillation clock before the next execution of the STOP instruction. Before changing the CPU clock from the internal high-speed oscillator to the high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) after the STOP mode is released, check the oscillation stabilization time with the oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC). 4. If the STOP instruction is executed when AMPH = 1, supply of the CPU clock is stopped for 4.06 to 16.12 s after the STOP mode is released when the internal high-speed oscillation clock is selected as the CPU clock, or for the duration of 160 external clocks when the high-speed system clock (external clock input) is selected as the CPU clock. 518 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (2) STOP mode release Figure 17-5. Operation Timing When STOP Mode Is Released (When Unmasked Interrupt Request Is Generated) STOP mode release STOP mode High-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) High-speed system clock (external clock input) Internal high-speed oscillation clock High-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) is selected as CPU clock when STOP instruction is executed Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) HALT status (oscillation stabilization time set by OSTS) High-speed system clock Clock switched by software High-speed system clock (external clock input) is selected as CPU clock when STOP instruction is executed High-speed system clock WaitNote2 Supply of the CPU clock is stopped (160 external clocks)Note1 Internal high-speed oscillation clock is selected as CPU clock when STOP instruction is executed Internal high-speed oscillation clock WaitNote2 High-speed system clock Clock switched by software Supply of the CPU clock is stopped (4.06 to 16.12 s)Note1 Notes 1. When AMPH = 1 2. The wait time is as follows: * When vectored interrupt servicing is carried out: 8 or 9 clocks * When vectored interrupt servicing is not carried out: 2 or 3 clocks The STOP mode can be released by the following two sources. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 519 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (a) Release by unmasked interrupt request When an unmasked interrupt request is generated, the STOP mode is released. After the oscillation stabilization time has elapsed, if interrupt acknowledgment is enabled, vectored interrupt servicing is carried out. If interrupt acknowledgment is disabled, the next address instruction is executed. Figure 17-6. STOP Mode Release by Interrupt Request Generation (1/2) (1) When high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) is used as CPU clock Interrupt request STOP instruction Standby release signal Status of CPU High-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) Wait (set by OSTS) Normal operation (high-speed system clock) STOP mode Oscillates Oscillation stopped Normal operation (high-speed system clock) Oscillation stabilization wait (HALT mode status) Oscillates Oscillation stabilization time (set by OSTS) (2) When high-speed system clock (external clock input) is used as CPU clock (1/2) * When AMPH = 1 STOP instruction Interrupt request Standby release signal Status of CPU High-speed system clock (external clock input) Note Normal operation (high-speed system clock) STOP mode Supply of the CPU clock is stopped Oscillates Oscillation stopped (160 external clocks) Wait Note Normal operation (high-speed system clock) Oscillates The wait time is as follows: * When vectored interrupt servicing is carried out: 8 or 9 clocks * When vectored interrupt servicing is not carried out: 2 or 3 clocks Remark The broken lines indicate the case when the interrupt request that has released the standby mode is acknowledged. 520 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION Figure 17-6. STOP Mode Release by Interrupt Request Generation (2/2) (2) When high-speed system clock (external clock input) is used as CPU clock (2/2) * When AMPH = 0 STOP instruction Interrupt request Standby release signal Status of CPU High-speed system clock (external clock input) Normal operation (high-speed system clock) STOP mode Oscillates Oscillation stopped Normal operation (high-speed system clock) WaitNote Oscillates (3) When internal high-speed oscillation clock is used as CPU clock * When AMPH = 1 STOP instruction Interrupt request Standby release signal Status of CPU Internal high-speed oscillation clock Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) STOP mode Oscillates Oscillation stopped Supply of the CPU clock is stopped Note Wait Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) (4.06 to 16.12 s) Oscillates Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) * When AMPH = 0 STOP instruction Interrupt request Standby release signal Status of CPU Internal high-speed oscillation clock Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Oscillates STOP mode WaitNote Oscillation stopped Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Oscillates Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Note The wait time is as follows: * When vectored interrupt servicing is carried out: 8 or 9 clocks * When vectored interrupt servicing is not carried out: 2 or 3 clocks Remark The broken lines indicate the case when the interrupt request that has released the standby mode is acknowledged. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 521 CHAPTER 17 STANDBY FUNCTION (b) Release by reset signal generation When the reset signal is generated, STOP mode is released, and then, as in the case with a normal reset operation, the program is executed after branching to the reset vector address. Figure 17-7. STOP Mode Release by Reset Signal Input (1) When high-speed system clock is used as CPU clock STOP instruction Reset signal Status of CPU Normal operation (high-speed system clock) High-speed system clock (X1 oscillation) STOP mode Oscillation stopped Oscillates Reset period Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Oscillation Oscillation stopped stopped Oscillates Oscillation stabilization time (211/fX to 216/fX) Starting X1 oscillation is specified by software. (2) When internal high-speed oscillation clock is used as CPU clock STOP instruction Reset signal Status of CPU Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Internal high-speed oscillation clock Reset Reset processing period (11 to 45 s) STOP mode Oscillation Oscillation stopped stopped Oscillates Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Oscillates Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Remark fX: X1 clock oscillation frequency Table 17-4. Operation in Response to Interrupt Request in STOP Mode Release Source Maskable interrupt MKxx PRxx IE ISP 0 0 0 x request Operation Next address instruction execution 0 0 1 x Interrupt servicing execution 0 1 0 1 Next address 0 1 x 0 instruction execution 0 1 1 1 Interrupt servicing execution Reset signal input 1 x x x STOP mode held - - x x Reset processing x: don't care 522 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION The following four operations are available to generate a reset signal. (1) External reset input via RESET pin (2) Internal reset by watchdog timer program loop detection (3) Internal reset by comparison of supply voltage and detection voltage of power-on-clear (POC) circuit (4) Internal reset by comparison of supply voltage and detection voltage of low-power-supply detector (LVI) External and internal resets have no functional differences. In both cases, program execution starts at the address at 0000H and 0001H when the reset signal is generated. A reset is applied when a low level is input to the RESET pin, the watchdog timer overflows, or by POC and LVI circuit voltage detection, and each item of hardware is set to the status shown in Tables 18-1 and 18-2. Each pin is high impedance during reset signal generation or during the oscillation stabilization time just after a reset release, except for P130, which is low-level output. When a low level is input to the RESET pin, the device is reset. It is released from the reset status when a high level is input to the RESET pin and program execution is started with the internal high-speed oscillation clock after reset processing. A reset by the watchdog timer is automatically released, and program execution starts using the internal high-speed oscillation clock (see Figures 18-2 to 18-4) after reset processing. Reset by POC and LVI circuit power supply detection is automatically released when VDD VPOC or VDD VLVI after the reset, and program execution starts using the internal high-speed oscillation clock (see CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT and CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR) after reset processing. Cautions 1. For an external reset, input a low level for 10 s or more to the RESET pin. 2. During reset input, the X1 clock, XT1 clock, internal high-speed oscillation clock, and internal low-speed oscillation clock stop oscillating. External main system clock input and external subsystem clock input become invalid. 3. When the STOP mode is released by a reset, the STOP mode contents are held during reset input. However, the port pins become high-impedance, except for P130, which is set to low-level output. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 523 524 Figure 18-1. Block Diagram of Reset Function Internal bus Reset control flag register (RESF) WDTRF LVIRF Set Set Watchdog timer reset signal Clear Reset signal to LVIM/LVIS register Power-on-clear circuit reset signal Low-voltage detector reset signal Caution An LVI circuit internal reset does not reset the LVI circuit. Remarks 1. LVIM: Low-voltage detection register 2. LVIS: Low-voltage detection level selection register Reset signal CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD RESET Clear CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Figure 18-2. Timing of Reset by RESET Input Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Internal high-speed oscillation clock Starting X1 oscillation is specified by software. High-speed system clock (when X1 oscillation is selected) CPU clock Reset period (oscillation stop) Normal operation Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) RESET Internal reset signal Delay Delay (5 s (TYP.)) Port pin (except P130) Hi-Z Port pin (P130) Note Note Set P130 to high-level output by software. Remark When reset is effected, P130 outputs a low level. If P130 is set to output a high level before reset is effected, the output signal of P130 can be dummy-output as the CPU reset signal. Figure 18-3. Timing of Reset Due to Watchdog Timer Overflow Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Internal high-speed oscillation clock Starting X1 oscillation is specified by software. High-speed system clock (when X1 oscillation is selected) CPU clock Reset period (oscillation stop) Normal operation Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) Watchdog timer overflow Internal reset signal Port pin (except P130) Hi-Z Port pin (P130) Note Note Set P130 to high-level output by software. Caution A watchdog timer internal reset resets the watchdog timer. Remark When reset is effected, P130 outputs a low level. If P130 is set to output a high level before reset is effected, the output signal of P130 can be dummy-output as the CPU reset signal. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 525 CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Figure 18-4. Timing of Reset in STOP Mode by RESET Input Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) STOP instruction execution Internal high-speed oscillation clock Starting X1 oscillation is specified by software. High-speed system clock (when X1 oscillation is selected) CPU clock Normal operation Stop status (oscillation stop) Reset period (oscillation stop) Reset processing Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock) (11 to 45 s) RESET Internal reset signal Delay Port pin (except P130) Delay (5 s (TYP.)) Port pin (P130) Hi-Z Note Note Set P130 to high-level output by software. Remarks 1. When reset is effected, P130 outputs a low level. If P130 is set to output a high level before reset is effected, the output signal of P130 can be dummy-output as the CPU reset signal. 2. For the reset timing of the power-on-clear circuit and low-voltage detector, see CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT and CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR. 526 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Table 18-1. Operation Statuses During Reset Period Item During Reset Period System clock Clock supply to the CPU is stopped. Main system clock Subsystem clock fRH Operation stopped fX Operation stopped (pin is I/O port mode) fEXCLK Clock input invalid (pin is I/O port mode) fXT Operation stopped (pin is I/O port mode) fEXCLKS Clock input invalid (pin is I/O port mode) fRL Operation stopped CPU Flash memory RAM Regulator Operable Port (latch) Operation stopped 16-bit timer/event 00 counter 01 8-bit timer/event 50 counter 51 8-bit timer H0 H1 Watch timer Watchdog timer Clock output Buzzer output A/D converter Serial interface UART60 UART61 CSI10 CAN controller Multiplier/divider Power-on-clear function Operable Low-voltage detection function Operation stopped External interrupt Remark fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock fX: X1 oscillation clock fEXCLK: External main system clock fXT: XT1 oscillation clock fEXCLKS: External subsystem clock fRL: Internal low-speed oscillation clock User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 527 CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Table 18-2. Hardware Statuses After Reset Acknowledgment (1/3) Hardware After Reset Note 1 Acknowledgment Program counter (PC) The contents of the reset vector table (0000H, 0001H) are set. Stack pointer (SP) Undefined Program status word (PSW) 02H RAM Data memory Undefined Note 2 General-purpose registers Undefined Note 2 Port registers (P0, P1, P3, P4, P6 to P9, P12, P13) (output latches) 00H Port mode registers FFH PM0, PM1, PM3, PM4, PM6 to PM9, PM12 PM13 FEH Pull-up resistor option registers (PU0, PU1, PU3, PU4, PU7, PU12, PU13) 00H Internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS) 0CH Internal memory size switching register (IMS) CFH Processor clock control register (PCC) 01H Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) 00H Internal oscillator mode register (RCM) 00H Main clock mode register (MCM) 00H Main OSC control register (MOC) 80H Note 3 Note 3 Note 4 Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) 05H Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) 00H 16-bit timer/event counters 00, 01 Timer counters 00, 01 (TM00, TM01) 0000H Capture/compare registers 000, 001, 010, 011(CR000, CR001, CR010, CR011) 0000H Mode control registers 00, 01 (TMC00, TMC01) 00H Prescaler mode registers 00, 01 (PRM00, PRM01) 00H Capture/compare control registers 00, 01 (CRC00, CRC01) 00H Timer output control registers 00, 01 (TOC00, TOC01) 00H Notes 1. 2. 3. During reset signal generation or oscillation stabilization time wait, only the PC contents among the hardware statuses become undefined. All other hardware statuses remain unchanged after reset. When a reset is executed in the standby mode, the pre-reset status is held even after reset. The initial values of the internal memory size switching register (IMS) and internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS) after a reset release are constant (IMS = CFH, IXS = 0CH) in all the 78K0/FC2 products, regardless of the internal memory capacity. Therefore, after a reset is released, be sure to set the following values for each product. Flash Memory Version (78K0/FC2) 4. 528 IMS IXS PD78F0881, 78F0884 C8H 0AH PD78F0882, 78F0885 CCH 08H PD78F0883, 78F0886 CFH 08H The value of this register is 00H immediately after a reset release but automatically changes to 80H after internal high-speed oscillation has been stabilized. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Table 18-2. Hardware Statuses After Reset Acknowledgment (2/3) Status After Reset Hardware Acknowledgment 8-bit timer/event counters 50, 51 8-bit timers H0, H1 Timer counters 50, 51 (TM50, TM51) 00H Compare registers 50, 51 (CR50, CR51) 00H Timer clock selection registers 50, 51 (TCL50, TCL51) 00H Mode control registers 50, 51 (TMC50, TMC51) 00H Compare registers 00, 10, 01, 11 (CMP00, CMP10, CMP01, CMP11) 00H Mode registers (TMHMD0, TMHMD1) 00H Note 1 Carrier control register 1 (TMCYC1) 00H Watch timer Operation mode register (WTM) 00H Clock output/buzzer output controller Clock output selection register (CKS) 00H Watchdog timer Enable register (WDTE) 1AH/9AH A/D converter 10-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCR) 0000H 8-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCRH) 00H Mode register (ADM) 00H Analog input channel specification register (ADS) 00H A/D port configuration register (ADPC) 00H Serial interface UART60, Receive buffer register 60, 61 (RXB60, RXB61) FFH UART61 Transmit buffer register 60, 61 (TXB60, TXB61) FFH Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 60, 61 (ASIM60, 01H Note 2 ASIM61) Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60, 61 00H (ASIS60, ASIS61) Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 60, 61 (ASIF60, 00H ASIF61) Serial interfaces CSI10 Notes 1. Clock selection register 60, 61 (CKSR60, CKSR61) 00H Baud rate generator control register 60, 61 (BRGC60, BRGC61) FFH Asynchronous serial interface control register 60, 61 (ASICL60, ASICL61) 16H Input switch control register (ISC) 00H Transmit buffer registers 10 (SOTB10) 00H Serial I/O shift registers 10 (SIO10) 00H Serial operation mode registers 10 (CSIM10) 00H Serial clock selection registers 10 (CSIC10) 00H During reset signal generation or oscillation stabilization time wait, only the PC contents among the hardware statuses become undefined. All other hardware statuses remain unchanged after reset. 2. 8-bit timer H1 only. 3. The reset value of WDTE is determined by the option byte setting. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 529 CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Table 18-2. Hardware Statuses After Reset Acknowledgment (3/3) Status After Reset Hardware Acknowledgment Multiplier/divider Remainder data register 0 (SDR0) 0000H Multiplication/division data register A0 (MDA0H, MDA0L) 0000H Multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0) 0000H Multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) 00H Reset function Reset control flag register (RESF) 00H Low-voltage detector Low-voltage detection register (LVIM) 00H Low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS) 00H Request flag registers 0L, 0H, 1L, 1H (IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, IF1H) 00H Mask flag registers 0L, 0H, 1L, 1H (MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, MK1H) FFH Priority specification flag registers 0L, 0H, 1L, 1H (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, FFH Interrupt Note Note Note PR1H) External interrupt rising edge enable register (EGP) 00H External interrupt falling edge enable register (EGN) 00H Notes 1. During reset signal generation or oscillation stabilization time wait, only the PC contents among the hardware statuses become undefined. All other hardware statuses remain unchanged after reset. 2 These values vary depending on the reset source. Reset Source RESET Input Reset by POC Reset by WDT Reset by LVI Register RESF WDTRF bit Cleared (0) Cleared (0) LVIRF bit LVIM Cleared (00H) Cleared (00H) Set (1) Held Held Set (1) Cleared (00H) Held LVIS 530 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION 18.1 Register for Confirming Reset Source Many internal reset generation sources exist in the 78K0/FC2. The reset control flag register (RESF) is used to store which source has generated the reset request. RESF can be read by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. RESET input, reset input by power-on-clear (POC) circuit, and reading RESF clear RESF to 00H. Figure 18-5. Format of Reset Control Flag Register (RESF) Address: FFACH After reset: 00H Note R Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RESF 0 0 0 WDTRF 0 0 0 LVIRF WDTRF Internal reset request by watchdog timer (WDT) 0 Internal reset request is not generated, or RESF is cleared. 1 Internal reset request is generated. LVIRF Internal reset request by low-voltage detector (LVI) 0 Internal reset request is not generated, or RESF is cleared. 1 Internal reset request is generated. Note The value after reset varies depending on the reset source. Caution Do not read data by a 1-bit memory manipulation instruction. The status of RESF when a reset request is generated is shown in Table 18-3. Table 18-3. RESF Status When Reset Request Is Generated Reset Source RESET Input Reset by POC Reset by WDT Reset by LVI Flag WDTRF LVIRF Cleared (0) Cleared (0) Set (1) Held Held Set (1) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 531 CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER 19.1 Functions of Multiplier/Divider The multiplier/divider has the following functions. * 16 bits x 16 bits = 32 bits (multiplication) * 32 bits / 16 bits = 32 bits, 16-bit remainder (division) 19.2 Configuration of Multiplier/Divider The multiplier/divider includes the following hardware. Table 19-1. Configuration of Multiplier/Divider Item Registers Configuration Remainder data register 0 (SDR0) Multiplication/division data registers A0 (MDA0H, MDA0L) Multiplication/division data registers B0 (MDB0) Control register Multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) Figure 19-1 shows the block diagram of the multiplier/divider. 532 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Figure 19-1. Block Diagram of Multiplier/Divider Internal bus Multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) Remainder data register 0 (SDR0 (SDR0H + SDR0L) Multiplication/division data register A0 (MDA0H (MDA0HH + MDA0HL) + MDA0L (MDA0LH + MDA0LL) ) DMUSEL0 DMUE Start MDA000 INTDMU Clear Controller Controller 17-bit adder Controller 6-bit counter CPU clock CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0 (MDB0H + MDB0L) 533 CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER (1) Remainder data register 0 (SDR0) SDR0 is a 16-bit register that stores a remainder. This register stores 0 in the multiplication mode and the remainder of an operation result in the division mode. SDR0 can be read by an 8-bit or 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears SDR0 to 0000H. Figure 19-2. Format of Remainder Data Register 0 (SDR0) Address: FF44H, FF45H After reset: 0000H Symbol R FF45H (SDR0H) SDR0 Cautions 1. FF44H (SDR0L) SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR SDR 015 014 013 012 011 010 009 008 007 006 005 004 003 002 001 000 The value read from SDR0 during operation processing (while bit 7 (DMUE) of multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) is 1) is not guaranteed. 2. SDR0 is reset when the operation is started (when DMUE is set to 1). (2) Multiplication/division data register A0 (MDA0H, MDA0L) MDA0 is a 32-bit register that sets a 16-bit multiplier A in the multiplication mode and a 32-bit dividend in the division mode, and stores the 32-bit result of the operation (higher 16 bits: MDA0H, lower 16 bits: MDA0L). Figure 19-3. Format of Multiplication/Division Data Register A0 (MDA0H, MDA0L) Address: FF4AH, FF4BH, FF4CH, FF4DH Symbol After reset: 0000H, 0000H R/W FF4DH (MDA0HH) MDA0H FF4CH (MDA0HL) MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA 031 030 Symbol 029 028 027 026 025 024 023 022 021 FF4BH (MDA0LH) MDA0L 020 019 018 017 016 FF4AH (MDA0LL) MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA MDA 015 Cautions 1. 014 013 012 011 010 009 008 007 006 005 004 003 002 001 000 MDA0H is cleared to 0 when an operation is started in the multiplication mode (when multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) is set to 81H). 2. Do not change the value of MDA0 during operation processing (while bit 7 (DMUE) of multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) is 1). Even in this case, the operation is executed, but the result is undefined. 3. 534 The value read from MDA0 during operation processing (while DMUE is 1) is not guaranteed. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER The functions of MDA0 when an operation is executed are shown in the table below. Table 19-2. Functions of MDA0 During Operation Execution DMUSEL0 Operation Mode Setting Operation Result 0 Division mode Dividend Division result (quotient) 1 Multiplication mode Higher 16 bits: 0, Lower 16 bits: Multiplier A Multiplication result (product) The register configuration differs between when multiplication is executed and when division is executed, as follows. * Register configuration during multiplication MDA0 (bits 15 to 0) x MDB0 (bits 15 to 0) = MDA0 (bits 31 to 0) * Register configuration during division MDA0 (bits 31 to 0) / MDB0 (bits 15 to 0) = MDA0 (bits 31 to 0) ... SDR0 (bits 15 to 0) MDA0 fetches the calculation result as soon as the clock is input, when bit 7 (DMUE) of multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) is set to 1. MDA0H and MDA0L can be set by an 8-bit or 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears MDA0H and MDA0L to 0000H. (3) Multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0) MDB0 is a register that stores a 16-bit multiplier B in the multiplication mode and a 16-bit divisor in the division mode. MDB0 can be set by an 8-bit or 16-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears MDB0 to 0000H. Figure 19-4. Format of Multiplication/Division Data Register B0 (MDB0) Address: FFAEH, FFAFH After reset: 0000H Symbol R/W FFAFH (MDB0H) MDB0 FFAEH (MDB0L) MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB MDB 015 Cautions 1. 014 013 012 011 010 009 008 007 006 005 004 003 002 001 000 Do not change the value of MDB0 during operation processing (while bit 7 (DMUE) of multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) is 1). Even in this case, the operation is executed, but the result is undefined. 2. Do not clear MDB0 to 0000H in the division mode. If set, undefined operation results are stored in MDA0 and SDR0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 535 CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER 19.3 Register Controlling Multiplier/Divider The multiplier/divider is controlled by multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0). (1) Multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) DMUC0 is an 8-bit register that controls the operation of the multiplier/divider. DMUC0 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears DMUC0 to 00H. Figure 19-5. Format of Multiplier/Divider Control Register 0 (DMUC0) Address: FF42H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol <7> 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DMUC0 DMUE 0 0 0 0 0 0 DMUSEL0 DMUENote Operation start/stop 0 Stops operation 1 Starts operation DMUSEL0 Operation mode (multiplication/division) selection 0 Division mode 1 Multiplication mode Note When DMUE is set to 1, the operation is started. DMUE is automatically cleared to 0 after the operation is complete. Cautions 1. If DMUE is cleared to 0 during operation processing (when DMUE is 1), the operation result is not guaranteed. If the operation is completed while the clearing instruction is being executed, the operation result is guaranteed, provided that the interrupt flag is set. 2. Do not change the value of DMUSEL0 during operation processing (while DMUE is 1). If it is changed, undefined operation results are stored in multiplication/division data register A0 (MDA0) and remainder data register 0 (SDR0). 3. If DMUE is cleared to 0 during operation processing (while DMUE is 1), the operation processing is stopped. To execute the operation again, set multiplication/division data register A0 (MDA0), multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0), and multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0), and start the operation (by setting DMUE to 1). 536 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER 19.4 Operations of Multiplier/Divider 19.4.1 Multiplication operation * Initial setting 1. Set operation data to multiplication/division data register A0L (MDA0L) and multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0). 2. Set bits 0 (DMUSEL0) and 7 (DMUE) of multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) to 1. Operation will start. * During operation 3. The operation will be completed when 16 internal clocks have been issued after the start of the operation (intermediate data is stored in the MDA0L and MDA0H registers during operation, and therefore the read values of these registers are not guaranteed). * End of operation 4. The operation result data is stored in the MDA0L and MDA0H registers. 5. DMUE is cleared to 0 (end of operation). 6. After the operation, an interrupt request signal (INTDMU) is generated. * Next operation 7. To execute multiplication next, start from the initial setting in 19.4.1 Multiplication operation. 8. To execute division next, start from the initial setting in 19.4.2 Division operation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 537 538 Figure 19-6. Timing Chart of Multiplication Operation (00DAH x 0093H) Operation clock DMUE DMUSEL0 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 Counter XXXX SDR0 MDA0 XXXX XXXX MDB0 XXXX INTDMU XXXX 00DA 0093 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F 10 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 00DA 0000 0049 0024 005B 0077 003B 0067 007D 003E 001F 000F 0007 0003 0001 0000 0000 006D 8036 C01B E00D 7006 B803 5C01 2E00 9700 4B80 A5C0 D2E0 E970 F4B8 FA5C 7D2E 0 CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER Internal clock CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER 19.4.2 Division operation * Initial setting 1. Set operation data to multiplication/division data register A0 (MDA0L and MDA0H) and multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0). 2. Set bits 0 (DMUSEL0) and 7 (DMUE) of multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) to 0 and 1, respectively. Operation will start. * During operation 3. The operation will be completed when 32 internal clocks have been issued after the start of the operation (intermediate data is stored in the MDA0L and MDA0H registers and remainder data register 0 (SDR0) during operation, and therefore the read values of these registers are not guaranteed). * End of operation 4. The result data is stored in the MDA0L, MDA0H, and SDR0 registers. 5. DMUE is cleared to 0 (end of operation). 6. After the operation, an interrupt request signal (INTDMU) is generated. * Next operation 7. To execute multiplication next, start from the initial setting in 19.4.1 Multiplication operation. 8. To execute division next, start from the initial setting in 19.4.2 Division operation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 539 540 Figure 19-7. Timing Chart of Division Operation (DCBA2586H / 0018H) Operation clock DMUE DMUSEL0 "0" User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 Counter XXXX SDR0 0000 MDA0 XXXX XXXX DCBA 2586 MDB0 XXXX 0018 INTDMU 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F 20 0001 0003 0006 000D 0003 0007 000E 0004 000B 0016 0014 0010 0008 0011 000B 0016 B974 72E8 E5D1 CBA2 A744 2E89 6D12 BA25 4B0C A618 2C30 6860 BAC1 6182 C304 8609 0C12 1824 3049 6093 C126 824C 0499 0932 64D8 C9B0 9361 26C3 4D87 9B0E 361D 6C3A 0 CHAPTER 19 MULTIPLIER/DIVIDER Internal clock CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT 20.1 Functions of Power-on-Clear Circuit The power-on-clear circuit (POC) has the following functions. * Generates internal reset signal at power on. In the 1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 0), the reset signal is released when the supply voltage (VDD) exceeds 1.59 V 0.15 V. In the 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 1), the reset signal is released when the supply voltage (VDD) exceeds 2.7 V 0.2 V. * Compares supply voltage (VDD) and detection voltage (VPOC = 1.59 V 0.15 V), generates internal reset signal when VDD < VPOC. Caution If an internal reset signal is generated in the POC circuit, the reset control flag register (RESF) is cleared to 00H. Remark The 78K0/FC2 incorporates multiple hardware functions that generate an internal reset signal. A flag that indicates the reset cause is located in the reset control flag register (RESF) for when an internal reset signal is generated by the watchdog timer (WDT) or low-voltage-detector (LVI). RESF is not cleared to 00H and the flag is set to 1 when an internal reset signal is generated by WDT or LVI. For details of RESF, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 541 CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT 20.2 Configuration of Power-on-Clear Circuit The block diagram of the power-on-clear circuit is shown in Figure 20-1. Figure 20-1. Block Diagram of Power-on-Clear Circuit VDD VDD + Internal reset signal - Reference voltage source 20.3 Operation of Power-on-Clear Circuit (1) In 1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 0) * An internal reset signal is generated on power application. When the supply voltage (VDD) exceeds the detection voltage (VPOC = 1.59 V 0.15 V), the reset status is released. * The supply voltage (VDD) and detection voltage (VPOC = 1.59 V 0.15 V) are compared. When VDD < VPOC, the internal reset signal is generated. It is released when VDD VPOC. (2) In 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 1) * An internal reset signal is generated on power application. When the supply voltage (VDD) exceeds the detection voltage (VDDPOC = 2.7 V 0.2 V), the reset status is released. * The supply voltage (VDD) and detection voltage (VPOC = 1.59 V 0.15 V) are compared. When VDD < VPOC, the internal reset signal is generated. It is released when VDD VDDPOC. The timing of generation of the internal reset signal by the power-on-clear circuit and low-voltage detector is shown below. 542 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT Figure 20-2. Timing of Generation of Internal Reset Signal by Power-on-Clear Circuit and Low-Voltage Detector (1/2) (1) In 1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 0) Set LVI to be used for reset Set LVI to be used for interrupt Set LVI to be used for reset Supply voltage (VDD) VLVI 1.8 VNote 1 VPOC = 1.59 V (TYP.) 0.5 V/ms (MIN.)Note 2 0V Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Note 3 Note 3 Internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) Starting oscillation is specified by software. High-speed system clock (fXH) (when X1 oscillation is selected) Operation CPU stops Wait for voltage stabilization (1.93 to 5.39 ms) Starting oscillation is specified by software. Normal operation Reset period (internal high-speed (oscillation oscillation clock)Note 4 stop) Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Starting oscillation is specified by software. Normal operation Reset period Wait for voltage (internal high-speed (oscillation stabilization oscillation clock)Note 4 stop) (1.93 to 5.39 ms) Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock)Note 4 Operation stops Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Internal reset signal Notes 1. The operation guaranteed range is 1.8 V VDD 5.5 V. To make the state at lower than 1.8 V reset state when the supply voltage falls, use the reset function of the low-voltage detector, or input the low level to the RESET pin. 2. If the voltage rises to 1.8 V at a rate slower than 0.5 V/ms (MIN.) on power application, input a low level to the RESET pin after power application and before the voltage reaches 1.8 V, or set the 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode by using an option byte (LVISTART = 1). 3. The internal voltage stabilization time includes the oscillation accuracy stabilization time of the internal high-speed oscillation clock. 4. The internal high-speed oscillation clock and a high-speed system clock or subsystem clock can be selected as the CPU clock. To use the X1 clock, use the OSTC register to confirm the lapse of the oscillation stabilization time. To use the XT1 clock, use the timer function for confirmation of the lapse of the stabilization time. Caution Set the low-voltage detector by software after the reset status is released (see CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR). Remark VLVI : LVI detection voltage VPOC : POC detection voltage User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 543 CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT Figure 20-2. Timing of Generation of Internal Reset Signal by Power-on-Clear Circuit and Low-Voltage Detector (2/2) (2) In 2.7 V / 1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 1) Set LVI to be used for reset Set LVI to be used for interrupt Set LVI to be used for reset Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Supply voltage (VDD) VLVI VDDPOC = 2.7 V (TYP.) 1.8 VNote 1 VPOC = 1.59 V (TYP.) 0V Wait for oscillation accuracy stabilization (86 to 361 s) Internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) Starting oscillation is specified by software. High-speed system clock (fXH) (when X1 oscillation is selected) CPU Operation stops Normal operation Reset period (internal high-speed (oscillation stop) oscillation clock)Note 2 Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Starting oscillation is specified by software. Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock)Note 2 Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Reset period (oscillation stop) Starting oscillation is specified by software. Normal operation (internal high-speed oscillation clock)Note 2 Operation stops Reset processing (11 to 45 s) Internal reset signal Notes 1. The operation guaranteed range is 1.8 V VDD 5.5 V. To make the state at lower than 1.8 V reset state when the supply voltage falls, use the reset function of the low-voltage detector, or input the low level to the RESET pin. 2. The internal high-speed oscillation clock and a high-speed system clock or subsystem clock can be selected as the CPU clock. To use the X1 clock, use the OSTC register to confirm the lapse of the oscillation stabilization time. To use the XT1 clock, use the timer function for confirmation of the lapse of the stabilization time. Cautions 1. Set the low-voltage detector by software after the reset status is released (see CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR). 2. A voltage oscillation stabilization time of 1.93 to 5.39 ms is required after the supply voltage reaches 1.59 V (TYP.). If the supply voltage rises from 1.59 V (TYP.) to 2.7 V (TYP.) within 1.93 ms, the power supply oscillation stabilization time of 0 to 5.39 ms is automatically generated before reset processing. Remark 544 VLVI : LVI detection voltage VPOC : POC detection voltage User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT 20.4 Cautions for Power-on-Clear Circuit In a system where the supply voltage (VDD) fluctuates for a certain period in the vicinity of the POC detection voltage (VPOC), the system may be repeatedly reset and released from the reset status. In this case, the time from release of reset to the start of the operation of the microcontroller can be arbitrarily set by taking the following action. After releasing the reset signal, wait for the supply voltage fluctuation period of each system by means of a software counter that uses a timer, and then initialize the ports. Figure 20-3. Example of Software Processing After Reset Release (1/2) * If supply voltage fluctuation is 50 ms or less in vicinity of POC detection voltage Reset Initialization processing <1> ; Check the reset sourceNote 2 Initialize the port. Power-on-clear ; fPRS = Internal high-speed oscillation clock (8.4 MHz (MAX.)) (default) Source: fPRS (8.4 MHz (MAX.))/212, where comparison value = 102: 50 ms Timer starts (TMHE1 = 1). Setting 8-bit timer H1 (to measure 50 ms) Clearing WDT Note 1 No 50 ms has passed? (TMIFH1 = 1?) Yes ; Setting of division ratio of system clock, such as setting of timer or A/D converter Initialization processing <2> Notes 1. 2. If reset is generated again during this period, initialization processing <2> is not started. A flowchart is shown on the next page. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 545 CHAPTER 20 POWER-ON-CLEAR CIRCUIT Figure 20-3. Example of Software Processing After Release of Reset (2/2) * Checking reset cause Check reset cause WDTRF of RESF register = 1? Yes No Reset processing by watchdog timer LVIRF of RESF register = 1? Yes No Reset processing by low-voltage detector Power-on-clear/external reset generated 546 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR 21.1 Functions of Low-Voltage Detector The low-voltage detector (LVI) has the following functions. * The LVI circuit compares the supply voltage (VDD) with the detection voltage (VLVI) or the input voltage from an external input pin (EXLVI) with the detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.): fixed), and generates an internal reset or internal interrupt signal. * The supply voltage (VDD) or input voltage from an external input pin (EXLVI) can be selected by software. * Reset or interrupt function can be selected by software. * Detection levels (16 levels) of supply voltage can be changed by software. * Operable in STOP mode. The reset and interrupt signals are generated as follows depending on selection by software. Selection of Level Detection of Supply Voltage (VDD) Selection Level Detection of Input Voltage from (LVISEL = 0) External Input Pin (EXLVI) (LVISEL = 1) Selects reset (LVIMD = 1). Selects interrupt (LVIMD = 0). Selects reset (LVIMD = 1). Selects interrupt (LVIMD = 0). Generates an internal reset Generates an internal interrupt Generates an internal reset Generates an internal interrupt signal when VDD < VLVI and signal when VDD drops lower signal when EXLVI < VEXLVI signal when EXLVI drops releases the reset signal when than VLVI (VDD < VLVI) or when and releases the reset signal lower than VEXLVI (EXLVI < VDD VLVI. VDD becomes VLVI or higher when EXLVI VEXLVI. (VDD VLVI). VEXLVI) or when EXLVI becomes VEXLVI or higher (EXLVI VEXLVI). Remark LVISEL: Bit 2 of low-voltage detection register (LVIM) LVIMD: Bit 1 of LVIM While the low-voltage detector is operating, whether the supply voltage or the input voltage from an external input pin is more than or less than the detection level can be checked by reading the low-voltage detection flag (LVIF: bit 0 of LVIM). When the low-voltage detector is used to reset, bit 0 (LVIRF) of the reset control flag register (RESF) is set to 1 if reset occurs. For details of RESF, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 547 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR 21.2 Configuration of Low-Voltage Detector The block diagram of the low-voltage detector is shown in Figure 21-1. Figure 21-1. Block Diagram of Low-Voltage Detector VDD N-ch Internal reset signal Selector EXLVI/P120/ INTP0 + Selector Low-voltage detection level selector VDD - INTLVI Reference voltage source 4 LVION LVISEL LVIMD LVIS3 LVIS2 LVIS1 LVIS0 Low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS) Low-voltage detection register (LVIM) Internal bus 21.3 Registers Controlling Low-Voltage Detector The low-voltage detector is controlled by the following registers. * Low-voltage detection register (LVIM) * Low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS) * Port mode register 12 (PM12) 548 LVIF User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR (1) Low-voltage detection register (LVIM) This register sets low-voltage detection and the operation mode. This register can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears LVIM to 00H. Figure 21-2. Format of Low-Voltage Detection Register (LVIM) Address: FFBEH After reset: 00H R/WNote 1 Symbol <7> 6 5 4 3 <2> <1> <0> LVIM LVION 0 0 0 0 LVISEL LVIMD LVIF Notes 2, 3 LVION Enables low-voltage detection operation 0 Disables operation 1 Enables operation Note 2 LVISEL Voltage detection selection 0 Detects level of supply voltage (VDD) 1 Detects level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) Note 2 LVIMD Low-voltage detection operation mode (interrupt/reset) selection * LVISEL = 0: Generates an internal interrupt signal when the supply voltage (VDD) drops 0 lower than the detection voltage (VLVI) (VDD < VLVI) or when VDD becomes VLVI or higher (VDD VLVI). * LVISEL = 1: Generates an interrupt signal when the input voltage from an external input pin (EXLVI) drops lower than the detection voltage (VEXLVI) (EXLVI < VEXLVI) or when EXLVI becomes VEXLVI or higher (EXLVI VEXLVI). * LVISEL = 0: Generates an internal reset signal when the supply voltage (VDD) < 1 detection voltage (VLVI) and releases the reset signal when VDD VLVI. * LVISEL = 1: Generates an internal reset signal when the input voltage from an external input pin (EXLVI) < detection voltage (VEXLVI) and releases the reset signal when EXLVI VEXLVI. Note 4 LVIF Low-voltage detection flag 0 * LVISEL = 0: Supply voltage (VDD) detection voltage (VLVI), or when operation is disabled * LVISEL = 1: Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) detection voltage (VEXLVI), or when operation is disabled 1 * LVISEL = 0: Supply voltage (VDD) < detection voltage (VLVI) * LVISEL = 1: Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) < detection voltage (VEXLVI) Notes 1. Bit 0 is read-only. 2. LVION, LVIMD, and LVISEL are cleared to 0 in the case of a reset other than an LVI reset. 3. When LVION is set to 1, operation of the comparator in the LVI circuit is started. These are not cleared to 0 in the case of an LVI reset. Use software to wait for an operation stabilization time and minimum pulse width (10 s (MAX.)) when LVION is set to 1 until the voltage is confirmed at LVIF. 4. The value of LVIF is output as the interrupt request signal INTLVI when LVION = 1 and LVIMD = 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 549 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Cautions 1. To stop LVI, follow either of the procedures below. * When using 8-bit memory manipulation instruction: Write 00H to LVIM. * When using 1-bit memory manipulation instruction: Clear LVION to 0. 2. Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) must be EXLVI < VDD. (2) Low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS) This register selects the low-voltage detection level. This register can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears LVIS to 00H. Figure 21-3. Format of Low-Voltage Detection Level Selection Register (LVIS) Address: FFBFH After reset: 00H R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LVIS 0 0 0 0 LVIS3 LVIS2 LVIS1 LVIS0 LVIS3 LVIS2 LVIS1 LVIS0 0 0 0 0 VLVI0 (4.24 V 0.1 V) 0 0 0 1 VLVI1 (4.09 V 0.1 V) 0 0 1 0 VLVI2 (3.93 V 0.1 V) 0 0 1 1 VLVI3 (3.78 V 0.1 V) 0 1 0 0 VLVI4 (3.62 V 0.1 V) 0 1 0 1 VLVI5 (3.47 V 0.1 V) 0 1 1 0 VLVI6 (3.32 V 0.1 V) 0 1 1 1 VLVI7 (3.16 V 0.1 V) 1 0 0 0 VLVI8 (3.01 V 0.1 V) 1 0 0 1 VLVI9 (2.85 V 0.1 V) 1 0 1 0 VLVI10 (2.70 V 0.1 V) 1 0 1 1 VLVI11 (2.55 V 0.1 V) 1 1 0 0 VLVI12 (2.39 V 0.1 V) 1 1 0 1 VLVI13 (2.24 V 0.1 V) 1 1 1 0 VLVI14 (2.08 V 0.1 V) 1 1 1 1 VLVI15 (1.93 V 0.1 V) Detection level Cautions 1. Be sure to clear bits 4 to 7 to 0. 2. Do not change the value of LVIS during LVI operation. 3. When an input voltage from the external input pin (EXLVI) is detected, the detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.)) is fixed. Therefore, setting of LVIS is not necessary. 550 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR (3) Port mode register 12 (PM12) When using the P120/EXLVI/INTP0 pin for external low-voltage detection potential input, set PM120 to 1. At this time, the output latch of P120 may be 0 or 1. PM12 can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets PM12 to FFH. Figure 21-4. Format of Port Mode Register 12 (PM12) Address: FF2CH After reset: FFH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM12 1 1 1 PM124 PM123 PM122 PM121 PM120 PM12n P12n pin I/O mode selection (n = 0 to 4) 0 Output mode (output buffer on) 1 Input mode (output buffer off) 21.4 Operation of Low-Voltage Detector The low-voltage detector can be used in the following two modes. (1) Used as reset (LVIMD = 1) * If LVISEL = 0, compares the supply voltage (VDD) and detection voltage (VLVI), generates an internal reset signal when VDD < VLVI, and releases internal reset when VDD VLVI. * If LVISEL = 1, compares the input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) and detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.)), generates an internal reset signal when EXLVI < VEXLVI, and releases internal reset when EXLVI VEXLVI. (2) Used as interrupt (LVIMD = 0) * If LVISEL = 0, compares the supply voltage (VDD) and detection voltage (VLVI). When VDD drops lower than VLVI (VDD < VLVI) or when VDD becomes VLVI or higher (VDD VLVI), generates an interrupt signal (INTLVI). * If LVISEL = 1, compares the input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) and detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.)). When EXLVI drops lower than VEXLVI (EXLVI < VEXLVI) or when EXLVI becomes VEXLVI or higher (EXLVI VEXLVI), generates an interrupt signal (INTLVI). While the low-voltage detector is operating, whether the supply voltage or the input voltage from an external input pin is more than or less than the detection level can be checked by reading the low-voltage detection flag (LVIF: bit 0 of LVIM). Remark LVIMD: Bit 1 of low-voltage detection register (LVIM) LVISEL: Bit 2 of LVIM User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 551 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR 21.4.1 When used as reset (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD) * When starting operation <1> Mask the LVI interrupt (LVIMK = 1). <2> Clear bit 2 (LVISEL) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM) to 0 (detects level of supply voltage (VDD)) (default value). <3> Set the detection voltage using bits 3 to 0 (LVIS3 to LVIS0) of the low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS). <4> Set bit 7 (LVION) of LVIM to 1 (enables LVI operation). <5> Use software to wait for an operation stabilization time and minimum pulse width (10 s (MAX.)). <6> Wait until it is checked that (supply voltage (VDD) detection voltage (VLVI)) by bit 0 (LVIF) of LVIM. <7> Set bit 1 (LVIMD) of LVIM to 1 (generates reset when the level is detected). Figure 21-5 shows the timing of the internal reset signal generated by the low-voltage detector. The numbers in this timing chart correspond to <1> to <7> above. Cautions 1. <1> must always be executed. When LVIMK = 0, an interrupt may occur immediately after the processing in <4>. 2. If supply voltage (VDD) detection voltage (VLVI) when LVIMD is set to 1, an internal reset signal is not generated. * When stopping operation Either of the following procedures must be executed. * When using 8-bit memory manipulation instruction: Write 00H to LVIM. * When using 1-bit memory manipulation instruction: Clear LVIMD to 0 and then LVION to 0. 552 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-5. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Internal Reset Signal Generation (Detects Level of Supply Voltage (VDD)) (1/2) (1) In 1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 0) Supply voltage (VDD) VLVI VPOC = 1.59 V (TYP.) Time LVIMK flag Note1 (set by software) H LVISEL flag (set by software) LVION flag (set by software) <1> <3> L <2> Not cleared Not cleared <4> Clear <5>Wait time LVIF flag <6> LVIMD flag (set by software) Clear Note2 Not cleared Not cleared <7> Clear LVIRF flagNote 3 LVI reset signal Cleared by software Cleared by software POC reset signal Internalreset signal Notes 1. The LVIMK flag is set to "1" by reset signal generation. 2. The LVIF flag may be set (1). 3. LVIRF is bit 0 of the reset control flag register (RESF). For details of RESF, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. Remark <1> to <7> in Figure 21-5 above correspond to <1> to <7> in the description of "When starting operation" in 21.4.1 (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 553 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-5. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Internal Reset Signal Generation (Detects Level of Supply Voltage (VDD)) (2/2) (2) In 2.7/1.59 V POC mode (option byte: LVISTART = 1) Supply voltage (VDD) VLVI 2.7 V (TYP.) VPOC = 1.59 V (TYP.) Time LVIMK flag (set by software) HNote 1 LVISEL flag (set by software) L LVION flag (set by software) <1> <3> <2> Not cleared Not cleared <4> Clear <5>Wait time LVIF flag <6> LVIMD flag (set by software) Clear Note 2 Not cleared Not cleared <7> Clear LVIRF flagNote 3 LVI reset signal Cleared by software Cleared by software POC reset signal Internal reset signal Notes 1. The LVIMK flag is set to "1" by reset signal generation. 2. The LVIF flag may be set (1). 3. LVIRF is bit 0 of the reset control flag register (RESF). For details of RESF, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. Remark <1> to <7> in Figure 21-5 above correspond to <1> to <7> in the description of "When starting operation" in 21.4.1 (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD). 554 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR (2) When detecting level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) * When starting operation <1> Mask the LVI interrupt (LVIMK = 1). <2> Set bit 2 (LVISEL) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM) to 1 (detects level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI)). <3> Set bit 7 (LVION) of LVIM to 1 (enables LVI operation). <4> Use software to wait for an operation stabilization time and minimum pulse width (10 s (MAX.)). <5> Wait until it is checked that (input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.))) by bit 0 (LVIF) of LVIM. <6> Set bit 1 (LVIMD) of LVIM to 1 (generates reset signal when the level is detected). Figure 21-6 shows the timing of the internal reset signal generated by the low-voltage detector. The numbers in this timing chart correspond to <1> to <6> above. Cautions 1. <1> must always be executed. When LVIMK = 0, an interrupt may occur immediately after the processing in <3>. 2. If input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.)) when LVIMD is set to 1, an internal reset signal is not generated. 3. Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) must be EXLVI < VDD. * When stopping operation Either of the following procedures must be executed. * When using 8-bit memory manipulation instruction: Write 00H to LVIM. * When using 1-bit memory manipulation instruction: Clear LVIMD to 0 and then LVION to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 555 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-6. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Internal Reset Signal Generation (Detects Level of Input Voltage from External Input Pin (EXLVI)) Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) LVI detection voltage (VEXLVI) Time LVIMK flag (set by software) LVISEL flag (set by software) HNote 1 <1> Not cleared Not cleared Not cleared Not cleared Not cleared Not cleared Not cleared Not cleared <2> LVION flag (set by software) <3> <4> Wait time LVIF flag <5> LVIMD flag (set by software) Note 2 Not cleared <6> LVIRF flagNote 3 LVI reset signal Cleared by software Cleared by software Internal reset signal Notes 1. The LVIMK flag is set to "1" by reset signal generation. 2. The LVIF flag may be set (1). 3. LVIRF is bit 0 of the reset control flag register (RESF). For details of RESF, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. Remark <1> to <6> in Figure 21-6 above correspond to <1> to <6> in the description of "When starting operation" in 21.4.1 (2) When detecting level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI). 556 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR 21.4.2 When used as interrupt (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD) * When starting operation <1> Mask the LVI interrupt (LVIMK = 1). <2> Clear bit 2 (LVISEL) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM) to 0 (detects level of supply voltage (VDD)) (default value). <3> Set the detection voltage using bits 3 to 0 (LVIS3 to LVIS0) of the low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS). <4> Set bit 7 (LVION) of LVIM to 1 (enables LVI operation). <5> Use software to wait for an operation stabilization time and minimum pulse width (10 s (MAX.)). <6> Confirm that "supply voltage (VDD) detection voltage (VLVI)" when detecting the falling edge of VDD, or "supply voltage (VDD) < detection voltage (VLVI)" when detecting the rising edge of VDD, at bit 0 (LVIF) of LVIM. <7> Clear the interrupt request flag of LVI (LVIIF) to 0. <8> Release the interrupt mask flag of LVI (LVIMK). <9> Clear bit 1 (LVIMD) of LVIM to 0 (generates interrupt signal when the level is detected) (default value). <10> Execute the EI instruction (when vector interrupts are used). Figure 21-7 shows the timing of the interrupt signal generated by the low-voltage detector. The numbers in this timing chart correspond to <1> to <9> above. * When stopping operation Either of the following procedures must be executed. * When using 8-bit memory manipulation instruction: Write 00H to LVIM. * When using 1-bit memory manipulation instruction: Clear LVION to 0. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 557 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-7. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Interrupt Signal Generation (Detects Level of Supply Voltage (VDD)) (1/2) (1) In 1.59 V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 0) Supply voltage (VDD) VLVI VPOC = 1.59 V (TYP.) Time LVIMK flag (set by software) <1> Note 1 LVISEL flag (set by software) <8> Cleared by software <3> L LVION flag (set by software) <2> <4> <5> Wait time LVIF flag <6> Note 2 INTLVI Note 2 LVIIF flag Note 2 LVIMD flag (set by software) L <7> Cleared by software <9> Internal reset signal Notes 1. 2. Remark The LVIMK flag is set to "1" by reset signal generation. The interrupt request signal (INTLVI) is generated and the LVIF and LVIIF flags may be set (1). <1> to <9> in Figure 21-7 above correspond to <1> to <9> in the description of "When starting operation" in 21.4.2 (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD). 558 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-7. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Interrupt Signal Generation (Detects Level of Supply Voltage (VDD)) (2/2) (2) In 2.7/1.59 V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 1) Supply voltage (VDD) VLVI 2.7 V(TYP.) VPOC = 1.59 V (TYP.) Time LVIMK flag (set by software) <1> Note 1 LVISEL flag (set by software) <8> Cleared by software <3> L <2> LVION flag (set by software) <4> <5> Wait time LVIF flag <6> Note 2 INTLVI Note 2 LVIIF flag LVIMD flag (set by software) Note 2 <7> Cleared by software L <9> Internal reset signal Notes 1. 2. Remark The LVIMK flag is set to "1" by reset signal generation. The interrupt request signal (INTLVI) is generated and the LVIF and LVIIF flags may be set (1). <1> to <9> in Figure 21-7 above correspond to <1> to <9> in the description of "When starting operation" in 21.4.2 (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 559 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR (2) When detecting level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) * When starting operation <1> Mask the LVI interrupt (LVIMK = 1). <2> Set bit 2 (LVISEL) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM) to 1 (detects level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI)). <3> Set bit 7 (LVION) of LVIM to 1 (enables LVI operation). <4> Use software to wait for an operation stabilization time and minimum pulse width (10 s (MAX.)). <5> Confirm that "input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.)" when detecting the falling edge of EXLVI, or "input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) < detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V (TYP.))" when detecting the rising edge of EXLVI, at bit 0 (LVIF) of LVIM. <6> Clear the interrupt request flag of LVI (LVIIF) to 0. <7> Release the interrupt mask flag of LVI (LVIMK). <8> Clear bit 1 (LVIMD) of LVIM to 0 (generates interrupt signal when the level is detected) (default value). <9> Execute the EI instruction (when vector interrupts are used). Figure 21-8 shows the timing of the interrupt signal generated by the low-voltage detector. The numbers in this timing chart correspond to <1> to <8> above. Caution Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) must be EXLVI < VDD. * When stopping operation Either of the following procedures must be executed. * When using 8-bit memory manipulation instruction: Write 00H to LVIM. * When using 1-bit memory manipulation instruction: Clear LVION to 0. 560 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-8. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Interrupt Signal Generation (Detects Level of Input Voltage from External Input Pin (EXLVI)) Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) VEXLVI Time LVIMK flag (set by software) <1> Note 1 <7> Cleared by software LVISEL flag (set by software) LVION flag (set by software) <2> <3> <4> Wait time LVIF flag <5> Note 2 INTLVI Note 2 LVIIF flag Note 2 LVIMD flag (set by software) L <6> Cleared by software <8> Notes 1. 2. Remark The LVIMK flag is set to "1" by reset signal generation. The interrupt request signal (INTLVI) is generated and the LVIF and LVIIF flags may be set (1). <1> to <8> in Figure 21-8 above correspond to <1> to <8> in the description of "When starting operation" in 21.4.2 (2) When detecting level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 561 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR 21.5 Cautions for Low-Voltage Detector In a system where the supply voltage (VDD) fluctuates for a certain period in the vicinity of the LVI detection voltage (VLVI), the operation is as follows depending on how the low-voltage detector is used. (1) When used as reset The system may be repeatedly reset and released from the reset status. In this case, the time from release of reset to the start of the operation of the microcontroller can be arbitrarily set by taking action (1) below. (2) When used as interrupt Interrupt requests may be frequently generated. Take (b) of action (2) below. (1) When used as reset After releasing the reset signal, wait for the supply voltage fluctuation period of each system by means of a software counter that uses a timer, and then initialize the ports (see Figure 21-9). (2) When used as interrupt (a) Confirm that "supply voltage (VDD) detection voltage (VLVI)" when detecting the falling edge of VDD, or "supply voltage (VDD) < detection voltage (VLVI)" when detecting the rising edge of VDD, in the servicing routine of the LVI interrupt by using bit 0 (LVIF) of the low-voltage detection register (LVIM). Clear bit 0 (LVIIF) of interrupt request flag register 0L (IF0L) to 0. (b) In a system where the supply voltage fluctuation period is long in the vicinity of the LVI detection voltage, wait for the supply voltage fluctuation period, confirm that "supply voltage (VDD) detection voltage (VLVI)" when detecting the falling edge of VDD, or "supply voltage (VDD) < detection voltage (VLVI)" when detecting the rising edge of VDD, using the LVIF flag, and clear the LVIIF flag to 0. Remark If bit 2 (LVISEL) of the low voltage detection register (LVIM) is set to "1", the meanings of the above words change as follows. 562 * Supply voltage (VDD) Input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) * Detection voltage (VLVI) Detection voltage (VEXLVI = 1.21 V) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-9. Example of Software Processing After Reset Release (1/2) * If supply voltage fluctuation is 50 ms or less in vicinity of LVI detection voltage Reset ; Check the reset sourceNote Initialize the port. Initialization processing <1> LVI reset ; Setting of detection level by LVIS The low-voltage detector operates (LVION = 1). Setting LVI ; fPRS = Internal high-speed oscillation clock (8.4 MHz (MAX.)) (default) Source: fPRS (8.4 MHz (MAX.))/212, Where comparison value = 102: 50 ms Timer starts (TMHE1 = 1). Setting 8-bit timer H1 (to measure 50 ms) Clearing WDT Detection voltage or higher (LVIF = 0?) Yes No LVIF = 0 Restarting timer H1 (TMHE1 = 0 TMHE1 = 1) No ; The low-voltage detection flag is cleared. ; The timer counter is cleared and the timer is started. 50 ms has passed? (TMIFH1 = 1?) Yes Initialization processing <2> Note ; Setting of division ratio of system clock, such as setting of timer or A/D converter A flowchart is shown on the next page. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 563 CHAPTER 21 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECTOR Figure 21-9. Example of Software Processing After Reset Release (2/2) * Checking reset cause Check reset cause WDTRF of RESF register = 1? Yes No Reset processing by watchdog timer LVIRF of RESF register = 1? No Yes Power-on-clear/external reset generated Reset processing by low-voltage detector 564 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE 22.1 Functions of Option Bytes The flash memory at 0080H to 0084H of the 78K0/FC2 is an option byte area. When power is turned on or when the device is restarted from the reset status, the device automatically references the option bytes and sets specified functions. When using the product, be sure to set the following functions by using the option bytes. When the boot swap operation is used during self-programming, 0080H to 0084H are switched to 1080H to 1084H. Therefore, set values that are the same as those of 0080H to 0084H to 1080H to 1084H in advance. Caution Be sure to set 00H to 0082H and 0083H (0082H/1082H and 0083H/1083H when the boot swap function is used). (1) 0080H/1080H { Internal low-speed oscillator operation * Can be stopped by software * Cannot be stopped { Watchdog timer interval time setting { Watchdog timer counter operation * Enabled counter operation * Disabled counter operation { Watchdog timer window open period setting Caution Set a value that is the same as that of 0080H to 1080H because 0080H and 1080H are switched during the boot swap operation. (2) 0081H/1081H { Selecting POC mode * During 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode operation (LVISTART = 1) The device is in the reset state upon power application and until the supply voltage reaches 2.7 V (TYP.). It is released from the reset state when the voltage exceeds 2.7 V (TYP.). After that, POC is not detected at 2.7 V but is detected at 1.59 V (TYP.). If the supply voltage rises to 1.8 V after power application at a pace slower than 0.5 V/ms (MIN.), use of the 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode is recommended. * During 1.59 V POC mode operation (LVISTART = 0) The device is in the reset state upon power application and until the supply voltage reaches 1.59 V (TYP.). It is released from the reset state when the voltage exceeds 1.59 V (TYP.). After that, POC is detected at 1.59 V (TYP.), in the same manner as on power application. Caution LVISTART can only be written by using a dedicated flash memory programmer. It cannot be set during self-programming or boot swap operation during self-programming (at this time, 1.59 V POC mode (default) is set). However, because the value of 1081H is copied to 0081H during the boot swap operation, it is recommended to set a value that is the same as that of 0081H to 1081H when the boot swap function is used. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 565 CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE (3) 0084H/1084H { On-chip debug operation control * Disabling on-chip debug operation * Enabling on-chip debug operation and erasing data of the flash memory in case authentication of the onchip debug security ID fails * Enabling on-chip debug operation and not erasing data of the flash memory even in case authentication of the on-chip debug security ID fails Caution To use the on-chip debug function, set 02H or 03H to 0084H. Set a value that is the same as that of 0084H to 1084H because 0084H and 1084H are switched during the boot operation. 566 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE 22.2 Format of Option Byte The format of the option byte is shown below. Figure 22-1. Format of Option Byte (1/2) Note Address: 0080H/1080H 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 WINDOW1 WINDOW0 WDTON WDCS2 WDCS1 WDCS0 LSROSC WINDOW1 WINDOW0 0 0 25% 0 1 50% 1 0 75% 1 1 100% WDTON Watchdog timer window open period Operation control of watchdog timer counter/illegal access detection 0 Counter operation disabled (counting stopped after reset), illegal access detection operation disabled 1 Counter operation enabled (counting started after reset), illegal access detection operation enabled WDCS2 WDCS1 WDCS0 Watchdog timer overflow time 10 0 0 0 2 /fRL (3.88 ms) 0 0 1 2 /fRL (7.76 ms) 0 1 0 2 /fRL (15.52 ms) 0 1 1 2 /fRL (31.03 ms) 1 0 0 2 /fRL (62.06 ms) 1 0 1 2 /fRL (124.12 ms) 1 1 0 2 /fRL (248.24 ms) 1 1 1 2 /fRL (496.48 ms) LSROSC 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 Internal low-speed oscillator operation 0 Can be stopped by software (stopped when 1 is written to bit 0 (LSRSTOP) of RCM register) 1 Cannot be stopped (not stopped even if 1 is written to LSRSTOP bit) Note Set a value that is the same as that of 0080H to 1080H because 0080H and 1080H are switched during the boot swap operation. Cautions 1. The combination of WDCS2 = WDCS1 = WDCS0 = 0 and WINDOW1 = WINDOW0 = 0 is prohibited. 2. The watchdog timer continues its operation during self-programming and EEPROM emulation of the flash memory. During processing, the interrupt acknowledge time is delayed. Set the overflow time and window size taking this delay into consideration. 3. If LSROSC = 0 (oscillation can be stopped by software), the count clock is not supplied to the watchdog timer in the HALT and STOP modes, regardless of the setting of bit 0 (LSRSTOP) of the internal oscillator mode register (RCM). When 8-bit timer H1 operates with the internal low-speed oscillation clock, the count clock is supplied to 8-bit timer H1 even in the HALT/STOP mode. 4. Be sure to clear bit 7 to 0. Remarks 1. 2. fRL: Internal low-speed oscillation clock frequency ( ): fRL = 264 kHz (MAX.) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 567 CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE Figure 22-1. Format of Option Byte (2/2) Notes 1, 2 Address: 0081H/1081H 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LVISTART LVISTART Notes 1. POC mode selection 0 1.59 V POC mode (default) 1 2.7 V/1.59 V POC mode LVISTART can only be written by using a dedicated flash memory programmer. It cannot be set during self-programming or boot swap operation during self-programming (at this time, 1.59 V POC mode (default) is set). However, because the value of 1081H is copied to 0081H during the boot swap operation, it is recommended to set a value that is the same as that of 0081H to 1081H when the boot swap function is used. 2. To change the setting for the POC mode, set the value to 0081H again after batch erasure (chip erasure) of the flash memory. The setting cannot be changed after the memory of the specified block is erased. Caution Be sure to clear bits 7 to 1 to "0". Note Address: 0082H/1082H, 0083H/1083H 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Note Be sure to set 00H to 0082H and 0083H, as these addresses are reserved areas. Also set 00H to 1082H and 1083H because 0082H and 0083H are switched with 1082H and 1083H when the boot swap operation is used. Note Address: 0084H/1084H Note 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OCDEN1 OCDEN0 OCDEN1 OCDEN0 0 0 Operation disabled 0 1 Setting prohibited 1 0 Operation enabled. Does not erase data of the flash memory in case authentication of the on-chip debug security ID fails. 1 1 Operation enabled. Erases data of the flash memory in case authentication of the on-chip debug security ID fails. On-chip debug operation control To use the on-chip debug function, set 02H or 03H to 0084H. Set a value that is the same as that of 0084H to 1084H because 0084H and 1084H are switched during the boot swap operation. Remark 568 For the on-chip debug security ID, see CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE Here is an example of description of the software for setting the option bytes. OPT CSEG OPTION: DB AT 0080H 30H ; Enables watchdog timer operation (illegal access detection operation), ; Window open period of watchdog timer: 50%, ; Overflow time of watchdog timer: 210/fRL, ; Internal low-speed oscillator can be stopped by software. Remark DB 00H ; 1.59 V POC mode DB 00H ; Reserved area DB 00H ; Reserved area DB 00H ; On-chip debug operation disabled Referencing of the option byte is performed during reset processing. For the reset processing timing, see CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 569 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY The 78K0/FC2 incorporates the flash memory to which a program can be written, erased, and overwritten while mounted on the board. 23.1 Internal Memory Size Switching Register The internal memory capacity can be selected using the internal memory size switching register (IMS). IMS is set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets IMS to CFH. Caution Be sure to set each product to the values shown in Table 23-1 after a reset release. Figure 23-1. Format of Internal Memory Size Switching Register (IMS) Address: FFF0H After reset: CFH Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 0 ROM3 ROM2 ROM1 ROM0 RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 1 1 0 IMS R/W Other than above Internal high-speed RAM capacity selection 1024 bytes Setting prohibited ROM3 ROM2 ROM1 ROM0 1 0 0 0 32 KB 1 1 0 0 48 KB 1 1 1 1 60 KB Other than above Internal ROM capacity selection Setting prohibited Caution To set the memory size, set IMS and then IXS. Set the memory size so that the internal ROM and internal expansion RAM areas do not overlap. Table 23-1. Internal Memory Size Switching Register Settings Flash Memory Versions (78K0/FC2) 570 IMS Setting PD78F0881, 78F0884 C8H PD78F0882, 78F0885 CFH PD78F0883, 78F0886 CFH User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.2 Internal Expansion RAM Size Switching Register The internal expansion RAM capacity can be selected using the internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS). IXS is set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets IXS to 0CH. Caution Be sure to set each product to the values shown in Table 23-2 after a reset release. Figure 23-2. Format of Internal Expansion RAM Size Switching Register (IXS) Address: FFF4H After reset: 0CH R/W Symbol 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IXS 0 0 0 IXRAM4 IXRAM3 IXRAM2 IXRAM1 IXRAM0 IXRAM4 IXRAM3 IXRAM2 IXRAM1 IXRAM0 0 1 0 1 0 1024 bytes 0 1 0 0 0 2048 bytes Other than above Internal expansion RAM capacity selection Setting prohibited Caution To set memory size, set IMS and then IXS. Set memory size so that the internal ROM area and internal expansion RAM area do not overlap. Table 23-2. Internal Expansion RAM Size Switching Register Settings Flash Memory Versions (78K0/FC2) IXS Setting PD78F0881, 78F0884 0AH PD78F0882, 78F0885 08H PD78F0883, 78F0886 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 571 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.3 Writing with Flash Memory Programmer Data can be written to the flash memory on-board or off-board, by using a dedicated flash memory programmer. (1) On-board programming The contents of the flash memory can be rewritten after the 78K0/FC2 has been mounted on the target system. The connectors that connect the dedicated flash memory programmer must be mounted on the target system. (2) Off-board programming Data can be written to the flash memory with a dedicated program adapter (FA series) before the 78K0/FC2 is mounted on the target system. Remark The FA series is a product of Naito Densei Machida Mfg. Co., Ltd. Table 23-3. Wiring Between 78K0/FC2 and Dedicated Flash memory Programmer (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) Pin Configuration of Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer Signal Name I/O With CSI10 Pin Function Pin Name With UART60 Pin No. Pin Name Pin No. SI/RxD Input Receive signal SO10/P12 29 TxD60/P13 28 SO/TxD Output Transmit signal SI10/RxD61/P11 30 RxD60/P14 27 SCK Output Transfer clock SCK10/TxD61/P10 31 - - - - Note 2 Note 2 Note 1 CLK Output Clock to 78K0/FC2 /RESET Output Reset signal RESET 3 RESET 3 FLMD0 Output Mode signal FLMD0 6 FLMD0 6 VDD I/O VDD voltage generation/ VDD 11 VDD 11 power monitoring EVDD 11 EVDD 11 AVREF 32 AVREF 32 VSS 10 VSS 10 EVSS 10 EVSS 10 AVSS 33 AVSS 33 - GND Notes 1. 2. Ground Only the internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) can be used when CSI10 is used. Only the X1 clock (fX) or external main system clock (fEXCLK) can be used when UART60 is used. When using the clock output of the dedicated flash memory programmer, pin connection varies depending on the type of the dedicated flash memory programmer used. * PG-FP4, FL-PR4: Connect CLK of the programmer to EXCLK/X2/P122 (pin 7). * PG-FPL3, FP-LITE3: Connect CLK of the programmer to X1/P121 (pin 8), and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122 (pin 7). 572 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Examples of the recommended connection when using the adapter for flash memory writing are shown below. Figure 23-3. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in 3-Wire Serial I/O (CSI10) Mode (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) VDD (2.7 to 5.5 V) GND 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 GND VDD VDD2 (LVDD) SI SO SCK CLK /RESET FLMD0 WRITER INTERFACE User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 573 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Figure 23-4. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in UART (UART60) Mode (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) VDD (2.7 to 5.5 V) GND 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 1 2 3 4 5 6 Note 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 GND VDD VDD2 (LVDD) SI SO SCK CLK Note /RESET FLMD0 WRITER INTERFACE Note The above figure illustrates an example of wiring when using the clock output from the PG-FP4 or FL-PR4. When using the clock output from the PG-FPL3 or FP-LITE3, connect CLK to X1/P121 (pin 8), and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122 (pin 7). 574 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Table 23-4. Wiring Between 78K0/FC2 and Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) Pin Configuration of Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer Signal Name I/O With CSI10 Pin Function Pin Name With UART60 Pin No. Pin Name Pin No. SI/RxD Input Receive signal SO10/P12 32 TxD60/P13 31 SO/TxD Output Transmit signal SI10/RxD61/P11 33 RxD60/P14 30 SCK Output Transfer clock SCK10/TxD61/P10 34 - - - - Note 2 Note 2 Note 1 CLK Output Clock to 78K0/FC2 /RESET Output Reset signal RESET 4 RESET 4 FLMD0 Output Mode signal FLMD0 7 FLMD0 7 VDD I/O VDD voltage generation/ VDD 12 VDD 12 power monitoring EVDD 12 EVDD 12 AVREF 35 AVREF 35 VSS 11 VSS 11 EVSS 11 EVSS 11 AVSS 36 AVSS 36 - GND Notes 1. 2. Ground Only the internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) can be used when CSI10 is used. Only the X1 clock (fX) or external main system clock (fEXCLK) can be used when UART60 is used. When using the clock output of the dedicated flash memory programmer, pin connection varies depending on the type of the dedicated flash memory programmer used. * PG-FP4, FL-PR4: Connect CLK of the programmer to EXCLK/X2/P122 (pin 8). * PG-FPL3, FP-LITE3: Connect CLK of the programmer to X1/P121 (pin 9), and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122 (pin 8). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 575 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Examples of the recommended connection when using the adapter for flash memory writing are shown below. Figure 23-5. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in 3-Wire Serial I/O (CSI10) Mode (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) VDD (2.7 to 5.5 V) GND 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 GND VDD VDD2 (LVDD) SI SO SCK CLK /RESET FLMD0 WRITER INTERFACE 576 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Figure 23-6. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in UART (UART60) Mode (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) VDD (2.7 to 5.5 V) GND 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Note 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 GND VDD VDD2 (LVDD) SI SO SCK CLK Note /RESET FLMD0 WRITER INTERFACE Note The above figure illustrates an example of wiring when using the clock output from the PG-FP4 or FL-PR4. When using the clock output from the PG-FPL3 or FP-LITE3, connect CLK to X1/P121 (pin 9), and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122 (pin 8). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 577 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.4 Programming Environment The environment required for writing a program to the flash memory of the 78K0/FC2 is illustrated below. Figure 23-7. Environment for Writing Program to Flash Memory FLMD0 XXXXXX VDD XXXX Bxxxxx Cxxxxxx XXX YYY XXXX YYYY Axxxx STATVE PG-FP4 (Flash Pro4) XXXXX RS-232C VSS USB RESET Dedicated flash memory programmer 78K0/FC2 CSI10/UART60 Host machine A host machine that controls the dedicated flash memory programmer is necessary. To interface between the dedicated flash memory programmer and the 78K0/FC2, CSI10 or UART60 is used for manipulation such as writing and erasing. To write the flash memory off-board, a dedicated program adapter (FA series) is necessary. 23.5 Communication Mode Communication between the dedicated flash memory programmer and the 78K0/FC2 is established by serial communication via CSI10 or UART60 of the 78K0/FC2. (1) CSI10 Transfer rate: 2.4 kHz to 2.5 MHz Figure 23-8. Communication with Dedicated Flash memory programmer (CSI10) FLMD0 VDD XXXXXX GND STATVE PG-FP4 (Flash Pro4) Dedicated flash memory programmer /RESET VSS/EVSS/AVSS RESET SI/RxD SO10 SO/TxD SI10 SCK 578 VDD/EVDD/AVREF XXXX Bxxxxx Cxxxxxx XXXXX XXX YYY XXXX YYYY Axxxx FLMD0 SCK10 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 78K0/FC2 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY (2) UART60 Transfer rate: 115200 bps Figure 23-9. Communication with Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer (UART60) FLMD0 VDD XXXXXX GND VDD/EVDD/AVREF VSS/EVSS/AVSS XXXX Cxxxxxx XXX YYY STATVE PG-FP4 (Flash Pro4) XXXXX XXXX YYYY Axxxx Bxxxxx FLMD0 Dedicated flash memory programmer /RESET RESET SI/RxD TxD60 SO/TxD RxD60 CLKNote EXCLKNote 78K0/FC2 Note The above figure illustrates an example of wiring when using the clock output from the PG-FP4 or FL-PR4. When using the clock output from the PG-FPL3 or FP-LITE3, connect CLK to X1/P121 (pin 8; PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883, pin 9; PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886), and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122 (pin 7; PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883, pin 8; PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886). CLK X1 X2 The dedicated flash memory programmer generates the following signals for the 78K0/FC2. For details, refer to the user's manual for the PG-FP4, FL-PR4, PG-FPL3, or FP-LITE3. Table 23-5. Pin Connection Dedicated Flash memory programmer Signal Name I/O Pin Function 78K0/FC2 Pin Name FLMD0 Output Mode signal FLMD0 VDD I/O VDD voltage generation/power monitoring VDD, EVDD, AVREF Ground VSS, EVSS, AVSS - GND CLK Output Clock output to 78K0/FC2 Note 1 /RESET Output Reset signal RESET SI/RxD Input Receive signal SO10/TxD60 SO/TxD Output Transmit signal SI10/RxD60 SCK Output Transfer clock SCK10 Notes 1. Connection CSI10 x Note 2 UART60 { Note 1 x Only the X1 clock (fX) or external main system clock (fEXCLK) can be used when UART60 is used. When using the clock output of the dedicated flash memory programmer, pin connection varies depending on the type of the dedicated flash memory programmer used. Connect CLK of the programmer to EXCLK/X2/P122 (pin 7; PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883, pin 8; PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886). * PG-FPL3, FP-LITE3: Connect CLK of the programmer to X1/P121 (pin 8; PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883, pin 9; PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886), and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122 (pin 7; PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883, pin 8; PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886). Only the internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) can be used when CSI10 is used. * PG-FP4, FL-PR4: 2. Remark : Be sure to connect the pin. {: The pin does not have to be connected if the signal is generated on the target board. x: The pin does not have to be connected. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 579 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.6 Connection of Pins on Board To write the flash memory on-board, connectors that connect the dedicated flash memory programmer must be provided on the target system. First provide a function that selects the normal operation mode or flash memory programming mode on the board. When the flash memory programming mode is set, all the pins not used for programming the flash memory are in the same status as immediately after reset. Therefore, if the external device does not recognize the state immediately after reset, the pins must be handled as described below. 23.6.1 FLMD0 pin In the normal operation mode, 0 V is input to the FLMD0 pin. In the flash memory programming mode, the VDD write voltage is supplied to the FLMD0 pin. An FLMD0 pin connection example is shown below. Figure 23-10. FLMD0 Pin Connection Example 78K0/FC2 Dedicated flash memory programmer connection pin FLMD0 10 k (recommended) 23.6.2 Serial interface pins The pins used by each serial interface are listed below. Table 23-6. Pins Used by Each Serial Interface Serial Interface Pins Used CSI10 SO10, SI10, SCK10 UART60 TxD60, RxD60 To connect the dedicated flash memory programmer to the pins of a serial interface that is connected to another device on the board, care must be exercised so that signals do not collide or that the other device does not malfunction. 580 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY (1) Signal collision If the dedicated flash memory programmer (output) is connected to a pin (input) of a serial interface connected to another device (output), signal collision takes place. To avoid this collision, either isolate the connection with the other device, or make the other device go into an output high-impedance state. Figure 23-11. Signal Collision (Input Pin of Serial Interface) 78K0/FC2 Signal collision Input pin Dedicated flash memory programmer connection pin Other device Output pin In the flash memory programming mode, the signal output by the device collides with the signal sent from the dedicated flash memory programmer. Therefore, isolate the signal of the other device. (2) Malfunction of other device If the dedicated flash memory programmer (output or input) is connected to a pin (input or output) of a serial interface connected to another device (input), a signal may be output to the other device, causing the device to malfunction. To avoid this malfunction, isolate the connection with the other device. Figure 23-12. Malfunction of Other Device 78K0/FC2 Pin Dedicated flash memory programmer connection pin Other device Input pin If the signal output by the 78K0/FC2 in the flash memory programming mode affects the other device, isolate the signal of the other device. 78K0/FC2 Pin Dedicated flash memory programmer connection pin Other device Input pin If the signal output by the dedicated flash memory programmer in the flash memory programming mode affects the other device, isolate the signal of the other device. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 581 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.6.3 RESET pin If the reset signal of the dedicated flash memory programmer is connected to the RESET pin that is connected to the reset signal generator on the board, signal collision takes place. To prevent this collision, isolate the connection with the reset signal generator. If the reset signal is input from the user system while the flash memory programming mode is set, the flash memory will not be correctly programmed. Do not input any signal other than the reset signal of the dedicated flash memory programmer. Figure 23-13. Signal Collision (RESET Pin) 78K0/FC2 Signal collision RESET Dedicated flash memory programmer connection signal Reset signal generator Output pin In the flash memory programming mode, the signal output by the reset signal generator collides with the signal output by the dedicated flash memory programmer. Therefore, isolate the signal of the reset signal generator. 23.6.4 Port pins When the flash memory programming mode is set, all the pins not used for flash memory programming enter the same status as that immediately after reset. If external devices connected to the ports do not recognize the port status immediately after reset, the port pin must be connected to VDD or VSS via a resistor. 23.6.5 REGC pin Connect the REGC pin to GND via a capacitor (0.47 to 1 F: recommended) in the same manner as during normal operation. 23.6.6 Other signal pins Connect X1 and X2 in the same status as in the normal operation mode when using the on-board clock. To input the operating clock from the dedicated flash memory programmer, however, connect as follows. * PG-FP4, FL-PR4: Connect CLK of the programmer to EXCLK/X2/P122. * PG-FPL3, FP-LITE3: Connect CLK of the programmer and X1/P121, and connect its inverted signal to X2/EXCLK/P122. Cautions 1. Only the internal high-speed oscillation clock (fRH) can be used when CSI10 is used. 2. Only the X1 clock (fX) or external main system clock (fEXCLK) can be used when UART60 is used. 3. Connect P31/INTP2/TI002 and P121/X1 as follows when writing the flash memory with a flash memory programmer. * P31/INTP2/TI002: Connect to EVSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended). * P121/X1: When using this pin as a port, connect it to VSS via a resistor (10 k: recommended) (in the input mode) or leave it open (in the output mode). The above connection is not necessary when writing the flash memory by means of self programming. 582 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.6.7 Power supply To use the supply voltage output of the flash memory programmer, connect the VDD pin to VDD of the flash memory programmer, and the VSS pin to GND of the flash memory programmer. To use the on-board supply voltage, connect in compliance with the normal operation mode. However, be sure to connect the VDD and VSS pins to VDD and GND of the flash memory programmer to use the power monitor function with the flash memory programmer, even when using the on-board supply voltage. Supply the same other power supplies (EVDD, EVSS, AVREF, and AVSS) as those in the normal operation mode. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 583 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.7 Programming Method 23.7.1 Controlling flash memory The following figure illustrates the procedure to manipulate the flash memory. Figure 23-14. Flash Memory Manipulation Procedure Start FLMD0 pulse supply Flash memory programming mode is set Selecting communication mode Manipulate flash memory No End? Yes End 23.7.2 Flash memory programming mode To rewrite the contents of the flash memory by using the dedicated flash memory programmer, set the 78K0/FC2 in the flash memory programming mode. To set the mode, set the FLMD0 pin to VDD and clear the reset signal. Change the mode by using a jumper when writing the flash memory on-board. Figure 23-15. Flash Memory Programming Mode VDD 5.5 V 0V VDD RESET 0V FLMD0 pulse VDD FLMD0 0V Flash memory programming mode Table 23-7. Relationship Between FLMD0 Pin and Operation Mode After Reset Release FLMD0 0 VDD 584 Operation Mode Normal operation mode Flash memory programming mode User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.7.3 Selecting communication mode In the 78K0/FC2, a communication mode is selected by inputting pulses (up to 8 pulses) to the FLMD0 pin after the dedicated flash memory programming mode is entered. These FLMD0 pulses are generated by the flash memory programmer. The following table shows the relationship between the number of pulses and communication modes. Table 23-8. Communication Modes Communication Mode Standard Setting Port Speed UART-Ext-Osc 3-wire serial I/O (CSI10) CSI-Internal-Osc Pins Used Frequency Note 2 UART (UART60) Note 1 Note 3 115200 bps 2 to 20 MHz Multiply Rate 1.0 UART-Ext-FP4CK - 2.4 kHz to 2.5 MHz Peripheral Number of Clock FLMD0 Pulses TxD60, RxD60 fX 0 fEXCLK 3 SO10, SI10, SCK10 fRH 8 Notes 1. Selection items for Standard settings on GUI of the flash memory programmer. 2. Because factors other than the baud rate error, such as the signal waveform slew, also affect UART communication, thoroughly evaluate the slew as well as the baud rate error. 3. The possible setting range differs depending on the voltage. For details, refer to the chapter of electrical specifications. Caution When UART60 is selected, the receive clock is calculated based on the reset command sent from the dedicated flash memory programmer after the FLMD0 pulse has been received. Remark f X: X1 clock fEXCLK: External main system clock fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock 23.7.4 Communication commands The 78K0/FC2 communicates with the dedicated flash memory programmer by using commands. The signals sent from the flash memory programmer to the 78K0/FC2 are called commands, and the commands sent from the 78K0/FC2 to the dedicated flash memory programmer are called response. Figure 23-16. Communication Commands XXXXXX Command XXXX STATVE PG-FP4 (Flash Pro4) XXXXX XXX YYY XXXX YYYY Axxxx Bxxxxx Cxxxxxx Dedicated flash memory programmer Response 78K0/FC2 The flash memory control commands of the 78K0/FC2 are listed in the table below. All these commands are issued from the programmer and the 78K0/FC2 perform processing corresponding to the respective commands. Table 23-9. Flash Memory Control Commands Classification Verify Command Name Verify Function Compares the contents of a specified area of the flash memory with data transmitted from the programmer. Erase Chip Erase Erases the entire flash memory. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 585 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Block Erase Erases a specified area in the flash memory. Blank check Block Blank Check Checks if a specified block in the flash memory has been correctly Write Programming Writes data to a specified area in the flash memory. Getting information Status Gets the current operating status (status data). Silicon Signature Gets 78K0/Fx2 information (such as the part number and flash memory erased. configuration). Version Get Gets the 78K0/Fx2 version and firmware version. Checksum Gets the checksum data for a specified area. Security Security Set Sets security information. Others Reset Used to detect synchronization status of communication. Oscillating Frequency Set Specifies an oscillation frequency. The 78K0/FC2 return a response for the command issued by the dedicated flash memory programmer. The response names sent from the 78K0/FC2 are listed below. Table 23-10. Response Names Command Name 586 Function ACK Acknowledges command/data. NAK Acknowledges illegal command/data. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.8 Security Settings The 78K0/FC2 supports a security function that prohibits rewriting the user program written to the internal flash memory, so that the program cannot be changed by an unauthorized person. The operations shown below can be performed using the security set command. The security setting is valid when the programming mode is set next. * Disabling batch erase (chip erase) Execution of the block erase and batch erase (chip erase) commands for entire blocks in the flash memory is prohibited by this setting during on-board/off-board programming. Once execution of the batch erase (chip erase) command is prohibited, all of the prohibition settings (including prohibition of batch erase (chip erase)) can no longer be cancelled. Caution After the security setting for the batch erase is set, erasure cannot be performed for the device. In addition, even if a write command is executed, data different from that which has already been written to the flash memory cannot be written, because the erase command is disabled. * Disabling block erase Execution of the block erase command for a specific block in the flash memory is prohibited during on-board/offboard programming. However, blocks can be erased by means of self programming. * Disabling write Execution of the write and block erase commands for entire blocks in the flash memory is prohibited during onboard/off-board programming. However, blocks can be written by means of self programming. * Disabling rewriting boot cluster 0 Execution of the batch erase (chip erase) command, block erase command, and write command on boot cluster 0 (0000H to 0FFFH) in the flash memory is prohibited by this setting. Caution If a security setting that rewrites boot cluster 0 has been applied, boot cluster 0 of that device will not be rewritten. The batch erase (chip erase), block erase, write commands, and rewriting boot cluster 0 are enabled by the default setting when the flash memory is shipped. Security can be set by on-board/off-board programming and self programming. Each security setting can be used in combination. Prohibition of erasing blocks and writing is cleared by executing the batch erase (chip erase) command. Table 23-11 shows the relationship between the erase and write commands when the 78K0/FC2 security function is enabled. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 587 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Table 23-11. Relationship Between Enabling Security Function and Command (1) During on-board/off-board programming Valid Security Executed Command Batch Erase (Chip Erase) Block Erase Write Note Prohibition of batch erase (chip erase) Cannot be erased in batch Blocks cannot be Can be performed Prohibition of block erase Can be erased in batch. erased. Can be performed. Prohibition of writing . Cannot be performed. Prohibition of rewriting boot cluster 0 Cannot be erased in batch Boot cluster 0 cannot be Boot cluster 0 cannot be erased. written. Note Confirm that no data has been written to the write area. Because data cannot be erased after batch erase (chip erase) is prohibited, do not write data if the data has not been erased. (2) During self programming Valid Security Executed Command Block Erase Prohibition of batch erase (chip erase) Write Blocks can be erased. Can be performed. Boot cluster 0 cannot be erased. Boot cluster 0 cannot be written. Prohibition of block erase Prohibition of writing Prohibition of rewriting boot cluster 0 Table 23-12 shows how to perform security settings in each programming mode. Table 23-12. Setting Security in Each Programming Mode (1) On-board/off-board programming Security Security Setting How to Disable Security Setting Prohibition of batch erase (chip erase) Set via GUI of dedicated flash memory Cannot be disabled after set. Prohibition of block erase programmer, etc. Execute batch erase (chip erase) Prohibition of writing command Prohibition of rewriting boot cluster 0 Cannot be disabled after set. (2) Self programming Security Prohibition of batch erase (chip erase) Security Setting Set by using information library. How to Disable Security Setting Cannot be disabled after set. Prohibition of block erase Execute batch erase (chip erase) Prohibition of writing command during on-board/off-board programming (cannot be disabled during self programming) Prohibition of rewriting boot cluster 0 588 Cannot be disabled after set. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.9 Processing Time for Each Command When PG-FP4 Is Used (Reference) The following table shows the processing time for each command (reference) when the PG-FP4 is used as a dedicated flash memory programmer. Table 23-13. Processing Time for Each Command When PG-FP4 Is Used (Reference) (1) PD78F0883, 78F0886 (internal ROM capacity: 60 KB) Command of Port: CSI-Internal-OSC Port: UART-Ext-FP4CK (External main system clock (fEXCLK)), PG-FP4 (Internal high-speed Speed: 115,200 bps oscillation clock (fRH)), Frequency: 2.0 MHz Speed: 2.5 MHz Frequency: 20 MHz Signature 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) Blankcheck 1 s (TYP.) 1 s (TYP.) 1 s (TYP.) Erase 1.5 s (TYP.) 1 s (TYP.) 1 s (TYP.) Program 5 s (TYP.) 9 s (TYP.) 9 s (TYP.) Verify 2 s (TYP.) 6.5 s (TYP.) 6.5 s (TYP.) E.P.V 6 s (TYP.) 10.5 s (TYP.) 10.5 s (TYP.) Checksum 0.5 s (TYP.) 1 s (TYP.) 1 s (TYP.) Security 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) (2) PD78F0881, 78F0884 (internal ROM capacity: 32 KB) Command of Port: CSI-Internal-OSC Port: UART-Ext-FP4CK (External main system clock (fEXCLK)), PG-FP4 (Internal high-speed Speed: 115,200 bps oscillation clock (fRH)), Frequency: 2.0 MHz Speed: 2.5 MHz Frequency: 20 MHz Signature 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) Blankcheck 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) Erase 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) Program 2.5 s (TYP.) 5 s (TYP.) 5 s (TYP.) Verify 1.5 s (TYP.) 4 s (TYP.) 3.5 s (TYP.) E.P.V 3.5 s (TYP.) 6 s (TYP.) 6 s (TYP.) Checksum 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) Security 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) 0.5 s (TYP.) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 589 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.10 Flash Memory Programming by Self-Programming The 78K0/FC2 supports a self-programming function that can be used to rewrite the flash memory via a user program. Because this function allows a user application to rewrite the flash memory by using the 78K0/FC2 selfprogramming library, it can be used to upgrade the program in the field. If an interrupt occurs during self-programming, self-programming can be temporarily stopped and interrupt servicing can be executed. To execute interrupt servicing, restore the normal operation mode after self-programming has been stopped, and execute the EI instruction. After the self-programming mode is later restored, self- programming can be resumed. Remark For details of the self-programming function and the 78K0/FC2 self-programming library, refer to a separate document to be published (document name: 78K0/Fx2 Application Note, release schedule: Pending). Cautions 1. The self-programming function cannot be used when the CPU operates with the subsystem clock. 2. Input a high level to the FLMD0 pin during self-programming. 3. Be sure to execute the DI instruction before starting self-programming. The self-programming function checks the interrupt request flags (IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, and IF1H). If an interrupt request is generated, self-programming is stopped. 4. Self-programming is also stopped by an interrupt request that is not masked even in the DI status. To prevent this, mask the interrupt by using the interrupt mask flag registers (MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, and MK1H). 5. Self-programming is executed with the internal high-speed oscillation clock. If the CPU operates with the X1 clock or external main system clock, the oscillation stabilization wait time of the internal high-speed oscillation clock elapses during self-programming. 6. Allocate the entry program for self-programming in the common area of 0000H to 7FFFH. Figure 23-17. Operation Mode and Memory Map for Self-Programming (PD78F0883, 78F0886) FFFFH FF00H FEFFH FB00H FA F F H FA 0 0 H F9FFH FFFFH FF00H FEFFH SFR Internal highspeed RAM FB00H FA F F H FA 0 0 H F9FFH AFCAN area Reserved AFCAN area Reserved F800H F7FFH F800H F7FFH Internal expansion RAM F000H EFFFH Flash memory control firmware ROM Internal expansion RAM F000H EFFFH Disable accessing Flash memory control firmware ROM Disable accessing 8000H 7FFFH Enable accessing 8000H 7FFFH Flash memory (common area) 0000H Flash memory (common area) Instructions can be fetched from common area. 0000H Normal mode 590 SFR Internal highspeed RAM Self-programming mode User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Instructions can be fetched from common area and firmware ROM. CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY The following figure illustrates a flow of rewriting the flash memory by using a self programming sample library. Figure 23-18. Flow of Self-Programming (Rewriting Flash Memory) Start of self programming FLMD0 pin Low level High level FlashStart Setting operating environment FlashEnv CheckFLMD Normal completion? No Yes FlashBlockBlankCheck No Erased? Yes FlashBlockErase FlashWordWrite Normal completion? Normal completion? No Yes No Yes FlashBlockVerify Normal completion? No Yes FlashEnd FLMD0 pin High level Low level End of self programming User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 591 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY The following table shows the processing time and interrupt response time for the self programming sample library. Table 23-14. Processing Time and Interrupt Response Time for Self Programming Sample Library (1/4) (1) When internal high-speed oscillation clock is used and entry RAM is located outside short direct addressing range Processing Time (s) Library Name Interrupt Response Time (s) Static Model of Normal Model of C Compiler C Compiler/Assembler Min. Max. Min. Min. Max. 4.25 - - 977.75 - - 753.125 - - 12765.875 Self programming start library Initialize library Mode check library 753.875 Block blank check library Block erase library Word write library Program verify library 12770.875 36909.5 356318 36904.5 391.25 1300.5 356296.25 389.25 1393.5 394.75 1289.5 390.25 1324.5 - - - - - - - - 1214 2409 1207 2402 (1214.375) (2409.375) (1207.375) (2402.375) 25618.875 Self programming end library 25613.875 4.25 Get information library (option value: 03H) Max. 871.25 866 (871.375) (866.125) Get information library 863.375 858.125 (option value: 04H) (863.5) (858.25) Get information library (option value: 05H) 1024.75 1037.5 (1043.625) (1038.375) Set information library 105524.75 790809.375 105523.75 790808.375 387 852.5 EEPROM write library 1496.5 2691.5 1489.5 2684.5 399.75 1395.5 (1496.875) (2691.875) (1489.875) (2684.875) Remark The value in the parentheses indicates the value when a write start address structure is located at a place other than the internal high-speed RAM. 592 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Table 23-14. Processing Time and Interrupt Response Time for Self Programming Sample Library (2/4) (2) When internal high-speed oscillation clock is used and entry RAM is located in short direct addressing range (FE20H) Processing Time (s) Library Name Normal Model of C Compiler Interrupt Response Time (s) Static Model of C Compiler/Assembler Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. Self programming start library 4.25 - - Initialize library 443.5 - - - - Mode check library Block blank check library Block erase library Word write library Program verify library 219.625 218.875 12236.625 36363.25 12231.625 355771.75 36358.25 81.25 727.5 355750 79.25 820.5 84.75 716.5 80.25 751.5 - - - - - - - - 679.75 1874.75 672.75 1867.75 (680.125) (1875.125) (673.125) (1868.125) 25072.625 Self programming end library 25067.625 4.25 Get information library 337 331.75 (337.125) (331.875) Get information library 329.125 323.875 (option value: 04H) (239.25) (324) (option value: 03H) Get information library (option value: 05H) 502.25 497 (503.125) (497.875) Set information library 104978.5 541143.125 104977.5 541142.125 77 279.5 EEPROM write library 962.25 2157.25 955.25 2150.25 89.75 822.5 (962.625) (2157.625) (955.625) (2150.625) Remark The value in the parentheses indicates the value when a write start address structure is located at a place other than the internal high-speed RAM. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 593 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Table 23-14. Processing Time and Interrupt Response Time for Self Programming Sample Library (3/4) (3) When high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation or external clock input) is used and entry RAM is located outside short direct addressing range Processing Time (s) Library Name Interrupt Response Time (s) Static Model of C Normal Model of C Compiler Compiler/Assembler Min. Max. Min. Max. 34/fXH - - 49/fXH + 485.8125 - - 29/fXH + 374.75 - - 134/fXH + 6382.0625 18/fXH + 192 28/fXH + 698 18/fXH + 186 28/fXH + 745 22/fXH + 189 28/fXH + 693 18/fXH + 192 28/fXH + 709 - - Self programming start library Initialize library Mode check library Block blank check library Block erase library Word write library Program verify library 35/fXH + 374.75 174/fXH + 6382.0625 Max. 174/fXH + 174/fXH + 134/fXH + 134/fXH + 31093.875 298948.125 31093.875 298948.125 318 (321)/fXH 318 (321)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH + 644.125 + 1491.625 + 644.125 + 1491.625 174/fXH + 13448.5625 Self programming end library Get information library Min. 134/fXH + 13448.5625 34/fXH 171 (172)/fXH + 432.4375 129 (130)/fXH + 432.4375 - - 181 (182)/fXH + 427.875 139 (140)/fXH + 427.875 - - 404 (411)/fXH + 496.125 362 (369)/fXH + 496.125 - - 16/fXH + 190 28/fXH + 454 22/fXH + 191 28/fXH + 783 (option value: 03H) Get information library (option value: 04H) Get information library (option value: 05H) Set information library EEPROM write library 75/fXH + 75/fXH + 67/fXH + 67/fXH + 79157.6875 652400 79157.6875 652400 318 (321)/fXH 318 (321)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH + 799.875 + 1647.375 + 799.875 + 1647.375 Remarks 1. The value in the parentheses indicates the value when a write start address structure is located at a place other than the internal high-speed RAM. 2. fXH: High-speed system clock frequency 594 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Table 23-14. Processing Time and Interrupt Response Time for Self Programming Sample Library (4/4) (4) When high-speed system clock (X1 oscillation or external clock input) is used and entry RAM is located in short direct addressing range (FE20H) Processing Time (s) Library Name Interrupt Response Time (s) Static Model of Normal Model of C Compiler C Compiler/Assembler Min. Max. Min. Max. 34/fXH - - 49/fXH + 224.6875 - - 29/fXH + 113.625 - - 134/fXH + 6120.9375 18/fXH + 55 28/fXH + 462 18/fXH + 49 28/fXH + 509 22/fXH + 52 28/fXH + 457 18/fXH + 55 28/fXH + 473 - - Self programming start library Initialize library Mode check library Block blank check library Block erase library Word write library Program verify library 35/fXH + 113.625 174/fXH + 6120.9375 Max. 174/fXH + 174/fXH + 134/fXH + 134/fXH + 30820.75 298675 30820.75 298675 318 (321)/fXH 318 (321)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH + 383 + 1230.5 + 383 + 1230.5 174/fXH + 13175.4375 Self programming end library Get information library Min. 134/fXH + 13175.4375 34/fXH 171 (172)/fXH + 171.3125 129 (130)/fXH + 171.3125 - - 181 (182)/fXH + 166.75 139 (140)/fXH + 166.75 - - 404 (411)/fXH + 231.875 362 (369)/fXH + 231.875 - - 16/fXH +53 28/fXH +218 22/fXH +54 28/fXH +547 (option value: 03H) Get information library (option value: 04H) Get information library (option value: 05H) Set information library EEPROM write library 75/fXH + 75/fXH + 67/fXH + 67/fXH + 78884.5625 527566.875 78884.5625 527566.875 318 (321)/fXH 318 (321)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH 262 (265)/fXH + 538.75 + 1386.25 + 538.75 + 1386.25 Remarks 1. The value in the parentheses indicates the value when a write start address structure is located at a place other than the internal high-speed RAM. 2. fXH: High-speed system clock frequency User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 595 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.10.1 Registers used for self-programming function The following three registers are used for the self-programming function. * Flash-programming mode control register (FLPMC) * Flash protect command register (PFCMD) * Flash status register (PFS) (1) Flash-programming mode control register (FLPMC) This register is used to enable or disable writing or erasing of the flash memory and to set the operation mode during self-programming. The FLPMC can be written only in a specific sequence (see 23.10.1 (2) Flash protect command register (PFCMD)) so that the application system does not stop inadvertently due to malfunction caused by noise or program hang-up. FLPMC can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation sets this register to 0xHNote. Note Differs depending on the operation mode. * User mode: 08H * On-board mode: 0CH 596 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Figure 23-19. Format of Flash-Programming Mode Control Register (FLPMC) After reset: 0xHNote 1 Address: FFC4H R/WNote 2 Symbol FLPMC 0 0 0 FWEDIS 0 FWEPR FLSPM1 FLSPM0 Control of flash memory writing/erasing 0 Writing/erasing enabledNote 3 1 Writing/erasing disabled FWEPR Status of FLMD0 pin 0 Low level 1 High levelNote 3 FLSPM1Note 4 FLSPM0Note 4 Notes 1. FWEDIS Selection of operation mode during self-programming 0 0 Normal mode Access (fetch of a command, lead of data) is possible to all the address domains of a flash memory. 0 1 Self-programming mode Execution"CALL #8100 H" of firmware is possible. Access (lead of an instruction fetch and data) is possible to a flash memory . 1 1 Setting prohibited 1 0 Differs depending on the operation mode. * User mode: 08H * On-board mode: 0CH 2. Bit 2 (FWEPR) is read-only. 3. For actual writing/erasing, the FLMD0 pin must be high (FWEPR = 1), as well as FWEDIS = 0. FWEDIS FWEPR 0 1 Other than above 4. Enable or disable of flash memory writing/erasing Writing/erasing enabled Writing/erasing disabled The user ROM (flash memory) or firmware ROM can be selected by FLSPM1 and FLSPM0, and the operation mode set on the application system by the mode pin or the self-programming mode can be selected. Cautions 1. Be sure to keep FWEDIS at 0 until writing or erasing of the flash memory is completed. 2. Make sure that FWEDIS = 1 in the normal mode. 3. Manipulate FLSPM1 and FLSPM0 after execution branches to the internal RAM. The address of the flash memory is specified by an address signal from the CPU when FLSPM1 = 0 or the set value of the firmware written when FLSPM1 = 1. In the on-board mode, the specifications of FLSPM1 and FLSPM0 are ignored. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 597 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY (2) Flash protect command register (PFCMD) If the application system stops inadvertently due to malfunction caused by noise or program hang-up, an operation to write the flash programming mode control register (FLPMC) may have a serious effect on the system. PFCMD is used to protect FLPMC from being written, so that the application system does not stop inadvertently. Writing FLPMC is enabled only when a write operation is performed in the following specific sequence. <1> Write a specific value to PFCMD (PFCMD = A5H) <2> Write the value to be set to FLPMC (writing in this step is invalid) <3> Write the inverted value of the value to be set to FLPMC <4> Write the value to be set to FLPMC (writing in this step is valid) This rewrites the value of the register, so that the register cannot be written illegally. Occurrence of an illegal store operation can be checked by bit 0 (FPRERR) of the flash status register (PFS). A5H must be written to PFCMD each time the value of FLPMC is changed. PFCMD can be set by an 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation makes this register undefined. Figure 23-20. Format of Flash Protect Command Register (PFCMD) Address: FFC0H After reset: Undefined W Symbol PFCMD REG7 REG6 REG5 REG4 REG3 REG2 REG1 REG0 (3) Flash status register (PFS) If data is not written to the flash programming mode control register (FLPMC), which is protected, in the correct sequence (writing the flash protect command register (PFCMD)), FLPMC is not written and a protection error occurs. If this happens, bit 0 of PFS (FPRERR) is set to 1. This bit is a cumulative flag. After checking FPRERR, clear it by writing 0 to it. PFS can be set by a 1-bit or 8-bit memory manipulation instruction. Reset signal generation clears this register to 00H. Figure 23-21. Format of Flash Status Register (PFS) Address: FFC2H After reset: 00H R/W Symbol PFS 598 0 0 0 0 0 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 0 0 FPRERR CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY The operating conditions of the FPRERR flag are as follows. * If PFCMD is written when the store instruction operation recently performed on a peripheral register is not to write a specific value (A5H) to PFCMD * If the first store instruction operation after <1> is on a peripheral register other than FLPMC * If the first store instruction operation after <2> is on a peripheral register other than FLPMC * If a value other than the inverted value of the value to be set to FLPMC is written by the first store instruction after <2> * If the first store instruction operation after <3> is on a peripheral register other than FLPMC * If a value other than the value to be set to FLPMC (value written in <2>) is written by the first store instruction after <3> Remark The numbers in angle brackets above correspond to the those in (2) Flash protect command register (PFCMD). * If 0 is written to the FPRERR flag * If reset signal is generated To write 05H to FLPMC MOV PFCMD, #0A5H ; Writes A5H to PFCMD. MOV FLPMC, #05H ; Writes 05H to FLPMC. MOV FLPMC, #0FAH ; Writes 0FAH (inverted value of 05H) to FLPMC. MOV FLPMC, #05H ; Writes 05H to FLPMC. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 599 CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY 23.11 Boot Swap Function If rewriting the boot area has failed during self-programming due to a power failure or some other cause, the data in the boot area may be lost and the program may not be restarted by resetting. The boot swap function is used to avoid this problem. Before erasing boot cluster 0Note, which is a boot program area, by self-programming, write a new boot program to boot cluster 1 in advance. When the program has been correctly written to boot cluster 1, swap this boot cluster 1 and boot cluster 0 by using the set information function of the firmware of the 78K0/FC2, so that boot cluster 1 is used as a boot area. After that, erase or write the original boot program area, boot cluster 0. As a result, even if a power failure occurs while the boot programming area is being rewritten, the program is executed correctly because it is booted from boot cluster 1 to be swapped when the program is reset and started next. If the program has been correctly written to boot cluster 0, restore the original boot area by using the set information function of the firmware of the 78K0/FC2. Note A boot cluster is a 4 KB area and boot clusters 0 and 1 are swapped by the boot swap function. Boot cluster 0 (0000H to 0FFFH): Original boot program area Boot cluster 1 (1000H to 1FFFH): Area subject to boot swap function Figure 23-22. Boot Swap Function XXXXH User program Self-programming to boot cluster 1 User program Execution of boot swap by firmware User program 2000H User program New boot program (boot cluster 1) New boot program (boot cluster 1) Boot program (boot cluster 0) Boot program (boot cluster 0) Boot program (boot cluster 0) 1000H 0000H Boot Boot Boot XXXXH Self-programming to boot cluster 0 User program Execution of boot swap by firmware User program 2000H 1000H 0000H 600 New boot program (boot cluster 1) New boot program (boot cluster 1) Boot New boot program (boot cluster 0) New boot program (boot cluster 0) Boot User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 23 FLASH MEMORY Figure 23-23. Example of Executing Boot Swapping Block number Boot cluster 1 Boot cluster 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Program Program Program Program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program 1000H 0000H Erasing block 4 Erasing block 5 Erasing block 6 Erasing block 7 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Program Program Program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Program Program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Booted by boot cluster 0 Writing blocks 5 to 7 7 New boot program 6 New boot program 5 New boot program 4 New boot program 3 Boot program 2 Boot program 1 Boot program 0 Boot program Boot swap 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program 0000H 1000H Erasing block 0 Erasing block 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program Boot program Boot program Boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program Boot program Boot program Booted by boot cluster 1 Erasing block 2 Erasing block 3 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program Boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program Writing blocks 0 to 3 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program New boot program Boot swap canceled 7 New boot program 6 New boot program 5 New boot program 4 New boot program 1 0 0 0 H 3 New boot program 2 New boot program 1 New boot program 0 New boot program 0 0 0 0 H Booted by boot cluster 0 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 601 CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION 24.1 Outline of Functions The 78K0/FC2 uses the VDD, FLMD0, RESET, X1 (or P31), X2 (or P32), and VSS pins to communicate with the host machine via an on-chip debug emulator (QB-78K0MINI). Whether X1 and P31, or X2 and P32 are used can be selected. Caution Do not use this product for mass production after the on-chip debug function has been used because its reliability cannot be guaranteed, due to issues with respect to the number of times the flash memory can be rewritten. NEC Electronics does not accept complaints concerning when use this product for mass production after the on-chip debug function has been used. 602 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION 24.2 Connection with MINICUBE In order to connect QB-78K0MINI, it is necessary to mount the connector for emulator connection, and the circuit for connection on a target system. The connector for OCD (a two-row 2.54 pitch type connector, with reverse-insertion blocker) is described below. * Recommended connectors: (straight) HIF3FC-10PA-2.54DSA (manufactured by Hirose Electric Co., Ltd.) (right angle) HIF3FC-10PA-2.54DS (manufactured by Hirose Electric Co., Ltd.)) Pin No. Name IN/OUT Remark 1 RESET_IN IN Target reset input signal 2 RESET_OUT OUT Reset signal output to target device 3 FLMD0 OUT Output signal Note used to control on-chip debugging functions 4 VDD_IN IN This signal is used to generate an interface output signal when the target system's VDD is detected. 5 X2 IN/OUT Bidirectional signal used for data communications 6 GND - Connected to GND. 7 X1 OUT Output signal used for clock supply 8 GND - Connected to GND. 9 RESERVED - Open 10 RESERVED - Open Note FLMD0 is at high level during on-chip debugging. Figure 24-1. Connector Pin Layout 10-pin general-purpose connector TOP VIEW 9 7 5 3 1 10 8 6 4 2 Target system (Top view) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 603 CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION 24.3 Connection Circuit Examples The following are examples of circuits required when connecting the QB-78K0MINI to the target system. Figure 24-2. Connection Circuit Example (When QB-78K0MINI Is Not Used) Target device QB-78K0MINI target connector Shorted by jumper FLMD0 FLMD0 Note RESET IN Target reset RESET RESET OUT X1 X1 X2 X2 GND GND VDD VDD P31 Note Note Make pull-down resistor 470 or more (10 k: recommended). Figure 24-3. Connection Circuit Example (When Using QB-78K0MINI: X1 and X2 Are Used) Target device QB-78K0MINI target connector FLMD0 FLMD0 Note RESET IN Target reset RESET RESET OUT X1 X1 X2 X2 GND GND VDD VDD Oscillator is deleted P31 Note Note Make pull-down resistor 470 or more (10 k: recommended). Cautions 1. Input the clock from the X1 pin during on-chip debugging. 2. Control the X1 and X2 pins by externally pulling down the P31 pin or by using an external circuit using the P130 pin (that outputs a low level when the device is reset). 604 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION Figure 24-4. Connection Circuit Example (When Using QB-78K0MINI: Ports 31 and 32 Are Used) Target device QB-78K0MINI target connector FLMD0 FLMD0 Note RESET IN Target reset RESET RESET OUT X1 P31 Note X2 P32 GND GND VDD VDD X1 X2 Note Make pull-down resistor 470 or more (10 k: recommended). Connect the FLMD0 pin as follows when performing self programming by means of on-chip debugging. Figure 24-5. Connection of FLMD0 Pin for Self Programming by Means of On-Chip Debugging QB-78K0MINI target connector Target device Port 1 k (recommended) FLMD0 FLMD0 10 k (recommended) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 605 CHAPTER 24 ON-CHIP DEBUG FUNCTION 24.4 On-Chip Debug Security ID The 78K0/FC2 has an on-chip debug operation control flag in the flash memory at 0084H (see CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE) and an on-chip debug security ID setting area at 0085H to 008EH. When the boot swap function is used, also set a value that is the same as that of 1084H and 1085H to 108EH in advance, because 0084H, 0085H to 008EH and 1084H, and 1085H to 108EH are switched. For details on the on-chip debug security ID, refer to the QB-78K0MINI User's Manual (U17029E). Table 24-1. On-Chip Debug Security ID Address 0085H to 008EH On-Chip Debug Security ID Any ID code of 10 bytes 1085H to 108EH 24.5 Restrictions and Cautions on On-Chip Debug Function When setting to on-chip debugging mode via the normal port, without using pins X1 and X2, two of the user ports will be unavailable for use. A high-level signal is always output from to the FLMD0 pin during emulation when self-writing. Be sure to connect a pull-down resistor to the FLMD0 pin, and manipulate this pin based on high/high impedance levels, rather than on high/low levels, when using ports for manipulation. In order to realize on-chip debug function, use the following user resource. (a) Flash memory area { Addresses 0x02 and 0x03 { Addresses 0x7E and 0x7F (when using a software break) { Address 0x84 { Addresses 0x85 to 0x8E { Addresses 0x8F to 0x18F: Standard value of program (+256 bytes when using pseudo real-time RAM monitor function) (when using a device with 10 or more SFRs the can be accessed in 16-bit units: +n (the number of exceeding registers x 6 bytes)) (b) Internal extended RAM area { Addresses 0xF7F0 to 0xF7FF (when using pseudo real-time RAM monitor function) (c) Internal high-speed RAM area { 7 bytes as stack area: Standard value of stack (+2 bytes when using software breaks) (+7 bytes when using pseudo real-time RAM monitor function) For details, refer to the QB-78K0MINI User's Manual (U17029E). 606 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET This chapter lists each instruction set of 78K0/FC2 in table form. For details of each operation and operation code, refer to the separate document 78K/0 Series Instructions User's Manual (U12326E). 25.1 Conventions Used in Operation List 25.1.1 Operand identifiers and specification methods Operands are written in the "Operand" column of each instruction in accordance with the specification method of the instruction operand identifier (refer to the assembler specifications for details). When there are two or more methods, select one of them. Upper case letters and the symbols #, !, $ and [ ] are keywords and must be written as they are. Each symbol has the following meaning. * #: Immediate data specification * !: Absolute address specification * $: Relative address specification * [ ]: Indirect address specification In the case of immediate data, describe an appropriate numeric value or a label. When using a label, be sure to write the #, !, $, and [ ] symbols. For operand register identifiers r and rp, either function names (X, A, C, etc.) or absolute names (names in parentheses in the table below, R0, R1, R2, etc.) can be used for specification. Table 25-1. Operand Identifiers and Specification Methods Identifier Specification Method r X (R0), A (R1), C (R2), B (R3), E (R4), D (R5), L (R6), H (R7), rp AX (RP0), BC (RP1), DE (RP2), HL (RP3) sfr Special function register symbol sfrp Special function register symbol (16-bit manipulatable register even addresses only) saddr FE20H to FF1FH Immediate data or labels saddrp FE20H to FF1FH Immediate data or labels (even address only) addr16 0000H to FFFFH Immediate data or labels Note Note (Only even addresses for 16-bit data transfer instructions) addr11 0800H to 0FFFH Immediate data or labels addr5 0040H to 007FH Immediate data or labels (even address only) word 16-bit immediate data or label byte 8-bit immediate data or label bit 3-bit immediate data or label RBn RB0 to RB3 Note Addresses from FFD0H to FFDFH cannot be accessed with these operands. Remark For special function register symbols, see Table 3-7. Special Function Register List. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 607 CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET 25.1.2 Description of operation column A: A register; 8-bit accumulator X: X register B: B register C: C register D: D register E: E register H: H register L: L register AX: AX register pair; 16-bit accumulator BC: BC register pair DE: DE register pair HL: HL register pair PC: Program counter SP: Stack pointer PSW: Program status word CY: Carry flag AC: Auxiliary carry flag Z: Zero flag RBS: Register bank select flag IE: Interrupt request enable flag ( ): Memory contents indicated by address or register contents in parentheses XH, XL: Higher 8 bits and lower 8 bits of 16-bit register : Logical product (AND) : Logical sum (OR) : Exclusive logical sum (exclusive OR) : Inverted data addr16: 16-bit immediate data or label jdisp8: Signed 8-bit data (displacement value) 25.1.3 Description of flag operation column (Blank): Not affected 0: Cleared to 0 1: Set to 1 x: Set/cleared according to the result R: Previously saved value is restored 608 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET 25.2 Operation List Instruction Mnemonic Group 8-bit data MOV transfer XCH Notes 1. Operands Clocks Bytes Note 1 Note 2 Z AC CY r, #byte 2 4 - r byte saddr, #byte 3 6 7 (saddr) byte sfr, #byte 3 - 7 sfr byte A, r Note 3 1 2 - Ar r, A Note 3 1 2 - rA A, saddr 2 4 5 A (saddr) saddr, A 2 4 5 (saddr) A A, sfr 2 - 5 A sfr sfr, A 2 - 5 sfr A A, !addr16 3 8 9 A (addr16) !addr16, A 3 8 9 (addr16) A PSW, #byte 3 - 7 PSW byte A, PSW 2 - 5 A PSW PSW, A 2 - 5 PSW A A, [DE] 1 4 5 A (DE) [DE], A 1 4 5 (DE) A A, [HL] 1 4 5 A (HL) [HL], A 1 4 5 (HL) A A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A (HL + byte) [HL + byte], A 2 8 9 (HL + byte) A A, [HL + B] 1 6 7 A (HL + B) [HL + B], A 1 6 7 (HL + B) A A, [HL + C] 1 6 7 A (HL + C) [HL + C], A 1 6 7 (HL + C) A 1 2 - Ar A, r Note 3 Flag Operation A, saddr 2 4 6 A (saddr) A, sfr 2 - 6 A (sfr) A, !addr16 3 8 10 A (addr16) A, [DE] 1 4 6 A (DE) A, [HL] 1 4 6 A (HL) A, [HL + byte] 2 8 10 A (HL + byte) A, [HL + B] 2 8 10 A (HL + B) A, [HL + C] 2 8 10 A (HL + C) x x x x x x When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access 2. When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed 3. Except "r = A" Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 609 CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group Operands Note 1 16-bit data MOVW transfer 3 6 - rp word 4 8 10 (saddrp) word sfrp, #word 4 - 10 sfrp word AX, saddrp 2 6 8 AX (saddrp) saddrp, AX 2 6 8 (saddrp) AX AX, sfrp 2 - 8 AX sfrp sfrp, AX 2 - 8 sfrp AX 4 - AX rp AX, rp Note 3 1 rp, AX Note 3 1 4 - rp AX 3 10 12 AX (addr16) 3 10 12 (addr16) AX 1 4 - AX rp 2 4 - A, CY A + byte x x x 3 6 8 (saddr), CY (saddr) + byte x x x 2 4 - A, CY A + r x x x 2 4 - r, CY r + A x x x XCHW AX, rp ADD A, #byte operation Note 3 saddr, #byte A, r Note 4 r, A ADDC Z AC CY Note 2 saddrp, #word !addr16, AX 8-bit A, saddr 2 4 5 A, CY A + (saddr) x x x A, !addr16 3 8 9 A, CY A + (addr16) x x x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A, CY A + (HL) x x x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A, CY A + (HL + byte) x x x A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A, CY A + (HL + B) x x x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A, CY A + (HL + C) x x x A, #byte 2 4 - A, CY A + byte + CY x x x 3 6 8 (saddr), CY (saddr) + byte + CY x x x 2 4 - A, CY A + r + CY x x x 2 4 - r, CY r + A + CY x x x saddr, #byte A, r r, A Note 4 A, saddr 2 4 5 A, CY A + (saddr) + CY x x x A, !addr16 3 8 9 A, CY A + (addr16) + C x x x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A, CY A + (HL) + CY x x x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A, CY A + (HL + byte) + CY x x x A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A, CY A + (HL + B) + CY x x x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A, CY A + (HL + C) + CY x x x When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access 2. When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed 3. Only when rp = BC, DE or HL 4. Except "r = A" Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. 610 Flag Operation rp, #word AX, !addr16 Notes 1. Clocks Bytes This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group Operands Note 1 8-bit SUB operation SUBC Z AC CY Note 2 2 4 - A, CY A - byte x x x saddr, #byte 3 6 8 (saddr), CY (saddr) - byte x x x 2 4 - A, CY A - r x x x r, A 2 4 - r, CY r - A x x x A, saddr 2 4 5 A, CY A - (saddr) x x x Note 3 A, !addr16 3 8 9 A, CY A - (addr16) x x x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A, CY A - (HL) x x x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A, CY A - (HL + byte) x x x A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A, CY A - (HL + B) x x x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A, CY A - (HL + C) x x x A, #byte 2 4 - A, CY A - byte - CY x x x saddr, #byte 3 6 8 (saddr), CY (saddr) - byte - CY x x x 2 4 - A, CY A - r - CY x x x r, A 2 4 - r, CY r - A - CY x x x A, saddr 2 4 5 A, CY A - (saddr) - CY x x x A, !addr16 3 8 9 A, CY A - (addr16) - CY x x x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A, CY A - (HL) - CY x x x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A, CY A - (HL + byte) - CY x x x A, r AND Flag Operation A, #byte A, r Note 3 A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A, CY A - (HL + B) - CY x x x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A, CY A - (HL + C) - CY x x x A, #byte 2 4 - A A byte x 3 6 8 (saddr) (saddr) byte x 2 4 - AAr x 2 4 - rrA x saddr, #byte A, r r, A Notes 1. Clocks Bytes Note 3 A, saddr 2 4 5 A A (saddr) x A, !addr16 3 8 9 A A (addr16) x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A A [HL] x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A A [HL + byte] x A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A A [HL + B] x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A A [HL + C] x When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access 2. When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed 3. Except "r = A" Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 611 CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group Operands Note 1 8-bit OR operation XOR Z AC CY Note 2 2 4 - A A byte x saddr, #byte 3 6 8 (saddr) (saddr) byte x 2 4 - AAr x r, A 2 4 - rrA x A, saddr 2 4 5 A A (saddr) x Note 3 A, !addr16 3 8 9 A A (addr16) x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A A (HL) x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A A (HL + byte) x A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A A (HL + B) x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A A (HL + C) x A, #byte 2 4 - A A byte x saddr, #byte 3 6 8 (saddr) (saddr) byte x 2 4 - AAr x r, A 2 4 - rrA x A, saddr 2 4 5 A A (saddr) x A, !addr16 3 8 9 A A (addr16) x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A A (HL) x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A A (HL + byte) x A, r CMP Note 3 A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A A (HL + B) x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A A (HL + C) x A, #byte 2 4 - A - byte x x x 3 6 8 (saddr) - byte x x x 2 4 - A-r x x x 2 4 - r-A x x x saddr, #byte A, r r, A Note 3 A, saddr 2 4 5 A - (saddr) x x x A, !addr16 3 8 9 A - (addr16) x x x A, [HL] 1 4 5 A - (HL) x x x A, [HL + byte] 2 8 9 A - (HL + byte) x x x A, [HL + B] 2 8 9 A - (HL + B) x x x A, [HL + C] 2 8 9 A - (HL + C) x x x When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access 2. When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed 3. Except "r = A" Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. 612 Flag Operation A, #byte A, r Notes 1. Clocks Bytes This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group Operands Clocks Bytes Note 1 Note 2 Flag Operation Z AC CY 16-bit ADDW AX, #word 3 6 - AX, CY AX + word x x x operation SUBW AX, #word 3 6 - AX, CY AX - word x x x CMPW AX, #word 3 6 - AX - word x x x Multiply/ MULU X 2 16 - AX A x X divide DIVUW C 2 25 - AX (Quotient), C (Remainder) AX / C Increment/ INC decrement DEC INCW Rotate r 1 2 - rr+1 x x saddr 2 4 6 (saddr) (saddr) + 1 x x r 1 2 - rr-1 x x saddr 2 4 6 (saddr) (saddr) - 1 x x rp 1 4 - rp rp + 1 DECW rp 1 4 - rp rp - 1 ROR A, 1 1 2 - (CY, A7 A0, Am - 1 Am) x 1 time x ROL A, 1 1 2 - (CY, A0 A7, Am + 1 Am) x 1 time x RORC A, 1 1 2 - (CY A0, A7 CY, Am - 1 Am) x 1 time x ROLC A, 1 1 2 - (CY A7, A0 CY, Am + 1 Am) x 1 time x ROR4 [HL] 2 10 12 A3 - 0 (HL)3 - 0, (HL)7 - 4 A3 - 0, (HL)3 - 0 (HL)7 - 4 ROL4 [HL] 2 10 12 A3 - 0 (HL)7 - 4, (HL)3 - 0 A3 - 0, (HL)7 - 4 (HL)3 - 0 BCD ADJBA adjustment ADJBS Bit MOV1 manipulate Notes 1. 2. 2 4 - Decimal Adjust Accumulator after Addition x x x x x 2 4 - Decimal Adjust Accumulator after Subtract CY, saddr.bit 3 6 7 CY (saddr.bit) x CY, sfr.bit 3 - 7 CY sfr.bit x CY, A.bit 2 4 - CY A.bit x CY, PSW.bit 3 - 7 CY PSW.bit x CY, [HL].bit 2 6 7 CY (HL).bit x saddr.bit, CY 3 6 8 (saddr.bit) CY sfr.bit, CY 3 - 8 sfr.bit CY A.bit, CY 2 4 - A.bit CY PSW.bit, CY 3 - 8 PSW.bit CY [HL].bit, CY 2 6 8 (HL).bit CY x x x When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 613 CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group AND1 manipulate OR1 XOR1 SET1 CLR1 2. Clocks Bytes Note 1 Bit Notes 1. Operands Z AC CY Note 2 CY, saddr.bit 3 6 7 CY CY saddr.bit) x CY, sfr.bit 3 - 7 CY CY sfr.bit x CY, A.bit 2 4 - CY CY A.bit x CY, PSW.bit 3 - 7 CY CY PSW.bit x CY, [HL].bit 2 6 7 CY CY (HL).bit x CY, saddr.bit 3 6 7 CY CY (saddr.bit) x CY, sfr.bit 3 - 7 CY CY sfr.bit x CY, A.bit 2 4 - CY CY A.bit x CY, PSW.bit 3 - 7 CY CY PSW.bit x CY, [HL].bit 2 6 7 CY CY (HL).bit x CY, saddr.bit 3 6 7 CY CY (saddr.bit) x CY, sfr.bit 3 - 7 CY CY sfr.bit x CY, A.bit 2 4 - CY CY A.bit x CY, PSW. bit 3 - 7 CY CY PSW.bit x CY, [HL].bit 2 6 7 CY CY (HL).bit x saddr.bit 2 4 6 (saddr.bit) 1 sfr.bit 3 - 8 sfr.bit 1 A.bit 2 4 - A.bit 1 PSW.bit 2 - 6 PSW.bit 1 [HL].bit 2 6 8 (HL).bit 1 saddr.bit 2 4 6 (saddr.bit) 0 sfr.bit 3 - 8 sfr.bit 0 A.bit 2 4 - A.bit 0 PSW.bit 2 - 6 PSW.bit 0 x x x x x x [HL].bit 2 6 8 (HL).bit 0 SET1 CY 1 2 - CY 1 CLR1 CY 1 2 - CY 0 0 NOT1 CY 1 2 - CY CY x 1 When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. 614 Flag Operation This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group Call/return CALL Operands !addr16 Clocks Bytes 3 Note 1 Note 2 7 - Operation Flag Z AC CY (SP - 1) (PC + 3)H, (SP - 2) (PC + 3)L, PC addr16, SP SP - 2 CALLF !addr11 2 5 - (SP - 1) (PC + 2)H, (SP - 2) (PC + 2)L, PC15 - 11 00001, PC10 - 0 addr11, SP SP - 2 CALLT [addr5] 1 6 - (SP - 1) (PC + 1)H, (SP - 2) (PC + 1)L, PCH (00000000, addr5 + 1), PCL (00000000, addr5), SP SP - 2 BRK 1 6 - (SP - 1) PSW, (SP - 2) (PC + 1)H, (SP - 3) (PC + 1)L, PCH (003FH), PCL (003EH), SP SP - 3, IE 0 RET 1 6 - PCH (SP + 1), PCL (SP), SP SP + 2 RETI 1 6 - PCH (SP + 1), PCL (SP), R R R PSW (SP + 2), SP SP + 3 RETB 1 6 - PCH (SP + 1), PCL (SP), R R R PSW (SP + 2), SP SP + 3 Stack PUSH manipulate PSW rp 1 1 2 - 4 - (SP - 1) PSW, SP SP - 1 (SP - 1) rpH, (SP - 2) rpL, SP SP - 2 POP PSW 1 2 - rp 1 4 - PSW (SP), SP SP + 1 R R R rpH (SP + 1), rpL (SP), SP SP + 2 MOVW SP, #word 4 - 10 SP word SP, AX 2 - 8 SP AX AX, SP 2 - 8 AX SP Unconditional BR !addr16 3 6 - PC addr16 branch $addr16 2 6 - PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 - PCH A, PCL X AX 2 8 Conditional BC $addr16 2 6 - PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 if CY = 1 branch BNC $addr16 2 6 - PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 if CY = 0 BZ $addr16 2 6 - PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 if Z = 1 BNZ $addr16 2 6 - PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 if Z = 0 Notes 1. 2. When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 615 CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET Instruction Mnemonic Group Operands Clocks Bytes Note 1 Z AC CY Note 2 Conditional BT saddr.bit, $addr16 3 8 9 PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if(saddr.bit) = 1 branch sfr.bit, $addr16 4 - 11 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if sfr.bit = 1 A.bit, $addr16 3 8 - PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if A.bit = 1 PSW.bit, $addr16 3 - 9 PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if PSW.bit = 1 [HL].bit, $addr16 3 10 11 PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if (HL).bit = 1 saddr.bit, $addr16 4 10 11 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if(saddr.bit) = 0 sfr.bit, $addr16 4 - 11 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if sfr.bit = 0 A.bit, $addr16 3 8 - PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if A.bit = 0 BF BTCLR Flag Operation PSW.bit, $addr16 4 - 11 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if PSW. bit = 0 [HL].bit, $addr16 3 10 11 PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if (HL).bit = 0 saddr.bit, $addr16 4 10 12 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if(saddr.bit) = 1 then reset(saddr.bit) sfr.bit, $addr16 4 - 12 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if sfr.bit = 1 then reset sfr.bit A.bit, $addr16 3 8 - PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if A.bit = 1 then reset A.bit PSW.bit, $addr16 4 - 12 PC PC + 4 + jdisp8 if PSW.bit = 1 x x x then reset PSW.bit [HL].bit, $addr16 3 10 12 PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if (HL).bit = 1 then reset (HL).bit DBNZ B, $addr16 2 6 - B B - 1, then PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 if B 0 C, $addr16 2 6 - C C -1, then Saddr, $addr16 3 8 10 (saddr) (saddr) - 1, then PC PC + 2 + jdisp8 if C 0 PC PC + 3 + jdisp8 if(saddr) 0 CPU SEL 2 4 - RBS1, 0 n control NOP 1 2 - No Operation EI 2 - 6 IE 1(Enable Interrupt) DI 2 - 6 IE 0(Disable Interrupt) HALT 2 6 - Set HALT Mode STOP 2 6 - Set STOP Mode Notes 1. 2. RBn When the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed or for an instruction with no data access When an area except the internal high-speed RAM area is accessed Remarks 1. One instruction clock cycle is one cycle of the CPU clock (fCPU) selected by the processor clock control register (PCC). 2. 616 This clock cycle applies to the internal ROM program. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET 25.3 Instructions Listed by Addressing Type (1) 8-bit instructions MOV, XCH, ADD, ADDC, SUB, SUBC, AND, OR, XOR, CMP, MULU, DIVUW, INC, DEC, ROR, ROL, RORC, ROLC, ROR4, ROL4, PUSH, POP, DBNZ Second Operand #byte A rNote sfr saddr !addr16 PSW [DE] [HL] [HL + byte] $addr16 1 None [HL + B] First Operand A r [HL + C] ADD MOV MOV MOV MOV ADDC XCH XCH XCH XCH SUB ADD ADD ADD SUBC ADDC ADDC ADDC ADDC ADDC AND SUB SUB SUB OR SUBC SUBC SUBC SUBC SUBC XOR AND AND AND AND AND CMP OR OR OR OR OR XOR XOR XOR XOR XOR CMP CMP CMP CMP CMP MOV MOV SUB MOV MOV MOV ROR XCH XCH XCH ROL ADD ADD RORC ROLC SUB MOV INC ADD DEC ADDC SUB SUBC AND OR XOR CMP B, C DBNZ sfr MOV MOV saddr MOV MOV DBNZ INC DEC ADD ADDC SUB SUBC AND OR XOR CMP !addr16 PSW MOV MOV PUSH MOV POP [DE] MOV [HL] MOV ROR4 ROL4 [HL + byte] MOV [HL + B] [HL + C] X MULU C DIVUW Note Except "r = A" User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 617 CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET (2) 16-bit instructions MOVW, XCHW, ADDW, SUBW, CMPW, PUSH, POP, INCW, DECW Second Operand #word AX rp Note sfrp saddrp !addr16 SP None First Operand AX ADDW MOVW SUBW XCHW MOVW MOVW MOVW MOVW CMPW rp MOVW MOVW Note INCW DECW PUSH POP Sfrp MOVW MOVW saddrp MOVW MOVW !addr16 SP MOVW MOVW Note MOVW Only when rp = BC, DE, HL (3) Bit manipulation instructions MOV1, AND1, OR1, XOR1, SET1, CLR1, NOT1, BT, BF, BTCLR Second Operand A.bit sfr.bit saddr.bit PSW.bit [HL].bit CY $addr16 None First Operand A.bit MOV1 BT SET1 BF CLR1 BTCLR sfr.bit MOV1 BT SET1 BF CLR1 BTCLR saddr.bit MOV1 BT SET1 BF CLR1 BTCLR PSW.bit MOV1 BT SET1 BF CLR1 BTCLR [HL].bit MOV1 BT SET1 BF CLR1 BTCLR CY 618 MOV1 MOV1 MOV1 MOV1 MOV1 SET1 AND1 AND1 AND1 AND1 AND1 CLR1 OR1 OR1 OR1 OR1 OR1 NOT1 XOR1 XOR1 XOR1 XOR1 XOR1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 25 INSTRUCTION SET (4) Call instructions/branch instructions CALL, CALLF, CALLT, BR, BC, BNC, BZ, BNZ, BT, BF, BTCLR, DBNZ Second Operand AX !addr16 !addr11 [addr5] $addr16 First Operand Basic instruction BR CALL CALLF CALLT BR BR BC BNC BZ BNZ Compound BT instruction BF BTCLR DBNZ (5) Other instructions ADJBA, ADJBS, BRK, RET, RETI, RETB, SEL, NOP, EI, DI, HALT, STOP User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 619 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) 26.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Absolute Maximum Ratings (TA = 25C) (1/2) Parameter Supply voltage Symbol Conditions Ratings Unit VDD -0.5 to +6.5 V EVDD -0.5 to +6.5 V VSS -0.5 to +0.3 V EVSS -0.5 to +0.3 -0.5 to VDD +0.3 AVREF REGC pin V Note1 V AVSS -0.5 to +0.3 V VREGC -0.5 to +3.6 V and VDD Input voltage Input voltage VI1 -0.3 to VDD +0.3 P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, Note1 V P40, P41, P70 to P73, P80 to P87, P90, P120, P131, X1, X2, XT1, XT2, RESET, FLMD0 VI2 Output voltage P60 to P63 -0.3 to +6.5 N-ch open drain -0.3 to VDD +0.3 VO Analog input voltage VAN ANI0 to ANI8 V Note1 -0.3 to AVREF +0.3 Note2 Note1 and -0.3 to VDD +0.3 Output current, high IOH Per pin P00, P01, P06, V V Note1 -10 mA -55 mA -25 mA -0.5 mA P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Total of all pins P06, P10 to P17, -80 mA P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 IOH2 Per pin P80 to P87, P90 -2 Total of all pins IOH3 Per pin P121 to P124 Total of all pins -1 mA -4 Notes 1. Must be 6.5 V or lower. 2. ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885 and 78F0886 only. Cautions 1. Product quality may suffer if the absolute maximum rating is exceeded even momentarily for any parameter. That is, the absolute maximum ratings are rated values at which the product is on the verge of suffering physical damage, and therefore the product must be used under conditions that ensure that the absolute maximum ratings are not exceeded. 2. P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. 620 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) Absolute Maximum Ratings (TA = 25C) (2/2) Parameter Output current, low Symbol IOL Conditions Per pin P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, Ratings Unit 30 mA 140 mA 60 mA 1 mA P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Total of P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, all pins P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 200 mA P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 IOL2 Per pin P80 to P87, P90 All pins IOL3 Per pin 5 P121 to P124 All pins Operating ambient TA temperature Storage temperature 4 10 In normal operation mode -40 to +85 In flash memory programming mode -40 to +85 -65 to +150 Tstg mA C C Cautions 1. Product quality may suffer if the absolute maximum rating is exceeded even momentarily for any parameter. That is, the absolute maximum ratings are rated values at which the product is on the verge of suffering physical damage, and therefore the product must be used under conditions that ensure that the absolute maximum ratings are not exceeded. 2. P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 621 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) 26.2 Oscillator Characteristics (1) Main System Clock (Crystal/Ceramic) Oscillator Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Resonator Recommended Circuit Ceramic resonator Parameter X1 clock VSS X1 X2 Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit MHz 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 4.0 20 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 4.0 10 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 4.0 5.0 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 4.0 20 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 4.0 10 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 4.0 5.0 oscillation Note frequency (fX) C1 C2 Crystal resonator X1 clock VSS X1 X2 MHz oscillation Note frequency (fX) C1 C2 Note Indicates only oscillator characteristics. Refer to AC Characteristics for instruction execution time. Cautions 1. When using the X1 oscillator, wire as follows in the area enclosed by the broken lines in the above figures to avoid an adverse effect from wiring capacitance. * Keep the wiring length as short as possible. * Do not cross the wiring with the other signal lines. * Do not route the wiring near a signal line through which a high fluctuating current flows. * Always make the ground point of the oscillator capacitor the same potential as VSS. * Do not ground the capacitor to a ground pattern through which a high current flows. * Do not fetch signals from the oscillator. 2. Since the CPU is started by the 8 MHz internal oscillator after reset, check the oscillation stabilization time of the main system clock using the oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC). Determine the oscillation stabilization time of the OSTC register and oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) after sufficiently evaluating the oscillation stabilization time with the resonator to be used. Remark For the resonator selection and oscillator constant, customers are requested to either evaluate the oscillation themselves or apply to the resonator manufacturer for evaluation. 622 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) (2) On-chip Internal Oscillator Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Resonator Parameter Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V 7.6 8 8.4 MHz 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 7.6 8 10.4 MHz RSTS = 0 2.48 5.6 9.86 MHz Internal low-speed oscillation 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V 216 240 264 kHz clock frequency (fRL) 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 192 240 264 kHz Internal high-speed oscillation RSTS = 1 8 MHz internal oscillator Note clock frequency (fRH) 240 kHz internal oscillator Note Indicates only oscillator characteristics. Refer to AC Characteristics for instruction execution time. Remark RSTS: Bit 7 of the internal oscillation mode register (RCM) (3) Subsystem Clock Oscillator Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Resonator Crystal resonator Recommended Circuit VSS XT2 XT1 Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 32 32.768 35 kHz Note frequency (fXT) Rd C4 Parameter XT1 clock oscillation C3 Note Indicates only oscillator characteristics. Refer to AC Characteristics for instruction execution time. Cautions 1. When using the XT1 oscillator, wire as follows in the area enclosed by the broken lines in the above figures to avoid an adverse effect from wiring capacitance. * Keep the wiring length as short as possible. * Do not cross the wiring with the other signal lines. * Do not route the wiring near a signal line through which a high fluctuating current flows. * Always make the ground point of the oscillator capacitor the same potential as VSS. * Do not ground the capacitor to a ground pattern through which a high current flows. * Do not fetch signals from the oscillator. 2. The subsystem clock oscillator is designed as a low-amplitude circuit for reducing power consumption, and is more prone to malfunction due to noise than the high-speed system clock oscillator. Particular care is therefore required with the wiring method when the subsystem clock is used. Remark For the resonator selection and oscillator constant, customers are requested to either evaluate the oscillation themselves or apply to the resonator manufacturer for evaluation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 623 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) 26.3 DC Characteristics DC Characteristics (1/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 4.0 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note 1 Output current, high IOH1 Conditions MIN. TYP. Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, MAX. Unit -3.0 mA -18.0 mA -12.0 mA -23.0 mA -100 A 8.5 mA 15 mA 45 mA 20 mA 65 mA 400 A P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOH2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Output current, low Note3 Note3 IOL1 Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Per pin for P60 to P63 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOL2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Notes 1. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from VDD to an output pin. 2. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from an output pin to GND. 3. Specification under conditions where the duty factor is 70% (time for which current is output is 0.7 x t and time for which current is not output is 0.3 x t, where t is a specific time). The total output current of the pins at a duty factor of other than 70% can be calculated by the following expression. * Where the duty factor of IOH is n%: Total output current of pins = (IOH x 0.7) / (n x 0.01) Where the duty factor is 50%, IOH = 20.0 mA Total output current of pins = (20.0 x 0.7) / (50 x 0.01) = 28.0 mA However, the current that is allowed to flow into one pin does not vary depending on the duty factor. A current higher than the absolute maximum rating must not flow into one pin. Caution Remark P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. High level output current and low level current are the spec in Duty = 70% conditions. 624 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (2/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD < 4.0 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note 1 Output current, high IOH1 Conditions MIN. TYP. Per pin for P00, P01,P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, MAX. Unit -2.5 mA -15.0 mA -7.0 mA -18.0 mA -100 A 5.0 mA 35 mA P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOH2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Output current, low Note3 IOL1 Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 15 mA Note2 Total of pins 50 mA Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 400 A Total of pins IOL2 P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Notes 1. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from VDD to an output pin. 2. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from an output pin to GND. 3. Specification under conditions where the duty factor is 70% (time for which current is output is 0.7 x t and time for which current is not output is 0.3 x t, where t is a specific time). The total output current of the pins at a duty factor of other than 70% can be calculated by the following expression. * Where the duty factor of IOH is n%: Total output current of pins = (IOH x 0.7) / (n x 0.01) Where the duty factor is 50%, IOH = 20.0 mA Total output current of pins = (20.0 x 0.7) / (50 x 0.01) = 28.0 mA However, the current that is allowed to flow into one pin does not vary depending on the duty factor. A current higher than the absolute maximum rating must not flow into one pin. Caution P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. High level output current and low level current are the spec in Duty = 70% conditions. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 625 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (3/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD < 2.7 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note 1 Output current, high IOH1 Conditions MIN. TYP. Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, MAX. Unit -1.0 mA -10 mA -5.0 mA -15 mA -100 A 2.0 mA 20 mA P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOH2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Output current, low Note3 IOL1 Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17 P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 9 mA Note2 Total of pins 29 mA Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 400 A Total of pins IOL2 P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Notes 1. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from VDD to an output pin. 2. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from an output pin to GND. 3. Specification under conditions where the duty factor is 70% (time for which current is output is 0.7 x t and time for which current is not output is 0.3 x t, where t is a specific time). The total output current of the pins at a duty factor of other than 70% can be calculated by the following expression. * Where the duty factor of IOH is n%: Total output current of pins = (IOH x 0.7) / (n x 0.01) Where the duty factor is 50%, IOH = 20.0 mA Total output current of pins = (20.0 x 0.7) / (50 x 0.01) = 28.0 mA However, the current that is allowed to flow into one pin does not vary depending on the duty factor. A current higher than the absolute maximum rating must not flow into one pin. Caution P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. High level output current and low level current are the spec in Duty = 70% conditions. 626 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (4/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Input voltage, high Input voltage, low Output voltage, high Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit VIH1 P12, P13, P15, P40, P41, P70, P121 to P124 0.7VDD VDD V VIH2 P00, P01, P06, P10, P11, P14, P16, P17, P30 to P33, P71 to P73, P120, P131, RESET, EXCLK, EXCLKS 0.8VDD VDD V VIH3 P80 to P87, P90 0.7AVREF AVREF V VIH4 P60 to P63 0.7VDD 6.0 V VIL1 P12, P13, P15, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70, P121 to P124 0 0.3VDD V VIL2 P00, P01, P06, P10, P11, P14, P16, P17, P30 to P33, P71 to P73, P120, P131, RESET, EXCLK, EXCLKS 0 0.2VDD V VIL3 P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD 0 0.3AVREF V VOH1 IOH = -3.0 mA P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, IOH = -2.5 mA P30 to P33, P40, IOH = -1.0 mA P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V VDD - 0.7 V 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V VDD - 0.5 V 1.8 V VDD 2.7V VDD - 0.5 V VDD - 0.5 V VOH2 IOH = -100 A P80 to P87, P90 VOL1 IOL = 8.5 mA AVREF = VDD AVREF = VDD P121 to P124 Output voltage, low IOL = 5.0 mA IOL = 2.0 mA IOL = 1.0 mA P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 IOL = 0.5 mA VOL2 IOL = 400 A P80 to P87, P90 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.7 V 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.7 V 1.8 V VDD 2.7 V 0.5 V 1.8 V VDD 2.7 V 0.5 V 1.8 V VDD 2.7 V 0.4 V AVREF = VDD 0.4 V 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 2.0 V P121 to P124 VOL3 IOL = 15 mA P60 to P63 IOL = 5.0 mA Caution 0.4 V IOL = 5.0 mA 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.6 V IOL = 3.0 mA 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.4 V IOL = 2.0 mA 1.8 V VDD 2.7 V 0.4 V P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 627 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (5/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Input leakage current, Symbol Conditions TYP. MAX. Unit ILIH1 VI = VDD P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P131, RESET, FLMD0 1 A ILIH2 VI = AVREF P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD 1 A ILIH3 VI = VDD P121 to P124 I/O port mode 1 A (X1, X2, XT1, XT2) OSC port mode 20 A P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, -1 A high Input leakage current, MIN. ILIL1 VI = VSS P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, low P131, RESET, FLMD0 ILIL2 ILIL3 P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD -1 A P121 to P124 I/O port mode -1 A (X1, X2, XT1, XT2) OSC port mode -20 A 100 k Pull-up resistor RU VI = VSS 10 20 FLMD0 supply voltage VIL In normal operation mode 0 0.2VDD V VIH In self programming mode 0.8 VDD VDD V Caution P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. 628 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (6/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, 2.3 V AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Supply current Note 1 Symbol IDD1 Conditions Operating mode Note 2 fXH = 20 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes 2, 3 fXH = 10 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes 2, 3 fXH = 10 MHz , VDD = 3.0 V Notes 2, 3 fXH = 5 MHz , VDD = 3.0 V Notes 2, 3 fXH = 5 MHz , VDD = 2.0 V fRH = 8 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V HALT mode Note 2 fXH = 20 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes 2, 3 fXH = 10 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes 2, 3 fXH = 5 MHz , VDD = 3.0 V fRH = 8 MHz Notes 1. STOP mode Resonator connection 4.7 8.2 Square wave input 1.8 3.6 Resonator connection 2.5 4.7 Square wave input 1.7 3.5 Resonator connection 2.4 4.0 Square wave input 1.0 2.0 Resonator connection 1.4 2.4 Square wave input 0.8 1.7 Resonator connection 1.1 1.9 1.5 2.7 mA 6 30 A Square wave input Resonator connection 15 35 Square wave input 1.0 3.9 Resonator connection 2.2 5.7 Square wave input 0.6 2.0 Note 5 , mA mA mA mA mA mA Resonator connection 1.2 3.1 Square wave input 0.3 1.0 Resonator connection 0.6 1.5 0.5 1.4 mA Square wave input 3.0 27 A Resonator connection 12 32 1 20 , VDD = 5.0 V VDD = 5.0 V Note 6 6.8 Note 4 fSUB = 32.768 kHz IDD3 3.4 , VDD = 5.0 V Note 5 mA Square wave input Note 4 fSUB = 32.768 kHz IDD2 MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit VDD = 5.0 V mA A Total current flowing into the internal power supply (VDD, EVDD), including the peripheral operation current and the input leakage current flowing when the level of the input pin are fixed to VDD or VSS. However, the current flowing into the pull-up resistors and the output current of the port is not included. 2. Not including the operating current of the 8 MHz internal oscillator, XT1 oscillation, 240 kHz internal oscillator and the current flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer and LVI circuit. 3. When AMPH (bit 0 of clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL)) = 0. 4. Not including the operating current of the X1 oscillation, XT1 oscillation and 240 kHz internal oscillator. 5. Not including the operating current of the X1 oscillation, 8 MHz internal oscillator and 240 kHz internal 6. Not including the operating current of the 240 kHz internal oscillator and XT1 oscillation, and the current Not including the current flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer, LVI circuit and CAN controller. oscillator, and the current flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer and LVI circuit. flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer and LVI circuit. Remarks 1. fXH: High-speed system clock frequency (X1 clock oscillation frequency or external main system clock frequency) 2. fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock frequency 3. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency (XT1 clock oscillation frequency or external subsystem clock frequency) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 629 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (7/7) (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, 2.3 V AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter A/D converter Symbol IADC Conditions Note 1 ADCE = 1 Note 2 During 240 kHz internal low-speed oscillation clock operation MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 0.86 1.9 mA 5 10 A 9 18 A operating current Watchdog timer IWDT operating current LVI operating Note 3 ILVI current Notes 1. Current flowing only to the A/D converter (AVREF-pin). The current value of the 78K0/FC2 is the sum of 2. Current flowing only to the watchdog timer (VDD-pin) (including the operating current of the 240 kHz IDD1 or IDD2 and IADC when the A/D converter operates in an operation mode or the HALT mode. internal oscillator). The current value of the 78K0/FC2 is the sum of IDD2 or IDD3 and IWDT when the watchdog timer operates in the HALT or STOP mode. 3. Current flowing only to the LVI circuit (VDD-pin). The current value of the 78K0/FC2 is the sum of IDD2 or IDD3 and ILVI when the LVI circuit operates in the HALT or STOP mode. 630 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) 26.4 AC Characteristics (1) Basic operation (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Instruction cycle (minimum Symbol TCY instruction execution time) Conditions MAX. Unit Main system clock (fXP) 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.1 8 s 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 0.2 8 s 8 s 125 s 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 20 MHz 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 10 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 5 Subsystem clock (fSUB) operation fPRS TYP. operation 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V Peripheral hardware clock MIN. fPRS = fXH frequency 0.4 Note1 114 122 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V 7.6 8.4 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 7.6 10.4 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 4.0 20 MHz 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 4.0 10 MHz 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 4.0 5 MHz fPRS = fRH MHz Note2 External main system clock fEXT frequency External clock input high level fEXTH, 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 24 width, low level width fEXTL 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 48 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 96 External subsystem clock ns fEXTS 32 External sub clock input high fEXTSH, 12 s level width, low level width fEXTSL 2/fsam + s 32.768 35 kHz frequency TI000, TI010, TI011 input high- tTIH0, level width, low-level width tTIL0 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.1 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V fTI5 Note3 s 2/fsam + 0.5 TI50, TI51 input frequency s 2/fsam + 0.2 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V Note3 Note3 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 10 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 10 MHz 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 5 MHz MHz TI50, TI51 input high-level width, tTIH5, 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 50 ns low-level width 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 50 ns 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 100 ns 1 s 10 s tTIL5 Interrupt input high-level width, tINIH, low-level width tINIL RESET low-level width tRSL Notes 1. 2. 3. 0.38 s when operating with the 8 MHz internal oscillator. This spec is a definition of the main system clock. Therefore, peripheral hardware must use the clock of fRH/2 or less. (VDD = 1.8 V or less) TI sampling with selection count clock (fPRS, fPRS/4, fPRS/256) using bits 0 and 1 (PRM0n0, PRM0n1) of prescaler mode registers 00 (PRM0n). Note that when selecting the TI0n0 valid edge as the count clock, fsam = fPRS (n = 0, 1). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 631 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) TCY vs. VDD (Main System Clock Operation) Cycle time TCY [ s] 20.0 10.0 8.0 5.0 2.0 Guaranteed operation range 1.0 0.4 0.2 0.1 0 1.0 2.0 3.0 2.7 1.8 4.0 5.0 Supply voltage VDD [V] 632 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 6.0 5.5 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) AC Timing Test Points (Excluding X1, XT1) 0.8VDD 0.8VDD Test points 0.2VDD 0.2VDD External clock input timing 1/fEXT tEXTL tEXTH 0.8VDD EXCLK 0.2VDD 1/fEXTS tEXTSL tEXTSH 0.8VDD 0.2VDD EXCLKS TI Timing tTIL0 tTIH0 TI000, TI010, TI011 1/fTI5 tTIL5 tTIH5 tINTL tINTH TI50, TI51 Interrupt Request Input Timing INTP0 to INTP7 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 633 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) RESET Input Timing tRSL RESET (2) Serial interface (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) (a) UART mode (UART6n, dedicated baud rate generator output) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. Transfer rate Remark MAX. Unit 625 kbps MAX. Unit n = 0, 1 (b) 3-wire serial I/O mode (master mode, SCK10... internal clock output) Parameter Symbol SCK10 cycle time SCK10 high-/low-level width tKCY1 Note1 SI10 setup time (to SCK10) Conditions MIN. 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 200 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 400 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 600 tKH1, 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V tKCY1/2 - 20 tKL1 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V tKCY1/2 - 30 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V tKCY1/2 - 60 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 70 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 100 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 190 tSIK1 SI10 hold time (from SCK10) tKSI1 Delay time from SCK10 to tKSO1 TYP. ns ns ns 30 ns Note2 C = 50 pF 40 ns MAX. Unit SO10 output Notes 1. It is value at the time of fX use. Keep in mind that spec different at the time of fOSC8 use. 2. C is the load capacitance of the SCK10 and SO10 output lines. (c) 3-wire serial I/O mode (slave mode, SCK10... external clock input) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. SCK10 cycle time tKCY2 400 ns SCK10 high-/low-level width tKH2, tKCY2/2 ns 80 ns 50 ns tKL2 SI10 setup time (to SCK10) tSIK2 SI10 hold time (from SCK10) tKSI2 Delay time from SCK10 to tKSO2 Note C = 50 pF SO10 output 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 120 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 120 1.8 V VDD < 2.7 V 180 Note C is the load capacitance of the SO10 output line. 634 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD ns CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) Serial Transfer Timing 3-wire serial I/O mode: tKCYm tKLm tKHm SCK10 tSIKm SI10 tKSIm Input data tKSOm SO10 Remark Output data m = 1, 2 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 635 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) (3) CAN controller (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. Transfer rate Internal delay time tNODE note CAN Internal clock toutput CTxD pin (Transfer data) tinput CRxD pin (Receive data) Internal delay time (tNODE) = Internal Transfer Delay (toutput) + Internal Receive Delay (tinput) Note CAN Internal clock (fCAN): CAN baud rate clock 78K0/FC2 CTxD pin Internal Transfer Delay CAN macro Internal Receive Delay CRxD pin Image figure of internal delay 636 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD MAX. Unit 1 Mbps 100 ns CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) (4) A/D Converter Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, 1.8 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, 2.3 V AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Resolution Overall error AINL Conversion time tCONV Notes 1, 2 Zero-scale error Full-scale error EZS Notes 1, 2 EFS Note 1 Integral non-linearity error Differential non-linearity error Analog input voltage 2. MIN. MAX. Unit 10 bit 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 0.4 %FSR 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 0.6 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 1.2 RES Notes 1, 2 Notes 1. Conditions ILE Note 1 DLE VAIN TYP. 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 6.1 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 12.2 36.7 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 27 66.6 36.7 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 0.4 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 0.6 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 0.6 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 0.4 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 0.6 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 0.6 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 2.5 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 4.5 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 6.5 4.0 V AVREF 5.5 V 1.5 2.7 V AVREF < 4.0 V 2.0 2.3 V AVREF < 2.7 V 2.0 2.3 V AVREF 5.5 V AVSS AVREF s %FSR %FSR LSB LSB V Excludes quantization error (1/2 LSB). This value is indicated as a ratio (%FSR) to the full-scale value. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 637 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) (5) POC Circuit Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, VSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Detection voltage VPOC0 Power supply rise time tPTH Minimum pulse width tPW Conditions VDD: 0 V VPOC0 MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 1.44 1.59 1.74 V 0.5 V/ms 200 s POC Circuit Timing Supply voltage (VDD) Detection voltage (MAX.) Detection voltage (TYP.) Detection voltage (MIN.) tPW tPTH Time Caution Spec may change after device evaluation. 638 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) (6) LVI Circuit Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, VPOC VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = 0 V) Parameter Detection Symbol Supply voltage level voltage External input pin Note 1 Detection voltage on Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit VLVI0 4.14 4.24 4.34 V VLVI1 3.99 4.09 4.19 V VLVI2 3.83 3.93 4.03 V VLVI3 3.68 3.78 3.88 V VLVI4 3.52 3.62 3.72 V VLVI5 3.37 3.47 3.57 V VLVI6 3.22 3.32 3.42 V VLVI7 3.06 3.16 3.26 V VLVI8 2.91 3.01 3.11 V VLVI9 2.75 2.85 2.95 V VLVI10 2.60 2.70 2.80 V VLVI11 2.45 2.55 2.65 V VLVI12 2.29 2.39 2.49 V VLVI13 2.14 2.24 2.34 V VLVI14 1.98 2.08 2.18 V VLVI15 1.83 1.93 2.03 V EXLVI EXLVI < VDD, 1.8 V VDD 5.5 V 1.11 1.21 1.31 V VDDLVI LVISTART (option bye) = 1 2.50 2.70 2.90 V application of supply voltage Minimum pulse width tLW Note 2 Operation stabilization wait time s 200 tLWAIT1 10 s Notes 1. External input pin is alternate P120/INTP pin. 2. Time required from setting LVION to 1 to operation stabilization. Remarks 1. VLVIn-1 > VLVIn (n = 1 to 15) 2. VPOC < VLVIm (VPOC : Power-on clear detection voltage, m = 0 to 15) LVI Circuit Timing Supply voltage (VDD) Detection voltage (MAX.) Detection voltage (TYP.) Detection voltage (MIN.) tLWAIT1 LVION < -1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD tLW Time 639 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) (7) Power Supply Starting Time (TA = -40 to +85C, VSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note Starting maximum time to VDD min (1.8 V) tPUP1 Conditions MIN. TYP. LVI starting option invalid MAX. Unit 3.6 ms 1.9 ms When pin RESET intact (VDD: 0 V1.8 V) Note Starting maximum time to VDD min (1.8 V) tPUP2 LVI starting option invalid When pin RESET use (pin RESET releaseVDD: 1.8 V) Note Start a power supply in time shorter than this when LVI staring option invalid. VDD VDD 1.8 V 1.8 V 0V 0V POC POC TPUP1 RESET pin TPUP2 Pin RESET intact 640 Pin RESET use User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) 26.5 Data Retention Characteristics Data Memory STOP Mode Low Supply Voltage Data Retention Characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C) Parameter Data retention supply voltage Symbol Conditions MIN. 1.44 VDDDR TYP. Note MAX. Unit 5.5 V Note The value depends on the POC detection voltage. When the voltage drops, the data is retained until a POC reset is effected, but data is not retained when a POC reset is effected. Data Retention Timing STOP mode Operation Data retention characteristics VDD STOP instruction execution VDDDR Standby release signal (Interrupt request) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 641 CHAPTER 26 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A) GRADE PRODUCTS) 26.6 Flash EEPROM Programming Characteristics (1) Basic characteristics (TA = -40 to +85C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = 0 V) Parameter VDD supply current Notes 1, 2 Erase time Symbol IDD Conditions MIN. fXP = 10 MHz (TYP.), 20 MHz (MAX.) TYP. MAX. Unit 4.5 11.0 mA All block Teraca 20 200 ms Block unit Terasa 20 200 ms Note 1 Write time (in 8-bit units) Twrwa 10 100 s Number of rewrites per chip Cerwr Retention: 15 years 100 Times Note 3 1 erase + 1 write after erase = 1 rewrite Notes 1. Characteristic of the flash memory. For the characteristic when a dedicated flash memory programmer, PG-FP4, is used and the rewrite time during self programming, 2. The prewrite time before erasure and the erase verify time (writeback time) are not included. 3. When a product is first written after shipment, "erase write" and "write only" are both taken as one rewrite. Remark 642 SPEC may change after device evaluation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) 27.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Absolute Maximum Ratings (TA = 25C) (1/2) Parameter Supply voltage Symbol Conditions Ratings Unit VDD -0.5 to +6.5 V EVDD -0.5 to +6.5 V VSS -0.5 to +0.3 V EVSS -0.5 to +0.3 -0.5 to VDD +0.3 AVREF REGC pin V Note1 V AVSS -0.5 to +0.3 V VREGC -0.5 to +3.6 V and VDD Input voltage Input voltage VI1 -0.3 to VDD +0.3 P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, Note1 V P40, P41, P70 to P73, P80 to P87, P90, P120, P131, X1, X2, XT1, XT2, RESET, FLMD0 VI2 Output voltage P60 to P63 -0.3 to +6.5 N-ch open drain -0.3 to VDD +0.3 VO Analog input voltage VAN ANI0 to ANI8 V Note1 -0.3 to AVREF +0.3 Note2 Note1 and -0.3 to VDD +0.3 Output current, high IOH Per pin P00, P01, P06, V V Note1 -10 mA -55 mA -25 mA -0.5 mA P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Total of all pins P06, P10 to P17, -80 mA P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 IOH2 Per pin P80 to P87, P90 -2 Total of all pins IOH3 Per pin P121 to P124 Total of all pins -1 mA -4 Notes 1. Must be 6.5 V or lower. 2. ANI8 is PD78F0884, 78F0885 and 78F0886 only. Cautions 1. Product quality may suffer if the absolute maximum rating is exceeded even momentarily for any parameter. That is, the absolute maximum ratings are rated values at which the product is on the verge of suffering physical damage, and therefore the product must be used under conditions that ensure that the absolute maximum ratings are not exceeded. 2. P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 643 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) Absolute Maximum Ratings (TA = 25C) (2/2) Parameter Output current, low Symbol IOL Conditions Per pin P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, Ratings Unit 30 mA 140 mA 60 mA 1 mA P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Total of P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, all pins P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 200 mA P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 IOL2 Per pin P80 to P87, P90 All pins IOL3 Per pin 5 P121 to P124 All pins Operating ambient TA temperature Storage temperature 4 10 In normal operation mode -40 to +125 In flash memory programming mode -40 to +125 -65 to +150 Tstg mA C C Cautions 1. Product quality may suffer if the absolute maximum rating is exceeded even momentarily for any parameter. That is, the absolute maximum ratings are rated values at which the product is on the verge of suffering physical damage, and therefore the product must be used under conditions that ensure that the absolute maximum ratings are not exceeded. 2. P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. 644 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) 27.2 Oscillator Characteristics (1) Main System Clock (Crystal/Ceramic) Oscillator Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Resonator Recommended Circuit Ceramic resonator Parameter X2 MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit MHz 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 4.0 20 frequency (fX) 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 4.0 10 X1 clock 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 4.0 20 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 4.0 10 X1 clock VSS X1 Conditions oscillation Note C1 C2 Crystal resonator VSS X1 X2 MHz oscillation Note frequency (fX) C1 C2 Note Indicates only oscillator characteristics. Refer to AC Characteristics for instruction execution time. Cautions 1. When using the X1 oscillator, wire as follows in the area enclosed by the broken lines in the above figures to avoid an adverse effect from wiring capacitance. * Keep the wiring length as short as possible. * Do not cross the wiring with the other signal lines. * Do not route the wiring near a signal line through which a high fluctuating current flows. * Always make the ground point of the oscillator capacitor the same potential as VSS. * Do not ground the capacitor to a ground pattern through which a high current flows. * Do not fetch signals from the oscillator. 2. Since the CPU is started by the 8 MHz internal oscillator after reset, check the oscillation stabilization time of the main system clock using the oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC). Determine the oscillation stabilization time of the OSTC register and oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) after sufficiently evaluating the oscillation stabilization time with the resonator to be used. Remark For the resonator selection and oscillator constant, customers are requested to either evaluate the oscillation themselves or apply to the resonator manufacturer for evaluation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 645 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) (2) On-chip Internal Oscillator Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Resonator Parameter Conditions Internal high-speed oscillation RSTS = 1 8 MHz internal oscillator 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 7.6 8 8.46 MHz Note 240 kHz internal oscillator clock frequency (fRH) RSTS = 0 2.48 5.6 9.86 MHz Internal low-speed oscillation 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V 216 240 264 kHz Note clock frequency (fRL) Note Indicates only oscillator characteristics. Refer to AC Characteristics for instruction execution time. Remark RSTS: Bit 7 of the internal oscillation mode register (RCM) (3) Subsystem Clock Oscillator Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Resonator Crystal resonator Recommended Circuit VSS XT2 XT1 Conditions XT1 clock oscillation MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 32 32.768 35 kHz Note frequency (fXT) Rd C4 Parameter C3 Note Indicates only oscillator characteristics. Refer to AC Characteristics for instruction execution time. Cautions 1. When using the XT1 oscillator, wire as follows in the area enclosed by the broken lines in the above figures to avoid an adverse effect from wiring capacitance. * Keep the wiring length as short as possible. * Do not cross the wiring with the other signal lines. * Do not route the wiring near a signal line through which a high fluctuating current flows. * Always make the ground point of the oscillator capacitor the same potential as VSS. * Do not ground the capacitor to a ground pattern through which a high current flows. * Do not fetch signals from the oscillator. 2. The subsystem clock oscillator is designed as a low-amplitude circuit for reducing power consumption, and is more prone to malfunction due to noise than the high-speed system clock oscillator. Particular care is therefore required with the wiring method when the subsystem clock is used. Remark For the resonator selection and oscillator constant, customers are requested to either evaluate the oscillation themselves or apply to the resonator manufacturer for evaluation. 646 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) 27.3 DC Characteristics DC Characteristics (1/6) (TA = -40 to +125C, 4.0 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note 1 Output current, high IOH1 Conditions MIN. TYP. Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, MAX. Unit -1.5 mA -10.0 mA -6.0 mA -14.0 mA -100 A 4.0 mA 8.0 mA 20 mA 10 mA 30 mA 400 A P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOH2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Output current, low Note3 Note3 IOL1 Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Per pin for P60 to P63 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOL2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Notes 1. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from VDD to an output pin. 2. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from an output pin to GND. 3. Specification under conditions where the duty factor is 70% (time for which current is output is 0.7 x t and time for which current is not output is 0.3 x t, where t is a specific time). The total output current of the pins at a duty factor of other than 70% can be calculated by the following expression. * Where the duty factor of IOH is n%: Total output current of pins = (IOH x 0.7) / (n x 0.01) Where the duty factor is 50%, IOH = 20.0 mA Total output current of pins = (20.0 x 0.7) / (50 x 0.01) = 28.0 mA However, the current that is allowed to flow into one pin does not vary depending on the duty factor. A current higher than the absolute maximum rating must not flow into one pin. Caution Remark P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. High level output current and low level current are the spec in Duty = 70% conditions. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 647 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (2/6) (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD < 4.0 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note 1 Output current, high IOH1 Conditions MIN. TYP. Per pin for P00, P01,P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, MAX. Unit -1.0 mA -8.0 mA -4.0 mA -12.0 mA -100 A 2.0 mA 16.0 mA P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 Total of pins P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 Note2 Total of pins IOH2 Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Output current, low Note3 IOL1 Per pin for P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 Note2 Total of pins P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P130 Note2 8.0 mA Note2 Total of pins 24.0 mA Per pin for P80 to P87, P90 400 A Total of pins IOL2 P00, P01, P40, P41, P120, P131 AVREF = VDD Per pin for P121 to P124 Notes 1. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from VDD to an output pin. 2. Value of current at which the device operation is guaranteed even if the current flows from an output pin to GND. 3. Specification under conditions where the duty factor is 70% (time for which current is output is 0.7 x t and time for which current is not output is 0.3 x t, where t is a specific time). The total output current of the pins at a duty factor of other than 70% can be calculated by the following expression. * Where the duty factor of IOH is n%: Total output current of pins = (IOH x 0.7) / (n x 0.01) Where the duty factor is 50%, IOH = 20.0 mA Total output current of pins = (20.0 x 0.7) / (50 x 0.01) = 28.0 mA However, the current that is allowed to flow into one pin does not vary depending on the duty factor. A current higher than the absolute maximum rating must not flow into one pin. Caution P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. High level output current and low level current are the spec in Duty = 70% conditions. 648 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (3/6) (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Input voltage, high Input voltage, low Output voltage, high Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit VIH1 P12, P13, P15, P40, P41, P70, P121 to P124 0.7VDD VDD V VIH2 P00, P01, P06, P10, P11, P14, P16, P17, P30 to P33, P71 to P73, P120, P131, RESET, EXCLK, EXCLKS 0.8VDD VDD V VIH3 P80 to P87, P90 0.7AVREF AVREF V VIH4 P60 to P63 0.7VDD 6.0 V VIL1 P12, P13, P15, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70, P121 to P124 0 0.3VDD V VIL2 P00, P01, P06, P10, P11, P14, P16, P17, P30 to P33, P60 toP63, P71 to P73, P120, P131, RESET, EXCLK, EXCLKS 0 0.2VDD V VIL3 P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD 0 0.3AVREF V VOH1 IOH = -1.5 mA P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, IOH = -1.0 mA P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V VDD - 0.7 V 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V VDD - 0.7 V VDD - 0.5 V VOH2 IOH = -100 A P80 to P87, P90 VOL1 IOL = 4.0mA AVREF = VDD AVREF = VDD P121 to P124 Output voltage, low IOL = 2.0 mA VOL2 IOL = 400 A P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P70 to P73, P120, P130, P131 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.7 V 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.7 V P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD 0.4 V 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 2.0 V 0.6 V 0.6 V P121 to P124 VOL3 IOL = 8 mA P60 to P63 IOL = 2.0 mA IOL = 2.0 mA Caution 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 649 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (4/6) (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Input leakage current, Symbol Conditions TYP. MAX. Unit ILIH1 VI = VDD P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, P131, RESET, FLMD0 5 A ILIH2 VI = AVREF P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD 5 A ILIH3 VI = VDD P121 to P124 I/O port mode 5 A (X1, X2, XT1, XT2) OSC port mode 20 A P00, P01, P06, P10 to P17, P30 to P33, -5 A high Input leakage current, MIN. ILIL1 VI = VSS P40, P41, P60 to P63, P70 to P73, P120, low P131, RESET, FLMD0 ILIL2 P80 to P87, P90 AVREF = VDD -5 A ILIL3 P121 to P124 I/O port mode -5 A (X1, X2, XT1, XT2) OSC port mode -20 A 100 k Pull-up resistor RU VI = VSS 10 20 FLMD0 supply voltage VIL In normal operation mode 0 0.2VDD V VIH In self programming mode 0.8 VDD VDD V Caution P06, P63, P90 and P131 are PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886 only. Remark Unless specified otherwise, the characteristics of alternate-function pins are the same as those of port pins. 650 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (5/6) (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, 2.7 V AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Supply current Note1 Symbol IDD1 Conditions Operating mode Note2 fXH = 20 MHz , 3.4 10.3 Resonator connection 4.7 12.5 Square wave input 1.8 5.4 Resonator connection 2.5 7.2 Square wave input 1.7 5.4 Square wave input VDD = 5.0 V Notes2, 3 fXH = 10 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes2, 3 fXH = 10 MHz , VDD = 3.0 V Notes2, 3 fXH = 5 MHz MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit , VDD = 3.0 V fSUB = 32.768 kHz , VDD = 5.0 V IDD2 HALT mode Note2 fXH = 20 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes2, 3 fXH = 10 MHz , VDD = 5.0 V Notes2, 3 fXH = 5 MHz , VDD = 3.0 V 2.4 6.0 1.0 3.0 Resonator connection 1.4 3.6 1.5 4.2 mA A Square wave input 6 138 Resonator connection 15 145 Square wave input 1.0 5.9 Resonator connection 2.2 8.6 Square wave input 0.6 3.1 Resonator connection 1.2 4.7 Square wave input 0.3 1.6 Resonator connection 0.6 2.4 Note4 fRH = 8 MHz fSUB = 32.768 kHz , VDD = 5.0 V Note 6 IDD3 Notes 1. STOP mode mA mA mA mA 0.5 2.1 mA Square wave input 3.0 133 A Resonator connection 12 138 1 100 , VDD = 5.0 V Note5 mA Square wave input , VDD = 5.0 V Note5 mA Resonator connection Note4 fRH = 8 MHz mA VDD = 5.0 V A Total current flowing into the internal power supply (VDD, EVDD), including the peripheral operation current and the input leakage current flowing when the level of the input pin are fixed to VDD or VSS. However, the current flowing into the pull-up resistors and the output current of the port is not included. 2. Not including the operating current of the 8 MHz internal oscillator, XT1 oscillation, 240 kHz internal oscillator and the current flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer and LVI circuit. 3. When AMPH (bit 0 of clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL)) = 0. 4. Not including the operating current of the X1 oscillation, XT1 oscillation and 240 kHz internal oscillator. 5. Not including the operating current of the X1 oscillation, 8 MHz internal oscillator and 240 kHz internal 6. Not including the operating current of the 240 kHz internal oscillator and XT1 oscillation, and the current Not including the current flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer, LVI circuit and CAN controller. oscillator, and the current flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer and LVI circuit. flowing into the A/D converter, watchdog timer and LVI circuit. Remarks 1. fXH: High-speed system clock frequency (X1 clock oscillation frequency or external main system clock frequency) 2. fRH: Internal high-speed oscillation clock frequency 3. fSUB: Subsystem clock frequency (XT1 clock oscillation frequency or external subsystem clock frequency) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 651 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) DC Characteristics (6/6) (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter A/D converter Symbol IADC Conditions Note 1 ADCE = 1 Note 2 During 240 kHz internal low-speed oscillation clock operation MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 0.86 2.9 mA 5 15 A 9 27 A operating current Watchdog timer IWDT operating current LVI operating Note 3 ILVI current Notes 1. Current flowing only to the A/D converter (AVREF-pin). The current value of the 78K0/FC2 is the sum of 2. Current flowing only to the watchdog timer (VDD-pin) (including the operating current of the 240 kHz IDD1 or IDD2 and IADC when the A/D converter operates in an operation mode or the HALT mode. internal oscillator). The current value of the 78K0/FC2 is the sum of IDD2 or IDD3 and IWDT when the watchdog timer operates in the HALT or STOP mode. 3. Current flowing only to the LVI circuit (VDD-pin). The current value of the 78K0/FC2 is the sum of IDD2 or IDD3 and ILVI when the LVI circuit operates in the HALT or STOP mode. 652 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) 27.4 AC Characteristics (1) Basic operation (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Instruction cycle (minimum Symbol TCY instruction execution time) Conditions fPRS frequency Unit 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.1 8 s 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 0.2 8 s 125 s 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 20 MHz 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 10 fPRS = fXH fPRS = fRH fEXT MAX. Main system clock (fXP) frequency External main system clock TYP. operation Subsystem clock (fSUB) operation Peripheral hardware clock MIN. 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V 114 122 7.6 8.46 MHz 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 4.0 20 MHz 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 4.0 10 MHz External clock input high level fEXTH, 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 24 width, low level width fEXTL 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 48 External subsystem clock fEXTS 32 External sub clock input high fEXTSH, 12 s level width, low level width fEXTSL 2/fsam + s ns 32.768 35 kHz frequency TI000, TI010, TI011 input high- tTIH0, level width, low-level width tTIL0 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V Note 0.1 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V s 2/fsam + Note 0.2 TI50, TI51 input frequency fTI5 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 10 MHz 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 10 MHz TI50, TI51 input high-level width, tTIH5, 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 50 ns low-level width 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 50 ns 1 s 10 s tTIL5 Interrupt input high-level width, tINIH, low-level width tINIL RESET low-level width tRSL Note TI sampling with selection count clock (fPRS, fPRS/4, fPRS/256) using bits 0 and 1 (PRM0n0, PRM0n1) of prescaler mode registers 00 (PRM0n). Note that when selecting the TI0n0 valid edge as the count clock, fsam = fPRS (n = 0, 1). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 653 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) TCY vs. VDD (Main System Clock Operation) Cycle time TCY [ s] 20.0 10.0 8.0 5.0 2.0 Guaranteed operation range 1.0 0.4 0.2 0.1 0 1.0 2.0 3.0 2.7 4.0 5.0 Supply voltage VDD [V] 654 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 6.0 5.5 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) AC Timing Test Points (Excluding X1, XT1) 0.8VDD 0.8VDD Test points 0.2VDD 0.2VDD External clock input timing 1/fEXT tEXTL tEXTH 0.8VDD EXCLK 0.2VDD 1/fEXTS tEXTSL tEXTSH 0.8VDD 0.2VDD EXCLKS TI Timing tTIL0 tTIH0 TI000, TI010, TI011 1/fTI5 tTIL5 tTIH5 tINTL tINTH TI50, TI51 Interrupt Request Input Timing INTP0 to INTP7 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 655 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) RESET Input Timing tRSL RESET (2) Serial interface (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) (a) UART mode (UART6n, dedicated baud rate generator output) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. Transfer rate Remark MAX. Unit 625 kbps MAX. Unit n = 0, 1 (b) 3-wire serial I/O mode (master mode, SCK10... internal clock output) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V SCK10 cycle time tKCY1 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 400 SCK10 high-/low-level widthNote1 tKH1, 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V tKCY1/2 - 20 tKL1 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V tKCY1/2 - 30 tSIK1 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 70 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 100 SI10 setup time (to SCK10) SI10 hold time (from SCK10) Delay time from SCK10 to 200 tKSI1 tKSO1 TYP. ns ns ns 30 ns Note2 C = 50 pF 40 ns MAX. Unit SO10 output Notes 1. It is value at the time of fX use. Keep in mind that spec different at the time of fOSC8 use. 2. C is the load capacitance of the SCK10 and SO10 output lines. (c) 3-wire serial I/O mode (slave mode, SCK10... external clock input) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. SCK10 cycle time tKCY2 400 ns SCK10 high-/low-level width tKH2, tKCY2/2 ns 80 ns 50 ns tKL2 SI10 setup time (to SCK10) tSIK2 SI10 hold time (from SCK10) tKSI2 Delay time from SCK10 to tKSO2 Note C = 50 pF SO10 output 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 120 2.7 V VDD < 4.0 V 120 Note C is the load capacitance of the SO10 output line. 656 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD ns CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) Serial Transfer Timing 3-wire serial I/O mode: tKCYm tKLm tKHm SCK10 tSIKm SI10 tKSIm Input data tKSOm SO10 Remark Output data m = 1, 2 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 657 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) (3) CAN controller (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Conditions MIN. TYP. Transfer rate Internal delay time tNODE note CAN Internal clock toutput CTxD pin (Transfer data) tinput CRxD pin (Receive data) Internal delay time (tNODE) = Internal Transfer Delay (toutput) + Internal Receive Delay (tinput) Note CAN Internal clock (fCAN): CAN baud rate clock 78K0/FC2 CTxD pin Internal Transfer Delay CAN macro Internal Receive Delay CRxD pin Image figure of internal delay 658 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD MAX. Unit 1 Mbps 100 ns CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) (4) A/D Converter Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V, 2.7 V AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = AVSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Resolution Overall error AINL Conversion time tCONV Notes 1, 2 Zero-scale error Full-scale error EZS Notes 1, 2 EFS Note 1 Integral non-linearity error Differential non-linearity error Analog input voltage 2. MIN. MAX. Unit 10 bit 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.4 %FSR 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.6 RES Notes 1, 2 Notes 1. Conditions ILE Note 1 DLE TYP. 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 6.1 36.7 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 12.2 36.7 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.4 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.6 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 0.4 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 0.6 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 2.5 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 4.5 4.0 V VDD 5.5 V 1.5 2.7 V VDD 4.0 V 2.0 VAIN AVSS AVREF s %FSR %FSR LSB LSB V Excludes quantization error (1/2 LSB). This value is indicated as a ratio (%FSR) to the full-scale value. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 659 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) (5) POC Circuit Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, VSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Detection voltage VPOC0 Power supply rise time tPTH Minimum pulse width tPW Conditions VDD: 0 V VPOC0 MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit 1.44 1.59 1.74 V 0.5 V/ms 200 s POC Circuit Timing Supply voltage (VDD) Detection voltage (MAX.) Detection voltage (TYP.) Detection voltage (MIN.) tPW tPTH Time Caution Spec may change after device evaluation. 660 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) (6) LVI Circuit Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, VPOC VDD = EVDD = 0 V 5.5 V, AVREF VDD, VSS = EVSS = 0 V) Parameter Detection Symbol Supply voltage level voltage External input pin Note 1 Detection voltage on Conditions MIN. TYP. MAX. Unit VLVI0 4.14 4.24 4.34 V VLVI1 3.99 4.09 4.19 V VLVI2 3.83 3.93 4.03 V VLVI3 3.68 3.78 3.88 V VLVI4 3.52 3.62 3.72 V VLVI5 3.37 3.47 3.57 V VLVI6 3.22 3.32 3.42 V VLVI7 3.06 3.16 3.26 V VLVI8 2.91 3.01 3.11 V VLVI9 2.75 2.85 2.95 V EXLVI EXLVI < VDD, 2.7 V VDD 5.5 V 1.11 1.21 1.31 V VDDLVI LVISTART (option bye) = 1 2.50 2.70 2.90 V application of supply voltage Minimum pulse width tLW Operation stabilization wait time Note 2 s 200 tLWAIT1 10 s Notes 1. External input pin is alternate P120/INTP pin. 2. Time required from setting LVION to 1 to operation stabilization. Remarks 1. VLVIn-1 > VLVIn (n = 1 to 15) 2. VPOC < VLVIm (VPOC : Power-on clear detection voltage, m = 0 to 15) LVI Circuit Timing Supply voltage (VDD) Detection voltage (MAX.) Detection voltage (TYP.) Detection voltage (MIN.) tLWAIT1 LVION < -1 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD tLW Time 661 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) (7) Power Supply Starting Time (TA = -40 to +125C, VSS = 0 V) Parameter Symbol Note Starting maximum time to VDD min (2.7 V) tPUP1 (VDD: 0 V2.7 V) Conditions MIN. TYP. LVI starting option invalid MAX. Unit 3.6 ms 1.9 ms When pin RESET intact Note Starting maximum time to VDD min (2.7 V) (pin RESET releaseVDD: 2.7 V) tPUP2 LVI starting option invalid When pin RESET use Note Start a power supply in time shorter than this when LVI staring option invalid. VDD VDD 2.7 V 2.7 V 0V 0V POC POC TPUP1 RESET pin TPUP2 Pin RESET intact 662 Pin RESET use User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) 27.5 Data Retention Characteristics Data Memory STOP Mode Low Supply Voltage Data Retention Characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C) Parameter Data retention supply voltage Symbol Conditions MIN. 1.44 VDDDR TYP. Note MAX. Unit 5.5 V Note The value depends on the POC detection voltage. When the voltage drops, the data is retained until a POC reset is effected, but data is not retained when a POC reset is effected. Data Retention Timing STOP mode Operation Data retention characteristics VDD STOP instruction execution VDDDR Standby release signal (Interrupt request) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 663 CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) 27.6 Flash EEPROM Programming Characteristics (1) Basic characteristics (TA = -40 to +125C, 2.7 V VDD = EVDD = 0 V 5.5 V, VSS = EVSS = 0 V) Parameter VDD supply current Notes 1, 2 Erase time Symbol IDD Conditions MIN. fXP = 10 MHz (TYP.), 20 MHz (MAX.) TYP. MAX. Unit 4.5 16 mA All block Teraca 20 200 ms Block unit Terasa 20 200 ms Note 1 Write time (in 8-bit units) Twrwa 10 100 s Number of rewrites per chip Cerwr Retention: 15 years 100 Times Note 3 1 erase + 1 write after erase = 1 rewrite Notes 1. Characteristic of the flash memory. For the characteristic when a dedicated flash memory programmer, PG-FP4, is used and the rewrite time during self programming, 2. The prewrite time before erasure and the erase verify time (writeback time) are not included. 3. When a product is first written after shipment, "erase write" and "write only" are both taken as one rewrite. Remark 664 SPEC may change after device evaluation. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 28 PACKAGE DRAWINGS * PD78F0881GB(A)-GAF-AX, 78F0881GB(A2)-GAF-AX, 78F0882GB(A)-GAF-AX, 78F0882GB(A2)-GAF-AX, 78F0883GB(A)-GAF-AX, 78F0883GB(A2)-GAF-AX 44-PIN PLASTIC LQFP (10x10) HD detail of lead end D L1 33 A3 23 c 22 34 L Lp E HE (UNIT:mm) 44 12 11 1 ZE e ZD b x M S A A2 S y A1 S NOTE Each lead centerline is located within 0.20 mm of its true position at maximum material condition. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD ITEM D DIMENSIONS 10.000.20 E 10.000.20 HD 12.000.20 HE 12.000.20 A 1.60 MAX. A1 0.100.05 A2 1.400.05 A3 0.25 b 0.35 +0.08 -0.04 c 0.125 +0.075 -0.025 L 0.50 Lp 0.600.15 L1 1.000.20 3 +5 -3 e 0.80 x 0.20 y 0.10 ZD 1.00 ZE 1.00 P44GB-80-GAF 665 CHAPTER 27 PACKAGE DRAWINGS * PD78F0884GA(A)-GAM-AX, 78F0884GA(A2)-GAM-AX, 78F0885GA(A)-GAM-AX, 78F0885GA(A2)-GAM-AX, 78F0886GA(A)-GAM-AX, 78F0886GA(A2)-GAM-AX 48-PIN PLASTIC LQFP (FINE PITCH) (7x7) HD D detail of lead end 36 A3 25 37 c 24 L Lp E L1 HE (UNIT:mm) 13 48 1 12 ZE e ZD b x M S A A2 A1 S NOTE Each lead centerline is located within 0.08 mm of its true position at maximum material condition. 666 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD DIMENSIONS 7.000.20 E 7.000.20 HD 9.000.20 HE 9.000.20 A 1.60 MAX. A1 0.100.05 A2 1.400.05 A3 0.25 +0.07 0.20 -0.03 b S y ITEM D c 0.125 +0.075 -0.025 L 0.50 Lp 0.600.15 L1 1.000.20 3 +5 -3 e 0.50 x 0.08 y 0.08 ZD 0.75 ZE 0.75 P48GA-50-GAM CHAPTER 29 RECOMMENDED SOLDERING CONDITIONS These products should be soldered and mounted under the following recommended conditions. For soldering methods and conditions other than those recommended below, please contact an NEC Electronics sales representative. For technical information, see the following website. Semiconductor Device Mount Manual (http://www.necel.com/pkg/en/mount/index.html) Table 29-1. Surface Mounting Type Soldering Conditions * 44-pin plastic LQFP (10 x 10) PD78F0881GB(A)-GAF-AX, 78F0881GB(A2)-GAF-AX, 78F0882GB(A)-GAF-AX, 78F0882GB(A2)-GAF-AX, 78F0883GB(A)-GAF-AX, 78F0883GB(A2)-GAF-AX * 48-pin plastic LQFP (7 x 7) PD78F0884GA(A)-GAM-AX, 78F0884GA(A2)-GAM-AX, 78F0885GA(A)-GAM-AX, 78F0885GA(A2)-GAM-AX, 78F0886GA(A)-GAM-AX, 78F0886GA(A2)-GAM-AX Soldering Method Soldering Conditions Recommended Condition Symbol Infrared reflow Package peak temperature: 260C, Time: 60 seconds max. (at 220C or higher), Note Count: 3 times or less, Exposure limit: 7 days 20 to 72 hours) Partial heating IR60-207-3 (after that, prebake at 125C for Pin temperature: 350C max., Time: 3 seconds max. (per pin row) - Note After opening the dry pack, store it at 25C or less and 65% RH or less for the allowable storage period. Caution Do not use different soldering methods together (except for partial heating). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 667 CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT 30.1 Cautions for Wait This product has two internal system buses. One is a CPU bus and the other is a peripheral bus that interfaces with the low-speed peripheral hardware. Because the clock of the CPU bus and the clock of the peripheral bus are asynchronous, unexpected illegal data may be passed if an access to the CPU conflicts with an access to the peripheral hardware. When accessing the peripheral hardware that may cause a conflict, therefore, the CPU repeatedly executes processing, until the correct data is passed. As a result, the CPU does not start the next instruction processing but waits. If this happens, the number of execution clocks of an instruction increases by the number of wait clocks (for the number of wait clocks, see Table 301). This must be noted when real-time processing is performed. 668 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT 30.2 Peripheral Hardware That Generates Wait Table 30-1 lists the registers that issue a wait request when accessed by the CPU, and the number of CPU wait clocks. Table 30-1. Registers That Generate Wait and Number of CPU Wait Clocks Peripheral Register Access Number of Wait Clocks Hardware Serial interface ASIS60 Read 1 clock (fixed) ASIS61 Read 1 clock (fixed) ADM Write 1 to 5 clocks (when fAD = fPRS/2 is selected) ADS Write 1 to 7 clocks (when fAD = fPRS/3 is selected) ADPC Write ADCR Read UART60 Serial interface UART61 A/D converter 1 to 9 clocks (when fAD = fPRS/4 is selected) 2 to 13 clocks (when fAD = fPRS/6 is selected) 2 to 17 clocks (when fAD = fPRS/8 is selected) 2 to 25 clocks (when fAD = fPRS/12 is selected) The above number of clocks is when the same source clock is selected for fCPU and fPRS. The number of wait clocks can be calculated by the following expression and under the following conditions. 2 fCPU +1 * Number of wait clocks = fAD * Fraction is truncated if the number of wait clocks 0.5 and rounded up if the number of wait clocks > 0.5. fAD: A/D conversion clock frequency (fPRS/2 to fPRS/12) fCPU: CPU clock frequency fPRS: Peripheral hardware clock frequency fXP: Main system clock frequency * Maximum number of times: Maximum speed of CPU (fXP), lowest speed of A/D conversion clock (fPRS/12) * Minimum number of times: Minimum speed of CPU (fSUB/2), highest speed of A/D conversion clock (fPRS/2) Caution When the CPU is operating on the subsystem clock and the peripheral hardware clock is stopped, do not access the registers listed above using an access method in which a wait request is issued. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 669 CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT Table 30-2 RAM Access That Generate Wait and Number of CPU Wait Clocks Peripheral Register Access Hardware CAN Global Reg. Read/Write Cause number of wait clocks MIN. MAX. 1 1 synchronizaition of NPB signals with VPCLK CANmodule Reg. MIN. ROUNDUP[(1/FVPCLK) x 1/(1/FVPSTB)] MAX. ROUNDUP[(1/FVPCLK) x 2/(1/FVPSTB)] C0RGPT Read 2 14 Synchronization of NPB signals with VPCLK C0LIPT RAM access delay (1 RAM - RD access) C0TGPT C0LOPT MIN. ROUNDUP[(1/FCANCLK) x 3/(1/FVPSTB)] Message Buf. MAX. ROUNDUP[(1/FCANCLK) x 4/(1/FVPSTB)] Message Buf. Write(8 bit) 2 17 synchronization of NPB signals with VPCLK RAM access delay (1RAM - RD + 1RAM - WR access) MIN. ROUNDUP[(1/FCANCLK) x 4/(1/FVPSTB)] MAX. ROUNDUP[(1/FCANCLK) x 5/(1/FVPSTB)] Message Buf. Write(16 bit) 1 11 synchronization of NPB signals with VPCLK RAM access delay (1 RAM - WR access) MIN. ROUNDUP[(1/FCANCLK) x 2/(1/FVPSTB)] MAX. ROUNDUP[(1/FCANCLK) x 3/(1/FVPSTB)] Caution Remark When Value is CANMOD(CAN module system clock) 2 MHz. FVPCLK: VPCLK frequency FVPSTB: VPSTB frequency FCANCLK: AFCAN macro frequency 670 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD CHAPTER 30 CAUTIONS FOR WAIT 30.3 Example of Wait Occurrence * Serial interface UART61 Number of execution clocks: 6 (5 clocks when data is read from a register that does not issue a wait (MOV A, sfr).) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 671 APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS The following development tools are available for the development of systems that employ the 78K0/FC2. Figure A-1 shows the development tool configuration. * Support for PC98-NX series Unless otherwise specified, products supported by IBM PC/ATTM compatibles are compatible with PC98-NX series computers. When using PC98-NX series computers, refer to the explanation for IBM PC/AT compatibles. * WindowsTM Unless otherwise specified, "Windows" means the following OSs. * Windows 98 * Windows NTTM * Windows 2000 * Windows XPTM Caution For the development tools of the 78K0/FC2, contact an NEC Electronics sales representative. 672 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS Figure A-1. Development Tool Configuration (1/3) (1) When using the in-circuit emulator QB-78K0FX2 Software package * Software package Debugging software Language processing software * Assembler package * Integrated debuggerNote 4 * C compiler package * System simulator * Device fileNote 1 * C library source fileNote 2 Control software * Project manager (Windows only)Note 3 Host machine (PC or EWS) USB interface cableNote 4 Power supply unitNote 4 QB-78K0FX2Note 4 Flash memory write environment Flash memory programmerNote 4 Emulation probe Flash memory write adapter Flash memory Target system Notes 1. Download the device file for 78K0/FC2 (DF780893) from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). 2. The C library source file is not included in the software package. 3. The project manager PM+ is included in the assembler package. 4. In-circuit emulator QB-78K0FX2 is supplied with integrated debugger ID78K0-QB, simple flash memory PM+ is only used for Windows. programmer PG-FPL3, power supply unit, and USB interface cable. Any other products are sold separately. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 673 APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS Figure A-1. Development Tool Configuration (2/3) (2) When using the on-chip debug emulator QB-78K0MINI Software package * Software package Debugging software Language processing software * Assembler package * Integrated debuggerNote 4 * C compiler package * System simulator * Device fileNote 1 * C library source fileNote 2 Control software * Project manager (Windows only)Note 3 Host machine (PC or EWS) USB interface cableNote 4 QB-78K0MININote 4 Flash memory write environment Flash memory programmer Connection cableNote 4 Flash memory write adapter Flash memory Target connector Target system Notes 1. Download the device file for 78K0/FC2 (DF780893) from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). 2. The C library source file is not included in the software package. 3. The project manager PM+ is included in the assembler package. PM+ is only used for Windows. 4. On-chip debug emulator QB-78K0MINI is supplied with integrated debugger ID78K0-QB, USB interface cable, and connection cable. Any other products are sold separately. 674 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS Figure A-1. Development Tool Configuration (3/3) (3) When using the on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 Software package * Software package Debugging software Language processing software * Assembler package * Integrated debuggerNote 1 * C compiler package * System simulator * Device fileNote 1 * C library source fileNote 2 Control software * Project manager (Windows only)Note 3 Host machine (PC or EWS) USB interface cableNote 4 QB-MINI2Note 4 QB-MINI2Note 4 Connection cable 78K0-OCD boardNote 4 (16-pin cable)Note 4 Connection cable (10-pin/16-pin cable)Note 4 Target connector Target system Notes 1. Download the device file for 78K0/FC2 (DF780893) and the integrated debugger (ID78K0-QB) from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). 2. The C library source file is not included in the software package. 3. The project manager PM+ is included in the assembler package. The PM+ is only used for Windows. 4. On-chip debug emulator QB-MINI2 is supplied with USB interface cable, connection cables (10-pin cable and 16-pin cable), and 78K0-OCD board. Any other products are sold separately. In addition, download the software for operating the QB-MINI2 from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 675 APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS A.1 Software Package SP78K0 Development tools (software) common to the 78K/0 Series are combined in this package. 78K/0 Series software package Part number: SxxxxSP78K0 xxxx in the part number differs depending on the host machine and OS used. Remark SxxxxSP78K0 xxxx Host Machine OS AB17 PC-9800 series, Windows (Japanese version) BB17 IBM PC/AT compatibles Windows (English version) Supply Medium CD-ROM A.2 Language Processing Software RA78K0 This assembler converts programs written in mnemonics into object codes executable Assembler package with a microcontroller. This assembler is also provided with functions capable of automatically creating symbol tables and branch instruction optimization. This assembler should be used in combination with a device file (DF780893) This assembler package is a DOS-based application. It can also be used in Windows, however, by using the project manager (included in assembler package) on Windows. Part number: SxxxxRA78K0 CC78K0 This compiler converts programs written in C language into object codes executable with C compiler package a microcontroller. This compiler should be used in combination with an assembler package and device file (both sold separately). This C compiler package is a DOS-based application. It can also be used in Windows, however, by using the project manager (included in assembler package) on Windows. Part number: SxxxxCC78K0 Note 1 DF780893 This file contains information peculiar to the device. Device file This device file should be used in combination with a tool (RA78K0, CC78K0, and ID78K0-QB) (all sold separately). The corresponding OS and host machine differ depending on the tool to be used (all sold separately). Part number: SxxxxDF780893 CC78K/0-L Note 2 C library source file This is a source file of the functions that configure the object library included in the C compiler package (CC78K0). This file is required to match the object library included in the C compiler package to the user's specifications. Part number: SxxxxCC78K0-L Notes 1. The DF780893 can be used in common with the RA78K0, CC78K0, and ID78K0-QB. Download the DF780893 from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). 2. 676 The CC78K0-L is not included in the software package (SP78K0). User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS Remark xxxx in the part number differs depending on the host machine and OS used. SxxxxRA78K0 SxxxxCC78K0 SxxxxCC78K0-L xxxx Host Machine AB17 PC-9800 series, BB17 IBM PC/AT compatibles 3P17 HP9000 series 700 3K17 SPARCstation OS Windows (Japanese version) TM TM Supply Medium CD-ROM Windows (English version) HP-UX TM SunOS TM TM Solaris (Rel. 10.10) (Rel. 4.1.4), (Rel. 2.5.1) SxxxxDF780893 xxxx Host Machine OS AB13 PC-9800 series, Windows (Japanese version) BB13 IBM PC/AT compatibles Windows (English version) Supply Medium 3.5-inch 2HD FD A.3 Control Software PM+ This is control software designed to enable efficient user program development in the Project manager Windows environment. All operations used in development of a user program, such as starting the editor, building, and starting the debugger, can be performed from PM+. PM+ is included in the assembler package (RA78K0). It can only be used in Windows. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 677 APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS A.4 Flash Memory Programming Tools A.4.1 When using flash memory programmer FG-FP4, FL-PR4, PG-FPL3, and FP-LITE3 PG-FP4, FL-PR4 Flash memory programmer dedicated to microcontrollers with on-chip flash memory. Flash memory programmer PG-FPL3, FP-LITE3 Simple flash memory programmer dedicated to microcontrollers with on-chip flash Simple flash memory programmer memory. Remark FL-PR4, FP-LITE3 are products of Naito Densei Machida Mfg. Co., Ltd. TEL: +81-45-475-4191 Naito Densei Machida Mfg. Co., Ltd. A.4.2 When using on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 QB-MINI2 This is a flash memory programmer dedicated to microcontrollers with on-chip flash On-chip debug emulator with memory. It is available also as on-chip debug emulator which serves to debug hardware programming function and software when developing application systems using the 78K0/Fx2. When using this as flash memory programmer, it should be used in combination with a connection cable (16-pin cable) and a USB interface cable that is used to connect the host machine. Target connector specifications 16-pin general-purpose connector (2.54 mm pitch) Remarks 1. The QB-MINI2 is supplied with a USB interface cable and connection cables (10-pin cable and 16-pin cable), and the 78K0-OCD board. A connection cable (10-pin cable) and the 78K0-OCD board are used only when using the on-chip debug function. 2. Download the software for operating the QB-MINI2 from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). 678 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS A.5 Debugging Tools (Hardware) A.5.1 When using in-circuit emulator QB-78K0FX2 Note QB-78K0FX2 The in-circuit emulator serves to debug hardware and software when developing application In-circuit emulator systems using the 78K0/Fx2. It supports the integrated debugger (ID78K0-QB). This emulator should be used in combination with a power supply unit and emulation probe, and the USB is used to connect this emulator to the host machine. QB-144-CA-01 This adapter is used in waveform monitoring using the oscilloscope, etc. Check pin adapter QB-80-EP-01T This emulation probe is flexible type and used to connect the in-circuit emulator and target Emulation probe system. QB-44GB-EA-02T This adapter is used to perform the pin conversion from the in-circuit emulator to the target QB-48GA-EA-01T connector. Exchange adapter * QB-44GB-EA-02T: For 44-pin plastic LQFP (GB-UES, GB-GAF type) * QB-48GA-EA-01T: For 48-pin plastic LQFP (GA-8EU, GA-GAM type) QB-44GB-YS-01T This space adapter is used to adjust the height between the target system and in-circuit QB-48GA-YS-01T emulator. Space adapter * QB-44GB-YS-01T: For 44-pin plastic LQFP (GB-UES, GB-GAF type) * QB-48GA-YS-01T: For 48-pin plastic LQFP (GA-8EU, GA-GAM type) QB-44GB-YQ-01T This YQ connector is used to connect the target connector and exchange adapter. QB-48GA-YQ-01T * QB-44GB-YQ-01T: For 44-pin plastic LQFP (GB-UES, GB-GAF type) YQ connector * QB-48GA-YQ-01T: For 48-pin plastic LQFP (GA-8EU, GA-GAM type) QB-44GB-HQ-01T This mount adapter is used to mount the target device with socket. QB-48GA-HQ-01T * QB-44GB-HQ-01T: For 44-pin plastic LQFP (GB-UES, GB-GAF type) Mount adapter * QB-48GA-HQ-01T: For 48-pin plastic LQFP (GA-8EU, GA-GAM type) QB-44GB-NQ-01T This target connector is used to mount on the target system. QB-48GA-NQ-01T * QB-44GB-NQ-01T: For 44-pin plastic LQFP (GB-UES, GB-GAF type) Target connector * QB-48GA-NQ-01T: For 48-pin plastic LQFP (GA-8EU, GA-GAM type) Note The QB-78K0FX2 is supplied with a power supply unit, USB interface cable, and flash memory programmer PG-FPL3. It is also supplied with integrated debugger ID78K0-QB as control software. Remark The package contents differ depending on the part number. Package Contents In-Circuit Emulator Emulation Probe Exchange Adapter YQ Connector Target Connector Part Number QB-78K0FX2-ZZZ (-EE) QB-78K0FX2 QB-78K0FX2-T44GB Not included QB-80-EP-01T QB-78K0FX2-T48GA QB-44GB-EA-01T QB-44GB-YQ-01T QB-44GB-NQ-01T QB-48GA-EA-01T QB-48GA-YQ-01T QB-48GA-NQ-01T A.5.2 When using on-chip debug emulator QB-78K0MINI QB-78K0MINI This on-chip debug emulator serves to debug hardware and software when developing On-chip debug emulator application systems using the 78K0/Fx2. It supports the integrated debugger (ID78K0QB). This emulator should be used a connection cable and a USB interface cable that is used to connect the host machine. Target connector specifications 10-pin general-purpose connector (2.54 mm pitch) Remark The QB-78K0MINI is supplied with a USB interface cable and a connection cable. As control software, the integrated debugger ID78K0-QB is supplied. User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 679 APPENDIX A DEVELOPMENT TOOLS A.5.3 When using on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 QB-MINI2 This on-chip debug emulator serves to debug hardware and software when developing On-chip debug emulator with application systems using the 78K0/Fx2. It is available also as flash memory programming function programmer dedicated to microcontrollers with on-chip flash memory. When using this as on-chip debug emulator, it should be used in combination with a connection cable (10pin cable or 16-pin cable), a USB interface cable that is used to connect the host machine, and the 78K0-OCD board. Target connector specifications 10-pin general-purpose connector (2.54 mm pitch) or 16-pin general-purpose connector (2.54 mm pitch) Remarks 1. The QB-MINI2 is supplied with a USB interface cable and connection cables (10-pin cable and 16-pin cable), and the 78K0-OCD board. A connection cable (10-pin cable) and the 78K0-OCD board are used only when using the on-chip debug function. 2. Download the software for operating the QB-MINI2 from the download site for development tools (http://www.necel.com/micro/ods/eng/index.html). A.6 Debugging Tools (Software) SM+ for 78K0/Fx2 Note SM+ for 78K0/Fx2 is Windows-based software. System simulator It is used to perform debugging at the C source level or assembler level while simulating the operation of the target system on a host machine. Use of SM+ for 78K0/Fx2 allows the execution of application logical testing and performance testing on an independent basis from hardware development, thereby providing higher development efficiency and software quality. SM+ for 78K0/FX2 should be used in combination with the device file (DF780893). ID78K0-QB This debugger supports the in-circuit emulators for the 78K/0 Series. The ID78K0-QB is Integrated debugger Windows-based software. It has improved C-compatible debugging functions and can display the results of tracing with the source program using an integrating window function that associates the source program, disassemble display, and memory display with the trace result. It should be used in combination with the device file. Part number: SxxxxID78K0-QB Note This product is under development Remark xxxx in the part number differs depending on the host machine and OS used. SxxxxID78K0-QB xxxx 680 Host Machine OS AB17 PC-9800 series, Windows (Japanese version) BB17 IBM PC/AT compatibles Windows (English version) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD Supply Medium CD-ROM APPENDIX B NOTES ON TARGET SYSTEM DESIGN This chapter shows areas on the target system where component mounting is prohibited and areas where there are component mounting height restrictions when the QB-78K0FX2 is used. (a) Case of 44-pin GB package 15 9.85 10 9.85 10 Figure B-1. The Restriction Domain on a Target System (Case of 44-pin GB Package) 15 13.375 17.375 Note : Exchange adapter area: Components up to 17.45 mm in height can be mounted : Emulation probe tip area: Components up to 24.45 mm in height can be mountedNote Note Height can be adjusted by using space adapters (each adds 2.4 mm) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 681 APPENDIX B NOTES ON TARGET SYSTEM DESIGN (b) Case of 48-pin GA package 15 9.5 10 10 15 13.375 17.375 : Exchange adapter area: Components up to 17.45 mm in height can be mountedNote : Emulation probe tip area: Components up to 24.45 mm in height can be mountedNote Note 682 9.5 Figure B-2. The Restriction Domain on a Target System (Case of 48-pin GA Package) Height can be adjusted by using space adapters (each adds 2.4 mm) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX C.1 Register Index (In Alphabetical Order with Respect to Register Names) [1] 10-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCR)..............................................................................................................265 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000 (CR000)....................................................................................................149 16-bit timer capture/compare register 001 (CR001)....................................................................................................149 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010 (CR010)....................................................................................................151 16-bit timer capture/compare register 011 (CR011)....................................................................................................151 16-bit timer counter 00 (TM00)....................................................................................................................................148 16-bit timer counter 01 (TM01)....................................................................................................................................148 16-bit timer mode control register 00 (TMC00) ...........................................................................................................154 16-bit timer mode control register 01 (TMC01) ...........................................................................................................154 16-bit timer output control register 00 (TOC00)...........................................................................................................159 16-bit timer output control register 01 (TOC01)...........................................................................................................159 [8] 8-bit A/D conversion result register (ADCRH) .............................................................................................................266 8-bit timer compare register 50 (CR50).......................................................................................................................199 8-bit timer compare register 51 (CR51).......................................................................................................................199 8-bit timer counter 50 (TM50)......................................................................................................................................198 8-bit timer counter 51 (TM51)......................................................................................................................................198 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 (TMCYC1)........................................................................................................221 8-bit timer H compare register 00 (CMP00) ................................................................................................................217 8-bit timer H compare register 01 (CMP01) ................................................................................................................217 8-bit timer H compare register 10 (CMP10) ................................................................................................................217 8-bit timer H compare register 11 (CMP11) ................................................................................................................217 8-bit timer H mode register 0 (TMHMD0)....................................................................................................................218 8-bit timer H mode register 1 (TMHMD1)....................................................................................................................218 8-bit timer mode control register 50 (TMC50) .............................................................................................................202 8-bit timer mode control register 51 (TMC51) .............................................................................................................202 [A] A/D converter mode register (ADM)............................................................................................................................262 A/D port configuration register (ADPC) .......................................................................................................................268 Analog input channel specification register (ADS) ......................................................................................................267 Asynchronous serial interface control register 60 (ASICL60)......................................................................................304 Asynchronous serial interface control register 61 (ASICL61)......................................................................................304 Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 60 (ASIM60) .........................................................................291 Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 61 (ASIM61) .........................................................................291 Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60 (ASIS60).................................................................296 Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 61 (ASIS61).................................................................296 Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 60 (ASIF60) ....................................................................298 Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 61 (ASIF61) ....................................................................298 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 683 APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX [B] Baud rate generator control register 60 (BRGC60) .....................................................................................................302 Baud rate generator control register 61 (BRGC61) .....................................................................................................302 [C] CAN global automatic block transmission control register (C0GMABT)......................................................................394 CAN global automatic block transmission delay setting register (C0GMABTD) ..........................................................396 CAN global clock selection register (C0GMCS) ..........................................................................................................393 CAN global control register (C0GMCTRL) ..................................................................................................................391 CAN message configuration register (C0MCONFm)...................................................................................................421 CAN message control register m (C0MCTRLm) .........................................................................................................423 CAN message data byte register xm (C0MDATAxm) .................................................................................................418 CAN message data byte register zm (C0MDATAzm) .................................................................................................418 CAN message data length register m (C0MDLCm) ....................................................................................................420 CAN message id register Hm (C0MIDHm)..................................................................................................................422 CAN message id register Lm (C0MIDLm) ...................................................................................................................422 CAN module bit rate prescaler register (C0BRP) .......................................................................................................409 CAN module bit rate register (C0BTR)........................................................................................................................410 CAN module control register (C0CTRL) ......................................................................................................................399 CAN module error counter register (C0ERC) ..............................................................................................................405 CAN module information register (C0INFO)................................................................................................................404 CAN module interrupt enable register (C0IE)..............................................................................................................406 CAN module interrupt status register (C0INTS) ..........................................................................................................408 CAN module last error code register (C0LEC) ............................................................................................................403 CAN module last in-pointer register (C0LIPT) .............................................................................................................412 CAN module last out-pointer register (C0LOPT) .........................................................................................................414 CAN module mask control register 1H (C0MASK1H) .................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 1L (C0MASK1L)...................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 2H (C0MASK2H) .................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 2H (C0MASK2L) ..................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 3H (C0MASK3H) .................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 3L (C0MASK3L)...................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 4H (C0MASK4H) .................................................................................................397 CAN module mask control register 4L (C0MASK4L)...................................................................................................397 CAN module receive history list register (C0RGPT)....................................................................................................413 CAN module time stamp register (C0TS) ....................................................................................................................416 CAN module transmit history list register (C0TGPT)...................................................................................................415 Capture/compare control register 00 (CRC00)............................................................................................................157 Capture/compare control register 01 (CRC01)............................................................................................................157 Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) ........................................................................................................116 Clock output selection register (CKS) .........................................................................................................................255 Clock selection register 60 (CKSR60).........................................................................................................................300 Clock selection register 61 (CKSR61).........................................................................................................................300 [E] External interrupt falling edge enable register (EGN)..................................................................................................499 684 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX External interrupt rising edge enable register (EGP)...................................................................................................499 [F] Flash-programming mode control register (FLPMC)...................................................................................................596 Flash protect command register (PFCMD) .................................................................................................................598 Flash status register (PFS) .........................................................................................................................................598 [I] Input switch control register (ISC) ...............................................................................................................................308 Internal expansion RAM size switching register (IXS).................................................................................................571 Internal memory size switching register (IMS) ............................................................................................................570 Internal oscillator mode register (RCM) ......................................................................................................................113 Interrupt mask flag register 0H (MK0H) ......................................................................................................................497 Interrupt mask flag register 0L (MK0L)........................................................................................................................497 Interrupt mask flag register 1H (MK1H) ......................................................................................................................497 Interrupt mask flag register 1L (MK1L)........................................................................................................................497 Interrupt request flag register 0H (IF0H) .....................................................................................................................495 Interrupt request flag register 0L (IF0L) ......................................................................................................................495 Interrupt request flag register 1H (IF1H) .....................................................................................................................495 Interrupt request flag register 1L (IF1L) ......................................................................................................................495 [L] Low-voltage detection level selection register (LVIS)..................................................................................................550 Low-voltage detection register (LVIM) ........................................................................................................................549 [M] Main clock mode register (MCM) ................................................................................................................................114 Main OSC control register (MOC) ...............................................................................................................................115 Multiplication/division data register A0H (MDA0H)......................................................................................................534 Multiplication/division data register A0L (MDA0L).......................................................................................................534 Multiplication/division data register B0 (MDB0)...........................................................................................................535 Multiplier/divider control register 0 (DMUC0) ..............................................................................................................536 [O] Oscillation stabilization time counter status register (OSTC) ......................................................................................118 Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS)....................................................................................................119 [P] Port mode register 0 (PM0)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 1 (PM1)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 12 (PM12).......................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 13 (PM13).......................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 3 (PM3)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 4 (PM4)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 6 (PM6)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 7 (PM7)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 8 (PM8)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port mode register 9 (PM9)...........................................................................................................................................99 Port register 0 (P0)......................................................................................................................................................103 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 685 APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX Port register 1 (P1)......................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 12 (P12) ..................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 13 (P13) ..................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 3 (P3)......................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 4 (P4)......................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 6 (P6)......................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 7 (P7)......................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 8 (P8)......................................................................................................................................................103 Port register 9 (P9)......................................................................................................................................................103 Prescaler mode register 00 (PRM00)..........................................................................................................................162 Prescaler mode register 01 (PRM01)..........................................................................................................................162 Priority specification flag register 0H (PR0H) ..............................................................................................................498 Priority specification flag register 0L (PR0L) ...............................................................................................................498 Priority specification flag register 1H (PR1H) ..............................................................................................................498 Priority specification flag register 1L (PR1L) ...............................................................................................................498 Processor clock control register (PCC) .......................................................................................................................111 Program stetaus word (PSW)......................................................................................................................................500 Pull-up resistor option register 0 (PU0) .......................................................................................................................104 Pull-up resistor option register 1 (PU1) .......................................................................................................................104 Pull-up resistor option register 12 (PU12) ...................................................................................................................104 Pull-up resistor option register 13 (PU13) ...................................................................................................................104 Pull-up resistor option register 3 (PU3) .......................................................................................................................104 Pull-up resistor option register 4 (PU4) .......................................................................................................................104 Pull-up resistor option register 7 (PU7) .......................................................................................................................104 [R] Receive buffer register 60 (RXB60) ............................................................................................................................290 Receive buffer register 61 (RXB61) ............................................................................................................................290 Receive shift register 60 (RXS60) ...............................................................................................................................290 Receive shift register 61 (RXS61) ...............................................................................................................................290 Remainder data register 0 (SDR0)..............................................................................................................................534 Reset control flag register (RESF) ..............................................................................................................................531 [S] Serial clock selection register 10 (CSIC10) .................................................................................................................336 Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) ...............................................................................................................335 Serial I/O shift register 10 (SIO10) ..............................................................................................................................334 [T] Timer clock selection register 50 (TCL50)...................................................................................................................200 Timer clock selection register 51 (TCL51)...................................................................................................................200 Transmit buffer register 10 (SOTB10) .........................................................................................................................334 Transmit buffer register 60 (TXB60)............................................................................................................................290 Transmit buffer register 61 (TXB61)............................................................................................................................290 Transmit shift register 60 (TXS60) ..............................................................................................................................290 Transmit shift register 61 (TXS61) ..............................................................................................................................290 686 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX [W] Watchdog timer enable register (WDTE) ....................................................................................................................248 Watch timer operation mode register (WTM) ..............................................................................................................241 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 687 APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX C.2 Register Index (In Alphabetical Order with Respect to Register Symbol) [A] ADCR: 10-bit A/D conversion result register ...................................................................................................265 ADCRH: 8-bit A/D conversion result register .....................................................................................................266 ADM: A/D converter mode register ...............................................................................................................262 ADPC: A/D port configureation register ..........................................................................................................268 ADS: Analog input channel specification register .........................................................................................267 ASICL60: Asynchronous serial interface control register 60 ...............................................................................304 ASICL61: Asynchronous serial interface control register 61 ...............................................................................304 ASIF60: Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 60............................................................298 ASIF61: Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 61............................................................298 ASIM60: Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 60 .................................................................291 ASIM61: Asynchronous serial interface operation mode register 61 .................................................................291 ASIS60: Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 60 ........................................................296 ASIS61: Asynchronous serial interface reception error status register 61 ........................................................296 [B] BRGC60: Baud rate generator control register 60...............................................................................................302 BRGC61: Baud rate generator control register 61...............................................................................................302 [C] C0BRP: CAN module bit rate prescaler register ...............................................................................................409 C0BTR: CAN module bit rate register...............................................................................................................410 C0CTRL: CAN module control register ...............................................................................................................399 C0ERC: CAN module error counter register .....................................................................................................405 C0GMABT: CAN global automatic block transmission control register ..................................................................394 C0GMABTD: CAN global automatic block transmission delay setting register .........................................................396 C0GMCS: CAN global clock selection register.....................................................................................................393 C0GMCTRL: CAN global control register .................................................................................................................391 C0IE: CAN module interrupt enable register .................................................................................................406 C0INFO: CAN module information register ........................................................................................................404 C0INTS: CAN module interrupt status register ..................................................................................................408 C0LEC: CAN module last error code register ...................................................................................................403 C0LIPT: CAN module last in-pointer register ....................................................................................................412 C0LOPT: CAN module last out-pointer register ..................................................................................................414 C0MCONFm: CAN message configuration register...................................................................................................421 C0MCTRL: CAN message control register ............................................................................................................423 C0MDATAxm: CAN message data byte register xm ..................................................................................................418 C0MDATAzm: CAN message data byte register zm ..................................................................................................418 C0MDLCm: CAN message data length register m .................................................................................................420 C0MASK1H: CAN module mask control register 1H ................................................................................................397 C0MASK1L: CAN module mask control register 1L.................................................................................................397 C0MASK2H: CAN module mask control register 2H ................................................................................................397 C0MASK2L: CAN module mask control register 2H ................................................................................................397 C0MASK3H: CAN module mask control register 3H ................................................................................................397 688 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX C0MASK3L: CAN module mask control register 3L ...................................................................................................397 C0MASK4H: CAN module mask control register 4H ..................................................................................................397 C0MASK4L: CAN module mask control register 4L ...................................................................................................397 C0MIDHm: CAN message id register Hm ................................................................................................................422 C0MIDLm: CAN message id register Lm.................................................................................................................422 C0RGPT: CAN module receive history list register................................................................................................413 C0TGPT: CAN module transmit history list register...............................................................................................415 C0TS: CAN module time stamp register...........................................................................................................416 CKS: Clock output selection register ..............................................................................................................255 CKSR60: Clock selection register 60 ....................................................................................................................300 CKSR61: Clock selection register 61 ....................................................................................................................300 CMP00: 8-bit timer H compare register 00 ..........................................................................................................217 CMP01: 8-bit timer H compare register 01 ..........................................................................................................217 CMP10: 8-bit timer H compare register 10 ..........................................................................................................217 CMP11: 8-bit timer H compare register 11 ..........................................................................................................217 CR000: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 000.............................................................................................149 CR001: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 001.............................................................................................149 CR010: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 010.............................................................................................151 CR011: 16-bit timer capture/compare register 011.............................................................................................151 CR50: 8-bit timer compare register 50..............................................................................................................199 CR51: 8-bit timer compare register 51..............................................................................................................199 CRC00: Capture/compare control register 00 .....................................................................................................157 CRC01: Capture/compare control register 01 .....................................................................................................157 CSIC10: Serial clock selection register 10 ...........................................................................................................336 CSIM10: Serial operation mode register 10..........................................................................................................335 [D] DMUC0: Multiplier/divider control register 0 .........................................................................................................536 [E] EGN: External interrupt falling edge enable register .......................................................................................499 EGP: External interrupt rising edge enable register ........................................................................................499 [F] FLPMC: Flash-programming mode control register.............................................................................................596 [I] IF0H: Interrupt request flag register 0H ...........................................................................................................495 IF0L: Interrupt request flag register 0L ...........................................................................................................495 IF1H: Interrupt request flag register 1H ...........................................................................................................495 IF1L: Interrupt request flag register 1L ...........................................................................................................495 IMS: Internal memory size switching register.................................................................................................570 ISC: Input switch control register...................................................................................................................308 IXS: Internal expansion RAM size switching register ....................................................................................571 [L] LVIM: Low-voltage detection register...............................................................................................................549 LVIS: Low-voltage detection level selection register .......................................................................................550 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 689 APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX [M] MCM: Main clock mode register.........................................................................................................................114 MDA0H: tiplication/division data register A0H........................................................................................................534 MDA0L: ltiplication/division data register A0L........................................................................................................534 MDB0: ltiplication/division data register B0..........................................................................................................535 MK0H: Interrupt mask flag register 0H ................................................................................................................497 MK0L: Interrupt mask flag register 0L .................................................................................................................497 MK1H: Interrupt mask flag register 1H ................................................................................................................497 MK1L: Interrupt mask flag register 1L .................................................................................................................497 MOC: Main OSC control register .......................................................................................................................115 [O] OSCCTL: Clock operation mode select register ......................................................................................................116 OSTC: Oscillation stabilization time counter status register ................................................................................118 OSTS: Oscillation stabilization time select register .............................................................................................119 [P] P0: Port register 0 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P1: Port register 1 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P12: Port register 12 ........................................................................................................................................103 P13: Port register 13 ........................................................................................................................................103 P3: Port register 3 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P4: Port register 4 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P6: Port register 6 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P7: Port register 7 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P8: Port register 8 ..........................................................................................................................................103 P9: Port register 9 ..........................................................................................................................................103 PCC: Processor clock control register...............................................................................................................111 PFCMD: Flash protect command register ..............................................................................................................598 PFS: Flash status register ................................................................................................................................598 PM0: Port mode register 0 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM1: Port mode register 1 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM12: Port mode register 12 ................................................................................................................................99 PM13: Port mode register 13 ................................................................................................................................99 PM3: Port mode register 3 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM4: Port mode register 4 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM6: Port mode register 6 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM7: Port mode register 7 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM8: Port mode register 8 ..................................................................................................................................99 PM9: Port mode register 9 ..................................................................................................................................99 PR0H: Priority specification flag register 0H .......................................................................................................498 PR0L: Priority specification flag register 0L ........................................................................................................498 PR1H: Priority specification flag register 1H .......................................................................................................498 PR1L: Priority specification flag register 1L ........................................................................................................498 PRM00: Prescaler mode register 00 .....................................................................................................................162 PRM01: Prescaler mode register 01 .....................................................................................................................162 690 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX C REGISTER INDEX PSW: Program stetaus word .............................................................................................................................500 PU0: Pull-up resistor option register 0..............................................................................................................104 PU1: Pull-up resistor option register 1..............................................................................................................104 PU12: Pull-up resistor option register 12............................................................................................................104 PU13: Pull-up resistor option register 13............................................................................................................104 PU3: Pull-up resistor option register 3..............................................................................................................104 PU4: Pull-up resistor option register 4..............................................................................................................104 PU7: Pull-up resistor option register 7..............................................................................................................104 [R] RCM: Internal oscillator mode register ..............................................................................................................113 RESF: Reset control flag register .......................................................................................................................531 RXB60: Receive buffer register 60 .......................................................................................................................290 RXB61: Receive buffer register 61 .......................................................................................................................290 RXS60: Receive shift register 60..........................................................................................................................290 RXS61: Receive shift register 61..........................................................................................................................290 [S] SDR0: Remainder data register 0.......................................................................................................................534 SIO10: Serial I/O shift register 10........................................................................................................................334 SOTB10: Transmit buffer register 10 ......................................................................................................................334 [T] TCL50: Timer clock selection register 50.............................................................................................................200 TCL51: Timer clock selection register 51.............................................................................................................200 TM00: 16-bit timer counter 00 ............................................................................................................................148 TM01: 16-bit timer counter 01 ............................................................................................................................148 TM50: 8-bit timer counter 50 ..............................................................................................................................198 TM51: 8-bit timer counter 51 ..............................................................................................................................198 TMC00: 16-bit timer mode control register 00.......................................................................................................154 TMC01: 16-bit timer mode control register 01.......................................................................................................154 TMC50: 8-bit timer mode control register 50.........................................................................................................202 TMC51: 8-bit timer mode control register 51.........................................................................................................202 TMCYC1: 8-bit timer H carrier control register 1 ......................................................................................................221 TMHMD0: 8-bit timer H mode register 0...................................................................................................................218 TMHMD1: 8-bit timer H mode register 1...................................................................................................................218 TOC00: 16-bit timer output control register 00......................................................................................................159 TOC01: 16-bit timer output control register 01......................................................................................................159 TXB60: Transmit buffer register 60 ......................................................................................................................290 TXB61: Transmit buffer register 61 ......................................................................................................................290 TXS60: Transmit shift register 60.........................................................................................................................290 TXS61: Transmit shift register 61.........................................................................................................................290 [W] WDTE: Watchdog timer enable register ..............................................................................................................248 WTM: Watch timer operation mode register ......................................................................................................241 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 691 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY The mark shows major revised points. The revised points can be easily searched by copying an "" in the PDF file and specifying it in the "Fine what:" field. D.1 Main Revisions in this Edition Page p.7 Description Addition of QB-MINI2 in Documents Related to Development Tools (Hardware) (User's Manuals) Change of PG-FPL3 in Documents Related to Flash Memory Programming p.23 p.27 Change of table in 1.5.1 78K0/Fx2 product lineup Change of table in 1.7 Outline of Functions Change of table for timer in 1.7 Outline of Functions p.83 Change of Caution 1 in 4.2.3 Port 3 p.88 Change of Figure 4-12. Block Diagram of P70 p.107 Change of Figure 4-24. Bit Manipulation Instruction (P10) p.163 Change of Figure 6-14. Format of Prescaler Mode Register 00 (PRM00) p.164 Change of Figure 6-15. Format of Prescaler Mode Register 01 (PRM01) p.249 Change of table in 10.4.1 Controlling operation of watchdog timer p.261 Change of the explanation in 12.2 (9) AVREF pin Change of the explanation in 12.2 (12) A/D port configuration register (ADPC) p.489 Change of the explanation in 16.1 (1) Maskable interrupts Change of the explanation in 16.2 Interrupt Sources and Configuration p.490 Change of Table 16-1. Interrupt Source List p.495 Change of Figure 16-2. Format of Interrupt Request Flag Registers (IF0L, IF0H, IF1L, IF1H) p.497 Change of Figure 16-3. Format of Interrupt Mask Flag Registers (MK0L, MK0H, MK1L, MK1H) p.498 Change of Figure 16-4. Format of Priority Specification Flag Registers (PR0L, PR0H, PR1L, PR1H) p.679 Change of A.5.1 When using in-circuit emulator QB-78K0FX2 692 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY D.2 Revision History of Preceding Editions Here is the revision history of the preceding editions. Chapter indicates the chapter of each edition. (1/10) Edition 3rd Description Addition of ANI8 to alternative function of P90 Addition of PG-FPL3 in Documents Related to Flash Memory Programming Change of the explanation in 1.1 Features 1.4 Pin Configuration (Top View) * Addition of Caution 1 to 4 Change of 10-bit A/D converter number for 78K0/FC2 in 1.5.1 78K0/Fx2 product lineup Change of AD converter in 1.7 Outline of Functions Change of EVDD and VDD in Table 2-1. Pin I/O Buffer Power Supplies Change of REGC in Table 2-3. Non-port pins (2/2) Change of 2.2.8 P90 (port 9) Change of 2.2.14 REGC Change of Figure 3-1. Memory Map (PD78F0881, 78F0884) Addition of Note 3 and 4 and Remark in Figure 3-1. Memory Map (PD78F0881, 78F0884) Change of Figure 3-2. Memory Map (PD78F0882, 78F0885) Addition of Note 3 and 4 and Remark in Figure 3-2. Memory Map (PD78F0882, 78F0885) Change of Figure 3-3. Memory Map (PD78F0883, 78F0886) Addition of Note 3 and 4 and Remark in Figure 3-3. Memory Map (PD78F0883, 78F0886) Addition of Table 3-2. Correspondence Between Address Values and Block Numbers in Flash Memory Addition of (5) On-chip debug security ID setting area in 3.1.1 Internal program memory space Addition of Note 1 in Table 3-7. Special Function Register List (4/5) Change of Note in Table 3-7. Special Function Register List (5/5) Change of EVDD and VDD in Table 4-1. Pin I/O Buffer Power Supplies Addition of Caution in 4.2.2 Port 1 Addition of Caution 1 in 4.2.3 Port 3 Change of the explanation in 4.2.5 Port 6 4.2.7 Port 8 * Change of the explanation * Addition of Table 4-4. Setting Functions of P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7 Pins and Caution Change of 4.2.8 Port 9 Addition of Caution 1 in 4.2.9 Port 12 Change of Figure 4-17. Block Diagram of P120 Change of Figure 4-18. Block Diagram of P121 to P124 Addition of ADPC in 4.3 Registers Controlling Port Function Addition of (4) A/D port configuration register (ADPC) in 4.3 Registers Controlling Port Function Addition of 4.5 Cautions on 1-Bit Manipulation Instruction for Port Register n (Pn) Change of Caution 1 and Addition of Caution 3 in 5.3 (4) Main OSC control register (MOC) Change of Caution 2 and 3 in 5.3 (5) Clock operation mode select register (OSCCTL) Addition of the explanation in 5.4.1 X1 oscillator and 5.4.2 XT1 oscillator Addition of (b) External clock in Figure 5-9. Example of External Circuit of X1 Oscillator and Figure 6-10. Example of External Circuit of XT1 Oscillator User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 693 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (2/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of explanation and Remark in 5.4.3 When subsystem clock is not used Figure 5-12 Operation of the clock generating circuit when power supply voltage injection (When 1.59 V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 0)) * Change of Figure 5-12 and Note 2 * Addition of Note 1 Figure 5-13 Operation of the clock generating circuit when power supply voltage injection (When 2.7 V/1.59V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 1)) * Change of Figure 5-13 and Caution 2 * Addition of Caution 1 Change of 5.6.1 Controlling high-speed system clock Change of explanation and Addition of Note in 5.6.1 (2) Example of setting procedure when using the external main system clock Change of 5.6.2 Example of controlling internal high-speed oscillation clock Change of 5.6.3 Example of controlling subsystem clock Figure 5-14. CPU Clock Status Transition Diagram * Change of Figure 5-14 * Addition of Remark Change of Table 5-5. Changing CPU Clock Addition of 5.6.8 Time required for switchover of CPU clock and main system clock Addition of 5.6.9 Conditions before clock oscillation is stopped Change of Figure 6-2. Block Diagram of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counter 01 (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) and Figure 6-3. Block Diagram of 16-Bit Timer/Event Counter 01 (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) Change of explanation and Addition of Caution in 6.2 (1) 16-bit timer counter 0n (TM0n) Addition of Caution in 6.2 (2) 16-bit timer capture/compare register 00n (CR00n) Addition of 6.2 (4) Setting range when CR00n or CR01n is used as a compare register Change of explanation in 6.3 (1) 16-bit timer mode control register 0n (TMC0n) Change of Figure 6-7. Format of 16-Bit Timer Mode Control Register 00 (TMC00) Change of Figure 6-8. Format of 16-Bit Timer Mode Control Register 01 (TMC01) Change of explanation in 6.3 (2) Capture/compare control register 0n (CRC0n) Change of Figure 6-9. Format of Capture/Compare Control Register 00 (CRC00) Addition of Figure 6-10. Example of CR01n Capture Operation (When Rising Edge Is Specified) Change of Figure 6-11. Format of Capture/Compare Control Register 01 (CRC01) Change of explanation and Addition of Caution in 6.3 (3) 16-bit timer output control register 0n (TOC0n) Change of Figure 6-12. Format of 16-Bit Timer Output Control Register 00 (TOC00) Change of Figure 6-13. Format of 16-Bit Timer Output Control Register 01 (TOC01) Change of explanation and Caution 1 to 3 in 6.3 (4) Prescaler mode register 0n (PRM0n) Change of Figure 6-14. Format of Prescaler Mode Register 00 (PRM00) Addition of 6.5 Special Use of TM0n Addition of 6.6 Cautions for 16-Bit Timer/Event Counters 00 and 01 Change of explanation and Caution in 8.2 (1) 8-bit timer H compare register 0n (CMP0n) Change of 8.2 (2) 8-bit timer H compare register 1n (CMP1n) Change of Caution 1 in Figure 8-5. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Mode Register 0 (TMHMD0) Change of Figure 8-6. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Mode Register 1 (TMHMD1) 694 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (3/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of Caution 1 in Figure 8-6. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Mode Register 1 (TMHMD1) Change of Figure 8-7. Format of 8-Bit Timer H Carrier Control Register 1 (TMCYC1) Change of WTM0 bit in Figure 9-2. Format of Watch Timer Operation Mode Register (WTM) Change of explanation in 9.4.1 Watch timer operation Change of Table 9-4. Watch Timer Interrupt Time Change of Figure 9-3. Operation Timing of Watch Timer/Interval Timer Change of explanation in 10.1 Functions of Watchdog Timer Change of explanation in Table 10-2. Setting of Option Bytes and Watchdog Timer and Figure 10-1. Block Diagram of Watchdog Timer Change of explanation in 10.4.1 Controlling operation of watchdog timer Change of Caution 4 and 5 in 10.4.1 Controlling operation of watchdog timer Change of Caution 2 in Table 10-3. Setting of Overflow Time of Watchdog Timer Change of explanation in 10.4.3 Setting window open period of watchdog timer Change of Caution 2 in Table 10-4. Setting Window Open Period of Watchdog Timer Addition of Note1, Caution1 and 2 in Figure 11-2. Format of Clock Output Selection Register (CKS) Figure 12-1. Block Diagram of A/D Converter * Change of figure * Addition of Note 2 Change of explanation in 12.2 (2) Sample & hold circuit, (3) Series resistor string, (4) Voltage comparator and (5) Successive approximation register (SAR) Change of explanation in 12.2 (8) Controller Addition of 12.2 (15) Port mode register 9 (PM9) Change of Note 2 in Figure 12-3. Format of A/D Converter Mode Register (ADM) Change of Table 12-1. Settings of ADCS and ADCE Figure 12-4. Timing Chart When Comparator Is Used * Change of Figure 12-4 and Note Change of (1), (2) and Caution 1 and Addition of Caution 4 in Table 12-2. A/D Conversion Time Selection Change of Figure 12-8. Format of Analog Input Channel Specification Register (ADS) and Caution 1 Change of explanation and Caution 1 in 12.3 (5) A/D port configuration register (ADPC) Change of Figure 12-9. Format of A/D Port Configuration Register (ADPC) Addition of explanation in 12.3 (6) Port mode register 8 (PM8) Addition of 12.3 (7) Port mode register 9 (PM9) Addition of Table 12-3. Setting Functions of P80/ANI0 to P87/ANI7, P90/ANI8 Pins Change of 12.4.1 Basic operations of A/D converter Change of explanation in 12.4.3 (1) A/D conversion operation Change of 12.6 Cautions for A/D Converter Change of explanation and Addition of Caution 3 to 5 in 13.1 (2) Asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode Change of Figure 13-1. LIN Transmission Operation Figure 13-2. LIN Reception Operation * Change of Figure 13-2 and explanation Addition of Figure 13-4. Port Configuration for LIN Reception Operation (UART61) Addition of Caution 3 in 13.2 (3) Transmit buffer register 6n (TXB6n) User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 695 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (4/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of Note 1 in Figure 13-7. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 60 (ASIM60) (1/2) Addition of Caution 4 and 5 in Figure 13-7. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 60 (ASIM60) (2/2) Change of Note 1 in Figure 13-8. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 61 (ASIM61) (1/2) Addition of Caution 4 and 5 in Figure 13-8. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Operation Mode Register 61 (ASIM61) (2/2) Change of bit 0 from INTSR6n to TXSF6n of 13.3 (3) Asynchronous serial interface transmission status register 6n (ASIF6n) and Figure 13-11. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Transmission Status Register 60 (ASIF60) and Figure 13-12. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Transmission Status Register 61 (ASIF61) Figure 13-15. Format of Baud Rate Generator Control Register 60 (BRGC60) * Change of Figure 13-15 and Remark 2 Figure 13-16. Format of Baud Rate Generator Control Register 61 (BRGC61) * Change of Figure 13-16 and1 Remark 2 Change of Caution in 13.3 (6) Asynchronous serial interface control register 6n (ASICL6n) Change of Caution 1, 2 and 4 and Addition of Caution 6 in Figure 13-17. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Control Register 60 (ASICL60) (2/2) Change of Caution 1, 2 and 4 and Addition of Caution 6 in Figure 13-18. Format of Asynchronous Serial Interface Control Register 61 (ASICL61) (2/2) Change of Caution in 13.4.1 (1) Register used Change of explanation in 13.4.2 (2) (c) Normal transmission Change of bit 0 from INTSR6n to TXSF6n of 13.4.2 (d) Continuous transmission Change of bit 0 from INTSR6n to TXSF6n of Figure 13-24. Example of Continuous Transmission Processing Flow Change of bit 0 from INTSR6n to TXSF6n of Figure 13-25. Timing of Starting Continuous Transmission Change of bit 0 from INTSR6n to TXSF6n of Figure 13-26. Timing of Ending Continuous Transmission Change of Caution in 13.4.2 (2) (e) Normal reception Change of explanation in 13.4.2 (2) (h) SBF transmission Change of explanation in 13.4.3 (2) (a) Baud rate Table 13-4. Set Data of Baud Rate Generator * Change of Table 13-4 and Remark Change of Table 13-5. Maximum/Minimum Permissible Baud Rate Error Change of Table 14-1. Configuration of Serial Interface CSI10 and Figure 14-1. Block Diagram of Serial Interface CSI10 * Change of Figure 14-1 * Addition of Remark Change of Note 2 and 5 in Figure 14-2. Format of Serial Operation Mode Register 10 (CSIM10) Change of Caution 2 in Figure 14-3. Format of Serial Clock Selection Register 10 (CSIC10) Change of note 1 in 14.4.1 (1) (a) Serial operation mode register 10 (CSIM10) Addition of Remark 1 in Figure 14-11. Timing of Clock/Data Phase Change of 14.4.2 (3) Timing of output to SO1n pin (first bit) Change of 14.4.2 (4) Output value of SO1n pin (last bit) 696 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (5/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of 14.4.2 (5) SO1n output (see (a) in Figure 14-1) Change of Table 15-1. Overview of Functions Change of Table 15-11. Error Types Change of Table 15-13. Types of Error States Change of explanation in 15.3.6 (4) (b) Error counter Change of Caution in 15.3.6 (4) (c) Occurrence of bit error in intermission Change of explanation in 15.3.6 (5) Recovery from bus-off state Change of explanation and Caution 2 and Addition of Caution 1 in 15.3.6 (5) (a) Recovery operation from bus-off state through normal recovery sequence Change of explanation in 15.3.7 (1) Prescaler Addition of Remark in Figure 15-18. Segment Setting and Figure 15-19. Reference: Configuration of Data Bit Time Defined by CAN Specification Addition of Caution in Table 15-17. Bit Configuration of CAN Global Registers to Table 15-19. Bit Configuration of Message Buffer Registers Movement of 15.6 Bit Set/Clear Function Change of Caution in EFSD bit in 15.7 (1) (a) Read Addition of Caution in GOM bit in 15.7 (1) (b) write Change of Remark 4 in CCERC bit and Remark 3 in VAILD bit in 15.7 (6) (a) Read Addition of Caution 2, 3 in PSMODE1 and PSMODE2 bits and Caution in OPMODE2-OPMODE0 bits in 15.7 (6) (a) Read Addition of Caution in CINTS5 to CINTS0 bit in 15.7 (11) (b) Write Addition of Note in ROVF bit in 15.7 (15) (a) Read Addition of Note in TOVF bit in 15.7 (17) (a) Read Addition of Remark in TSEN bit in 15.7 (18) (a) Read Change of Caution 2 in 15.7 (20) CAN message Data Length Register m (C0MDLCm) Addition of Caution 2 in ID28 to ID0 in 15.7 (22) CAN Message ID Register m (C0MIDLm, C0MIDHm) Addition of Caution in TRQ bit and Caution 2 and 3 in RDY bit in 15.7 (23) (a) Read Addition of Caution in IE bit in 15.7 (23) (b) Write Addition of Caution in RDY bit in 15.7 (23) (b) Write Addition of 15.9.2 Receive Data Read Addition of Caution in 15.9.3 Receive History List Function Change of the explanation in 15.9.4 Mask Function Change of Caution in 15.9.6 Remote Frame Reception Change of the explanation in 15.10.1 Message Transmission Change of Remark 2 in 15.10.1 Message Transmission Addition of Caution in 15.10.2 Transmit History List Function Addition of Remark in 15.11.1 (1) Entering CAN sleep mode Change of the explanation in 15.11.1 (2) Status in CAN sleep mode Change of the explanation and addition of Caution in 15.11.1 (3) Releasing CAN sleep mode Change of the explanation in 15.11.2 (2) Status in CAN stop mode Addition of 15.13.4 Receipt/Transmit Operation in Each Operation Mode Change of explanation in Figure 15-35. Timing Diagram of Capture Signal TSOUT User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 697 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (6/10) Edition 3rd Description Addition of Note 2 in Figure 15-40. Message Buffer Redefinition Addition of Remark in Figure 15-44. Transmission via Interrupt (Using C0LOPT Register) Addition of Remark in Figure 15-45. Transmission via Interrupt (Using C0TGPT Register) Addition of Remark in Figure 15-46. Transmission via Software Polling Addition of Note in Figure 15-47. Transmission Abort Processing (Except Normal Operation Mode with ABT) Addition of Note in Figure 15-48. Transmission Abort Processing Except for ABT Transmission (Normal Operation Mode with ABT) Change of Figure 15-51. Reception via Interrupt (Using C0LIPT Register) and addition of Remark Change of Figure 15-52. Reception via Interrupt (Using C0RGPT Register) and addition of Remark Change of Figure 15-53. Reception via Software Polling and addition of Remark Change of Figure 15-54. Setting CAN Sleep Mode/Stop Mode Change of Figure 15-55. Clear CAN Sleep/Stop Mode Addition of Note, Caution and Remark in Figure 15-56. Bus-Off Recovery (Except Normal Operation Mode with ABT) Addition of Note, Caution and Remark in Figure 15-57. Bus-Off Recovery (Normal Operation Mode with ABT) Change of Figure 15-61. Setting CPU Standby (from CAN Sleep Mode) and addition of Caution Change of Figure 15-62. Setting CPU Standby (from CAN Stop Mode) Change of explanation in 16.1 (1) Maskable interrupts Change of explanation in 16.2 Interrupt Sources and Configuration Addition of Note 3 in Table 16-1. Interrupt Source List (2/2) Addition of Note 3 in Table 16-2. Flags Corresponding to Interrupt Request Sources Change of Caution 3 in 17.1.1 (2) STOP mode Figure 17-1. Format of Oscillation Stabilization Time Counter Status Register (OSTC) * Change of Figure 17-1 and Caution 2 Change of explanation and Caution 3 in 17.1.2 (2) Oscillation stabilization time select register (OSTS) Change of Table 17-1. Operating Statuses in HALT Mode Addition of Note in Table 17-1. Operating Statuses in HALT Mode (2/2) Change of Figure 17-4. HALT Mode Release by Reset Change and addition of Note in Table 17-3. Operating Statuses in STOP Mode Change of Caution 4 in Table 17-3. Operating Statuses in STOP Mode Figure 17-5. Operation Timing When STOP Mode Is Released * Change of Figure 17-5 * Addition of Note1 and 2 Change of Figure 17-6. STOP Mode Release by Interrupt Request Generation Change of 17.2.2 (2) (b) Release by reset signal generation and Figure 17-7. STOP Mode Release by Reset Change of explanation in CHAPTER 18 RESET FUNCTION Change of Figure 18-2. Timing of Reset by RESET Input and Figure 18-3. Timing of Reset Due to Watchdog Timer Overflow Change of Figure 18-4. Timing of Reset in STOP Mode by RESET Input Change of Table 18-1. Operation Statuses During Reset Period Addition of Note 1 in Table 18-2. Hardware Statuses After Reset Acknowledgment (2/3) Addition of Note 1 and change of Note 2 in Table 18-2. Hardware Statuses After Reset Acknowledgment (3/3) 698 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (7/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of explanation in 20.1 Functions of Power-on-Clear Circuit Change of 20.3 Operation of Power-on-Clear Circuit Figure 20-2. Timing of Generation of Internal Reset Signal by Power-on-Clear Circuit and Low-Voltage Detector (1/2) * Change of Figure and Note 2, 4 * Addition of Note 1, 3 Figure 20-2. Timing of Generation of Internal Reset Signal by Power-on-Clear Circuit and Low-Voltage Detector (2/2) * Change of Figure and Note 2 * Addition of Note 1 and Caution 2 Change of Figure 20-3. Example of Software Processing After Reset Release (1/2) Change of explanation in 21.1 Functions of Low-Voltage Detector Change of Figure 21-1. Block Diagram of Low-Voltage Detector Figure 21-2. Format of Low-Voltage Detection Register (LVIM) * Change of Figure and Note 3 Change of Caution 3 in Figure 21-3. Format of Low-Voltage Detection Level Selection Register (LVIS) Change of explanation and Remark in 21.4 Operation of Low-Voltage Detector Change of explanation in 21.4.1 (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD) Change of explanation and Note 2 in 21.4.2 (2) When detecting level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) Change of Figure 21-6. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Internal Reset Signal Generation (Detects Level of Input Voltage from External Input Pin (EXLVI)) Change of explanation in 21.4.1 (1) When detecting level of supply voltage (VDD) Figure 21-7. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Interrupt Signal Generation (Detects Level of Supply Voltage (VDD)) * Change of Figure 21-7 and Note 2 Change of explanation in 21.4.2 (2) When detecting level of input voltage from external input pin (EXLVI) Figure 21-8. Timing of Low-Voltage Detector Interrupt Signal Generation (Detects Level of Input Voltage from External Input Pin (EXLVI)) * Change of Figure 21-8 and Note 2 Change of explanation in 21.5 Cautions for Low-Voltage Detector Change of Figure 21-9. Example of Software Processing After Reset Release (1/2) Change of CHAPTER 22 OPTION BYTE Addition of Caution in 23.1 Internal Memory Size Switching Register Addition of Caution and change in 23.2 Internal Expansion RAM Size Switching Register Change of Note 2 in Table 23-3. Wiring Between 78K0/FC2 and Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) Change of Figure 23-3. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in 3-Wire Serial I/O (CSI10) Mode (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) Figure 23-4. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in UART (UART60) Mode (PD78F0881, 78F0882, 78F0883) * Change of Figure 23-4 * Addition of Note User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 699 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (8/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of Note 2 in Table 23-4. Wiring Between 78K0/FC2 and Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) Change of Figure 23-5. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in 3-Wire Serial I/O (CSI10) Mode (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) Figure 23-6. Example of Wiring Adapter for Flash Memory Writing in UART (UART60) Mode (PD78F0884, 78F0885, 78F0886) * Change of Figure 23-6 * Addition of Note Change of explanation in 23.5 (1) CSI10 Change of Figure 23-8. Communication with Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer (CSI10) Figure 23-9. Communication with Dedicated Flash Memory Programmer (UART60) * Change of Figure and Note Change of explanation in 23.5 (2) UART60 Table 23-5. Pin Connection * Change of Table and Note 1 Change of explanation in 23.6.5 REGC pin Change of explanation and Caution 3 in 23.6.6 Other signal pins Change of explanation in 23.6.7 Power supply Change of Note 1 in Table 23-8. Communication Modes Addition of 23.8 Security Settings Addition of 23.9 Processing Time for Each Command When PG-FP4 Is Used (Reference) Change of Figure 23-17. Operation Mode and Memory Map for Self-Programming (PD78F0883, 78F0886) Change of Figure 23-18. Self-Programming Procedure Addition of Table 23-14. Processing Time and Interrupt Response Time for Self Programming Sample Library Change of 23.11 Boot swap function Change of Caution in 24.1 Outline of Functions Addition of Note and Caution in Figure 24-2. Connection Circuit Example (When QB-78K0MINI Is Not Used) and Figure 24-3. Connection Circuit Example (When Using QB-78K0MINI: X1 and X2 Are Used) Addition of Note in Figure 24-4. Connection Circuit Example (When Using QB-78K0MINI: Ports 31 and 32 Are Used) Addition of Figure 24-5. Connection of FLMD0 Pin for Self Programming by Means of On-Chip Debugging Addition of 24.4 On-Chip Debug Security Change of 24.5 Restrictions and Cautions on On-Chip Debug Function 26.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings * Addition of REGC pin input voltage of Absolute Maximum Ratings * Addition of IOH2 and IOH3 in Output current, high of Absolute Maximum Ratings * Addition of IOL2 and IOL3 in Output current, low of Absolute Maximum Ratings 26.2 Oscillator Characteristics * Addition of RSTS = 1 and RSTS = 0 in the condition of 8 MHz internal oscillator * Change of MAX. and MIN. value of 240 kHz internal oscillator * Addition of Remark in (2) On-chip Internal Oscillator Characteristics 700 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (9/10) Edition 3rd Description 26.3 DC Characteristics * Change of MAX. value of Output current, high in 4.0 V VDD = EVDD 5.5 V and 2.7 V VDD = EVDD < 4.0 V * Addition of Note 1 to 3 and change of Remark of Output current, high and Output current, low * Change of MAX. value of Output current, high * Addition of VIH4 of Input voltage, high * Addition of IOL = 5.0 mA, 2.0 mA in the condition of Output voltage, low * Change of MAX. value of Output voltage, low (IOL = 1.0 mA and VOL3, IOL = 5.0 mA, 3.0 mA, 1.0 mA) * Change of Supply current, A/D converter operating current, Watchdog timer operating current, LVI operating current 26.4 (1) Basic operation * Change of MIN. value of External clock input high level width, low level width, External sub clock input high level width, low level width and TI000, TI010, TI011 input high-level width, low-level width * Addition of Peripheral hardware clock frequency and Note 1, 2 * Change of TCY vs. VDD (Main System Clock Operation) * Change of External clock input timing Change of MAX. value of Transfer rate in (a) UART mode (UART6n, dedicated baud rate generator output) Change of MIN. value of SCK1n cycle time, SCK1n high-/low-level width, SI1n setup time (to SCK1n) in 26.4 (2) (b) 3-wire serial I/O mode (master mode, SCK1n... internal clock output) Change of MAX. value of Delay time from SCK1n to SO1n output in 26.4 (2) (c) 3-wire serial I/O mode (slave mode, SCK1n... external clock input) 26.4 (4) A/D Converter Characteristics * Addition of MAX. value of Overall, Conversion time, Zero-scale error, Full-scale error, Integral non-linearity error, Differential non-linearity error Change of MIN. value of Power supply rise time, Minimum pulse width in 26.4 (5) POC Circuit Characteristics 26.4 (6) LVI Circuit Characteristics * Addition of condition * Addition of MIN. and MAX. value of External input pin * Addition of Detection voltage on application of supply voltage of Detection voltage * Change of value of Minimum pulse width * Change of LVI Circuit Timing Change of value of Starting maximum time to VDD min (1.8 V) (VDD: 0 V1.8 V) and Starting maximum time to VDD min (1.8 V) (pin RESET releaseVDD: 1.8 V) in 26.4 (7) Power Supply Starting Time Change of Note in 26.5 Data Retention Characteristics Change of 26.6 Flash EEPROM Programming Characteristics Addition of CHAPTER 27 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ((A2) GRADE PRODUCTS) Change of 44-PIN PLASTIC LQFP (10x10) and 64-PIN PLASTIC LQFP (FINE PITCH) (12x12) in CHAPTER 28 PACKAGE DRAWINGS Addition of CHAPTER 29 RECOMMENDED SOLDERING CONDITIONS Change of Table 30-1. Registers That Generate Wait and Number of CPU Wait Clocks Change of 30.3 Example of Wait Occurrence Change of explanation in Windows Addition of Note 1 in Figure A-1. Development Tool Configuration Addition of (3) When using the on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 in Figure A-1. Development Tool Configuration User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 701 APPENDIX D REVISION HISTORY (10/10) Edition 3rd Description Change of DF780893 Device file, Note 1 and Remark in A.2 Language Processing Software Change of A.4 Flash Memory Programming Tools Change of explanation and Note in A.5.1 When using in-circuit emulator QB-78K0FX2 Addition of Remark in A.5.2 When using on-chip debug emulator QB-78K0MINI Addition of A.5.3 When using on-chip debug emulator with programming function QB-MINI2 Change of A.6 Debugging Tools (Software) 2nd Modification of part number in 1. 3 Ordering Information Addition of Caution 2 in 2.2.3 P30 to P33 (port 3) Addition of Caution in 2.2.10 P120 to P124 (port 12) Addition of Note in Table 2-4 Pin I/O Circuit Types (1/2) Addition of Note 3 in Table 2-4 Pin I/O Circuit Types (2/2) Addition of Caution 2 in 4.2.3 Port 3 Addition of Caution in 4.2.10 Port 12 Modification of processing time in Figure 5-12 Operation of the clock generating circuit when power supply voltage injection (When 1.59 V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 0)) Modification of processing time in Figure 5-13 Operation of the clock generating circuit when power supply voltage injection (When 2.7 V/1.59V POC mode setup (option byte: LVISTART = 1)) Modification of address to FF8FH in Figure 9-2 Format of Watch Timer Operation Mode Register (WTM) Addition of Caution in 23.7.4 Port pins Addition of Caution 3 in 23.7.6 Other signal pins Modification of standard setting in Table 23-7 Communication Modes Modification of Note 4 in 26.3 DC characteristics 702 User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD [MEMO] User's Manual U17555EJ4V0UD 703 For further information, please contact: NEC Electronics Corporation 1753, Shimonumabe, Nakahara-ku, Kawasaki, Kanagawa 211-8668, Japan Tel: 044-435-5111 http://www.necel.com/ [America] [Europe] [Asia & Oceania] NEC Electronics America, Inc. 2880 Scott Blvd. Santa Clara, CA 95050-2554, U.S.A. Tel: 408-588-6000 800-366-9782 http://www.am.necel.com/ NEC Electronics (Europe) GmbH Arcadiastrasse 10 40472 Dusseldorf, Germany Tel: 0211-65030 http://www.eu.necel.com/ NEC Electronics (China) Co., Ltd 7th Floor, Quantum Plaza, No. 27 ZhiChunLu Haidian District, Beijing 100083, P.R.China Tel: 010-8235-1155 http://www.cn.necel.com/ Hanover Office Podbielskistrasse 166 B 30177 Hannover Tel: 0 511 33 40 2-0 Munich Office Werner-Eckert-Strasse 9 81829 Munchen Tel: 0 89 92 10 03-0 Stuttgart Office Industriestrasse 3 70565 Stuttgart Tel: 0 711 99 01 0-0 United Kingdom Branch Cygnus House, Sunrise Parkway Linford Wood, Milton Keynes MK14 6NP, U.K. Tel: 01908-691-133 Succursale Francaise 9, rue Paul Dautier, B.P. 52 78142 Velizy-Villacoublay Cedex France Tel: 01-3067-5800 Sucursal en Espana Juan Esplandiu, 15 28007 Madrid, Spain Tel: 091-504-2787 Tyskland Filial Taby Centrum Entrance S (7th floor) 18322 Taby, Sweden Tel: 08 638 72 00 NEC Electronics Shanghai Ltd. Room 2511-2512, Bank of China Tower, 200 Yincheng Road Central, Pudong New Area, Shanghai P.R. China P.C:200120 Tel: 021-5888-5400 http://www.cn.necel.com/ NEC Electronics Hong Kong Ltd. Unit 1601-1613, 16/F., Tower 2, Grand Century Place, 193 Prince Edward Road West, Mongkok, Kowloon, Hong Kong Tel: 2886-9318 http://www.hk.necel.com/ NEC Electronics Taiwan Ltd. 7F, No. 363 Fu Shing North Road Taipei, Taiwan, R. O. C. Tel: 02-8175-9600 http://www.tw.necel.com/ NEC Electronics Singapore Pte. Ltd. 238A Thomson Road, #12-08 Novena Square, Singapore 307684 Tel: 6253-8311 http://www.sg.necel.com/ NEC Electronics Korea Ltd. 11F., Samik Lavied'or Bldg., 720-2, Yeoksam-Dong, Kangnam-Ku, Seoul, 135-080, Korea Tel: 02-558-3737 http://www.kr.necel.com/ Filiale Italiana Via Fabio Filzi, 25/A 20124 Milano, Italy Tel: 02-667541 Branch The Netherlands Steijgerweg 6 5616 HS Eindhoven The Netherlands Tel: 040 265 40 10 G07.1A